oracular (1) ffmpeg-all.1.gz

Provided by: ffmpeg_7.0.2-3ubuntu1_amd64 bug

NAME

       ffmpeg - ffmpeg media converter

SYNOPSIS

       ffmpeg [global_options] {[input_file_options] -i input_url} ... {[output_file_options] output_url} ...

DESCRIPTION

       ffmpeg is a universal media converter. It can read a wide variety of inputs - including live
       grabbing/recording devices - filter, and transcode them into a plethora of output formats.

       ffmpeg reads from an arbitrary number of input "files" (which can be regular files, pipes, network
       streams, grabbing devices, etc.), specified by the "-i" option, and writes to an arbitrary number of
       output "files", which are specified by a plain output url. Anything found on the command line which
       cannot be interpreted as an option is considered to be an output url.

       Each input or output url can, in principle, contain any number of streams of different types
       (video/audio/subtitle/attachment/data). The allowed number and/or types of streams may be limited by the
       container format. Selecting which streams from which inputs will go into which output is either done
       automatically or with the "-map" option (see the Stream selection chapter).

       To refer to input files in options, you must use their indices (0-based). E.g.  the first input file is
       0, the second is 1, etc. Similarly, streams within a file are referred to by their indices. E.g. "2:3"
       refers to the fourth stream in the third input file. Also see the Stream specifiers chapter.

       As a general rule, options are applied to the next specified file. Therefore, order is important, and you
       can have the same option on the command line multiple times. Each occurrence is then applied to the next
       input or output file.  Exceptions from this rule are the global options (e.g. verbosity level), which
       should be specified first.

       Do not mix input and output files -- first specify all input files, then all output files. Also do not
       mix options which belong to different files. All options apply ONLY to the next input or output file and
       are reset between files.

       Some simple examples follow.

       •   Convert an input media file to a different format, by re-encoding media streams:

                   ffmpeg -i input.avi output.mp4

       •   Set the video bitrate of the output file to 64 kbit/s:

                   ffmpeg -i input.avi -b:v 64k -bufsize 64k output.mp4

       •   Force the frame rate of the output file to 24 fps:

                   ffmpeg -i input.avi -r 24 output.mp4

       •   Force the frame rate of the input file (valid for raw formats only) to 1 fps and the frame rate of
           the output file to 24 fps:

                   ffmpeg -r 1 -i input.m2v -r 24 output.mp4

       The format option may be needed for raw input files.

DETAILED DESCRIPTION

       The transcoding process in ffmpeg for each output can be described by the following diagram:

                _______              ______________
               |       |            |              |
               | input |  demuxer   | encoded data |   decoder
               | file  | ---------> | packets      | -----+
               |_______|            |______________|      |
                                                          v
                                                      _________
                                                     |         |
                                                     | decoded |
                                                     | frames  |
                                                     |_________|
                ________             ______________       |
               |        |           |              |      |
               | output | <-------- | encoded data | <----+
               | file   |   muxer   | packets      |   encoder
               |________|           |______________|

       ffmpeg calls the libavformat library (containing demuxers) to read input files and get packets containing
       encoded data from them. When there are multiple input files, ffmpeg tries to keep them synchronized by
       tracking lowest timestamp on any active input stream.

       Encoded packets are then passed to the decoder (unless streamcopy is selected for the stream, see further
       for a description). The decoder produces uncompressed frames (raw video/PCM audio/...) which can be
       processed further by filtering (see next section). After filtering, the frames are passed to the encoder,
       which encodes them and outputs encoded packets. Finally, those are passed to the muxer, which writes the
       encoded packets to the output file.

   Filtering
       Before encoding, ffmpeg can process raw audio and video frames using filters from the libavfilter
       library. Several chained filters form a filter graph. ffmpeg distinguishes between two types of
       filtergraphs: simple and complex.

       Simple filtergraphs

       Simple filtergraphs are those that have exactly one input and output, both of the same type. In the above
       diagram they can be represented by simply inserting an additional step between decoding and encoding:

                _________                        ______________
               |         |                      |              |
               | decoded |                      | encoded data |
               | frames  |\                   _ | packets      |
               |_________| \                  /||______________|
                            \   __________   /
                 simple     _\||          | /  encoder
                 filtergraph   | filtered |/
                               | frames   |
                               |__________|

       Simple filtergraphs are configured with the per-stream -filter option (with -vf and -af aliases for video
       and audio respectively).  A simple filtergraph for video can look for example like this:

                _______        _____________        _______        ________
               |       |      |             |      |       |      |        |
               | input | ---> | deinterlace | ---> | scale | ---> | output |
               |_______|      |_____________|      |_______|      |________|

       Note that some filters change frame properties but not frame contents. E.g. the "fps" filter in the
       example above changes number of frames, but does not touch the frame contents. Another example is the
       "setpts" filter, which only sets timestamps and otherwise passes the frames unchanged.

       Complex filtergraphs

       Complex filtergraphs are those which cannot be described as simply a linear processing chain applied to
       one stream. This is the case, for example, when the graph has more than one input and/or output, or when
       output stream type is different from input. They can be represented with the following diagram:

                _________
               |         |
               | input 0 |\                    __________
               |_________| \                  |          |
                            \   _________    /| output 0 |
                             \ |         |  / |__________|
                _________     \| complex | /
               |         |     |         |/
               | input 1 |---->| filter  |\
               |_________|     |         | \   __________
                              /| graph   |  \ |          |
                             / |         |   \| output 1 |
                _________   /  |_________|    |__________|
               |         | /
               | input 2 |/
               |_________|

       Complex filtergraphs are configured with the -filter_complex option.  Note that this option is global,
       since a complex filtergraph, by its nature, cannot be unambiguously associated with a single stream or
       file.

       The -lavfi option is equivalent to -filter_complex.

       A trivial example of a complex filtergraph is the "overlay" filter, which has two video inputs and one
       video output, containing one video overlaid on top of the other. Its audio counterpart is the "amix"
       filter.

   Stream copy
       Stream copy is a mode selected by supplying the "copy" parameter to the -codec option. It makes ffmpeg
       omit the decoding and encoding step for the specified stream, so it does only demuxing and muxing. It is
       useful for changing the container format or modifying container-level metadata. The diagram above will,
       in this case, simplify to this:

                _______              ______________            ________
               |       |            |              |          |        |
               | input |  demuxer   | encoded data |  muxer   | output |
               | file  | ---------> | packets      | -------> | file   |
               |_______|            |______________|          |________|

       Since there is no decoding or encoding, it is very fast and there is no quality loss. However, it might
       not work in some cases because of many factors. Applying filters is obviously also impossible, since
       filters work on uncompressed data.

   Loopback decoders
       While decoders are normally associated with demuxer streams, it is also possible to create "loopback"
       decoders that decode the output from some encoder and allow it to be fed back to complex filtergraphs.
       This is done with the "-dec" directive, which takes as a parameter the index of the output stream that
       should be decoded. Every such directive creates a new loopback decoder, indexed with successive integers
       starting at zero. These indices should then be used to refer to loopback decoders in complex filtergraph
       link labels, as described in the documentation for -filter_complex.

       E.g. the following example:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT                                        \
                 -map 0:v:0 -c:v libx264 -crf 45 -f null -            \
                 -dec 0:0 -filter_complex '[0:v][dec:0]hstack[stack]' \
                 -map '[stack]' -c:v ffv1 OUTPUT

       reads an input video and

       •   (line 2) encodes it with "libx264" at low quality;

       •   (line 3) decodes this encoded stream and places it side by side with the original input video;

       •   (line 4) combined video is then losslessly encoded and written into OUTPUT.

STREAM SELECTION

       ffmpeg provides the "-map" option for manual control of stream selection in each output file. Users can
       skip "-map" and let ffmpeg perform automatic stream selection as described below. The "-vn / -an / -sn /
       -dn" options can be used to skip inclusion of video, audio, subtitle and data streams respectively,
       whether manually mapped or automatically selected, except for those streams which are outputs of complex
       filtergraphs.

   Description
       The sub-sections that follow describe the various rules that are involved in stream selection.  The
       examples that follow next show how these rules are applied in practice.

       While every effort is made to accurately reflect the behavior of the program, FFmpeg is under continuous
       development and the code may have changed since the time of this writing.

       Automatic stream selection

       In the absence of any map options for a particular output file, ffmpeg inspects the output format to
       check which type of streams can be included in it, viz. video, audio and/or subtitles. For each
       acceptable stream type, ffmpeg will pick one stream, when available, from among all the inputs.

       It will select that stream based upon the following criteria:

       •   for video, it is the stream with the highest resolution,

       •   for audio, it is the stream with the most channels,

       •   for subtitles, it is the first subtitle stream found but there's a caveat.  The output format's
           default subtitle encoder can be either text-based or image-based, and only a subtitle stream of the
           same type will be chosen.

       In the case where several streams of the same type rate equally, the stream with the lowest index is
       chosen.

       Data or attachment streams are not automatically selected and can only be included using "-map".

       Manual stream selection

       When "-map" is used, only user-mapped streams are included in that output file, with one possible
       exception for filtergraph outputs described below.

       Complex filtergraphs

       If there are any complex filtergraph output streams with unlabeled pads, they will be added to the first
       output file. This will lead to a fatal error if the stream type is not supported by the output format. In
       the absence of the map option, the inclusion of these streams leads to the automatic stream selection of
       their types being skipped. If map options are present, these filtergraph streams are included in addition
       to the mapped streams.

       Complex filtergraph output streams with labeled pads must be mapped once and exactly once.

       Stream handling

       Stream handling is independent of stream selection, with an exception for subtitles described below.
       Stream handling is set via the "-codec" option addressed to streams within a specific output file. In
       particular, codec options are applied by ffmpeg after the stream selection process and thus do not
       influence the latter. If no "-codec" option is specified for a stream type, ffmpeg will select the
       default encoder registered by the output file muxer.

       An exception exists for subtitles. If a subtitle encoder is specified for an output file, the first
       subtitle stream found of any type, text or image, will be included. ffmpeg does not validate if the
       specified encoder can convert the selected stream or if the converted stream is acceptable within the
       output format. This applies generally as well: when the user sets an encoder manually, the stream
       selection process cannot check if the encoded stream can be muxed into the output file.  If it cannot,
       ffmpeg will abort and all output files will fail to be processed.

   Examples
       The following examples illustrate the behavior, quirks and limitations of ffmpeg's stream selection
       methods.

       They assume the following three input files.

               input file 'A.avi'
                     stream 0: video 640x360
                     stream 1: audio 2 channels

               input file 'B.mp4'
                     stream 0: video 1920x1080
                     stream 1: audio 2 channels
                     stream 2: subtitles (text)
                     stream 3: audio 5.1 channels
                     stream 4: subtitles (text)

               input file 'C.mkv'
                     stream 0: video 1280x720
                     stream 1: audio 2 channels
                     stream 2: subtitles (image)

       Example: automatic stream selection

               ffmpeg -i A.avi -i B.mp4 out1.mkv out2.wav -map 1:a -c:a copy out3.mov

       There are three output files specified, and for the first two, no "-map" options are set, so ffmpeg will
       select streams for these two files automatically.

       out1.mkv is a Matroska container file and accepts video, audio and subtitle streams, so ffmpeg will try
       to select one of each type.For video, it will select "stream 0" from B.mp4, which has the highest
       resolution among all the input video streams.For audio, it will select "stream 3" from B.mp4, since it
       has the greatest number of channels.For subtitles, it will select "stream 2" from B.mp4, which is the
       first subtitle stream from among A.avi and B.mp4.

       out2.wav accepts only audio streams, so only "stream 3" from B.mp4 is selected.

       For out3.mov, since a "-map" option is set, no automatic stream selection will occur. The "-map 1:a"
       option will select all audio streams from the second input B.mp4. No other streams will be included in
       this output file.

       For the first two outputs, all included streams will be transcoded. The encoders chosen will be the
       default ones registered by each output format, which may not match the codec of the selected input
       streams.

       For the third output, codec option for audio streams has been set to "copy", so no decoding-filtering-
       encoding operations will occur, or can occur.  Packets of selected streams shall be conveyed from the
       input file and muxed within the output file.

       Example: automatic subtitles selection

               ffmpeg -i C.mkv out1.mkv -c:s dvdsub -an out2.mkv

       Although out1.mkv is a Matroska container file which accepts subtitle streams, only a video and audio
       stream shall be selected. The subtitle stream of C.mkv is image-based and the default subtitle encoder of
       the Matroska muxer is text-based, so a transcode operation for the subtitles is expected to fail and
       hence the stream isn't selected. However, in out2.mkv, a subtitle encoder is specified in the command and
       so, the subtitle stream is selected, in addition to the video stream. The presence of "-an" disables
       audio stream selection for out2.mkv.

       Example: unlabeled filtergraph outputs

               ffmpeg -i A.avi -i C.mkv -i B.mp4 -filter_complex "overlay" out1.mp4 out2.srt

       A filtergraph is setup here using the "-filter_complex" option and consists of a single video filter. The
       "overlay" filter requires exactly two video inputs, but none are specified, so the first two available
       video streams are used, those of A.avi and C.mkv. The output pad of the filter has no label and so is
       sent to the first output file out1.mp4. Due to this, automatic selection of the video stream is skipped,
       which would have selected the stream in B.mp4. The audio stream with most channels viz. "stream 3" in
       B.mp4, is chosen automatically. No subtitle stream is chosen however, since the MP4 format has no default
       subtitle encoder registered, and the user hasn't specified a subtitle encoder.

       The 2nd output file, out2.srt, only accepts text-based subtitle streams. So, even though the first
       subtitle stream available belongs to C.mkv, it is image-based and hence skipped.  The selected stream,
       "stream 2" in B.mp4, is the first text-based subtitle stream.

       Example: labeled filtergraph outputs

               ffmpeg -i A.avi -i B.mp4 -i C.mkv -filter_complex "[1:v]hue=s=0[outv];overlay;aresample" \
                      -map '[outv]' -an        out1.mp4 \
                                               out2.mkv \
                      -map '[outv]' -map 1:a:0 out3.mkv

       The above command will fail, as the output pad labelled "[outv]" has been mapped twice.  None of the
       output files shall be processed.

               ffmpeg -i A.avi -i B.mp4 -i C.mkv -filter_complex "[1:v]hue=s=0[outv];overlay;aresample" \
                      -an        out1.mp4 \
                                 out2.mkv \
                      -map 1:a:0 out3.mkv

       This command above will also fail as the hue filter output has a label, "[outv]", and hasn't been mapped
       anywhere.

       The command should be modified as follows,

               ffmpeg -i A.avi -i B.mp4 -i C.mkv -filter_complex "[1:v]hue=s=0,split=2[outv1][outv2];overlay;aresample" \
                       -map '[outv1]' -an        out1.mp4 \
                                                 out2.mkv \
                       -map '[outv2]' -map 1:a:0 out3.mkv

       The video stream from B.mp4 is sent to the hue filter, whose output is cloned once using the split
       filter, and both outputs labelled. Then a copy each is mapped to the first and third output files.

       The overlay filter, requiring two video inputs, uses the first two unused video streams. Those are the
       streams from A.avi and C.mkv. The overlay output isn't labelled, so it is sent to the first output file
       out1.mp4, regardless of the presence of the "-map" option.

       The aresample filter is sent the first unused audio stream, that of A.avi. Since this filter output is
       also unlabelled, it too is mapped to the first output file. The presence of "-an" only suppresses
       automatic or manual stream selection of audio streams, not outputs sent from filtergraphs. Both these
       mapped streams shall be ordered before the mapped stream in out1.mp4.

       The video, audio and subtitle streams mapped to "out2.mkv" are entirely determined by automatic stream
       selection.

       out3.mkv consists of the cloned video output from the hue filter and the first audio stream from B.mp4.

OPTIONS

       All the numerical options, if not specified otherwise, accept a string representing a number as input,
       which may be followed by one of the SI unit prefixes, for example: 'K', 'M', or 'G'.

       If 'i' is appended to the SI unit prefix, the complete prefix will be interpreted as a unit prefix for
       binary multiples, which are based on powers of 1024 instead of powers of 1000. Appending 'B' to the SI
       unit prefix multiplies the value by 8. This allows using, for example: 'KB', 'MiB', 'G' and 'B' as number
       suffixes.

       Options which do not take arguments are boolean options, and set the corresponding value to true. They
       can be set to false by prefixing the option name with "no". For example using "-nofoo" will set the
       boolean option with name "foo" to false.

       Options that take arguments support a special syntax where the argument given on the command line is
       interpreted as a path to the file from which the actual argument value is loaded. To use this feature,
       add a forward slash '/' immediately before the option name (after the leading dash). E.g.

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -/filter:v filter.script OUTPUT

       will load a filtergraph description from the file named filter.script.

   Stream specifiers
       Some options are applied per-stream, e.g. bitrate or codec. Stream specifiers are used to precisely
       specify which stream(s) a given option belongs to.

       A stream specifier is a string generally appended to the option name and separated from it by a colon.
       E.g. "-codec:a:1 ac3" contains the "a:1" stream specifier, which matches the second audio stream.
       Therefore, it would select the ac3 codec for the second audio stream.

       A stream specifier can match several streams, so that the option is applied to all of them. E.g. the
       stream specifier in "-b:a 128k" matches all audio streams.

       An empty stream specifier matches all streams. For example, "-codec copy" or "-codec: copy" would copy
       all the streams without reencoding.

       Possible forms of stream specifiers are:

       stream_index
           Matches the stream with this index. E.g. "-threads:1 4" would set the thread count for the second
           stream to 4. If stream_index is used as an additional stream specifier (see below), then it selects
           stream number stream_index from the matching streams. Stream numbering is based on the order of the
           streams as detected by libavformat except when a stream group specifier or program ID is also
           specified. In this case it is based on the ordering of the streams in the group or program.

       stream_type[:additional_stream_specifier]
           stream_type is one of following: 'v' or 'V' for video, 'a' for audio, 's' for subtitle, 'd' for data,
           and 't' for attachments. 'v' matches all video streams, 'V' only matches video streams which are not
           attached pictures, video thumbnails or cover arts. If additional_stream_specifier is used, then it
           matches streams which both have this type and match the additional_stream_specifier. Otherwise, it
           matches all streams of the specified type.

       g:group_specifier[:additional_stream_specifier]
           Matches streams which are in the group with the specifier group_specifier.  if
           additional_stream_specifier is used, then it matches streams which both are part of the group and
           match the additional_stream_specifier.  group_specifier may be one of the following:

           group_index
               Match the stream with this group index.

           #group_id or i:group_id
               Match the stream with this group id.

       p:program_id[:additional_stream_specifier]
           Matches streams which are in the program with the id program_id. If additional_stream_specifier is
           used, then it matches streams which both are part of the program and match the
           additional_stream_specifier.

       #stream_id or i:stream_id
           Match the stream by stream id (e.g. PID in MPEG-TS container).

       m:key[:value]
           Matches streams with the metadata tag key having the specified value. If value is not given, matches
           streams that contain the given tag with any value.

       u   Matches streams with usable configuration, the codec must be defined and the essential information
           such as video dimension or audio sample rate must be present.

           Note that in ffmpeg, matching by metadata will only work properly for input files.

   Generic options
       These options are shared amongst the ff* tools.

       -L  Show license.

       -h, -?, -help, --help [arg]
           Show help. An optional parameter may be specified to print help about a specific item. If no argument
           is specified, only basic (non advanced) tool options are shown.

           Possible values of arg are:

           long
               Print advanced tool options in addition to the basic tool options.

           full
               Print complete list of options, including shared and private options for encoders, decoders,
               demuxers, muxers, filters, etc.

           decoder=decoder_name
               Print detailed information about the decoder named decoder_name. Use the -decoders option to get
               a list of all decoders.

           encoder=encoder_name
               Print detailed information about the encoder named encoder_name. Use the -encoders option to get
               a list of all encoders.

           demuxer=demuxer_name
               Print detailed information about the demuxer named demuxer_name. Use the -formats option to get a
               list of all demuxers and muxers.

           muxer=muxer_name
               Print detailed information about the muxer named muxer_name. Use the -formats option to get a
               list of all muxers and demuxers.

           filter=filter_name
               Print detailed information about the filter named filter_name. Use the -filters option to get a
               list of all filters.

           bsf=bitstream_filter_name
               Print detailed information about the bitstream filter named bitstream_filter_name.  Use the -bsfs
               option to get a list of all bitstream filters.

           protocol=protocol_name
               Print detailed information about the protocol named protocol_name.  Use the -protocols option to
               get a list of all protocols.

       -version
           Show version.

       -buildconf
           Show the build configuration, one option per line.

       -formats
           Show available formats (including devices).

       -demuxers
           Show available demuxers.

       -muxers
           Show available muxers.

       -devices
           Show available devices.

       -codecs
           Show all codecs known to libavcodec.

           Note that the term 'codec' is used throughout this documentation as a shortcut for what is more
           correctly called a media bitstream format.

       -decoders
           Show available decoders.

       -encoders
           Show all available encoders.

       -bsfs
           Show available bitstream filters.

       -protocols
           Show available protocols.

       -filters
           Show available libavfilter filters.

       -pix_fmts
           Show available pixel formats.

       -sample_fmts
           Show available sample formats.

       -layouts
           Show channel names and standard channel layouts.

       -dispositions
           Show stream dispositions.

       -colors
           Show recognized color names.

       -sources device[,opt1=val1[,opt2=val2]...]
           Show autodetected sources of the input device.  Some devices may provide system-dependent source
           names that cannot be autodetected.  The returned list cannot be assumed to be always complete.

                   ffmpeg -sources pulse,server=192.168.0.4

       -sinks device[,opt1=val1[,opt2=val2]...]
           Show autodetected sinks of the output device.  Some devices may provide system-dependent sink names
           that cannot be autodetected.  The returned list cannot be assumed to be always complete.

                   ffmpeg -sinks pulse,server=192.168.0.4

       -loglevel [flags+]loglevel | -v [flags+]loglevel
           Set logging level and flags used by the library.

           The optional flags prefix can consist of the following values:

           repeat
               Indicates that repeated log output should not be compressed to the first line and the "Last
               message repeated n times" line will be omitted.

           level
               Indicates that log output should add a "[level]" prefix to each message line. This can be used as
               an alternative to log coloring, e.g. when dumping the log to file.

           Flags can also be used alone by adding a '+'/'-' prefix to set/reset a single flag without affecting
           other flags or changing loglevel. When setting both flags and loglevel, a '+' separator is expected
           between the last flags value and before loglevel.

           loglevel is a string or a number containing one of the following values:

           quiet, -8
               Show nothing at all; be silent.

           panic, 0
               Only show fatal errors which could lead the process to crash, such as an assertion failure. This
               is not currently used for anything.

           fatal, 8
               Only show fatal errors. These are errors after which the process absolutely cannot continue.

           error, 16
               Show all errors, including ones which can be recovered from.

           warning, 24
               Show all warnings and errors. Any message related to possibly incorrect or unexpected events will
               be shown.

           info, 32
               Show informative messages during processing. This is in addition to warnings and errors. This is
               the default value.

           verbose, 40
               Same as "info", except more verbose.

           debug, 48
               Show everything, including debugging information.

           trace, 56

           For example to enable repeated log output, add the "level" prefix, and set loglevel to "verbose":

                   ffmpeg -loglevel repeat+level+verbose -i input output

           Another example that enables repeated log output without affecting current state of "level" prefix
           flag or loglevel:

                   ffmpeg [...] -loglevel +repeat

           By default the program logs to stderr. If coloring is supported by the terminal, colors are used to
           mark errors and warnings. Log coloring can be disabled setting the environment variable
           AV_LOG_FORCE_NOCOLOR, or can be forced setting the environment variable AV_LOG_FORCE_COLOR.

       -report
           Dump full command line and log output to a file named "program-YYYYMMDD-HHMMSS.log" in the current
           directory.  This file can be useful for bug reports.  It also implies "-loglevel debug".

           Setting the environment variable FFREPORT to any value has the same effect. If the value is a
           ':'-separated key=value sequence, these options will affect the report; option values must be escaped
           if they contain special characters or the options delimiter ':' (see the ``Quoting and escaping''
           section in the ffmpeg-utils manual).

           The following options are recognized:

           file
               set the file name to use for the report; %p is expanded to the name of the program, %t is
               expanded to a timestamp, "%%" is expanded to a plain "%"

           level
               set the log verbosity level using a numerical value (see "-loglevel").

           For example, to output a report to a file named ffreport.log using a log level of 32 (alias for log
           level "info"):

                   FFREPORT=file=ffreport.log:level=32 ffmpeg -i input output

           Errors in parsing the environment variable are not fatal, and will not appear in the report.

       -hide_banner
           Suppress printing banner.

           All FFmpeg tools will normally show a copyright notice, build options and library versions. This
           option can be used to suppress printing this information.

       -cpuflags flags (global)
           Allows setting and clearing cpu flags. This option is intended for testing. Do not use it unless you
           know what you're doing.

                   ffmpeg -cpuflags -sse+mmx ...
                   ffmpeg -cpuflags mmx ...
                   ffmpeg -cpuflags 0 ...

           Possible flags for this option are:

           x86
               mmx
               mmxext
               sse
               sse2
               sse2slow
               sse3
               sse3slow
               ssse3
               atom
               sse4.1
               sse4.2
               avx
               avx2
               xop
               fma3
               fma4
               3dnow
               3dnowext
               bmi1
               bmi2
               cmov
           ARM
               armv5te
               armv6
               armv6t2
               vfp
               vfpv3
               neon
               setend
           AArch64
               armv8
               vfp
               neon
           PowerPC
               altivec
           Specific Processors
               pentium2
               pentium3
               pentium4
               k6
               k62
               athlon
               athlonxp
               k8
       -cpucount count (global)
           Override detection of CPU count. This option is intended for testing. Do not use it unless you know
           what you're doing.

                   ffmpeg -cpucount 2

       -max_alloc bytes
           Set the maximum size limit for allocating a block on the heap by ffmpeg's family of malloc functions.
           Exercise extreme caution when using this option. Don't use if you do not understand the full
           consequence of doing so.  Default is INT_MAX.

   AVOptions
       These options are provided directly by the libavformat, libavdevice and libavcodec libraries. To see the
       list of available AVOptions, use the -help option. They are separated into two categories:

       generic
           These options can be set for any container, codec or device. Generic options are listed under
           AVFormatContext options for containers/devices and under AVCodecContext options for codecs.

       private
           These options are specific to the given container, device or codec. Private options are listed under
           their corresponding containers/devices/codecs.

       For example to write an ID3v2.3 header instead of a default ID3v2.4 to an MP3 file, use the id3v2_version
       private option of the MP3 muxer:

               ffmpeg -i input.flac -id3v2_version 3 out.mp3

       All codec AVOptions are per-stream, and thus a stream specifier should be attached to them:

               ffmpeg -i multichannel.mxf -map 0:v:0 -map 0:a:0 -map 0:a:0 -c:a:0 ac3 -b:a:0 640k -ac:a:1 2 -c:a:1 aac -b:2 128k out.mp4

       In the above example, a multichannel audio stream is mapped twice for output.  The first instance is
       encoded with codec ac3 and bitrate 640k.  The second instance is downmixed to 2 channels and encoded with
       codec aac. A bitrate of 128k is specified for it using absolute index of the output stream.

       Note: the -nooption syntax cannot be used for boolean AVOptions, use -option 0/-option 1.

       Note: the old undocumented way of specifying per-stream AVOptions by prepending v/a/s to the options name
       is now obsolete and will be removed soon.

   Main options
       -f fmt (input/output)
           Force input or output file format. The format is normally auto detected for input files and guessed
           from the file extension for output files, so this option is not needed in most cases.

       -i url (input)
           input file url

       -y (global)
           Overwrite output files without asking.

       -n (global)
           Do not overwrite output files, and exit immediately if a specified output file already exists.

       -stream_loop number (input)
           Set number of times input stream shall be looped. Loop 0 means no loop, loop -1 means infinite loop.

       -recast_media (global)
           Allow forcing a decoder of a different media type than the one detected or designated by the demuxer.
           Useful for decoding media data muxed as data streams.

       -c[:stream_specifier] codec (input/output,per-stream)
       -codec[:stream_specifier] codec (input/output,per-stream)
           Select an encoder (when used before an output file) or a decoder (when used before an input file) for
           one or more streams. codec is the name of a decoder/encoder or a special value "copy" (output only)
           to indicate that the stream is not to be re-encoded.

           For example

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -map 0 -c:v libx264 -c:a copy OUTPUT

           encodes all video streams with libx264 and copies all audio streams.

           For each stream, the last matching "c" option is applied, so

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -map 0 -c copy -c:v:1 libx264 -c:a:137 libvorbis OUTPUT

           will copy all the streams except the second video, which will be encoded with libx264, and the 138th
           audio, which will be encoded with libvorbis.

       -t duration (input/output)
           When used as an input option (before "-i"), limit the duration of data read from the input file.

           When used as an output option (before an output url), stop writing the output after its duration
           reaches duration.

           duration must be a time duration specification, see the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual.

           -to and -t are mutually exclusive and -t has priority.

       -to position (input/output)
           Stop writing the output or reading the input at position.  position must be a time duration
           specification, see the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual.

           -to and -t are mutually exclusive and -t has priority.

       -fs limit_size (output)
           Set the file size limit, expressed in bytes. No further chunk of bytes is written after the limit is
           exceeded. The size of the output file is slightly more than the requested file size.

       -ss position (input/output)
           When used as an input option (before "-i"), seeks in this input file to position. Note that in most
           formats it is not possible to seek exactly, so ffmpeg will seek to the closest seek point before
           position.  When transcoding and -accurate_seek is enabled (the default), this extra segment between
           the seek point and position will be decoded and discarded. When doing stream copy or when
           -noaccurate_seek is used, it will be preserved.

           When used as an output option (before an output url), decodes but discards input until the timestamps
           reach position.

           position must be a time duration specification, see the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual.

       -sseof position (input)
           Like the "-ss" option but relative to the "end of file". That is negative values are earlier in the
           file, 0 is at EOF.

       -isync input_index (input)
           Assign an input as a sync source.

           This will take the difference between the start times of the target and reference inputs and offset
           the timestamps of the target file by that difference. The source timestamps of the two inputs should
           derive from the same clock source for expected results. If "copyts" is set then "start_at_zero" must
           also be set. If either of the inputs has no starting timestamp then no sync adjustment is made.

           Acceptable values are those that refer to a valid ffmpeg input index. If the sync reference is the
           target index itself or -1, then no adjustment is made to target timestamps. A sync reference may not
           itself be synced to any other input.

           Default value is -1.

       -itsoffset offset (input)
           Set the input time offset.

           offset must be a time duration specification, see the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual.

           The offset is added to the timestamps of the input files. Specifying a positive offset means that the
           corresponding streams are delayed by the time duration specified in offset.

       -itsscale scale (input,per-stream)
           Rescale input timestamps. scale should be a floating point number.

       -timestamp date (output)
           Set the recording timestamp in the container.

           date must be a date specification, see the Date section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual.

       -metadata[:metadata_specifier] key=value (output,per-metadata)
           Set a metadata key/value pair.

           An optional metadata_specifier may be given to set metadata on streams, chapters or programs. See
           "-map_metadata" documentation for details.

           This option overrides metadata set with "-map_metadata". It is also possible to delete metadata by
           using an empty value.

           For example, for setting the title in the output file:

                   ffmpeg -i in.avi -metadata title="my title" out.flv

           To set the language of the first audio stream:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -metadata:s:a:0 language=eng OUTPUT

       -disposition[:stream_specifier] value (output,per-stream)
           Sets the disposition for a stream.

           By default, the disposition is copied from the input stream, unless the output stream this option
           applies to is fed by a complex filtergraph - in that case the disposition is unset by default.

           value is a sequence of items separated by '+' or '-'. The first item may also be prefixed with '+' or
           '-', in which case this option modifies the default value. Otherwise (the first item is not prefixed)
           this options overrides the default value. A '+' prefix adds the given disposition, '-' removes it. It
           is also possible to clear the disposition by setting it to 0.

           If no "-disposition" options were specified for an output file, ffmpeg will automatically set the
           'default' disposition on the first stream of each type, when there are multiple streams of this type
           in the output file and no stream of that type is already marked as default.

           The "-dispositions" option lists the known dispositions.

           For example, to make the second audio stream the default stream:

                   ffmpeg -i in.mkv -c copy -disposition:a:1 default out.mkv

           To make the second subtitle stream the default stream and remove the default disposition from the
           first subtitle stream:

                   ffmpeg -i in.mkv -c copy -disposition:s:0 0 -disposition:s:1 default out.mkv

           To add an embedded cover/thumbnail:

                   ffmpeg -i in.mp4 -i IMAGE -map 0 -map 1 -c copy -c:v:1 png -disposition:v:1 attached_pic out.mp4

           Not all muxers support embedded thumbnails, and those who do, only support a few formats, like JPEG
           or PNG.

       -program [title=title:][program_num=program_num:]st=stream[:st=stream...] (output)
           Creates a program with the specified title, program_num and adds the specified stream(s) to it.

       -stream_group type=type:st=stream[:st=stream][:stg=stream_group][:id=stream_group_id...] (output)
           Creates a stream group of the specified type, stream_group_id and adds the specified stream(s) and/or
           previously defined stream_group(s) to it.

           type can be one of the following:

           iamf_audio_element
               Groups streams that belong to the same IAMF Audio Element

               For this group type, the following options are available

               audio_element_type
                   The Audio Element type. The following values are supported:

                   channel
                       Scalable channel audio representation

                   scene
                       Ambisonics representation

               demixing
                   Demixing information used to reconstruct a scalable channel audio representation.  This
                   option must be separated from the rest with a ',', and takes the following key=value options

                   parameter_id
                       An identifier parameters blocks in frames may refer to

                   dmixp_mode
                       A pre-defined combination of demixing parameters

               recon_gain
                   Recon gain information used to reconstruct a scalable channel audio representation.  This
                   option must be separated from the rest with a ',', and takes the following key=value options

                   parameter_id
                       An identifier parameters blocks in frames may refer to

               layer
                   A layer defining a Channel Layout in the Audio Element.  This option must be separated from
                   the rest with a ','. Several ',' separated entries can be defined, and at least one must be
                   set.

                   It takes the following ":"-separated key=value options

                   ch_layout
                       The layer's channel layout

                   flags
                       The following flags are available:

                       recon_gain
                           Wether to signal if recon_gain is present as metadata in parameter blocks within
                           frames

                   output_gain
                   output_gain_flags
                       Which channels output_gain applies to. The following flags are available:

                       FL
                       FR
                       BL
                       BR
                       TFL
                       TFR
                   ambisonics_mode
                       The ambisonics mode. This has no effect if audio_element_type is set to channel.

                       The following values are supported:

                       mono
                           Each ambisonics channel is coded as an individual mono stream in the group

               default_w
                   Default weight value

           iamf_mix_presentation
               Groups streams that belong to all IAMF Audio Element the same IAMF Mix Presentation references

               For this group type, the following options are available

               submix
                   A sub-mix within the Mix Presentation.  This option must be separated from the rest with a
                   ','. Several ',' separated entries can be defined, and at least one must be set.

                   It takes the following ":"-separated key=value options

                   parameter_id
                       An identifier parameters blocks in frames may refer to, for post-processing the mixed
                       audio signal to generate the audio signal for playback

                   parameter_rate
                       The sample rate duration fields in parameters blocks in frames that refer to this
                       parameter_id are expressed as

                   default_mix_gain
                       Default mix gain value to apply when there are no parameter blocks sharing the same
                       parameter_id for a given frame

                   element
                       References an Audio Element used in this Mix Presentation to generate the final output
                       audio signal for playback.  This option must be separated from the rest with a '|'.
                       Several '|' separated entries can be defined, and at least one must be set.

                       It takes the following ":"-separated key=value options:

                       stg The stream_group_id for an Audio Element which this sub-mix refers to

                       parameter_id
                           An identifier parameters blocks in frames may refer to, for applying any processing
                           to the referenced and rendered Audio Element before being summed with other processed
                           Audio Elements

                       parameter_rate
                           The sample rate duration fields in parameters blocks in frames that refer to this
                           parameter_id are expressed as

                       default_mix_gain
                           Default mix gain value to apply when there are no parameter blocks sharing the same
                           parameter_id for a given frame

                       annotations
                           A key=value string describing the sub-mix element where "key" is a string conforming
                           to BCP-47 that specifies the language for the "value" string. "key" must be the same
                           as the one in the mix's annotations

                       headphones_rendering_mode
                           Indicates whether the input channel-based Audio Element is rendered to stereo
                           loudspeakers or spatialized with a binaural renderer when played back on headphones.
                           This has no effect if the referenced Audio Element's audio_element_type is set to
                           channel.

                           The following values are supported:

                           stereo
                           binaural
                   layout
                       Specifies the layouts for this sub-mix on which the loudness information was measured.
                       This option must be separated from the rest with a '|'. Several '|' separated entries can
                       be defined, and at least one must be set.

                       It takes the following ":"-separated key=value options:

                       layout_type
                           loudspeakers
                               The layout follows the loudspeaker sound system convention of ITU-2051-3.

                           binaural
                               The layout is binaural.

                       sound_system
                           Channel layout matching one of Sound Systems A to J of ITU-2051-3, plus 7.1.2 and
                           3.1.2 This has no effect if layout_type is set to binaural.

                       integrated_loudness
                           The program integrated loudness information, as defined in ITU-1770-4.

                       digital_peak
                           The digital (sampled) peak value of the audio signal, as defined in ITU-1770-4.

                       true_peak
                           The true peak of the audio signal, as defined in ITU-1770-4.

                       dialog_anchored_loudness
                           The Dialogue loudness information, as defined in ITU-1770-4.

                       album_anchored_loudness
                           The Album loudness information, as defined in ITU-1770-4.

               annotations
                   A key=value string string describing the mix where "key" is a string conforming to BCP-47
                   that specifies the language for the "value" string. "key" must be the same as the ones in all
                   sub-mix element's annotationss

       -target type (output)
           Specify target file type ("vcd", "svcd", "dvd", "dv", "dv50"). type may be prefixed with "pal-",
           "ntsc-" or "film-" to use the corresponding standard. All the format options (bitrate, codecs, buffer
           sizes) are then set automatically. You can just type:

                   ffmpeg -i myfile.avi -target vcd /tmp/vcd.mpg

           Nevertheless you can specify additional options as long as you know they do not conflict with the
           standard, as in:

                   ffmpeg -i myfile.avi -target vcd -bf 2 /tmp/vcd.mpg

           The parameters set for each target are as follows.

           VCD

                   <pal>:
                   -f vcd -muxrate 1411200 -muxpreload 0.44 -packetsize 2324
                   -s 352x288 -r 25
                   -codec:v mpeg1video -g 15 -b:v 1150k -maxrate:v 1150k -minrate:v 1150k -bufsize:v 327680
                   -ar 44100 -ac 2
                   -codec:a mp2 -b:a 224k

                   <ntsc>:
                   -f vcd -muxrate 1411200 -muxpreload 0.44 -packetsize 2324
                   -s 352x240 -r 30000/1001
                   -codec:v mpeg1video -g 18 -b:v 1150k -maxrate:v 1150k -minrate:v 1150k -bufsize:v 327680
                   -ar 44100 -ac 2
                   -codec:a mp2 -b:a 224k

                   <film>:
                   -f vcd -muxrate 1411200 -muxpreload 0.44 -packetsize 2324
                   -s 352x240 -r 24000/1001
                   -codec:v mpeg1video -g 18 -b:v 1150k -maxrate:v 1150k -minrate:v 1150k -bufsize:v 327680
                   -ar 44100 -ac 2
                   -codec:a mp2 -b:a 224k

           SVCD

                   <pal>:
                   -f svcd -packetsize 2324
                   -s 480x576 -pix_fmt yuv420p -r 25
                   -codec:v mpeg2video -g 15 -b:v 2040k -maxrate:v 2516k -minrate:v 0 -bufsize:v 1835008 -scan_offset 1
                   -ar 44100
                   -codec:a mp2 -b:a 224k

                   <ntsc>:
                   -f svcd -packetsize 2324
                   -s 480x480 -pix_fmt yuv420p -r 30000/1001
                   -codec:v mpeg2video -g 18 -b:v 2040k -maxrate:v 2516k -minrate:v 0 -bufsize:v 1835008 -scan_offset 1
                   -ar 44100
                   -codec:a mp2 -b:a 224k

                   <film>:
                   -f svcd -packetsize 2324
                   -s 480x480 -pix_fmt yuv420p -r 24000/1001
                   -codec:v mpeg2video -g 18 -b:v 2040k -maxrate:v 2516k -minrate:v 0 -bufsize:v 1835008 -scan_offset 1
                   -ar 44100
                   -codec:a mp2 -b:a 224k

           DVD

                   <pal>:
                   -f dvd -muxrate 10080k -packetsize 2048
                   -s 720x576 -pix_fmt yuv420p -r 25
                   -codec:v mpeg2video -g 15 -b:v 6000k -maxrate:v 9000k -minrate:v 0 -bufsize:v 1835008
                   -ar 48000
                   -codec:a ac3 -b:a 448k

                   <ntsc>:
                   -f dvd -muxrate 10080k -packetsize 2048
                   -s 720x480 -pix_fmt yuv420p -r 30000/1001
                   -codec:v mpeg2video -g 18 -b:v 6000k -maxrate:v 9000k -minrate:v 0 -bufsize:v 1835008
                   -ar 48000
                   -codec:a ac3 -b:a 448k

                   <film>:
                   -f dvd -muxrate 10080k -packetsize 2048
                   -s 720x480 -pix_fmt yuv420p -r 24000/1001
                   -codec:v mpeg2video -g 18 -b:v 6000k -maxrate:v 9000k -minrate:v 0 -bufsize:v 1835008
                   -ar 48000
                   -codec:a ac3 -b:a 448k

           DV

                   <pal>:
                   -f dv
                   -s 720x576 -pix_fmt yuv420p -r 25
                   -ar 48000 -ac 2

                   <ntsc>:
                   -f dv
                   -s 720x480 -pix_fmt yuv411p -r 30000/1001
                   -ar 48000 -ac 2

                   <film>:
                   -f dv
                   -s 720x480 -pix_fmt yuv411p -r 24000/1001
                   -ar 48000 -ac 2

           The "dv50" target is identical to the "dv" target except that the pixel format set is "yuv422p" for
           all three standards.

           Any user-set value for a parameter above will override the target preset value. In that case, the
           output may not comply with the target standard.

       -dn (input/output)
           As an input option, blocks all data streams of a file from being filtered or being automatically
           selected or mapped for any output. See "-discard" option to disable streams individually.

           As an output option, disables data recording i.e. automatic selection or mapping of any data stream.
           For full manual control see the "-map" option.

       -dframes number (output)
           Set the number of data frames to output. This is an obsolete alias for "-frames:d", which you should
           use instead.

       -frames[:stream_specifier] framecount (output,per-stream)
           Stop writing to the stream after framecount frames.

       -q[:stream_specifier] q (output,per-stream)
       -qscale[:stream_specifier] q (output,per-stream)
           Use fixed quality scale (VBR). The meaning of q/qscale is codec-dependent.  If qscale is used without
           a stream_specifier then it applies only to the video stream, this is to maintain compatibility with
           previous behavior and as specifying the same codec specific value to 2 different codecs that is audio
           and video generally is not what is intended when no stream_specifier is used.

       -filter[:stream_specifier] filtergraph (output,per-stream)
           Create the filtergraph specified by filtergraph and use it to filter the stream.

           filtergraph is a description of the filtergraph to apply to the stream, and must have a single input
           and a single output of the same type of the stream. In the filtergraph, the input is associated to
           the label "in", and the output to the label "out". See the ffmpeg-filters manual for more information
           about the filtergraph syntax.

           See the -filter_complex option if you want to create filtergraphs with multiple inputs and/or
           outputs.

       -reinit_filter[:stream_specifier] integer (input,per-stream)
           This boolean option determines if the filtergraph(s) to which this stream is fed gets reinitialized
           when input frame parameters change mid-stream. This option is enabled by default as most video and
           all audio filters cannot handle deviation in input frame properties.  Upon reinitialization, existing
           filter state is lost, like e.g. the frame count "n" reference available in some filters. Any frames
           buffered at time of reinitialization are lost.  The properties where a change triggers
           reinitialization are, for video, frame resolution or pixel format; for audio, sample format, sample
           rate, channel count or channel layout.

       -filter_threads nb_threads (global)
           Defines how many threads are used to process a filter pipeline. Each pipeline will produce a thread
           pool with this many threads available for parallel processing.  The default is the number of
           available CPUs.

       -pre[:stream_specifier] preset_name (output,per-stream)
           Specify the preset for matching stream(s).

       -stats (global)
           Print encoding progress/statistics. It is on by default, to explicitly disable it you need to specify
           "-nostats".

       -stats_period time (global)
           Set period at which encoding progress/statistics are updated. Default is 0.5 seconds.

       -progress url (global)
           Send program-friendly progress information to url.

           Progress information is written periodically and at the end of the encoding process. It is made of
           "key=value" lines. key consists of only alphanumeric characters. The last key of a sequence of
           progress information is always "progress".

           The update period is set using "-stats_period".

       -stdin
           Enable interaction on standard input. On by default unless standard input is used as an input. To
           explicitly disable interaction you need to specify "-nostdin".

           Disabling interaction on standard input is useful, for example, if ffmpeg is in the background
           process group. Roughly the same result can be achieved with "ffmpeg ... < /dev/null" but it requires
           a shell.

       -debug_ts (global)
           Print timestamp/latency information. It is off by default. This option is mostly useful for testing
           and debugging purposes, and the output format may change from one version to another, so it should
           not be employed by portable scripts.

           See also the option "-fdebug ts".

       -attach filename (output)
           Add an attachment to the output file. This is supported by a few formats like Matroska for e.g. fonts
           used in rendering subtitles. Attachments are implemented as a specific type of stream, so this option
           will add a new stream to the file. It is then possible to use per-stream options on this stream in
           the usual way. Attachment streams created with this option will be created after all the other
           streams (i.e. those created with "-map" or automatic mappings).

           Note that for Matroska you also have to set the mimetype metadata tag:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -attach DejaVuSans.ttf -metadata:s:2 mimetype=application/x-truetype-font out.mkv

           (assuming that the attachment stream will be third in the output file).

       -dump_attachment[:stream_specifier] filename (input,per-stream)
           Extract the matching attachment stream into a file named filename. If filename is empty, then the
           value of the "filename" metadata tag will be used.

           E.g. to extract the first attachment to a file named 'out.ttf':

                   ffmpeg -dump_attachment:t:0 out.ttf -i INPUT

           To extract all attachments to files determined by the "filename" tag:

                   ffmpeg -dump_attachment:t "" -i INPUT

           Technical note -- attachments are implemented as codec extradata, so this option can actually be used
           to extract extradata from any stream, not just attachments.

   Video Options
       -vframes number (output)
           Set the number of video frames to output. This is an obsolete alias for "-frames:v", which you should
           use instead.

       -r[:stream_specifier] fps (input/output,per-stream)
           Set frame rate (Hz value, fraction or abbreviation).

           As an input option, ignore any timestamps stored in the file and instead generate timestamps assuming
           constant frame rate fps.  This is not the same as the -framerate option used for some input formats
           like image2 or v4l2 (it used to be the same in older versions of FFmpeg).  If in doubt use -framerate
           instead of the input option -r.

           As an output option:

           video encoding
               Duplicate or drop frames right before encoding them to achieve constant output frame rate fps.

           video streamcopy
               Indicate to the muxer that fps is the stream frame rate. No data is dropped or duplicated in this
               case. This may produce invalid files if fps does not match the actual stream frame rate as
               determined by packet timestamps.  See also the "setts" bitstream filter.

       -fpsmax[:stream_specifier] fps (output,per-stream)
           Set maximum frame rate (Hz value, fraction or abbreviation).

           Clamps output frame rate when output framerate is auto-set and is higher than this value.  Useful in
           batch processing or when input framerate is wrongly detected as very high.  It cannot be set together
           with "-r". It is ignored during streamcopy.

       -s[:stream_specifier] size (input/output,per-stream)
           Set frame size.

           As an input option, this is a shortcut for the video_size private option, recognized by some demuxers
           for which the frame size is either not stored in the file or is configurable -- e.g. raw video or
           video grabbers.

           As an output option, this inserts the "scale" video filter to the end of the corresponding
           filtergraph. Please use the "scale" filter directly to insert it at the beginning or some other
           place.

           The format is wxh (default - same as source).

       -aspect[:stream_specifier] aspect (output,per-stream)
           Set the video display aspect ratio specified by aspect.

           aspect can be a floating point number string, or a string of the form num:den, where num and den are
           the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. For example "4:3", "16:9", "1.3333", and "1.7777"
           are valid argument values.

           If used together with -vcodec copy, it will affect the aspect ratio stored at container level, but
           not the aspect ratio stored in encoded frames, if it exists.

       -display_rotation[:stream_specifier] rotation (input,per-stream)
           Set video rotation metadata.

           rotation is a decimal number specifying the amount in degree by which the video should be rotated
           counter-clockwise before being displayed.

           This option overrides the rotation/display transform metadata stored in the file, if any. When the
           video is being transcoded (rather than copied) and "-autorotate" is enabled, the video will be
           rotated at the filtering stage. Otherwise, the metadata will be written into the output file if the
           muxer supports it.

           If the "-display_hflip" and/or "-display_vflip" options are given, they are applied after the
           rotation specified by this option.

       -display_hflip[:stream_specifier] (input,per-stream)
           Set whether on display the image should be horizontally flipped.

           See the "-display_rotation" option for more details.

       -display_vflip[:stream_specifier] (input,per-stream)
           Set whether on display the image should be vertically flipped.

           See the "-display_rotation" option for more details.

       -vn (input/output)
           As an input option, blocks all video streams of a file from being filtered or being automatically
           selected or mapped for any output. See "-discard" option to disable streams individually.

           As an output option, disables video recording i.e. automatic selection or mapping of any video
           stream. For full manual control see the "-map" option.

       -vcodec codec (output)
           Set the video codec. This is an alias for "-codec:v".

       -pass[:stream_specifier] n (output,per-stream)
           Select the pass number (1 or 2). It is used to do two-pass video encoding. The statistics of the
           video are recorded in the first pass into a log file (see also the option -passlogfile), and in the
           second pass that log file is used to generate the video at the exact requested bitrate.  On pass 1,
           you may just deactivate audio and set output to null, examples for Windows and Unix:

                   ffmpeg -i foo.mov -c:v libxvid -pass 1 -an -f rawvideo -y NUL
                   ffmpeg -i foo.mov -c:v libxvid -pass 1 -an -f rawvideo -y /dev/null

       -passlogfile[:stream_specifier] prefix (output,per-stream)
           Set two-pass log file name prefix to prefix, the default file name prefix is ``ffmpeg2pass''. The
           complete file name will be PREFIX-N.log, where N is a number specific to the output stream

       -vf filtergraph (output)
           Create the filtergraph specified by filtergraph and use it to filter the stream.

           This is an alias for "-filter:v", see the -filter option.

       -autorotate
           Automatically rotate the video according to file metadata. Enabled by default, use -noautorotate to
           disable it.

       -autoscale
           Automatically scale the video according to the resolution of first frame.  Enabled by default, use
           -noautoscale to disable it. When autoscale is disabled, all output frames of filter graph might not
           be in the same resolution and may be inadequate for some encoder/muxer. Therefore, it is not
           recommended to disable it unless you really know what you are doing.  Disable autoscale at your own
           risk.

   Advanced Video options
       -pix_fmt[:stream_specifier] format (input/output,per-stream)
           Set pixel format. Use "-pix_fmts" to show all the supported pixel formats.  If the selected pixel
           format can not be selected, ffmpeg will print a warning and select the best pixel format supported by
           the encoder.  If pix_fmt is prefixed by a "+", ffmpeg will exit with an error if the requested pixel
           format can not be selected, and automatic conversions inside filtergraphs are disabled.  If pix_fmt
           is a single "+", ffmpeg selects the same pixel format as the input (or graph output) and automatic
           conversions are disabled.

       -sws_flags flags (input/output)
           Set default flags for the libswscale library. These flags are used by automatically inserted "scale"
           filters and those within simple filtergraphs, if not overridden within the filtergraph definition.

           See the ffmpeg-scaler manual for a list of scaler options.

       -rc_override[:stream_specifier] override (output,per-stream)
           Rate control override for specific intervals, formatted as "int,int,int" list separated with slashes.
           Two first values are the beginning and end frame numbers, last one is quantizer to use if positive,
           or quality factor if negative.

       -vstats
           Dump video coding statistics to vstats_HHMMSS.log. See the vstats file format section for the format
           description.

       -vstats_file file
           Dump video coding statistics to file. See the vstats file format section for the format description.

       -vstats_version file
           Specify which version of the vstats format to use. Default is 2. See the vstats file format section
           for the format description.

       -vtag fourcc/tag (output)
           Force video tag/fourcc. This is an alias for "-tag:v".

       -force_key_frames[:stream_specifier] time[,time...] (output,per-stream)
       -force_key_frames[:stream_specifier] expr:expr (output,per-stream)
       -force_key_frames[:stream_specifier] source (output,per-stream)
           force_key_frames can take arguments of the following form:

           time[,time...]
               If the argument consists of timestamps, ffmpeg will round the specified times to the nearest
               output timestamp as per the encoder time base and force a keyframe at the first frame having
               timestamp equal or greater than the computed timestamp. Note that if the encoder time base is too
               coarse, then the keyframes may be forced on frames with timestamps lower than the specified time.
               The default encoder time base is the inverse of the output framerate but may be set otherwise via
               "-enc_time_base".

               If one of the times is ""chapters"[delta]", it is expanded into the time of the beginning of all
               chapters in the file, shifted by delta, expressed as a time in seconds.  This option can be
               useful to ensure that a seek point is present at a chapter mark or any other designated place in
               the output file.

               For example, to insert a key frame at 5 minutes, plus key frames 0.1 second before the beginning
               of every chapter:

                       -force_key_frames 0:05:00,chapters-0.1

           expr:expr
               If the argument is prefixed with "expr:", the string expr is interpreted like an expression and
               is evaluated for each frame. A key frame is forced in case the evaluation is non-zero.

               The expression in expr can contain the following constants:

               n   the number of current processed frame, starting from 0

               n_forced
                   the number of forced frames

               prev_forced_n
                   the number of the previous forced frame, it is "NAN" when no keyframe was forced yet

               prev_forced_t
                   the time of the previous forced frame, it is "NAN" when no keyframe was forced yet

               t   the time of the current processed frame

               For example to force a key frame every 5 seconds, you can specify:

                       -force_key_frames expr:gte(t,n_forced*5)

               To force a key frame 5 seconds after the time of the last forced one, starting from second 13:

                       -force_key_frames expr:if(isnan(prev_forced_t),gte(t,13),gte(t,prev_forced_t+5))

           source
               If the argument is "source", ffmpeg will force a key frame if the current frame being encoded is
               marked as a key frame in its source.  In cases where this particular source frame has to be
               dropped, enforce the next available frame to become a key frame instead.

           Note that forcing too many keyframes is very harmful for the lookahead algorithms of certain
           encoders: using fixed-GOP options or similar would be more efficient.

       -copyinkf[:stream_specifier] (output,per-stream)
           When doing stream copy, copy also non-key frames found at the beginning.

       -init_hw_device type[=name][:device[,key=value...]]
           Initialise a new hardware device of type type called name, using the given device parameters.  If no
           name is specified it will receive a default name of the form "type%d".

           The meaning of device and the following arguments depends on the device type:

           cuda
               device is the number of the CUDA device.

               The following options are recognized:

               primary_ctx
                   If set to 1, uses the primary device context instead of creating a new one.

               Examples:

               -init_hw_device cuda:1
                   Choose the second device on the system.

               -init_hw_device cuda:0,primary_ctx=1
                   Choose the first device and use the primary device context.

           dxva2
               device is the number of the Direct3D 9 display adapter.

           d3d11va
               device is the number of the Direct3D 11 display adapter.  If not specified, it will attempt to
               use the default Direct3D 11 display adapter or the first Direct3D 11 display adapter whose
               hardware VendorId is specified by vendor_id.

               Examples:

               -init_hw_device d3d11va
                   Create a d3d11va device on the default Direct3D 11 display adapter.

               -init_hw_device d3d11va:1
                   Create a d3d11va device on the Direct3D 11 display adapter specified by index 1.

               -init_hw_device d3d11va:,vendor_id=0x8086
                   Create a d3d11va device on the first Direct3D 11 display adapter whose hardware VendorId is
                   0x8086.

           vaapi
               device is either an X11 display name, a DRM render node or a DirectX adapter index.  If not
               specified, it will attempt to open the default X11 display ($DISPLAY) and then the first DRM
               render node (/dev/dri/renderD128), or the default DirectX adapter on Windows.

               The following options are recognized:

               kernel_driver
                   When device is not specified, use this option to specify the name of the kernel driver
                   associated with the desired device. This option is available only when the hardware
                   acceleration method drm and vaapi are enabled.

               Examples:

               -init_hw_device vaapi
                   Create a vaapi device on the default device.

               -init_hw_device vaapi:/dev/dri/renderD129
                   Create a vaapi device on DRM render node /dev/dri/renderD129.

               -init_hw_device vaapi:1
                   Create a vaapi device on DirectX adapter 1.

               -init_hw_device vaapi:,kernel_driver=i915
                   Create a vaapi device on a device associated with kernel driver i915.

           vdpau
               device is an X11 display name.  If not specified, it will attempt to open the default X11 display
               ($DISPLAY).

           qsv device selects a value in MFX_IMPL_*. Allowed values are:

               auto
               sw
               hw
               auto_any
               hw_any
               hw2
               hw3
               hw4

               If not specified, auto_any is used.  (Note that it may be easier to achieve the desired result
               for QSV by creating the platform-appropriate subdevice (dxva2 or d3d11va or vaapi) and then
               deriving a QSV device from that.)

               The following options are recognized:

               child_device
                   Specify a DRM render node on Linux or DirectX adapter on Windows.

               child_device_type
                   Choose platform-appropriate subdevice type. On Windows d3d11va is used as default subdevice
                   type when "--enable-libvpl" is specified at configuration time, dxva2 is used as default
                   subdevice type when "--enable-libmfx" is specified at configuration time. On Linux user can
                   use vaapi only as subdevice type.

               Examples:

               -init_hw_device qsv:hw,child_device=/dev/dri/renderD129
                   Create a QSV device with MFX_IMPL_HARDWARE on DRM render node /dev/dri/renderD129.

               -init_hw_device qsv:hw,child_device=1
                   Create a QSV device with MFX_IMPL_HARDWARE on DirectX adapter 1.

               -init_hw_device qsv:hw,child_device_type=d3d11va
                   Choose the GPU subdevice with type d3d11va and create QSV device with MFX_IMPL_HARDWARE.

               -init_hw_device qsv:hw,child_device_type=dxva2
                   Choose the GPU subdevice with type dxva2 and create QSV device with MFX_IMPL_HARDWARE.

               -init_hw_device qsv:hw,child_device=1,child_device_type=d3d11va
                   Create a QSV device with MFX_IMPL_HARDWARE on DirectX adapter 1 with subdevice type d3d11va.

               -init_hw_device vaapi=va:/dev/dri/renderD129 -init_hw_device qsv=hw1@va
                   Create a VAAPI device called va on /dev/dri/renderD129, then derive a QSV device called hw1
                   from device va.

           opencl
               device selects the platform and device as platform_index.device_index.

               The set of devices can also be filtered using the key-value pairs to find only devices matching
               particular platform or device strings.

               The strings usable as filters are:

               platform_profile
               platform_version
               platform_name
               platform_vendor
               platform_extensions
               device_name
               device_vendor
               driver_version
               device_version
               device_profile
               device_extensions
               device_type

               The indices and filters must together uniquely select a device.

               Examples:

               -init_hw_device opencl:0.1
                   Choose the second device on the first platform.

               -init_hw_device opencl:,device_name=Foo9000
                   Choose the device with a name containing the string Foo9000.

               -init_hw_device opencl:1,device_type=gpu,device_extensions=cl_khr_fp16
                   Choose the GPU device on the second platform supporting the cl_khr_fp16 extension.

           vulkan
               If device is an integer, it selects the device by its index in a system-dependent list of
               devices.  If device is any other string, it selects the first device with a name containing that
               string as a substring.

               The following options are recognized:

               debug
                   If set to 1, enables the validation layer, if installed.

               linear_images
                   If set to 1, images allocated by the hwcontext will be linear and locally mappable.

               instance_extensions
                   A plus separated list of additional instance extensions to enable.

               device_extensions
                   A plus separated list of additional device extensions to enable.

               Examples:

               -init_hw_device vulkan:1
                   Choose the second device on the system.

               -init_hw_device vulkan:RADV
                   Choose the first device with a name containing the string RADV.

               -init_hw_device vulkan:0,instance_extensions=VK_KHR_wayland_surface+VK_KHR_xcb_surface
                   Choose the first device and enable the Wayland and XCB instance extensions.

       -init_hw_device type[=name]@source
           Initialise a new hardware device of type type called name, deriving it from the existing device with
           the name source.

       -init_hw_device list
           List all hardware device types supported in this build of ffmpeg.

       -filter_hw_device name
           Pass the hardware device called name to all filters in any filter graph.  This can be used to set the
           device to upload to with the "hwupload" filter, or the device to map to with the "hwmap" filter.
           Other filters may also make use of this parameter when they require a hardware device.  Note that
           this is typically only required when the input is not already in hardware frames - when it is,
           filters will derive the device they require from the context of the frames they receive as input.

           This is a global setting, so all filters will receive the same device.

       -hwaccel[:stream_specifier] hwaccel (input,per-stream)
           Use hardware acceleration to decode the matching stream(s). The allowed values of hwaccel are:

           none
               Do not use any hardware acceleration (the default).

           auto
               Automatically select the hardware acceleration method.

           vdpau
               Use VDPAU (Video Decode and Presentation API for Unix) hardware acceleration.

           dxva2
               Use DXVA2 (DirectX Video Acceleration) hardware acceleration.

           d3d11va
               Use D3D11VA (DirectX Video Acceleration) hardware acceleration.

           vaapi
               Use VAAPI (Video Acceleration API) hardware acceleration.

           qsv Use the Intel QuickSync Video acceleration for video transcoding.

               Unlike most other values, this option does not enable accelerated decoding (that is used
               automatically whenever a qsv decoder is selected), but accelerated transcoding, without copying
               the frames into the system memory.

               For it to work, both the decoder and the encoder must support QSV acceleration and no filters
               must be used.

           This option has no effect if the selected hwaccel is not available or not supported by the chosen
           decoder.

           Note that most acceleration methods are intended for playback and will not be faster than software
           decoding on modern CPUs. Additionally, ffmpeg will usually need to copy the decoded frames from the
           GPU memory into the system memory, resulting in further performance loss. This option is thus mainly
           useful for testing.

       -hwaccel_device[:stream_specifier] hwaccel_device (input,per-stream)
           Select a device to use for hardware acceleration.

           This option only makes sense when the -hwaccel option is also specified.  It can either refer to an
           existing device created with -init_hw_device by name, or it can create a new device as if
           -init_hw_device type:hwaccel_device were called immediately before.

       -hwaccels
           List all hardware acceleration components enabled in this build of ffmpeg.  Actual runtime
           availability depends on the hardware and its suitable driver being installed.

       -fix_sub_duration_heartbeat[:stream_specifier]
           Set a specific output video stream as the heartbeat stream according to which to split and push
           through currently in-progress subtitle upon receipt of a random access packet.

           This lowers the latency of subtitles for which the end packet or the following subtitle has not yet
           been received. As a drawback, this will most likely lead to duplication of subtitle events in order
           to cover the full duration, so when dealing with use cases where latency of when the subtitle event
           is passed on to output is not relevant this option should not be utilized.

           Requires -fix_sub_duration to be set for the relevant input subtitle stream for this to have any
           effect, as well as for the input subtitle stream having to be directly mapped to the same output in
           which the heartbeat stream resides.

   Audio Options
       -aframes number (output)
           Set the number of audio frames to output. This is an obsolete alias for "-frames:a", which you should
           use instead.

       -ar[:stream_specifier] freq (input/output,per-stream)
           Set the audio sampling frequency. For output streams it is set by default to the frequency of the
           corresponding input stream. For input streams this option only makes sense for audio grabbing devices
           and raw demuxers and is mapped to the corresponding demuxer options.

       -aq q (output)
           Set the audio quality (codec-specific, VBR). This is an alias for -q:a.

       -ac[:stream_specifier] channels (input/output,per-stream)
           Set the number of audio channels. For output streams it is set by default to the number of input
           audio channels. For input streams this option only makes sense for audio grabbing devices and raw
           demuxers and is mapped to the corresponding demuxer options.

       -an (input/output)
           As an input option, blocks all audio streams of a file from being filtered or being automatically
           selected or mapped for any output. See "-discard" option to disable streams individually.

           As an output option, disables audio recording i.e. automatic selection or mapping of any audio
           stream. For full manual control see the "-map" option.

       -acodec codec (input/output)
           Set the audio codec. This is an alias for "-codec:a".

       -sample_fmt[:stream_specifier] sample_fmt (output,per-stream)
           Set the audio sample format. Use "-sample_fmts" to get a list of supported sample formats.

       -af filtergraph (output)
           Create the filtergraph specified by filtergraph and use it to filter the stream.

           This is an alias for "-filter:a", see the -filter option.

   Advanced Audio options
       -atag fourcc/tag (output)
           Force audio tag/fourcc. This is an alias for "-tag:a".

       -guess_layout_max channels (input,per-stream)
           If some input channel layout is not known, try to guess only if it corresponds to at most the
           specified number of channels. For example, 2 tells to ffmpeg to recognize 1 channel as mono and 2
           channels as stereo but not 6 channels as 5.1. The default is to always try to guess. Use 0 to disable
           all guessing.

   Subtitle options
       -scodec codec (input/output)
           Set the subtitle codec. This is an alias for "-codec:s".

       -sn (input/output)
           As an input option, blocks all subtitle streams of a file from being filtered or being automatically
           selected or mapped for any output. See "-discard" option to disable streams individually.

           As an output option, disables subtitle recording i.e. automatic selection or mapping of any subtitle
           stream. For full manual control see the "-map" option.

   Advanced Subtitle options
       -fix_sub_duration
           Fix subtitles durations. For each subtitle, wait for the next packet in the same stream and adjust
           the duration of the first to avoid overlap. This is necessary with some subtitles codecs, especially
           DVB subtitles, because the duration in the original packet is only a rough estimate and the end is
           actually marked by an empty subtitle frame. Failing to use this option when necessary can result in
           exaggerated durations or muxing failures due to non-monotonic timestamps.

           Note that this option will delay the output of all data until the next subtitle packet is decoded: it
           may increase memory consumption and latency a lot.

       -canvas_size size
           Set the size of the canvas used to render subtitles.

   Advanced options
       -map [-]input_file_id[:stream_specifier][?] | [linklabel] (output)
           Create one or more streams in the output file. This option has two forms for specifying the data
           source(s): the first selects one or more streams from some input file (specified with "-i"), the
           second takes an output from some complex filtergraph (specified with "-filter_complex").

           In the first form, an output stream is created for every stream from the input file with the index
           input_file_id. If stream_specifier is given, only those streams that match the specifier are used
           (see the Stream specifiers section for the stream_specifier syntax).

           A "-" character before the stream identifier creates a "negative" mapping.  It disables matching
           streams from already created mappings.

           A trailing "?" after the stream index will allow the map to be optional: if the map matches no
           streams the map will be ignored instead of failing. Note the map will still fail if an invalid input
           file index is used; such as if the map refers to a non-existent input.

           An alternative [linklabel] form will map outputs from complex filter graphs (see the -filter_complex
           option) to the output file.  linklabel must correspond to a defined output link label in the graph.

           This option may be specified multiple times, each adding more streams to the output file. Any given
           input stream may also be mapped any number of times as a source for different output streams, e.g. in
           order to use different encoding options and/or filters. The streams are created in the output in the
           same order in which the "-map" options are given on the commandline.

           Using this option disables the default mappings for this output file.

           Examples:

           map everything
               To map ALL streams from the first input file to output

                       ffmpeg -i INPUT -map 0 output

           select specific stream
               If you have two audio streams in the first input file, these streams are identified by 0:0 and
               0:1. You can use "-map" to select which streams to place in an output file. For example:

                       ffmpeg -i INPUT -map 0:1 out.wav

               will map the second input stream in INPUT to the (single) output stream in out.wav.

           create multiple streams
               To select the stream with index 2 from input file a.mov (specified by the identifier 0:2), and
               stream with index 6 from input b.mov (specified by the identifier 1:6), and copy them to the
               output file out.mov:

                       ffmpeg -i a.mov -i b.mov -c copy -map 0:2 -map 1:6 out.mov

           create multiple streams 2
               To select all video and the third audio stream from an input file:

                       ffmpeg -i INPUT -map 0:v -map 0:a:2 OUTPUT

           negative map
               To map all the streams except the second audio, use negative mappings

                       ffmpeg -i INPUT -map 0 -map -0:a:1 OUTPUT

           optional map
               To map the video and audio streams from the first input, and using the trailing "?", ignore the
               audio mapping if no audio streams exist in the first input:

                       ffmpeg -i INPUT -map 0:v -map 0:a? OUTPUT

           map by language
               To pick the English audio stream:

                       ffmpeg -i INPUT -map 0:m:language:eng OUTPUT

       -ignore_unknown
           Ignore input streams with unknown type instead of failing if copying such streams is attempted.

       -copy_unknown
           Allow input streams with unknown type to be copied instead of failing if copying such streams is
           attempted.

       -map_metadata[:metadata_spec_out] infile[:metadata_spec_in] (output,per-metadata)
           Set metadata information of the next output file from infile. Note that those are file indices (zero-
           based), not filenames.  Optional metadata_spec_in/out parameters specify, which metadata to copy.  A
           metadata specifier can have the following forms:

           g   global metadata, i.e. metadata that applies to the whole file

           s[:stream_spec]
               per-stream metadata. stream_spec is a stream specifier as described in the Stream specifiers
               chapter. In an input metadata specifier, the first matching stream is copied from. In an output
               metadata specifier, all matching streams are copied to.

           c:chapter_index
               per-chapter metadata. chapter_index is the zero-based chapter index.

           p:program_index
               per-program metadata. program_index is the zero-based program index.

           If metadata specifier is omitted, it defaults to global.

           By default, global metadata is copied from the first input file, per-stream and per-chapter metadata
           is copied along with streams/chapters. These default mappings are disabled by creating any mapping of
           the relevant type. A negative file index can be used to create a dummy mapping that just disables
           automatic copying.

           For example to copy metadata from the first stream of the input file to global metadata of the output
           file:

                   ffmpeg -i in.ogg -map_metadata 0:s:0 out.mp3

           To do the reverse, i.e. copy global metadata to all audio streams:

                   ffmpeg -i in.mkv -map_metadata:s:a 0:g out.mkv

           Note that simple 0 would work as well in this example, since global metadata is assumed by default.

       -map_chapters input_file_index (output)
           Copy chapters from input file with index input_file_index to the next output file. If no chapter
           mapping is specified, then chapters are copied from the first input file with at least one chapter.
           Use a negative file index to disable any chapter copying.

       -benchmark (global)
           Show benchmarking information at the end of an encode.  Shows real, system and user time used and
           maximum memory consumption.  Maximum memory consumption is not supported on all systems, it will
           usually display as 0 if not supported.

       -benchmark_all (global)
           Show benchmarking information during the encode.  Shows real, system and user time used in various
           steps (audio/video encode/decode).

       -timelimit duration (global)
           Exit after ffmpeg has been running for duration seconds in CPU user time.

       -dump (global)
           Dump each input packet to stderr.

       -hex (global)
           When dumping packets, also dump the payload.

       -readrate speed (input)
           Limit input read speed.

           Its value is a floating-point positive number which represents the maximum duration of media, in
           seconds, that should be ingested in one second of wallclock time.  Default value is zero and
           represents no imposed limitation on speed of ingestion.  Value 1 represents real-time speed and is
           equivalent to "-re".

           Mainly used to simulate a capture device or live input stream (e.g. when reading from a file).
           Should not be used with a low value when input is an actual capture device or live stream as it may
           cause packet loss.

           It is useful for when flow speed of output packets is important, such as live streaming.

       -re (input)
           Read input at native frame rate. This is equivalent to setting "-readrate 1".

       -readrate_initial_burst seconds
           Set an initial read burst time, in seconds, after which -re/-readrate will be enforced.

       -vsync parameter (global)
       -fps_mode[:stream_specifier] parameter (output,per-stream)
           Set video sync method / framerate mode. vsync is applied to all output video streams but can be
           overridden for a stream by setting fps_mode. vsync is deprecated and will be removed in the future.

           For compatibility reasons some of the values for vsync can be specified as numbers (shown in
           parentheses in the following table).

           passthrough (0)
               Each frame is passed with its timestamp from the demuxer to the muxer.

           cfr (1)
               Frames will be duplicated and dropped to achieve exactly the requested constant frame rate.

           vfr (2)
               Frames are passed through with their timestamp or dropped so as to prevent 2 frames from having
               the same timestamp.

           auto (-1)
               Chooses between cfr and vfr depending on muxer capabilities. This is the default method.

           Note that the timestamps may be further modified by the muxer, after this.  For example, in the case
           that the format option avoid_negative_ts is enabled.

           With -map you can select from which stream the timestamps should be taken. You can leave either video
           or audio unchanged and sync the remaining stream(s) to the unchanged one.

       -frame_drop_threshold parameter
           Frame drop threshold, which specifies how much behind video frames can be before they are dropped. In
           frame rate units, so 1.0 is one frame.  The default is -1.1. One possible usecase is to avoid
           framedrops in case of noisy timestamps or to increase frame drop precision in case of exact
           timestamps.

       -apad parameters (output,per-stream)
           Pad the output audio stream(s). This is the same as applying "-af apad".  Argument is a string of
           filter parameters composed the same as with the "apad" filter.  "-shortest" must be set for this
           output for the option to take effect.

       -copyts
           Do not process input timestamps, but keep their values without trying to sanitize them. In
           particular, do not remove the initial start time offset value.

           Note that, depending on the vsync option or on specific muxer processing (e.g. in case the format
           option avoid_negative_ts is enabled) the output timestamps may mismatch with the input timestamps
           even when this option is selected.

       -start_at_zero
           When used with copyts, shift input timestamps so they start at zero.

           This means that using e.g. "-ss 50" will make output timestamps start at 50 seconds, regardless of
           what timestamp the input file started at.

       -copytb mode
           Specify how to set the encoder timebase when stream copying.  mode is an integer numeric value, and
           can assume one of the following values:

           1   Use the demuxer timebase.

               The time base is copied to the output encoder from the corresponding input demuxer. This is
               sometimes required to avoid non monotonically increasing timestamps when copying video streams
               with variable frame rate.

           0   Use the decoder timebase.

               The time base is copied to the output encoder from the corresponding input decoder.

           -1  Try to make the choice automatically, in order to generate a sane output.

           Default value is -1.

       -enc_time_base[:stream_specifier] timebase (output,per-stream)
           Set the encoder timebase. timebase can assume one of the following values:

           0   Assign a default value according to the media type.

               For video - use 1/framerate, for audio - use 1/samplerate.

           demux
               Use the timebase from the demuxer.

           filter
               Use the timebase from the filtergraph.

           a positive number
               Use the provided number as the timebase.

               This field can be provided as a ratio of two integers (e.g. 1:24, 1:48000) or as a decimal number
               (e.g. 0.04166, 2.0833e-5)

           Default value is 0.

       -bitexact (input/output)
           Enable bitexact mode for (de)muxer and (de/en)coder

       -shortest (output)
           Finish encoding when the shortest output stream ends.

           Note that this option may require buffering frames, which introduces extra latency. The maximum
           amount of this latency may be controlled with the "-shortest_buf_duration" option.

       -shortest_buf_duration duration (output)
           The "-shortest" option may require buffering potentially large amounts of data when at least one of
           the streams is "sparse" (i.e. has large gaps between frames – this is typically the case for
           subtitles).

           This option controls the maximum duration of buffered frames in seconds.  Larger values may allow the
           "-shortest" option to produce more accurate results, but increase memory use and latency.

           The default value is 10 seconds.

       -dts_delta_threshold threshold
           Timestamp discontinuity delta threshold, expressed as a decimal number of seconds.

           The timestamp discontinuity correction enabled by this option is only applied to input formats
           accepting timestamp discontinuity (for which the "AVFMT_TS_DISCONT" flag is enabled), e.g. MPEG-TS
           and HLS, and is automatically disabled when employing the "-copyts" option (unless wrapping is
           detected).

           If a timestamp discontinuity is detected whose absolute value is greater than threshold, ffmpeg will
           remove the discontinuity by decreasing/increasing the current DTS and PTS by the corresponding delta
           value.

           The default value is 10.

       -dts_error_threshold threshold
           Timestamp error delta threshold, expressed as a decimal number of seconds.

           The timestamp correction enabled by this option is only applied to input formats not accepting
           timestamp discontinuity (for which the "AVFMT_TS_DISCONT" flag is not enabled).

           If a timestamp discontinuity is detected whose absolute value is greater than threshold, ffmpeg will
           drop the PTS/DTS timestamp value.

           The default value is "3600*30" (30 hours), which is arbitrarily picked and quite conservative.

       -muxdelay seconds (output)
           Set the maximum demux-decode delay.

       -muxpreload seconds (output)
           Set the initial demux-decode delay.

       -streamid output-stream-index:new-value (output)
           Assign a new stream-id value to an output stream. This option should be specified prior to the output
           filename to which it applies.  For the situation where multiple output files exist, a streamid may be
           reassigned to a different value.

           For example, to set the stream 0 PID to 33 and the stream 1 PID to 36 for an output mpegts file:

                   ffmpeg -i inurl -streamid 0:33 -streamid 1:36 out.ts

       -bsf[:stream_specifier] bitstream_filters (input/output,per-stream)
           Apply bitstream filters to matching streams. The filters are applied to each packet as it is received
           from the demuxer (when used as an input option) or before it is sent to the muxer (when used as an
           output option).

           bitstream_filters is a comma-separated list of bitstream filter specifications, each of the form

                   <filter>[=<optname0>=<optval0>:<optname1>=<optval1>:...]

           Any of the ',=:' characters that are to be a part of an option value need to be escaped with a
           backslash.

           Use the "-bsfs" option to get the list of bitstream filters.

           E.g.

                   ffmpeg -bsf:v h264_mp4toannexb -i h264.mp4 -c:v copy -an out.h264

           applies the "h264_mp4toannexb" bitstream filter (which converts MP4-encapsulated H.264 stream to
           Annex B) to the input video stream.

           On the other hand,

                   ffmpeg -i file.mov -an -vn -bsf:s mov2textsub -c:s copy -f rawvideo sub.txt

           applies the "mov2textsub" bitstream filter (which extracts text from MOV subtitles) to the output
           subtitle stream. Note, however, that since both examples use "-c copy", it matters little whether the
           filters are applied on input or output - that would change if transcoding was happening.

       -tag[:stream_specifier] codec_tag (input/output,per-stream)
           Force a tag/fourcc for matching streams.

       -timecode hh:mm:ssSEPff
           Specify Timecode for writing. SEP is ':' for non drop timecode and ';' (or '.') for drop.

                   ffmpeg -i input.mpg -timecode 01:02:03.04 -r 30000/1001 -s ntsc output.mpg

       -filter_complex filtergraph (global)
           Define a complex filtergraph, i.e. one with arbitrary number of inputs and/or outputs. For simple
           graphs -- those with one input and one output of the same type -- see the -filter options.
           filtergraph is a description of the filtergraph, as described in the ``Filtergraph syntax'' section
           of the ffmpeg-filters manual.

           Input link labels must refer to either input streams or loopback decoders. For input streams, use the
           "[file_index:stream_specifier]" syntax (i.e. the same as -map uses). If stream_specifier matches
           multiple streams, the first one will be used.

           For decoders, the link label must be [dec:dec_idx], where dec_idx is the index of the loopback
           decoder to be connected to given input.

           An unlabeled input will be connected to the first unused input stream of the matching type.

           Output link labels are referred to with -map. Unlabeled outputs are added to the first output file.

           Note that with this option it is possible to use only lavfi sources without normal input files.

           For example, to overlay an image over video

                   ffmpeg -i video.mkv -i image.png -filter_complex '[0:v][1:v]overlay[out]' -map
                   '[out]' out.mkv

           Here "[0:v]" refers to the first video stream in the first input file, which is linked to the first
           (main) input of the overlay filter. Similarly the first video stream in the second input is linked to
           the second (overlay) input of overlay.

           Assuming there is only one video stream in each input file, we can omit input labels, so the above is
           equivalent to

                   ffmpeg -i video.mkv -i image.png -filter_complex 'overlay[out]' -map
                   '[out]' out.mkv

           Furthermore we can omit the output label and the single output from the filter graph will be added to
           the output file automatically, so we can simply write

                   ffmpeg -i video.mkv -i image.png -filter_complex 'overlay' out.mkv

           As a special exception, you can use a bitmap subtitle stream as input: it will be converted into a
           video with the same size as the largest video in the file, or 720x576 if no video is present. Note
           that this is an experimental and temporary solution. It will be removed once libavfilter has proper
           support for subtitles.

           For example, to hardcode subtitles on top of a DVB-T recording stored in MPEG-TS format, delaying the
           subtitles by 1 second:

                   ffmpeg -i input.ts -filter_complex \
                     '[#0x2ef] setpts=PTS+1/TB [sub] ; [#0x2d0] [sub] overlay' \
                     -sn -map '#0x2dc' output.mkv

           (0x2d0, 0x2dc and 0x2ef are the MPEG-TS PIDs of respectively the video, audio and subtitles streams;
           0:0, 0:3 and 0:7 would have worked too)

           To generate 5 seconds of pure red video using lavfi "color" source:

                   ffmpeg -filter_complex 'color=c=red' -t 5 out.mkv

       -filter_complex_threads nb_threads (global)
           Defines how many threads are used to process a filter_complex graph.  Similar to filter_threads but
           used for "-filter_complex" graphs only.  The default is the number of available CPUs.

       -lavfi filtergraph (global)
           Define a complex filtergraph, i.e. one with arbitrary number of inputs and/or outputs. Equivalent to
           -filter_complex.

       -accurate_seek (input)
           This option enables or disables accurate seeking in input files with the -ss option. It is enabled by
           default, so seeking is accurate when transcoding. Use -noaccurate_seek to disable it, which may be
           useful e.g. when copying some streams and transcoding the others.

       -seek_timestamp (input)
           This option enables or disables seeking by timestamp in input files with the -ss option. It is
           disabled by default. If enabled, the argument to the -ss option is considered an actual timestamp,
           and is not offset by the start time of the file. This matters only for files which do not start from
           timestamp 0, such as transport streams.

       -thread_queue_size size (input/output)
           For input, this option sets the maximum number of queued packets when reading from the file or
           device. With low latency / high rate live streams, packets may be discarded if they are not read in a
           timely manner; setting this value can force ffmpeg to use a separate input thread and read packets as
           soon as they arrive. By default ffmpeg only does this if multiple inputs are specified.

           For output, this option specified the maximum number of packets that may be queued to each muxing
           thread.

       -sdp_file file (global)
           Print sdp information for an output stream to file.  This allows dumping sdp information when at
           least one output isn't an rtp stream. (Requires at least one of the output formats to be rtp).

       -discard (input)
           Allows discarding specific streams or frames from streams.  Any input stream can be fully discarded,
           using value "all" whereas selective discarding of frames from a stream occurs at the demuxer and is
           not supported by all demuxers.

           none
               Discard no frame.

           default
               Default, which discards no frames.

           noref
               Discard all non-reference frames.

           bidir
               Discard all bidirectional frames.

           nokey
               Discard all frames excepts keyframes.

           all Discard all frames.

       -abort_on flags (global)
           Stop and abort on various conditions. The following flags are available:

           empty_output
               No packets were passed to the muxer, the output is empty.

           empty_output_stream
               No packets were passed to the muxer in some of the output streams.

       -max_error_rate (global)
           Set fraction of decoding frame failures across all inputs which when crossed ffmpeg will return exit
           code 69. Crossing this threshold does not terminate processing. Range is a floating-point number
           between 0 to 1. Default is 2/3.

       -xerror (global)
           Stop and exit on error

       -max_muxing_queue_size packets (output,per-stream)
           When transcoding audio and/or video streams, ffmpeg will not begin writing into the output until it
           has one packet for each such stream. While waiting for that to happen, packets for other streams are
           buffered. This option sets the size of this buffer, in packets, for the matching output stream.

           The default value of this option should be high enough for most uses, so only touch this option if
           you are sure that you need it.

       -muxing_queue_data_threshold bytes (output,per-stream)
           This is a minimum threshold until which the muxing queue size is not taken into account. Defaults to
           50 megabytes per stream, and is based on the overall size of packets passed to the muxer.

       -auto_conversion_filters (global)
           Enable automatically inserting format conversion filters in all filter graphs, including those
           defined by -vf, -af, -filter_complex and -lavfi. If filter format negotiation requires a conversion,
           the initialization of the filters will fail.  Conversions can still be performed by inserting the
           relevant conversion filter (scale, aresample) in the graph.  On by default, to explicitly disable it
           you need to specify "-noauto_conversion_filters".

       -bits_per_raw_sample[:stream_specifier] value (output,per-stream)
           Declare the number of bits per raw sample in the given output stream to be value. Note that this
           option sets the information provided to the encoder/muxer, it does not change the stream to conform
           to this value. Setting values that do not match the stream properties may result in encoding failures
           or invalid output files.

       -stats_enc_pre[:stream_specifier] path (output,per-stream)
       -stats_enc_post[:stream_specifier] path (output,per-stream)
       -stats_mux_pre[:stream_specifier] path (output,per-stream)
           Write per-frame encoding information about the matching streams into the file given by path.

           -stats_enc_pre writes information about raw video or audio frames right before they are sent for
           encoding, while -stats_enc_post writes information about encoded packets as they are received from
           the encoder.  -stats_mux_pre writes information about packets just as they are about to be sent to
           the muxer. Every frame or packet produces one line in the specified file. The format of this line is
           controlled by -stats_enc_pre_fmt / -stats_enc_post_fmt / -stats_mux_pre_fmt.

           When stats for multiple streams are written into a single file, the lines corresponding to different
           streams will be interleaved. The precise order of this interleaving is not specified and not
           guaranteed to remain stable between different invocations of the program, even with the same options.

       -stats_enc_pre_fmt[:stream_specifier] format_spec (output,per-stream)
       -stats_enc_post_fmt[:stream_specifier] format_spec (output,per-stream)
       -stats_mux_pre_fmt[:stream_specifier] format_spec (output,per-stream)
           Specify the format for the lines written with -stats_enc_pre / -stats_enc_post / -stats_mux_pre.

           format_spec is a string that may contain directives of the form {fmt}. format_spec is backslash-
           escaped --- use \{, \}, and \\ to write a literal {, }, or \, respectively, into the output.

           The directives given with fmt may be one of the following:

           fidx
               Index of the output file.

           sidx
               Index of the output stream in the file.

           n   Frame number. Pre-encoding: number of frames sent to the encoder so far.  Post-encoding: number
               of packets received from the encoder so far.  Muxing: number of packets submitted to the muxer
               for this stream so far.

           ni  Input frame number. Index of the input frame (i.e. output by a decoder) that corresponds to this
               output frame or packet. -1 if unavailable.

           tb  Timebase in which this frame/packet's timestamps are expressed, as a rational number num/den.
               Note that encoder and muxer may use different timebases.

           tbi Timebase for ptsi, as a rational number num/den. Available when ptsi is available, 0/1 otherwise.

           pts Presentation timestamp of the frame or packet, as an integer. Should be multiplied by the
               timebase to compute presentation time.

           ptsi
               Presentation timestamp of the input frame (see ni), as an integer. Should be multiplied by tbi to
               compute presentation time. Printed as (2^63 - 1 = 9223372036854775807) when not available.

           t   Presentation time of the frame or packet, as a decimal number. Equal to pts multiplied by tb.

           ti  Presentation time of the input frame (see ni), as a decimal number. Equal to ptsi multiplied by
               tbi. Printed as inf when not available.

           dts (packet)
               Decoding timestamp of the packet, as an integer. Should be multiplied by the timebase to compute
               presentation time.

           dt (packet)
               Decoding time of the frame or packet, as a decimal number. Equal to dts multiplied by tb.

           sn (frame,audio)
               Number of audio samples sent to the encoder so far.

           samp (frame,audio)
               Number of audio samples in the frame.

           size (packet)
               Size of the encoded packet in bytes.

           br (packet)
               Current bitrate in bits per second.

           abr (packet)
               Average bitrate for the whole stream so far, in bits per second, -1 if it cannot be determined at
               this point.

           key (packet)
               Character 'K' if the packet contains a keyframe, character 'N' otherwise.

           Directives tagged with packet may only be used with -stats_enc_post_fmt and -stats_mux_pre_fmt.

           Directives tagged with frame may only be used with -stats_enc_pre_fmt.

           Directives tagged with audio may only be used with audio streams.

           The default format strings are:

           pre-encoding
               {fidx} {sidx} {n} {t}

           post-encoding
               {fidx} {sidx} {n} {t}

           In the future, new items may be added to the end of the default formatting strings. Users who depend
           on the format staying exactly the same, should prescribe it manually.

           Note that stats for different streams written into the same file may have different formats.

   Preset files
       A preset file contains a sequence of option=value pairs, one for each line, specifying a sequence of
       options which would be awkward to specify on the command line. Lines starting with the hash ('#')
       character are ignored and are used to provide comments. Check the presets directory in the FFmpeg source
       tree for examples.

       There are two types of preset files: ffpreset and avpreset files.

       ffpreset files

       ffpreset files are specified with the "vpre", "apre", "spre", and "fpre" options. The "fpre" option takes
       the filename of the preset instead of a preset name as input and can be used for any kind of codec. For
       the "vpre", "apre", and "spre" options, the options specified in a preset file are applied to the
       currently selected codec of the same type as the preset option.

       The argument passed to the "vpre", "apre", and "spre" preset options identifies the preset file to use
       according to the following rules:

       First ffmpeg searches for a file named arg.ffpreset in the directories $FFMPEG_DATADIR (if set), and
       $HOME/.ffmpeg, and in the datadir defined at configuration time (usually PREFIX/share/ffmpeg) or in a
       ffpresets folder along the executable on win32, in that order. For example, if the argument is
       "libvpx-1080p", it will search for the file libvpx-1080p.ffpreset.

       If no such file is found, then ffmpeg will search for a file named codec_name-arg.ffpreset in the above-
       mentioned directories, where codec_name is the name of the codec to which the preset file options will be
       applied. For example, if you select the video codec with "-vcodec libvpx" and use "-vpre 1080p", then it
       will search for the file libvpx-1080p.ffpreset.

       avpreset files

       avpreset files are specified with the "pre" option. They work similar to ffpreset files, but they only
       allow encoder- specific options. Therefore, an option=value pair specifying an encoder cannot be used.

       When the "pre" option is specified, ffmpeg will look for files with the suffix .avpreset in the
       directories $AVCONV_DATADIR (if set), and $HOME/.avconv, and in the datadir defined at configuration time
       (usually PREFIX/share/ffmpeg), in that order.

       First ffmpeg searches for a file named codec_name-arg.avpreset in the above-mentioned directories, where
       codec_name is the name of the codec to which the preset file options will be applied. For example, if you
       select the video codec with "-vcodec libvpx" and use "-pre 1080p", then it will search for the file
       libvpx-1080p.avpreset.

       If no such file is found, then ffmpeg will search for a file named arg.avpreset in the same directories.

   vstats file format
       The "-vstats" and "-vstats_file" options enable generation of a file containing statistics about the
       generated video outputs.

       The "-vstats_version" option controls the format version of the generated file.

       With version 1 the format is:

               frame= <FRAME> q= <FRAME_QUALITY> PSNR= <PSNR> f_size= <FRAME_SIZE> s_size= <STREAM_SIZE>kB time= <TIMESTAMP> br= <BITRATE>kbits/s avg_br= <AVERAGE_BITRATE>kbits/s

       With version 2 the format is:

               out= <OUT_FILE_INDEX> st= <OUT_FILE_STREAM_INDEX> frame= <FRAME_NUMBER> q= <FRAME_QUALITY>f PSNR= <PSNR> f_size= <FRAME_SIZE> s_size= <STREAM_SIZE>kB time= <TIMESTAMP> br= <BITRATE>kbits/s avg_br= <AVERAGE_BITRATE>kbits/s

       The value corresponding to each key is described below:

       avg_br
           average bitrate expressed in Kbits/s

       br  bitrate expressed in Kbits/s

       frame
           number of encoded frame

       out out file index

       PSNR
           Peak Signal to Noise Ratio

       q   quality of the frame

       f_size
           encoded packet size expressed as number of bytes

       s_size
           stream size expressed in KiB

       st  out file stream index

       time
           time of the packet

       type
           picture type

       See also the -stats_enc options for an alternative way to show encoding statistics.

EXAMPLES

   Video and Audio grabbing
       If you specify the input format and device then ffmpeg can grab video and audio directly.

               ffmpeg -f oss -i /dev/dsp -f video4linux2 -i /dev/video0 /tmp/out.mpg

       Or with an ALSA audio source (mono input, card id 1) instead of OSS:

               ffmpeg -f alsa -ac 1 -i hw:1 -f video4linux2 -i /dev/video0 /tmp/out.mpg

       Note that you must activate the right video source and channel before launching ffmpeg with any TV viewer
       such as <http://linux.bytesex.org/xawtv/> by Gerd Knorr. You also have to set the audio recording levels
       correctly with a standard mixer.

   X11 grabbing
       Grab the X11 display with ffmpeg via

               ffmpeg -f x11grab -video_size cif -framerate 25 -i :0.0 /tmp/out.mpg

       0.0 is display.screen number of your X11 server, same as the DISPLAY environment variable.

               ffmpeg -f x11grab -video_size cif -framerate 25 -i :0.0+10,20 /tmp/out.mpg

       0.0 is display.screen number of your X11 server, same as the DISPLAY environment variable. 10 is the
       x-offset and 20 the y-offset for the grabbing.

   Video and Audio file format conversion
       Any supported file format and protocol can serve as input to ffmpeg:

       Examples:

       •   You can use YUV files as input:

                   ffmpeg -i /tmp/test%d.Y /tmp/out.mpg

           It will use the files:

                   /tmp/test0.Y, /tmp/test0.U, /tmp/test0.V,
                   /tmp/test1.Y, /tmp/test1.U, /tmp/test1.V, etc...

           The Y files use twice the resolution of the U and V files. They are raw files, without header. They
           can be generated by all decent video decoders. You must specify the size of the image with the -s
           option if ffmpeg cannot guess it.

       •   You can input from a raw YUV420P file:

                   ffmpeg -i /tmp/test.yuv /tmp/out.avi

           test.yuv is a file containing raw YUV planar data. Each frame is composed of the Y plane followed by
           the U and V planes at half vertical and horizontal resolution.

       •   You can output to a raw YUV420P file:

                   ffmpeg -i mydivx.avi hugefile.yuv

       •   You can set several input files and output files:

                   ffmpeg -i /tmp/a.wav -s 640x480 -i /tmp/a.yuv /tmp/a.mpg

           Converts the audio file a.wav and the raw YUV video file a.yuv to MPEG file a.mpg.

       •   You can also do audio and video conversions at the same time:

                   ffmpeg -i /tmp/a.wav -ar 22050 /tmp/a.mp2

           Converts a.wav to MPEG audio at 22050 Hz sample rate.

       •   You can encode to several formats at the same time and define a mapping from input stream to output
           streams:

                   ffmpeg -i /tmp/a.wav -map 0:a -b:a 64k /tmp/a.mp2 -map 0:a -b:a 128k /tmp/b.mp2

           Converts a.wav to a.mp2 at 64 kbits and to b.mp2 at 128 kbits. '-map file:index' specifies which
           input stream is used for each output stream, in the order of the definition of output streams.

       •   You can transcode decrypted VOBs:

                   ffmpeg -i snatch_1.vob -f avi -c:v mpeg4 -b:v 800k -g 300 -bf 2 -c:a libmp3lame -b:a 128k snatch.avi

           This is a typical DVD ripping example; the input is a VOB file, the output an AVI file with MPEG-4
           video and MP3 audio. Note that in this command we use B-frames so the MPEG-4 stream is DivX5
           compatible, and GOP size is 300 which means one intra frame every 10 seconds for 29.97fps input
           video. Furthermore, the audio stream is MP3-encoded so you need to enable LAME support by passing
           "--enable-libmp3lame" to configure.  The mapping is particularly useful for DVD transcoding to get
           the desired audio language.

           NOTE: To see the supported input formats, use "ffmpeg -demuxers".

       •   You can extract images from a video, or create a video from many images:

           For extracting images from a video:

                   ffmpeg -i foo.avi -r 1 -s WxH -f image2 foo-%03d.jpeg

           This will extract one video frame per second from the video and will output them in files named
           foo-001.jpeg, foo-002.jpeg, etc. Images will be rescaled to fit the new WxH values.

           If you want to extract just a limited number of frames, you can use the above command in combination
           with the "-frames:v" or "-t" option, or in combination with -ss to start extracting from a certain
           point in time.

           For creating a video from many images:

                   ffmpeg -f image2 -framerate 12 -i foo-%03d.jpeg -s WxH foo.avi

           The syntax "foo-%03d.jpeg" specifies to use a decimal number composed of three digits padded with
           zeroes to express the sequence number. It is the same syntax supported by the C printf function, but
           only formats accepting a normal integer are suitable.

           When importing an image sequence, -i also supports expanding shell-like wildcard patterns (globbing)
           internally, by selecting the image2-specific "-pattern_type glob" option.

           For example, for creating a video from filenames matching the glob pattern "foo-*.jpeg":

                   ffmpeg -f image2 -pattern_type glob -framerate 12 -i 'foo-*.jpeg' -s WxH foo.avi

       •   You can put many streams of the same type in the output:

                   ffmpeg -i test1.avi -i test2.avi -map 1:1 -map 1:0 -map 0:1 -map 0:0 -c copy -y test12.nut

           The resulting output file test12.nut will contain the first four streams from the input files in
           reverse order.

       •   To force CBR video output:

                   ffmpeg -i myfile.avi -b 4000k -minrate 4000k -maxrate 4000k -bufsize 1835k out.m2v

       •   The four options lmin, lmax, mblmin and mblmax use 'lambda' units, but you may use the QP2LAMBDA
           constant to easily convert from 'q' units:

                   ffmpeg -i src.ext -lmax 21*QP2LAMBDA dst.ext

SYNTAX

       This section documents the syntax and formats employed by the FFmpeg libraries and tools.

   Quoting and escaping
       FFmpeg adopts the following quoting and escaping mechanism, unless explicitly specified. The following
       rules are applied:

       •   ' and \ are special characters (respectively used for quoting and escaping). In addition to them,
           there might be other special characters depending on the specific syntax where the escaping and
           quoting are employed.

       •   A special character is escaped by prefixing it with a \.

       •   All characters enclosed between '' are included literally in the parsed string. The quote character '
           itself cannot be quoted, so you may need to close the quote and escape it.

       •   Leading and trailing whitespaces, unless escaped or quoted, are removed from the parsed string.

       Note that you may need to add a second level of escaping when using the command line or a script, which
       depends on the syntax of the adopted shell language.

       The function "av_get_token" defined in libavutil/avstring.h can be used to parse a token quoted or
       escaped according to the rules defined above.

       The tool tools/ffescape in the FFmpeg source tree can be used to automatically quote or escape a string
       in a script.

       Examples

       •   Escape the string "Crime d'Amour" containing the "'" special character:

                   Crime d\'Amour

       •   The string above contains a quote, so the "'" needs to be escaped when quoting it:

                   'Crime d'\''Amour'

       •   Include leading or trailing whitespaces using quoting:

                   '  this string starts and ends with whitespaces  '

       •   Escaping and quoting can be mixed together:

                   ' The string '\'string\'' is a string '

       •   To include a literal \ you can use either escaping or quoting:

                   'c:\foo' can be written as c:\\foo

   Date
       The accepted syntax is:

               [(YYYY-MM-DD|YYYYMMDD)[T|t| ]]((HH:MM:SS[.m...]]])|(HHMMSS[.m...]]]))[Z]
               now

       If the value is "now" it takes the current time.

       Time is local time unless Z is appended, in which case it is interpreted as UTC.  If the year-month-day
       part is not specified it takes the current year-month-day.

   Time duration
       There are two accepted syntaxes for expressing time duration.

               [-][<HH>:]<MM>:<SS>[.<m>...]

       HH expresses the number of hours, MM the number of minutes for a maximum of 2 digits, and SS the number
       of seconds for a maximum of 2 digits. The m at the end expresses decimal value for SS.

       or

               [-]<S>+[.<m>...][s|ms|us]

       S expresses the number of seconds, with the optional decimal part m.  The optional literal suffixes s, ms
       or us indicate to interpret the value as seconds, milliseconds or microseconds, respectively.

       In both expressions, the optional - indicates negative duration.

       Examples

       The following examples are all valid time duration:

       55  55 seconds

       0.2 0.2 seconds

       200ms
           200 milliseconds, that's 0.2s

       200000us
           200000 microseconds, that's 0.2s

       12:03:45
           12 hours, 03 minutes and 45 seconds

       23.189
           23.189 seconds

   Video size
       Specify the size of the sourced video, it may be a string of the form widthxheight, or the name of a size
       abbreviation.

       The following abbreviations are recognized:

       ntsc
           720x480

       pal 720x576

       qntsc
           352x240

       qpal
           352x288

       sntsc
           640x480

       spal
           768x576

       film
           352x240

       ntsc-film
           352x240

       sqcif
           128x96

       qcif
           176x144

       cif 352x288

       4cif
           704x576

       16cif
           1408x1152

       qqvga
           160x120

       qvga
           320x240

       vga 640x480

       svga
           800x600

       xga 1024x768

       uxga
           1600x1200

       qxga
           2048x1536

       sxga
           1280x1024

       qsxga
           2560x2048

       hsxga
           5120x4096

       wvga
           852x480

       wxga
           1366x768

       wsxga
           1600x1024

       wuxga
           1920x1200

       woxga
           2560x1600

       wqsxga
           3200x2048

       wquxga
           3840x2400

       whsxga
           6400x4096

       whuxga
           7680x4800

       cga 320x200

       ega 640x350

       hd480
           852x480

       hd720
           1280x720

       hd1080
           1920x1080

       2k  2048x1080

       2kflat
           1998x1080

       2kscope
           2048x858

       4k  4096x2160

       4kflat
           3996x2160

       4kscope
           4096x1716

       nhd 640x360

       hqvga
           240x160

       wqvga
           400x240

       fwqvga
           432x240

       hvga
           480x320

       qhd 960x540

       2kdci
           2048x1080

       4kdci
           4096x2160

       uhd2160
           3840x2160

       uhd4320
           7680x4320

   Video rate
       Specify the frame rate of a video, expressed as the number of frames generated per second. It has to be a
       string in the format frame_rate_num/frame_rate_den, an integer number, a float number or a valid video
       frame rate abbreviation.

       The following abbreviations are recognized:

       ntsc
           30000/1001

       pal 25/1

       qntsc
           30000/1001

       qpal
           25/1

       sntsc
           30000/1001

       spal
           25/1

       film
           24/1

       ntsc-film
           24000/1001

   Ratio
       A ratio can be expressed as an expression, or in the form numerator:denominator.

       Note that a ratio with infinite (1/0) or negative value is considered valid, so you should check on the
       returned value if you want to exclude those values.

       The undefined value can be expressed using the "0:0" string.

   Color
       It can be the name of a color as defined below (case insensitive match) or a "[0x|#]RRGGBB[AA]" sequence,
       possibly followed by @ and a string representing the alpha component.

       The alpha component may be a string composed by "0x" followed by an hexadecimal number or a decimal
       number between 0.0 and 1.0, which represents the opacity value (0x00 or 0.0 means completely transparent,
       0xff or 1.0 completely opaque). If the alpha component is not specified then 0xff is assumed.

       The string random will result in a random color.

       The following names of colors are recognized:

       AliceBlue
           0xF0F8FF

       AntiqueWhite
           0xFAEBD7

       Aqua
           0x00FFFF

       Aquamarine
           0x7FFFD4

       Azure
           0xF0FFFF

       Beige
           0xF5F5DC

       Bisque
           0xFFE4C4

       Black
           0x000000

       BlanchedAlmond
           0xFFEBCD

       Blue
           0x0000FF

       BlueViolet
           0x8A2BE2

       Brown
           0xA52A2A

       BurlyWood
           0xDEB887

       CadetBlue
           0x5F9EA0

       Chartreuse
           0x7FFF00

       Chocolate
           0xD2691E

       Coral
           0xFF7F50

       CornflowerBlue
           0x6495ED

       Cornsilk
           0xFFF8DC

       Crimson
           0xDC143C

       Cyan
           0x00FFFF

       DarkBlue
           0x00008B

       DarkCyan
           0x008B8B

       DarkGoldenRod
           0xB8860B

       DarkGray
           0xA9A9A9

       DarkGreen
           0x006400

       DarkKhaki
           0xBDB76B

       DarkMagenta
           0x8B008B

       DarkOliveGreen
           0x556B2F

       Darkorange
           0xFF8C00

       DarkOrchid
           0x9932CC

       DarkRed
           0x8B0000

       DarkSalmon
           0xE9967A

       DarkSeaGreen
           0x8FBC8F

       DarkSlateBlue
           0x483D8B

       DarkSlateGray
           0x2F4F4F

       DarkTurquoise
           0x00CED1

       DarkViolet
           0x9400D3

       DeepPink
           0xFF1493

       DeepSkyBlue
           0x00BFFF

       DimGray
           0x696969

       DodgerBlue
           0x1E90FF

       FireBrick
           0xB22222

       FloralWhite
           0xFFFAF0

       ForestGreen
           0x228B22

       Fuchsia
           0xFF00FF

       Gainsboro
           0xDCDCDC

       GhostWhite
           0xF8F8FF

       Gold
           0xFFD700

       GoldenRod
           0xDAA520

       Gray
           0x808080

       Green
           0x008000

       GreenYellow
           0xADFF2F

       HoneyDew
           0xF0FFF0

       HotPink
           0xFF69B4

       IndianRed
           0xCD5C5C

       Indigo
           0x4B0082

       Ivory
           0xFFFFF0

       Khaki
           0xF0E68C

       Lavender
           0xE6E6FA

       LavenderBlush
           0xFFF0F5

       LawnGreen
           0x7CFC00

       LemonChiffon
           0xFFFACD

       LightBlue
           0xADD8E6

       LightCoral
           0xF08080

       LightCyan
           0xE0FFFF

       LightGoldenRodYellow
           0xFAFAD2

       LightGreen
           0x90EE90

       LightGrey
           0xD3D3D3

       LightPink
           0xFFB6C1

       LightSalmon
           0xFFA07A

       LightSeaGreen
           0x20B2AA

       LightSkyBlue
           0x87CEFA

       LightSlateGray
           0x778899

       LightSteelBlue
           0xB0C4DE

       LightYellow
           0xFFFFE0

       Lime
           0x00FF00

       LimeGreen
           0x32CD32

       Linen
           0xFAF0E6

       Magenta
           0xFF00FF

       Maroon
           0x800000

       MediumAquaMarine
           0x66CDAA

       MediumBlue
           0x0000CD

       MediumOrchid
           0xBA55D3

       MediumPurple
           0x9370D8

       MediumSeaGreen
           0x3CB371

       MediumSlateBlue
           0x7B68EE

       MediumSpringGreen
           0x00FA9A

       MediumTurquoise
           0x48D1CC

       MediumVioletRed
           0xC71585

       MidnightBlue
           0x191970

       MintCream
           0xF5FFFA

       MistyRose
           0xFFE4E1

       Moccasin
           0xFFE4B5

       NavajoWhite
           0xFFDEAD

       Navy
           0x000080

       OldLace
           0xFDF5E6

       Olive
           0x808000

       OliveDrab
           0x6B8E23

       Orange
           0xFFA500

       OrangeRed
           0xFF4500

       Orchid
           0xDA70D6

       PaleGoldenRod
           0xEEE8AA

       PaleGreen
           0x98FB98

       PaleTurquoise
           0xAFEEEE

       PaleVioletRed
           0xD87093

       PapayaWhip
           0xFFEFD5

       PeachPuff
           0xFFDAB9

       Peru
           0xCD853F

       Pink
           0xFFC0CB

       Plum
           0xDDA0DD

       PowderBlue
           0xB0E0E6

       Purple
           0x800080

       Red 0xFF0000

       RosyBrown
           0xBC8F8F

       RoyalBlue
           0x4169E1

       SaddleBrown
           0x8B4513

       Salmon
           0xFA8072

       SandyBrown
           0xF4A460

       SeaGreen
           0x2E8B57

       SeaShell
           0xFFF5EE

       Sienna
           0xA0522D

       Silver
           0xC0C0C0

       SkyBlue
           0x87CEEB

       SlateBlue
           0x6A5ACD

       SlateGray
           0x708090

       Snow
           0xFFFAFA

       SpringGreen
           0x00FF7F

       SteelBlue
           0x4682B4

       Tan 0xD2B48C

       Teal
           0x008080

       Thistle
           0xD8BFD8

       Tomato
           0xFF6347

       Turquoise
           0x40E0D0

       Violet
           0xEE82EE

       Wheat
           0xF5DEB3

       White
           0xFFFFFF

       WhiteSmoke
           0xF5F5F5

       Yellow
           0xFFFF00

       YellowGreen
           0x9ACD32

   Channel Layout
       A channel layout specifies the spatial disposition of the channels in a multi-channel audio stream. To
       specify a channel layout, FFmpeg makes use of a special syntax.

       Individual channels are identified by an id, as given by the table below:

       FL  front left

       FR  front right

       FC  front center

       LFE low frequency

       BL  back left

       BR  back right

       FLC front left-of-center

       FRC front right-of-center

       BC  back center

       SL  side left

       SR  side right

       TC  top center

       TFL top front left

       TFC top front center

       TFR top front right

       TBL top back left

       TBC top back center

       TBR top back right

       DL  downmix left

       DR  downmix right

       WL  wide left

       WR  wide right

       SDL surround direct left

       SDR surround direct right

       LFE2
           low frequency 2

       Standard channel layout compositions can be specified by using the following identifiers:

       mono
           FC

       stereo
           FL+FR

       2.1 FL+FR+LFE

       3.0 FL+FR+FC

       3.0(back)
           FL+FR+BC

       4.0 FL+FR+FC+BC

       quad
           FL+FR+BL+BR

       quad(side)
           FL+FR+SL+SR

       3.1 FL+FR+FC+LFE

       5.0 FL+FR+FC+BL+BR

       5.0(side)
           FL+FR+FC+SL+SR

       4.1 FL+FR+FC+LFE+BC

       5.1 FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR

       5.1(side)
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+SL+SR

       6.0 FL+FR+FC+BC+SL+SR

       6.0(front)
           FL+FR+FLC+FRC+SL+SR

       3.1.2
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+TFL+TFR

       hexagonal
           FL+FR+FC+BL+BR+BC

       6.1 FL+FR+FC+LFE+BC+SL+SR

       6.1 FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR+BC

       6.1(front)
           FL+FR+LFE+FLC+FRC+SL+SR

       7.0 FL+FR+FC+BL+BR+SL+SR

       7.0(front)
           FL+FR+FC+FLC+FRC+SL+SR

       7.1 FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR+SL+SR

       7.1(wide)
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR+FLC+FRC

       7.1(wide-side)
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+FLC+FRC+SL+SR

       5.1.2
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR+TFL+TFR

       octagonal
           FL+FR+FC+BL+BR+BC+SL+SR

       cube
           FL+FR+BL+BR+TFL+TFR+TBL+TBR

       5.1.4
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR+TFL+TFR+TBL+TBR

       7.1.2
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR+SL+SR+TFL+TFR

       7.1.4
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR+SL+SR+TFL+TFR+TBL+TBR

       7.2.3
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR+SL+SR+TFL+TFR+TBC+LFE2

       9.1.4
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR+FLC+FRC+SL+SR+TFL+TFR+TBL+TBR

       hexadecagonal
           FL+FR+FC+BL+BR+BC+SL+SR+WL+WR+TBL+TBR+TBC+TFC+TFL+TFR

       downmix
           DL+DR

       22.2
           FL+FR+FC+LFE+BL+BR+FLC+FRC+BC+SL+SR+TC+TFL+TFC+TFR+TBL+TBC+TBR+LFE2+TSL+TSR+BFC+BFL+BFR

       A custom channel layout can be specified as a sequence of terms, separated by '+'.  Each term can be:

       •   the name of a single channel (e.g. FL, FR, FC, LFE, etc.), each optionally containing a custom name
           after a '@', (e.g. FL@Left, FR@Right, FC@Center, LFE@Low_Frequency, etc.)

       A standard channel layout can be specified by the following:

       •   the name of a single channel (e.g. FL, FR, FC, LFE, etc.)

       •   the name of a standard channel layout (e.g. mono, stereo, 4.0, quad, 5.0, etc.)

       •   a number of channels, in decimal, followed by 'c', yielding the default channel layout for that
           number of channels (see the function "av_channel_layout_default"). Note that not all channel counts
           have a default layout.

       •   a number of channels, in decimal, followed by 'C', yielding an unknown channel layout with the
           specified number of channels. Note that not all channel layout specification strings support unknown
           channel layouts.

       •   a channel layout mask, in hexadecimal starting with "0x" (see the "AV_CH_*" macros in
           libavutil/channel_layout.h.

       Before libavutil version 53 the trailing character "c" to specify a number of channels was optional, but
       now it is required, while a channel layout mask can also be specified as a decimal number (if and only if
       not followed by "c" or "C").

       See also the function "av_channel_layout_from_string" defined in libavutil/channel_layout.h.

EXPRESSION EVALUATION

       When evaluating an arithmetic expression, FFmpeg uses an internal formula evaluator, implemented through
       the libavutil/eval.h interface.

       An expression may contain unary, binary operators, constants, and functions.

       Two expressions expr1 and expr2 can be combined to form another expression "expr1;expr2".  expr1 and
       expr2 are evaluated in turn, and the new expression evaluates to the value of expr2.

       The following binary operators are available: "+", "-", "*", "/", "^".

       The following unary operators are available: "+", "-".

       The following functions are available:

       abs(x)
           Compute absolute value of x.

       acos(x)
           Compute arccosine of x.

       asin(x)
           Compute arcsine of x.

       atan(x)
           Compute arctangent of x.

       atan2(y, x)
           Compute principal value of the arc tangent of y/x.

       between(x, min, max)
           Return 1 if x is greater than or equal to min and lesser than or equal to max, 0 otherwise.

       bitand(x, y)
       bitor(x, y)
           Compute bitwise and/or operation on x and y.

           The results of the evaluation of x and y are converted to integers before executing the bitwise
           operation.

           Note that both the conversion to integer and the conversion back to floating point can lose
           precision. Beware of unexpected results for large numbers (usually 2^53 and larger).

       ceil(expr)
           Round the value of expression expr upwards to the nearest integer. For example, "ceil(1.5)" is "2.0".

       clip(x, min, max)
           Return the value of x clipped between min and max.

       cos(x)
           Compute cosine of x.

       cosh(x)
           Compute hyperbolic cosine of x.

       eq(x, y)
           Return 1 if x and y are equivalent, 0 otherwise.

       exp(x)
           Compute exponential of x (with base "e", the Euler's number).

       floor(expr)
           Round the value of expression expr downwards to the nearest integer. For example, "floor(-1.5)" is
           "-2.0".

       gauss(x)
           Compute Gauss function of x, corresponding to "exp(-x*x/2) / sqrt(2*PI)".

       gcd(x, y)
           Return the greatest common divisor of x and y. If both x and y are 0 or either or both are less than
           zero then behavior is undefined.

       gt(x, y)
           Return 1 if x is greater than y, 0 otherwise.

       gte(x, y)
           Return 1 if x is greater than or equal to y, 0 otherwise.

       hypot(x, y)
           This function is similar to the C function with the same name; it returns "sqrt(x*x + y*y)", the
           length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides of length x and y, or the distance of the
           point (x, y) from the origin.

       if(x, y)
           Evaluate x, and if the result is non-zero return the result of the evaluation of y, return 0
           otherwise.

       if(x, y, z)
           Evaluate x, and if the result is non-zero return the evaluation result of y, otherwise the evaluation
           result of z.

       ifnot(x, y)
           Evaluate x, and if the result is zero return the result of the evaluation of y, return 0 otherwise.

       ifnot(x, y, z)
           Evaluate x, and if the result is zero return the evaluation result of y, otherwise the evaluation
           result of z.

       isinf(x)
           Return 1.0 if x is +/-INFINITY, 0.0 otherwise.

       isnan(x)
           Return 1.0 if x is NAN, 0.0 otherwise.

       ld(var)
           Load the value of the internal variable with number var, which was previously stored with st(var,
           expr).  The function returns the loaded value.

       lerp(x, y, z)
           Return linear interpolation between x and y by amount of z.

       log(x)
           Compute natural logarithm of x.

       lt(x, y)
           Return 1 if x is lesser than y, 0 otherwise.

       lte(x, y)
           Return 1 if x is lesser than or equal to y, 0 otherwise.

       max(x, y)
           Return the maximum between x and y.

       min(x, y)
           Return the minimum between x and y.

       mod(x, y)
           Compute the remainder of division of x by y.

       not(expr)
           Return 1.0 if expr is zero, 0.0 otherwise.

       pow(x, y)
           Compute the power of x elevated y, it is equivalent to "(x)^(y)".

       print(t)
       print(t, l)
           Print the value of expression t with loglevel l. If l is not specified then a default log level is
           used.  Returns the value of the expression printed.

           Prints t with loglevel l

       random(idx)
           Return a pseudo random value between 0.0 and 1.0. idx is the index of the internal variable which
           will be used to save the seed/state.

       randomi(idx, min, max)
           Return a pseudo random value in the interval between min and max. idx is the index of the internal
           variable which will be used to save the seed/state.

       root(expr, max)
           Find an input value for which the function represented by expr with argument ld(0) is 0 in the
           interval 0..max.

           The expression in expr must denote a continuous function or the result is undefined.

           ld(0) is used to represent the function input value, which means that the given expression will be
           evaluated multiple times with various input values that the expression can access through ld(0). When
           the expression evaluates to 0 then the corresponding input value will be returned.

       round(expr)
           Round the value of expression expr to the nearest integer. For example, "round(1.5)" is "2.0".

       sgn(x)
           Compute sign of x.

       sin(x)
           Compute sine of x.

       sinh(x)
           Compute hyperbolic sine of x.

       sqrt(expr)
           Compute the square root of expr. This is equivalent to "(expr)^.5".

       squish(x)
           Compute expression "1/(1 + exp(4*x))".

       st(var, expr)
           Store the value of the expression expr in an internal variable. var specifies the number of the
           variable where to store the value, and it is a value ranging from 0 to 9. The function returns the
           value stored in the internal variable.  Note, Variables are currently not shared between expressions.

       tan(x)
           Compute tangent of x.

       tanh(x)
           Compute hyperbolic tangent of x.

       taylor(expr, x)
       taylor(expr, x, id)
           Evaluate a Taylor series at x, given an expression representing the ld(id)-th derivative of a
           function at 0.

           When the series does not converge the result is undefined.

           ld(id) is used to represent the derivative order in expr, which means that the given expression will
           be evaluated multiple times with various input values that the expression can access through ld(id).
           If id is not specified then 0 is assumed.

           Note, when you have the derivatives at y instead of 0, "taylor(expr, x-y)" can be used.

       time(0)
           Return the current (wallclock) time in seconds.

       trunc(expr)
           Round the value of expression expr towards zero to the nearest integer. For example, "trunc(-1.5)" is
           "-1.0".

       while(cond, expr)
           Evaluate expression expr while the expression cond is non-zero, and returns the value of the last
           expr evaluation, or NAN if cond was always false.

       The following constants are available:

       PI  area of the unit disc, approximately 3.14

       E   exp(1) (Euler's number), approximately 2.718

       PHI golden ratio (1+sqrt(5))/2, approximately 1.618

       Assuming that an expression is considered "true" if it has a non-zero value, note that:

       "*" works like AND

       "+" works like OR

       For example the construct:

               if (A AND B) then C

       is equivalent to:

               if(A*B, C)

       In your C code, you can extend the list of unary and binary functions, and define recognized constants,
       so that they are available for your expressions.

       The evaluator also recognizes the International System unit prefixes.  If 'i' is appended after the
       prefix, binary prefixes are used, which are based on powers of 1024 instead of powers of 1000.  The 'B'
       postfix multiplies the value by 8, and can be appended after a unit prefix or used alone. This allows
       using for example 'KB', 'MiB', 'G' and 'B' as number postfix.

       The list of available International System prefixes follows, with indication of the corresponding powers
       of 10 and of 2.

       y   10^-24 / 2^-80

       z   10^-21 / 2^-70

       a   10^-18 / 2^-60

       f   10^-15 / 2^-50

       p   10^-12 / 2^-40

       n   10^-9 / 2^-30

       u   10^-6 / 2^-20

       m   10^-3 / 2^-10

       c   10^-2

       d   10^-1

       h   10^2

       k   10^3 / 2^10

       K   10^3 / 2^10

       M   10^6 / 2^20

       G   10^9 / 2^30

       T   10^12 / 2^40

       P   10^15 / 2^50

       E   10^18 / 2^60

       Z   10^21 / 2^70

       Y   10^24 / 2^80

CODEC OPTIONS

       libavcodec provides some generic global options, which can be set on all the encoders and decoders. In
       addition, each codec may support so-called private options, which are specific for a given codec.

       Sometimes, a global option may only affect a specific kind of codec, and may be nonsensical or ignored by
       another, so you need to be aware of the meaning of the specified options. Also some options are meant
       only for decoding or encoding.

       Options may be set by specifying -option value in the FFmpeg tools, or by setting the value explicitly in
       the "AVCodecContext" options or using the libavutil/opt.h API for programmatic use.

       The list of supported options follow:

       b integer (encoding,audio,video)
           Set bitrate in bits/s. Default value is 200K.

       ab integer (encoding,audio)
           Set audio bitrate (in bits/s). Default value is 128K.

       bt integer (encoding,video)
           Set video bitrate tolerance (in bits/s). In 1-pass mode, bitrate tolerance specifies how far
           ratecontrol is willing to deviate from the target average bitrate value. This is not related to
           min/max bitrate. Lowering tolerance too much has an adverse effect on quality.

       flags flags (decoding/encoding,audio,video,subtitles)
           Set generic flags.

           Possible values:

           mv4 Use four motion vector by macroblock (mpeg4).

           qpel
               Use 1/4 pel motion compensation.

           loop
               Use loop filter.

           qscale
               Use fixed qscale.

           pass1
               Use internal 2pass ratecontrol in first pass mode.

           pass2
               Use internal 2pass ratecontrol in second pass mode.

           gray
               Only decode/encode grayscale.

           psnr
               Set error[?] variables during encoding.

           truncated
               Input bitstream might be randomly truncated.

           drop_changed
               Don't output frames whose parameters differ from first decoded frame in stream.  Error
               AVERROR_INPUT_CHANGED is returned when a frame is dropped.

           ildct
               Use interlaced DCT.

           low_delay
               Force low delay.

           global_header
               Place global headers in extradata instead of every keyframe.

           bitexact
               Only write platform-, build- and time-independent data. (except (I)DCT).  This ensures that file
               and data checksums are reproducible and match between platforms. Its primary use is for
               regression testing.

           aic Apply H263 advanced intra coding / mpeg4 ac prediction.

           ilme
               Apply interlaced motion estimation.

           cgop
               Use closed gop.

           output_corrupt
               Output even potentially corrupted frames.

       time_base rational number
           Set codec time base.

           It is the fundamental unit of time (in seconds) in terms of which frame timestamps are represented.
           For fixed-fps content, timebase should be "1 / frame_rate" and timestamp increments should be
           identically 1.

       g integer (encoding,video)
           Set the group of picture (GOP) size. Default value is 12.

       ar integer (decoding/encoding,audio)
           Set audio sampling rate (in Hz).

       ac integer (decoding/encoding,audio)
           Set number of audio channels.

       cutoff integer (encoding,audio)
           Set cutoff bandwidth. (Supported only by selected encoders, see their respective documentation
           sections.)

       frame_size integer (encoding,audio)
           Set audio frame size.

           Each submitted frame except the last must contain exactly frame_size samples per channel. May be 0
           when the codec has CODEC_CAP_VARIABLE_FRAME_SIZE set, in that case the frame size is not restricted.
           It is set by some decoders to indicate constant frame size.

       frame_number integer
           Set the frame number.

       delay integer
       qcomp float (encoding,video)
           Set video quantizer scale compression (VBR). It is used as a constant in the ratecontrol equation.
           Recommended range for default rc_eq: 0.0-1.0.

       qblur float (encoding,video)
           Set video quantizer scale blur (VBR).

       qmin integer (encoding,video)
           Set min video quantizer scale (VBR). Must be included between -1 and 69, default value is 2.

       qmax integer (encoding,video)
           Set max video quantizer scale (VBR). Must be included between -1 and 1024, default value is 31.

       qdiff integer (encoding,video)
           Set max difference between the quantizer scale (VBR).

       bf integer (encoding,video)
           Set max number of B frames between non-B-frames.

           Must be an integer between -1 and 16. 0 means that B-frames are disabled. If a value of -1 is used,
           it will choose an automatic value depending on the encoder.

           Default value is 0.

       b_qfactor float (encoding,video)
           Set qp factor between P and B frames.

       codec_tag integer
       bug flags (decoding,video)
           Workaround not auto detected encoder bugs.

           Possible values:

           autodetect
           xvid_ilace
               Xvid interlacing bug (autodetected if fourcc==XVIX)

           ump4
               (autodetected if fourcc==UMP4)

           no_padding
               padding bug (autodetected)

           amv
           qpel_chroma
           std_qpel
               old standard qpel (autodetected per fourcc/version)

           qpel_chroma2
           direct_blocksize
               direct-qpel-blocksize bug (autodetected per fourcc/version)

           edge
               edge padding bug (autodetected per fourcc/version)

           hpel_chroma
           dc_clip
           ms  Workaround various bugs in microsoft broken decoders.

           trunc
               trancated frames

       strict integer (decoding/encoding,audio,video)
           Specify how strictly to follow the standards.

           Possible values:

           very
               strictly conform to an older more strict version of the spec or reference software

           strict
               strictly conform to all the things in the spec no matter what consequences

           normal
           unofficial
               allow unofficial extensions

           experimental
               allow non standardized experimental things, experimental (unfinished/work in progress/not well
               tested) decoders and encoders.  Note: experimental decoders can pose a security risk, do not use
               this for decoding untrusted input.

       b_qoffset float (encoding,video)
           Set QP offset between P and B frames.

       err_detect flags (decoding,audio,video)
           Set error detection flags.

           Possible values:

           crccheck
               verify embedded CRCs

           bitstream
               detect bitstream specification deviations

           buffer
               detect improper bitstream length

           explode
               abort decoding on minor error detection

           ignore_err
               ignore decoding errors, and continue decoding.  This is useful if you want to analyze the content
               of a video and thus want everything to be decoded no matter what. This option will not result in
               a video that is pleasing to watch in case of errors.

           careful
               consider things that violate the spec and have not been seen in the wild as errors

           compliant
               consider all spec non compliancies as errors

           aggressive
               consider things that a sane encoder should not do as an error

       has_b_frames integer
       block_align integer
       rc_override_count integer
       maxrate integer (encoding,audio,video)
           Set max bitrate tolerance (in bits/s). Requires bufsize to be set.

       minrate integer (encoding,audio,video)
           Set min bitrate tolerance (in bits/s). Most useful in setting up a CBR encode. It is of little use
           elsewise.

       bufsize integer (encoding,audio,video)
           Set ratecontrol buffer size (in bits).

       i_qfactor float (encoding,video)
           Set QP factor between P and I frames.

       i_qoffset float (encoding,video)
           Set QP offset between P and I frames.

       dct integer (encoding,video)
           Set DCT algorithm.

           Possible values:

           auto
               autoselect a good one (default)

           fastint
               fast integer

           int accurate integer

           mmx
           altivec
           faan
               floating point AAN DCT

       lumi_mask float (encoding,video)
           Compress bright areas stronger than medium ones.

       tcplx_mask float (encoding,video)
           Set temporal complexity masking.

       scplx_mask float (encoding,video)
           Set spatial complexity masking.

       p_mask float (encoding,video)
           Set inter masking.

       dark_mask float (encoding,video)
           Compress dark areas stronger than medium ones.

       idct integer (decoding/encoding,video)
           Select IDCT implementation.

           Possible values:

           auto
           int
           simple
           simplemmx
           simpleauto
               Automatically pick a IDCT compatible with the simple one

           arm
           altivec
           sh4
           simplearm
           simplearmv5te
           simplearmv6
           simpleneon
           xvid
           faani
               floating point AAN IDCT

       slice_count integer
       ec flags (decoding,video)
           Set error concealment strategy.

           Possible values:

           guess_mvs
               iterative motion vector (MV) search (slow)

           deblock
               use strong deblock filter for damaged MBs

           favor_inter
               favor predicting from the previous frame instead of the current

       bits_per_coded_sample integer
       aspect rational number (encoding,video)
           Set sample aspect ratio.

       sar rational number (encoding,video)
           Set sample aspect ratio. Alias to aspect.

       debug flags (decoding/encoding,audio,video,subtitles)
           Print specific debug info.

           Possible values:

           pict
               picture info

           rc  rate control

           bitstream
           mb_type
               macroblock (MB) type

           qp  per-block quantization parameter (QP)

           dct_coeff
           green_metadata
               display complexity metadata for the upcoming frame, GoP or for a given duration.

           skip
           startcode
           er  error recognition

           mmco
               memory management control operations (H.264)

           bugs
           buffers
               picture buffer allocations

           thread_ops
               threading operations

           nomc
               skip motion compensation

       cmp integer (encoding,video)
           Set full pel me compare function.

           Possible values:

           sad sum of absolute differences, fast (default)

           sse sum of squared errors

           satd
               sum of absolute Hadamard transformed differences

           dct sum of absolute DCT transformed differences

           psnr
               sum of squared quantization errors (avoid, low quality)

           bit number of bits needed for the block

           rd  rate distortion optimal, slow

           zero
               0

           vsad
               sum of absolute vertical differences

           vsse
               sum of squared vertical differences

           nsse
               noise preserving sum of squared differences

           w53 5/3 wavelet, only used in snow

           w97 9/7 wavelet, only used in snow

           dctmax
           chroma
       subcmp integer (encoding,video)
           Set sub pel me compare function.

           Possible values:

           sad sum of absolute differences, fast (default)

           sse sum of squared errors

           satd
               sum of absolute Hadamard transformed differences

           dct sum of absolute DCT transformed differences

           psnr
               sum of squared quantization errors (avoid, low quality)

           bit number of bits needed for the block

           rd  rate distortion optimal, slow

           zero
               0

           vsad
               sum of absolute vertical differences

           vsse
               sum of squared vertical differences

           nsse
               noise preserving sum of squared differences

           w53 5/3 wavelet, only used in snow

           w97 9/7 wavelet, only used in snow

           dctmax
           chroma
       mbcmp integer (encoding,video)
           Set macroblock compare function.

           Possible values:

           sad sum of absolute differences, fast (default)

           sse sum of squared errors

           satd
               sum of absolute Hadamard transformed differences

           dct sum of absolute DCT transformed differences

           psnr
               sum of squared quantization errors (avoid, low quality)

           bit number of bits needed for the block

           rd  rate distortion optimal, slow

           zero
               0

           vsad
               sum of absolute vertical differences

           vsse
               sum of squared vertical differences

           nsse
               noise preserving sum of squared differences

           w53 5/3 wavelet, only used in snow

           w97 9/7 wavelet, only used in snow

           dctmax
           chroma
       ildctcmp integer (encoding,video)
           Set interlaced dct compare function.

           Possible values:

           sad sum of absolute differences, fast (default)

           sse sum of squared errors

           satd
               sum of absolute Hadamard transformed differences

           dct sum of absolute DCT transformed differences

           psnr
               sum of squared quantization errors (avoid, low quality)

           bit number of bits needed for the block

           rd  rate distortion optimal, slow

           zero
               0

           vsad
               sum of absolute vertical differences

           vsse
               sum of squared vertical differences

           nsse
               noise preserving sum of squared differences

           w53 5/3 wavelet, only used in snow

           w97 9/7 wavelet, only used in snow

           dctmax
           chroma
       dia_size integer (encoding,video)
           Set diamond type & size for motion estimation.

           (1024, INT_MAX)
               full motion estimation(slowest)

           (768, 1024]
               umh motion estimation

           (512, 768]
               hex motion estimation

           (256, 512]
               l2s diamond motion estimation

           [2,256]
               var diamond motion estimation

           (-1,  2)
               small diamond motion estimation

           -1  funny diamond motion estimation

           (INT_MIN, -1)
               sab diamond motion estimation

       last_pred integer (encoding,video)
           Set amount of motion predictors from the previous frame.

       precmp integer (encoding,video)
           Set pre motion estimation compare function.

           Possible values:

           sad sum of absolute differences, fast (default)

           sse sum of squared errors

           satd
               sum of absolute Hadamard transformed differences

           dct sum of absolute DCT transformed differences

           psnr
               sum of squared quantization errors (avoid, low quality)

           bit number of bits needed for the block

           rd  rate distortion optimal, slow

           zero
               0

           vsad
               sum of absolute vertical differences

           vsse
               sum of squared vertical differences

           nsse
               noise preserving sum of squared differences

           w53 5/3 wavelet, only used in snow

           w97 9/7 wavelet, only used in snow

           dctmax
           chroma
       pre_dia_size integer (encoding,video)
           Set diamond type & size for motion estimation pre-pass.

       subq integer (encoding,video)
           Set sub pel motion estimation quality.

       me_range integer (encoding,video)
           Set limit motion vectors range (1023 for DivX player).

       global_quality integer (encoding,audio,video)
       slice_flags integer
       mbd integer (encoding,video)
           Set macroblock decision algorithm (high quality mode).

           Possible values:

           simple
               use mbcmp (default)

           bits
               use fewest bits

           rd  use best rate distortion

       rc_init_occupancy integer (encoding,video)
           Set number of bits which should be loaded into the rc buffer before decoding starts.

       flags2 flags (decoding/encoding,audio,video,subtitles)
           Possible values:

           fast
               Allow non spec compliant speedup tricks.

           noout
               Skip bitstream encoding.

           ignorecrop
               Ignore cropping information from sps.

           local_header
               Place global headers at every keyframe instead of in extradata.

           chunks
               Frame data might be split into multiple chunks.

           showall
               Show all frames before the first keyframe.

           export_mvs
               Export motion vectors into frame side-data (see "AV_FRAME_DATA_MOTION_VECTORS") for codecs that
               support it. See also doc/examples/export_mvs.c.

           skip_manual
               Do not skip samples and export skip information as frame side data.

           ass_ro_flush_noop
               Do not reset ASS ReadOrder field on flush.

           icc_profiles
               Generate/parse embedded ICC profiles from/to colorimetry tags.

       export_side_data flags (decoding/encoding,audio,video,subtitles)
           Possible values:

           mvs Export motion vectors into frame side-data (see "AV_FRAME_DATA_MOTION_VECTORS") for codecs that
               support it. See also doc/examples/export_mvs.c.

           prft
               Export encoder Producer Reference Time into packet side-data (see "AV_PKT_DATA_PRFT") for codecs
               that support it.

           venc_params
               Export video encoding parameters through frame side data (see "AV_FRAME_DATA_VIDEO_ENC_PARAMS")
               for codecs that support it. At present, those are H.264 and VP9.

           film_grain
               Export film grain parameters through frame side data (see "AV_FRAME_DATA_FILM_GRAIN_PARAMS").
               Supported at present by AV1 decoders.

       threads integer (decoding/encoding,video)
           Set the number of threads to be used, in case the selected codec implementation supports multi-
           threading.

           Possible values:

           auto, 0
               automatically select the number of threads to set

           Default value is auto.

       dc integer (encoding,video)
           Set intra_dc_precision.

       nssew integer (encoding,video)
           Set nsse weight.

       skip_top integer (decoding,video)
           Set number of macroblock rows at the top which are skipped.

       skip_bottom integer (decoding,video)
           Set number of macroblock rows at the bottom which are skipped.

       profile integer (encoding,audio,video)
           Set encoder codec profile. Default value is unknown. Encoder specific profiles are documented in the
           relevant encoder documentation.

       level integer (encoding,audio,video)
           Set the encoder level. This level depends on the specific codec, and might correspond to the profile
           level. It is set by default to unknown.

           Possible values:

           unknown
       lowres integer (decoding,audio,video)
           Decode at 1= 1/2, 2=1/4, 3=1/8 resolutions.

       mblmin integer (encoding,video)
           Set min macroblock lagrange factor (VBR).

       mblmax integer (encoding,video)
           Set max macroblock lagrange factor (VBR).

       skip_loop_filter integer (decoding,video)
       skip_idct        integer (decoding,video)
       skip_frame       integer (decoding,video)
           Make decoder discard processing depending on the frame type selected by the option value.

           skip_loop_filter skips frame loop filtering, skip_idct skips frame IDCT/dequantization, skip_frame
           skips decoding.

           Possible values:

           none
               Discard no frame.

           default
               Discard useless frames like 0-sized frames.

           noref
               Discard all non-reference frames.

           bidir
               Discard all bidirectional frames.

           nokey
               Discard all frames excepts keyframes.

           nointra
               Discard all frames except I frames.

           all Discard all frames.

           Default value is default.

       bidir_refine integer (encoding,video)
           Refine the two motion vectors used in bidirectional macroblocks.

       keyint_min integer (encoding,video)
           Set minimum interval between IDR-frames.

       refs integer (encoding,video)
           Set reference frames to consider for motion compensation.

       trellis integer (encoding,audio,video)
           Set rate-distortion optimal quantization.

       mv0_threshold integer (encoding,video)
       compression_level integer (encoding,audio,video)
       bits_per_raw_sample integer
       channel_layout integer (decoding/encoding,audio)
           See the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for the required syntax.

       rc_max_vbv_use float (encoding,video)
       rc_min_vbv_use float (encoding,video)
       color_primaries integer (decoding/encoding,video)
           Possible values:

           bt709
               BT.709

           bt470m
               BT.470 M

           bt470bg
               BT.470 BG

           smpte170m
               SMPTE 170 M

           smpte240m
               SMPTE 240 M

           film
               Film

           bt2020
               BT.2020

           smpte428
           smpte428_1
               SMPTE ST 428-1

           smpte431
               SMPTE 431-2

           smpte432
               SMPTE 432-1

           jedec-p22
               JEDEC P22

       color_trc integer (decoding/encoding,video)
           Possible values:

           bt709
               BT.709

           gamma22
               BT.470 M

           gamma28
               BT.470 BG

           smpte170m
               SMPTE 170 M

           smpte240m
               SMPTE 240 M

           linear
               Linear

           log
           log100
               Log

           log_sqrt
           log316
               Log square root

           iec61966_2_4
           iec61966-2-4
               IEC 61966-2-4

           bt1361
           bt1361e
               BT.1361

           iec61966_2_1
           iec61966-2-1
               IEC 61966-2-1

           bt2020_10
           bt2020_10bit
               BT.2020 - 10 bit

           bt2020_12
           bt2020_12bit
               BT.2020 - 12 bit

           smpte2084
               SMPTE ST 2084

           smpte428
           smpte428_1
               SMPTE ST 428-1

           arib-std-b67
               ARIB STD-B67

       colorspace integer (decoding/encoding,video)
           Possible values:

           rgb RGB

           bt709
               BT.709

           fcc FCC

           bt470bg
               BT.470 BG

           smpte170m
               SMPTE 170 M

           smpte240m
               SMPTE 240 M

           ycocg
               YCOCG

           bt2020nc
           bt2020_ncl
               BT.2020 NCL

           bt2020c
           bt2020_cl
               BT.2020 CL

           smpte2085
               SMPTE 2085

           chroma-derived-nc
               Chroma-derived NCL

           chroma-derived-c
               Chroma-derived CL

           ictcp
               ICtCp

       color_range integer (decoding/encoding,video)
           If used as input parameter, it serves as a hint to the decoder, which color_range the input has.
           Possible values:

           tv
           mpeg
           limited
               MPEG (219*2^(n-8))

           pc
           jpeg
           full
               JPEG (2^n-1)

       chroma_sample_location integer (decoding/encoding,video)
           Possible values:

           left
           center
           topleft
           top
           bottomleft
           bottom
       log_level_offset integer
           Set the log level offset.

       slices integer (encoding,video)
           Number of slices, used in parallelized encoding.

       thread_type flags (decoding/encoding,video)
           Select which multithreading methods to use.

           Use of frame will increase decoding delay by one frame per thread, so clients which cannot provide
           future frames should not use it.

           Possible values:

           slice
               Decode more than one part of a single frame at once.

               Multithreading using slices works only when the video was encoded with slices.

           frame
               Decode more than one frame at once.

           Default value is slice+frame.

       audio_service_type integer (encoding,audio)
           Set audio service type.

           Possible values:

           ma  Main Audio Service

           ef  Effects

           vi  Visually Impaired

           hi  Hearing Impaired

           di  Dialogue

           co  Commentary

           em  Emergency

           vo  Voice Over

           ka  Karaoke

       request_sample_fmt sample_fmt (decoding,audio)
           Set sample format audio decoders should prefer. Default value is "none".

       pkt_timebase rational number
       sub_charenc encoding (decoding,subtitles)
           Set the input subtitles character encoding.

       field_order  field_order (video)
           Set/override the field order of the video.  Possible values:

           progressive
               Progressive video

           tt  Interlaced video, top field coded and displayed first

           bb  Interlaced video, bottom field coded and displayed first

           tb  Interlaced video, top coded first, bottom displayed first

           bt  Interlaced video, bottom coded first, top displayed first

       skip_alpha bool (decoding,video)
           Set to 1 to disable processing alpha (transparency). This works like the gray flag in the flags
           option which skips chroma information instead of alpha. Default is 0.

       codec_whitelist list (input)
           "," separated list of allowed decoders. By default all are allowed.

       dump_separator string (input)
           Separator used to separate the fields printed on the command line about the Stream parameters.  For
           example, to separate the fields with newlines and indentation:

                   ffprobe -dump_separator "
                                             "  -i ~/videos/matrixbench_mpeg2.mpg

       max_pixels integer (decoding/encoding,video)
           Maximum number of pixels per image. This value can be used to avoid out of memory failures due to
           large images.

       apply_cropping bool (decoding,video)
           Enable cropping if cropping parameters are multiples of the required alignment for the left and top
           parameters. If the alignment is not met the cropping will be partially applied to maintain alignment.
           Default is 1 (enabled).  Note: The required alignment depends on if "AV_CODEC_FLAG_UNALIGNED" is set
           and the CPU. "AV_CODEC_FLAG_UNALIGNED" cannot be changed from the command line. Also hardware
           decoders will not apply left/top Cropping.

DECODERS

       Decoders are configured elements in FFmpeg which allow the decoding of multimedia streams.

       When you configure your FFmpeg build, all the supported native decoders are enabled by default. Decoders
       requiring an external library must be enabled manually via the corresponding "--enable-lib" option. You
       can list all available decoders using the configure option "--list-decoders".

       You can disable all the decoders with the configure option "--disable-decoders" and selectively enable /
       disable single decoders with the options "--enable-decoder=DECODER" / "--disable-decoder=DECODER".

       The option "-decoders" of the ff* tools will display the list of enabled decoders.

VIDEO DECODERS

       A description of some of the currently available video decoders follows.

   av1
       AOMedia Video 1 (AV1) decoder.

       Options

       operating_point
           Select an operating point of a scalable AV1 bitstream (0 - 31). Default is 0.

   rawvideo
       Raw video decoder.

       This decoder decodes rawvideo streams.

       Options

       top top_field_first
           Specify the assumed field type of the input video.

           -1  the video is assumed to be progressive (default)

           0   bottom-field-first is assumed

           1   top-field-first is assumed

   libdav1d
       dav1d AV1 decoder.

       libdav1d allows libavcodec to decode the AOMedia Video 1 (AV1) codec.  Requires the presence of the
       libdav1d headers and library during configuration.  You need to explicitly configure the build with
       "--enable-libdav1d".

       Options

       The following options are supported by the libdav1d wrapper.

       framethreads
           Set amount of frame threads to use during decoding. The default value is 0 (autodetect).  This option
           is deprecated for libdav1d >= 1.0 and will be removed in the future. Use the option "max_frame_delay"
           and the global option "threads" instead.

       tilethreads
           Set amount of tile threads to use during decoding. The default value is 0 (autodetect).  This option
           is deprecated for libdav1d >= 1.0 and will be removed in the future. Use the global option "threads"
           instead.

       max_frame_delay
           Set max amount of frames the decoder may buffer internally. The default value is 0 (autodetect).

       filmgrain
           Apply film grain to the decoded video if present in the bitstream. Defaults to the internal default
           of the library.  This option is deprecated and will be removed in the future. See the global option
           "export_side_data" to export Film Grain parameters instead of applying it.

       oppoint
           Select an operating point of a scalable AV1 bitstream (0 - 31). Defaults to the internal default of
           the library.

       alllayers
           Output all spatial layers of a scalable AV1 bitstream. The default value is false.

   libdavs2
       AVS2-P2/IEEE1857.4 video decoder wrapper.

       This decoder allows libavcodec to decode AVS2 streams with davs2 library.

   libuavs3d
       AVS3-P2/IEEE1857.10 video decoder.

       libuavs3d allows libavcodec to decode AVS3 streams.  Requires the presence of the libuavs3d headers and
       library during configuration.  You need to explicitly configure the build with "--enable-libuavs3d".

       Options

       The following option is supported by the libuavs3d wrapper.

       frame_threads
           Set amount of frame threads to use during decoding. The default value is 0 (autodetect).

   libxevd
       eXtra-fast Essential Video Decoder (XEVD) MPEG-5 EVC decoder wrapper.

       This decoder requires the presence of the libxevd headers and library during configuration. You need to
       explicitly configure the build with --enable-libxevd.

       The xevd project website is at <https://github.com/mpeg5/xevd>.

       Options

       The following options are supported by the libxevd wrapper.  The xevd-equivalent options or values are
       listed in parentheses for easy migration.

       To get a more accurate and extensive documentation of the libxevd options, invoke the command  "xevd_app
       --help" or consult the libxevd documentation.

       threads (threads)
           Force to use a specific number of threads

   QSV Decoders
       The family of Intel QuickSync Video decoders (VC1, MPEG-2, H.264, HEVC, JPEG/MJPEG, VP8, VP9, AV1).

       Common Options

       The following options are supported by all qsv decoders.

       async_depth
           Internal parallelization depth, the higher the value the higher the latency.

       gpu_copy
           A GPU-accelerated copy between video and system memory

           default
           on
           off

       HEVC Options

       Extra options for hevc_qsv.

       load_plugin
           A user plugin to load in an internal session

           none
           hevc_sw
           hevc_hw
       load_plugins
           A :-separate list of hexadecimal plugin UIDs to load in an internal session

   v210
       Uncompressed 4:2:2 10-bit decoder.

       Options

       custom_stride
           Set the line size of the v210 data in bytes. The default value is 0 (autodetect). You can use the
           special -1 value for a strideless v210 as seen in BOXX files.

AUDIO DECODERS

       A description of some of the currently available audio decoders follows.

   ac3
       AC-3 audio decoder.

       This decoder implements part of ATSC A/52:2010 and ETSI TS 102 366, as well as the undocumented RealAudio
       3 (a.k.a. dnet).

       AC-3 Decoder Options

       -drc_scale value
           Dynamic Range Scale Factor. The factor to apply to dynamic range values from the AC-3 stream. This
           factor is applied exponentially. The default value is 1.  There are 3 notable scale factor ranges:

           drc_scale == 0
               DRC disabled. Produces full range audio.

           0 < drc_scale <= 1
               DRC enabled.  Applies a fraction of the stream DRC value.  Audio reproduction is between full
               range and full compression.

           drc_scale > 1
               DRC enabled. Applies drc_scale asymmetrically.  Loud sounds are fully compressed.  Soft sounds
               are enhanced.

   flac
       FLAC audio decoder.

       This decoder aims to implement the complete FLAC specification from Xiph.

       FLAC Decoder options

       -use_buggy_lpc
           The lavc FLAC encoder used to produce buggy streams with high lpc values (like the default value).
           This option makes it possible to decode such streams correctly by using lavc's old buggy lpc logic
           for decoding.

   ffwavesynth
       Internal wave synthesizer.

       This decoder generates wave patterns according to predefined sequences. Its use is purely internal and
       the format of the data it accepts is not publicly documented.

   libcelt
       libcelt decoder wrapper.

       libcelt allows libavcodec to decode the Xiph CELT ultra-low delay audio codec.  Requires the presence of
       the libcelt headers and library during configuration.  You need to explicitly configure the build with
       "--enable-libcelt".

   libgsm
       libgsm decoder wrapper.

       libgsm allows libavcodec to decode the GSM full rate audio codec. Requires the presence of the libgsm
       headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly configure the build with
       "--enable-libgsm".

       This decoder supports both the ordinary GSM and the Microsoft variant.

   libilbc
       libilbc decoder wrapper.

       libilbc allows libavcodec to decode the Internet Low Bitrate Codec (iLBC) audio codec. Requires the
       presence of the libilbc headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly configure the
       build with "--enable-libilbc".

       Options

       The following option is supported by the libilbc wrapper.

       enhance
           Enable the enhancement of the decoded audio when set to 1. The default value is 0 (disabled).

   libopencore-amrnb
       libopencore-amrnb decoder wrapper.

       libopencore-amrnb allows libavcodec to decode the Adaptive Multi-Rate Narrowband audio codec. Using it
       requires the presence of the libopencore-amrnb headers and library during configuration. You need to
       explicitly configure the build with "--enable-libopencore-amrnb".

       An FFmpeg native decoder for AMR-NB exists, so users can decode AMR-NB without this library.

   libopencore-amrwb
       libopencore-amrwb decoder wrapper.

       libopencore-amrwb allows libavcodec to decode the Adaptive Multi-Rate Wideband audio codec. Using it
       requires the presence of the libopencore-amrwb headers and library during configuration. You need to
       explicitly configure the build with "--enable-libopencore-amrwb".

       An FFmpeg native decoder for AMR-WB exists, so users can decode AMR-WB without this library.

   libopus
       libopus decoder wrapper.

       libopus allows libavcodec to decode the Opus Interactive Audio Codec.  Requires the presence of the
       libopus headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly configure the build with
       "--enable-libopus".

       An FFmpeg native decoder for Opus exists, so users can decode Opus without this library.

SUBTITLES DECODERS

   libaribb24
       ARIB STD-B24 caption decoder.

       Implements profiles A and C of the ARIB STD-B24 standard.

       libaribb24 Decoder Options

       -aribb24-base-path path
           Sets the base path for the libaribb24 library. This is utilized for reading of configuration files
           (for custom unicode conversions), and for dumping of non-text symbols as images under that location.

           Unset by default.

       -aribb24-skip-ruby-text boolean
           Tells the decoder wrapper to skip text blocks that contain half-height ruby text.

           Enabled by default.

   libaribcaption
       Yet another ARIB STD-B24 caption decoder using external libaribcaption library.

       Implements profiles A and C of the Japanse ARIB STD-B24 standard, Brazilian ABNT NBR 15606-1, and
       Philippines version of ISDB-T.

       Requires the presence of the libaribcaption headers and library (<https://github.com/xqq/libaribcaption>)
       during configuration.  You need to explicitly configure the build with "--enable-libaribcaption".  If
       both libaribb24 and libaribcaption are enabled, libaribcaption decoder precedes.

       libaribcaption Decoder Options

       -sub_type subtitle_type
           Specifies the format of the decoded subtitles.

           bitmap
               Graphical image.

           ass ASS formatted text.

           text
               Simple text based output without formatting.

           The default is ass as same as libaribb24 decoder.  Some present players (e.g., mpv) expect ASS format
           for ARIB caption.

       -caption_encoding encoding_scheme
           Specifies the encoding scheme of input subtitle text.

           auto
               Automatically detect text encoding (default).

           jis 8bit-char JIS encoding defined in ARIB STD B24.  This encoding used in Japan for ISDB captions.

           utf8
               UTF-8 encoding defined in ARIB STD B24.  This encoding is used in Philippines for ISDB-T
               captions.

           latin
               Latin character encoding defined in ABNT NBR 15606-1.  This encoding is used in South America for
               SBTVD / ISDB-Tb captions.

       -font font_name[,font_name2,...]
           Specify comma-separated list of font family names to be used for bitmap or ass type subtitle
           rendering.  Only first font name is used for ass type subtitle.

           If not specified, use internaly defined default font family.

       -ass_single_rect boolean
           ARIB STD-B24 specifies that some captions may be displayed at different positions at a time (multi-
           rectangle subtitle).  Since some players (e.g., old mpv) can't handle multiple ASS rectangles in a
           single AVSubtitle, or multiple ASS rectangles of indeterminate duration with the same start
           timestamp, this option can change the behavior so that all the texts are displayed in a single ASS
           rectangle.

           The default is false.

           If your player cannot handle AVSubtitles with multiple ASS rectangles properly, set this option to
           true or define ASS_SINGLE_RECT=1 to change default behavior at compilation.

       -force_outline_text boolean
           Specify whether always render outline text for all characters regardless of the indication by
           charactor style.

           The default is false.

       -outline_width number (0.0 - 3.0)
           Specify width for outline text, in dots (relative).

           The default is 1.5.

       -ignore_background boolean
           Specify whether to ignore background color rendering.

           The default is false.

       -ignore_ruby boolean
           Specify whether to ignore rendering for ruby-like (furigana) characters.

           The default is false.

       -replace_drcs boolean
           Specify whether to render replaced DRCS characters as Unicode characters.

           The default is true.

       -replace_msz_ascii boolean
           Specify whether to replace MSZ (Middle Size; half width) fullwidth alphanumerics with halfwidth
           alphanumerics.

           The default is true.

       -replace_msz_japanese boolean
           Specify whether to replace some MSZ (Middle Size; half width) fullwidth japanese special characters
           with halfwidth ones.

           The default is true.

       -replace_msz_glyph boolean
           Specify whether to replace MSZ (Middle Size; half width) characters with halfwidth glyphs if the
           fonts supports it.  This option works under FreeType or DirectWrite renderer with Adobe-Japan1
           compliant fonts.  e.g., IBM Plex Sans JP, Morisawa BIZ UDGothic, Morisawa BIZ UDMincho, Yu Gothic, Yu
           Mincho, and Meiryo.

           The default is true.

       -canvas_size image_size
           Specify the resolution of the canvas to render subtitles to; usually, this should be frame size of
           input video.  This only applies when "-subtitle_type" is set to bitmap.

           The libaribcaption decoder assumes input frame size for bitmap rendering as below:

           1.  PROFILE_A : 1440 x 1080 with SAR (PAR) 4:3

           2.  PROFILE_C : 320 x 180 with SAR (PAR) 1:1

           If actual frame size of input video does not match above assumption, the rendered captions may be
           distorted.  To make the captions undistorted, add "-canvas_size" option to specify actual input video
           size.

           Note that the "-canvas_size" option is not required for video with different size but same aspect
           ratio.  In such cases, the caption will be stretched or shrunk to actual video size if "-canvas_size"
           option is not specified.  If "-canvas_size" option is specified with different size, the caption will
           be stretched or shrunk as specified size with calculated SAR.

       libaribcaption decoder usage examples

       Display MPEG-TS file with ARIB subtitle by "ffplay" tool:

               ffplay -sub_type bitmap MPEG.TS

       Display MPEG-TS file with input frame size 1920x1080 by "ffplay" tool:

               ffplay -sub_type bitmap -canvas_size 1920x1080 MPEG.TS

       Embed ARIB subtitle in transcoded video:

               ffmpeg -sub_type bitmap -i src.m2t -filter_complex "[0:v][0:s]overlay" -vcodec h264 dest.mp4

   dvbsub
       Options

       compute_clut
           -2  Compute clut once if no matching CLUT is in the stream.

           -1  Compute clut if no matching CLUT is in the stream.

           0   Never compute CLUT

           1   Always compute CLUT and override the one provided in the stream.

       dvb_substream
           Selects the dvb substream, or all substreams if -1 which is default.

   dvdsub
       This codec decodes the bitmap subtitles used in DVDs; the same subtitles can also be found in VobSub file
       pairs and in some Matroska files.

       Options

       palette
           Specify the global palette used by the bitmaps. When stored in VobSub, the palette is normally
           specified in the index file; in Matroska, the palette is stored in the codec extra-data in the same
           format as in VobSub. In DVDs, the palette is stored in the IFO file, and therefore not available when
           reading from dumped VOB files.

           The format for this option is a string containing 16 24-bits hexadecimal numbers (without 0x prefix)
           separated by commas, for example "0d00ee, ee450d, 101010, eaeaea, 0ce60b, ec14ed, ebff0b, 0d617a,
           7b7b7b, d1d1d1, 7b2a0e, 0d950c, 0f007b, cf0dec, cfa80c, 7c127b".

       ifo_palette
           Specify the IFO file from which the global palette is obtained.  (experimental)

       forced_subs_only
           Only decode subtitle entries marked as forced. Some titles have forced and non-forced subtitles in
           the same track. Setting this flag to 1 will only keep the forced subtitles. Default value is 0.

   libzvbi-teletext
       Libzvbi allows libavcodec to decode DVB teletext pages and DVB teletext subtitles. Requires the presence
       of the libzvbi headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly configure the build with
       "--enable-libzvbi".

       Options

       txt_page
           List of teletext page numbers to decode. Pages that do not match the specified list are dropped. You
           may use the special "*" string to match all pages, or "subtitle" to match all subtitle pages.
           Default value is *.

       txt_default_region
           Set default character set used for decoding, a value between 0 and 87 (see ETS 300 706, Section 15,
           Table 32). Default value is -1, which does not override the libzvbi default. This option is needed
           for some legacy level 1.0 transmissions which cannot signal the proper charset.

       txt_chop_top
           Discards the top teletext line. Default value is 1.

       txt_format
           Specifies the format of the decoded subtitles.

           bitmap
               The default format, you should use this for teletext pages, because certain graphics and colors
               cannot be expressed in simple text or even ASS.

           text
               Simple text based output without formatting.

           ass Formatted ASS output, subtitle pages and teletext pages are returned in different styles,
               subtitle pages are stripped down to text, but an effort is made to keep the text alignment and
               the formatting.

       txt_left
           X offset of generated bitmaps, default is 0.

       txt_top
           Y offset of generated bitmaps, default is 0.

       txt_chop_spaces
           Chops leading and trailing spaces and removes empty lines from the generated text. This option is
           useful for teletext based subtitles where empty spaces may be present at the start or at the end of
           the lines or empty lines may be present between the subtitle lines because of double-sized teletext
           characters.  Default value is 1.

       txt_duration
           Sets the display duration of the decoded teletext pages or subtitles in milliseconds. Default value
           is -1 which means infinity or until the next subtitle event comes.

       txt_transparent
           Force transparent background of the generated teletext bitmaps. Default value is 0 which means an
           opaque background.

       txt_opacity
           Sets the opacity (0-255) of the teletext background. If txt_transparent is not set, it only affects
           characters between a start box and an end box, typically subtitles. Default value is 0 if
           txt_transparent is set, 255 otherwise.

ENCODERS

       Encoders are configured elements in FFmpeg which allow the encoding of multimedia streams.

       When you configure your FFmpeg build, all the supported native encoders are enabled by default. Encoders
       requiring an external library must be enabled manually via the corresponding "--enable-lib" option. You
       can list all available encoders using the configure option "--list-encoders".

       You can disable all the encoders with the configure option "--disable-encoders" and selectively enable /
       disable single encoders with the options "--enable-encoder=ENCODER" / "--disable-encoder=ENCODER".

       The option "-encoders" of the ff* tools will display the list of enabled encoders.

AUDIO ENCODERS

       A description of some of the currently available audio encoders follows.

   aac
       Advanced Audio Coding (AAC) encoder.

       This encoder is the default AAC encoder, natively implemented into FFmpeg.

       Options

       b   Set bit rate in bits/s. Setting this automatically activates constant bit rate (CBR) mode. If this
           option is unspecified it is set to 128kbps.

       q   Set quality for variable bit rate (VBR) mode. This option is valid only using the ffmpeg command-line
           tool. For library interface users, use global_quality.

       cutoff
           Set cutoff frequency. If unspecified will allow the encoder to dynamically adjust the cutoff to
           improve clarity on low bitrates.

       aac_coder
           Set AAC encoder coding method. Possible values:

           twoloop
               Two loop searching (TLS) method. This is the default method.

               This method first sets quantizers depending on band thresholds and then tries to find an optimal
               combination by adding or subtracting a specific value from all quantizers and adjusting some
               individual quantizer a little.  Will tune itself based on whether aac_is, aac_ms and aac_pns are
               enabled.

           anmr
               Average noise to mask ratio (ANMR) trellis-based solution.

               This is an experimental coder which currently produces a lower quality, is more unstable and is
               slower than the default twoloop coder but has potential.  Currently has no support for the aac_is
               or aac_pns options.  Not currently recommended.

           fast
               Constant quantizer method.

               Uses a cheaper version of twoloop algorithm that doesn't try to do as many clever adjustments.
               Worse with low bitrates (less than 64kbps), but is better and much faster at higher bitrates.

       aac_ms
           Sets mid/side coding mode. The default value of "auto" will automatically use M/S with bands which
           will benefit from such coding. Can be forced for all bands using the value "enable", which is mainly
           useful for debugging or disabled using "disable".

       aac_is
           Sets intensity stereo coding tool usage. By default, it's enabled and will automatically toggle IS
           for similar pairs of stereo bands if it's beneficial.  Can be disabled for debugging by setting the
           value to "disable".

       aac_pns
           Uses perceptual noise substitution to replace low entropy high frequency bands with imperceptible
           white noise during the decoding process. By default, it's enabled, but can be disabled for debugging
           purposes by using "disable".

       aac_tns
           Enables the use of a multitap FIR filter which spans through the high frequency bands to hide
           quantization noise during the encoding process and is reverted by the decoder. As well as decreasing
           unpleasant artifacts in the high range this also reduces the entropy in the high bands and allows for
           more bits to be used by the mid-low bands. By default it's enabled but can be disabled for debugging
           by setting the option to "disable".

       aac_ltp
           Enables the use of the long term prediction extension which increases coding efficiency in very low
           bandwidth situations such as encoding of voice or solo piano music by extending constant harmonic
           peaks in bands throughout frames. This option is implied by profile:a aac_low and is incompatible
           with aac_pred. Use in conjunction with -ar to decrease the samplerate.

       aac_pred
           Enables the use of a more traditional style of prediction where the spectral coefficients transmitted
           are replaced by the difference of the current coefficients minus the previous "predicted"
           coefficients. In theory and sometimes in practice this can improve quality for low to mid bitrate
           audio.  This option implies the aac_main profile and is incompatible with aac_ltp.

       profile
           Sets the encoding profile, possible values:

           aac_low
               The default, AAC "Low-complexity" profile. Is the most compatible and produces decent quality.

           mpeg2_aac_low
               Equivalent to "-profile:a aac_low -aac_pns 0". PNS was introduced with the MPEG4 specifications.

           aac_ltp
               Long term prediction profile, is enabled by and will enable the aac_ltp option. Introduced in
               MPEG4.

           aac_main
               Main-type prediction profile, is enabled by and will enable the aac_pred option. Introduced in
               MPEG2.

           If this option is unspecified it is set to aac_low.

   ac3 and ac3_fixed
       AC-3 audio encoders.

       These encoders implement part of ATSC A/52:2010 and ETSI TS 102 366, as well as the undocumented
       RealAudio 3 (a.k.a. dnet).

       The ac3 encoder uses floating-point math, while the ac3_fixed encoder only uses fixed-point integer math.
       This does not mean that one is always faster, just that one or the other may be better suited to a
       particular system. The ac3_fixed encoder is not the default codec for any of the output formats, so it
       must be specified explicitly using the option "-acodec ac3_fixed" in order to use it.

       AC-3 Metadata

       The AC-3 metadata options are used to set parameters that describe the audio, but in most cases do not
       affect the audio encoding itself. Some of the options do directly affect or influence the decoding and
       playback of the resulting bitstream, while others are just for informational purposes. A few of the
       options will add bits to the output stream that could otherwise be used for audio data, and will thus
       affect the quality of the output. Those will be indicated accordingly with a note in the option list
       below.

       These parameters are described in detail in several publicly-available documents.

       *<<http://www.atsc.org/cms/standards/a_52-2010.pdf>>
       *<<http://www.atsc.org/cms/standards/a_54a_with_corr_1.pdf>>
       *<<http://www.dolby.com/uploadedFiles/zz-_Shared_Assets/English_PDFs/Professional/18_Metadata.Guide.pdf>>
       *<<http://www.dolby.com/uploadedFiles/zz-_Shared_Assets/English_PDFs/Professional/46_DDEncodingGuidelines.pdf>>

       Metadata Control Options

       -per_frame_metadata boolean
           Allow Per-Frame Metadata. Specifies if the encoder should check for changing metadata for each frame.

           0   The metadata values set at initialization will be used for every frame in the stream. (default)

           1   Metadata values can be changed before encoding each frame.

       Downmix Levels

       -center_mixlev level
           Center Mix Level. The amount of gain the decoder should apply to the center channel when downmixing
           to stereo. This field will only be written to the bitstream if a center channel is present. The value
           is specified as a scale factor. There are 3 valid values:

           0.707
               Apply -3dB gain

           0.595
               Apply -4.5dB gain (default)

           0.500
               Apply -6dB gain

       -surround_mixlev level
           Surround Mix Level. The amount of gain the decoder should apply to the surround channel(s) when
           downmixing to stereo. This field will only be written to the bitstream if one or more surround
           channels are present. The value is specified as a scale factor.  There are 3 valid values:

           0.707
               Apply -3dB gain

           0.500
               Apply -6dB gain (default)

           0.000
               Silence Surround Channel(s)

       Audio Production Information

       Audio Production Information is optional information describing the mixing environment.  Either none or
       both of the fields are written to the bitstream.

       -mixing_level number
           Mixing Level. Specifies peak sound pressure level (SPL) in the production environment when the mix
           was mastered. Valid values are 80 to 111, or -1 for unknown or not indicated. The default value is
           -1, but that value cannot be used if the Audio Production Information is written to the bitstream.
           Therefore, if the "room_type" option is not the default value, the "mixing_level" option must not be
           -1.

       -room_type type
           Room Type. Describes the equalization used during the final mixing session at the studio or on the
           dubbing stage. A large room is a dubbing stage with the industry standard X-curve equalization; a
           small room has flat equalization.  This field will not be written to the bitstream if both the
           "mixing_level" option and the "room_type" option have the default values.

           0
           notindicated
               Not Indicated (default)

           1
           large
               Large Room

           2
           small
               Small Room

       Other Metadata Options

       -copyright boolean
           Copyright Indicator. Specifies whether a copyright exists for this audio.

           0
           off No Copyright Exists (default)

           1
           on  Copyright Exists

       -dialnorm value
           Dialogue Normalization. Indicates how far the average dialogue level of the program is below digital
           100% full scale (0 dBFS). This parameter determines a level shift during audio reproduction that sets
           the average volume of the dialogue to a preset level. The goal is to match volume level between
           program sources. A value of -31dB will result in no volume level change, relative to the source
           volume, during audio reproduction. Valid values are whole numbers in the range -31 to -1, with -31
           being the default.

       -dsur_mode mode
           Dolby Surround Mode. Specifies whether the stereo signal uses Dolby Surround (Pro Logic). This field
           will only be written to the bitstream if the audio stream is stereo. Using this option does NOT mean
           the encoder will actually apply Dolby Surround processing.

           0
           notindicated
               Not Indicated (default)

           1
           off Not Dolby Surround Encoded

           2
           on  Dolby Surround Encoded

       -original boolean
           Original Bit Stream Indicator. Specifies whether this audio is from the original source and not a
           copy.

           0
           off Not Original Source

           1
           on  Original Source (default)

       Extended Bitstream Information

       The extended bitstream options are part of the Alternate Bit Stream Syntax as specified in Annex D of the
       A/52:2010 standard. It is grouped into 2 parts.  If any one parameter in a group is specified, all values
       in that group will be written to the bitstream.  Default values are used for those that are written but
       have not been specified.  If the mixing levels are written, the decoder will use these values instead of
       the ones specified in the "center_mixlev" and "surround_mixlev" options if it supports the Alternate Bit
       Stream Syntax.

       Extended Bitstream Information - Part 1

       -dmix_mode mode
           Preferred Stereo Downmix Mode. Allows the user to select either Lt/Rt (Dolby Surround) or Lo/Ro
           (normal stereo) as the preferred stereo downmix mode.

           0
           notindicated
               Not Indicated (default)

           1
           ltrt
               Lt/Rt Downmix Preferred

           2
           loro
               Lo/Ro Downmix Preferred

       -ltrt_cmixlev level
           Lt/Rt Center Mix Level. The amount of gain the decoder should apply to the center channel when
           downmixing to stereo in Lt/Rt mode.

           1.414
               Apply +3dB gain

           1.189
               Apply +1.5dB gain

           1.000
               Apply 0dB gain

           0.841
               Apply -1.5dB gain

           0.707
               Apply -3.0dB gain

           0.595
               Apply -4.5dB gain (default)

           0.500
               Apply -6.0dB gain

           0.000
               Silence Center Channel

       -ltrt_surmixlev level
           Lt/Rt Surround Mix Level. The amount of gain the decoder should apply to the surround channel(s) when
           downmixing to stereo in Lt/Rt mode.

           0.841
               Apply -1.5dB gain

           0.707
               Apply -3.0dB gain

           0.595
               Apply -4.5dB gain

           0.500
               Apply -6.0dB gain (default)

           0.000
               Silence Surround Channel(s)

       -loro_cmixlev level
           Lo/Ro Center Mix Level. The amount of gain the decoder should apply to the center channel when
           downmixing to stereo in Lo/Ro mode.

           1.414
               Apply +3dB gain

           1.189
               Apply +1.5dB gain

           1.000
               Apply 0dB gain

           0.841
               Apply -1.5dB gain

           0.707
               Apply -3.0dB gain

           0.595
               Apply -4.5dB gain (default)

           0.500
               Apply -6.0dB gain

           0.000
               Silence Center Channel

       -loro_surmixlev level
           Lo/Ro Surround Mix Level. The amount of gain the decoder should apply to the surround channel(s) when
           downmixing to stereo in Lo/Ro mode.

           0.841
               Apply -1.5dB gain

           0.707
               Apply -3.0dB gain

           0.595
               Apply -4.5dB gain

           0.500
               Apply -6.0dB gain (default)

           0.000
               Silence Surround Channel(s)

       Extended Bitstream Information - Part 2

       -dsurex_mode mode
           Dolby Surround EX Mode. Indicates whether the stream uses Dolby Surround EX (7.1 matrixed to 5.1).
           Using this option does NOT mean the encoder will actually apply Dolby Surround EX processing.

           0
           notindicated
               Not Indicated (default)

           1
           on  Dolby Surround EX Off

           2
           off Dolby Surround EX On

       -dheadphone_mode mode
           Dolby Headphone Mode. Indicates whether the stream uses Dolby Headphone encoding (multi-channel
           matrixed to 2.0 for use with headphones). Using this option does NOT mean the encoder will actually
           apply Dolby Headphone processing.

           0
           notindicated
               Not Indicated (default)

           1
           on  Dolby Headphone Off

           2
           off Dolby Headphone On

       -ad_conv_type type
           A/D Converter Type. Indicates whether the audio has passed through HDCD A/D conversion.

           0
           standard
               Standard A/D Converter (default)

           1
           hdcd
               HDCD A/D Converter

       Other AC-3 Encoding Options

       -stereo_rematrixing boolean
           Stereo Rematrixing. Enables/Disables use of rematrixing for stereo input. This is an optional AC-3
           feature that increases quality by selectively encoding the left/right channels as mid/side. This
           option is enabled by default, and it is highly recommended that it be left as enabled except for
           testing purposes.

       cutoff frequency
           Set lowpass cutoff frequency. If unspecified, the encoder selects a default determined by various
           other encoding parameters.

       Floating-Point-Only AC-3 Encoding Options

       These options are only valid for the floating-point encoder and do not exist for the fixed-point encoder
       due to the corresponding features not being implemented in fixed-point.

       -channel_coupling boolean
           Enables/Disables use of channel coupling, which is an optional AC-3 feature that increases quality by
           combining high frequency information from multiple channels into a single channel. The per-channel
           high frequency information is sent with less accuracy in both the frequency and time domains. This
           allows more bits to be used for lower frequencies while preserving enough information to reconstruct
           the high frequencies. This option is enabled by default for the floating-point encoder and should
           generally be left as enabled except for testing purposes or to increase encoding speed.

           -1
           auto
               Selected by Encoder (default)

           0
           off Disable Channel Coupling

           1
           on  Enable Channel Coupling

       -cpl_start_band number
           Coupling Start Band. Sets the channel coupling start band, from 1 to 15. If a value higher than the
           bandwidth is used, it will be reduced to 1 less than the coupling end band. If auto is used, the
           start band will be determined by the encoder based on the bit rate, sample rate, and channel layout.
           This option has no effect if channel coupling is disabled.

           -1
           auto
               Selected by Encoder (default)

   flac
       FLAC (Free Lossless Audio Codec) Encoder

       Options

       The following options are supported by FFmpeg's flac encoder.

       compression_level
           Sets the compression level, which chooses defaults for many other options if they are not set
           explicitly. Valid values are from 0 to 12, 5 is the default.

       frame_size
           Sets the size of the frames in samples per channel.

       lpc_coeff_precision
           Sets the LPC coefficient precision, valid values are from 1 to 15, 15 is the default.

       lpc_type
           Sets the first stage LPC algorithm

           none
               LPC is not used

           fixed
               fixed LPC coefficients

           levinson
           cholesky
       lpc_passes
           Number of passes to use for Cholesky factorization during LPC analysis

       min_partition_order
           The minimum partition order

       max_partition_order
           The maximum partition order

       prediction_order_method
           estimation
           2level
           4level
           8level
           search
               Bruteforce search

           log
       ch_mode
           Channel mode

           auto
               The mode is chosen automatically for each frame

           indep
               Channels are independently coded

           left_side
           right_side
           mid_side
       exact_rice_parameters
           Chooses if rice parameters are calculated exactly or approximately.  if set to 1 then they are chosen
           exactly, which slows the code down slightly and improves compression slightly.

       multi_dim_quant
           Multi Dimensional Quantization. If set to 1 then a 2nd stage LPC algorithm is applied after the first
           stage to finetune the coefficients. This is quite slow and slightly improves compression.

   opus
       Opus encoder.

       This is a native FFmpeg encoder for the Opus format. Currently, it's in development and only implements
       the CELT part of the codec. Its quality is usually worse and at best is equal to the libopus encoder.

       Options

       b   Set bit rate in bits/s. If unspecified it uses the number of channels and the layout to make a good
           guess.

       opus_delay
           Sets the maximum delay in milliseconds. Lower delays than 20ms will very quickly decrease quality.

   libfdk_aac
       libfdk-aac AAC (Advanced Audio Coding) encoder wrapper.

       The libfdk-aac library is based on the Fraunhofer FDK AAC code from the Android project.

       Requires the presence of the libfdk-aac headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-libfdk-aac". The library is also incompatible with GPL, so if you
       allow the use of GPL, you should configure with "--enable-gpl --enable-nonfree --enable-libfdk-aac".

       This encoder has support for the AAC-HE profiles.

       VBR encoding, enabled through the vbr or flags +qscale options, is experimental and only works with some
       combinations of parameters.

       Support for encoding 7.1 audio is only available with libfdk-aac 0.1.3 or higher.

       For more information see the fdk-aac project at <http://sourceforge.net/p/opencore-amr/fdk-aac/>.

       Options

       The following options are mapped on the shared FFmpeg codec options.

       b   Set bit rate in bits/s. If the bitrate is not explicitly specified, it is automatically set to a
           suitable value depending on the selected profile.

           In case VBR mode is enabled the option is ignored.

       ar  Set audio sampling rate (in Hz).

       channels
           Set the number of audio channels.

       flags +qscale
           Enable fixed quality, VBR (Variable Bit Rate) mode.  Note that VBR is implicitly enabled when the vbr
           value is positive.

       cutoff
           Set cutoff frequency. If not specified (or explicitly set to 0) it will use a value automatically
           computed by the library. Default value is 0.

       profile
           Set audio profile.

           The following profiles are recognized:

           aac_low
               Low Complexity AAC (LC)

           aac_he
               High Efficiency AAC (HE-AAC)

           aac_he_v2
               High Efficiency AAC version 2 (HE-AACv2)

           aac_ld
               Low Delay AAC (LD)

           aac_eld
               Enhanced Low Delay AAC (ELD)

           If not specified it is set to aac_low.

       The following are private options of the libfdk_aac encoder.

       afterburner
           Enable afterburner feature if set to 1, disabled if set to 0. This improves the quality but also the
           required processing power.

           Default value is 1.

       eld_sbr
           Enable SBR (Spectral Band Replication) for ELD if set to 1, disabled if set to 0.

           Default value is 0.

       eld_v2
           Enable ELDv2 (LD-MPS extension for ELD stereo signals) for ELDv2 if set to 1, disabled if set to 0.

           Note that option is available when fdk-aac version
           (AACENCODER_LIB_VL0.AACENCODER_LIB_VL1.AACENCODER_LIB_VL2) > (4.0.0).

           Default value is 0.

       signaling
           Set SBR/PS signaling style.

           It can assume one of the following values:

           default
               choose signaling implicitly (explicit hierarchical by default, implicit if global header is
               disabled)

           implicit
               implicit backwards compatible signaling

           explicit_sbr
               explicit SBR, implicit PS signaling

           explicit_hierarchical
               explicit hierarchical signaling

           Default value is default.

       latm
           Output LATM/LOAS encapsulated data if set to 1, disabled if set to 0.

           Default value is 0.

       header_period
           Set StreamMuxConfig and PCE repetition period (in frames) for sending in-band configuration buffers
           within LATM/LOAS transport layer.

           Must be a 16-bits non-negative integer.

           Default value is 0.

       vbr Set VBR mode, from 1 to 5. 1 is lowest quality (though still pretty good) and 5 is highest quality. A
           value of 0 will disable VBR, and CBR (Constant Bit Rate) is enabled.

           Currently only the aac_low profile supports VBR encoding.

           VBR modes 1-5 correspond to roughly the following average bit rates:

           1   32 kbps/channel

           2   40 kbps/channel

           3   48-56 kbps/channel

           4   64 kbps/channel

           5   about 80-96 kbps/channel

           Default value is 0.

       frame_length
           Set the audio frame length in samples. Default value is the internal default of the library. Refer to
           the library's documentation for information about supported values.

       Examples

       •   Use ffmpeg to convert an audio file to VBR AAC in an M4A (MP4) container:

                   ffmpeg -i input.wav -codec:a libfdk_aac -vbr 3 output.m4a

       •   Use ffmpeg to convert an audio file to CBR 64k kbps AAC, using the High-Efficiency AAC profile:

                   ffmpeg -i input.wav -c:a libfdk_aac -profile:a aac_he -b:a 64k output.m4a

   libmp3lame
       LAME (Lame Ain't an MP3 Encoder) MP3 encoder wrapper.

       Requires the presence of the libmp3lame headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-libmp3lame".

       See libshine for a fixed-point MP3 encoder, although with a lower quality.

       Options

       The following options are supported by the libmp3lame wrapper. The lame-equivalent of the options are
       listed in parentheses.

       b (-b)
           Set bitrate expressed in bits/s for CBR or ABR. LAME "bitrate" is expressed in kilobits/s.

       q (-V)
           Set constant quality setting for VBR. This option is valid only using the ffmpeg command-line tool.
           For library interface users, use global_quality.

       compression_level (-q)
           Set algorithm quality. Valid arguments are integers in the 0-9 range, with 0 meaning highest quality
           but slowest, and 9 meaning fastest while producing the worst quality.

       cutoff (--lowpass)
           Set lowpass cutoff frequency. If unspecified, the encoder dynamically adjusts the cutoff.

       reservoir
           Enable use of bit reservoir when set to 1. Default value is 1. LAME has this enabled by default, but
           can be overridden by use --nores option.

       joint_stereo (-m j)
           Enable the encoder to use (on a frame by frame basis) either L/R stereo or mid/side stereo. Default
           value is 1.

       abr (--abr)
           Enable the encoder to use ABR when set to 1. The lame --abr sets the target bitrate, while this
           options only tells FFmpeg to use ABR still relies on b to set bitrate.

       copyright (-c)
           Set MPEG audio copyright flag when set to 1. The default value is 0 (disabled).

       original (-o)
           Set MPEG audio original flag when set to 1. The default value is 1 (enabled).

   libopencore-amrnb
       OpenCORE Adaptive Multi-Rate Narrowband encoder.

       Requires the presence of the libopencore-amrnb headers and library during configuration. You need to
       explicitly configure the build with "--enable-libopencore-amrnb --enable-version3".

       This is a mono-only encoder. Officially it only supports 8000Hz sample rate, but you can override it by
       setting strict to unofficial or lower.

       Options

       b   Set bitrate in bits per second. Only the following bitrates are supported, otherwise libavcodec will
           round to the nearest valid bitrate.

           4750
           5150
           5900
           6700
           7400
           7950
           10200
           12200
       dtx Allow discontinuous transmission (generate comfort noise) when set to 1. The default value is 0
           (disabled).

   libopus
       libopus Opus Interactive Audio Codec encoder wrapper.

       Requires the presence of the libopus headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-libopus".

       Option Mapping

       Most libopus options are modelled after the opusenc utility from opus-tools. The following is an option
       mapping chart describing options supported by the libopus wrapper, and their opusenc-equivalent in
       parentheses.

       b (bitrate)
           Set the bit rate in bits/s.  FFmpeg's b option is expressed in bits/s, while opusenc's bitrate in
           kilobits/s.

       vbr (vbr, hard-cbr, and cvbr)
           Set VBR mode. The FFmpeg vbr option has the following valid arguments, with the opusenc equivalent
           options in parentheses:

           off (hard-cbr)
               Use constant bit rate encoding.

           on (vbr)
               Use variable bit rate encoding (the default).

           constrained (cvbr)
               Use constrained variable bit rate encoding.

       compression_level (comp)
           Set encoding algorithm complexity. Valid options are integers in the 0-10 range. 0 gives the fastest
           encodes but lower quality, while 10 gives the highest quality but slowest encoding. The default is
           10.

       frame_duration (framesize)
           Set maximum frame size, or duration of a frame in milliseconds. The argument must be exactly the
           following: 2.5, 5, 10, 20, 40, 60. Smaller frame sizes achieve lower latency but less quality at a
           given bitrate.  Sizes greater than 20ms are only interesting at fairly low bitrates.  The default is
           20ms.

       packet_loss (expect-loss)
           Set expected packet loss percentage. The default is 0.

       fec (n/a)
           Enable inband forward error correction. packet_loss must be non-zero to take advantage - frequency of
           FEC 'side-data' is proportional to expected packet loss.  Default is disabled.

       application (N.A.)
           Set intended application type. Valid options are listed below:

           voip
               Favor improved speech intelligibility.

           audio
               Favor faithfulness to the input (the default).

           lowdelay
               Restrict to only the lowest delay modes by disabling voice-optimized modes.

       cutoff (N.A.)
           Set cutoff bandwidth in Hz. The argument must be exactly one of the following: 4000, 6000, 8000,
           12000, or 20000, corresponding to narrowband, mediumband, wideband, super wideband, and fullband
           respectively. The default is 0 (cutoff disabled). Note that libopus forces a wideband cutoff for
           bitrates < 15 kbps, unless CELT-only (application set to lowdelay) mode is used.

       mapping_family (mapping_family)
           Set channel mapping family to be used by the encoder. The default value of -1 uses mapping family 0
           for mono and stereo inputs, and mapping family 1 otherwise. The default also disables the surround
           masking and LFE bandwidth optimzations in libopus, and requires that the input contains 8 channels or
           fewer.

           Other values include 0 for mono and stereo, 1 for surround sound with masking and LFE bandwidth
           optimizations, and 255 for independent streams with an unspecified channel layout.

       apply_phase_inv (N.A.) (requires libopus >= 1.2)
           If set to 0, disables the use of phase inversion for intensity stereo, improving the quality of mono
           downmixes, but slightly reducing normal stereo quality. The default is 1 (phase inversion enabled).

   libshine
       Shine Fixed-Point MP3 encoder wrapper.

       Shine is a fixed-point MP3 encoder. It has a far better performance on platforms without an FPU, e.g.
       armel CPUs, and some phones and tablets.  However, as it is more targeted on performance than quality, it
       is not on par with LAME and other production-grade encoders quality-wise. Also, according to the
       project's homepage, this encoder may not be free of bugs as the code was written a long time ago and the
       project was dead for at least 5 years.

       This encoder only supports stereo and mono input. This is also CBR-only.

       The original project (last updated in early 2007) is at <http://sourceforge.net/projects/libshine-fxp/>.
       We only support the updated fork by the Savonet/Liquidsoap project at <https://github.com/savonet/shine>.

       Requires the presence of the libshine headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-libshine".

       See also libmp3lame.

       Options

       The following options are supported by the libshine wrapper. The shineenc-equivalent of the options are
       listed in parentheses.

       b (-b)
           Set bitrate expressed in bits/s for CBR. shineenc -b option is expressed in kilobits/s.

   libtwolame
       TwoLAME MP2 encoder wrapper.

       Requires the presence of the libtwolame headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-libtwolame".

       Options

       The following options are supported by the libtwolame wrapper. The twolame-equivalent options follow the
       FFmpeg ones and are in parentheses.

       b (-b)
           Set bitrate expressed in bits/s for CBR. twolame b option is expressed in kilobits/s. Default value
           is 128k.

       q (-V)
           Set quality for experimental VBR support. Maximum value range is from -50 to 50, useful range is from
           -10 to 10. The higher the value, the better the quality. This option is valid only using the ffmpeg
           command-line tool. For library interface users, use global_quality.

       mode (--mode)
           Set the mode of the resulting audio. Possible values:

           auto
               Choose mode automatically based on the input. This is the default.

           stereo
               Stereo

           joint_stereo
               Joint stereo

           dual_channel
               Dual channel

           mono
               Mono

       psymodel (--psyc-mode)
           Set psychoacoustic model to use in encoding. The argument must be an integer between -1 and 4,
           inclusive. The higher the value, the better the quality. The default value is 3.

       energy_levels (--energy)
           Enable energy levels extensions when set to 1. The default value is 0 (disabled).

       error_protection (--protect)
           Enable CRC error protection when set to 1. The default value is 0 (disabled).

       copyright (--copyright)
           Set MPEG audio copyright flag when set to 1. The default value is 0 (disabled).

       original (--original)
           Set MPEG audio original flag when set to 1. The default value is 0 (disabled).

   libvo-amrwbenc
       VisualOn Adaptive Multi-Rate Wideband encoder.

       Requires the presence of the libvo-amrwbenc headers and library during configuration. You need to
       explicitly configure the build with "--enable-libvo-amrwbenc --enable-version3".

       This is a mono-only encoder. Officially it only supports 16000Hz sample rate, but you can override it by
       setting strict to unofficial or lower.

       Options

       b   Set bitrate in bits/s. Only the following bitrates are supported, otherwise libavcodec will round to
           the nearest valid bitrate.

           6600
           8850
           12650
           14250
           15850
           18250
           19850
           23050
           23850
       dtx Allow discontinuous transmission (generate comfort noise) when set to 1. The default value is 0
           (disabled).

   libvorbis
       libvorbis encoder wrapper.

       Requires the presence of the libvorbisenc headers and library during configuration. You need to
       explicitly configure the build with "--enable-libvorbis".

       Options

       The following options are supported by the libvorbis wrapper. The oggenc-equivalent of the options are
       listed in parentheses.

       To get a more accurate and extensive documentation of the libvorbis options, consult the libvorbisenc's
       and oggenc's documentations.  See <http://xiph.org/vorbis/>, <http://wiki.xiph.org/Vorbis-tools>, and
       oggenc(1).

       b (-b)
           Set bitrate expressed in bits/s for ABR. oggenc -b is expressed in kilobits/s.

       q (-q)
           Set constant quality setting for VBR. The value should be a float number in the range of -1.0 to
           10.0. The higher the value, the better the quality. The default value is 3.0.

           This option is valid only using the ffmpeg command-line tool.  For library interface users, use
           global_quality.

       cutoff (--advanced-encode-option lowpass_frequency=N)
           Set cutoff bandwidth in Hz, a value of 0 disables cutoff. oggenc's related option is expressed in
           kHz. The default value is 0 (cutoff disabled).

       minrate (-m)
           Set minimum bitrate expressed in bits/s. oggenc -m is expressed in kilobits/s.

       maxrate (-M)
           Set maximum bitrate expressed in bits/s. oggenc -M is expressed in kilobits/s. This only has effect
           on ABR mode.

       iblock (--advanced-encode-option impulse_noisetune=N)
           Set noise floor bias for impulse blocks. The value is a float number from -15.0 to 0.0. A negative
           bias instructs the encoder to pay special attention to the crispness of transients in the encoded
           audio. The tradeoff for better transient response is a higher bitrate.

   mjpeg
       Motion JPEG encoder.

       Options

       huffman
           Set the huffman encoding strategy. Possible values:

           default
               Use the default huffman tables. This is the default strategy.

           optimal
               Compute and use optimal huffman tables.

   wavpack
       WavPack lossless audio encoder.

       Options

       The equivalent options for wavpack command line utility are listed in parentheses.

       Shared options

       The following shared options are effective for this encoder. Only special notes about this particular
       encoder will be documented here. For the general meaning of the options, see the Codec Options chapter.

       frame_size (--blocksize)
           For this encoder, the range for this option is between 128 and 131072. Default is automatically
           decided based on sample rate and number of channel.

           For the complete formula of calculating default, see libavcodec/wavpackenc.c.

       compression_level (-f, -h, -hh, and -x)

       Private options

       joint_stereo (-j)
           Set whether to enable joint stereo. Valid values are:

           on (1)
               Force mid/side audio encoding.

           off (0)
               Force left/right audio encoding.

           auto
               Let the encoder decide automatically.

       optimize_mono
           Set whether to enable optimization for mono. This option is only effective for non-mono streams.
           Available values:

           on  enabled

           off disabled

VIDEO ENCODERS

       A description of some of the currently available video encoders follows.

   a64_multi, a64_multi5
       A64 / Commodore 64 multicolor charset encoder. "a64_multi5" is extended with 5th color (colram).

   Cinepak
       Cinepak aka CVID encoder.  Compatible with Windows 3.1 and vintage MacOS.

       Options

       g integer
           Keyframe interval.  A keyframe is inserted at least every "-g" frames, sometimes sooner.

       q:v integer
           Quality factor. Lower is better. Higher gives lower bitrate.  The following table lists bitrates when
           encoding akiyo_cif.y4m for various values of "-q:v" with "-g 100":

           "-q:v 1" 1918 kb/s
           "-q:v 2" 1735 kb/s
           "-q:v 4" 1500 kb/s
           "-q:v 10" 1041 kb/s
           "-q:v 20" 826 kb/s
           "-q:v 40" 553 kb/s
           "-q:v 100" 394 kb/s
           "-q:v 200" 312 kb/s
           "-q:v 400" 266 kb/s
           "-q:v 1000" 237 kb/s
       max_extra_cb_iterations integer
           Max extra codebook recalculation passes, more is better and slower.

       skip_empty_cb boolean
           Avoid wasting bytes, ignore vintage MacOS decoder.

       max_strips integer
       min_strips integer
           The minimum and maximum number of strips to use.  Wider range sometimes improves quality.  More
           strips is generally better quality but costs more bits.  Fewer strips tend to yield more keyframes.
           Vintage compatible is 1..3.

       strip_number_adaptivity integer
           How much number of strips is allowed to change between frames.  Higher is better but slower.

   GIF
       GIF image/animation encoder.

       Options

       gifflags integer
           Sets the flags used for GIF encoding.

           offsetting
               Enables picture offsetting.

               Default is enabled.

           transdiff
               Enables transparency detection between frames.

               Default is enabled.

       gifimage integer
           Enables encoding one full GIF image per frame, rather than an animated GIF.

           Default value is 0.

       global_palette integer
           Writes a palette to the global GIF header where feasible.

           If disabled, every frame will always have a palette written, even if there is a global palette
           supplied.

           Default value is 1.

   Hap
       Vidvox Hap video encoder.

       Options

       format integer
           Specifies the Hap format to encode.

           hap
           hap_alpha
           hap_q

           Default value is hap.

       chunks integer
           Specifies the number of chunks to split frames into, between 1 and 64. This permits multithreaded
           decoding of large frames, potentially at the cost of data-rate. The encoder may modify this value to
           divide frames evenly.

           Default value is 1.

       compressor integer
           Specifies the second-stage compressor to use. If set to none, chunks will be limited to 1, as chunked
           uncompressed frames offer no benefit.

           none
           snappy

           Default value is snappy.

   jpeg2000
       The native jpeg 2000 encoder is lossy by default, the "-q:v" option can be used to set the encoding
       quality. Lossless encoding can be selected with "-pred 1".

       Options

       format integer
           Can be set to either "j2k" or "jp2" (the default) that makes it possible to store non-rgb pix_fmts.

       tile_width integer
           Sets tile width. Range is 1 to 1073741824. Default is 256.

       tile_height integer
           Sets tile height. Range is 1 to 1073741824. Default is 256.

       pred integer
           Allows setting the discrete wavelet transform (DWT) type

           dwt97int (Lossy)
           dwt53 (Lossless)

           Default is "dwt97int"

       sop boolean
           Enable this to add SOP marker at the start of each packet. Disabled by default.

       eph boolean
           Enable this to add EPH marker at the end of each packet header. Disabled by default.

       prog integer
           Sets the progression order to be used by the encoder.  Possible values are:

           lrcp
           rlcp
           rpcl
           pcrl
           cprl

           Set to "lrcp" by default.

       layer_rates string
           By default, when this option is not used, compression is done using the quality metric.  This option
           allows for compression using compression ratio. The compression ratio for each level could be
           specified. The compression ratio of a layer "l" species the what ratio of total file size is
           contained in the first "l" layers.

           Example usage:

                   ffmpeg -i input.bmp -c:v jpeg2000 -layer_rates "100,10,1" output.j2k

           This would compress the image to contain 3 layers, where the data contained in the first layer would
           be compressed by 1000 times, compressed by 100 in the first two layers, and shall contain all data
           while using all 3 layers.

   librav1e
       rav1e AV1 encoder wrapper.

       Requires the presence of the rav1e headers and library during configuration.  You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-librav1e".

       Options

       qmax
           Sets the maximum quantizer to use when using bitrate mode.

       qmin
           Sets the minimum quantizer to use when using bitrate mode.

       qp  Uses quantizer mode to encode at the given quantizer (0-255).

       speed
           Selects the speed preset (0-10) to encode with.

       tiles
           Selects how many tiles to encode with.

       tile-rows
           Selects how many rows of tiles to encode with.

       tile-columns
           Selects how many columns of tiles to encode with.

       rav1e-params
           Set rav1e options using a list of key=value pairs separated by ":". See rav1e --help for a list of
           options.

           For example to specify librav1e encoding options with -rav1e-params:

                   ffmpeg -i input -c:v librav1e -b:v 500K -rav1e-params speed=5:low_latency=true output.mp4

   libaom-av1
       libaom AV1 encoder wrapper.

       Requires the presence of the libaom headers and library during configuration.  You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-libaom".

       Options

       The wrapper supports the following standard libavcodec options:

       b   Set bitrate target in bits/second.  By default this will use variable-bitrate mode.  If maxrate and
           minrate are also set to the same value then it will use constant-bitrate mode, otherwise if crf is
           set as well then it will use constrained-quality mode.

       g keyint_min
           Set key frame placement.  The GOP size sets the maximum distance between key frames; if zero the
           output stream will be intra-only.  The minimum distance is ignored unless it is the same as the GOP
           size, in which case key frames will always appear at a fixed interval.  Not set by default, so
           without this option the library has completely free choice about where to place key frames.

       qmin qmax
           Set minimum/maximum quantisation values.  Valid range is from 0 to 63 (warning: this does not match
           the quantiser values actually used by AV1 - divide by four to map real quantiser values to this
           range).  Defaults to min/max (no constraint).

       minrate maxrate bufsize rc_init_occupancy
           Set rate control buffering parameters.  Not used if not set - defaults to unconstrained variable
           bitrate.

       threads
           Set the number of threads to use while encoding.  This may require the tiles or row-mt options to
           also be set to actually use the specified number of threads fully. Defaults to the number of hardware
           threads supported by the host machine.

       profile
           Set the encoding profile.  Defaults to using the profile which matches the bit depth and chroma
           subsampling of the input.

       The wrapper also has some specific options:

       cpu-used
           Set the quality/encoding speed tradeoff.  Valid range is from 0 to 8, higher numbers indicating
           greater speed and lower quality.  The default value is 1, which will be slow and high quality.

       auto-alt-ref
           Enable use of alternate reference frames.  Defaults to the internal default of the library.

       arnr-max-frames (frames)
           Set altref noise reduction max frame count. Default is -1.

       arnr-strength (strength)
           Set altref noise reduction filter strength. Range is -1 to 6. Default is -1.

       aq-mode (aq-mode)
           Set adaptive quantization mode. Possible values:

           none (0)
               Disabled.

           variance (1)
               Variance-based.

           complexity (2)
               Complexity-based.

           cyclic (3)
               Cyclic refresh.

       tune (tune)
           Set the distortion metric the encoder is tuned with. Default is "psnr".

           psnr (0)
           ssim (1)
       lag-in-frames
           Set the maximum number of frames which the encoder may keep in flight at any one time for lookahead
           purposes.  Defaults to the internal default of the library.

       error-resilience
           Enable error resilience features:

           default
               Improve resilience against losses of whole frames.

           Not enabled by default.

       crf Set the quality/size tradeoff for constant-quality (no bitrate target) and constrained-quality (with
           maximum bitrate target) modes. Valid range is 0 to 63, higher numbers indicating lower quality and
           smaller output size.  Only used if set; by default only the bitrate target is used.

       static-thresh
           Set a change threshold on blocks below which they will be skipped by the encoder.  Defined in
           arbitrary units as a nonnegative integer, defaulting to zero (no blocks are skipped).

       drop-threshold
           Set a threshold for dropping frames when close to rate control bounds.  Defined as a percentage of
           the target buffer - when the rate control buffer falls below this percentage, frames will be dropped
           until it has refilled above the threshold.  Defaults to zero (no frames are dropped).

       denoise-noise-level (level)
           Amount of noise to be removed for grain synthesis. Grain synthesis is disabled if this option is not
           set or set to 0.

       denoise-block-size (pixels)
           Block size used for denoising for grain synthesis. If not set, AV1 codec uses the default value of
           32.

       undershoot-pct (pct)
           Set datarate undershoot (min) percentage of the target bitrate. Range is -1 to 100.  Default is -1.

       overshoot-pct (pct)
           Set datarate overshoot (max) percentage of the target bitrate. Range is -1 to 1000.  Default is -1.

       minsection-pct (pct)
           Minimum percentage variation of the GOP bitrate from the target bitrate. If minsection-pct is not
           set, the libaomenc wrapper computes it as follows: "(minrate * 100 / bitrate)".  Range is -1 to 100.
           Default is -1 (unset).

       maxsection-pct (pct)
           Maximum percentage variation of the GOP bitrate from the target bitrate. If maxsection-pct is not
           set, the libaomenc wrapper computes it as follows: "(maxrate * 100 / bitrate)".  Range is -1 to 5000.
           Default is -1 (unset).

       frame-parallel (boolean)
           Enable frame parallel decodability features. Default is true.

       tiles
           Set the number of tiles to encode the input video with, as columns x rows.  Larger numbers allow
           greater parallelism in both encoding and decoding, but may decrease coding efficiency.  Defaults to
           the minimum number of tiles required by the size of the input video (this is 1x1 (that is, a single
           tile) for sizes up to and including 4K).

       tile-columns tile-rows
           Set the number of tiles as log2 of the number of tile rows and columns.  Provided for compatibility
           with libvpx/VP9.

       row-mt (Requires libaom >= 1.0.0-759-g90a15f4f2)
           Enable row based multi-threading. Disabled by default.

       enable-cdef (boolean)
           Enable Constrained Directional Enhancement Filter. The libaom-av1 encoder enables CDEF by default.

       enable-restoration (boolean)
           Enable Loop Restoration Filter. Default is true for libaom-av1.

       enable-global-motion (boolean)
           Enable the use of global motion for block prediction. Default is true.

       enable-intrabc (boolean)
           Enable block copy mode for intra block prediction. This mode is useful for screen content. Default is
           true.

       enable-rect-partitions (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable rectangular partitions. Default is true.

       enable-1to4-partitions (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable 1:4/4:1 partitions. Default is true.

       enable-ab-partitions (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable AB shape partitions. Default is true.

       enable-angle-delta (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable angle delta intra prediction. Default is true.

       enable-cfl-intra (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable chroma predicted from luma intra prediction. Default is true.

       enable-filter-intra (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable filter intra predictor. Default is true.

       enable-intra-edge-filter (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable intra edge filter. Default is true.

       enable-smooth-intra (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable smooth intra prediction mode. Default is true.

       enable-paeth-intra (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable paeth predictor in intra prediction. Default is true.

       enable-palette (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable palette prediction mode. Default is true.

       enable-flip-idtx (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable extended transform type, including FLIPADST_DCT, DCT_FLIPADST, FLIPADST_FLIPADST,
           ADST_FLIPADST, FLIPADST_ADST, IDTX, V_DCT, H_DCT, V_ADST, H_ADST, V_FLIPADST, H_FLIPADST. Default is
           true.

       enable-tx64 (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable 64-pt transform. Default is true.

       reduced-tx-type-set (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Use reduced set of transform types. Default is false.

       use-intra-dct-only (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Use DCT only for INTRA modes. Default is false.

       use-inter-dct-only (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Use DCT only for INTER modes. Default is false.

       use-intra-default-tx-only (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Use Default-transform only for INTRA modes. Default is false.

       enable-ref-frame-mvs (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable temporal mv prediction. Default is true.

       enable-reduced-reference-set (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Use reduced set of single and compound references. Default is false.

       enable-obmc (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable obmc. Default is true.

       enable-dual-filter (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable dual filter. Default is true.

       enable-diff-wtd-comp (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable difference-weighted compound. Default is true.

       enable-dist-wtd-comp (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable distance-weighted compound. Default is true.

       enable-onesided-comp (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable one sided compound. Default is true.

       enable-interinter-wedge (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable interinter wedge compound. Default is true.

       enable-interintra-wedge (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable interintra wedge compound. Default is true.

       enable-masked-comp (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable masked compound. Default is true.

       enable-interintra-comp (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable interintra compound. Default is true.

       enable-smooth-interintra (boolean) (Requires libaom >= v2.0.0)
           Enable smooth interintra mode. Default is true.

       aom-params
           Set libaom options using a list of key=value pairs separated by ":". For a list of supported options,
           see aomenc --help under the section "AV1 Specific Options".

           For example to specify libaom encoding options with -aom-params:

                   ffmpeg -i input -c:v libaom-av1 -b:v 500K -aom-params tune=psnr:enable-tpl-model=1 output.mp4

   libsvtav1
       SVT-AV1 encoder wrapper.

       Requires the presence of the SVT-AV1 headers and library during configuration.  You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-libsvtav1".

       Options

       profile
           Set the encoding profile.

           main
           high
           professional
       level
           Set the operating point level. For example: '4.0'

       hielevel
           Set the Hierarchical prediction levels.

           3level
           4level
               This is the default.

       tier
           Set the operating point tier.

           main
               This is the default.

           high
       qmax
           Set the maximum quantizer to use when using a bitrate mode.

       qmin
           Set the minimum quantizer to use when using a bitrate mode.

       crf Constant rate factor value used in crf rate control mode (0-63).

       qp  Set the quantizer used in cqp rate control mode (0-63).

       sc_detection
           Enable scene change detection.

       la_depth
           Set number of frames to look ahead (0-120).

       preset
           Set the quality-speed tradeoff, in the range 0 to 13.  Higher values are faster but lower quality.

       tile_rows
           Set log2 of the number of rows of tiles to use (0-6).

       tile_columns
           Set log2 of the number of columns of tiles to use (0-4).

       svtav1-params
           Set SVT-AV1 options using a list of key=value pairs separated by ":". See the SVT-AV1 encoder user
           guide for a list of accepted parameters.

   libjxl
       libjxl JPEG XL encoder wrapper.

       Requires the presence of the libjxl headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-libjxl".

       Options

       The libjxl wrapper supports the following options:

       distance
           Set the target Butteraugli distance. This is a quality setting: lower distance yields higher quality,
           with distance=1.0 roughly comparable to libjpeg Quality 90 for photographic content. Setting
           distance=0.0 yields true lossless encoding. Valid values range between 0.0 and 15.0, and sane values
           rarely exceed 5.0. Setting distance=0.1 usually attains transparency for most input. The default is
           1.0.

       effort
           Set the encoding effort used. Higher effort values produce more consistent quality and usually
           produces a better quality/bpp curve, at the cost of more CPU time required. Valid values range from 1
           to 9, and the default is 7.

       modular
           Force the encoder to use Modular mode instead of choosing automatically. The default is to use VarDCT
           for lossy encoding and Modular for lossless. VarDCT is generally superior to Modular for lossy
           encoding but does not support lossless encoding.

   libkvazaar
       Kvazaar H.265/HEVC encoder.

       Requires the presence of the libkvazaar headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly
       configure the build with --enable-libkvazaar.

       Options

       b   Set target video bitrate in bit/s and enable rate control.

       kvazaar-params
           Set kvazaar parameters as a list of name=value pairs separated by commas (,). See kvazaar
           documentation for a list of options.

   libopenh264
       Cisco libopenh264 H.264/MPEG-4 AVC encoder wrapper.

       This encoder requires the presence of the libopenh264 headers and library during configuration. You need
       to explicitly configure the build with "--enable-libopenh264". The library is detected using pkg-config.

       For more information about the library see <http://www.openh264.org>.

       Options

       The following FFmpeg global options affect the configurations of the libopenh264 encoder.

       b   Set the bitrate (as a number of bits per second).

       g   Set the GOP size.

       maxrate
           Set the max bitrate (as a number of bits per second).

       flags +global_header
           Set global header in the bitstream.

       slices
           Set the number of slices, used in parallelized encoding. Default value is 0. This is only used when
           slice_mode is set to fixed.

       loopfilter
           Enable loop filter, if set to 1 (automatically enabled). To disable set a value of 0.

       profile
           Set profile restrictions. If set to the value of main enable CABAC (set the
           "SEncParamExt.iEntropyCodingModeFlag" flag to 1).

       max_nal_size
           Set maximum NAL size in bytes.

       allow_skip_frames
           Allow skipping frames to hit the target bitrate if set to 1.

   libtheora
       libtheora Theora encoder wrapper.

       Requires the presence of the libtheora headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-libtheora".

       For more information about the libtheora project see <http://www.theora.org/>.

       Options

       The following global options are mapped to internal libtheora options which affect the quality and the
       bitrate of the encoded stream.

       b   Set the video bitrate in bit/s for CBR (Constant Bit Rate) mode.  In case VBR (Variable Bit Rate)
           mode is enabled this option is ignored.

       flags
           Used to enable constant quality mode (VBR) encoding through the qscale flag, and to enable the
           "pass1" and "pass2" modes.

       g   Set the GOP size.

       global_quality
           Set the global quality as an integer in lambda units.

           Only relevant when VBR mode is enabled with "flags +qscale". The value is converted to QP units by
           dividing it by "FF_QP2LAMBDA", clipped in the [0 - 10] range, and then multiplied by 6.3 to get a
           value in the native libtheora range [0-63]. A higher value corresponds to a higher quality.

       q   Enable VBR mode when set to a non-negative value, and set constant quality value as a double floating
           point value in QP units.

           The value is clipped in the [0-10] range, and then multiplied by 6.3 to get a value in the native
           libtheora range [0-63].

           This option is valid only using the ffmpeg command-line tool. For library interface users, use
           global_quality.

       Examples

       •   Set maximum constant quality (VBR) encoding with ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -codec:v libtheora -q:v 10 OUTPUT.ogg

       •   Use ffmpeg to convert a CBR 1000 kbps Theora video stream:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -codec:v libtheora -b:v 1000k OUTPUT.ogg

   libvpx
       VP8/VP9 format supported through libvpx.

       Requires the presence of the libvpx headers and library during configuration.  You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-libvpx".

       Options

       The following options are supported by the libvpx wrapper. The vpxenc-equivalent options or values are
       listed in parentheses for easy migration.

       To reduce the duplication of documentation, only the private options and some others requiring special
       attention are documented here. For the documentation of the undocumented generic options, see the Codec
       Options chapter.

       To get more documentation of the libvpx options, invoke the command ffmpeg -h encoder=libvpx, ffmpeg -h
       encoder=libvpx-vp9 or vpxenc --help. Further information is available in the libvpx API documentation.

       b (target-bitrate)
           Set bitrate in bits/s. Note that FFmpeg's b option is expressed in bits/s, while vpxenc's target-
           bitrate is in kilobits/s.

       g (kf-max-dist)
       keyint_min (kf-min-dist)
       qmin (min-q)
           Minimum (Best Quality) Quantizer.

       qmax (max-q)
           Maximum (Worst Quality) Quantizer.  Can be changed per-frame.

       bufsize (buf-sz, buf-optimal-sz)
           Set ratecontrol buffer size (in bits). Note vpxenc's options are specified in milliseconds, the
           libvpx wrapper converts this value as follows: "buf-sz = bufsize * 1000 / bitrate", "buf-optimal-sz =
           bufsize * 1000 / bitrate * 5 / 6".

       rc_init_occupancy (buf-initial-sz)
           Set number of bits which should be loaded into the rc buffer before decoding starts. Note vpxenc's
           option is specified in milliseconds, the libvpx wrapper converts this value as follows:
           "rc_init_occupancy * 1000 / bitrate".

       undershoot-pct
           Set datarate undershoot (min) percentage of the target bitrate.

       overshoot-pct
           Set datarate overshoot (max) percentage of the target bitrate.

       skip_threshold (drop-frame)
       qcomp (bias-pct)
       maxrate (maxsection-pct)
           Set GOP max bitrate in bits/s. Note vpxenc's option is specified as a percentage of the target
           bitrate, the libvpx wrapper converts this value as follows: "(maxrate * 100 / bitrate)".

       minrate (minsection-pct)
           Set GOP min bitrate in bits/s. Note vpxenc's option is specified as a percentage of the target
           bitrate, the libvpx wrapper converts this value as follows: "(minrate * 100 / bitrate)".

       minrate, maxrate, b end-usage=cbr
           "(minrate == maxrate == bitrate)".

       crf (end-usage=cq, cq-level)
       tune (tune)
           psnr (psnr)
           ssim (ssim)
       quality, deadline (deadline)
           best
               Use best quality deadline. Poorly named and quite slow, this option should be avoided as it may
               give worse quality output than good.

           good
               Use good quality deadline. This is a good trade-off between speed and quality when used with the
               cpu-used option.

           realtime
               Use realtime quality deadline.

       speed, cpu-used (cpu-used)
           Set quality/speed ratio modifier. Higher values speed up the encode at the cost of quality.

       nr (noise-sensitivity)
       static-thresh
           Set a change threshold on blocks below which they will be skipped by the encoder.

       slices (token-parts)
           Note that FFmpeg's slices option gives the total number of partitions, while vpxenc's token-parts is
           given as log2(partitions).

       max-intra-rate
           Set maximum I-frame bitrate as a percentage of the target bitrate. A value of 0 means unlimited.

       force_key_frames
           "VPX_EFLAG_FORCE_KF"

       Alternate reference frame related
           auto-alt-ref
               Enable use of alternate reference frames (2-pass only).  Values greater than 1 enable multi-layer
               alternate reference frames (VP9 only).

           arnr-maxframes
               Set altref noise reduction max frame count.

           arnr-type
               Set altref noise reduction filter type: backward, forward, centered.

           arnr-strength
               Set altref noise reduction filter strength.

           rc-lookahead, lag-in-frames (lag-in-frames)
               Set number of frames to look ahead for frametype and ratecontrol.

           min-gf-interval
               Set minimum golden/alternate reference frame interval (VP9 only).

       error-resilient
           Enable error resiliency features.

       sharpness integer
           Increase sharpness at the expense of lower PSNR.  The valid range is [0, 7].

       ts-parameters
           Sets the temporal scalability configuration using a :-separated list of key=value pairs. For example,
           to specify temporal scalability parameters with "ffmpeg":

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:v libvpx -ts-parameters ts_number_layers=3:\
                   ts_target_bitrate=250,500,1000:ts_rate_decimator=4,2,1:\
                   ts_periodicity=4:ts_layer_id=0,2,1,2:ts_layering_mode=3 OUTPUT

           Below is a brief explanation of each of the parameters, please refer to "struct vpx_codec_enc_cfg" in
           "vpx/vpx_encoder.h" for more details.

           ts_number_layers
               Number of temporal coding layers.

           ts_target_bitrate
               Target bitrate for each temporal layer (in kbps).  (bitrate should be inclusive of the lower
               temporal layer).

           ts_rate_decimator
               Frame rate decimation factor for each temporal layer.

           ts_periodicity
               Length of the sequence defining frame temporal layer membership.

           ts_layer_id
               Template defining the membership of frames to temporal layers.

           ts_layering_mode
               (optional) Selecting the temporal structure from a set of pre-defined temporal layering modes.
               Currently supports the following options.

               0   No temporal layering flags are provided internally, relies on flags being passed in using
                   "metadata" field in "AVFrame" with following keys.

                   vp8-flags
                       Sets the flags passed into the encoder to indicate the referencing scheme for the current
                       frame.  Refer to function "vpx_codec_encode" in "vpx/vpx_encoder.h" for more details.

                   temporal_id
                       Explicitly sets the temporal id of the current frame to encode.

               2   Two temporal layers. 0-1...

               3   Three temporal layers. 0-2-1-2...; with single reference frame.

               4   Same as option "3", except there is a dependency between the two temporal layer 2 frames
                   within the temporal period.

       VP8-specific options
           screen-content-mode
               Screen content mode, one of: 0 (off), 1 (screen), 2 (screen with more aggressive rate control).

       VP9-specific options
           lossless
               Enable lossless mode.

           tile-columns
               Set number of tile columns to use. Note this is given as log2(tile_columns). For example, 8 tile
               columns would be requested by setting the tile-columns option to 3.

           tile-rows
               Set number of tile rows to use. Note this is given as log2(tile_rows).  For example, 4 tile rows
               would be requested by setting the tile-rows option to 2.

           frame-parallel
               Enable frame parallel decodability features.

           aq-mode
               Set adaptive quantization mode (0: off (default), 1: variance 2: complexity, 3: cyclic refresh,
               4: equator360).

           colorspace color-space
               Set input color space. The VP9 bitstream supports signaling the following colorspaces:

               rgb sRGB
               bt709 bt709
               unspecified unknown
               bt470bg bt601
               smpte170m smpte170
               smpte240m smpte240
               bt2020_ncl bt2020
           row-mt boolean
               Enable row based multi-threading.

           tune-content
               Set content type: default (0), screen (1), film (2).

           corpus-complexity
               Corpus VBR mode is a variant of standard VBR where the complexity distribution midpoint is passed
               in rather than calculated for a specific clip or chunk.

               The valid range is [0, 10000]. 0 (default) uses standard VBR.

           enable-tpl boolean
               Enable temporal dependency model.

           ref-frame-config
               Using per-frame metadata, set members of the structure "vpx_svc_ref_frame_config_t" in
               "vpx/vp8cx.h" to fine-control referencing schemes and frame buffer management.  Use a :-separated
               list of key=value pairs.  For example,

                       av_dict_set(&av_frame->metadata, "ref-frame-config", \
                       "rfc_update_buffer_slot=7:rfc_lst_fb_idx=0:rfc_gld_fb_idx=1:rfc_alt_fb_idx=2:rfc_reference_last=0:rfc_reference_golden=0:rfc_reference_alt_ref=0");

               rfc_update_buffer_slot
                   Indicates the buffer slot number to update

               rfc_update_last
                   Indicates whether to update the LAST frame

               rfc_update_golden
                   Indicates whether to update GOLDEN frame

               rfc_update_alt_ref
                   Indicates whether to update ALT_REF frame

               rfc_lst_fb_idx
                   LAST frame buffer index

               rfc_gld_fb_idx
                   GOLDEN frame buffer index

               rfc_alt_fb_idx
                   ALT_REF frame buffer index

               rfc_reference_last
                   Indicates whether to reference LAST frame

               rfc_reference_golden
                   Indicates whether to reference GOLDEN frame

               rfc_reference_alt_ref
                   Indicates whether to reference ALT_REF frame

               rfc_reference_duration
                   Indicates frame duration

       For more information about libvpx see: <http://www.webmproject.org/>

   libwebp
       libwebp WebP Image encoder wrapper

       libwebp is Google's official encoder for WebP images. It can encode in either lossy or lossless mode.
       Lossy images are essentially a wrapper around a VP8 frame. Lossless images are a separate codec developed
       by Google.

       Pixel Format

       Currently, libwebp only supports YUV420 for lossy and RGB for lossless due to limitations of the format
       and libwebp. Alpha is supported for either mode.  Because of API limitations, if RGB is passed in when
       encoding lossy or YUV is passed in for encoding lossless, the pixel format will automatically be
       converted using functions from libwebp. This is not ideal and is done only for convenience.

       Options

       -lossless boolean
           Enables/Disables use of lossless mode. Default is 0.

       -compression_level integer
           For lossy, this is a quality/speed tradeoff. Higher values give better quality for a given size at
           the cost of increased encoding time. For lossless, this is a size/speed tradeoff. Higher values give
           smaller size at the cost of increased encoding time. More specifically, it controls the number of
           extra algorithms and compression tools used, and varies the combination of these tools. This maps to
           the method option in libwebp. The valid range is 0 to 6.  Default is 4.

       -quality float
           For lossy encoding, this controls image quality. For lossless encoding, this controls the effort and
           time spent in compression.  Range is 0 to 100. Default is 75.

       -preset type
           Configuration preset. This does some automatic settings based on the general type of the image.

           none
               Do not use a preset.

           default
               Use the encoder default.

           picture
               Digital picture, like portrait, inner shot

           photo
               Outdoor photograph, with natural lighting

           drawing
               Hand or line drawing, with high-contrast details

           icon
               Small-sized colorful images

           text
               Text-like

   libx264, libx264rgb
       x264 H.264/MPEG-4 AVC encoder wrapper.

       This encoder requires the presence of the libx264 headers and library during configuration. You need to
       explicitly configure the build with "--enable-libx264".

       libx264 supports an impressive number of features, including 8x8 and 4x4 adaptive spatial transform,
       adaptive B-frame placement, CAVLC/CABAC entropy coding, interlacing (MBAFF), lossless mode, psy
       optimizations for detail retention (adaptive quantization, psy-RD, psy-trellis).

       Many libx264 encoder options are mapped to FFmpeg global codec options, while unique encoder options are
       provided through private options. Additionally the x264opts and x264-params private options allows one to
       pass a list of key=value tuples as accepted by the libx264 "x264_param_parse" function.

       The x264 project website is at <http://www.videolan.org/developers/x264.html>.

       The libx264rgb encoder is the same as libx264, except it accepts packed RGB pixel formats as input
       instead of YUV.

       Supported Pixel Formats

       x264 supports 8- to 10-bit color spaces. The exact bit depth is controlled at x264's configure time.

       Options

       The following options are supported by the libx264 wrapper. The x264-equivalent options or values are
       listed in parentheses for easy migration.

       To reduce the duplication of documentation, only the private options and some others requiring special
       attention are documented here. For the documentation of the undocumented generic options, see the Codec
       Options chapter.

       To get a more accurate and extensive documentation of the libx264 options, invoke the command x264
       --fullhelp or consult the libx264 documentation.

       In the list below, note that the x264 option name is shown in parentheses after the libavcodec
       corresponding name, in case there is a direct mapping.

       b (bitrate)
           Set bitrate in bits/s. Note that FFmpeg's b option is expressed in bits/s, while x264's bitrate is in
           kilobits/s.

       bf (bframes)
           Number of B-frames between I and P-frames

       g (keyint)
           Maximum GOP size

       qmin (qpmin)
           Minimum quantizer scale

       qmax (qpmax)
           Maximum quantizer scale

       qdiff (qpstep)
           Maximum difference between quantizer scales

       qblur (qblur)
           Quantizer curve blur

       qcomp (qcomp)
           Quantizer curve compression factor

       refs (ref)
           Number of reference frames each P-frame can use. The range is 0-16.

       level (level)
           Set the "x264_param_t.i_level_idc" value in case the value is positive, it is ignored otherwise.

           This value can be set using the "AVCodecContext" API (e.g. by setting the "AVCodecContext" value
           directly), and is specified as an integer mapped on a corresponding level (e.g. the value 31 maps to
           H.264 level IDC "3.1", as defined in the "x264_levels" table). It is ignored when set to a non
           positive value.

           Alternatively it can be set as a private option, overriding the value set in "AVCodecContext", and in
           this case must be specified as the level IDC identifier (e.g. "3.1"), as defined by H.264 Annex A.

       sc_threshold (scenecut)
           Sets the threshold for the scene change detection.

       trellis (trellis)
           Performs Trellis quantization to increase efficiency. Enabled by default.

       nr (nr)
           Noise reduction

       me_range (merange)
           Maximum range of the motion search in pixels.

       me_method (me)
           Set motion estimation method. Possible values in the decreasing order of speed:

           dia (dia)
           epzs (dia)
               Diamond search with radius 1 (fastest). epzs is an alias for dia.

           hex (hex)
               Hexagonal search with radius 2.

           umh (umh)
               Uneven multi-hexagon search.

           esa (esa)
               Exhaustive search.

           tesa (tesa)
               Hadamard exhaustive search (slowest).

       forced-idr
           Normally, when forcing a I-frame type, the encoder can select any type of I-frame. This option forces
           it to choose an IDR-frame.

       subq (subme)
           Sub-pixel motion estimation method.

       b_strategy (b-adapt)
           Adaptive B-frame placement decision algorithm. Use only on first-pass.

       keyint_min (min-keyint)
           Minimum GOP size.

       coder
           Set entropy encoder. Possible values:

           ac  Enable CABAC.

           vlc Enable CAVLC and disable CABAC. It generates the same effect as x264's --no-cabac option.

       cmp Set full pixel motion estimation comparison algorithm. Possible values:

           chroma
               Enable chroma in motion estimation.

           sad Ignore chroma in motion estimation. It generates the same effect as x264's --no-chroma-me option.

       threads (threads)
           Number of encoding threads.

       thread_type
           Set multithreading technique. Possible values:

           slice
               Slice-based multithreading. It generates the same effect as x264's --sliced-threads option.

           frame
               Frame-based multithreading.

       flags
           Set encoding flags. It can be used to disable closed GOP and enable open GOP by setting it to
           "-cgop". The result is similar to the behavior of x264's --open-gop option.

       rc_init_occupancy (vbv-init)
           Initial VBV buffer occupancy

       preset (preset)
           Set the encoding preset.

       tune (tune)
           Set tuning of the encoding params.

       profile (profile)
           Set profile restrictions.

       fastfirstpass
           Enable fast settings when encoding first pass, when set to 1. When set to 0, it has the same effect
           of x264's --slow-firstpass option.

       crf (crf)
           Set the quality for constant quality mode.

       crf_max (crf-max)
           In CRF mode, prevents VBV from lowering quality beyond this point.

       qp (qp)
           Set constant quantization rate control method parameter.

       aq-mode (aq-mode)
           Set AQ method. Possible values:

           none (0)
               Disabled.

           variance (1)
               Variance AQ (complexity mask).

           autovariance (2)
               Auto-variance AQ (experimental).

       aq-strength (aq-strength)
           Set AQ strength, reduce blocking and blurring in flat and textured areas.

       psy Use psychovisual optimizations when set to 1. When set to 0, it has the same effect as x264's
           --no-psy option.

       psy-rd (psy-rd)
           Set strength of psychovisual optimization, in psy-rd:psy-trellis format.

       rc-lookahead (rc-lookahead)
           Set number of frames to look ahead for frametype and ratecontrol.

       weightb
           Enable weighted prediction for B-frames when set to 1. When set to 0, it has the same effect as
           x264's --no-weightb option.

       weightp (weightp)
           Set weighted prediction method for P-frames. Possible values:

           none (0)
               Disabled

           simple (1)
               Enable only weighted refs

           smart (2)
               Enable both weighted refs and duplicates

       ssim (ssim)
           Enable calculation and printing SSIM stats after the encoding.

       intra-refresh (intra-refresh)
           Enable the use of Periodic Intra Refresh instead of IDR frames when set to 1.

       avcintra-class (class)
           Configure the encoder to generate AVC-Intra.  Valid values are 50, 100 and 200

       bluray-compat (bluray-compat)
           Configure the encoder to be compatible with the bluray standard.  It is a shorthand for setting
           "bluray-compat=1 force-cfr=1".

       b-bias (b-bias)
           Set the influence on how often B-frames are used.

       b-pyramid (b-pyramid)
           Set method for keeping of some B-frames as references. Possible values:

           none (none)
               Disabled.

           strict (strict)
               Strictly hierarchical pyramid.

           normal (normal)
               Non-strict (not Blu-ray compatible).

       mixed-refs
           Enable the use of one reference per partition, as opposed to one reference per macroblock when set to
           1. When set to 0, it has the same effect as x264's --no-mixed-refs option.

       8x8dct
           Enable adaptive spatial transform (high profile 8x8 transform) when set to 1. When set to 0, it has
           the same effect as x264's --no-8x8dct option.

       fast-pskip
           Enable early SKIP detection on P-frames when set to 1. When set to 0, it has the same effect as
           x264's --no-fast-pskip option.

       aud (aud)
           Enable use of access unit delimiters when set to 1.

       mbtree
           Enable use macroblock tree ratecontrol when set to 1. When set to 0, it has the same effect as x264's
           --no-mbtree option.

       deblock (deblock)
           Set loop filter parameters, in alpha:beta form.

       cplxblur (cplxblur)
           Set fluctuations reduction in QP (before curve compression).

       partitions (partitions)
           Set partitions to consider as a comma-separated list of values.  Possible values in the list:

           p8x8
               8x8 P-frame partition.

           p4x4
               4x4 P-frame partition.

           b8x8
               4x4 B-frame partition.

           i8x8
               8x8 I-frame partition.

           i4x4
               4x4 I-frame partition.  (Enabling p4x4 requires p8x8 to be enabled. Enabling i8x8 requires
               adaptive spatial transform (8x8dct option) to be enabled.)

           none (none)
               Do not consider any partitions.

           all (all)
               Consider every partition.

       direct-pred (direct)
           Set direct MV prediction mode. Possible values:

           none (none)
               Disable MV prediction.

           spatial (spatial)
               Enable spatial predicting.

           temporal (temporal)
               Enable temporal predicting.

           auto (auto)
               Automatically decided.

       slice-max-size (slice-max-size)
           Set the limit of the size of each slice in bytes. If not specified but RTP payload size (ps) is
           specified, that is used.

       stats (stats)
           Set the file name for multi-pass stats.

       nal-hrd (nal-hrd)
           Set signal HRD information (requires vbv-bufsize to be set).  Possible values:

           none (none)
               Disable HRD information signaling.

           vbr (vbr)
               Variable bit rate.

           cbr (cbr)
               Constant bit rate (not allowed in MP4 container).

       x264opts opts
       x264-params opts
           Override the x264 configuration using a :-separated list of key=value options.

           The argument for both options is a list of key=value couples separated by ":". With x264opts the
           value can be omitted, and the value 1 is assumed in that case.

           For filter and psy-rd options values that use ":" as a separator themselves, use "," instead. They
           accept it as well since long ago but this is kept undocumented for some reason.

           For example, the options might be provided as:

                   level=30:bframes=0:weightp=0:cabac=0:ref=1:vbv-maxrate=768:vbv-bufsize=2000:analyse=all:me=umh:no-fast-pskip=1:subq=6:8x8dct=0:trellis=0

           For example to specify libx264 encoding options with ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i foo.mpg -c:v libx264 -x264opts keyint=123:min-keyint=20 -an out.mkv

           To get the complete list of the libx264 options, invoke the command x264 --fullhelp or consult the
           libx264 documentation.

       a53cc boolean
           Import closed captions (which must be ATSC compatible format) into output.  Only the mpeg2 and h264
           decoders provide these. Default is 1 (on).

       udu_sei boolean
           Import user data unregistered SEI if available into output. Default is 0 (off).

       mb_info boolean
           Set mb_info data through AVFrameSideData, only useful when used from the API. Default is 0 (off).

       Encoding ffpresets for common usages are provided so they can be used with the general presets system
       (e.g. passing the pre option).

   libx265
       x265 H.265/HEVC encoder wrapper.

       This encoder requires the presence of the libx265 headers and library during configuration. You need to
       explicitly configure the build with --enable-libx265.

       Options

       b   Sets target video bitrate.

       bf
       g   Set the GOP size.

       keyint_min
           Minimum GOP size.

       refs
           Number of reference frames each P-frame can use. The range is from 1-16.

       preset
           Set the x265 preset.

       tune
           Set the x265 tune parameter.

       profile
           Set profile restrictions.

       crf Set the quality for constant quality mode.

       qp  Set constant quantization rate control method parameter.

       qmin
           Minimum quantizer scale.

       qmax
           Maximum quantizer scale.

       qdiff
           Maximum difference between quantizer scales.

       qblur
           Quantizer curve blur

       qcomp
           Quantizer curve compression factor

       i_qfactor
       b_qfactor
       forced-idr
           Normally, when forcing a I-frame type, the encoder can select any type of I-frame. This option forces
           it to choose an IDR-frame.

       udu_sei boolean
           Import user data unregistered SEI if available into output. Default is 0 (off).

       x265-params
           Set x265 options using a list of key=value couples separated by ":". See x265 --help for a list of
           options.

           For example to specify libx265 encoding options with -x265-params:

                   ffmpeg -i input -c:v libx265 -x265-params crf=26:psy-rd=1 output.mp4

   libxavs2
       xavs2 AVS2-P2/IEEE1857.4 encoder wrapper.

       This encoder requires the presence of the libxavs2 headers and library during configuration. You need to
       explicitly configure the build with --enable-libxavs2.

       The following standard libavcodec options are used:

       •   b / bit_rateg / gop_sizebf / max_b_frames

       The encoder also has its own specific options:

       Options

       lcu_row_threads
           Set the number of parallel threads for rows from 1 to 8 (default 5).

       initial_qp
           Set the xavs2 quantization parameter from 1 to 63 (default 34). This is used to set the initial qp
           for the first frame.

       qp  Set the xavs2 quantization parameter from 1 to 63 (default 34). This is used to set the qp value
           under constant-QP mode.

       max_qp
           Set the max qp for rate control from 1 to 63 (default 55).

       min_qp
           Set the min qp for rate control from 1 to 63 (default 20).

       speed_level
           Set the Speed level from 0 to 9 (default 0). Higher is better but slower.

       log_level
           Set the log level from -1 to 3 (default 0). -1: none, 0: error, 1: warning, 2: info, 3: debug.

       xavs2-params
           Set xavs2 options using a list of key=value couples separated by ":".

           For example to specify libxavs2 encoding options with -xavs2-params:

                   ffmpeg -i input -c:v libxavs2 -xavs2-params RdoqLevel=0 output.avs2

   libxeve
       eXtra-fast Essential Video Encoder (XEVE) MPEG-5 EVC encoder wrapper.  The xeve-equivalent options or
       values are listed in parentheses for easy migration.

       This encoder requires the presence of the libxeve headers and library during configuration. You need to
       explicitly configure the build with --enable-libxeve.

           Many libxeve encoder options are mapped to FFmpeg global codec options, while unique encoder options
           are provided through private options.  Additionally the xeve-params private options allows one to
           pass a list of key=value tuples as accepted by the libxeve "parse_xeve_params" function.

       The xeve project website is at <https://github.com/mpeg5/xeve>.

       Options

       The following options are supported by the libxeve wrapper.  The xeve-equivalent options or values are
       listed in parentheses for easy migration.

           To reduce the duplication of documentation, only the private options and some others requiring
           special attention are documented here. For the documentation of the undocumented generic options, see
           the Codec Options chapter.

           To get a more accurate and extensive documentation of the libxeve options, invoke the command
           "xeve_app --help" or consult the libxeve documentation.

       b (bitrate)
           Set target video bitrate in bits/s.  Note that FFmpeg's b option is expressed in bits/s, while xeve's
           bitrate is in kilobits/s.

       bf (bframes)
           Set the maximum number of B frames (1,3,7,15).

       g (keyint)
           Set the GOP size (I-picture period).

       preset (preset)
           Set the xeve preset.  Set the encoder preset value to determine encoding speed [fast, medium, slow,
           placebo]

       tune (tune)
           Set the encoder tune parameter [psnr, zerolatency]

       profile (profile)
           Set the encoder profile [0: baseline; 1: main]

       crf (crf)
           Set the quality for constant quality mode.  Constant rate factor <10..49> [default: 32]

       qp (qp)
           Set constant quantization rate control method parameter.  Quantization parameter qp <0..51> [default:
           32]

       threads (threads)
           Force to use a specific number of threads

   libxvid
       Xvid MPEG-4 Part 2 encoder wrapper.

       This encoder requires the presence of the libxvidcore headers and library during configuration. You need
       to explicitly configure the build with "--enable-libxvid --enable-gpl".

       The native "mpeg4" encoder supports the MPEG-4 Part 2 format, so users can encode to this format without
       this library.

       Options

       The following options are supported by the libxvid wrapper. Some of the following options are listed but
       are not documented, and correspond to shared codec options. See the Codec Options chapter for their
       documentation. The other shared options which are not listed have no effect for the libxvid encoder.

       b
       g
       qmin
       qmax
       mpeg_quant
       threads
       bf
       b_qfactor
       b_qoffset
       flags
           Set specific encoding flags. Possible values:

           mv4 Use four motion vector by macroblock.

           aic Enable high quality AC prediction.

           gray
               Only encode grayscale.

           qpel
               Enable quarter-pixel motion compensation.

           cgop
               Enable closed GOP.

           global_header
               Place global headers in extradata instead of every keyframe.

       gmc Enable the use of global motion compensation (GMC).  Default is 0 (disabled).

       me_quality
           Set motion estimation quality level. Possible values in decreasing order of speed and increasing
           order of quality:

           0   Use no motion estimation (default).

           1, 2
               Enable advanced diamond zonal search for 16x16 blocks and half-pixel refinement for 16x16 blocks.

           3, 4
               Enable all of the things described above, plus advanced diamond zonal search for 8x8 blocks and
               half-pixel refinement for 8x8 blocks, also enable motion estimation on chroma planes for P and
               B-frames.

           5, 6
               Enable all of the things described above, plus extended 16x16 and 8x8 blocks search.

       mbd Set macroblock decision algorithm. Possible values in the increasing order of quality:

           simple
               Use macroblock comparing function algorithm (default).

           bits
               Enable rate distortion-based half pixel and quarter pixel refinement for 16x16 blocks.

           rd  Enable all of the things described above, plus rate distortion-based half pixel and quarter pixel
               refinement for 8x8 blocks, and rate distortion-based search using square pattern.

       lumi_aq
           Enable lumi masking adaptive quantization when set to 1. Default is 0 (disabled).

       variance_aq
           Enable variance adaptive quantization when set to 1. Default is 0 (disabled).

           When combined with lumi_aq, the resulting quality will not be better than any of the two specified
           individually. In other words, the resulting quality will be the worse one of the two effects.

       trellis
           Set rate-distortion optimal quantization.

       ssim
           Set structural similarity (SSIM) displaying method. Possible values:

           off Disable displaying of SSIM information.

           avg Output average SSIM at the end of encoding to stdout. The format of showing the average SSIM is:

                       Average SSIM: %f

               For users who are not familiar with C, %f means a float number, or a decimal (e.g. 0.939232).

           frame
               Output both per-frame SSIM data during encoding and average SSIM at the end of encoding to
               stdout. The format of per-frame information is:

                              SSIM: avg: %1.3f min: %1.3f max: %1.3f

               For users who are not familiar with C, %1.3f means a float number rounded to 3 digits after the
               dot (e.g. 0.932).

       ssim_acc
           Set SSIM accuracy. Valid options are integers within the range of 0-4, while 0 gives the most
           accurate result and 4 computes the fastest.

   MediaFoundation
       This provides wrappers to encoders (both audio and video) in the MediaFoundation framework. It can access
       both SW and HW encoders.  Video encoders can take input in either of nv12 or yuv420p form (some encoders
       support both, some support only either - in practice, nv12 is the safer choice, especially among HW
       encoders).

   Microsoft RLE
       Microsoft RLE aka MSRLE encoder.  Only 8-bit palette mode supported.  Compatible with Windows 3.1 and
       Windows 95.

       Options

       g integer
           Keyframe interval.  A keyframe is inserted at least every "-g" frames, sometimes sooner.

   mpeg2
       MPEG-2 video encoder.

       Options

       profile
           Select the mpeg2 profile to encode:

           422
           high
           ss  Spatially Scalable

           snr SNR Scalable

           main
           simple
       level
           Select the mpeg2 level to encode:

           high
           high1440
           main
           low
       seq_disp_ext integer
           Specifies if the encoder should write a sequence_display_extension to the output.

           -1
           auto
               Decide automatically to write it or not (this is the default) by checking if the data to be
               written is different from the default or unspecified values.

           0
           never
               Never write it.

           1
           always
               Always write it.

       video_format integer
           Specifies the video_format written into the sequence display extension indicating the source of the
           video pictures. The default is unspecified, can be component, pal, ntsc, secam or mac.  For maximum
           compatibility, use component.

       a53cc boolean
           Import closed captions (which must be ATSC compatible format) into output.  Default is 1 (on).

   png
       PNG image encoder.

       Private options

       dpi integer
           Set physical density of pixels, in dots per inch, unset by default

       dpm integer
           Set physical density of pixels, in dots per meter, unset by default

   ProRes
       Apple ProRes encoder.

       FFmpeg contains 2 ProRes encoders, the prores-aw and prores-ks encoder.  The used encoder can be chosen
       with the "-vcodec" option.

       Private Options for prores-ks

       profile integer
           Select the ProRes profile to encode

           proxy
           lt
           standard
           hq
           4444
           4444xq
       quant_mat integer
           Select quantization matrix.

           auto
           default
           proxy
           lt
           standard
           hq

           If set to auto, the matrix matching the profile will be picked.  If not set, the matrix providing the
           highest quality, default, will be picked.

       bits_per_mb integer
           How many bits to allot for coding one macroblock. Different profiles use between 200 and 2400 bits
           per macroblock, the maximum is 8000.

       mbs_per_slice integer
           Number of macroblocks in each slice (1-8); the default value (8) should be good in almost all
           situations.

       vendor string
           Override the 4-byte vendor ID.  A custom vendor ID like apl0 would claim the stream was produced by
           the Apple encoder.

       alpha_bits integer
           Specify number of bits for alpha component.  Possible values are 0, 8 and 16.  Use 0 to disable alpha
           plane coding.

       Speed considerations

       In the default mode of operation the encoder has to honor frame constraints (i.e. not produce frames with
       size bigger than requested) while still making output picture as good as possible.  A frame containing a
       lot of small details is harder to compress and the encoder would spend more time searching for
       appropriate quantizers for each slice.

       Setting a higher bits_per_mb limit will improve the speed.

       For the fastest encoding speed set the qscale parameter (4 is the recommended value) and do not set a
       size constraint.

   QSV Encoders
       The family of Intel QuickSync Video encoders (MPEG-2, H.264, HEVC, JPEG/MJPEG, VP9, AV1)

       Ratecontrol Method

       The ratecontrol method is selected as follows:

       •   When global_quality is specified, a quality-based mode is used.  Specifically this means either

           -   CQP - constant quantizer scale, when the qscale codec flag is also set (the -qscale ffmpeg
               option).

           -   LA_ICQ - intelligent constant quality with lookahead, when the look_ahead option is also set.

           -   ICQ -- intelligent constant quality otherwise. For the ICQ modes, global quality range is 1 to
               51, with 1 being the best quality.

       •   Otherwise when the desired average bitrate is specified with the b option, a bitrate-based mode is
           used.

           -   LA - VBR with lookahead, when the look_ahead option is specified.

           -   VCM - video conferencing mode, when the vcm option is set.

           -   CBR - constant bitrate, when maxrate is specified and equal to the average bitrate.

           -   VBR - variable bitrate, when maxrate is specified, but is higher than the average bitrate.

           -   AVBR - average VBR mode, when maxrate is not specified, both avbr_accuracy and avbr_convergence
               are set to non-zero. This mode is available for H264 and HEVC on Windows.

       •   Otherwise the default ratecontrol method CQP is used.

       Note that depending on your system, a different mode than the one you specified may be selected by the
       encoder. Set the verbosity level to verbose or higher to see the actual settings used by the QSV runtime.

       Global Options -> MSDK Options

       Additional libavcodec global options are mapped to MSDK options as follows:

       •   g/gop_size -> GopPicSizebf/max_b_frames+1 -> GopRefDistrc_init_occupancy/rc_initial_buffer_occupancy -> InitialDelayInKBslices -> NumSlicerefs -> NumRefFrameb_strategy/b_frame_strategy -> BRefTypecgop/CLOSED_GOP codec flag -> GopOptFlag

       •   For the CQP mode, the i_qfactor/i_qoffset and b_qfactor/b_qoffset set the difference between QPP and
           QPI, and QPP and QPB respectively.

       •   Setting the coder option to the value vlc will make the H.264 encoder use CAVLC instead of CABAC.

       Common Options

       Following options are used by all qsv encoders.

       async_depth
           Specifies how many asynchronous operations an application performs before the application explicitly
           synchronizes the result. If zero, the value is not specified.

       preset
           This option itemizes a range of choices from veryfast (best speed) to veryslow (best quality).

           veryfast
           faster
           fast
           medium
           slow
           slower
           veryslow
       forced_idr
           Forcing I frames as IDR frames.

       low_power
           For encoders set this flag to ON to reduce power consumption and GPU usage.

       Runtime Options

       Following options can be used durning qsv encoding.

       global_quality
       i_quant_factor
       i_quant_offset
       b_quant_factor
       b_quant_offset
           Supported in h264_qsv and hevc_qsv.  Change these value to reset qsv codec's qp configuration.

       max_frame_size
           Supported in h264_qsv and hevc_qsv.  Change this value to reset qsv codec's MaxFrameSize
           configuration.

       gop_size
           Change this value to reset qsv codec's gop configuration.

       int_ref_type
       int_ref_cycle_size
       int_ref_qp_delta
       int_ref_cycle_dist
           Supported in h264_qsv and hevc_qsv.  Change these value to reset qsv codec's Intra Refresh
           configuration.

       qmax
       qmin
       max_qp_i
       min_qp_i
       max_qp_p
       min_qp_p
       max_qp_b
       min_qp_b
           Supported in h264_qsv.  Change these value to reset qsv codec's max/min qp configuration.

       low_delay_brc
           Supported in h264_qsv, hevc_qsv and av1_qsv.  Change this value to reset qsv codec's low_delay_brc
           configuration.

       framerate
           Change this value to reset qsv codec's framerate configuration.

       bit_rate
       rc_buffer_size
       rc_initial_buffer_occupancy
       rc_max_rate
           Change these value to reset qsv codec's bitrate control configuration.

       pic_timing_sei
           Supported in h264_qsv and hevc_qsv.  Change this value to reset qsv codec's pic_timing_sei
           configuration.

       H264 options

       These options are used by h264_qsv

       extbrc
           Extended bitrate control.

       recovery_point_sei
           Set this flag to insert the recovery point SEI message at the beginning of every intra refresh cycle.

       rdo Enable rate distortion optimization.

       max_frame_size
           Maximum encoded frame size in bytes.

       max_frame_size_i
           Maximum encoded frame size for I frames in bytes. If this value is set as larger than zero, then for
           I frames the value set by max_frame_size is ignored.

       max_frame_size_p
           Maximum encoded frame size for P frames in bytes. If this value is set as larger than zero, then for
           P frames the value set by max_frame_size is ignored.

       max_slice_size
           Maximum encoded slice size in bytes.

       bitrate_limit
           Toggle bitrate limitations.  Modifies bitrate to be in the range imposed by the QSV encoder. Setting
           this flag off may lead to violation of HRD conformance. Mind that specifying bitrate below the QSV
           encoder range might significantly affect quality. If on this option takes effect in non CQP modes: if
           bitrate is not in the range imposed by the QSV encoder, it will be changed to be in the range.

       mbbrc
           Setting this flag enables macroblock level bitrate control that generally improves subjective visual
           quality. Enabling this flag may have negative impact on performance and objective visual quality
           metric.

       low_delay_brc
           Setting this flag turns on or off LowDelayBRC feautre in qsv plugin, which provides more accurate
           bitrate control to minimize the variance of bitstream size frame by frame. Value: -1-default 0-off
           1-on

       adaptive_i
           This flag controls insertion of I frames by the QSV encoder. Turn ON this flag to allow changing of
           frame type from P and B to I.

       adaptive_b
           This flag controls changing of frame type from B to P.

       p_strategy
           Enable P-pyramid: 0-default 1-simple 2-pyramid(bf need to be set to 0).

       b_strategy
           This option controls usage of B frames as reference.

       dblk_idc
           This option disable deblocking. It has value in range 0~2.

       cavlc
           If set, CAVLC is used; if unset, CABAC is used for encoding.

       vcm Video conferencing mode, please see ratecontrol method.

       idr_interval
           Distance (in I-frames) between IDR frames.

       pic_timing_sei
           Insert picture timing SEI with pic_struct_syntax element.

       single_sei_nal_unit
           Put all the SEI messages into one NALU.

       max_dec_frame_buffering
           Maximum number of frames buffered in the DPB.

       look_ahead
           Use VBR algorithm with look ahead.

       look_ahead_depth
           Depth of look ahead in number frames.

       look_ahead_downsampling
           Downscaling factor for the frames saved for the lookahead analysis.

           unknown
           auto
           off
           2x
           4x
       int_ref_type
           Specifies intra refresh type. The major goal of intra refresh is improvement of error resilience
           without significant impact on encoded bitstream size caused by I frames. The SDK encoder achieves
           this by encoding part of each frame in refresh cycle using intra MBs. none means no refresh. vertical
           means vertical refresh, by column of MBs. horizontal means horizontal refresh, by rows of MBs. slice
           means horizontal refresh by slices without overlapping. In case of slice, in_ref_cycle_size is
           ignored. To enable intra refresh, B frame should be set to 0.

       int_ref_cycle_size
           Specifies number of pictures within refresh cycle starting from 2. 0 and 1 are invalid values.

       int_ref_qp_delta
           Specifies QP difference for inserted intra MBs. This is signed value in [-51, 51] range if target
           encoding bit-depth for luma samples is 8 and this range is [-63, 63] for 10 bit-depth or [-75, 75]
           for 12 bit-depth respectively.

       int_ref_cycle_dist
           Distance between the beginnings of the intra-refresh cycles in frames.

       profile
           unknown
           baseline
           main
           high
       a53cc
           Use A53 Closed Captions (if available).

       aud Insert the Access Unit Delimiter NAL.

       mfmode
           Multi-Frame Mode.

           off
           auto
       repeat_pps
           Repeat pps for every frame.

       max_qp_i
           Maximum video quantizer scale for I frame.

       min_qp_i
           Minimum video quantizer scale for I frame.

       max_qp_p
           Maximum video quantizer scale for P frame.

       min_qp_p
           Minimum video quantizer scale for P frame.

       max_qp_b
           Maximum video quantizer scale for B frame.

       min_qp_b
           Minimum video quantizer scale for B frame.

       scenario
           Provides a hint to encoder about the scenario for the encoding session.

           unknown
           displayremoting
           videoconference
           archive
           livestreaming
           cameracapture
           videosurveillance
           gamestreaming
           remotegaming
       avbr_accuracy
           Accuracy of the AVBR ratecontrol (unit of tenth of percent).

       avbr_convergence
           Convergence of the AVBR ratecontrol (unit of 100 frames)

           The parameters avbr_accuracy and avbr_convergence are for the average variable bitrate control (AVBR)
           algorithm.  The algorithm focuses on overall encoding quality while meeting the specified bitrate,
           target_bitrate, within the accuracy range avbr_accuracy, after a avbr_Convergence period. This method
           does not follow HRD and the instant bitrate is not capped or padded.

       skip_frame
           Use per-frame metadata "qsv_skip_frame" to skip frame when encoding. This option defines the usage of
           this metadata.

           no_skip
               Frame skipping is disabled.

           insert_dummy
               Encoder inserts into bitstream frame where all macroblocks are encoded as skipped.

           insert_nothing
               Similar to insert_dummy, but encoder inserts nothing into bitstream. The skipped frames are still
               used in brc. For example, gop still include skipped frames, and the frames after skipped frames
               will be larger in size.

           brc_only
               skip_frame metadata indicates the number of missed frames before the current frame.

       HEVC Options

       These options are used by hevc_qsv

       extbrc
           Extended bitrate control.

       recovery_point_sei
           Set this flag to insert the recovery point SEI message at the beginning of every intra refresh cycle.

       rdo Enable rate distortion optimization.

       max_frame_size
           Maximum encoded frame size in bytes.

       max_frame_size_i
           Maximum encoded frame size for I frames in bytes. If this value is set as larger than zero, then for
           I frames the value set by max_frame_size is ignored.

       max_frame_size_p
           Maximum encoded frame size for P frames in bytes. If this value is set as larger than zero, then for
           P frames the value set by max_frame_size is ignored.

       max_slice_size
           Maximum encoded slice size in bytes.

       mbbrc
           Setting this flag enables macroblock level bitrate control that generally improves subjective visual
           quality. Enabling this flag may have negative impact on performance and objective visual quality
           metric.

       low_delay_brc
           Setting this flag turns on or off LowDelayBRC feautre in qsv plugin, which provides more accurate
           bitrate control to minimize the variance of bitstream size frame by frame. Value: -1-default 0-off
           1-on

       adaptive_i
           This flag controls insertion of I frames by the QSV encoder. Turn ON this flag to allow changing of
           frame type from P and B to I.

       adaptive_b
           This flag controls changing of frame type from B to P.

       p_strategy
           Enable P-pyramid: 0-default 1-simple 2-pyramid(bf need to be set to 0).

       b_strategy
           This option controls usage of B frames as reference.

       dblk_idc
           This option disable deblocking. It has value in range 0~2.

       idr_interval
           Distance (in I-frames) between IDR frames.

           begin_only
               Output an IDR-frame only at the beginning of the stream.

       load_plugin
           A user plugin to load in an internal session.

           none
           hevc_sw
           hevc_hw
       load_plugins
           A :-separate list of hexadecimal plugin UIDs to load in an internal session.

       look_ahead_depth
           Depth of look ahead in number frames, available when extbrc option is enabled.

       profile
           Set the encoding profile (scc requires libmfx >= 1.32).

           unknown
           main
           main10
           mainsp
           rext
           scc
       tier
           Set the encoding tier (only level >= 4 can support high tier).  This option only takes effect when
           the level option is specified.

           main
           high
       gpb 1: GPB (generalized P/B frame)

           0: regular P frame.

       tile_cols
           Number of columns for tiled encoding.

       tile_rows
           Number of rows for tiled encoding.

       aud Insert the Access Unit Delimiter NAL.

       pic_timing_sei
           Insert picture timing SEI with pic_struct_syntax element.

       transform_skip
           Turn this option ON to enable transformskip. It is supported on platform equal or newer than ICL.

       int_ref_type
           Specifies intra refresh type. The major goal of intra refresh is improvement of error resilience
           without significant impact on encoded bitstream size caused by I frames. The SDK encoder achieves
           this by encoding part of each frame in refresh cycle using intra MBs. none means no refresh. vertical
           means vertical refresh, by column of MBs. horizontal means horizontal refresh, by rows of MBs. slice
           means horizontal refresh by slices without overlapping. In case of slice, in_ref_cycle_size is
           ignored. To enable intra refresh, B frame should be set to 0.

       int_ref_cycle_size
           Specifies number of pictures within refresh cycle starting from 2. 0 and 1 are invalid values.

       int_ref_qp_delta
           Specifies QP difference for inserted intra MBs. This is signed value in [-51, 51] range if target
           encoding bit-depth for luma samples is 8 and this range is [-63, 63] for 10 bit-depth or [-75, 75]
           for 12 bit-depth respectively.

       int_ref_cycle_dist
           Distance between the beginnings of the intra-refresh cycles in frames.

       max_qp_i
           Maximum video quantizer scale for I frame.

       min_qp_i
           Minimum video quantizer scale for I frame.

       max_qp_p
           Maximum video quantizer scale for P frame.

       min_qp_p
           Minimum video quantizer scale for P frame.

       max_qp_b
           Maximum video quantizer scale for B frame.

       min_qp_b
           Minimum video quantizer scale for B frame.

       scenario
           Provides a hint to encoder about the scenario for the encoding session.

           unknown
           displayremoting
           videoconference
           archive
           livestreaming
           cameracapture
           videosurveillance
           gamestreaming
           remotegaming
       avbr_accuracy
           Accuracy of the AVBR ratecontrol (unit of tenth of percent).

       avbr_convergence
           Convergence of the AVBR ratecontrol (unit of 100 frames)

           The parameters avbr_accuracy and avbr_convergence are for the average variable bitrate control (AVBR)
           algorithm.  The algorithm focuses on overall encoding quality while meeting the specified bitrate,
           target_bitrate, within the accuracy range avbr_accuracy, after a avbr_Convergence period. This method
           does not follow HRD and the instant bitrate is not capped or padded.

       skip_frame
           Use per-frame metadata "qsv_skip_frame" to skip frame when encoding. This option defines the usage of
           this metadata.

           no_skip
               Frame skipping is disabled.

           insert_dummy
               Encoder inserts into bitstream frame where all macroblocks are encoded as skipped.

           insert_nothing
               Similar to insert_dummy, but encoder inserts nothing into bitstream. The skipped frames are still
               used in brc. For example, gop still include skipped frames, and the frames after skipped frames
               will be larger in size.

           brc_only
               skip_frame metadata indicates the number of missed frames before the current frame.

       MPEG2 Options

       These options are used by mpeg2_qsv

       profile
           unknown
           simple
           main
           high

       VP9 Options

       These options are used by vp9_qsv

       profile
           unknown
           profile0
           profile1
           profile2
           profile3
       tile_cols
           Number of columns for tiled encoding (requires libmfx >= 1.29).

       tile_rows
           Number of rows for tiled encoding (requires libmfx  >= 1.29).

       AV1 Options

       These options are used by av1_qsv (requires libvpl).

       profile
           unknown
           main
       tile_cols
           Number of columns for tiled encoding.

       tile_rows
           Number of rows for tiled encoding.

       adaptive_i
           This flag controls insertion of I frames by the QSV encoder. Turn ON this flag to allow changing of
           frame type from P and B to I.

       adaptive_b
           This flag controls changing of frame type from B to P.

       b_strategy
           This option controls usage of B frames as reference.

       extbrc
           Extended bitrate control.

       look_ahead_depth
           Depth of look ahead in number frames, available when extbrc option is enabled.

       low_delay_brc
           Setting this flag turns on or off LowDelayBRC feautre in qsv plugin, which provides more accurate
           bitrate control to minimize the variance of bitstream size frame by frame. Value: -1-default 0-off
           1-on

       max_frame_size
           Set the allowed max size in bytes for each frame. If the frame size exceeds the limitation, encoder
           will adjust the QP value to control the frame size.  Invalid in CQP rate control mode.

   snow
       Options

       iterative_dia_size
           dia size for the iterative motion estimation

   VAAPI encoders
       Wrappers for hardware encoders accessible via VAAPI.

       These encoders only accept input in VAAPI hardware surfaces.  If you have input in software frames, use
       the hwupload filter to upload them to the GPU.

       The following standard libavcodec options are used:

       •   g / gop_sizebf / max_b_framesprofile

           If not set, this will be determined automatically from the format of the input frames and the
           profiles supported by the driver.

       •   levelb / bit_ratemaxrate / rc_max_ratebufsize / rc_buffer_sizerc_init_occupancy / rc_initial_buffer_occupancycompression_level

           Speed / quality tradeoff: higher values are faster / worse quality.

       •   q / global_quality

           Size / quality tradeoff: higher values are smaller / worse quality.

       •   qminqmaxi_qfactor / i_quant_factori_qoffset / i_quant_offsetb_qfactor / b_quant_factorb_qoffset / b_quant_offsetslices

       All encoders support the following options:

       low_power
           Some drivers/platforms offer a second encoder for some codecs intended to use less power than the
           default encoder; setting this option will attempt to use that encoder.  Note that it may support a
           reduced feature set, so some other options may not be available in this mode.

       idr_interval
           Set the number of normal intra frames between full-refresh (IDR) frames in open-GOP mode.  The intra
           frames are still IRAPs, but will not include global headers and may have non-decodable leading
           pictures.

       b_depth
           Set the B-frame reference depth.  When set to one (the default), all B-frames will refer only to P-
           or I-frames.  When set to greater values multiple layers of B-frames will be present, frames in each
           layer only referring to frames in higher layers.

       async_depth
           Maximum processing parallelism. Increase this to improve single channel performance. This option
           doesn't work if driver doesn't implement vaSyncBuffer function. Please make sure there are enough
           hw_frames allocated if a large number of async_depth is used.

       max_frame_size
           Set the allowed max size in bytes for each frame. If the frame size exceeds the limitation, encoder
           will adjust the QP value to control the frame size.  Invalid in CQP rate control mode.

       rc_mode
           Set the rate control mode to use.  A given driver may only support a subset of modes.

           Possible modes:

           auto
               Choose the mode automatically based on driver support and the other options.  This is the
               default.

           CQP Constant-quality.

           CBR Constant-bitrate.

           VBR Variable-bitrate.

           ICQ Intelligent constant-quality.

           QVBR
               Quality-defined variable-bitrate.

           AVBR
               Average variable bitrate.

       blbrc
           Enable block level rate control, which assigns different bitrate block by block.  Invalid for CQP
           mode.

       Each encoder also has its own specific options:

       av1_vaapi
           profile sets the value of seq_profile.  tier sets the value of seq_tier.  level sets the value of
           seq_level_idx.

           tiles
               Set the number of tiles to encode the input video with, as columns x rows.  (default is auto,
               which means use minimal tile column/row number).

           tile_groups
               Set tile groups number. All the tiles will be distributed as evenly as possible to each tile
               group. (default is 1).

       h264_vaapi
           profile sets the value of profile_idc and the constraint_set*_flags.  level sets the value of
           level_idc.

           coder
               Set entropy encoder (default is cabac).  Possible values:

               ac
               cabac
                   Use CABAC.

               vlc
               cavlc
                   Use CAVLC.

           aud Include access unit delimiters in the stream (not included by default).

           sei Set SEI message types to include.  Some combination of the following values:

               identifier
                   Include a user_data_unregistered message containing information about the encoder.

               timing
                   Include picture timing parameters (buffering_period and pic_timing messages).

               recovery_point
                   Include recovery points where appropriate (recovery_point messages).

       hevc_vaapi
           profile and level set the values of general_profile_idc and general_level_idc respectively.

           aud Include access unit delimiters in the stream (not included by default).

           tier
               Set general_tier_flag.  This may affect the level chosen for the stream if it is not explicitly
               specified.

           sei Set SEI message types to include.  Some combination of the following values:

               hdr Include HDR metadata if the input frames have it (mastering_display_colour_volume and
                   content_light_level messages).

           tiles
               Set the number of tiles to encode the input video with, as columns x rows.  Larger numbers allow
               greater parallelism in both encoding and decoding, but may decrease coding efficiency.

       mjpeg_vaapi
           Only baseline DCT encoding is supported.  The encoder always uses the standard quantisation and
           huffman tables - global_quality scales the standard quantisation table (range 1-100).

           For YUV, 4:2:0, 4:2:2 and 4:4:4 subsampling modes are supported.  RGB is also supported, and will
           create an RGB JPEG.

           jfif
               Include JFIF header in each frame (not included by default).

           huffman
               Include standard huffman tables (on by default).  Turning this off will save a few hundred bytes
               in each output frame, but may lose compatibility with some JPEG decoders which don't fully handle
               MJPEG.

       mpeg2_vaapi
           profile and level set the value of profile_and_level_indication.

       vp8_vaapi
           B-frames are not supported.

           global_quality sets the q_idx used for non-key frames (range 0-127).

           loop_filter_level
           loop_filter_sharpness
               Manually set the loop filter parameters.

       vp9_vaapi
           global_quality sets the q_idx used for P-frames (range 0-255).

           loop_filter_level
           loop_filter_sharpness
               Manually set the loop filter parameters.

           B-frames are supported, but the output stream is always in encode order rather than display order.
           If B-frames are enabled, it may be necessary to use the vp9_raw_reorder bitstream filter to modify
           the output stream to display frames in the correct order.

           Only normal frames are produced - the vp9_superframe bitstream filter may be required to produce a
           stream usable with all decoders.

   vbn
       Vizrt Binary Image encoder.

       This format is used by the broadcast vendor Vizrt for quick texture streaming.  Advanced features of the
       format such as LZW compression of texture data or generation of mipmaps are not supported.

       Options

       format string
           Sets the texture compression used by the VBN file. Can be dxt1, dxt5 or raw. Default is dxt5.

   vc2
       SMPTE VC-2 (previously BBC Dirac Pro). This codec was primarily aimed at professional broadcasting but
       since it supports yuv420, yuv422 and yuv444 at 8 (limited range or full range), 10 or 12 bits, this makes
       it suitable for other tasks which require low overhead and low compression (like screen recording).

       Options

       b   Sets target video bitrate. Usually that's around 1:6 of the uncompressed video bitrate (e.g. for
           1920x1080 50fps yuv422p10 that's around 400Mbps). Higher values (close to the uncompressed bitrate)
           turn on lossless compression mode.

       field_order
           Enables field coding when set (e.g. to tt - top field first) for interlaced inputs. Should increase
           compression with interlaced content as it splits the fields and encodes each separately.

       wavelet_depth
           Sets the total amount of wavelet transforms to apply, between 1 and 5 (default).  Lower values reduce
           compression and quality. Less capable decoders may not be able to handle values of wavelet_depth over
           3.

       wavelet_type
           Sets the transform type. Currently only 5_3 (LeGall) and 9_7 (Deslauriers-Dubuc) are implemented,
           with 9_7 being the one with better compression and thus is the default.

       slice_width
       slice_height
           Sets the slice size for each slice. Larger values result in better compression.  For compatibility
           with other more limited decoders use slice_width of 32 and slice_height of 8.

       tolerance
           Sets the undershoot tolerance of the rate control system in percent. This is to prevent an expensive
           search from being run.

       qm  Sets the quantization matrix preset to use by default or when wavelet_depth is set to 5

           -   default Uses the default quantization matrix from the specifications, extended with values for
               the fifth level. This provides a good balance between keeping detail and omitting artifacts.

           -   flat Use a completely zeroed out quantization matrix. This increases PSNR but might reduce
               perception. Use in bogus benchmarks.

           -   color Reduces detail but attempts to preserve color at extremely low bitrates.

SUBTITLES ENCODERS

   dvdsub
       This codec encodes the bitmap subtitle format that is used in DVDs.  Typically they are stored in VOBSUB
       file pairs (*.idx + *.sub), and they can also be used in Matroska files.

       Options

       palette
           Specify the global palette used by the bitmaps.

           The format for this option is a string containing 16 24-bits hexadecimal numbers (without 0x prefix)
           separated by commas, for example "0d00ee, ee450d, 101010, eaeaea, 0ce60b, ec14ed, ebff0b, 0d617a,
           7b7b7b, d1d1d1, 7b2a0e, 0d950c, 0f007b, cf0dec, cfa80c, 7c127b".

       even_rows_fix
           When set to 1, enable a work-around that makes the number of pixel rows even in all subtitles.  This
           fixes a problem with some players that cut off the bottom row if the number is odd.  The work-around
           just adds a fully transparent row if needed.  The overhead is low, typically one byte per subtitle on
           average.

           By default, this work-around is disabled.

BITSTREAM FILTERS

       When you configure your FFmpeg build, all the supported bitstream filters are enabled by default. You can
       list all available ones using the configure option "--list-bsfs".

       You can disable all the bitstream filters using the configure option "--disable-bsfs", and selectively
       enable any bitstream filter using the option "--enable-bsf=BSF", or you can disable a particular
       bitstream filter using the option "--disable-bsf=BSF".

       The option "-bsfs" of the ff* tools will display the list of all the supported bitstream filters included
       in your build.

       The ff* tools have a -bsf option applied per stream, taking a comma-separated list of filters, whose
       parameters follow the filter name after a '='.

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:v copy -bsf:v filter1[=opt1=str1:opt2=str2][,filter2] OUTPUT

       Below is a description of the currently available bitstream filters, with their parameters, if any.

   aac_adtstoasc
       Convert MPEG-2/4 AAC ADTS to an MPEG-4 Audio Specific Configuration bitstream.

       This filter creates an MPEG-4 AudioSpecificConfig from an MPEG-2/4 ADTS header and removes the ADTS
       header.

       This filter is required for example when copying an AAC stream from a raw ADTS AAC or an MPEG-TS
       container to MP4A-LATM, to an FLV file, or to MOV/MP4 files and related formats such as 3GP or M4A.
       Please note that it is auto-inserted for MP4A-LATM and MOV/MP4 and related formats.

   av1_metadata
       Modify metadata embedded in an AV1 stream.

       td  Insert or remove temporal delimiter OBUs in all temporal units of the stream.

           insert
               Insert a TD at the beginning of every TU which does not already have one.

           remove
               Remove the TD from the beginning of every TU which has one.

       color_primaries
       transfer_characteristics
       matrix_coefficients
           Set the color description fields in the stream (see AV1 section 6.4.2).

       color_range
           Set the color range in the stream (see AV1 section 6.4.2; note that this cannot be set for streams
           using BT.709 primaries, sRGB transfer characteristic and identity (RGB) matrix coefficients).

           tv  Limited range.

           pc  Full range.

       chroma_sample_position
           Set the chroma sample location in the stream (see AV1 section 6.4.2).  This can only be set for 4:2:0
           streams.

           vertical
               Left position (matching the default in MPEG-2 and H.264).

           colocated
               Top-left position.

       tick_rate
           Set the tick rate (time_scale / num_units_in_display_tick) in the timing info in the sequence header.

       num_ticks_per_picture
           Set the number of ticks in each picture, to indicate that the stream has a fixed framerate.  Ignored
           if tick_rate is not also set.

       delete_padding
           Deletes Padding OBUs.

   chomp
       Remove zero padding at the end of a packet.

   dca_core
       Extract the core from a DCA/DTS stream, dropping extensions such as DTS-HD.

   dump_extra
       Add extradata to the beginning of the filtered packets except when said packets already exactly begin
       with the extradata that is intended to be added.

       freq
           The additional argument specifies which packets should be filtered.  It accepts the values:

           k
           keyframe
               add extradata to all key packets

           e
           all add extradata to all packets

       If not specified it is assumed k.

       For example the following ffmpeg command forces a global header (thus disabling individual packet
       headers) in the H.264 packets generated by the "libx264" encoder, but corrects them by adding the header
       stored in extradata to the key packets:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -map 0 -flags:v +global_header -c:v libx264 -bsf:v dump_extra out.ts

   dv_error_marker
       Blocks in DV which are marked as damaged are replaced by blocks of the specified color.

       color
           The color to replace damaged blocks by

       sta A 16 bit mask which specifies which of the 16 possible error status values are to be replaced by
           colored blocks. 0xFFFE is the default which replaces all non 0 error status values.

           ok  No error, no concealment

           err Error, No concealment

           res Reserved

           notok
               Error or concealment

           notres
               Not reserved

           Aa, Ba, Ca, Ab, Bb, Cb, A, B, C, a, b, erri, erru
               The specific error status code

           see page 44-46 or section 5.5 of
           <http://web.archive.org/web/20060927044735/http://www.smpte.org/smpte_store/standards/pdf/s314m.pdf>

   eac3_core
       Extract the core from a E-AC-3 stream, dropping extra channels.

   extract_extradata
       Extract the in-band extradata.

       Certain codecs allow the long-term headers (e.g. MPEG-2 sequence headers, or H.264/HEVC (VPS/)SPS/PPS) to
       be transmitted either "in-band" (i.e. as a part of the bitstream containing the coded frames) or "out of
       band" (e.g. on the container level). This latter form is called "extradata" in FFmpeg terminology.

       This bitstream filter detects the in-band headers and makes them available as extradata.

       remove
           When this option is enabled, the long-term headers are removed from the bitstream after extraction.

   filter_units
       Remove units with types in or not in a given set from the stream.

       pass_types
           List of unit types or ranges of unit types to pass through while removing all others.  This is
           specified as a '|'-separated list of unit type values or ranges of values with '-'.

       remove_types
           Identical to pass_types, except the units in the given set removed and all others passed through.

       The types used by pass_types and remove_types correspond to NAL unit types (nal_unit_type) in H.264, HEVC
       and H.266 (see Table 7-1 in the H.264 and HEVC specifications or Table 5 in the H.266 specification), to
       marker values for JPEG (without 0xFF prefix) and to start codes without start code prefix (i.e. the byte
       following the 0x000001) for MPEG-2.  For VP8 and VP9, every unit has type zero.

       Extradata is unchanged by this transformation, but note that if the stream contains inline parameter sets
       then the output may be unusable if they are removed.

       For example, to remove all non-VCL NAL units from an H.264 stream:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:v copy -bsf:v 'filter_units=pass_types=1-5' OUTPUT

       To remove all AUDs, SEI and filler from an H.265 stream:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:v copy -bsf:v 'filter_units=remove_types=35|38-40' OUTPUT

       To remove all user data from a MPEG-2 stream, including Closed Captions:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:v copy -bsf:v 'filter_units=remove_types=178' OUTPUT

       To remove all SEI from a H264 stream, including Closed Captions:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:v copy -bsf:v 'filter_units=remove_types=6' OUTPUT

       To remove all prefix and suffix SEI from a HEVC stream, including Closed Captions and dynamic HDR:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:v copy -bsf:v 'filter_units=remove_types=39|40' OUTPUT

   hapqa_extract
       Extract Rgb or Alpha part of an HAPQA file, without recompression, in order to create an HAPQ or an
       HAPAlphaOnly file.

       texture
           Specifies the texture to keep.

           color
           alpha

       Convert HAPQA to HAPQ

               ffmpeg -i hapqa_inputfile.mov -c copy -bsf:v hapqa_extract=texture=color -tag:v HapY -metadata:s:v:0 encoder="HAPQ" hapq_file.mov

       Convert HAPQA to HAPAlphaOnly

               ffmpeg -i hapqa_inputfile.mov -c copy -bsf:v hapqa_extract=texture=alpha -tag:v HapA -metadata:s:v:0 encoder="HAPAlpha Only" hapalphaonly_file.mov

   h264_metadata
       Modify metadata embedded in an H.264 stream.

       aud Insert or remove AUD NAL units in all access units of the stream.

           pass
           insert
           remove

           Default is pass.

       sample_aspect_ratio
           Set the sample aspect ratio of the stream in the VUI parameters.  See H.264 table E-1.

       overscan_appropriate_flag
           Set whether the stream is suitable for display using overscan or not (see H.264 section E.2.1).

       video_format
       video_full_range_flag
           Set the video format in the stream (see H.264 section E.2.1 and table E-2).

       colour_primaries
       transfer_characteristics
       matrix_coefficients
           Set the colour description in the stream (see H.264 section E.2.1 and tables E-3, E-4 and E-5).

       chroma_sample_loc_type
           Set the chroma sample location in the stream (see H.264 section E.2.1 and figure E-1).

       tick_rate
           Set the tick rate (time_scale / num_units_in_tick) in the VUI parameters.  This is the smallest time
           unit representable in the stream, and in many cases represents the field rate of the stream (double
           the frame rate).

       fixed_frame_rate_flag
           Set whether the stream has fixed framerate - typically this indicates that the framerate is exactly
           half the tick rate, but the exact meaning is dependent on interlacing and the picture structure (see
           H.264 section E.2.1 and table E-6).

       zero_new_constraint_set_flags
           Zero constraint_set4_flag and constraint_set5_flag in the SPS. These bits were reserved in a previous
           version of the H.264 spec, and thus some hardware decoders require these to be zero. The result of
           zeroing this is still a valid bitstream.

       crop_left
       crop_right
       crop_top
       crop_bottom
           Set the frame cropping offsets in the SPS.  These values will replace the current ones if the stream
           is already cropped.

           These fields are set in pixels.  Note that some sizes may not be representable if the chroma is
           subsampled or the stream is interlaced (see H.264 section 7.4.2.1.1).

       sei_user_data
           Insert a string as SEI unregistered user data.  The argument must be of the form UUID+string, where
           the UUID is as hex digits possibly separated by hyphens, and the string can be anything.

           For example, 086f3693-b7b3-4f2c-9653-21492feee5b8+hello will insert the string ``hello'' associated
           with the given UUID.

       delete_filler
           Deletes both filler NAL units and filler SEI messages.

       display_orientation
           Insert, extract or remove Display orientation SEI messages.  See H.264 section D.1.27 and D.2.27 for
           syntax and semantics.

           pass
           insert
           remove
           extract

           Default is pass.

           Insert mode works in conjunction with "rotate" and "flip" options.  Any pre-existing Display
           orientation messages will be removed in insert or remove mode.  Extract mode attaches the display
           matrix to the packet as side data.

       rotate
           Set rotation in display orientation SEI (anticlockwise angle in degrees).  Range is -360 to +360.
           Default is NaN.

       flip
           Set flip in display orientation SEI.

           horizontal
           vertical

           Default is unset.

       level
           Set the level in the SPS.  Refer to H.264 section A.3 and tables A-1 to A-5.

           The argument must be the name of a level (for example, 4.2), a level_idc value (for example, 42), or
           the special name auto indicating that the filter should attempt to guess the level from the input
           stream properties.

   h264_mp4toannexb
       Convert an H.264 bitstream from length prefixed mode to start code prefixed mode (as defined in the Annex
       B of the ITU-T H.264 specification).

       This is required by some streaming formats, typically the MPEG-2 transport stream format (muxer
       "mpegts").

       For example to remux an MP4 file containing an H.264 stream to mpegts format with ffmpeg, you can use the
       command:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT.mp4 -codec copy -bsf:v h264_mp4toannexb OUTPUT.ts

       Please note that this filter is auto-inserted for MPEG-TS (muxer "mpegts") and raw H.264 (muxer "h264")
       output formats.

   h264_redundant_pps
       This applies a specific fixup to some Blu-ray streams which contain redundant PPSs modifying irrelevant
       parameters of the stream which confuse other transformations which require correct extradata.

   hevc_metadata
       Modify metadata embedded in an HEVC stream.

       aud Insert or remove AUD NAL units in all access units of the stream.

           insert
           remove
       sample_aspect_ratio
           Set the sample aspect ratio in the stream in the VUI parameters.

       video_format
       video_full_range_flag
           Set the video format in the stream (see H.265 section E.3.1 and table E.2).

       colour_primaries
       transfer_characteristics
       matrix_coefficients
           Set the colour description in the stream (see H.265 section E.3.1 and tables E.3, E.4 and E.5).

       chroma_sample_loc_type
           Set the chroma sample location in the stream (see H.265 section E.3.1 and figure E.1).

       tick_rate
           Set the tick rate in the VPS and VUI parameters (time_scale / num_units_in_tick). Combined with
           num_ticks_poc_diff_one, this can set a constant framerate in the stream.  Note that it is likely to
           be overridden by container parameters when the stream is in a container.

       num_ticks_poc_diff_one
           Set poc_proportional_to_timing_flag in VPS and VUI and use this value to set
           num_ticks_poc_diff_one_minus1 (see H.265 sections 7.4.3.1 and E.3.1).  Ignored if tick_rate is not
           also set.

       crop_left
       crop_right
       crop_top
       crop_bottom
           Set the conformance window cropping offsets in the SPS.  These values will replace the current ones
           if the stream is already cropped.

           These fields are set in pixels.  Note that some sizes may not be representable if the chroma is
           subsampled (H.265 section 7.4.3.2.1).

       level
           Set the level in the VPS and SPS.  See H.265 section A.4 and tables A.6 and A.7.

           The argument must be the name of a level (for example, 5.1), a general_level_idc value (for example,
           153 for level 5.1), or the special name auto indicating that the filter should attempt to guess the
           level from the input stream properties.

   hevc_mp4toannexb
       Convert an HEVC/H.265 bitstream from length prefixed mode to start code prefixed mode (as defined in the
       Annex B of the ITU-T H.265 specification).

       This is required by some streaming formats, typically the MPEG-2 transport stream format (muxer
       "mpegts").

       For example to remux an MP4 file containing an HEVC stream to mpegts format with ffmpeg, you can use the
       command:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT.mp4 -codec copy -bsf:v hevc_mp4toannexb OUTPUT.ts

       Please note that this filter is auto-inserted for MPEG-TS (muxer "mpegts") and raw HEVC/H.265 (muxer
       "h265" or "hevc") output formats.

   imxdump
       Modifies the bitstream to fit in MOV and to be usable by the Final Cut Pro decoder. This filter only
       applies to the mpeg2video codec, and is likely not needed for Final Cut Pro 7 and newer with the
       appropriate -tag:v.

       For example, to remux 30 MB/sec NTSC IMX to MOV:

               ffmpeg -i input.mxf -c copy -bsf:v imxdump -tag:v mx3n output.mov

   mjpeg2jpeg
       Convert MJPEG/AVI1 packets to full JPEG/JFIF packets.

       MJPEG is a video codec wherein each video frame is essentially a JPEG image. The individual frames can be
       extracted without loss, e.g. by

               ffmpeg -i ../some_mjpeg.avi -c:v copy frames_%d.jpg

       Unfortunately, these chunks are incomplete JPEG images, because they lack the DHT segment required for
       decoding. Quoting from <http://www.digitalpreservation.gov/formats/fdd/fdd000063.shtml>:

       Avery Lee, writing in the rec.video.desktop newsgroup in 2001, commented that "MJPEG, or at least the
       MJPEG in AVIs having the MJPG fourcc, is restricted JPEG with a fixed -- and *omitted* -- Huffman table.
       The JPEG must be YCbCr colorspace, it must be 4:2:2, and it must use basic Huffman encoding, not
       arithmetic or progressive. . . . You can indeed extract the MJPEG frames and decode them with a regular
       JPEG decoder, but you have to prepend the DHT segment to them, or else the decoder won't have any idea
       how to decompress the data. The exact table necessary is given in the OpenDML spec."

       This bitstream filter patches the header of frames extracted from an MJPEG stream (carrying the AVI1
       header ID and lacking a DHT segment) to produce fully qualified JPEG images.

               ffmpeg -i mjpeg-movie.avi -c:v copy -bsf:v mjpeg2jpeg frame_%d.jpg
               exiftran -i -9 frame*.jpg
               ffmpeg -i frame_%d.jpg -c:v copy rotated.avi

   mjpegadump
       Add an MJPEG A header to the bitstream, to enable decoding by Quicktime.

   mov2textsub
       Extract a representable text file from MOV subtitles, stripping the metadata header from each subtitle
       packet.

       See also the text2movsub filter.

   mpeg2_metadata
       Modify metadata embedded in an MPEG-2 stream.

       display_aspect_ratio
           Set the display aspect ratio in the stream.

           The following fixed values are supported:

           4/3
           16/9
           221/100

           Any other value will result in square pixels being signalled instead (see H.262 section 6.3.3 and
           table 6-3).

       frame_rate
           Set the frame rate in the stream.  This is constructed from a table of known values combined with a
           small multiplier and divisor - if the supplied value is not exactly representable, the nearest
           representable value will be used instead (see H.262 section 6.3.3 and table 6-4).

       video_format
           Set the video format in the stream (see H.262 section 6.3.6 and table 6-6).

       colour_primaries
       transfer_characteristics
       matrix_coefficients
           Set the colour description in the stream (see H.262 section 6.3.6 and tables 6-7, 6-8 and 6-9).

   mpeg4_unpack_bframes
       Unpack DivX-style packed B-frames.

       DivX-style packed B-frames are not valid MPEG-4 and were only a workaround for the broken Video for
       Windows subsystem.  They use more space, can cause minor AV sync issues, require more CPU power to decode
       (unless the player has some decoded picture queue to compensate the 2,0,2,0 frame per packet style) and
       cause trouble if copied into a standard container like mp4 or mpeg-ps/ts, because MPEG-4 decoders may not
       be able to decode them, since they are not valid MPEG-4.

       For example to fix an AVI file containing an MPEG-4 stream with DivX-style packed B-frames using ffmpeg,
       you can use the command:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT.avi -codec copy -bsf:v mpeg4_unpack_bframes OUTPUT.avi

   noise
       Damages the contents of packets or simply drops them without damaging the container. Can be used for
       fuzzing or testing error resilience/concealment.

       Parameters:

       amount
           Accepts an expression whose evaluation per-packet determines how often bytes in that packet will be
           modified. A value below 0 will result in a variable frequency.  Default is 0 which results in no
           modification. However, if neither amount nor drop is specified, amount will be set to -1. See below
           for accepted variables.

       drop
           Accepts an expression evaluated per-packet whose value determines whether that packet is dropped.
           Evaluation to a positive value results in the packet being dropped. Evaluation to a negative value
           results in a variable chance of it being dropped, roughly inverse in proportion to the magnitude of
           the value. Default is 0 which results in no drops. See below for accepted variables.

       dropamount
           Accepts a non-negative integer, which assigns a variable chance of it being dropped, roughly inverse
           in proportion to the value. Default is 0 which results in no drops. This option is kept for backwards
           compatibility and is equivalent to setting drop to a negative value with the same magnitude i.e.
           "dropamount=4" is the same as "drop=-4". Ignored if drop is also specified.

       Both "amount" and "drop" accept expressions containing the following variables:

       n   The index of the packet, starting from zero.

       tb  The timebase for packet timestamps.

       pts Packet presentation timestamp.

       dts Packet decoding timestamp.

       nopts
           Constant representing AV_NOPTS_VALUE.

       startpts
           First non-AV_NOPTS_VALUE PTS seen in the stream.

       startdts
           First non-AV_NOPTS_VALUE DTS seen in the stream.

       duration
       d   Packet duration, in timebase units.

       pos Packet position in input; may be -1 when unknown or not set.

       size
           Packet size, in bytes.

       key Whether packet is marked as a keyframe.

       state
           A pseudo random integer, primarily derived from the content of packet payload.

       Examples

       Apply modification to every byte but don't drop any packets.

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c copy -bsf noise=1 output.mkv

       Drop every video packet not marked as a keyframe after timestamp 30s but do not modify any of the
       remaining packets.

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c copy -bsf:v noise=drop='gt(t\,30)*not(key)' output.mkv

       Drop one second of audio every 10 seconds and add some random noise to the rest.

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c copy -bsf:a noise=amount=-1:drop='between(mod(t\,10)\,9\,10)' output.mkv

   null
       This bitstream filter passes the packets through unchanged.

   pcm_rechunk
       Repacketize PCM audio to a fixed number of samples per packet or a fixed packet rate per second. This is
       similar to the asetnsamples audio filter but works on audio packets instead of audio frames.

       nb_out_samples, n
           Set the number of samples per each output audio packet. The number is intended as the number of
           samples per each channel. Default value is 1024.

       pad, p
           If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio packet with silence, so that it will contain the same
           number of samples (or roughly the same number of samples, see frame_rate) as the previous ones.
           Default value is 1.

       frame_rate, r
           This option makes the filter output a fixed number of packets per second instead of a fixed number of
           samples per packet. If the audio sample rate is not divisible by the frame rate then the number of
           samples will not be constant but will vary slightly so that each packet will start as close to the
           frame boundary as possible. Using this option has precedence over nb_out_samples.

       You can generate the well known 1602-1601-1602-1601-1602 pattern of 48kHz audio for NTSC frame rate using
       the frame_rate option.

               ffmpeg -f lavfi -i sine=r=48000:d=1 -c pcm_s16le -bsf pcm_rechunk=r=30000/1001 -f framecrc -

   pgs_frame_merge
       Merge a sequence of PGS Subtitle segments ending with an "end of display set" segment into a single
       packet.

       This is required by some containers that support PGS subtitles (muxer "matroska").

   prores_metadata
       Modify color property metadata embedded in prores stream.

       color_primaries
           Set the color primaries.  Available values are:

           auto
               Keep the same color primaries property (default).

           unknown
           bt709
           bt470bg
               BT601 625

           smpte170m
               BT601 525

           bt2020
           smpte431
               DCI P3

           smpte432
               P3 D65

       transfer_characteristics
           Set the color transfer.  Available values are:

           auto
               Keep the same transfer characteristics property (default).

           unknown
           bt709
               BT 601, BT 709, BT 2020

           smpte2084
               SMPTE ST 2084

           arib-std-b67
               ARIB STD-B67

       matrix_coefficients
           Set the matrix coefficient.  Available values are:

           auto
               Keep the same colorspace property (default).

           unknown
           bt709
           smpte170m
               BT 601

           bt2020nc

       Set Rec709 colorspace for each frame of the file

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c copy -bsf:v prores_metadata=color_primaries=bt709:color_trc=bt709:colorspace=bt709 output.mov

       Set Hybrid Log-Gamma parameters for each frame of the file

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c copy -bsf:v prores_metadata=color_primaries=bt2020:color_trc=arib-std-b67:colorspace=bt2020nc output.mov

   remove_extra
       Remove extradata from packets.

       It accepts the following parameter:

       freq
           Set which frame types to remove extradata from.

           k   Remove extradata from non-keyframes only.

           keyframe
               Remove extradata from keyframes only.

           e, all
               Remove extradata from all frames.

   setts
       Set PTS and DTS in packets.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       ts
       pts
       dts Set expressions for PTS, DTS or both.

       duration
           Set expression for duration.

       time_base
           Set output time base.

       The expressions are evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following constants:

       N   The count of the input packet. Starting from 0.

       TS  The demux timestamp in input in case of "ts" or "dts" option or presentation timestamp in case of
           "pts" option.

       POS The original position in the file of the packet, or undefined if undefined for the current packet

       DTS The demux timestamp in input.

       PTS The presentation timestamp in input.

       DURATION
           The duration in input.

       STARTDTS
           The DTS of the first packet.

       STARTPTS
           The PTS of the first packet.

       PREV_INDTS
           The previous input DTS.

       PREV_INPTS
           The previous input PTS.

       PREV_INDURATION
           The previous input duration.

       PREV_OUTDTS
           The previous output DTS.

       PREV_OUTPTS
           The previous output PTS.

       PREV_OUTDURATION
           The previous output duration.

       NEXT_DTS
           The next input DTS.

       NEXT_PTS
           The next input PTS.

       NEXT_DURATION
           The next input duration.

       TB  The timebase of stream packet belongs.

       TB_OUT
           The output timebase.

       SR  The sample rate of stream packet belongs.

       NOPTS
           The AV_NOPTS_VALUE constant.

       For example, to set PTS equal to DTS (not recommended if B-frames are involved):

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:a copy -bsf:a setts=pts=DTS out.mkv

   showinfo
       Log basic packet information. Mainly useful for testing, debugging, and development.

   text2movsub
       Convert text subtitles to MOV subtitles (as used by the "mov_text" codec) with metadata headers.

       See also the mov2textsub filter.

   trace_headers
       Log trace output containing all syntax elements in the coded stream headers (everything above the level
       of individual coded blocks).  This can be useful for debugging low-level stream issues.

       Supports AV1, H.264, H.265, (M)JPEG, MPEG-2 and VP9, but depending on the build only a subset of these
       may be available.

   truehd_core
       Extract the core from a TrueHD stream, dropping ATMOS data.

   vp9_metadata
       Modify metadata embedded in a VP9 stream.

       color_space
           Set the color space value in the frame header.  Note that any frame set to RGB will be implicitly set
           to PC range and that RGB is incompatible with profiles 0 and 2.

           unknown
           bt601
           bt709
           smpte170
           smpte240
           bt2020
           rgb
       color_range
           Set the color range value in the frame header.  Note that any value imposed by the color space will
           take precedence over this value.

           tv
           pc

   vp9_superframe
       Merge VP9 invisible (alt-ref) frames back into VP9 superframes. This fixes merging of split/segmented VP9
       streams where the alt-ref frame was split from its visible counterpart.

   vp9_superframe_split
       Split VP9 superframes into single frames.

   vp9_raw_reorder
       Given a VP9 stream with correct timestamps but possibly out of order, insert additional show-existing-
       frame packets to correct the ordering.

FORMAT OPTIONS

       The libavformat library provides some generic global options, which can be set on all the muxers and
       demuxers. In addition each muxer or demuxer may support so-called private options, which are specific for
       that component.

       Options may be set by specifying -option value in the FFmpeg tools, or by setting the value explicitly in
       the "AVFormatContext" options or using the libavutil/opt.h API for programmatic use.

       The list of supported options follows:

       avioflags flags (input/output)
           Possible values:

           direct
               Reduce buffering.

       probesize integer (input)
           Set probing size in bytes, i.e. the size of the data to analyze to get stream information. A higher
           value will enable detecting more information in case it is dispersed into the stream, but will
           increase latency. Must be an integer not lesser than 32. It is 5000000 by default.

       max_probe_packets integer (input)
           Set the maximum number of buffered packets when probing a codec.  Default is 2500 packets.

       packetsize integer (output)
           Set packet size.

       fflags flags
           Set format flags. Some are implemented for a limited number of formats.

           Possible values for input files:

           discardcorrupt
               Discard corrupted packets.

           fastseek
               Enable fast, but inaccurate seeks for some formats.

           genpts
               Generate missing PTS if DTS is present.

           igndts
               Ignore DTS if PTS is also set. In case the PTS is set, the DTS value is set to NOPTS. This is
               ignored when the "nofillin" flag is set.

           ignidx
               Ignore index.

           nobuffer
               Reduce the latency introduced by buffering during initial input streams analysis.

           nofillin
               Do not fill in missing values in packet fields that can be exactly calculated.

           noparse
               Disable AVParsers, this needs "+nofillin" too.

           sortdts
               Try to interleave output packets by DTS. At present, available only for AVIs with an index.

           Possible values for output files:

           autobsf
               Automatically apply bitstream filters as required by the output format. Enabled by default.

           bitexact
               Only write platform-, build- and time-independent data.  This ensures that file and data
               checksums are reproducible and match between platforms. Its primary use is for regression
               testing.

           flush_packets
               Write out packets immediately.

           shortest
               Stop muxing at the end of the shortest stream.  It may be needed to increase max_interleave_delta
               to avoid flushing the longer streams before EOF.

       seek2any integer (input)
           Allow seeking to non-keyframes on demuxer level when supported if set to 1.  Default is 0.

       analyzeduration integer (input)
           Specify how many microseconds are analyzed to probe the input. A higher value will enable detecting
           more accurate information, but will increase latency. It defaults to 5,000,000 microseconds = 5
           seconds.

       cryptokey hexadecimal string (input)
           Set decryption key.

       indexmem integer (input)
           Set max memory used for timestamp index (per stream).

       rtbufsize integer (input)
           Set max memory used for buffering real-time frames.

       fdebug flags (input/output)
           Print specific debug info.

           Possible values:

           ts
       max_delay integer (input/output)
           Set maximum muxing or demuxing delay in microseconds.

       fpsprobesize integer (input)
           Set number of frames used to probe fps.

       audio_preload integer (output)
           Set microseconds by which audio packets should be interleaved earlier.

       chunk_duration integer (output)
           Set microseconds for each chunk.

       chunk_size integer (output)
           Set size in bytes for each chunk.

       err_detect, f_err_detect flags (input)
           Set error detection flags. "f_err_detect" is deprecated and should be used only via the ffmpeg tool.

           Possible values:

           crccheck
               Verify embedded CRCs.

           bitstream
               Detect bitstream specification deviations.

           buffer
               Detect improper bitstream length.

           explode
               Abort decoding on minor error detection.

           careful
               Consider things that violate the spec and have not been seen in the wild as errors.

           compliant
               Consider all spec non compliancies as errors.

           aggressive
               Consider things that a sane encoder should not do as an error.

       max_interleave_delta integer (output)
           Set maximum buffering duration for interleaving. The duration is expressed in microseconds, and
           defaults to 10000000 (10 seconds).

           To ensure all the streams are interleaved correctly, libavformat will wait until it has at least one
           packet for each stream before actually writing any packets to the output file. When some streams are
           "sparse" (i.e. there are large gaps between successive packets), this can result in excessive
           buffering.

           This field specifies the maximum difference between the timestamps of the first and the last packet
           in the muxing queue, above which libavformat will output a packet regardless of whether it has queued
           a packet for all the streams.

           If set to 0, libavformat will continue buffering packets until it has a packet for each stream,
           regardless of the maximum timestamp difference between the buffered packets.

       use_wallclock_as_timestamps integer (input)
           Use wallclock as timestamps if set to 1. Default is 0.

       avoid_negative_ts integer (output)
           Possible values:

           make_non_negative
               Shift timestamps to make them non-negative.  Also note that this affects only leading negative
               timestamps, and not non-monotonic negative timestamps.

           make_zero
               Shift timestamps so that the first timestamp is 0.

           auto (default)
               Enables shifting when required by the target format.

           disabled
               Disables shifting of timestamp.

           When shifting is enabled, all output timestamps are shifted by the same amount. Audio, video, and
           subtitles desynching and relative timestamp differences are preserved compared to how they would have
           been without shifting.

       skip_initial_bytes integer (input)
           Set number of bytes to skip before reading header and frames if set to 1.  Default is 0.

       correct_ts_overflow integer (input)
           Correct single timestamp overflows if set to 1. Default is 1.

       flush_packets integer (output)
           Flush the underlying I/O stream after each packet. Default is -1 (auto), which means that the
           underlying protocol will decide, 1 enables it, and has the effect of reducing the latency, 0 disables
           it and may increase IO throughput in some cases.

       output_ts_offset offset (output)
           Set the output time offset.

           offset must be a time duration specification, see the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual.

           The offset is added by the muxer to the output timestamps.

           Specifying a positive offset means that the corresponding streams are delayed bt the time duration
           specified in offset. Default value is 0 (meaning that no offset is applied).

       format_whitelist list (input)
           "," separated list of allowed demuxers. By default all are allowed.

       dump_separator string (input)
           Separator used to separate the fields printed on the command line about the Stream parameters.  For
           example, to separate the fields with newlines and indentation:

                   ffprobe -dump_separator "
                                             "  -i ~/videos/matrixbench_mpeg2.mpg

       max_streams integer (input)
           Specifies the maximum number of streams. This can be used to reject files that would require too many
           resources due to a large number of streams.

       skip_estimate_duration_from_pts bool (input)
           Skip estimation of input duration when calculated using PTS.  At present, applicable for MPEG-PS and
           MPEG-TS.

       strict, f_strict integer (input/output)
           Specify how strictly to follow the standards. "f_strict" is deprecated and should be used only via
           the ffmpeg tool.

           Possible values:

           very
               strictly conform to an older more strict version of the spec or reference software

           strict
               strictly conform to all the things in the spec no matter what consequences

           normal
           unofficial
               allow unofficial extensions

           experimental
               allow non standardized experimental things, experimental (unfinished/work in progress/not well
               tested) decoders and encoders.  Note: experimental decoders can pose a security risk, do not use
               this for decoding untrusted input.

   Format stream specifiers
       Format stream specifiers allow selection of one or more streams that match specific properties.

       The exact semantics of stream specifiers is defined by the avformat_match_stream_specifier() function
       declared in the libavformat/avformat.h header and documented in the Stream specifiers section in the
       ffmpeg(1) manual.

DEMUXERS

       Demuxers are configured elements in FFmpeg that can read the multimedia streams from a particular type of
       file.

       When you configure your FFmpeg build, all the supported demuxers are enabled by default. You can list all
       available ones using the configure option "--list-demuxers".

       You can disable all the demuxers using the configure option "--disable-demuxers", and selectively enable
       a single demuxer with the option "--enable-demuxer=DEMUXER", or disable it with the option
       "--disable-demuxer=DEMUXER".

       The option "-demuxers" of the ff* tools will display the list of enabled demuxers. Use "-formats" to view
       a combined list of enabled demuxers and muxers.

       The description of some of the currently available demuxers follows.

   aa
       Audible Format 2, 3, and 4 demuxer.

       This demuxer is used to demux Audible Format 2, 3, and 4 (.aa) files.

   aac
       Raw Audio Data Transport Stream AAC demuxer.

       This demuxer is used to demux an ADTS input containing a single AAC stream alongwith any ID3v1/2 or APE
       tags in it.

   apng
       Animated Portable Network Graphics demuxer.

       This demuxer is used to demux APNG files.  All headers, but the PNG signature, up to (but not including)
       the first fcTL chunk are transmitted as extradata.  Frames are then split as being all the chunks between
       two fcTL ones, or between the last fcTL and IEND chunks.

       -ignore_loop bool
           Ignore the loop variable in the file if set. Default is enabled.

       -max_fps int
           Maximum framerate in frames per second. Default of 0 imposes no limit.

       -default_fps int
           Default framerate in frames per second when none is specified in the file (0 meaning as fast as
           possible). Default is 15.

   asf
       Advanced Systems Format demuxer.

       This demuxer is used to demux ASF files and MMS network streams.

       -no_resync_search bool
           Do not try to resynchronize by looking for a certain optional start code.

   concat
       Virtual concatenation script demuxer.

       This demuxer reads a list of files and other directives from a text file and demuxes them one after the
       other, as if all their packets had been muxed together.

       The timestamps in the files are adjusted so that the first file starts at 0 and each next file starts
       where the previous one finishes. Note that it is done globally and may cause gaps if all streams do not
       have exactly the same length.

       All files must have the same streams (same codecs, same time base, etc.).

       The duration of each file is used to adjust the timestamps of the next file: if the duration is incorrect
       (because it was computed using the bit-rate or because the file is truncated, for example), it can cause
       artifacts. The "duration" directive can be used to override the duration stored in each file.

       Syntax

       The script is a text file in extended-ASCII, with one directive per line.  Empty lines, leading spaces
       and lines starting with '#' are ignored. The following directive is recognized:

       "file path"
           Path to a file to read; special characters and spaces must be escaped with backslash or single
           quotes.

           All subsequent file-related directives apply to that file.

       "ffconcat version 1.0"
           Identify the script type and version.

           To make FFmpeg recognize the format automatically, this directive must appear exactly as is (no extra
           space or byte-order-mark) on the very first line of the script.

       "duration dur"
           Duration of the file. This information can be specified from the file; specifying it here may be more
           efficient or help if the information from the file is not available or accurate.

           If the duration is set for all files, then it is possible to seek in the whole concatenated video.

       "inpoint timestamp"
           In point of the file. When the demuxer opens the file it instantly seeks to the specified timestamp.
           Seeking is done so that all streams can be presented successfully at In point.

           This directive works best with intra frame codecs, because for non-intra frame ones you will usually
           get extra packets before the actual In point and the decoded content will most likely contain frames
           before In point too.

           For each file, packets before the file In point will have timestamps less than the calculated start
           timestamp of the file (negative in case of the first file), and the duration of the files (if not
           specified by the "duration" directive) will be reduced based on their specified In point.

           Because of potential packets before the specified In point, packet timestamps may overlap between two
           concatenated files.

       "outpoint timestamp"
           Out point of the file. When the demuxer reaches the specified decoding timestamp in any of the
           streams, it handles it as an end of file condition and skips the current and all the remaining
           packets from all streams.

           Out point is exclusive, which means that the demuxer will not output packets with a decoding
           timestamp greater or equal to Out point.

           This directive works best with intra frame codecs and formats where all streams are tightly
           interleaved. For non-intra frame codecs you will usually get additional packets with presentation
           timestamp after Out point therefore the decoded content will most likely contain frames after Out
           point too. If your streams are not tightly interleaved you may not get all the packets from all
           streams before Out point and you may only will be able to decode the earliest stream until Out point.

           The duration of the files (if not specified by the "duration" directive) will be reduced based on
           their specified Out point.

       "file_packet_metadata key=value"
           Metadata of the packets of the file. The specified metadata will be set for each file packet. You can
           specify this directive multiple times to add multiple metadata entries.  This directive is
           deprecated, use "file_packet_meta" instead.

       "file_packet_meta key value"
           Metadata of the packets of the file. The specified metadata will be set for each file packet. You can
           specify this directive multiple times to add multiple metadata entries.

       "option key value"
           Option to access, open and probe the file.  Can be present multiple times.

       "stream"
           Introduce a stream in the virtual file.  All subsequent stream-related directives apply to the last
           introduced stream.  Some streams properties must be set in order to allow identifying the matching
           streams in the subfiles.  If no streams are defined in the script, the streams from the first file
           are copied.

       "exact_stream_id id"
           Set the id of the stream.  If this directive is given, the string with the corresponding id in the
           subfiles will be used.  This is especially useful for MPEG-PS (VOB) files, where the order of the
           streams is not reliable.

       "stream_meta key value"
           Metadata for the stream.  Can be present multiple times.

       "stream_codec value"
           Codec for the stream.

       "stream_extradata hex_string"
           Extradata for the string, encoded in hexadecimal.

       "chapter id start end"
           Add a chapter. id is an unique identifier, possibly small and consecutive.

       Options

       This demuxer accepts the following option:

       safe
           If set to 1, reject unsafe file paths and directives.  A file path is considered safe if it does not
           contain a protocol specification and is relative and all components only contain characters from the
           portable character set (letters, digits, period, underscore and hyphen) and have no period at the
           beginning of a component.

           If set to 0, any file name is accepted.

           The default is 1.

       auto_convert
           If set to 1, try to perform automatic conversions on packet data to make the streams concatenable.
           The default is 1.

           Currently, the only conversion is adding the h264_mp4toannexb bitstream filter to H.264 streams in
           MP4 format. This is necessary in particular if there are resolution changes.

       segment_time_metadata
           If set to 1, every packet will contain the lavf.concat.start_time and the lavf.concat.duration packet
           metadata values which are the start_time and the duration of the respective file segments in the
           concatenated output expressed in microseconds. The duration metadata is only set if it is known based
           on the concat file.  The default is 0.

       Examples

       •   Use absolute filenames and include some comments:

                   # my first filename
                   file /mnt/share/file-1.wav
                   # my second filename including whitespace
                   file '/mnt/share/file 2.wav'
                   # my third filename including whitespace plus single quote
                   file '/mnt/share/file 3'\''.wav'

       •   Allow for input format auto-probing, use safe filenames and set the duration of the first file:

                   ffconcat version 1.0

                   file file-1.wav
                   duration 20.0

                   file subdir/file-2.wav

   dash
       Dynamic Adaptive Streaming over HTTP demuxer.

       This demuxer presents all AVStreams found in the manifest.  By setting the discard flags on AVStreams the
       caller can decide which streams to actually receive.  Each stream mirrors the "id" and "bandwidth"
       properties from the "<Representation>" as metadata keys named "id" and "variant_bitrate" respectively.

       Options

       This demuxer accepts the following option:

       cenc_decryption_key
           16-byte key, in hex, to decrypt files encrypted using ISO Common Encryption (CENC/AES-128 CTR;
           ISO/IEC 23001-7).

   dvdvideo
       DVD-Video demuxer, powered by libdvdnav and libdvdread.

       Can directly ingest DVD titles, specifically sequential PGCs, into a conversion pipeline. Menu assets,
       such as background video or audio, can also be demuxed given the menu's coordinates (at best effort).
       Seeking is not supported at this time.

       Block devices (DVD drives), ISO files, and directory structures are accepted.  Activate with "-f
       dvdvideo" in front of one of these inputs.

       This demuxer does NOT have decryption code of any kind. You are on your own working with encrypted DVDs,
       and should not expect support on the matter.

       Underlying playback is handled by libdvdnav, and structure parsing by libdvdread.  FFmpeg must be built
       with GPL library support available as well as the configure switches "--enable-libdvdnav" and
       "--enable-libdvdread".

       You will need to provide either the desired "title number" or exact PGC/PG coordinates.  Many open-source
       DVD players and tools can aid in providing this information.  If not specified, the demuxer will default
       to title 1 which works for many discs.  However, due to the flexibility of the format, it is recommended
       to check manually.  There are many discs that are authored strangely or with invalid headers.

       If the input is a real DVD drive, please note that there are some drives which may silently fail on
       reading bad sectors from the disc, returning random bits instead which is effectively corrupt data. This
       is especially prominent on aging or rotting discs.  A second pass and integrity checks would be needed to
       detect the corruption.  This is not an FFmpeg issue.

       Background

       DVD-Video is not a directly accessible, linear container format in the traditional sense. Instead, it
       allows for complex and programmatic playback of carefully muxed MPEG-PS streams that are stored in
       headerless VOB files.  To the end-user, these streams are known simply as "titles", but the actual
       logical playback sequence is defined by one or more "PGCs", or Program Group Chains, within the title.
       The PGC is in turn comprised of multiple "PGs", or Programs", which are the actual video segments (and
       for a typical video feature, sequentially ordered). The PGC structure, along with stream layout and
       metadata, are stored in IFO files that need to be parsed. PGCs can be thought of as playlists in easier
       terms.

       An actual DVD player relies on user GUI interaction via menus and an internal VM to drive the direction
       of demuxing. Generally, the user would either navigate (via menus) or automatically be redirected to the
       PGC of their choice. During this process and the subsequent playback, the DVD player's internal VM also
       maintains a state and executes instructions that can create jumps to different sectors during playback.
       This is why libdvdnav is involved, as a linear read of the MPEG-PS blobs on the disc (VOBs) is not enough
       to produce the right sequence in many cases.

       There are many other DVD structures (a long subject) that will not be discussed here.  NAV packets, in
       particular, are handled by this demuxer to build accurate timing but not emitted as a stream. For a good
       high-level understanding, refer to:
       <https://code.videolan.org/videolan/libdvdnav/-/blob/master/doc/dvd_structures>

       Options

       This demuxer accepts the following options:

       title int
           The title number to play. Must be set if pgc and pg are not set.  Not applicable to menus.  Default
           is 0 (auto), which currently only selects the first available title (title 1) and notifies the user
           about the implications.

       chapter_start int
           The chapter, or PTT (part-of-title), number to start at. Not applicable to menus.  Default is 1.

       chapter_end int
           The chapter, or PTT (part-of-title), number to end at. Not applicable to menus.  Default is 0, which
           is a special value to signal end at the last possible chapter.

       angle int
           The video angle number, referring to what is essentially an additional video stream that is composed
           from alternate frames interleaved in the VOBs.  Not applicable to menus.  Default is 1.

       region int
           The region code to use for playback. Some discs may use this to default playback at a particular
           angle in different regions. This option will not affect the region code of a real DVD drive, if used
           as an input. Not applicable to menus.  Default is 0, "world".

       menu bool
           Demux menu assets instead of navigating a title. Requires exact coordinates of the menu (menu_lu,
           menu_vts, pgc, pg).  Default is false.

       menu_lu int
           The menu language to demux. In DVD, menus are grouped by language.  Default is 0, the first language
           unit.

       menu_vts int
           The VTS where the menu lives, or 0 if it is a VMG menu (root-level).  Default is 0, VMG menu.

       pgc int
           The entry PGC to start playback, in conjunction with pg.  Alternative to setting title.  Chapter
           markers are not supported at this time.  Must be explicitly set for menus.  Default is 0,
           automatically resolve from value of title.

       pg int
           The entry PG to start playback, in conjunction with pgc.  Alternative to setting title.  Chapter
           markers are not supported at this time.  Default is 0, automatically resolve from value of title, or
           start from the beginning (PG 1) of the menu.

       preindex bool
           Enable this to have accurate chapter (PTT) markers and duration measurement, which requires a slow
           second pass read in order to index the chapter marker timestamps from NAV packets. This is non-ideal
           extra work for real optical drives.  It is recommended and faster to use this option with a backup of
           the DVD structure stored on a hard drive. Not compatible with pgc and pg.  Not applicable to menus.
           Default is 0, false.

       trim bool
           Skip padding cells (i.e. cells shorter than 1 second) from the beginning.  There exist many discs
           with filler segments at the beginning of the PGC, often with junk data intended for controlling a
           real DVD player's buffering speed and with no other material data value.  Not applicable to menus.
           Default is 1, true.

       Examples

       •   Open title 3 from a given DVD structure:

                   ffmpeg -f dvdvideo -title 3 -i <path to DVD> ...

       •   Open chapters 3-6 from title 1 from a given DVD structure:

                   ffmpeg -f dvdvideo -chapter_start 3 -chapter_end 6 -title 1 -i <path to DVD> ...

       •   Open only chapter 5 from title 1 from a given DVD structure:

                   ffmpeg -f dvdvideo -chapter_start 5 -chapter_end 5 -title 1 -i <path to DVD> ...

       •   Demux menu with language 1 from VTS 1, PGC 1, starting at PG 1:

                   ffmpeg -f dvdvideo -menu 1 -menu_lu 1 -menu_vts 1 -pgc 1 -pg 1 -i <path to DVD> ...

   ea
       Electronic Arts Multimedia format demuxer.

       This format is used by various Electronic Arts games.

       Options

       merge_alpha bool
           Normally the VP6 alpha channel (if exists) is returned as a secondary video stream, by setting this
           option you can make the demuxer return a single video stream which contains the alpha channel in
           addition to the ordinary video.

   imf
       Interoperable Master Format demuxer.

       This demuxer presents audio and video streams found in an IMF Composition, as specified in
       <https://doi.org/10.5594/SMPTE.ST2067-2.2020>.

               ffmpeg [-assetmaps <path of ASSETMAP1>,<path of ASSETMAP2>,...] -i <path of CPL> ...

       If "-assetmaps" is not specified, the demuxer looks for a file called ASSETMAP.xml in the same directory
       as the CPL.

   flv, live_flv, kux
       Adobe Flash Video Format demuxer.

       This demuxer is used to demux FLV files and RTMP network streams. In case of live network streams, if you
       force format, you may use live_flv option instead of flv to survive timestamp discontinuities.  KUX is a
       flv variant used on the Youku platform.

               ffmpeg -f flv -i myfile.flv ...
               ffmpeg -f live_flv -i rtmp://<any.server>/anything/key ....

       -flv_metadata bool
           Allocate the streams according to the onMetaData array content.

       -flv_ignore_prevtag bool
           Ignore the size of previous tag value.

       -flv_full_metadata bool
           Output all context of the onMetadata.

   gif
       Animated GIF demuxer.

       It accepts the following options:

       min_delay
           Set the minimum valid delay between frames in hundredths of seconds.  Range is 0 to 6000. Default
           value is 2.

       max_gif_delay
           Set the maximum valid delay between frames in hundredth of seconds.  Range is 0 to 65535. Default
           value is 65535 (nearly eleven minutes), the maximum value allowed by the specification.

       default_delay
           Set the default delay between frames in hundredths of seconds.  Range is 0 to 6000. Default value is
           10.

       ignore_loop
           GIF files can contain information to loop a certain number of times (or infinitely). If ignore_loop
           is set to 1, then the loop setting from the input will be ignored and looping will not occur. If set
           to 0, then looping will occur and will cycle the number of times according to the GIF. Default value
           is 1.

       For example, with the overlay filter, place an infinitely looping GIF over another video:

               ffmpeg -i input.mp4 -ignore_loop 0 -i input.gif -filter_complex overlay=shortest=1 out.mkv

       Note that in the above example the shortest option for overlay filter is used to end the output video at
       the length of the shortest input file, which in this case is input.mp4 as the GIF in this example loops
       infinitely.

   hls
       HLS demuxer

       Apple HTTP Live Streaming demuxer.

       This demuxer presents all AVStreams from all variant streams.  The id field is set to the bitrate variant
       index number. By setting the discard flags on AVStreams (by pressing 'a' or 'v' in ffplay), the caller
       can decide which variant streams to actually receive.  The total bitrate of the variant that the stream
       belongs to is available in a metadata key named "variant_bitrate".

       It accepts the following options:

       live_start_index
           segment index to start live streams at (negative values are from the end).

       prefer_x_start
           prefer to use #EXT-X-START if it's in playlist instead of live_start_index.

       allowed_extensions
           ',' separated list of file extensions that hls is allowed to access.

       max_reload
           Maximum number of times a insufficient list is attempted to be reloaded.  Default value is 1000.

       m3u8_hold_counters
           The maximum number of times to load m3u8 when it refreshes without new segments.  Default value is
           1000.

       http_persistent
           Use persistent HTTP connections. Applicable only for HTTP streams.  Enabled by default.

       http_multiple
           Use multiple HTTP connections for downloading HTTP segments.  Enabled by default for HTTP/1.1
           servers.

       http_seekable
           Use HTTP partial requests for downloading HTTP segments.  0 = disable, 1 = enable, -1 = auto, Default
           is auto.

       seg_format_options
           Set options for the demuxer of media segments using a list of key=value pairs separated by ":".

       seg_max_retry
           Maximum number of times to reload a segment on error, useful when segment skip on network error is
           not desired.  Default value is 0.

   image2
       Image file demuxer.

       This demuxer reads from a list of image files specified by a pattern.  The syntax and meaning of the
       pattern is specified by the option pattern_type.

       The pattern may contain a suffix which is used to automatically determine the format of the images
       contained in the files.

       The size, the pixel format, and the format of each image must be the same for all the files in the
       sequence.

       This demuxer accepts the following options:

       framerate
           Set the frame rate for the video stream. It defaults to 25.

       loop
           If set to 1, loop over the input. Default value is 0.

       pattern_type
           Select the pattern type used to interpret the provided filename.

           pattern_type accepts one of the following values.

           none
               Disable pattern matching, therefore the video will only contain the specified image. You should
               use this option if you do not want to create sequences from multiple images and your filenames
               may contain special pattern characters.

           sequence
               Select a sequence pattern type, used to specify a sequence of files indexed by sequential
               numbers.

               A sequence pattern may contain the string "%d" or "%0Nd", which specifies the position of the
               characters representing a sequential number in each filename matched by the pattern. If the form
               "%d0Nd" is used, the string representing the number in each filename is 0-padded and N is the
               total number of 0-padded digits representing the number. The literal character '%' can be
               specified in the pattern with the string "%%".

               If the sequence pattern contains "%d" or "%0Nd", the first filename of the file list specified by
               the pattern must contain a number inclusively contained between start_number and
               start_number+start_number_range-1, and all the following numbers must be sequential.

               For example the pattern "img-%03d.bmp" will match a sequence of filenames of the form
               img-001.bmp, img-002.bmp, ..., img-010.bmp, etc.; the pattern "i%%m%%g-%d.jpg" will match a
               sequence of filenames of the form i%m%g-1.jpg, i%m%g-2.jpg, ..., i%m%g-10.jpg, etc.

               Note that the pattern must not necessarily contain "%d" or "%0Nd", for example to convert a
               single image file img.jpeg you can employ the command:

                       ffmpeg -i img.jpeg img.png

           glob
               Select a glob wildcard pattern type.

               The pattern is interpreted like a glob() pattern. This is only selectable if libavformat was
               compiled with globbing support.

           glob_sequence (deprecated, will be removed)
               Select a mixed glob wildcard/sequence pattern.

               If your version of libavformat was compiled with globbing support, and the provided pattern
               contains at least one glob meta character among "%*?[]{}" that is preceded by an unescaped "%",
               the pattern is interpreted like a glob() pattern, otherwise it is interpreted like a sequence
               pattern.

               All glob special characters "%*?[]{}" must be prefixed with "%". To escape a literal "%" you
               shall use "%%".

               For example the pattern "foo-%*.jpeg" will match all the filenames prefixed by "foo-" and
               terminating with ".jpeg", and "foo-%?%?%?.jpeg" will match all the filenames prefixed with
               "foo-", followed by a sequence of three characters, and terminating with ".jpeg".

               This pattern type is deprecated in favor of glob and sequence.

           Default value is glob_sequence.

       pixel_format
           Set the pixel format of the images to read. If not specified the pixel format is guessed from the
           first image file in the sequence.

       start_number
           Set the index of the file matched by the image file pattern to start to read from. Default value is
           0.

       start_number_range
           Set the index interval range to check when looking for the first image file in the sequence, starting
           from start_number. Default value is 5.

       ts_from_file
           If set to 1, will set frame timestamp to modification time of image file. Note that monotonity of
           timestamps is not provided: images go in the same order as without this option. Default value is 0.
           If set to 2, will set frame timestamp to the modification time of the image file in nanosecond
           precision.

       video_size
           Set the video size of the images to read. If not specified the video size is guessed from the first
           image file in the sequence.

       export_path_metadata
           If set to 1, will add two extra fields to the metadata found in input, making them also available for
           other filters (see drawtext filter for examples). Default value is 0. The extra fields are described
           below:

           lavf.image2dec.source_path
               Corresponds to the full path to the input file being read.

           lavf.image2dec.source_basename
               Corresponds to the name of the file being read.

       Examples

       •   Use ffmpeg for creating a video from the images in the file sequence img-001.jpeg, img-002.jpeg, ...,
           assuming an input frame rate of 10 frames per second:

                   ffmpeg -framerate 10 -i 'img-%03d.jpeg' out.mkv

       •   As above, but start by reading from a file with index 100 in the sequence:

                   ffmpeg -framerate 10 -start_number 100 -i 'img-%03d.jpeg' out.mkv

       •   Read images matching the "*.png" glob pattern , that is all the files terminating with the ".png"
           suffix:

                   ffmpeg -framerate 10 -pattern_type glob -i "*.png" out.mkv

   libgme
       The Game Music Emu library is a collection of video game music file emulators.

       See <https://bitbucket.org/mpyne/game-music-emu/overview> for more information.

       It accepts the following options:

       track_index
           Set the index of which track to demux. The demuxer can only export one track.  Track indexes start at
           0. Default is to pick the first track. Number of tracks is exported as tracks metadata entry.

       sample_rate
           Set the sampling rate of the exported track. Range is 1000 to 999999. Default is 44100.

       max_size (bytes)
           The demuxer buffers the entire file into memory. Adjust this value to set the maximum buffer size,
           which in turn, acts as a ceiling for the size of files that can be read.  Default is 50 MiB.

   libmodplug
       ModPlug based module demuxer

       See <https://github.com/Konstanty/libmodplug>

       It will export one 2-channel 16-bit 44.1 kHz audio stream.  Optionally, a "pal8" 16-color video stream
       can be exported with or without printed metadata.

       It accepts the following options:

       noise_reduction
           Apply a simple low-pass filter. Can be 1 (on) or 0 (off). Default is 0.

       reverb_depth
           Set amount of reverb. Range 0-100. Default is 0.

       reverb_delay
           Set delay in ms, clamped to 40-250 ms. Default is 0.

       bass_amount
           Apply bass expansion a.k.a. XBass or megabass. Range is 0 (quiet) to 100 (loud). Default is 0.

       bass_range
           Set cutoff i.e. upper-bound for bass frequencies. Range is 10-100 Hz. Default is 0.

       surround_depth
           Apply a Dolby Pro-Logic surround effect. Range is 0 (quiet) to 100 (heavy). Default is 0.

       surround_delay
           Set surround delay in ms, clamped to 5-40 ms. Default is 0.

       max_size
           The demuxer buffers the entire file into memory. Adjust this value to set the maximum buffer size,
           which in turn, acts as a ceiling for the size of files that can be read. Range is 0 to 100 MiB.  0
           removes buffer size limit (not recommended). Default is 5 MiB.

       video_stream_expr
           String which is evaluated using the eval API to assign colors to the generated video stream.
           Variables which can be used are "x", "y", "w", "h", "t", "speed", "tempo", "order", "pattern" and
           "row".

       video_stream
           Generate video stream. Can be 1 (on) or 0 (off). Default is 0.

       video_stream_w
           Set video frame width in 'chars' where one char indicates 8 pixels. Range is 20-512. Default is 30.

       video_stream_h
           Set video frame height in 'chars' where one char indicates 8 pixels. Range is 20-512. Default is 30.

       video_stream_ptxt
           Print metadata on video stream. Includes "speed", "tempo", "order", "pattern", "row" and "ts" (time
           in ms). Can be 1 (on) or 0 (off). Default is 1.

   libopenmpt
       libopenmpt based module demuxer

       See <https://lib.openmpt.org/libopenmpt/> for more information.

       Some files have multiple subsongs (tracks) this can be set with the subsong option.

       It accepts the following options:

       subsong
           Set the subsong index. This can be either  'all', 'auto', or the index of the subsong. Subsong
           indexes start at 0. The default is 'auto'.

           The default value is to let libopenmpt choose.

       layout
           Set the channel layout. Valid values are 1, 2, and 4 channel layouts.  The default value is STEREO.

       sample_rate
           Set the sample rate for libopenmpt to output.  Range is from 1000 to INT_MAX. The value default is
           48000.

   mov/mp4/3gp
       Demuxer for Quicktime File Format & ISO/IEC Base Media File Format (ISO/IEC 14496-12 or MPEG-4 Part 12,
       ISO/IEC 15444-12 or JPEG 2000 Part 12).

       Registered extensions: mov, mp4, m4a, 3gp, 3g2, mj2, psp, m4b, ism, ismv, isma, f4v

       Options

       This demuxer accepts the following options:

       enable_drefs
           Enable loading of external tracks, disabled by default.  Enabling this can theoretically leak
           information in some use cases.

       use_absolute_path
           Allows loading of external tracks via absolute paths, disabled by default.  Enabling this poses a
           security risk. It should only be enabled if the source is known to be non-malicious.

       seek_streams_individually
           When seeking, identify the closest point in each stream individually and demux packets in that stream
           from identified point. This can lead to a different sequence of packets compared to demuxing linearly
           from the beginning. Default is true.

       ignore_editlist
           Ignore any edit list atoms. The demuxer, by default, modifies the stream index to reflect the
           timeline described by the edit list. Default is false.

       advanced_editlist
           Modify the stream index to reflect the timeline described by the edit list. "ignore_editlist" must be
           set to false for this option to be effective.  If both "ignore_editlist" and this option are set to
           false, then only the start of the stream index is modified to reflect initial dwell time or starting
           timestamp described by the edit list. Default is true.

       ignore_chapters
           Don't parse chapters. This includes GoPro 'HiLight' tags/moments. Note that chapters are only parsed
           when input is seekable. Default is false.

       use_mfra_for
           For seekable fragmented input, set fragment's starting timestamp from media fragment random access
           box, if present.

           Following options are available:

           auto
               Auto-detect whether to set mfra timestamps as PTS or DTS (default)

           dts Set mfra timestamps as DTS

           pts Set mfra timestamps as PTS

           0   Don't use mfra box to set timestamps

       use_tfdt
           For fragmented input, set fragment's starting timestamp to "baseMediaDecodeTime" from the "tfdt" box.
           Default is enabled, which will prefer to use the "tfdt" box to set DTS. Disable to use the
           "earliest_presentation_time" from the "sidx" box.  In either case, the timestamp from the "mfra" box
           will be used if it's available and "use_mfra_for" is set to pts or dts.

       export_all
           Export unrecognized boxes within the udta box as metadata entries. The first four characters of the
           box type are set as the key. Default is false.

       export_xmp
           Export entire contents of XMP_ box and uuid box as a string with key "xmp". Note that if "export_all"
           is set and this option isn't, the contents of XMP_ box are still exported but with key "XMP_".
           Default is false.

       activation_bytes
           4-byte key required to decrypt Audible AAX and AAX+ files. See Audible AAX subsection below.

       audible_fixed_key
           Fixed key used for handling Audible AAX/AAX+ files. It has been pre-set so should not be necessary to
           specify.

       decryption_key
           16-byte key, in hex, to decrypt files encrypted using ISO Common Encryption (CENC/AES-128 CTR;
           ISO/IEC 23001-7).

       max_stts_delta
           Very high sample deltas written in a trak's stts box may occasionally be intended but usually they
           are written in error or used to store a negative value for dts correction when treated as signed
           32-bit integers. This option lets the user set an upper limit, beyond which the delta is clamped to
           1. Values greater than the limit if negative when cast to int32 are used to adjust onward dts.

           Unit is the track time scale. Range is 0 to UINT_MAX. Default is "UINT_MAX - 48000*10" which allows
           up to a 10 second dts correction for 48 kHz audio streams while accommodating 99.9% of "uint32"
           range.

       interleaved_read
           Interleave packets from multiple tracks at demuxer level. For badly interleaved files, this prevents
           playback issues caused by large gaps between packets in different tracks, as MOV/MP4 do not have
           packet placement requirements.  However, this can cause excessive seeking on very badly interleaved
           files, due to seeking between tracks, so disabling it may prevent I/O issues, at the expense of
           playback.

       Audible AAX

       Audible AAX files are encrypted M4B files, and they can be decrypted by specifying a 4 byte activation
       secret.

               ffmpeg -activation_bytes 1CEB00DA -i test.aax -vn -c:a copy output.mp4

   mpegts
       MPEG-2 transport stream demuxer.

       This demuxer accepts the following options:

       resync_size
           Set size limit for looking up a new synchronization. Default value is 65536.

       skip_unknown_pmt
           Skip PMTs for programs not defined in the PAT. Default value is 0.

       fix_teletext_pts
           Override teletext packet PTS and DTS values with the timestamps calculated from the PCR of the first
           program which the teletext stream is part of and is not discarded. Default value is 1, set this
           option to 0 if you want your teletext packet PTS and DTS values untouched.

       ts_packetsize
           Output option carrying the raw packet size in bytes.  Show the detected raw packet size, cannot be
           set by the user.

       scan_all_pmts
           Scan and combine all PMTs. The value is an integer with value from -1 to 1 (-1 means automatic
           setting, 1 means enabled, 0 means disabled). Default value is -1.

       merge_pmt_versions
           Re-use existing streams when a PMT's version is updated and elementary streams move to different
           PIDs. Default value is 0.

       max_packet_size
           Set maximum size, in bytes, of packet emitted by the demuxer. Payloads above this size are split
           across multiple packets. Range is 1 to INT_MAX/2. Default is 204800 bytes.

   mpjpeg
       MJPEG encapsulated in multi-part MIME demuxer.

       This demuxer allows reading of MJPEG, where each frame is represented as a part of
       multipart/x-mixed-replace stream.

       strict_mime_boundary
           Default implementation applies a relaxed standard to multi-part MIME boundary detection, to prevent
           regression with numerous existing endpoints not generating a proper MIME MJPEG stream. Turning this
           option on by setting it to 1 will result in a stricter check of the boundary value.

   rawvideo
       Raw video demuxer.

       This demuxer allows one to read raw video data. Since there is no header specifying the assumed video
       parameters, the user must specify them in order to be able to decode the data correctly.

       This demuxer accepts the following options:

       framerate
           Set input video frame rate. Default value is 25.

       pixel_format
           Set the input video pixel format. Default value is "yuv420p".

       video_size
           Set the input video size. This value must be specified explicitly.

       For example to read a rawvideo file input.raw with ffplay, assuming a pixel format of "rgb24", a video
       size of "320x240", and a frame rate of 10 images per second, use the command:

               ffplay -f rawvideo -pixel_format rgb24 -video_size 320x240 -framerate 10 input.raw

   sbg
       SBaGen script demuxer.

       This demuxer reads the script language used by SBaGen <http://uazu.net/sbagen/> to generate binaural
       beats sessions. A SBG script looks like that:

               -SE
               a: 300-2.5/3 440+4.5/0
               b: 300-2.5/0 440+4.5/3
               off: -
               NOW      == a
               +0:07:00 == b
               +0:14:00 == a
               +0:21:00 == b
               +0:30:00    off

       A SBG script can mix absolute and relative timestamps. If the script uses either only absolute timestamps
       (including the script start time) or only relative ones, then its layout is fixed, and the conversion is
       straightforward. On the other hand, if the script mixes both kind of timestamps, then the NOW reference
       for relative timestamps will be taken from the current time of day at the time the script is read, and
       the script layout will be frozen according to that reference. That means that if the script is directly
       played, the actual times will match the absolute timestamps up to the sound controller's clock accuracy,
       but if the user somehow pauses the playback or seeks, all times will be shifted accordingly.

   tedcaptions
       JSON captions used for <http://www.ted.com/>.

       TED does not provide links to the captions, but they can be guessed from the page. The file
       tools/bookmarklets.html from the FFmpeg source tree contains a bookmarklet to expose them.

       This demuxer accepts the following option:

       start_time
           Set the start time of the TED talk, in milliseconds. The default is 15000 (15s). It is used to sync
           the captions with the downloadable videos, because they include a 15s intro.

       Example: convert the captions to a format most players understand:

               ffmpeg -i http://www.ted.com/talks/subtitles/id/1/lang/en talk1-en.srt

   vapoursynth
       Vapoursynth wrapper.

       Due to security concerns, Vapoursynth scripts will not be autodetected so the input format has to be
       forced. For ff* CLI tools, add "-f vapoursynth" before the input "-i yourscript.vpy".

       This demuxer accepts the following option:

       max_script_size
           The demuxer buffers the entire script into memory. Adjust this value to set the maximum buffer size,
           which in turn, acts as a ceiling for the size of scripts that can be read.  Default is 1 MiB.

   w64
       Sony Wave64 Audio demuxer.

       This demuxer accepts the following options:

       max_size
           See the same option for the wav demuxer.

   wav
       RIFF Wave Audio demuxer.

       This demuxer accepts the following options:

       max_size
           Specify the maximum packet size in bytes for the demuxed packets. By default this is set to 0, which
           means that a sensible value is chosen based on the input format.

MUXERS

       Muxers are configured elements in FFmpeg which allow writing multimedia streams to a particular type of
       file.

       When you configure your FFmpeg build, all the supported muxers are enabled by default. You can list all
       available muxers using the configure option "--list-muxers".

       You can disable all the muxers with the configure option "--disable-muxers" and selectively enable /
       disable single muxers with the options "--enable-muxer=MUXER" / "--disable-muxer=MUXER".

       The option "-muxers" of the ff* tools will display the list of enabled muxers. Use "-formats" to view a
       combined list of enabled demuxers and muxers.

       A description of some of the currently available muxers follows.

   Raw muxers
       This section covers raw muxers. They accept a single stream matching the designated codec. They do not
       store timestamps or metadata. The recognized extension is the same as the muxer name unless indicated
       otherwise.

       It comprises the following muxers. The media type and the eventual extensions used to automatically
       selects the muxer from the output extensions are also shown.

       ac3 audio
           Dolby Digital, also known as AC-3.

       adx audio
           CRI Middleware ADX audio.

           This muxer will write out the total sample count near the start of the first packet when the output
           is seekable and the count can be stored in 32 bits.

       aptx audio
           aptX (Audio Processing Technology for Bluetooth)

       aptx_hd audio (aptxdh)
           aptX HD (Audio Processing Technology for Bluetooth) audio

       avs2 video (avs, avs2)
           AVS2-P2 (Audio Video Standard - Second generation - Part 2) / IEEE 1857.4 video

       avs3 video (avs3)
           AVS3-P2 (Audio Video Standard - Third generation - Part 2) / IEEE 1857.10 video

       cavsvideo video (cavs)
           Chinese AVS (Audio Video Standard - First generation)

       codec2raw audio
           Codec 2 audio.

           No extension is registered so format name has to be supplied e.g. with the ffmpeg CLI tool "-f
           codec2raw".

       data any
           Generic data muxer.

           This muxer accepts a single stream with any codec of any type. The input stream has to be selected
           using the "-map" option with the ffmpeg CLI tool.

           No extension is registered so format name has to be supplied e.g. with the ffmpeg CLI tool "-f data".

       dfpwm audio (dfpwm)
           Raw DFPWM1a (Dynamic Filter Pulse With Modulation) audio muxer.

       dirac video (drc, vc2)
           BBC Dirac video.

           The Dirac Pro codec is a subset and is standardized as SMPTE VC-2.

       dnxhd video (dnxhd, dnxhr)
           Avid DNxHD video.

           It is standardized as SMPTE VC-3. Accepts DNxHR streams.

       dts audio
           DTS Coherent Acoustics (DCA) audio

       eac3 audio
           Dolby Digital Plus, also known as Enhanced AC-3

       evc video (evc)
           MPEG-5 Essential Video Coding (EVC) / EVC / MPEG-5 Part 1 EVC video

       g722 audio
           ITU-T G.722 audio

       g723_1 audio (tco, rco)
           ITU-T G.723.1 audio

       g726 audio
           ITU-T G.726 big-endian ("left-justified") audio.

           No extension is registered so format name has to be supplied e.g. with the ffmpeg CLI tool "-f g726".

       g726le audio
           ITU-T G.726 little-endian ("right-justified") audio.

           No extension is registered so format name has to be supplied e.g. with the ffmpeg CLI tool "-f
           g726le".

       gsm audio
           Global System for Mobile Communications audio

       h261 video
           ITU-T H.261 video

       h263 video
           ITU-T H.263 / H.263-1996, H.263+ / H.263-1998 / H.263 version 2 video

       h264 video (h264, 264)
           ITU-T H.264 / MPEG-4 Part 10 AVC video. Bitstream shall be converted to Annex B syntax if it's in
           length-prefixed mode.

       hevc video (hevc, h265, 265)
           ITU-T H.265 / MPEG-H Part 2 HEVC video. Bitstream shall be converted to Annex B syntax if it's in
           length-prefixed mode.

       m4v video
           MPEG-4 Part 2 video

       mjpeg video (mjpg, mjpeg)
           Motion JPEG video

       mlp audio
           Meridian Lossless Packing, also known as Packed PCM

       mp2 audio (mp2, m2a, mpa)
           MPEG-1 Audio Layer II audio

       mpeg1video video (mpg, mpeg, m1v)
           MPEG-1 Part 2 video.

       mpeg2video video (m2v)
           ITU-T H.262 / MPEG-2 Part 2 video

       obu video
           AV1 low overhead Open Bitstream Units muxer.

           Temporal delimiter OBUs will be inserted in all temporal units of the stream.

       rawvideo video (yuv, rgb)
           Raw uncompressed video.

       sbc audio (sbc, msbc)
           Bluetooth SIG low-complexity subband codec audio

       truehd audio (thd)
           Dolby TrueHD audio

       vc1 video
           SMPTE 421M / VC-1 video

       Examples

       •   Store raw video frames with the rawvideo muxer using ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -f lavfi -i testsrc -t 10 -s hd1080p testsrc.yuv

           Since the rawvideo muxer do not store the information related to size and format, this information
           must be provided when demuxing the file:

                   ffplay -video_size 1920x1080 -pixel_format rgb24 -f rawvideo testsrc.rgb

   Raw PCM muxers
       This section covers raw PCM (Pulse-Code Modulation) audio muxers.

       They accept a single stream matching the designated codec. They do not store timestamps or metadata. The
       recognized extension is the same as the muxer name.

       It comprises the following muxers. The optional additional extension used to automatically select the
       muxer from the output extension is also shown in parentheses.

       alaw (al)
           PCM A-law

       f32be
           PCM 32-bit floating-point big-endian

       f32le
           PCM 32-bit floating-point little-endian

       f64be
           PCM 64-bit floating-point big-endian

       f64le
           PCM 64-bit floating-point little-endian

       mulaw (ul)
           PCM mu-law

       s16be
           PCM signed 16-bit big-endian

       s16le
           PCM signed 16-bit little-endian

       s24be
           PCM signed 24-bit big-endian

       s24le
           PCM signed 24-bit little-endian

       s32be
           PCM signed 32-bit big-endian

       s32le
           PCM signed 32-bit little-endian

       s8 (sb)
           PCM signed 8-bit

       u16be
           PCM unsigned 16-bit big-endian

       u16le
           PCM unsigned 16-bit little-endian

       u24be
           PCM unsigned 24-bit big-endian

       u24le
           PCM unsigned 24-bit little-endian

       u32be
           PCM unsigned 32-bit big-endian

       u32le
           PCM unsigned 32-bit little-endian

       u8 (ub)
           PCM unsigned 8-bit

       vidc
           PCM Archimedes VIDC

   MPEG-1/MPEG-2 program stream muxers
       This section covers formats belonging to the MPEG-1 and MPEG-2 Systems family.

       The MPEG-1 Systems format (also known as ISO/IEEC 11172-1 or MPEG-1 program stream) has been adopted for
       the format of media track stored in VCD (Video Compact Disc).

       The MPEG-2 Systems standard (also known as ISO/IEEC 13818-1) covers two containers formats, one known as
       transport stream and one known as program stream; only the latter is covered here.

       The MPEG-2 program stream format (also known as VOB due to the corresponding file extension) is an
       extension of MPEG-1 program stream: in addition to support different codecs for the audio and video
       streams, it also stores subtitles and navigation metadata.  MPEG-2 program stream has been adopted for
       storing media streams in SVCD and DVD storage devices.

       This section comprises the following muxers.

       mpeg (mpg,mpeg)
           MPEG-1 Systems / MPEG-1 program stream muxer.

       vcd MPEG-1 Systems / MPEG-1 program stream (VCD) muxer.

           This muxer can be used to generate tracks in the format accepted by the VCD (Video Compact Disc)
           storage devices.

           It is the same as the mpeg muxer with a few differences.

       vob MPEG-2 program stream (VOB) muxer.

       dvd MPEG-2 program stream (DVD VOB) muxer.

           This muxer can be used to generate tracks in the format accepted by the DVD (Digital Versatile Disc)
           storage devices.

           This is the same as the vob muxer with a few differences.

       svcd (vob)
           MPEG-2 program stream (SVCD VOB) muxer.

           This muxer can be used to generate tracks in the format accepted by the SVCD (Super Video Compact
           Disc) storage devices.

           This is the same as the vob muxer with a few differences.

       Options

       muxrate rate
           Set user-defined mux rate expressed as a number of bits/s. If not specied the automatically computed
           mux rate is employed. Default value is 0.

       preload delay
           Set initial demux-decode delay in microseconds. Default value is 500000.

   MOV/MPEG-4/ISOMBFF muxers
       This section covers formats belonging to the QuickTime / MOV family, including the MPEG-4 Part 14 format
       and ISO base media file format (ISOBMFF). These formats share a common structure based on the ISO base
       media file format (ISOBMFF).

       The MOV format was originally developed for use with Apple QuickTime.  It was later used as the basis for
       the MPEG-4 Part 1 (later Part 14) format, also known as ISO/IEC 14496-1. That format was then generalized
       into ISOBMFF, also named MPEG-4 Part 12 format, ISO/IEC 14496-12, or ISO/IEC 15444-12.

       It comprises the following muxers.

       3gp Third Generation Partnership Project (3GPP) format for 3G UMTS multimedia services

       3g2 Third Generation Partnership Project 2 (3GP2 or 3GPP2) format for 3G CDMA2000 multimedia services,
           similar to 3gp with extensions and limitations

       f4v Adobe Flash Video format

       ipod
           MPEG-4 audio file format, as MOV/MP4 but limited to contain only audio streams, typically played with
           the Apple ipod device

       ismv
           Microsoft IIS (Internet Information Services) Smooth Streaming Audio/Video (ISMV or ISMA) format.
           This is based on MPEG-4 Part 14 format with a few incompatible variants, used to stream media files
           for the Microsoft IIS server.

       mov QuickTime player format identified by the ".mov" extension

       mp4 MP4 or MPEG-4 Part 14 format

       psp PlayStation Portable MP4/MPEG-4 Part 14 format variant. This is based on MPEG-4 Part 14 format with a
           few incompatible variants, used to play files on PlayStation devices.

       Fragmentation

       The mov, mp4, and ismv muxers support fragmentation. Normally, a MOV/MP4 file has all the metadata about
       all packets stored in one location.

       This data is usually written at the end of the file, but it can be moved to the start for better playback
       by adding "+faststart" to the "-movflags", or using the qt-faststart tool).

       A fragmented file consists of a number of fragments, where packets and metadata about these packets are
       stored together. Writing a fragmented file has the advantage that the file is decodable even if the
       writing is interrupted (while a normal MOV/MP4 is undecodable if it is not properly finished), and it
       requires less memory when writing very long files (since writing normal MOV/MP4 files stores info about
       every single packet in memory until the file is closed). The downside is that it is less compatible with
       other applications.

       Fragmentation is enabled by setting one of the options that define how to cut the file into fragments:

       frag_duration
       frag_size
       min_frag_duration
       movflags +frag_keyframe
       movflags +frag_custom

       If more than one condition is specified, fragments are cut when one of the specified conditions is
       fulfilled. The exception to this is the option min_frag_duration, which has to be fulfilled for any of
       the other conditions to apply.

       Options

       brand brand_string
           Override major brand.

       empty_hdlr_name bool
           Enable to skip writing the name inside a "hdlr" box.  Default is "false".

       encryption_key key
           set the media encryption key in hexadecimal format

       encryption_kid kid
           set the media encryption key identifier in hexadecimal format

       encryption_scheme scheme
           configure the encryption scheme, allowed values are none, and cenc-aes-ctr

       frag_duration duration
           Create fragments that are duration microseconds long.

       frag_interleave  number
           Interleave samples within fragments (max number of consecutive samples, lower is tighter
           interleaving, but with more overhead. It is set to 0 by default.

       frag_size size
           create fragments that contain up to size bytes of payload data

       iods_audio_profile profile
           specify iods number for the audio profile atom (from -1 to 255), default is -1

       iods_video_profile profile
           specify iods number for the video profile atom (from -1 to 255), default is -1

       ism_lookahead num_entries
           specify number of lookahead entries for ISM files (from 0 to 255), default is 0

       min_frag_duration duration
           do not create fragments that are shorter than duration microseconds long

       moov_size bytes
           Reserves space for the moov atom at the beginning of the file instead of placing the moov atom at the
           end. If the space reserved is insufficient, muxing will fail.

       mov_gamma gamma
           specify gamma value for gama atom (as a decimal number from 0 to 10), default is 0.0, must be set
           together with "+ movflags"

       movflags flags
           Set various muxing switches. The following flags can be used:

           cmaf
               write CMAF (Common Media Application Format) compatible fragmented MP4 output

           dash
               write DASH (Dynamic Adaptive Streaming over HTTP) compatible fragmented MP4 output

           default_base_moof
               Similarly to the omit_tfhd_offset flag, this flag avoids writing the absolute base_data_offset
               field in tfhd atoms, but does so by using the new default-base-is-moof flag instead. This flag is
               new from 14496-12:2012. This may make the fragments easier to parse in certain circumstances
               (avoiding basing track fragment location calculations on the implicit end of the previous track
               fragment).

           delay_moov
               delay writing the initial moov until the first fragment is cut, or until the first fragment flush

           disable_chpl
               Disable Nero chapter markers (chpl atom). Normally, both Nero chapters and a QuickTime chapter
               track are written to the file. With this option set, only the QuickTime chapter track will be
               written. Nero chapters can cause failures when the file is reprocessed with certain tagging
               programs, like mp3Tag 2.61a and iTunes 11.3, most likely other versions are affected as well.

           faststart
               Run a second pass moving the index (moov atom) to the beginning of the file. This operation can
               take a while, and will not work in various situations such as fragmented output, thus it is not
               enabled by default.

           frag_custom
               Allow the caller to manually choose when to cut fragments, by calling "av_write_frame(ctx, NULL)"
               to write a fragment with the packets written so far. (This is only useful with other applications
               integrating libavformat, not from ffmpeg.)

           frag_discont
               signal that the next fragment is discontinuous from earlier ones

           frag_every_frame
               fragment at every frame

           frag_keyframe
               start a new fragment at each video keyframe

           global_sidx
               write a global sidx index at the start of the file

           isml
               create a live smooth streaming feed (for pushing to a publishing point)

           negative_cts_offsets
               Enables utilization of version 1 of the CTTS box, in which the CTS offsets can be negative. This
               enables the initial sample to have DTS/CTS of zero, and reduces the need for edit lists for some
               cases such as video tracks with B-frames. Additionally, eases conformance with the DASH-IF
               interoperability guidelines.

               This option is implicitly set when writing ismv (Smooth Streaming) files.

           omit_tfhd_offset
               Do not write any absolute base_data_offset in tfhd atoms. This avoids tying fragments to absolute
               byte positions in the file/streams.

           prefer_icc
               If writing colr atom prioritise usage of ICC profile if it exists in stream packet side data.

           rtphint
               add RTP hinting tracks to the output file

           separate_moof
               Write a separate moof (movie fragment) atom for each track. Normally, packets for all tracks are
               written in a moof atom (which is slightly more efficient), but with this option set, the muxer
               writes one moof/mdat pair for each track, making it easier to separate tracks.

           skip_sidx
               Skip writing of sidx atom. When bitrate overhead due to sidx atom is high, this option could be
               used for cases where sidx atom is not mandatory. When the global_sidx flag is enabled, this
               option is ignored.

           skip_trailer
               skip writing the mfra/tfra/mfro trailer for fragmented files

           use_metadata_tags
               use mdta atom for metadata

           write_colr
               write colr atom even if the color info is unspecified. This flag is experimental, may be renamed
               or changed, do not use from scripts.

           write_gama
               write deprecated gama atom

       movie_timescale scale
           Set the timescale written in the movie header box ("mvhd").  Range is 1 to INT_MAX. Default is 1000.

       rtpflags flags
           Add RTP hinting tracks to the output file.

           The following flags can be used:

           h264_mode0
               use mode 0 for H.264 in RTP

           latm
               use MP4A-LATM packetization instead of MPEG4-GENERIC for AAC

           rfc2190
               use RFC 2190 packetization instead of RFC 4629 for H.263

           send_bye
               send RTCP BYE packets when finishing

           skip_rtcp
               do not send RTCP sender reports

       skip_iods bool
           skip writing iods atom (default value is "true")

       use_editlist bool
           use edit list (default value is "auto")

       use_stream_ids_as_track_ids bool
           use stream ids as track ids (default value is "false")

       video_track_timescale scale
           Set the timescale used for video tracks. Range is 0 to INT_MAX. If set to 0, the timescale is
           automatically set based on the native stream time base. Default is 0.

       write_btrt bool
           Force or disable writing bitrate box inside stsd box of a track. The box contains decoding buffer
           size (in bytes), maximum bitrate and average bitrate for the track. The box will be skipped if none
           of these values can be computed.  Default is -1 or "auto", which will write the box only in MP4 mode.

       write_prft option
           Write producer time reference box (PRFT) with a specified time source for the NTP field in the PRFT
           box. Set value as wallclock to specify timesource as wallclock time and pts to specify timesource as
           input packets' PTS values.

       write_tmcd bool
           Specify "on" to force writing a timecode track, "off" to disable it and "auto" to write a timecode
           track only for mov and mp4 output (default).

           Setting value to pts is applicable only for a live encoding use case, where PTS values are set as as
           wallclock time at the source. For example, an encoding use case with decklink capture source where
           video_pts and audio_pts are set to abs_wallclock.

       Examples

       •   Push Smooth Streaming content in real time to a publishing point on IIS with the ismv muxer using
           ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -re <<normal input/transcoding options>> -movflags isml+frag_keyframe -f ismv http://server/publishingpoint.isml/Streams(Encoder1)

   a64
       A64 Commodore 64 video muxer.

       This muxer accepts a single "a64_multi" or "a64_multi5" codec video stream.

   ac4
       Raw AC-4 audio muxer.

       This muxer accepts a single "ac4" audio stream.

       Options

       write_crc bool
           when enabled, write a CRC checksum for each packet to the output, default is "false"

   adts
       Audio Data Transport Stream muxer.

       It accepts a single AAC stream.

       Options

       write_id3v2 bool
           Enable to write ID3v2.4 tags at the start of the stream. Default is disabled.

       write_apetag bool
           Enable to write APE tags at the end of the stream. Default is disabled.

       write_mpeg2 bool
           Enable to set MPEG version bit in the ADTS frame header to 1 which indicates MPEG-2. Default is 0,
           which indicates MPEG-4.

   aea
       MD STUDIO audio muxer.

       This muxer accepts a single ATRAC1 audio stream with either one or two channels and a sample rate of
       44100Hz.

       As AEA supports storing the track title, this muxer will also write the title from stream's metadata to
       the container.

   aiff
       Audio Interchange File Format muxer.

       Options

       write_id3v2 bool
           Enable ID3v2 tags writing when set to 1. Default is 0 (disabled).

       id3v2_version bool
           Select ID3v2 version to write. Currently only version 3 and 4 (aka.  ID3v2.3 and ID3v2.4) are
           supported. The default is version 4.

   alp
       High Voltage Software's Lego Racers game audio muxer.

       It accepts a single ADPCM_IMA_ALP stream with no more than 2 channels and a sample rate not greater than
       44100 Hz.

       Extensions: "tun", "pcm"

       Options

       type type
           Set file type.

           type accepts the following values:

           tun Set file type as music. Must have a sample rate of 22050 Hz.

           pcm Set file type as sfx.

           auto
               Set file type as per output file extension. ".pcm" results in type "pcm" else type "tun" is set.
               (default)

   amr
       3GPP AMR (Adaptive Multi-Rate) audio muxer.

       It accepts a single audio stream containing an AMR NB stream.

   amv
       AMV (Actions Media Video) format muxer.

   apm
       Ubisoft Rayman 2 APM audio muxer.

       It accepts a single ADPCM IMA APM audio stream.

   apng
       Animated Portable Network Graphics muxer.

       It accepts a single APNG video stream.

       Options

       final_delay delay
           Force a delay expressed in seconds after the last frame of each repetition. Default value is 0.0.

       plays repetitions
           specify how many times to play the content, 0 causes an infinte loop, with 1 there is no loop

       Examples

       •   Use ffmpeg to generate an APNG output with 2 repetitions, and with a delay of half a second after the
           first repetition:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -final_delay 0.5 -plays 2 out.apng

   argo_asf
       Argonaut Games ASF audio muxer.

       It accepts a single ADPCM audio stream.

       Options

       version_major version
           override file major version, specified as an integer, default value is 2

       version_minor version
           override file minor version, specified as an integer, default value is 1

       name name
           Embed file name into file, if not specified use the output file name. The name is truncated to 8
           characters.

   argo_cvg
       Argonaut Games CVG audio muxer.

       It accepts a single one-channel ADPCM 22050Hz audio stream.

       The loop and reverb options set the corresponding flags in the header which can be later retrieved to
       process the audio stream accordingly.

       Options

       skip_rate_check bool
           skip sample rate check (default is "false")

       loop bool
           set loop flag (default is "false")

       reverb boolean
           set reverb flag (default is "true")

   asf, asf_stream
       Advanced / Active Systems (or Streaming) Format audio muxer.

       The asf_stream variant should be selected for streaming.

       Note that Windows Media Audio (wma) and Windows Media Video (wmv) use this muxer too.

       Options

       packet_size size
           Set the muxer packet size as a number of bytes. By tuning this setting you may reduce data
           fragmentation or muxer overhead depending on your source. Default value is 3200, minimum is 100,
           maximum is "64Ki".

   ass
       ASS/SSA (SubStation Alpha) subtitles muxer.

       It accepts a single ASS subtitles stream.

       Options

       ignore_readorder bool
           Write dialogue events immediately, even if they are out-of-order, default is "false", otherwise they
           are cached until the expected time event is found.

   ast
       AST (Audio Stream) muxer.

       This format is used to play audio on some Nintendo Wii games.

       It accepts a single audio stream.

       The loopstart and loopend options can be used to define a section of the file to loop for players
       honoring such options.

       Options

       loopstart start
           Specify loop start position expressesd in milliseconds, from -1 to "INT_MAX", in case -1 is set then
           no loop is specified (default -1) and the loopend value is ignored.

       loopend end
           Specify loop end position expressed in milliseconds, from 0 to "INT_MAX", default is 0, in case 0 is
           set it assumes the total stream duration.

   au
       SUN AU audio muxer.

       It accepts a single audio stream.

   avi
       Audio Video Interleaved muxer.

       AVI is a proprietary format developed by Microsoft, and later formally specified through the Open DML
       specification.

       Because of differences in players implementations, it might be required to set some options to make sure
       that the generated output can be correctly played by the target player.

       Options

       flipped_raw_rgb bool
           If set to "true", store positive height for raw RGB bitmaps, which indicates bitmap is stored bottom-
           up. Note that this option does not flip the bitmap which has to be done manually beforehand, e.g. by
           using the vflip filter. Default is "false" and indicates bitmap is stored top down.

       reserve_index_space size
           Reserve the specified amount of bytes for the OpenDML master index of each stream within the file
           header. By default additional master indexes are embedded within the data packets if there is no
           space left in the first master index and are linked together as a chain of indexes. This index
           structure can cause problems for some use cases, e.g. third-party software strictly relying on the
           OpenDML index specification or when file seeking is slow. Reserving enough index space in the file
           header avoids these problems.

           The required index space depends on the output file size and should be about 16 bytes per gigabyte.
           When this option is omitted or set to zero the necessary index space is guessed.

           Default value is 0.

       write_channel_mask bool
           Write the channel layout mask into the audio stream header.

           This option is enabled by default. Disabling the channel mask can be useful in specific scenarios,
           e.g. when merging multiple audio streams into one for compatibility with software that only supports
           a single audio stream in AVI (see the "amerge" section in the ffmpeg-filters manual).

   avif
       AV1 (Alliance for Open Media Video codec 1) image format muxer.

       This muxers stores images encoded using the AV1 codec.

       It accepts one or two video streams. In case two video streams are provided, the second one shall contain
       a single plane storing the alpha mask.

       In case more than one image is provided, the generated output is considered an animated AVIF and the
       number of loops can be specified with the loop option.

       This is based on the specification by Alliance for Open Media at url
       <https://aomediacodec.github.io/av1-avif>.

       Options

       loop count
           number of times to loop an animated AVIF, 0 specify an infinite loop, default is 0

       movie_timescale timescale
           Set the timescale written in the movie header box ("mvhd").  Range is 1 to INT_MAX. Default is 1000.

   avm2
       ShockWave Flash (SWF) / ActionScript Virtual Machine 2 (AVM2) format muxer.

       It accepts one audio stream, one video stream, or both.

   bit
       G.729 (.bit) file format muxer.

       It accepts a single G.729 audio stream.

   caf
       Apple CAF (Core Audio Format) muxer.

       It accepts a single audio stream.

   codec2
       Codec2 audio audio muxer.

       It accepts a single codec2 audio stream.

   chromaprint
       Chromaprint fingerprinter muxers.

       To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-chromaprint".

       This muxer feeds audio data to the Chromaprint library, which generates a fingerprint for the provided
       audio data. See: <https://acoustid.org/chromaprint>

       It takes a single signed native-endian 16-bit raw audio stream of at most 2 channels.

       Options

       algorithm version
           Select version of algorithm to fingerprint with. Range is 0 to 4. Version 3 enables silence
           detection. Default is 1.

       fp_format format
           Format to output the fingerprint as. Accepts the following options:

           base64
               Base64 compressed fingerprint (default)

           compressed
               Binary compressed fingerprint

           raw Binary raw fingerprint

       silence_threshold threshold
           Threshold for detecting silence. Range is from -1 to 32767, where -1 disables silence detection.
           Silence detection can only be used with version 3 of the algorithm.

           Silence detection must be disabled for use with the AcoustID service. Default is -1.

   crc
       CRC (Cyclic Redundancy Check) muxer.

       This muxer computes and prints the Adler-32 CRC of all the input audio and video frames. By default audio
       frames are converted to signed 16-bit raw audio and video frames to raw video before computing the CRC.

       The output of the muxer consists of a single line of the form: CRC=0xCRC, where CRC is a hexadecimal
       number 0-padded to 8 digits containing the CRC for all the decoded input frames.

       See also the framecrc muxer.

       Examples

       •   Use ffmpeg to compute the CRC of the input, and store it in the file out.crc:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -f crc out.crc

       •   Use ffmpeg to print the CRC to stdout with the command:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -f crc -

       •   You can select the output format of each frame with ffmpeg by specifying the audio and video codec
           and format. For example, to compute the CRC of the input audio converted to PCM unsigned 8-bit and
           the input video converted to MPEG-2 video, use the command:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:a pcm_u8 -c:v mpeg2video -f crc -

   dash
       Dynamic Adaptive Streaming over HTTP (DASH) muxer.

       This muxer creates segments and manifest files according to the MPEG-DASH standard ISO/IEC 23009-1:2014
       and following standard updates.

       For more information see:

       •   ISO DASH Specification:
           <http://standards.iso.org/ittf/PubliclyAvailableStandards/c065274_ISO_IEC_23009-1_2014.zip>

       •   WebM DASH Specification:
           <https://sites.google.com/a/webmproject.org/wiki/adaptive-streaming/webm-dash-specification>

       This muxer creates an MPD (Media Presentation Description) manifest file and segment files for each
       stream. Segment files are placed in the same directory of the MPD manifest file.

       The segment filename might contain pre-defined identifiers used in the manifest "SegmentTemplate" section
       as defined in section 5.3.9.4.4 of the standard.

       Available identifiers are "$RepresentationID$", "$Number$", "$Bandwidth$", and "$Time$". In addition to
       the standard identifiers, an ffmpeg-specific "$ext$" identifier is also supported. When specified, ffmpeg
       will replace "$ext$" in the file name with muxing format's extensions such as "mp4", "webm" etc.

       Options

       adaptation_sets adaptation_sets
           Assign streams to adaptation sets, specified in the MPD manifest "AdaptationSets" section.

           An adaptation set contains a set of one or more streams accessed as a single subset, e.g.
           corresponding streams encoded at different size selectable by the user depending on the available
           bandwidth, or to different audio streams with a different language.

           Each adaptation set is specified with the syntax:

                   id=<index>,streams=<streams>

           where index must be a numerical index, and streams is a sequence of ","-separated stream indices.
           Multiple adaptation sets can be specified, separated by spaces.

           To map all video (or audio) streams to an adaptation set, "v" (or "a") can be used as stream
           identifier instead of IDs.

           When no assignment is defined, this defaults to an adaptation set for each stream.

           The following optional fields can also be specified:

           descriptor
               Define the descriptor as defined by ISO/IEC 23009-1:2014/Amd.2:2015.

               For example:

                       <SupplementalProperty schemeIdUri=\"urn:mpeg:dash:srd:2014\" value=\"0,0,0,1,1,2,2\"/>

               The descriptor string should be a self-closing XML tag.

           frag_duration
               Override the global fragment duration specified with the frag_duration option.

           frag_type
               Override the global fragment type specified with the frag_type option.

           seg_duration
               Override the global segment duration specified with the seg_duration option.

           trick_id
               Mark an adaptation set as containing streams meant to be used for Trick Mode for the referenced
               adaptation set.

           A few examples of possible values for the adaptation_sets option follow:

                   id=0,seg_duration=2,frag_duration=1,frag_type=duration,streams=v id=1,seg_duration=2,frag_type=none,streams=a

                   id=0,seg_duration=2,frag_type=none,streams=0 id=1,seg_duration=10,frag_type=none,trick_id=0,streams=1

       dash_segment_type type
           Set DASH segment files type.

           Possible values:

           auto
               The dash segment files format will be selected based on the stream codec. This is the default
               mode.

           mp4 the dash segment files will be in ISOBMFF/MP4 format

           webm
               the dash segment files will be in WebM format

       extra_window_size size
           Set the maximum number of segments kept outside of the manifest before removing from disk.

       format_options options_list
           Set container format (mp4/webm) options using a ":"-separated list of key=value parameters. Values
           containing ":" special characters must be escaped.

       frag_duration duration
           Set the length in seconds of fragments within segments, fractional value can also be set.

       frag_type type
           Set the type of interval for fragmentation.

           Possible values:

           auto
               set one fragment per segment

           every_frame
               fragment at every frame

           duration
               fragment at specific time intervals

           pframes
               fragment at keyframes and following P-Frame reordering (Video only, experimental)

       global_sidx bool
           Write global "SIDX" atom. Applicable only for single file, mp4 output, non-streaming mode.

       hls_master_name file_name
           HLS master playlist name. Default is master.m3u8.

       hls_playlist bool
           Generate HLS playlist files. The master playlist is generated with filename specified by the
           hls_master_name option. One media playlist file is generated for each stream with filenames
           media_0.m3u8, media_1.m3u8, etc.

       http_opts http_opts
           Specify a list of ":"-separated key=value options to pass to the underlying HTTP protocol. Applicable
           only for HTTP output.

       http_persistent bool
           Use persistent HTTP connections. Applicable only for HTTP output.

       http_user_agent user_agent
           Override User-Agent field in HTTP header. Applicable only for HTTP output.

       ignore_io_errors bool
           Ignore IO errors during open and write. Useful for long-duration runs with network output. This is
           disabled by default.

       index_correction bool
           Enable or disable segment index correction logic. Applicable only when use_template is enabled and
           use_timeline is disabled. This is disabled by default.

           When enabled, the logic monitors the flow of segment indexes. If a streams's segment index value is
           not at the expected real time position, then the logic corrects that index value.

           Typically this logic is needed in live streaming use cases. The network bandwidth fluctuations are
           common during long run streaming. Each fluctuation can cause the segment indexes fall behind the
           expected real time position.

       init_seg_name init_name
           DASH-templated name to use for the initialization segment. Default is
           "init-stream$RepresentationID$.$ext$". "$ext$" is replaced with the file name extension specific for
           the segment format.

       ldash bool
           Enable Low-latency Dash by constraining the presence and values of some elements. This is disabled by
           default.

       lhls bool
           Enable Low-latency HLS (LHLS). Add "#EXT-X-PREFETCH" tag with current segment's URI. hls.js player
           folks are trying to standardize an open LHLS spec. The draft spec is available at
           <https://github.com/video-dev/hlsjs-rfcs/blob/lhls-spec/proposals/0001-lhls.md>.

           This option tries to comply with the above open spec. It enables streaming and hls_playlist options
           automatically.  This is an experimental feature.

           Note: This is not Apple's version LHLS. See
           <https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/draft-pantos-hls-rfc8216bis>

       master_m3u8_publish_rate segment_intervals_count
           Publish master playlist repeatedly every after specified number of segment intervals.

       max_playback_rate rate
           Set the maximum playback rate indicated as appropriate for the purposes of automatically adjusting
           playback latency and buffer occupancy during normal playback by clients.

       media_seg_name segment_name
           DASH-templated name to use for the media segments. Default is
           "chunk-stream$RepresentationID$-$Number%05d$.$ext$". "$ext$" is replaced with the file name extension
           specific for the segment format.

       method method
           Use the given HTTP method to create output files. Generally set to "PUT" or "POST".

       min_playback_rate rate
           Set the minimum playback rate indicated as appropriate for the purposes of automatically adjusting
           playback latency and buffer occupancy during normal playback by clients.

       mpd_profile flags
           Set one or more MPD manifest profiles.

           Possible values:

           dash
               MPEG-DASH ISO Base media file format live profile

           dvb_dash
               DVB-DASH profile

           Default value is "dash".

       remove_at_exit bool
           Enable or disable removal of all segments when finished. This is disabled by default.

       seg_duration duration
           Set the segment length in seconds (fractional value can be set). The value is treated as average
           segment duration when the use_template option is enabled and the use_timeline option is disabled and
           as minimum segment duration for all the other use cases.

           Default value is 5.

       single_file bool
           Enable or disable storing all segments in one file, accessed using byte ranges. This is disabled by
           default.

           The name of the single file can be specified with the single_file_name option, if not specified
           assume the basename of the manifest file with the output format extension.

       single_file_name file_name
           DASH-templated name to use for the manifest "baseURL" element. Imply that the single_file option is
           set to true. In the template, "$ext$" is replaced with the file name extension specific for the
           segment format.

       streaming bool
           Enable or disable chunk streaming mode of output. In chunk streaming mode, each frame will be a
           "moof" fragment which forms a chunk. This is disabled by default.

       target_latency target_latency
           Set an intended target latency in seconds for serving (fractional value can be set). Applicable only
           when the streaming and write_prft options are enabled. This is an informative fields clients can use
           to measure the latency of the service.

       timeout timeout
           Set timeout for socket I/O operations expressed in seconds (fractional value can be set). Applicable
           only for HTTP output.

       update_period period
           Set the MPD update period, for dynamic content. The unit is second. If set to 0, the period is
           automatically computed.

           Default value is 0.

       use_template bool
           Enable or disable use of "SegmentTemplate" instead of "SegmentList" in the manifest. This is enabled
           by default.

       use_timeline bool
           Enable or disable use of "SegmentTimeline" within the "SegmentTemplate" manifest section. This is
           enabled by default.

       utc_timing_url url
           URL of the page that will return the UTC timestamp in ISO format, for example
           "https://time.akamai.com/?iso"

       window_size size
           Set the maximum number of segments kept in the manifest, discard the oldest one. This is useful for
           live streaming.

           If the value is 0, all segments are kept in the manifest. Default value is 0.

       write_prft write_prft
           Write Producer Reference Time elements on supported streams. This also enables writing prft boxes in
           the underlying muxer. Applicable only when the utc_url option is enabled. It is set to auto by
           default, in which case the muxer will attempt to enable it only in modes that require it.

       Example

       Generate a DASH output reading from an input source in realtime using ffmpeg.

       Two multimedia streams are generated from the input file, both containing a video stream encoded through
       libx264, and an audio stream encoded with libfdk_aac. The first multimedia stream contains video with a
       bitrate of 800k and audio at the default rate, the second with video scaled to 320x170 pixels at 300k and
       audio resampled at 22005 Hz.

       The window_size option keeps only the latest 5 segments with the default duration of 5 seconds.

               ffmpeg -re -i <input> -map 0 -map 0 -c:a libfdk_aac -c:v libx264 \
               -b:v:0 800k -profile:v:0 main \
               -b:v:1 300k -s:v:1 320x170 -profile:v:1 baseline -ar:a:1 22050 \
               -bf 1 -keyint_min 120 -g 120 -sc_threshold 0 -b_strategy 0 \
               -use_timeline 1 -use_template 1 -window_size 5 \
               -adaptation_sets "id=0,streams=v id=1,streams=a" \
               -f dash /path/to/out.mpd

   daud
       D-Cinema audio muxer.

       It accepts a single 6-channels audio stream resampled at 96000 Hz encoded with the pcm_24daud codec.

       Example

       Use ffmpeg to mux input audio to a 5.1 channel layout resampled at 96000Hz:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -af aresample=96000,pan=5.1 slow.302

       For ffmpeg versions before 7.0 you might have to use the asetnsamples filter to limit the muxed packet
       size, because this format does not support muxing packets larger than 65535 bytes (3640 samples). For
       newer ffmpeg versions audio is automatically packetized to 36000 byte (2000 sample) packets.

   dv
       DV (Digital Video) muxer.

       It accepts exactly one dvvideo video stream and at most two pcm_s16 audio streams. More constraints are
       defined by the property of the video, which must correspond to a DV video supported profile, and on the
       framerate.

       Example

       Use ffmpeg to convert the input:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -s:v 720x480 -pix_fmt yuv411p -r 29.97 -ac 2 -ar 48000 -y out.dv

   ffmetadata
       FFmpeg metadata muxer.

       This muxer writes the streams metadata in the ffmetadata format.

       See the Metadata chapter for information about the format.

       Example

       Use ffmpeg to extract metadata from an input file to a metadata.ffmeta file in ffmetadata format:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f ffmetadata metadata.ffmeta

   fifo
       FIFO (First-In First-Out) muxer.

       The fifo pseudo-muxer allows the separation of encoding and muxing by using a first-in-first-out queue
       and running the actual muxer in a separate thread.

       This is especially useful in combination with the tee muxer and can be used to send data to several
       destinations with different reliability/writing speed/latency.

       The target muxer is either selected from the output name or specified through the fifo_format option.

       The behavior of the fifo muxer if the queue fills up or if the output fails (e.g. if a packet cannot be
       written to the output) is selectable:

       •   Output can be transparently restarted with configurable delay between retries based on real time or
           time of the processed stream.

       •   Encoding can be blocked during temporary failure, or continue transparently dropping packets in case
           the FIFO queue fills up.

       API users should be aware that callback functions ("interrupt_callback", "io_open" and "io_close") used
       within its "AVFormatContext" must be thread-safe.

       Options

       attempt_recovery bool
           If failure occurs, attempt to recover the output. This is especially useful when used with network
           output, since it makes it possible to restart streaming transparently. By default this option is set
           to "false".

       drop_pkts_on_overflow bool
           If set to "true", in case the fifo queue fills up, packets will be dropped rather than blocking the
           encoder. This makes it possible to continue streaming without delaying the input, at the cost of
           omitting part of the stream. By default this option is set to "false", so in such cases the encoder
           will be blocked until the muxer processes some of the packets and none of them is lost.

       fifo_format format_name
           Specify the format name. Useful if it cannot be guessed from the output name suffix.

       format_opts options
           Specify format options for the underlying muxer. Muxer options can be specified as a list of
           key=value pairs separated by ':'.

       max_recovery_attempts count
           Set maximum number of successive unsuccessful recovery attempts after which the output fails
           permanently. By default this option is set to 0 (unlimited).

       queue_size size
           Specify size of the queue as a number of packets. Default value is 60.

       recover_any_error bool
           If set to "true", recovery will be attempted regardless of type of the error causing the failure. By
           default this option is set to "false" and in case of certain (usually permanent) errors the recovery
           is not attempted even when the attempt_recovery option is set to "true".

       recovery_wait_streamtime bool
           If set to "false", the real time is used when waiting for the recovery attempt (i.e. the recovery
           will be attempted after the time specified by the recovery_wait_time option).

           If set to "true", the time of the processed stream is taken into account instead (i.e. the recovery
           will be attempted after discarding the packets corresponding to the recovery_wait_time option).

           By default this option is set to "false".

       recovery_wait_time duration
           Specify waiting time in seconds before the next recovery attempt after previous unsuccessful recovery
           attempt. Default value is 5.

       restart_with_keyframe bool
           Specify whether to wait for the keyframe after recovering from queue overflow or failure. This option
           is set to "false" by default.

       timeshift duration
           Buffer the specified amount of packets and delay writing the output. Note that the value of the
           queue_size option must be big enough to store the packets for timeshift. At the end of the input the
           fifo buffer is flushed at realtime speed.

       Example

       Use ffmpeg to stream to an RTMP server, continue processing the stream at real-time rate even in case of
       temporary failure (network outage) and attempt to recover streaming every second indefinitely:

               ffmpeg -re -i ... -c:v libx264 -c:a aac -f fifo -fifo_format flv \
                 -drop_pkts_on_overflow 1 -attempt_recovery 1 -recovery_wait_time 1 \
                 -map 0:v -map 0:a rtmp://example.com/live/stream_name

   film_cpk
       Sega film (.cpk) muxer.

       This format was used as internal format for several Sega games.

       For more information regarding the Sega film file format, visit
       <http://wiki.multimedia.cx/index.php?title=Sega_FILM>.

       It accepts at maximum one cinepak or raw video stream, and at maximum one audio stream.

   filmstrip
       Adobe Filmstrip muxer.

       This format is used by several Adobe tools to store a generated filmstrip export. It accepts a single raw
       video stream.

   fits
       Flexible Image Transport System (FITS) muxer.

       This image format is used to store astronomical data.

       For more information regarding the format, visit <https://fits.gsfc.nasa.gov>.

   flac
       Raw FLAC audio muxer.

       This muxer accepts exactly one FLAC audio stream. Additionally, it is possible to add images with
       disposition attached_pic.

       Options

       write_header bool
           write the file header if set to "true", default is "true"

       Example

       Use ffmpeg to store the audio stream from an input file, together with several pictures used with
       attached_pic disposition:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -i pic1.png -i pic2.jpg -map 0:a -map 1 -map 2 -disposition:v attached_pic OUTPUT

   flv
       Adobe Flash Video Format muxer.

       Options

       flvflags flags
           Possible values:

           aac_seq_header_detect
               Place AAC sequence header based on audio stream data.

           no_sequence_end
               Disable sequence end tag.

           no_metadata
               Disable metadata tag.

           no_duration_filesize
               Disable duration and filesize in metadata when they are equal to zero at the end of stream. (Be
               used to non-seekable living stream).

           add_keyframe_index
               Used to facilitate seeking; particularly for HTTP pseudo streaming.

   framecrc
       Per-packet CRC (Cyclic Redundancy Check) testing format.

       This muxer computes and prints the Adler-32 CRC for each audio and video packet. By default audio frames
       are converted to signed 16-bit raw audio and video frames to raw video before computing the CRC.

       The output of the muxer consists of a line for each audio and video packet of the form:

               <stream_index>, <packet_dts>, <packet_pts>, <packet_duration>, <packet_size>, 0x<CRC>

       CRC is a hexadecimal number 0-padded to 8 digits containing the CRC of the packet.

       Examples

       For example to compute the CRC of the audio and video frames in INPUT, converted to raw audio and video
       packets, and store it in the file out.crc:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f framecrc out.crc

       To print the information to stdout, use the command:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f framecrc -

       With ffmpeg, you can select the output format to which the audio and video frames are encoded before
       computing the CRC for each packet by specifying the audio and video codec. For example, to compute the
       CRC of each decoded input audio frame converted to PCM unsigned 8-bit and of each decoded input video
       frame converted to MPEG-2 video, use the command:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:a pcm_u8 -c:v mpeg2video -f framecrc -

       See also the crc muxer.

   framehash
       Per-packet hash testing format.

       This muxer computes and prints a cryptographic hash for each audio and video packet. This can be used for
       packet-by-packet equality checks without having to individually do a binary comparison on each.

       By default audio frames are converted to signed 16-bit raw audio and video frames to raw video before
       computing the hash, but the output of explicit conversions to other codecs can also be used. It uses the
       SHA-256 cryptographic hash function by default, but supports several other algorithms.

       The output of the muxer consists of a line for each audio and video packet of the form:

               <stream_index>, <packet_dts>, <packet_pts>, <packet_duration>, <packet_size>, <hash>

       hash is a hexadecimal number representing the computed hash for the packet.

       hash algorithm
           Use the cryptographic hash function specified by the string algorithm.  Supported values include
           "MD5", "murmur3", "RIPEMD128", "RIPEMD160", "RIPEMD256", "RIPEMD320", "SHA160", "SHA224", "SHA256"
           (default), "SHA512/224", "SHA512/256", "SHA384", "SHA512", "CRC32" and "adler32".

       Examples

       To compute the SHA-256 hash of the audio and video frames in INPUT, converted to raw audio and video
       packets, and store it in the file out.sha256:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f framehash out.sha256

       To print the information to stdout, using the MD5 hash function, use the command:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f framehash -hash md5 -

       See also the hash muxer.

   framemd5
       Per-packet MD5 testing format.

       This is a variant of the framehash muxer. Unlike that muxer, it defaults to using the MD5 hash function.

       Examples

       To compute the MD5 hash of the audio and video frames in INPUT, converted to raw audio and video packets,
       and store it in the file out.md5:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f framemd5 out.md5

       To print the information to stdout, use the command:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f framemd5 -

       See also the framehash and md5 muxers.

   gif
       Animated GIF muxer.

       Note that the GIF format has a very large time base: the delay between two frames can therefore not be
       smaller than one centi second.

       Options

       loop bool
           Set the number of times to loop the output. Use -1 for no loop, 0 for looping indefinitely (default).

       final_delay delay
           Force the delay (expressed in centiseconds) after the last frame. Each frame ends with a delay until
           the next frame. The default is -1, which is a special value to tell the muxer to re-use the previous
           delay. In case of a loop, you might want to customize this value to mark a pause for instance.

       Example

       Encode a gif looping 10 times, with a 5 seconds delay between the loops:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -loop 10 -final_delay 500 out.gif

       Note 1: if you wish to extract the frames into separate GIF files, you need to force the image2 muxer:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:v gif -f image2 "out%d.gif"

   gxf
       General eXchange Format (GXF) muxer.

       GXF was developed by Grass Valley Group, then standardized by SMPTE as SMPTE 360M and was extended in
       SMPTE RDD 14-2007 to include high-definition video resolutions.

       It accepts at most one video stream with codec mjpeg, or mpeg1video, or mpeg2video, or dvvideo with
       resolution 512x480 or 608x576, and several audio streams with rate 48000Hz and codec pcm16_le.

   hash
       Hash testing format.

       This muxer computes and prints a cryptographic hash of all the input audio and video frames. This can be
       used for equality checks without having to do a complete binary comparison.

       By default audio frames are converted to signed 16-bit raw audio and video frames to raw video before
       computing the hash, but the output of explicit conversions to other codecs can also be used. Timestamps
       are ignored. It uses the SHA-256 cryptographic hash function by default, but supports several other
       algorithms.

       The output of the muxer consists of a single line of the form: algo=hash, where algo is a short string
       representing the hash function used, and hash is a hexadecimal number representing the computed hash.

       hash algorithm
           Use the cryptographic hash function specified by the string algorithm.  Supported values include
           "MD5", "murmur3", "RIPEMD128", "RIPEMD160", "RIPEMD256", "RIPEMD320", "SHA160", "SHA224", "SHA256"
           (default), "SHA512/224", "SHA512/256", "SHA384", "SHA512", "CRC32" and "adler32".

       Examples

       To compute the SHA-256 hash of the input converted to raw audio and video, and store it in the file
       out.sha256:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f hash out.sha256

       To print an MD5 hash to stdout use the command:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f hash -hash md5 -

       See also the framehash muxer.

   hds
       HTTP Dynamic Streaming (HDS) muxer.

       HTTP dynamic streaming, or HDS, is an adaptive bitrate streaming method developed by Adobe. HDS delivers
       MP4 video content over HTTP connections. HDS can be used for on-demand streaming or live streaming.

       This muxer creates an .f4m (Adobe Flash Media Manifest File) manifest, an .abst (Adobe Bootstrap File)
       for each stream, and segment files in a directory specified as the output.

       These needs to be accessed by an HDS player throuhg HTTPS for it to be able to perform playback on the
       generated stream.

       Options

       extra_window_size int
           number of fragments kept outside of the manifest before removing from disk

       min_frag_duration microseconds
           minimum fragment duration (in microseconds), default value is 1 second (10000000)

       remove_at_exit bool
           remove all fragments when finished when set to "true"

       window_size int
           number of fragments kept in the manifest, if set to a value different from 0. By default all segments
           are kept in the output directory.

       Example

       Use ffmpeg to generate HDS files to the output.hds directory in real-time rate:

               ffmpeg -re -i INPUT -f hds -b:v 200k output.hds

   hls
       Apple HTTP Live Streaming muxer that segments MPEG-TS according to the HTTP Live Streaming (HLS)
       specification.

       It creates a playlist file, and one or more segment files. The output filename specifies the playlist
       filename.

       By default, the muxer creates a file for each segment produced. These files have the same name as the
       playlist, followed by a sequential number and a .ts extension.

       Make sure to require a closed GOP when encoding and to set the GOP size to fit your segment time
       constraint.

       For example, to convert an input file with ffmpeg:

               ffmpeg -i in.mkv -c:v h264 -flags +cgop -g 30 -hls_time 1 out.m3u8

       This example will produce the playlist, out.m3u8, and segment files: out0.ts, out1.ts, out2.ts, etc.

       See also the segment muxer, which provides a more generic and flexible implementation of a segmenter, and
       can be used to perform HLS segmentation.

       Options

       This muxer supports the following options:

       hls_init_time duration
           Set the initial target segment length. Default value is 0.

           duration must be a time duration specification, see the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual.

           Segment will be cut on the next key frame after this time has passed on the first m3u8 list.  After
           the initial playlist is filled ffmpeg will cut segments at duration equal to "hls_time"

       hls_time duration
           Set the target segment length. Default value is 2.

           duration must be a time duration specification, see the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual.  Segment will be cut on the next key frame after this time has passed.

       hls_list_size size
           Set the maximum number of playlist entries. If set to 0 the list file will contain all the segments.
           Default value is 5.

       hls_delete_threshold size
           Set the number of unreferenced segments to keep on disk before "hls_flags delete_segments" deletes
           them. Increase this to allow continue clients to download segments which were recently referenced in
           the playlist. Default value is 1, meaning segments older than "hls_list_size+1" will be deleted.

       hls_start_number_source
           Start the playlist sequence number ("#EXT-X-MEDIA-SEQUENCE") according to the specified source.
           Unless "hls_flags single_file" is set, it also specifies source of starting sequence numbers of
           segment and subtitle filenames. In any case, if "hls_flags append_list" is set and read playlist
           sequence number is greater than the specified start sequence number, then that value will be used as
           start value.

           It accepts the following values:

           generic (default)
               Set the starting sequence numbers according to start_number option value.

           epoch
               The start number will be the seconds since epoch (1970-01-01 00:00:00)

           epoch_us
               The start number will be the microseconds since epoch (1970-01-01 00:00:00)

           datetime
               The start number will be based on the current date/time as YYYYmmddHHMMSS. e.g. 20161231235759.

       start_number number
           Start the playlist sequence number ("#EXT-X-MEDIA-SEQUENCE") from the specified number when
           hls_start_number_source value is generic. (This is the default case.)  Unless "hls_flags single_file"
           is set, it also specifies starting sequence numbers of segment and subtitle filenames.  Default value
           is 0.

       hls_allow_cache allowcache
           Explicitly set whether the client MAY (1) or MUST NOT (0) cache media segments.

       hls_base_url baseurl
           Append baseurl to every entry in the playlist.  Useful to generate playlists with absolute paths.

           Note that the playlist sequence number must be unique for each segment and it is not to be confused
           with the segment filename sequence number which can be cyclic, for example if the wrap option is
           specified.

       hls_segment_filename filename
           Set the segment filename. Unless "hls_flags single_file" is set, filename is used as a string format
           with the segment number:

                   ffmpeg -i in.nut -hls_segment_filename 'file%03d.ts' out.m3u8

           This example will produce the playlist, out.m3u8, and segment files: file000.ts, file001.ts,
           file002.ts, etc.

           filename may contain full path or relative path specification, but only the file name part without
           any path info will be contained in the m3u8 segment list.  Should a relative path be specified, the
           path of the created segment files will be relative to the current working directory.  When
           strftime_mkdir is set, the whole expanded value of filename will be written into the m3u8 segment
           list.

           When "var_stream_map" is set with two or more variant streams, the filename pattern must contain the
           string "%v", this string specifies the position of variant stream index in the generated segment file
           names.

                   ffmpeg -i in.ts -b:v:0 1000k -b:v:1 256k -b:a:0 64k -b:a:1 32k \
                     -map 0:v -map 0:a -map 0:v -map 0:a -f hls -var_stream_map "v:0,a:0 v:1,a:1" \
                     -hls_segment_filename 'file_%v_%03d.ts' out_%v.m3u8

           This example will produce the playlists segment file sets: file_0_000.ts, file_0_001.ts,
           file_0_002.ts, etc. and file_1_000.ts, file_1_001.ts, file_1_002.ts, etc.

           The string "%v" may be present in the filename or in the last directory name containing the file, but
           only in one of them. (Additionally, %v may appear multiple times in the last sub-directory or
           filename.) If the string %v is present in the directory name, then sub-directories are created after
           expanding the directory name pattern. This enables creation of segments corresponding to different
           variant streams in subdirectories.

                   ffmpeg -i in.ts -b:v:0 1000k -b:v:1 256k -b:a:0 64k -b:a:1 32k \
                     -map 0:v -map 0:a -map 0:v -map 0:a -f hls -var_stream_map "v:0,a:0 v:1,a:1" \
                     -hls_segment_filename 'vs%v/file_%03d.ts' vs%v/out.m3u8

           This example will produce the playlists segment file sets: vs0/file_000.ts, vs0/file_001.ts,
           vs0/file_002.ts, etc. and vs1/file_000.ts, vs1/file_001.ts, vs1/file_002.ts, etc.

       strftime
           Use strftime() on filename to expand the segment filename with localtime.  The segment number is also
           available in this mode, but to use it, you need to specify second_level_segment_index hls_flag and
           %%d will be the specifier.

                   ffmpeg -i in.nut -strftime 1 -hls_segment_filename 'file-%Y%m%d-%s.ts' out.m3u8

           This example will produce the playlist, out.m3u8, and segment files: file-20160215-1455569023.ts,
           file-20160215-1455569024.ts, etc.  Note: On some systems/environments, the %s specifier is not
           available. See
             strftime() documentation.

                   ffmpeg -i in.nut -strftime 1 -hls_flags second_level_segment_index -hls_segment_filename 'file-%Y%m%d-%%04d.ts' out.m3u8

           This example will produce the playlist, out.m3u8, and segment files: file-20160215-0001.ts,
           file-20160215-0002.ts, etc.

       strftime_mkdir
           Used together with -strftime_mkdir, it will create all subdirectories which is expanded in filename.

                   ffmpeg -i in.nut -strftime 1 -strftime_mkdir 1 -hls_segment_filename '%Y%m%d/file-%Y%m%d-%s.ts' out.m3u8

           This example will create a directory 201560215 (if it does not exist), and then produce the playlist,
           out.m3u8, and segment files: 20160215/file-20160215-1455569023.ts,
           20160215/file-20160215-1455569024.ts, etc.

                   ffmpeg -i in.nut -strftime 1 -strftime_mkdir 1 -hls_segment_filename '%Y/%m/%d/file-%Y%m%d-%s.ts' out.m3u8

           This example will create a directory hierarchy 2016/02/15 (if any of them do not exist), and then
           produce the playlist, out.m3u8, and segment files: 2016/02/15/file-20160215-1455569023.ts,
           2016/02/15/file-20160215-1455569024.ts, etc.

       hls_segment_options options_list
           Set output format options using a :-separated list of key=value parameters. Values containing ":"
           special characters must be escaped.

       hls_key_info_file key_info_file
           Use the information in key_info_file for segment encryption. The first line of key_info_file
           specifies the key URI written to the playlist. The key URL is used to access the encryption key
           during playback. The second line specifies the path to the key file used to obtain the key during the
           encryption process. The key file is read as a single packed array of 16 octets in binary format. The
           optional third line specifies the initialization vector (IV) as a hexadecimal string to be used
           instead of the segment sequence number (default) for encryption. Changes to key_info_file will result
           in segment encryption with the new key/IV and an entry in the playlist for the new key URI/IV if
           "hls_flags periodic_rekey" is enabled.

           Key info file format:

                   <key URI>
                   <key file path>
                   <IV> (optional)

           Example key URIs:

                   http://server/file.key
                   /path/to/file.key
                   file.key

           Example key file paths:

                   file.key
                   /path/to/file.key

           Example IV:

                   0123456789ABCDEF0123456789ABCDEF

           Key info file example:

                   http://server/file.key
                   /path/to/file.key
                   0123456789ABCDEF0123456789ABCDEF

           Example shell script:

                   #!/bin/sh
                   BASE_URL=${1:-'.'}
                   openssl rand 16 > file.key
                   echo $BASE_URL/file.key > file.keyinfo
                   echo file.key >> file.keyinfo
                   echo $(openssl rand -hex 16) >> file.keyinfo
                   ffmpeg -f lavfi -re -i testsrc -c:v h264 -hls_flags delete_segments \
                     -hls_key_info_file file.keyinfo out.m3u8

       -hls_enc enc
           Enable (1) or disable (0) the AES128 encryption.  When enabled every segment generated is encrypted
           and the encryption key is saved as playlist name.key.

       -hls_enc_key key
           16-octet key to encrypt the segments, by default it is randomly generated.

       -hls_enc_key_url keyurl
           If set, keyurl is prepended instead of baseurl to the key filename in the playlist.

       -hls_enc_iv iv
           16-octet initialization vector for every segment instead of the autogenerated ones.

       hls_segment_type flags
           Possible values:

           mpegts
               Output segment files in MPEG-2 Transport Stream format. This is compatible with all HLS versions.

           fmp4
               Output segment files in fragmented MP4 format, similar to MPEG-DASH.  fmp4 files may be used in
               HLS version 7 and above.

       hls_fmp4_init_filename filename
           Set filename to the fragment files header file, default filename is init.mp4.

           Use "-strftime 1" on filename to expand the segment filename with localtime.

                   ffmpeg -i in.nut  -hls_segment_type fmp4 -strftime 1 -hls_fmp4_init_filename "%s_init.mp4" out.m3u8

           This will produce init like this 1602678741_init.mp4

       hls_fmp4_init_resend
           Resend init file after m3u8 file refresh every time, default is 0.

           When "var_stream_map" is set with two or more variant streams, the filename pattern must contain the
           string "%v", this string specifies the position of variant stream index in the generated init file
           names.  The string "%v" may be present in the filename or in the last directory name containing the
           file. If the string is present in the directory name, then sub-directories are created after
           expanding the directory name pattern. This enables creation of init files corresponding to different
           variant streams in subdirectories.

       hls_flags flags
           Possible values:

           single_file
               If this flag is set, the muxer will store all segments in a single MPEG-TS file, and will use
               byte ranges in the playlist. HLS playlists generated with this way will have the version number
               4.  For example:

                       ffmpeg -i in.nut -hls_flags single_file out.m3u8

               Will produce the playlist, out.m3u8, and a single segment file, out.ts.

           delete_segments
               Segment files removed from the playlist are deleted after a period of time equal to the duration
               of the segment plus the duration of the playlist.

           append_list
               Append new segments into the end of old segment list, and remove the "#EXT-X-ENDLIST" from the
               old segment list.

           round_durations
               Round the duration info in the playlist file segment info to integer values, instead of using
               floating point.  If there are no other features requiring higher HLS versions be used, then this
               will allow ffmpeg to output a HLS version 2 m3u8.

           discont_start
               Add the "#EXT-X-DISCONTINUITY" tag to the playlist, before the first segment's information.

           omit_endlist
               Do not append the "EXT-X-ENDLIST" tag at the end of the playlist.

           periodic_rekey
               The file specified by "hls_key_info_file" will be checked periodically and detect updates to the
               encryption info. Be sure to replace this file atomically, including the file containing the AES
               encryption key.

           independent_segments
               Add the "#EXT-X-INDEPENDENT-SEGMENTS" to playlists that has video segments and when all the
               segments of that playlist are guaranteed to start with a Key frame.

           iframes_only
               Add the "#EXT-X-I-FRAMES-ONLY" to playlists that has video segments and can play only I-frames in
               the "#EXT-X-BYTERANGE" mode.

           split_by_time
               Allow segments to start on frames other than keyframes. This improves behavior on some players
               when the time between keyframes is inconsistent, but may make things worse on others, and can
               cause some oddities during seeking. This flag should be used with the "hls_time" option.

           program_date_time
               Generate "EXT-X-PROGRAM-DATE-TIME" tags.

           second_level_segment_index
               Makes it possible to use segment indexes as %%d in hls_segment_filename expression besides
               date/time values when strftime is on.  To get fixed width numbers with trailing zeroes, %%0xd
               format is available where x is the required width.

           second_level_segment_size
               Makes it possible to use segment sizes (counted in bytes) as %%s in hls_segment_filename
               expression besides date/time values when strftime is on.  To get fixed width numbers with
               trailing zeroes, %%0xs format is available where x is the required width.

           second_level_segment_duration
               Makes it possible to use segment duration (calculated  in microseconds) as %%t in
               hls_segment_filename expression besides date/time values when strftime is on.  To get fixed width
               numbers with trailing zeroes, %%0xt format is available where x is the required width.

                       ffmpeg -i sample.mpeg \
                          -f hls -hls_time 3 -hls_list_size 5 \
                          -hls_flags second_level_segment_index+second_level_segment_size+second_level_segment_duration \
                          -strftime 1 -strftime_mkdir 1 -hls_segment_filename "segment_%Y%m%d%H%M%S_%%04d_%%08s_%%013t.ts" stream.m3u8

               This will produce segments like this: segment_20170102194334_0003_00122200_0000003000000.ts,
               segment_20170102194334_0004_00120072_0000003000000.ts etc.

           temp_file
               Write segment data to filename.tmp and rename to filename only once the segment is complete. A
               webserver serving up segments can be configured to reject requests to *.tmp to prevent access to
               in-progress segments before they have been added to the m3u8 playlist. This flag also affects how
               m3u8 playlist files are created.  If this flag is set, all playlist files will written into
               temporary file and renamed after they are complete, similarly as segments are handled.  But
               playlists with "file" protocol and with type ("hls_playlist_type") other than "vod" are always
               written into temporary file regardless of this flag. Master playlist files ("master_pl_name"), if
               any, with "file" protocol, are always written into temporary file regardless of this flag if
               "master_pl_publish_rate" value is other than zero.

       hls_playlist_type event
           Emit "#EXT-X-PLAYLIST-TYPE:EVENT" in the m3u8 header. Forces hls_list_size to 0; the playlist can
           only be appended to.

       hls_playlist_type vod
           Emit "#EXT-X-PLAYLIST-TYPE:VOD" in the m3u8 header. Forces hls_list_size to 0; the playlist must not
           change.

       method
           Use the given HTTP method to create the hls files.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -f hls -method PUT http://example.com/live/out.m3u8

           This example will upload all the mpegts segment files to the HTTP server using the HTTP PUT method,
           and update the m3u8 files every "refresh" times using the same method.  Note that the HTTP server
           must support the given method for uploading files.

       http_user_agent
           Override User-Agent field in HTTP header. Applicable only for HTTP output.

       var_stream_map
           Map string which specifies how to group the audio, video and subtitle streams into different variant
           streams. The variant stream groups are separated by space.  Expected string format is like this
           "a:0,v:0 a:1,v:1 ....". Here a:, v:, s: are the keys to specify audio, video and subtitle streams
           respectively.  Allowed values are 0 to 9 (limited just based on practical usage).

           When there are two or more variant streams, the output filename pattern must contain the string "%v",
           this string specifies the position of variant stream index in the output media playlist filenames.
           The string "%v" may be present in the filename or in the last directory name containing the file. If
           the string is present in the directory name, then sub-directories are created after expanding the
           directory name pattern. This enables creation of variant streams in subdirectories.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -b:v:0 1000k -b:v:1 256k -b:a:0 64k -b:a:1 32k \
                     -map 0:v -map 0:a -map 0:v -map 0:a -f hls -var_stream_map "v:0,a:0 v:1,a:1" \
                     http://example.com/live/out_%v.m3u8

           This example creates two hls variant streams. The first variant stream will contain video stream of
           bitrate 1000k and audio stream of bitrate 64k and the second variant stream will contain video stream
           of bitrate 256k and audio stream of bitrate 32k. Here, two media playlist with file names out_0.m3u8
           and out_1.m3u8 will be created. If you want something meaningful text instead of indexes in result
           names, you may specify names for each or some of the variants as in the following example.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -b:v:0 1000k -b:v:1 256k -b:a:0 64k -b:a:1 32k \
                     -map 0:v -map 0:a -map 0:v -map 0:a -f hls -var_stream_map "v:0,a:0,name:my_hd v:1,a:1,name:my_sd" \
                     http://example.com/live/out_%v.m3u8

           This example creates two hls variant streams as in the previous one.  But here, the two media
           playlist with file names out_my_hd.m3u8 and out_my_sd.m3u8 will be created.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -b:v:0 1000k -b:v:1 256k -b:a:0 64k \
                     -map 0:v -map 0:a -map 0:v -f hls -var_stream_map "v:0 a:0 v:1" \
                     http://example.com/live/out_%v.m3u8

           This example creates three hls variant streams. The first variant stream will be a video only stream
           with video bitrate 1000k, the second variant stream will be an audio only stream with bitrate 64k and
           the third variant stream will be a video only stream with bitrate 256k. Here, three media playlist
           with file names out_0.m3u8, out_1.m3u8 and out_2.m3u8 will be created.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -b:v:0 1000k -b:v:1 256k -b:a:0 64k -b:a:1 32k \
                     -map 0:v -map 0:a -map 0:v -map 0:a -f hls -var_stream_map "v:0,a:0 v:1,a:1" \
                     http://example.com/live/vs_%v/out.m3u8

           This example creates the variant streams in subdirectories. Here, the first media playlist is created
           at http://example.com/live/vs_0/out.m3u8 and the second one at http://example.com/live/vs_1/out.m3u8.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -b:a:0 32k -b:a:1 64k -b:v:0 1000k -b:v:1 3000k  \
                     -map 0:a -map 0:a -map 0:v -map 0:v -f hls \
                     -var_stream_map "a:0,agroup:aud_low a:1,agroup:aud_high v:0,agroup:aud_low v:1,agroup:aud_high" \
                     -master_pl_name master.m3u8 \
                     http://example.com/live/out_%v.m3u8

           This example creates two audio only and two video only variant streams. In addition to the
           #EXT-X-STREAM-INF tag for each variant stream in the master playlist, #EXT-X-MEDIA tag is also added
           for the two audio only variant streams and they are mapped to the two video only variant streams with
           audio group names 'aud_low' and 'aud_high'.

           By default, a single hls variant containing all the encoded streams is created.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -b:a:0 32k -b:a:1 64k -b:v:0 1000k \
                     -map 0:a -map 0:a -map 0:v -f hls \
                     -var_stream_map "a:0,agroup:aud_low,default:yes a:1,agroup:aud_low v:0,agroup:aud_low" \
                     -master_pl_name master.m3u8 \
                     http://example.com/live/out_%v.m3u8

           This example creates two audio only and one video only variant streams. In addition to the
           #EXT-X-STREAM-INF tag for each variant stream in the master playlist, #EXT-X-MEDIA tag is also added
           for the two audio only variant streams and they are mapped to the one video only variant streams with
           audio group name 'aud_low', and the audio group have default stat is NO or YES.

           By default, a single hls variant containing all the encoded streams is created.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -b:a:0 32k -b:a:1 64k -b:v:0 1000k \
                     -map 0:a -map 0:a -map 0:v -f hls \
                     -var_stream_map "a:0,agroup:aud_low,default:yes,language:ENG a:1,agroup:aud_low,language:CHN v:0,agroup:aud_low" \
                     -master_pl_name master.m3u8 \
                     http://example.com/live/out_%v.m3u8

           This example creates two audio only and one video only variant streams. In addition to the
           #EXT-X-STREAM-INF tag for each variant stream in the master playlist, #EXT-X-MEDIA tag is also added
           for the two audio only variant streams and they are mapped to the one video only variant streams with
           audio group name 'aud_low', and the audio group have default stat is NO or YES, and one audio have
           and language is named ENG, the other audio language is named CHN.

           By default, a single hls variant containing all the encoded streams is created.

                   ffmpeg -y -i input_with_subtitle.mkv \
                    -b:v:0 5250k -c:v h264 -pix_fmt yuv420p -profile:v main -level 4.1 \
                    -b:a:0 256k \
                    -c:s webvtt -c:a mp2 -ar 48000 -ac 2 -map 0:v -map 0:a:0 -map 0:s:0 \
                    -f hls -var_stream_map "v:0,a:0,s:0,sgroup:subtitle" \
                    -master_pl_name master.m3u8 -t 300 -hls_time 10 -hls_init_time 4 -hls_list_size \
                    10 -master_pl_publish_rate 10  -hls_flags \
                    delete_segments+discont_start+split_by_time ./tmp/video.m3u8

           This example adds "#EXT-X-MEDIA" tag with "TYPE=SUBTITLES" in the master playlist with webvtt
           subtitle group name 'subtitle'. Please make sure the input file has one text subtitle stream at
           least.

       cc_stream_map
           Map string which specifies different closed captions groups and their attributes. The closed captions
           stream groups are separated by space.  Expected string format is like this "ccgroup:<group
           name>,instreamid:<INSTREAM-ID>,language:<language code> ....".  'ccgroup' and 'instreamid' are
           mandatory attributes. 'language' is an optional attribute.  The closed captions groups configured
           using this option are mapped to different variant streams by providing the same 'ccgroup' name in the
           "var_stream_map" string. If "var_stream_map" is not set, then the first available ccgroup in
           "cc_stream_map" is mapped to the output variant stream. The examples for these two use cases are
           given below.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -b:v 1000k -b:a 64k -a53cc 1 -f hls \
                     -cc_stream_map "ccgroup:cc,instreamid:CC1,language:en" \
                     -master_pl_name master.m3u8 \
                     http://example.com/live/out.m3u8

           This example adds "#EXT-X-MEDIA" tag with "TYPE=CLOSED-CAPTIONS" in the master playlist with group
           name 'cc', language 'en' (english) and INSTREAM-ID 'CC1'. Also, it adds "CLOSED-CAPTIONS" attribute
           with group name 'cc' for the output variant stream.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -b:v:0 1000k -b:v:1 256k -b:a:0 64k -b:a:1 32k \
                     -a53cc:0 1 -a53cc:1 1\
                     -map 0:v -map 0:a -map 0:v -map 0:a -f hls \
                     -cc_stream_map "ccgroup:cc,instreamid:CC1,language:en ccgroup:cc,instreamid:CC2,language:sp" \
                     -var_stream_map "v:0,a:0,ccgroup:cc v:1,a:1,ccgroup:cc" \
                     -master_pl_name master.m3u8 \
                     http://example.com/live/out_%v.m3u8

           This example adds two "#EXT-X-MEDIA" tags with "TYPE=CLOSED-CAPTIONS" in the master playlist for the
           INSTREAM-IDs 'CC1' and 'CC2'. Also, it adds "CLOSED-CAPTIONS" attribute with group name 'cc' for the
           two output variant streams.

       master_pl_name
           Create HLS master playlist with the given name.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -f hls -master_pl_name master.m3u8 http://example.com/live/out.m3u8

           This example creates HLS master playlist with name master.m3u8 and it is published at
           http://example.com/live/

       master_pl_publish_rate
           Publish master play list repeatedly every after specified number of segment intervals.

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.ts -f hls -master_pl_name master.m3u8 \
                   -hls_time 2 -master_pl_publish_rate 30 http://example.com/live/out.m3u8

           This example creates HLS master playlist with name master.m3u8 and keep publishing it repeatedly
           every after 30 segments i.e. every after 60s.

       http_persistent
           Use persistent HTTP connections. Applicable only for HTTP output.

       timeout
           Set timeout for socket I/O operations. Applicable only for HTTP output.

       ignore_io_errors
           Ignore IO errors during open, write and delete. Useful for long-duration runs with network output.

       headers
           Set custom HTTP headers, can override built in default headers. Applicable only for HTTP output.

   ico
       ICO file muxer.

       Microsoft's icon file format (ICO) has some strict limitations that should be noted:

       •   Size cannot exceed 256 pixels in any dimension

       •   Only BMP and PNG images can be stored

       •   If a BMP image is used, it must be one of the following pixel formats:

                   BMP Bit Depth      FFmpeg Pixel Format
                   1bit               pal8
                   4bit               pal8
                   8bit               pal8
                   16bit              rgb555le
                   24bit              bgr24
                   32bit              bgra

       •   If a BMP image is used, it must use the BITMAPINFOHEADER DIB header

       •   If a PNG image is used, it must use the rgba pixel format

   image2
       Image file muxer.

       The image file muxer writes video frames to image files.

       The output filenames are specified by a pattern, which can be used to produce sequentially numbered
       series of files.  The pattern may contain the string "%d" or "%0Nd", this string specifies the position
       of the characters representing a numbering in the filenames. If the form "%0Nd" is used, the string
       representing the number in each filename is 0-padded to N digits. The literal character '%' can be
       specified in the pattern with the string "%%".

       If the pattern contains "%d" or "%0Nd", the first filename of the file list specified will contain the
       number 1, all the following numbers will be sequential.

       The pattern may contain a suffix which is used to automatically determine the format of the image files
       to write.

       For example the pattern "img-%03d.bmp" will specify a sequence of filenames of the form img-001.bmp,
       img-002.bmp, ..., img-010.bmp, etc.  The pattern "img%%-%d.jpg" will specify a sequence of filenames of
       the form img%-1.jpg, img%-2.jpg, ..., img%-10.jpg, etc.

       The image muxer supports the .Y.U.V image file format. This format is special in that each image frame
       consists of three files, for each of the YUV420P components. To read or write this image file format,
       specify the name of the '.Y' file. The muxer will automatically open the '.U' and '.V' files as required.

       Options

       frame_pts
           If set to 1, expand the filename with pts from pkt->pts.  Default value is 0.

       start_number
           Start the sequence from the specified number. Default value is 1.

       update
           If set to 1, the filename will always be interpreted as just a filename, not a pattern, and the
           corresponding file will be continuously overwritten with new images. Default value is 0.

       strftime
           If set to 1, expand the filename with date and time information from strftime(). Default value is 0.

       atomic_writing
           Write output to a temporary file, which is renamed to target filename once writing is completed.
           Default is disabled.

       protocol_opts options_list
           Set protocol options as a :-separated list of key=value parameters. Values containing the ":" special
           character must be escaped.

       Examples

       The following example shows how to use ffmpeg for creating a sequence of files img-001.jpeg,
       img-002.jpeg, ..., taking one image every second from the input video:

               ffmpeg -i in.avi -vsync cfr -r 1 -f image2 'img-%03d.jpeg'

       Note that with ffmpeg, if the format is not specified with the "-f" option and the output filename
       specifies an image file format, the image2 muxer is automatically selected, so the previous command can
       be written as:

               ffmpeg -i in.avi -vsync cfr -r 1 'img-%03d.jpeg'

       Note also that the pattern must not necessarily contain "%d" or "%0Nd", for example to create a single
       image file img.jpeg from the start of the input video you can employ the command:

               ffmpeg -i in.avi -f image2 -frames:v 1 img.jpeg

       The strftime option allows you to expand the filename with date and time information. Check the
       documentation of the strftime() function for the syntax.

       For example to generate image files from the strftime() "%Y-%m-%d_%H-%M-%S" pattern, the following ffmpeg
       command can be used:

               ffmpeg -f v4l2 -r 1 -i /dev/video0 -f image2 -strftime 1 "%Y-%m-%d_%H-%M-%S.jpg"

       You can set the file name with current frame's PTS:

               ffmpeg -f v4l2 -r 1 -i /dev/video0 -copyts -f image2 -frame_pts true %d.jpg

       A more complex example is to publish contents of your desktop directly to a WebDAV server every second:

               ffmpeg -f x11grab -framerate 1 -i :0.0 -q:v 6 -update 1 -protocol_opts method=PUT http://example.com/desktop.jpg

   matroska
       Matroska container muxer.

       This muxer implements the matroska and webm container specs.

       Metadata

       The recognized metadata settings in this muxer are:

       title
           Set title name provided to a single track. This gets mapped to the FileDescription element for a
           stream written as attachment.

       language
           Specify the language of the track in the Matroska languages form.

           The language can be either the 3 letters bibliographic ISO-639-2 (ISO 639-2/B) form (like "fre" for
           French), or a language code mixed with a country code for specialities in languages (like "fre-ca"
           for Canadian French).

       stereo_mode
           Set stereo 3D video layout of two views in a single video track.

           The following values are recognized:

           mono
               video is not stereo

           left_right
               Both views are arranged side by side, Left-eye view is on the left

           bottom_top
               Both views are arranged in top-bottom orientation, Left-eye view is at bottom

           top_bottom
               Both views are arranged in top-bottom orientation, Left-eye view is on top

           checkerboard_rl
               Each view is arranged in a checkerboard interleaved pattern, Left-eye view being first

           checkerboard_lr
               Each view is arranged in a checkerboard interleaved pattern, Right-eye view being first

           row_interleaved_rl
               Each view is constituted by a row based interleaving, Right-eye view is first row

           row_interleaved_lr
               Each view is constituted by a row based interleaving, Left-eye view is first row

           col_interleaved_rl
               Both views are arranged in a column based interleaving manner, Right-eye view is first column

           col_interleaved_lr
               Both views are arranged in a column based interleaving manner, Left-eye view is first column

           anaglyph_cyan_red
               All frames are in anaglyph format viewable through red-cyan filters

           right_left
               Both views are arranged side by side, Right-eye view is on the left

           anaglyph_green_magenta
               All frames are in anaglyph format viewable through green-magenta filters

           block_lr
               Both eyes laced in one Block, Left-eye view is first

           block_rl
               Both eyes laced in one Block, Right-eye view is first

       For example a 3D WebM clip can be created using the following command line:

               ffmpeg -i sample_left_right_clip.mpg -an -c:v libvpx -metadata stereo_mode=left_right -y stereo_clip.webm

       Options

       This muxer supports the following options:

       reserve_index_space
           By default, this muxer writes the index for seeking (called cues in Matroska terms) at the end of the
           file, because it cannot know in advance how much space to leave for the index at the beginning of the
           file. However for some use cases -- e.g.  streaming where seeking is possible but slow -- it is
           useful to put the index at the beginning of the file.

           If this option is set to a non-zero value, the muxer will reserve a given amount of space in the file
           header and then try to write the cues there when the muxing finishes. If the reserved space does not
           suffice, no Cues will be written, the file will be finalized and writing the trailer will return an
           error.  A safe size for most use cases should be about 50kB per hour of video.

           Note that cues are only written if the output is seekable and this option will have no effect if it
           is not.

       cues_to_front
           If set, the muxer will write the index at the beginning of the file by shifting the main data if
           necessary. This can be combined with reserve_index_space in which case the data is only shifted if
           the initially reserved space turns out to be insufficient.

           This option is ignored if the output is unseekable.

       default_mode
           This option controls how the FlagDefault of the output tracks will be set.  It influences which
           tracks players should play by default. The default mode is passthrough.

           infer
               Every track with disposition default will have the FlagDefault set.  Additionally, for each type
               of track (audio, video or subtitle), if no track with disposition default of this type exists,
               then the first track of this type will be marked as default (if existing). This ensures that the
               default flag is set in a sensible way even if the input originated from containers that lack the
               concept of default tracks.

           infer_no_subs
               This mode is the same as infer except that if no subtitle track with disposition default exists,
               no subtitle track will be marked as default.

           passthrough
               In this mode the FlagDefault is set if and only if the AV_DISPOSITION_DEFAULT flag is set in the
               disposition of the corresponding stream.

       flipped_raw_rgb
           If set to true, store positive height for raw RGB bitmaps, which indicates bitmap is stored bottom-
           up. Note that this option does not flip the bitmap which has to be done manually beforehand, e.g. by
           using the vflip filter.  Default is false and indicates bitmap is stored top down.

   md5
       MD5 testing format.

       This is a variant of the hash muxer. Unlike that muxer, it defaults to using the MD5 hash function.

       Examples

       To compute the MD5 hash of the input converted to raw audio and video, and store it in the file out.md5:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f md5 out.md5

       You can print the MD5 to stdout with the command:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f md5 -

       See also the hash and framemd5 muxers.

   mp3
       The MP3 muxer writes a raw MP3 stream with the following optional features:

       •   An ID3v2 metadata header at the beginning (enabled by default). Versions 2.3 and 2.4 are supported,
           the "id3v2_version" private option controls which one is used (3 or 4). Setting "id3v2_version" to 0
           disables the ID3v2 header completely.

           The muxer supports writing attached pictures (APIC frames) to the ID3v2 header.  The pictures are
           supplied to the muxer in form of a video stream with a single packet. There can be any number of
           those streams, each will correspond to a single APIC frame.  The stream metadata tags title and
           comment map to APIC description and picture type respectively. See <http://id3.org/id3v2.4.0-frames>
           for allowed picture types.

           Note that the APIC frames must be written at the beginning, so the muxer will buffer the audio frames
           until it gets all the pictures. It is therefore advised to provide the pictures as soon as possible
           to avoid excessive buffering.

       •   A Xing/LAME frame right after the ID3v2 header (if present). It is enabled by default, but will be
           written only if the output is seekable. The "write_xing" private option can be used to disable it.
           The frame contains various information that may be useful to the decoder, like the audio duration or
           encoder delay.

       •   A legacy ID3v1 tag at the end of the file (disabled by default). It may be enabled with the
           "write_id3v1" private option, but as its capabilities are very limited, its usage is not recommended.

       Examples:

       Write an mp3 with an ID3v2.3 header and an ID3v1 footer:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -id3v2_version 3 -write_id3v1 1 out.mp3

       To attach a picture to an mp3 file select both the audio and the picture stream with "map":

               ffmpeg -i input.mp3 -i cover.png -c copy -map 0 -map 1
               -metadata:s:v title="Album cover" -metadata:s:v comment="Cover (Front)" out.mp3

       Write a "clean" MP3 without any extra features:

               ffmpeg -i input.wav -write_xing 0 -id3v2_version 0 out.mp3

   mpegts
       MPEG transport stream muxer.

       This muxer implements ISO 13818-1 and part of ETSI EN 300 468.

       The recognized metadata settings in mpegts muxer are "service_provider" and "service_name". If they are
       not set the default for "service_provider" is FFmpeg and the default for "service_name" is Service01.

       Options

       The muxer options are:

       mpegts_transport_stream_id integer
           Set the transport_stream_id. This identifies a transponder in DVB.  Default is 0x0001.

       mpegts_original_network_id integer
           Set the original_network_id. This is unique identifier of a network in DVB. Its main use is in the
           unique identification of a service through the path Original_Network_ID, Transport_Stream_ID. Default
           is 0x0001.

       mpegts_service_id integer
           Set the service_id, also known as program in DVB. Default is 0x0001.

       mpegts_service_type integer
           Set the program service_type. Default is "digital_tv".  Accepts the following options:

           hex_value
               Any hexadecimal value between 0x01 and 0xff as defined in ETSI 300 468.

           digital_tv
               Digital TV service.

           digital_radio
               Digital Radio service.

           teletext
               Teletext service.

           advanced_codec_digital_radio
               Advanced Codec Digital Radio service.

           mpeg2_digital_hdtv
               MPEG2 Digital HDTV service.

           advanced_codec_digital_sdtv
               Advanced Codec Digital SDTV service.

           advanced_codec_digital_hdtv
               Advanced Codec Digital HDTV service.

       mpegts_pmt_start_pid integer
           Set the first PID for PMTs. Default is 0x1000, minimum is 0x0020, maximum is 0x1ffa. This option has
           no effect in m2ts mode where the PMT PID is fixed 0x0100.

       mpegts_start_pid integer
           Set the first PID for elementary streams. Default is 0x0100, minimum is 0x0020, maximum is 0x1ffa.
           This option has no effect in m2ts mode where the elementary stream PIDs are fixed.

       mpegts_m2ts_mode boolean
           Enable m2ts mode if set to 1. Default value is -1 which disables m2ts mode.

       muxrate integer
           Set a constant muxrate. Default is VBR.

       pes_payload_size integer
           Set minimum PES packet payload in bytes. Default is 2930.

       mpegts_flags flags
           Set mpegts flags. Accepts the following options:

           resend_headers
               Reemit PAT/PMT before writing the next packet.

           latm
               Use LATM packetization for AAC.

           pat_pmt_at_frames
               Reemit PAT and PMT at each video frame.

           system_b
               Conform to System B (DVB) instead of System A (ATSC).

           initial_discontinuity
               Mark the initial packet of each stream as discontinuity.

           nit Emit NIT table.

           omit_rai
               Disable writing of random access indicator.

       mpegts_copyts boolean
           Preserve original timestamps, if value is set to 1. Default value is -1, which results in shifting
           timestamps so that they start from 0.

       omit_video_pes_length boolean
           Omit the PES packet length for video packets. Default is 1 (true).

       pcr_period integer
           Override the default PCR retransmission time in milliseconds. Default is -1 which means that the PCR
           interval will be determined automatically: 20 ms is used for CBR streams, the highest multiple of the
           frame duration which is less than 100 ms is used for VBR streams.

       pat_period duration
           Maximum time in seconds between PAT/PMT tables. Default is 0.1.

       sdt_period duration
           Maximum time in seconds between SDT tables. Default is 0.5.

       nit_period duration
           Maximum time in seconds between NIT tables. Default is 0.5.

       tables_version integer
           Set PAT, PMT, SDT and NIT version (default 0, valid values are from 0 to 31, inclusively).  This
           option allows updating stream structure so that standard consumer may detect the change. To do so,
           reopen output "AVFormatContext" (in case of API usage) or restart ffmpeg instance, cyclically
           changing tables_version value:

                   ffmpeg -i source1.ts -codec copy -f mpegts -tables_version 0 udp://1.1.1.1:1111
                   ffmpeg -i source2.ts -codec copy -f mpegts -tables_version 1 udp://1.1.1.1:1111
                   ...
                   ffmpeg -i source3.ts -codec copy -f mpegts -tables_version 31 udp://1.1.1.1:1111
                   ffmpeg -i source1.ts -codec copy -f mpegts -tables_version 0 udp://1.1.1.1:1111
                   ffmpeg -i source2.ts -codec copy -f mpegts -tables_version 1 udp://1.1.1.1:1111
                   ...

       Example

               ffmpeg -i file.mpg -c copy \
                    -mpegts_original_network_id 0x1122 \
                    -mpegts_transport_stream_id 0x3344 \
                    -mpegts_service_id 0x5566 \
                    -mpegts_pmt_start_pid 0x1500 \
                    -mpegts_start_pid 0x150 \
                    -metadata service_provider="Some provider" \
                    -metadata service_name="Some Channel" \
                    out.ts

   mxf, mxf_d10, mxf_opatom
       MXF muxer.

       Options

       The muxer options are:

       store_user_comments bool
           Set if user comments should be stored if available or never.  IRT D-10 does not allow user comments.
           The default is thus to write them for mxf and mxf_opatom but not for mxf_d10

   null
       Null muxer.

       This muxer does not generate any output file, it is mainly useful for testing or benchmarking purposes.

       For example to benchmark decoding with ffmpeg you can use the command:

               ffmpeg -benchmark -i INPUT -f null out.null

       Note that the above command does not read or write the out.null file, but specifying the output file is
       required by the ffmpeg syntax.

       Alternatively you can write the command as:

               ffmpeg -benchmark -i INPUT -f null -

   nut
       -syncpoints flags
           Change the syncpoint usage in nut:

           default use the normal low-overhead seeking aids.
           none do not use the syncpoints at all, reducing the overhead but making the stream non-seekable;
                   Use of this option is not recommended, as the resulting files are very damage
                   sensitive and seeking is not possible. Also in general the overhead from
                   syncpoints is negligible. Note, -C<write_index> 0 can be used to disable
                   all growing data tables, allowing to mux endless streams with limited memory
                   and without these disadvantages.

           timestamped extend the syncpoint with a wallclock field.

           The none and timestamped flags are experimental.

       -write_index bool
           Write index at the end, the default is to write an index.

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f_strict experimental -syncpoints none - | processor

   ogg
       Ogg container muxer.

       -page_duration duration
           Preferred page duration, in microseconds. The muxer will attempt to create pages that are
           approximately duration microseconds long. This allows the user to compromise between seek granularity
           and container overhead. The default is 1 second. A value of 0 will fill all segments, making pages as
           large as possible. A value of 1 will effectively use 1 packet-per-page in most situations, giving a
           small seek granularity at the cost of additional container overhead.

       -serial_offset value
           Serial value from which to set the streams serial number.  Setting it to different and sufficiently
           large values ensures that the produced ogg files can be safely chained.

   rcwt
       Raw Captions With Time (RCWT) is a format native to ccextractor, a commonly used open source tool for
       processing 608/708 closed caption (CC) sources.  It can be used to archive the original, raw CC bitstream
       and to produce a source file for later CC processing or conversion. As a result, it also allows for
       interopability with ccextractor for processing CC data extracted via ffmpeg. The format is simple to
       parse and can be used to retain all lines and variants of CC.

       This muxer implements the specification as of 2024-01-05, which has been stable and unchanged for 10
       years as of this writing.

       This muxer will have some nuances from the way that ccextractor muxes RCWT.  No compatibility issues when
       processing the output with ccextractor have been observed as a result of this so far, but mileage may
       vary and outputs will not be a bit-exact match.

       A free specification of RCWT can be found here:
       <https://github.com/CCExtractor/ccextractor/blob/master/docs/BINARY_FILE_FORMAT.TXT>

   segment, stream_segment, ssegment
       Basic stream segmenter.

       This muxer outputs streams to a number of separate files of nearly fixed duration. Output filename
       pattern can be set in a fashion similar to image2, or by using a "strftime" template if the strftime
       option is enabled.

       "stream_segment" is a variant of the muxer used to write to streaming output formats, i.e. which do not
       require global headers, and is recommended for outputting e.g. to MPEG transport stream segments.
       "ssegment" is a shorter alias for "stream_segment".

       Every segment starts with a keyframe of the selected reference stream, which is set through the
       reference_stream option.

       Note that if you want accurate splitting for a video file, you need to make the input key frames
       correspond to the exact splitting times expected by the segmenter, or the segment muxer will start the
       new segment with the key frame found next after the specified start time.

       The segment muxer works best with a single constant frame rate video.

       Optionally it can generate a list of the created segments, by setting the option segment_list. The list
       type is specified by the segment_list_type option. The entry filenames in the segment list are set by
       default to the basename of the corresponding segment files.

       See also the hls muxer, which provides a more specific implementation for HLS segmentation.

       Options

       The segment muxer supports the following options:

       increment_tc 1|0
           if set to 1, increment timecode between each segment If this is selected, the input need to have a
           timecode in the first video stream. Default value is 0.

       reference_stream specifier
           Set the reference stream, as specified by the string specifier.  If specifier is set to "auto", the
           reference is chosen automatically. Otherwise it must be a stream specifier (see the ``Stream
           specifiers'' chapter in the ffmpeg manual) which specifies the reference stream. The default value is
           "auto".

       segment_format format
           Override the inner container format, by default it is guessed by the filename extension.

       segment_format_options options_list
           Set output format options using a :-separated list of key=value parameters. Values containing the ":"
           special character must be escaped.

       segment_list name
           Generate also a listfile named name. If not specified no listfile is generated.

       segment_list_flags flags
           Set flags affecting the segment list generation.

           It currently supports the following flags:

           cache
               Allow caching (only affects M3U8 list files).

           live
               Allow live-friendly file generation.

       segment_list_size size
           Update the list file so that it contains at most size segments. If 0 the list file will contain all
           the segments. Default value is 0.

       segment_list_entry_prefix prefix
           Prepend prefix to each entry. Useful to generate absolute paths.  By default no prefix is applied.

       segment_list_type type
           Select the listing format.

           The following values are recognized:

           flat
               Generate a flat list for the created segments, one segment per line.

           csv, ext
               Generate a list for the created segments, one segment per line, each line matching the format
               (comma-separated values):

                       <segment_filename>,<segment_start_time>,<segment_end_time>

               segment_filename is the name of the output file generated by the muxer according to the provided
               pattern. CSV escaping (according to RFC4180) is applied if required.

               segment_start_time and segment_end_time specify the segment start and end time expressed in
               seconds.

               A list file with the suffix ".csv" or ".ext" will auto-select this format.

               ext is deprecated in favor or csv.

           ffconcat
               Generate an ffconcat file for the created segments. The resulting file can be read using the
               FFmpeg concat demuxer.

               A list file with the suffix ".ffcat" or ".ffconcat" will auto-select this format.

           m3u8
               Generate an extended M3U8 file, version 3, compliant with
               <http://tools.ietf.org/id/draft-pantos-http-live-streaming>.

               A list file with the suffix ".m3u8" will auto-select this format.

           If not specified the type is guessed from the list file name suffix.

       segment_time time
           Set segment duration to time, the value must be a duration specification. Default value is "2". See
           also the segment_times option.

           Note that splitting may not be accurate, unless you force the reference stream key-frames at the
           given time. See the introductory notice and the examples below.

       min_seg_duration time
           Set minimum segment duration to time, the value must be a duration specification. This prevents the
           muxer ending segments at a duration below this value. Only effective with "segment_time". Default
           value is "0".

       segment_atclocktime 1|0
           If set to "1" split at regular clock time intervals starting from 00:00 o'clock. The time value
           specified in segment_time is used for setting the length of the splitting interval.

           For example with segment_time set to "900" this makes it possible to create files at 12:00 o'clock,
           12:15, 12:30, etc.

           Default value is "0".

       segment_clocktime_offset duration
           Delay the segment splitting times with the specified duration when using segment_atclocktime.

           For example with segment_time set to "900" and segment_clocktime_offset set to "300" this makes it
           possible to create files at 12:05, 12:20, 12:35, etc.

           Default value is "0".

       segment_clocktime_wrap_duration duration
           Force the segmenter to only start a new segment if a packet reaches the muxer within the specified
           duration after the segmenting clock time. This way you can make the segmenter more resilient to
           backward local time jumps, such as leap seconds or transition to standard time from daylight savings
           time.

           Default is the maximum possible duration which means starting a new segment regardless of the elapsed
           time since the last clock time.

       segment_time_delta delta
           Specify the accuracy time when selecting the start time for a segment, expressed as a duration
           specification. Default value is "0".

           When delta is specified a key-frame will start a new segment if its PTS satisfies the relation:

                   PTS >= start_time - time_delta

           This option is useful when splitting video content, which is always split at GOP boundaries, in case
           a key frame is found just before the specified split time.

           In particular may be used in combination with the ffmpeg option force_key_frames. The key frame times
           specified by force_key_frames may not be set accurately because of rounding issues, with the
           consequence that a key frame time may result set just before the specified time. For constant frame
           rate videos a value of 1/(2*frame_rate) should address the worst case mismatch between the specified
           time and the time set by force_key_frames.

       segment_times times
           Specify a list of split points. times contains a list of comma separated duration specifications, in
           increasing order. See also the segment_time option.

       segment_frames frames
           Specify a list of split video frame numbers. frames contains a list of comma separated integer
           numbers, in increasing order.

           This option specifies to start a new segment whenever a reference stream key frame is found and the
           sequential number (starting from 0) of the frame is greater or equal to the next value in the list.

       segment_wrap limit
           Wrap around segment index once it reaches limit.

       segment_start_number number
           Set the sequence number of the first segment. Defaults to 0.

       strftime 1|0
           Use the "strftime" function to define the name of the new segments to write. If this is selected, the
           output segment name must contain a "strftime" function template. Default value is 0.

       break_non_keyframes 1|0
           If enabled, allow segments to start on frames other than keyframes. This improves behavior on some
           players when the time between keyframes is inconsistent, but may make things worse on others, and can
           cause some oddities during seeking. Defaults to 0.

       reset_timestamps 1|0
           Reset timestamps at the beginning of each segment, so that each segment will start with near-zero
           timestamps. It is meant to ease the playback of the generated segments. May not work with some
           combinations of muxers/codecs. It is set to 0 by default.

       initial_offset offset
           Specify timestamp offset to apply to the output packet timestamps. The argument must be a time
           duration specification, and defaults to 0.

       write_empty_segments 1|0
           If enabled, write an empty segment if there are no packets during the period a segment would usually
           span. Otherwise, the segment will be filled with the next packet written. Defaults to 0.

       Make sure to require a closed GOP when encoding and to set the GOP size to fit your segment time
       constraint.

       Examples

       •   Remux the content of file in.mkv to a list of segments out-000.nut, out-001.nut, etc., and write the
           list of generated segments to out.list:

                   ffmpeg -i in.mkv -codec hevc -flags +cgop -g 60 -map 0 -f segment -segment_list out.list out%03d.nut

       •   Segment input and set output format options for the output segments:

                   ffmpeg -i in.mkv -f segment -segment_time 10 -segment_format_options movflags=+faststart out%03d.mp4

       •   Segment the input file according to the split points specified by the segment_times option:

                   ffmpeg -i in.mkv -codec copy -map 0 -f segment -segment_list out.csv -segment_times 1,2,3,5,8,13,21 out%03d.nut

       •   Use the ffmpeg force_key_frames option to force key frames in the input at the specified location,
           together with the segment option segment_time_delta to account for possible roundings operated when
           setting key frame times.

                   ffmpeg -i in.mkv -force_key_frames 1,2,3,5,8,13,21 -codec:v mpeg4 -codec:a pcm_s16le -map 0 \
                   -f segment -segment_list out.csv -segment_times 1,2,3,5,8,13,21 -segment_time_delta 0.05 out%03d.nut

           In order to force key frames on the input file, transcoding is required.

       •   Segment the input file by splitting the input file according to the frame numbers sequence specified
           with the segment_frames option:

                   ffmpeg -i in.mkv -codec copy -map 0 -f segment -segment_list out.csv -segment_frames 100,200,300,500,800 out%03d.nut

       •   Convert the in.mkv to TS segments using the "libx264" and "aac" encoders:

                   ffmpeg -i in.mkv -map 0 -codec:v libx264 -codec:a aac -f ssegment -segment_list out.list out%03d.ts

       •   Segment the input file, and create an M3U8 live playlist (can be used as live HLS source):

                   ffmpeg -re -i in.mkv -codec copy -map 0 -f segment -segment_list playlist.m3u8 \
                   -segment_list_flags +live -segment_time 10 out%03d.mkv

   smoothstreaming
       Smooth Streaming muxer generates a set of files (Manifest, chunks) suitable for serving with conventional
       web server.

       window_size
           Specify the number of fragments kept in the manifest. Default 0 (keep all).

       extra_window_size
           Specify the number of fragments kept outside of the manifest before removing from disk. Default 5.

       lookahead_count
           Specify the number of lookahead fragments. Default 2.

       min_frag_duration
           Specify the minimum fragment duration (in microseconds). Default 5000000.

       remove_at_exit
           Specify whether to remove all fragments when finished. Default 0 (do not remove).

   streamhash
       Per stream hash testing format.

       This muxer computes and prints a cryptographic hash of all the input frames, on a per-stream basis. This
       can be used for equality checks without having to do a complete binary comparison.

       By default audio frames are converted to signed 16-bit raw audio and video frames to raw video before
       computing the hash, but the output of explicit conversions to other codecs can also be used. Timestamps
       are ignored. It uses the SHA-256 cryptographic hash function by default, but supports several other
       algorithms.

       The output of the muxer consists of one line per stream of the form: streamindex,streamtype,algo=hash,
       where streamindex is the index of the mapped stream, streamtype is a single character indicating the type
       of stream, algo is a short string representing the hash function used, and hash is a hexadecimal number
       representing the computed hash.

       hash algorithm
           Use the cryptographic hash function specified by the string algorithm.  Supported values include
           "MD5", "murmur3", "RIPEMD128", "RIPEMD160", "RIPEMD256", "RIPEMD320", "SHA160", "SHA224", "SHA256"
           (default), "SHA512/224", "SHA512/256", "SHA384", "SHA512", "CRC32" and "adler32".

       Examples

       To compute the SHA-256 hash of the input converted to raw audio and video, and store it in the file
       out.sha256:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f streamhash out.sha256

       To print an MD5 hash to stdout use the command:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f streamhash -hash md5 -

       See also the hash and framehash muxers.

   tee
       The tee muxer can be used to write the same data to several outputs, such as files or streams.  It can be
       used, for example, to stream a video over a network and save it to disk at the same time.

       It is different from specifying several outputs to the ffmpeg command-line tool. With the tee muxer, the
       audio and video data will be encoded only once.  With conventional multiple outputs, multiple encoding
       operations in parallel are initiated, which can be a very expensive process. The tee muxer is not useful
       when using the libavformat API directly because it is then possible to feed the same packets to several
       muxers directly.

       Since the tee muxer does not represent any particular output format, ffmpeg cannot auto-select output
       streams. So all streams intended for output must be specified using "-map". See the examples below.

       Some encoders may need different options depending on the output format; the auto-detection of this can
       not work with the tee muxer, so they need to be explicitly specified.  The main example is the
       global_header flag.

       The slave outputs are specified in the file name given to the muxer, separated by '|'. If any of the
       slave name contains the '|' separator, leading or trailing spaces or any special character, those must be
       escaped (see the "Quoting and escaping" section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual).

       Options

       use_fifo bool
           If set to 1, slave outputs will be processed in separate threads using the fifo muxer. This allows to
           compensate for different speed/latency/reliability of outputs and setup transparent recovery. By
           default this feature is turned off.

       fifo_options
           Options to pass to fifo pseudo-muxer instances. See fifo.

       Muxer options can be specified for each slave by prepending them as a list of key=value pairs separated
       by ':', between square brackets. If the options values contain a special character or the ':' separator,
       they must be escaped; note that this is a second level escaping.

       The following special options are also recognized:

       f   Specify the format name. Required if it cannot be guessed from the output URL.

       bsfs[/spec]
           Specify a list of bitstream filters to apply to the specified output.

           It is possible to specify to which streams a given bitstream filter applies, by appending a stream
           specifier to the option separated by "/". spec must be a stream specifier (see Format stream
           specifiers).

           If the stream specifier is not specified, the bitstream filters will be applied to all streams in the
           output. This will cause that output operation to fail if the output contains streams to which the
           bitstream filter cannot be applied e.g. "h264_mp4toannexb" being applied to an output containing an
           audio stream.

           Options for a bitstream filter must be specified in the form of "opt=value".

           Several bitstream filters can be specified, separated by ",".

       use_fifo bool
           This allows to override tee muxer use_fifo option for individual slave muxer.

       fifo_options
           This allows to override tee muxer fifo_options for individual slave muxer.  See fifo.

       select
           Select the streams that should be mapped to the slave output, specified by a stream specifier. If not
           specified, this defaults to all the mapped streams. This will cause that output operation to fail if
           the output format does not accept all mapped streams.

           You may use multiple stream specifiers separated by commas (",") e.g.: "a:0,v"

       onfail
           Specify behaviour on output failure. This can be set to either "abort" (which is default) or
           "ignore". "abort" will cause whole process to fail in case of failure on this slave output. "ignore"
           will ignore failure on this output, so other outputs will continue without being affected.

       Examples

       •   Encode something and both archive it in a WebM file and stream it as MPEG-TS over UDP:

                   ffmpeg -i ... -c:v libx264 -c:a mp2 -f tee -map 0:v -map 0:a
                     "archive-20121107.mkv|[f=mpegts]udp://10.0.1.255:1234/"

       •   As above, but continue streaming even if output to local file fails (for example local drive fills
           up):

                   ffmpeg -i ... -c:v libx264 -c:a mp2 -f tee -map 0:v -map 0:a
                     "[onfail=ignore]archive-20121107.mkv|[f=mpegts]udp://10.0.1.255:1234/"

       •   Use ffmpeg to encode the input, and send the output to three different destinations. The "dump_extra"
           bitstream filter is used to add extradata information to all the output video keyframes packets, as
           requested by the MPEG-TS format. The select option is applied to out.aac in order to make it contain
           only audio packets.

                   ffmpeg -i ... -map 0 -flags +global_header -c:v libx264 -c:a aac
                          -f tee "[bsfs/v=dump_extra=freq=keyframe]out.ts|[movflags=+faststart]out.mp4|[select=a]out.aac"

       •   As above, but select only stream "a:1" for the audio output. Note that a second level escaping must
           be performed, as ":" is a special character used to separate options.

                   ffmpeg -i ... -map 0 -flags +global_header -c:v libx264 -c:a aac
                          -f tee "[bsfs/v=dump_extra=freq=keyframe]out.ts|[movflags=+faststart]out.mp4|[select=\'a:1\']out.aac"

   webm_chunk
       WebM Live Chunk Muxer.

       This muxer writes out WebM headers and chunks as separate files which can be consumed by clients that
       support WebM Live streams via DASH.

       Options

       This muxer supports the following options:

       chunk_start_index
           Index of the first chunk (defaults to 0).

       header
           Filename of the header where the initialization data will be written.

       audio_chunk_duration
           Duration of each audio chunk in milliseconds (defaults to 5000).

       Example

               ffmpeg -f v4l2 -i /dev/video0 \
                      -f alsa -i hw:0 \
                      -map 0:0 \
                      -c:v libvpx-vp9 \
                      -s 640x360 -keyint_min 30 -g 30 \
                      -f webm_chunk \
                      -header webm_live_video_360.hdr \
                      -chunk_start_index 1 \
                      webm_live_video_360_%d.chk \
                      -map 1:0 \
                      -c:a libvorbis \
                      -b:a 128k \
                      -f webm_chunk \
                      -header webm_live_audio_128.hdr \
                      -chunk_start_index 1 \
                      -audio_chunk_duration 1000 \
                      webm_live_audio_128_%d.chk

   webm_dash_manifest
       WebM DASH Manifest muxer.

       This muxer implements the WebM DASH Manifest specification to generate the DASH manifest XML. It also
       supports manifest generation for DASH live streams.

       For more information see:

       •   WebM DASH Specification:
           <https://sites.google.com/a/webmproject.org/wiki/adaptive-streaming/webm-dash-specification>

       •   ISO DASH Specification:
           <http://standards.iso.org/ittf/PubliclyAvailableStandards/c065274_ISO_IEC_23009-1_2014.zip>

       Options

       This muxer supports the following options:

       adaptation_sets
           This option has the following syntax: "id=x,streams=a,b,c id=y,streams=d,e" where x and y are the
           unique identifiers of the adaptation sets and a,b,c,d and e are the indices of the corresponding
           audio and video streams. Any number of adaptation sets can be added using this option.

       live
           Set this to 1 to create a live stream DASH Manifest. Default: 0.

       chunk_start_index
           Start index of the first chunk. This will go in the startNumber attribute of the SegmentTemplate
           element in the manifest. Default: 0.

       chunk_duration_ms
           Duration of each chunk in milliseconds. This will go in the duration attribute of the SegmentTemplate
           element in the manifest. Default: 1000.

       utc_timing_url
           URL of the page that will return the UTC timestamp in ISO format. This will go in the value attribute
           of the UTCTiming element in the manifest.  Default: None.

       time_shift_buffer_depth
           Smallest time (in seconds) shifting buffer for which any Representation is guaranteed to be
           available. This will go in the timeShiftBufferDepth attribute of the MPD element. Default: 60.

       minimum_update_period
           Minimum update period (in seconds) of the manifest. This will go in the minimumUpdatePeriod attribute
           of the MPD element. Default: 0.

       Example

               ffmpeg -f webm_dash_manifest -i video1.webm \
                      -f webm_dash_manifest -i video2.webm \
                      -f webm_dash_manifest -i audio1.webm \
                      -f webm_dash_manifest -i audio2.webm \
                      -map 0 -map 1 -map 2 -map 3 \
                      -c copy \
                      -f webm_dash_manifest \
                      -adaptation_sets "id=0,streams=0,1 id=1,streams=2,3" \
                      manifest.xml

METADATA

       FFmpeg is able to dump metadata from media files into a simple UTF-8-encoded INI-like text file and then
       load it back using the metadata muxer/demuxer.

       The file format is as follows:

       1.  A file consists of a header and a number of metadata tags divided into sections, each on its own
           line.

       2.  The header is a ;FFMETADATA string, followed by a version number (now 1).

       3.  Metadata tags are of the form key=value

       4.  Immediately after header follows global metadata

       5.  After global metadata there may be sections with per-stream/per-chapter metadata.

       6.  A section starts with the section name in uppercase (i.e. STREAM or CHAPTER) in brackets ([, ]) and
           ends with next section or end of file.

       7.  At the beginning of a chapter section there may be an optional timebase to be used for start/end
           values. It must be in form TIMEBASE=num/den, where num and den are integers. If the timebase is
           missing then start/end times are assumed to be in nanoseconds.

           Next a chapter section must contain chapter start and end times in form START=num, END=num, where num
           is a positive integer.

       8.  Empty lines and lines starting with ; or # are ignored.

       9.  Metadata keys or values containing special characters (=, ;, #, \ and a newline) must be escaped with
           a backslash \.

       10. Note that whitespace in metadata (e.g. foo = bar) is considered to be a part of the tag (in the
           example above key is foo , value is
            bar).

       A ffmetadata file might look like this:

               ;FFMETADATA1
               title=bike\\shed
               ;this is a comment
               artist=FFmpeg troll team

               [CHAPTER]
               TIMEBASE=1/1000
               START=0
               #chapter ends at 0:01:00
               END=60000
               title=chapter \#1
               [STREAM]
               title=multi\
               line

       By using the ffmetadata muxer and demuxer it is possible to extract metadata from an input file to an
       ffmetadata file, and then transcode the file into an output file with the edited ffmetadata file.

       Extracting an ffmetadata file with ffmpeg goes as follows:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f ffmetadata FFMETADATAFILE

       Reinserting edited metadata information from the FFMETADATAFILE file can be done as:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -i FFMETADATAFILE -map_metadata 1 -codec copy OUTPUT

PROTOCOL OPTIONS

       The libavformat library provides some generic global options, which can be set on all the protocols. In
       addition each protocol may support so-called private options, which are specific for that component.

       Options may be set by specifying -option value in the FFmpeg tools, or by setting the value explicitly in
       the "AVFormatContext" options or using the libavutil/opt.h API for programmatic use.

       The list of supported options follows:

       protocol_whitelist list (input)
           Set a ","-separated list of allowed protocols. "ALL" matches all protocols. Protocols prefixed by "-"
           are disabled.  All protocols are allowed by default but protocols used by an another protocol (nested
           protocols) are restricted to a per protocol subset.

PROTOCOLS

       Protocols are configured elements in FFmpeg that enable access to resources that require specific
       protocols.

       When you configure your FFmpeg build, all the supported protocols are enabled by default. You can list
       all available ones using the configure option "--list-protocols".

       You can disable all the protocols using the configure option "--disable-protocols", and selectively
       enable a protocol using the option "--enable-protocol=PROTOCOL", or you can disable a particular protocol
       using the option "--disable-protocol=PROTOCOL".

       The option "-protocols" of the ff* tools will display the list of supported protocols.

       All protocols accept the following options:

       rw_timeout
           Maximum time to wait for (network) read/write operations to complete, in microseconds.

       A description of the currently available protocols follows.

   amqp
       Advanced Message Queueing Protocol (AMQP) version 0-9-1 is a broker based publish-subscribe communication
       protocol.

       FFmpeg must be compiled with --enable-librabbitmq to support AMQP. A separate AMQP broker must also be
       run. An example open-source AMQP broker is RabbitMQ.

       After starting the broker, an FFmpeg client may stream data to the broker using the command:

               ffmpeg -re -i input -f mpegts amqp://[[user]:[password]@]hostname[:port][/vhost]

       Where hostname and port (default is 5672) is the address of the broker. The client may also set a
       user/password for authentication. The default for both fields is "guest". Name of virtual host on broker
       can be set with vhost. The default value is "/".

       Muliple subscribers may stream from the broker using the command:

               ffplay amqp://[[user]:[password]@]hostname[:port][/vhost]

       In RabbitMQ all data published to the broker flows through a specific exchange, and each subscribing
       client has an assigned queue/buffer. When a packet arrives at an exchange, it may be copied to a client's
       queue depending on the exchange and routing_key fields.

       The following options are supported:

       exchange
           Sets the exchange to use on the broker. RabbitMQ has several predefined exchanges: "amq.direct" is
           the default exchange, where the publisher and subscriber must have a matching routing_key;
           "amq.fanout" is the same as a broadcast operation (i.e. the data is forwarded to all queues on the
           fanout exchange independent of the routing_key); and "amq.topic" is similar to "amq.direct", but
           allows for more complex pattern matching (refer to the RabbitMQ documentation).

       routing_key
           Sets the routing key. The default value is "amqp". The routing key is used on the "amq.direct" and
           "amq.topic" exchanges to decide whether packets are written to the queue of a subscriber.

       pkt_size
           Maximum size of each packet sent/received to the broker. Default is 131072.  Minimum is 4096 and max
           is any large value (representable by an int). When receiving packets, this sets an internal buffer
           size in FFmpeg. It should be equal to or greater than the size of the published packets to the
           broker. Otherwise the received message may be truncated causing decoding errors.

       connection_timeout
           The timeout in seconds during the initial connection to the broker. The default value is rw_timeout,
           or 5 seconds if rw_timeout is not set.

       delivery_mode mode
           Sets the delivery mode of each message sent to broker.  The following values are accepted:

           persistent
               Delivery mode set to "persistent" (2). This is the default value.  Messages may be written to the
               broker's disk depending on its setup.

           non-persistent
               Delivery mode set to "non-persistent" (1).  Messages will stay in broker's memory unless the
               broker is under memory pressure.

   async
       Asynchronous data filling wrapper for input stream.

       Fill data in a background thread, to decouple I/O operation from demux thread.

               async:<URL>
               async:http://host/resource
               async:cache:http://host/resource

   bluray
       Read BluRay playlist.

       The accepted options are:

       angle
           BluRay angle

       chapter
           Start chapter (1...N)

       playlist
           Playlist to read (BDMV/PLAYLIST/?????.mpls)

       Examples:

       Read longest playlist from BluRay mounted to /mnt/bluray:

               bluray:/mnt/bluray

       Read angle 2 of playlist 4 from BluRay mounted to /mnt/bluray, start from chapter 2:

               -playlist 4 -angle 2 -chapter 2 bluray:/mnt/bluray

   cache
       Caching wrapper for input stream.

       Cache the input stream to temporary file. It brings seeking capability to live streams.

       The accepted options are:

       read_ahead_limit
           Amount in bytes that may be read ahead when seeking isn't supported. Range is -1 to INT_MAX.  -1 for
           unlimited. Default is 65536.

       URL Syntax is

               cache:<URL>

   concat
       Physical concatenation protocol.

       Read and seek from many resources in sequence as if they were a unique resource.

       A URL accepted by this protocol has the syntax:

               concat:<URL1>|<URL2>|...|<URLN>

       where URL1, URL2, ..., URLN are the urls of the resource to be concatenated, each one possibly specifying
       a distinct protocol.

       For example to read a sequence of files split1.mpeg, split2.mpeg, split3.mpeg with ffplay use the
       command:

               ffplay concat:split1.mpeg\|split2.mpeg\|split3.mpeg

       Note that you may need to escape the character "|" which is special for many shells.

   concatf
       Physical concatenation protocol using a line break delimited list of resources.

       Read and seek from many resources in sequence as if they were a unique resource.

       A URL accepted by this protocol has the syntax:

               concatf:<URL>

       where URL is the url containing a line break delimited list of resources to be concatenated, each one
       possibly specifying a distinct protocol. Special characters must be escaped with backslash or single
       quotes. See the "Quoting and escaping" section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual.

       For example to read a sequence of files split1.mpeg, split2.mpeg, split3.mpeg listed in separate lines
       within a file split.txt with ffplay use the command:

               ffplay concatf:split.txt

       Where split.txt contains the lines:

               split1.mpeg
               split2.mpeg
               split3.mpeg

   crypto
       AES-encrypted stream reading protocol.

       The accepted options are:

       key Set the AES decryption key binary block from given hexadecimal representation.

       iv  Set the AES decryption initialization vector binary block from given hexadecimal representation.

       Accepted URL formats:

               crypto:<URL>
               crypto+<URL>

   data
       Data in-line in the URI. See <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Data_URI_scheme>.

       For example, to convert a GIF file given inline with ffmpeg:

               ffmpeg -i "data:image/gif;base64,R0lGODdhCAAIAMIEAAAAAAAA//8AAP//AP///////////////ywAAAAACAAIAAADF0gEDLojDgdGiJdJqUX02iB4E8Q9jUMkADs=" smiley.png

   fd
       File descriptor access protocol.

       The accepted syntax is:

               fd: -fd <file_descriptor>

       If fd is not specified, by default the stdout file descriptor will be used for writing, stdin for
       reading. Unlike the pipe protocol, fd protocol has seek support if it corresponding to a regular file. fd
       protocol doesn't support pass file descriptor via URL for security.

       This protocol accepts the following options:

       blocksize
           Set I/O operation maximum block size, in bytes. Default value is "INT_MAX", which results in not
           limiting the requested block size.  Setting this value reasonably low improves user termination
           request reaction time, which is valuable if data transmission is slow.

       fd  Set file descriptor.

   file
       File access protocol.

       Read from or write to a file.

       A file URL can have the form:

               file:<filename>

       where filename is the path of the file to read.

       An URL that does not have a protocol prefix will be assumed to be a file URL. Depending on the build, an
       URL that looks like a Windows path with the drive letter at the beginning will also be assumed to be a
       file URL (usually not the case in builds for unix-like systems).

       For example to read from a file input.mpeg with ffmpeg use the command:

               ffmpeg -i file:input.mpeg output.mpeg

       This protocol accepts the following options:

       truncate
           Truncate existing files on write, if set to 1. A value of 0 prevents truncating. Default value is 1.

       blocksize
           Set I/O operation maximum block size, in bytes. Default value is "INT_MAX", which results in not
           limiting the requested block size.  Setting this value reasonably low improves user termination
           request reaction time, which is valuable for files on slow medium.

       follow
           If set to 1, the protocol will retry reading at the end of the file, allowing reading files that
           still are being written. In order for this to terminate, you either need to use the rw_timeout
           option, or use the interrupt callback (for API users).

       seekable
           Controls if seekability is advertised on the file. 0 means non-seekable, -1 means auto (seekable for
           normal files, non-seekable for named pipes).

           Many demuxers handle seekable and non-seekable resources differently, overriding this might speed up
           opening certain files at the cost of losing some features (e.g. accurate seeking).

   ftp
       FTP (File Transfer Protocol).

       Read from or write to remote resources using FTP protocol.

       Following syntax is required.

               ftp://[user[:password]@]server[:port]/path/to/remote/resource.mpeg

       This protocol accepts the following options.

       timeout
           Set timeout in microseconds of socket I/O operations used by the underlying low level operation. By
           default it is set to -1, which means that the timeout is not specified.

       ftp-user
           Set a user to be used for authenticating to the FTP server. This is overridden by the user in the FTP
           URL.

       ftp-password
           Set a password to be used for authenticating to the FTP server. This is overridden by the password in
           the FTP URL, or by ftp-anonymous-password if no user is set.

       ftp-anonymous-password
           Password used when login as anonymous user. Typically an e-mail address should be used.

       ftp-write-seekable
           Control seekability of connection during encoding. If set to 1 the resource is supposed to be
           seekable, if set to 0 it is assumed not to be seekable. Default value is 0.

       NOTE: Protocol can be used as output, but it is recommended to not do it, unless special care is taken
       (tests, customized server configuration etc.). Different FTP servers behave in different way during seek
       operation. ff* tools may produce incomplete content due to server limitations.

   gopher
       Gopher protocol.

   gophers
       Gophers protocol.

       The Gopher protocol with TLS encapsulation.

   hls
       Read Apple HTTP Live Streaming compliant segmented stream as a uniform one. The M3U8 playlists describing
       the segments can be remote HTTP resources or local files, accessed using the standard file protocol.  The
       nested protocol is declared by specifying "+proto" after the hls URI scheme name, where proto is either
       "file" or "http".

               hls+http://host/path/to/remote/resource.m3u8
               hls+file://path/to/local/resource.m3u8

       Using this protocol is discouraged - the hls demuxer should work just as well (if not, please report the
       issues) and is more complete.  To use the hls demuxer instead, simply use the direct URLs to the m3u8
       files.

   http
       HTTP (Hyper Text Transfer Protocol).

       This protocol accepts the following options:

       seekable
           Control seekability of connection. If set to 1 the resource is supposed to be seekable, if set to 0
           it is assumed not to be seekable, if set to -1 it will try to autodetect if it is seekable. Default
           value is -1.

       chunked_post
           If set to 1 use chunked Transfer-Encoding for posts, default is 1.

       content_type
           Set a specific content type for the POST messages or for listen mode.

       http_proxy
           set HTTP proxy to tunnel through e.g. http://example.com:1234

       headers
           Set custom HTTP headers, can override built in default headers. The value must be a string encoding
           the headers.

       multiple_requests
           Use persistent connections if set to 1, default is 0.

       post_data
           Set custom HTTP post data.

       referer
           Set the Referer header. Include 'Referer: URL' header in HTTP request.

       user_agent
           Override the User-Agent header. If not specified the protocol will use a string describing the
           libavformat build. ("Lavf/<version>")

       reconnect_at_eof
           If set then eof is treated like an error and causes reconnection, this is useful for live / endless
           streams.

       reconnect_streamed
           If set then even streamed/non seekable streams will be reconnected on errors.

       reconnect_on_network_error
           Reconnect automatically in case of TCP/TLS errors during connect.

       reconnect_on_http_error
           A comma separated list of HTTP status codes to reconnect on. The list can include specific status
           codes (e.g. '503') or the strings '4xx' / '5xx'.

       reconnect_delay_max
           Sets the maximum delay in seconds after which to give up reconnecting

       mime_type
           Export the MIME type.

       http_version
           Exports the HTTP response version number. Usually "1.0" or "1.1".

       icy If set to 1 request ICY (SHOUTcast) metadata from the server. If the server supports this, the
           metadata has to be retrieved by the application by reading the icy_metadata_headers and
           icy_metadata_packet options.  The default is 1.

       icy_metadata_headers
           If the server supports ICY metadata, this contains the ICY-specific HTTP reply headers, separated by
           newline characters.

       icy_metadata_packet
           If the server supports ICY metadata, and icy was set to 1, this contains the last non-empty metadata
           packet sent by the server. It should be polled in regular intervals by applications interested in
           mid-stream metadata updates.

       cookies
           Set the cookies to be sent in future requests. The format of each cookie is the same as the value of
           a Set-Cookie HTTP response field. Multiple cookies can be delimited by a newline character.

       offset
           Set initial byte offset.

       end_offset
           Try to limit the request to bytes preceding this offset.

       method
           When used as a client option it sets the HTTP method for the request.

           When used as a server option it sets the HTTP method that is going to be expected from the client(s).
           If the expected and the received HTTP method do not match the client will be given a Bad Request
           response.  When unset the HTTP method is not checked for now. This will be replaced by autodetection
           in the future.

       listen
           If set to 1 enables experimental HTTP server. This can be used to send data when used as an output
           option, or read data from a client with HTTP POST when used as an input option.  If set to 2 enables
           experimental multi-client HTTP server. This is not yet implemented in ffmpeg.c and thus must not be
           used as a command line option.

                   # Server side (sending):
                   ffmpeg -i somefile.ogg -c copy -listen 1 -f ogg http://<server>:<port>

                   # Client side (receiving):
                   ffmpeg -i http://<server>:<port> -c copy somefile.ogg

                   # Client can also be done with wget:
                   wget http://<server>:<port> -O somefile.ogg

                   # Server side (receiving):
                   ffmpeg -listen 1 -i http://<server>:<port> -c copy somefile.ogg

                   # Client side (sending):
                   ffmpeg -i somefile.ogg -chunked_post 0 -c copy -f ogg http://<server>:<port>

                   # Client can also be done with wget:
                   wget --post-file=somefile.ogg http://<server>:<port>

       send_expect_100
           Send an Expect: 100-continue header for POST. If set to 1 it will send, if set to 0 it won't, if set
           to -1 it will try to send if it is applicable. Default value is -1.

       auth_type
           Set HTTP authentication type. No option for Digest, since this method requires getting nonce
           parameters from the server first and can't be used straight away like Basic.

           none
               Choose the HTTP authentication type automatically. This is the default.

           basic
               Choose the HTTP basic authentication.

               Basic authentication sends a Base64-encoded string that contains a user name and password for the
               client. Base64 is not a form of encryption and should be considered the same as sending the user
               name and password in clear text (Base64 is a reversible encoding).  If a resource needs to be
               protected, strongly consider using an authentication scheme other than basic authentication.
               HTTPS/TLS should be used with basic authentication.  Without these additional security
               enhancements, basic authentication should not be used to protect sensitive or valuable
               information.

       HTTP Cookies

       Some HTTP requests will be denied unless cookie values are passed in with the request. The cookies option
       allows these cookies to be specified. At the very least, each cookie must specify a value along with a
       path and domain.  HTTP requests that match both the domain and path will automatically include the cookie
       value in the HTTP Cookie header field. Multiple cookies can be delimited by a newline.

       The required syntax to play a stream specifying a cookie is:

               ffplay -cookies "nlqptid=nltid=tsn; path=/; domain=somedomain.com;" http://somedomain.com/somestream.m3u8

   Icecast
       Icecast protocol (stream to Icecast servers)

       This protocol accepts the following options:

       ice_genre
           Set the stream genre.

       ice_name
           Set the stream name.

       ice_description
           Set the stream description.

       ice_url
           Set the stream website URL.

       ice_public
           Set if the stream should be public.  The default is 0 (not public).

       user_agent
           Override the User-Agent header. If not specified a string of the form "Lavf/<version>" will be used.

       password
           Set the Icecast mountpoint password.

       content_type
           Set the stream content type. This must be set if it is different from audio/mpeg.

       legacy_icecast
           This enables support for Icecast versions < 2.4.0, that do not support the HTTP PUT method but the
           SOURCE method.

       tls Establish a TLS (HTTPS) connection to Icecast.

               icecast://[<username>[:<password>]@]<server>:<port>/<mountpoint>

   ipfs
       InterPlanetary File System (IPFS) protocol support. One can access files stored on the IPFS network
       through so-called gateways. These are http(s) endpoints.  This protocol wraps the IPFS native protocols
       (ipfs:// and ipns://) to be sent to such a gateway. Users can (and should) host their own node which
       means this protocol will use one's local gateway to access files on the IPFS network.

       This protocol accepts the following options:

       gateway
           Defines the gateway to use. When not set, the protocol will first try locating the local gateway by
           looking at $IPFS_GATEWAY, $IPFS_PATH and "$HOME/.ipfs/", in that order.

       One can use this protocol in 2 ways. Using IPFS:

               ffplay ipfs://<hash>

       Or the IPNS protocol (IPNS is mutable IPFS):

               ffplay ipns://<hash>

   mmst
       MMS (Microsoft Media Server) protocol over TCP.

   mmsh
       MMS (Microsoft Media Server) protocol over HTTP.

       The required syntax is:

               mmsh://<server>[:<port>][/<app>][/<playpath>]

   md5
       MD5 output protocol.

       Computes the MD5 hash of the data to be written, and on close writes this to the designated output or
       stdout if none is specified. It can be used to test muxers without writing an actual file.

       Some examples follow.

               # Write the MD5 hash of the encoded AVI file to the file output.avi.md5.
               ffmpeg -i input.flv -f avi -y md5:output.avi.md5

               # Write the MD5 hash of the encoded AVI file to stdout.
               ffmpeg -i input.flv -f avi -y md5:

       Note that some formats (typically MOV) require the output protocol to be seekable, so they will fail with
       the MD5 output protocol.

   pipe
       UNIX pipe access protocol.

       Read and write from UNIX pipes.

       The accepted syntax is:

               pipe:[<number>]

       If fd isn't specified, number is the number corresponding to the file descriptor of the pipe (e.g. 0 for
       stdin, 1 for stdout, 2 for stderr).  If number is not specified, by default the stdout file descriptor
       will be used for writing, stdin for reading.

       For example to read from stdin with ffmpeg:

               cat test.wav | ffmpeg -i pipe:0
               # ...this is the same as...
               cat test.wav | ffmpeg -i pipe:

       For writing to stdout with ffmpeg:

               ffmpeg -i test.wav -f avi pipe:1 | cat > test.avi
               # ...this is the same as...
               ffmpeg -i test.wav -f avi pipe: | cat > test.avi

       This protocol accepts the following options:

       blocksize
           Set I/O operation maximum block size, in bytes. Default value is "INT_MAX", which results in not
           limiting the requested block size.  Setting this value reasonably low improves user termination
           request reaction time, which is valuable if data transmission is slow.

       fd  Set file descriptor.

       Note that some formats (typically MOV), require the output protocol to be seekable, so they will fail
       with the pipe output protocol.

   prompeg
       Pro-MPEG Code of Practice #3 Release 2 FEC protocol.

       The Pro-MPEG CoP#3 FEC is a 2D parity-check forward error correction mechanism for MPEG-2 Transport
       Streams sent over RTP.

       This protocol must be used in conjunction with the "rtp_mpegts" muxer and the "rtp" protocol.

       The required syntax is:

               -f rtp_mpegts -fec prompeg=<option>=<val>... rtp://<hostname>:<port>

       The destination UDP ports are "port + 2" for the column FEC stream and "port + 4" for the row FEC stream.

       This protocol accepts the following options:

       l=n The number of columns (4-20, LxD <= 100)

       d=n The number of rows (4-20, LxD <= 100)

       Example usage:

               -f rtp_mpegts -fec prompeg=l=8:d=4 rtp://<hostname>:<port>

   rist
       Reliable Internet Streaming Transport protocol

       The accepted options are:

       rist_profile
           Supported values:

           simple
           main
               This one is default.

           advanced
       buffer_size
           Set internal RIST buffer size in milliseconds for retransmission of data.  Default value is 0 which
           means the librist default (1 sec). Maximum value is 30 seconds.

       fifo_size
           Size of the librist receiver output fifo in number of packets. This must be a power of 2.  Defaults
           to 8192 (vs the librist default of 1024).

       overrun_nonfatal=1|0
           Survive in case of librist fifo buffer overrun. Default value is 0.

       pkt_size
           Set maximum packet size for sending data. 1316 by default.

       log_level
           Set loglevel for RIST logging messages. You only need to set this if you explicitly want to enable
           debug level messages or packet loss simulation, otherwise the regular loglevel is respected.

       secret
           Set override of encryption secret, by default is unset.

       encryption
           Set encryption type, by default is disabled.  Acceptable values are 128 and 256.

   rtmp
       Real-Time Messaging Protocol.

       The Real-Time Messaging Protocol (RTMP) is used for streaming multimedia content across a TCP/IP network.

       The required syntax is:

               rtmp://[<username>:<password>@]<server>[:<port>][/<app>][/<instance>][/<playpath>]

       The accepted parameters are:

       username
           An optional username (mostly for publishing).

       password
           An optional password (mostly for publishing).

       server
           The address of the RTMP server.

       port
           The number of the TCP port to use (by default is 1935).

       app It is the name of the application to access. It usually corresponds to the path where the application
           is installed on the RTMP server (e.g. /ondemand/, /flash/live/, etc.). You can override the value
           parsed from the URI through the "rtmp_app" option, too.

       playpath
           It is the path or name of the resource to play with reference to the application specified in app,
           may be prefixed by "mp4:". You can override the value parsed from the URI through the "rtmp_playpath"
           option, too.

       listen
           Act as a server, listening for an incoming connection.

       timeout
           Maximum time to wait for the incoming connection. Implies listen.

       Additionally, the following parameters can be set via command line options (or in code via "AVOption"s):

       rtmp_app
           Name of application to connect on the RTMP server. This option overrides the parameter specified in
           the URI.

       rtmp_buffer
           Set the client buffer time in milliseconds. The default is 3000.

       rtmp_conn
           Extra arbitrary AMF connection parameters, parsed from a string, e.g. like "B:1 S:authMe O:1
           NN:code:1.23 NS:flag:ok O:0".  Each value is prefixed by a single character denoting the type, B for
           Boolean, N for number, S for string, O for object, or Z for null, followed by a colon. For Booleans
           the data must be either 0 or 1 for FALSE or TRUE, respectively.  Likewise for Objects the data must
           be 0 or 1 to end or begin an object, respectively. Data items in subobjects may be named, by
           prefixing the type with 'N' and specifying the name before the value (i.e. "NB:myFlag:1"). This
           option may be used multiple times to construct arbitrary AMF sequences.

       rtmp_enhanced_codecs
           Specify the list of codecs the client advertises to support in an enhanced RTMP stream. This option
           should be set to a comma separated list of fourcc values, like "hvc1,av01,vp09" for multiple codecs
           or "hvc1" for only one codec. The specified list will be presented in the "fourCcLive" property of
           the Connect Command Message.

       rtmp_flashver
           Version of the Flash plugin used to run the SWF player. The default is LNX 9,0,124,2. (When
           publishing, the default is FMLE/3.0 (compatible; <libavformat version>).)

       rtmp_flush_interval
           Number of packets flushed in the same request (RTMPT only). The default is 10.

       rtmp_live
           Specify that the media is a live stream. No resuming or seeking in live streams is possible. The
           default value is "any", which means the subscriber first tries to play the live stream specified in
           the playpath. If a live stream of that name is not found, it plays the recorded stream. The other
           possible values are "live" and "recorded".

       rtmp_pageurl
           URL of the web page in which the media was embedded. By default no value will be sent.

       rtmp_playpath
           Stream identifier to play or to publish. This option overrides the parameter specified in the URI.

       rtmp_subscribe
           Name of live stream to subscribe to. By default no value will be sent.  It is only sent if the option
           is specified or if rtmp_live is set to live.

       rtmp_swfhash
           SHA256 hash of the decompressed SWF file (32 bytes).

       rtmp_swfsize
           Size of the decompressed SWF file, required for SWFVerification.

       rtmp_swfurl
           URL of the SWF player for the media. By default no value will be sent.

       rtmp_swfverify
           URL to player swf file, compute hash/size automatically.

       rtmp_tcurl
           URL of the target stream. Defaults to proto://host[:port]/app.

       tcp_nodelay=1|0
           Set TCP_NODELAY to disable Nagle's algorithm. Default value is 0.

           Remark: Writing to the socket is currently not optimized to minimize system calls and reduces the
           efficiency / effect of TCP_NODELAY.

       For example to read with ffplay a multimedia resource named "sample" from the application "vod" from an
       RTMP server "myserver":

               ffplay rtmp://myserver/vod/sample

       To publish to a password protected server, passing the playpath and app names separately:

               ffmpeg -re -i <input> -f flv -rtmp_playpath some/long/path -rtmp_app long/app/name rtmp://username:password@myserver/

   rtmpe
       Encrypted Real-Time Messaging Protocol.

       The Encrypted Real-Time Messaging Protocol (RTMPE) is used for streaming multimedia content within
       standard cryptographic primitives, consisting of Diffie-Hellman key exchange and HMACSHA256, generating a
       pair of RC4 keys.

   rtmps
       Real-Time Messaging Protocol over a secure SSL connection.

       The Real-Time Messaging Protocol (RTMPS) is used for streaming multimedia content across an encrypted
       connection.

   rtmpt
       Real-Time Messaging Protocol tunneled through HTTP.

       The Real-Time Messaging Protocol tunneled through HTTP (RTMPT) is used for streaming multimedia content
       within HTTP requests to traverse firewalls.

   rtmpte
       Encrypted Real-Time Messaging Protocol tunneled through HTTP.

       The Encrypted Real-Time Messaging Protocol tunneled through HTTP (RTMPTE) is used for streaming
       multimedia content within HTTP requests to traverse firewalls.

   rtmpts
       Real-Time Messaging Protocol tunneled through HTTPS.

       The Real-Time Messaging Protocol tunneled through HTTPS (RTMPTS) is used for streaming multimedia content
       within HTTPS requests to traverse firewalls.

   libsmbclient
       libsmbclient permits one to manipulate CIFS/SMB network resources.

       Following syntax is required.

               smb://[[domain:]user[:password@]]server[/share[/path[/file]]]

       This protocol accepts the following options.

       timeout
           Set timeout in milliseconds of socket I/O operations used by the underlying low level operation. By
           default it is set to -1, which means that the timeout is not specified.

       truncate
           Truncate existing files on write, if set to 1. A value of 0 prevents truncating. Default value is 1.

       workgroup
           Set the workgroup used for making connections. By default workgroup is not specified.

       For more information see: <http://www.samba.org/>.

   libssh
       Secure File Transfer Protocol via libssh

       Read from or write to remote resources using SFTP protocol.

       Following syntax is required.

               sftp://[user[:password]@]server[:port]/path/to/remote/resource.mpeg

       This protocol accepts the following options.

       timeout
           Set timeout of socket I/O operations used by the underlying low level operation. By default it is set
           to -1, which means that the timeout is not specified.

       truncate
           Truncate existing files on write, if set to 1. A value of 0 prevents truncating. Default value is 1.

       private_key
           Specify the path of the file containing private key to use during authorization.  By default libssh
           searches for keys in the ~/.ssh/ directory.

       Example: Play a file stored on remote server.

               ffplay sftp://user:password@server_address:22/home/user/resource.mpeg

   librtmp rtmp, rtmpe, rtmps, rtmpt, rtmpte
       Real-Time Messaging Protocol and its variants supported through librtmp.

       Requires the presence of the librtmp headers and library during configuration. You need to explicitly
       configure the build with "--enable-librtmp". If enabled this will replace the native RTMP protocol.

       This protocol provides most client functions and a few server functions needed to support RTMP, RTMP
       tunneled in HTTP (RTMPT), encrypted RTMP (RTMPE), RTMP over SSL/TLS (RTMPS) and tunneled variants of
       these encrypted types (RTMPTE, RTMPTS).

       The required syntax is:

               <rtmp_proto>://<server>[:<port>][/<app>][/<playpath>] <options>

       where rtmp_proto is one of the strings "rtmp", "rtmpt", "rtmpe", "rtmps", "rtmpte", "rtmpts"
       corresponding to each RTMP variant, and server, port, app and playpath have the same meaning as specified
       for the RTMP native protocol.  options contains a list of space-separated options of the form key=val.

       See the librtmp manual page (man 3 librtmp) for more information.

       For example, to stream a file in real-time to an RTMP server using ffmpeg:

               ffmpeg -re -i myfile -f flv rtmp://myserver/live/mystream

       To play the same stream using ffplay:

               ffplay "rtmp://myserver/live/mystream live=1"

   rtp
       Real-time Transport Protocol.

       The required syntax for an RTP URL is: rtp://hostname[:port][?option=val...]

       port specifies the RTP port to use.

       The following URL options are supported:

       ttl=n
           Set the TTL (Time-To-Live) value (for multicast only).

       rtcpport=n
           Set the remote RTCP port to n.

       localrtpport=n
           Set the local RTP port to n.

       localrtcpport=n'
           Set the local RTCP port to n.

       pkt_size=n
           Set max packet size (in bytes) to n.

       buffer_size=size
           Set the maximum UDP socket buffer size in bytes.

       connect=0|1
           Do a connect() on the UDP socket (if set to 1) or not (if set to 0).

       sources=ip[,ip]
           List allowed source IP addresses.

       block=ip[,ip]
           List disallowed (blocked) source IP addresses.

       write_to_source=0|1
           Send packets to the source address of the latest received packet (if set to 1) or to a default remote
           address (if set to 0).

       localport=n
           Set the local RTP port to n.

       localaddr=addr
           Local IP address of a network interface used for sending packets or joining multicast groups.

       timeout=n
           Set timeout (in microseconds) of socket I/O operations to n.

           This is a deprecated option. Instead, localrtpport should be used.

       Important notes:

       1.  If rtcpport is not set the RTCP port will be set to the RTP port value plus 1.

       2.  If localrtpport (the local RTP port) is not set any available port will be used for the local RTP and
           RTCP ports.

       3.  If localrtcpport (the local RTCP port) is not set it will be set to the local RTP port value plus 1.

   rtsp
       Real-Time Streaming Protocol.

       RTSP is not technically a protocol handler in libavformat, it is a demuxer and muxer. The demuxer
       supports both normal RTSP (with data transferred over RTP; this is used by e.g. Apple and Microsoft) and
       Real-RTSP (with data transferred over RDT).

       The muxer can be used to send a stream using RTSP ANNOUNCE to a server supporting it (currently Darwin
       Streaming Server and Mischa Spiegelmock's <https://github.com/revmischa/rtsp-server>).

       The required syntax for a RTSP url is:

               rtsp://<hostname>[:<port>]/<path>

       Options can be set on the ffmpeg/ffplay command line, or set in code via "AVOption"s or in
       "avformat_open_input".

       Muxer

       The following options are supported.

       rtsp_transport
           Set RTSP transport protocols.

           It accepts the following values:

           udp Use UDP as lower transport protocol.

           tcp Use TCP (interleaving within the RTSP control channel) as lower transport protocol.

           Default value is 0.

       rtsp_flags
           Set RTSP flags.

           The following values are accepted:

           latm
               Use MP4A-LATM packetization instead of MPEG4-GENERIC for AAC.

           rfc2190
               Use RFC 2190 packetization instead of RFC 4629 for H.263.

           skip_rtcp
               Don't send RTCP sender reports.

           h264_mode0
               Use mode 0 for H.264 in RTP.

           send_bye
               Send RTCP BYE packets when finishing.

           Default value is 0.

       min_port
           Set minimum local UDP port. Default value is 5000.

       max_port
           Set maximum local UDP port. Default value is 65000.

       buffer_size
           Set the maximum socket buffer size in bytes.

       pkt_size
           Set max send packet size (in bytes). Default value is 1472.

       Demuxer

       The following options are supported.

       initial_pause
           Do not start playing the stream immediately if set to 1. Default value is 0.

       rtsp_transport
           Set RTSP transport protocols.

           It accepts the following values:

           udp Use UDP as lower transport protocol.

           tcp Use TCP (interleaving within the RTSP control channel) as lower transport protocol.

           udp_multicast
               Use UDP multicast as lower transport protocol.

           http
               Use HTTP tunneling as lower transport protocol, which is useful for passing proxies.

           https
               Use HTTPs tunneling as lower transport protocol, which is useful for passing proxies and widely
               used for security consideration.

           Multiple lower transport protocols may be specified, in that case they are tried one at a time (if
           the setup of one fails, the next one is tried).  For the muxer, only the tcp and udp options are
           supported.

       rtsp_flags
           Set RTSP flags.

           The following values are accepted:

           filter_src
               Accept packets only from negotiated peer address and port.

           listen
               Act as a server, listening for an incoming connection.

           prefer_tcp
               Try TCP for RTP transport first, if TCP is available as RTSP RTP transport.

           satip_raw
               Export raw MPEG-TS stream instead of demuxing. The flag will simply write out the raw stream,
               with the original PAT/PMT/PIDs intact.

           Default value is none.

       allowed_media_types
           Set media types to accept from the server.

           The following flags are accepted:

           video
           audio
           data
           subtitle

           By default it accepts all media types.

       min_port
           Set minimum local UDP port. Default value is 5000.

       max_port
           Set maximum local UDP port. Default value is 65000.

       listen_timeout
           Set maximum timeout (in seconds) to establish an initial connection. Setting listen_timeout > 0 sets
           rtsp_flags to listen. Default is -1 which means an infinite timeout when listen mode is set.

       reorder_queue_size
           Set number of packets to buffer for handling of reordered packets.

       timeout
           Set socket TCP I/O timeout in microseconds.

       user_agent
           Override User-Agent header. If not specified, it defaults to the libavformat identifier string.

       buffer_size
           Set the maximum socket buffer size in bytes.

       When receiving data over UDP, the demuxer tries to reorder received packets (since they may arrive out of
       order, or packets may get lost totally). This can be disabled by setting the maximum demuxing delay to
       zero (via the "max_delay" field of AVFormatContext).

       When watching multi-bitrate Real-RTSP streams with ffplay, the streams to display can be chosen with
       "-vst" n and "-ast" n for video and audio respectively, and can be switched on the fly by pressing "v"
       and "a".

       Examples

       The following examples all make use of the ffplay and ffmpeg tools.

       •   Watch a stream over UDP, with a max reordering delay of 0.5 seconds:

                   ffplay -max_delay 500000 -rtsp_transport udp rtsp://server/video.mp4

       •   Watch a stream tunneled over HTTP:

                   ffplay -rtsp_transport http rtsp://server/video.mp4

       •   Send a stream in realtime to a RTSP server, for others to watch:

                   ffmpeg -re -i <input> -f rtsp -muxdelay 0.1 rtsp://server/live.sdp

       •   Receive a stream in realtime:

                   ffmpeg -rtsp_flags listen -i rtsp://ownaddress/live.sdp <output>

   sap
       Session Announcement Protocol (RFC 2974). This is not technically a protocol handler in libavformat, it
       is a muxer and demuxer.  It is used for signalling of RTP streams, by announcing the SDP for the streams
       regularly on a separate port.

       Muxer

       The syntax for a SAP url given to the muxer is:

               sap://<destination>[:<port>][?<options>]

       The RTP packets are sent to destination on port port, or to port 5004 if no port is specified.  options
       is a "&"-separated list. The following options are supported:

       announce_addr=address
           Specify the destination IP address for sending the announcements to.  If omitted, the announcements
           are sent to the commonly used SAP announcement multicast address 224.2.127.254 (sap.mcast.net), or
           ff0e::2:7ffe if destination is an IPv6 address.

       announce_port=port
           Specify the port to send the announcements on, defaults to 9875 if not specified.

       ttl=ttl
           Specify the time to live value for the announcements and RTP packets, defaults to 255.

       same_port=0|1
           If set to 1, send all RTP streams on the same port pair. If zero (the default), all streams are sent
           on unique ports, with each stream on a port 2 numbers higher than the previous.  VLC/Live555 requires
           this to be set to 1, to be able to receive the stream.  The RTP stack in libavformat for receiving
           requires all streams to be sent on unique ports.

       Example command lines follow.

       To broadcast a stream on the local subnet, for watching in VLC:

               ffmpeg -re -i <input> -f sap sap://224.0.0.255?same_port=1

       Similarly, for watching in ffplay:

               ffmpeg -re -i <input> -f sap sap://224.0.0.255

       And for watching in ffplay, over IPv6:

               ffmpeg -re -i <input> -f sap sap://[ff0e::1:2:3:4]

       Demuxer

       The syntax for a SAP url given to the demuxer is:

               sap://[<address>][:<port>]

       address is the multicast address to listen for announcements on, if omitted, the default 224.2.127.254
       (sap.mcast.net) is used. port is the port that is listened on, 9875 if omitted.

       The demuxers listens for announcements on the given address and port.  Once an announcement is received,
       it tries to receive that particular stream.

       Example command lines follow.

       To play back the first stream announced on the normal SAP multicast address:

               ffplay sap://

       To play back the first stream announced on one the default IPv6 SAP multicast address:

               ffplay sap://[ff0e::2:7ffe]

   sctp
       Stream Control Transmission Protocol.

       The accepted URL syntax is:

               sctp://<host>:<port>[?<options>]

       The protocol accepts the following options:

       listen
           If set to any value, listen for an incoming connection. Outgoing connection is done by default.

       max_streams
           Set the maximum number of streams. By default no limit is set.

   srt
       Haivision Secure Reliable Transport Protocol via libsrt.

       The supported syntax for a SRT URL is:

               srt://<hostname>:<port>[?<options>]

       options contains a list of &-separated options of the form key=val.

       or

               <options> srt://<hostname>:<port>

       options contains a list of '-key val' options.

       This protocol accepts the following options.

       connect_timeout=milliseconds
           Connection timeout; SRT cannot connect for RTT > 1500 msec (2 handshake exchanges) with the default
           connect timeout of 3 seconds. This option applies to the caller and rendezvous connection modes. The
           connect timeout is 10 times the value set for the rendezvous mode (which can be used as a workaround
           for this connection problem with earlier versions).

       ffs=bytes
           Flight Flag Size (Window Size), in bytes. FFS is actually an internal parameter and you should set it
           to not less than recv_buffer_size and mss. The default value is relatively large, therefore unless
           you set a very large receiver buffer, you do not need to change this option. Default value is 25600.

       inputbw=bytes/seconds
           Sender nominal input rate, in bytes per seconds. Used along with oheadbw, when maxbw is set to
           relative (0), to calculate maximum sending rate when recovery packets are sent along with the main
           media stream: inputbw * (100 + oheadbw) / 100 if inputbw is not set while maxbw is set to relative
           (0), the actual input rate is evaluated inside the library. Default value is 0.

       iptos=tos
           IP Type of Service. Applies to sender only. Default value is 0xB8.

       ipttl=ttl
           IP Time To Live. Applies to sender only. Default value is 64.

       latency=microseconds
           Timestamp-based Packet Delivery Delay.  Used to absorb bursts of missed packet retransmissions.  This
           flag sets both rcvlatency and peerlatency to the same value. Note that prior to version 1.3.0 this is
           the only flag to set the latency, however this is effectively equivalent to setting peerlatency, when
           side is sender and rcvlatency when side is receiver, and the bidirectional stream sending is not
           supported.

       listen_timeout=microseconds
           Set socket listen timeout.

       maxbw=bytes/seconds
           Maximum sending bandwidth, in bytes per seconds.  -1 infinite (CSRTCC limit is 30mbps) 0 relative to
           input rate (see inputbw) >0 absolute limit value Default value is 0 (relative)

       mode=caller|listener|rendezvous
           Connection mode.  caller opens client connection.  listener starts server to listen for incoming
           connections.  rendezvous use Rendez-Vous connection mode.  Default value is caller.

       mss=bytes
           Maximum Segment Size, in bytes. Used for buffer allocation and rate calculation using a packet
           counter assuming fully filled packets. The smallest MSS between the peers is used. This is 1500 by
           default in the overall internet.  This is the maximum size of the UDP packet and can be only
           decreased, unless you have some unusual dedicated network settings. Default value is 1500.

       nakreport=1|0
           If set to 1, Receiver will send `UMSG_LOSSREPORT` messages periodically until a lost packet is
           retransmitted or intentionally dropped. Default value is 1.

       oheadbw=percents
           Recovery bandwidth overhead above input rate, in percents.  See inputbw. Default value is 25%.

       passphrase=string
           HaiCrypt Encryption/Decryption Passphrase string, length from 10 to 79 characters. The passphrase is
           the shared secret between the sender and the receiver. It is used to generate the Key Encrypting Key
           using PBKDF2 (Password-Based Key Derivation Function). It is used only if pbkeylen is non-zero. It is
           used on the receiver only if the received data is encrypted.  The configured passphrase cannot be
           recovered (write-only).

       enforced_encryption=1|0
           If true, both connection parties must have the same password set (including empty, that is, with no
           encryption). If the password doesn't match or only one side is unencrypted, the connection is
           rejected. Default is true.

       kmrefreshrate=packets
           The number of packets to be transmitted after which the encryption key is switched to a new key.
           Default is -1.  -1 means auto (0x1000000 in srt library). The range for this option is integers in
           the 0 - "INT_MAX".

       kmpreannounce=packets
           The interval between when a new encryption key is sent and when switchover occurs. This value also
           applies to the subsequent interval between when switchover occurs and when the old encryption key is
           decommissioned. Default is -1.  -1 means auto (0x1000 in srt library). The range for this option is
           integers in the 0 - "INT_MAX".

       snddropdelay=microseconds
           The sender's extra delay before dropping packets. This delay is added to the default drop delay time
           interval value.

           Special value -1: Do not drop packets on the sender at all.

       payload_size=bytes
           Sets the maximum declared size of a packet transferred during the single call to the sending function
           in Live mode. Use 0 if this value isn't used (which is default in file mode).  Default is -1
           (automatic), which typically means MPEG-TS; if you are going to use SRT to send any different kind of
           payload, such as, for example, wrapping a live stream in very small frames, then you can use a bigger
           maximum frame size, though not greater than 1456 bytes.

       pkt_size=bytes
           Alias for payload_size.

       peerlatency=microseconds
           The latency value (as described in rcvlatency) that is set by the sender side as a minimum value for
           the receiver.

       pbkeylen=bytes
           Sender encryption key length, in bytes.  Only can be set to 0, 16, 24 and 32.  Enable sender
           encryption if not 0.  Not required on receiver (set to 0), key size obtained from sender in HaiCrypt
           handshake.  Default value is 0.

       rcvlatency=microseconds
           The time that should elapse since the moment when the packet was sent and the moment when it's
           delivered to the receiver application in the receiving function.  This time should be a buffer time
           large enough to cover the time spent for sending, unexpectedly extended RTT time, and the time needed
           to retransmit the lost UDP packet. The effective latency value will be the maximum of this options'
           value and the value of peerlatency set by the peer side. Before version 1.3.0 this option is only
           available as latency.

       recv_buffer_size=bytes
           Set UDP receive buffer size, expressed in bytes.

       send_buffer_size=bytes
           Set UDP send buffer size, expressed in bytes.

       timeout=microseconds
           Set raise error timeouts for read, write and connect operations. Note that the SRT library has
           internal timeouts which can be controlled separately, the value set here is only a cap on those.

       tlpktdrop=1|0
           Too-late Packet Drop. When enabled on receiver, it skips missing packets that have not been delivered
           in time and delivers the following packets to the application when their time-to-play has come. It
           also sends a fake ACK to the sender. When enabled on sender and enabled on the receiving peer, the
           sender drops the older packets that have no chance of being delivered in time. It was automatically
           enabled in the sender if the receiver supports it.

       sndbuf=bytes
           Set send buffer size, expressed in bytes.

       rcvbuf=bytes
           Set receive buffer size, expressed in bytes.

           Receive buffer must not be greater than ffs.

       lossmaxttl=packets
           The value up to which the Reorder Tolerance may grow. When Reorder Tolerance is > 0, then packet loss
           report is delayed until that number of packets come in. Reorder Tolerance increases every time a
           "belated" packet has come, but it wasn't due to retransmission (that is, when UDP packets tend to
           come out of order), with the difference between the latest sequence and this packet's sequence, and
           not more than the value of this option. By default it's 0, which means that this mechanism is turned
           off, and the loss report is always sent immediately upon experiencing a "gap" in sequences.

       minversion
           The minimum SRT version that is required from the peer. A connection to a peer that does not satisfy
           the minimum version requirement will be rejected.

           The version format in hex is 0xXXYYZZ for x.y.z in human readable form.

       streamid=string
           A string limited to 512 characters that can be set on the socket prior to connecting. This stream ID
           will be able to be retrieved by the listener side from the socket that is returned from srt_accept
           and was connected by a socket with that set stream ID. SRT does not enforce any special
           interpretation of the contents of this string.  This option doesn’t make sense in Rendezvous
           connection; the result might be that simply one side will override the value from the other side and
           it’s the matter of luck which one would win

       srt_streamid=string
           Alias for streamid to avoid conflict with ffmpeg command line option.

       smoother=live|file
           The type of Smoother used for the transmission for that socket, which is responsible for the
           transmission and congestion control. The Smoother type must be exactly the same on both connecting
           parties, otherwise the connection is rejected.

       messageapi=1|0
           When set, this socket uses the Message API, otherwise it uses Buffer API. Note that in live mode (see
           transtype) there’s only message API available. In File mode you can chose to use one of two modes:

           Stream API (default, when this option is false). In this mode you may send as many data as you wish
           with one sending instruction, or even use dedicated functions that read directly from a file. The
           internal facility will take care of any speed and congestion control. When receiving, you can also
           receive as many data as desired, the data not extracted will be waiting for the next call. There is
           no boundary between data portions in the Stream mode.

           Message API. In this mode your single sending instruction passes exactly one piece of data that has
           boundaries (a message). Contrary to Live mode, this message may span across multiple UDP packets and
           the only size limitation is that it shall fit as a whole in the sending buffer. The receiver shall
           use as large buffer as necessary to receive the message, otherwise the message will not be given up.
           When the message is not complete (not all packets received or there was a packet loss) it will not be
           given up.

       transtype=live|file
           Sets the transmission type for the socket, in particular, setting this option sets multiple other
           parameters to their default values as required for a particular transmission type.

           live: Set options as for live transmission. In this mode, you should send by one sending instruction
           only so many data that fit in one UDP packet, and limited to the value defined first in payload_size
           (1316 is default in this mode). There is no speed control in this mode, only the bandwidth control,
           if configured, in order to not exceed the bandwidth with the overhead transmission (retransmitted and
           control packets).

           file: Set options as for non-live transmission. See messageapi for further explanations

       linger=seconds
           The number of seconds that the socket waits for unsent data when closing.  Default is -1. -1 means
           auto (off with 0 seconds in live mode, on with 180 seconds in file mode). The range for this option
           is integers in the 0 - "INT_MAX".

       tsbpd=1|0
           When true, use Timestamp-based Packet Delivery mode. The default behavior depends on the transmission
           type: enabled in live mode, disabled in file mode.

       For more information see: <https://github.com/Haivision/srt>.

   srtp
       Secure Real-time Transport Protocol.

       The accepted options are:

       srtp_in_suite
       srtp_out_suite
           Select input and output encoding suites.

           Supported values:

           AES_CM_128_HMAC_SHA1_80
           SRTP_AES128_CM_HMAC_SHA1_80
           AES_CM_128_HMAC_SHA1_32
           SRTP_AES128_CM_HMAC_SHA1_32
       srtp_in_params
       srtp_out_params
           Set input and output encoding parameters, which are expressed by a base64-encoded representation of a
           binary block. The first 16 bytes of this binary block are used as master key, the following 14 bytes
           are used as master salt.

   subfile
       Virtually extract a segment of a file or another stream.  The underlying stream must be seekable.

       Accepted options:

       start
           Start offset of the extracted segment, in bytes.

       end End offset of the extracted segment, in bytes.  If set to 0, extract till end of file.

       Examples:

       Extract a chapter from a DVD VOB file (start and end sectors obtained externally and multiplied by 2048):

               subfile,,start,153391104,end,268142592,,:/media/dvd/VIDEO_TS/VTS_08_1.VOB

       Play an AVI file directly from a TAR archive:

               subfile,,start,183241728,end,366490624,,:archive.tar

       Play a MPEG-TS file from start offset till end:

               subfile,,start,32815239,end,0,,:video.ts

   tee
       Writes the output to multiple protocols. The individual outputs are separated by |

               tee:file://path/to/local/this.avi|file://path/to/local/that.avi

   tcp
       Transmission Control Protocol.

       The required syntax for a TCP url is:

               tcp://<hostname>:<port>[?<options>]

       options contains a list of &-separated options of the form key=val.

       The list of supported options follows.

       listen=2|1|0
           Listen for an incoming connection. 0 disables listen, 1 enables listen in single client mode, 2
           enables listen in multi-client mode. Default value is 0.

       local_addr=addr
           Local IP address of a network interface used for tcp socket connect.

       local_port=port
           Local port used for tcp socket connect.

       timeout=microseconds
           Set raise error timeout, expressed in microseconds.

           This option is only relevant in read mode: if no data arrived in more than this time interval, raise
           error.

       listen_timeout=milliseconds
           Set listen timeout, expressed in milliseconds.

       recv_buffer_size=bytes
           Set receive buffer size, expressed bytes.

       send_buffer_size=bytes
           Set send buffer size, expressed bytes.

       tcp_nodelay=1|0
           Set TCP_NODELAY to disable Nagle's algorithm. Default value is 0.

           Remark: Writing to the socket is currently not optimized to minimize system calls and reduces the
           efficiency / effect of TCP_NODELAY.

       tcp_mss=bytes
           Set maximum segment size for outgoing TCP packets, expressed in bytes.

       The following example shows how to setup a listening TCP connection with ffmpeg, which is then accessed
       with ffplay:

               ffmpeg -i <input> -f <format> tcp://<hostname>:<port>?listen
               ffplay tcp://<hostname>:<port>

   tls
       Transport Layer Security (TLS) / Secure Sockets Layer (SSL)

       The required syntax for a TLS/SSL url is:

               tls://<hostname>:<port>[?<options>]

       The following parameters can be set via command line options (or in code via "AVOption"s):

       ca_file, cafile=filename
           A file containing certificate authority (CA) root certificates to treat as trusted. If the linked TLS
           library contains a default this might not need to be specified for verification to work, but not all
           libraries and setups have defaults built in.  The file must be in OpenSSL PEM format.

       tls_verify=1|0
           If enabled, try to verify the peer that we are communicating with.  Note, if using OpenSSL, this
           currently only makes sure that the peer certificate is signed by one of the root certificates in the
           CA database, but it does not validate that the certificate actually matches the host name we are
           trying to connect to. (With other backends, the host name is validated as well.)

           This is disabled by default since it requires a CA database to be provided by the caller in many
           cases.

       cert_file, cert=filename
           A file containing a certificate to use in the handshake with the peer.  (When operating as server, in
           listen mode, this is more often required by the peer, while client certificates only are mandated in
           certain setups.)

       key_file, key=filename
           A file containing the private key for the certificate.

       listen=1|0
           If enabled, listen for connections on the provided port, and assume the server role in the handshake
           instead of the client role.

       http_proxy
           The HTTP proxy to tunnel through, e.g. "http://example.com:1234".  The proxy must support the CONNECT
           method.

       Example command lines:

       To create a TLS/SSL server that serves an input stream.

               ffmpeg -i <input> -f <format> tls://<hostname>:<port>?listen&cert=<server.crt>&key=<server.key>

       To play back a stream from the TLS/SSL server using ffplay:

               ffplay tls://<hostname>:<port>

   udp
       User Datagram Protocol.

       The required syntax for an UDP URL is:

               udp://<hostname>:<port>[?<options>]

       options contains a list of &-separated options of the form key=val.

       In case threading is enabled on the system, a circular buffer is used to store the incoming data, which
       allows one to reduce loss of data due to UDP socket buffer overruns. The fifo_size and overrun_nonfatal
       options are related to this buffer.

       The list of supported options follows.

       buffer_size=size
           Set the UDP maximum socket buffer size in bytes. This is used to set either the receive or send
           buffer size, depending on what the socket is used for.  Default is 32 KB for output, 384 KB for
           input.  See also fifo_size.

       bitrate=bitrate
           If set to nonzero, the output will have the specified constant bitrate if the input has enough
           packets to sustain it.

       burst_bits=bits
           When using bitrate this specifies the maximum number of bits in packet bursts.

       localport=port
           Override the local UDP port to bind with.

       localaddr=addr
           Local IP address of a network interface used for sending packets or joining multicast groups.

       pkt_size=size
           Set the size in bytes of UDP packets.

       reuse=1|0
           Explicitly allow or disallow reusing UDP sockets.

       ttl=ttl
           Set the time to live value (for multicast only).

       connect=1|0
           Initialize the UDP socket with connect(). In this case, the destination address can't be changed with
           ff_udp_set_remote_url later.  If the destination address isn't known at the start, this option can be
           specified in ff_udp_set_remote_url, too.  This allows finding out the source address for the packets
           with getsockname, and makes writes return with AVERROR(ECONNREFUSED) if "destination unreachable" is
           received.  For receiving, this gives the benefit of only receiving packets from the specified peer
           address/port.

       sources=address[,address]
           Only receive packets sent from the specified addresses. In case of multicast, also subscribe to
           multicast traffic coming from these addresses only.

       block=address[,address]
           Ignore packets sent from the specified addresses. In case of multicast, also exclude the source
           addresses in the multicast subscription.

       fifo_size=units
           Set the UDP receiving circular buffer size, expressed as a number of packets with size of 188 bytes.
           If not specified defaults to 7*4096.

       overrun_nonfatal=1|0
           Survive in case of UDP receiving circular buffer overrun. Default value is 0.

       timeout=microseconds
           Set raise error timeout, expressed in microseconds.

           This option is only relevant in read mode: if no data arrived in more than this time interval, raise
           error.

       broadcast=1|0
           Explicitly allow or disallow UDP broadcasting.

           Note that broadcasting may not work properly on networks having a broadcast storm protection.

       Examples

       •   Use ffmpeg to stream over UDP to a remote endpoint:

                   ffmpeg -i <input> -f <format> udp://<hostname>:<port>

       •   Use ffmpeg to stream in mpegts format over UDP using 188 sized UDP packets, using a large input
           buffer:

                   ffmpeg -i <input> -f mpegts udp://<hostname>:<port>?pkt_size=188&buffer_size=65535

       •   Use ffmpeg to receive over UDP from a remote endpoint:

                   ffmpeg -i udp://[<multicast-address>]:<port> ...

   unix
       Unix local socket

       The required syntax for a Unix socket URL is:

               unix://<filepath>

       The following parameters can be set via command line options (or in code via "AVOption"s):

       timeout
           Timeout in ms.

       listen
           Create the Unix socket in listening mode.

   zmq
       ZeroMQ asynchronous messaging using the libzmq library.

       This library supports unicast streaming to multiple clients without relying on an external server.

       The required syntax for streaming or connecting to a stream is:

               zmq:tcp://ip-address:port

       Example: Create a localhost stream on port 5555:

               ffmpeg -re -i input -f mpegts zmq:tcp://127.0.0.1:5555

       Multiple clients may connect to the stream using:

               ffplay zmq:tcp://127.0.0.1:5555

       Streaming to multiple clients is implemented using a ZeroMQ Pub-Sub pattern.  The server side binds to a
       port and publishes data. Clients connect to the server (via IP address/port) and subscribe to the stream.
       The order in which the server and client start generally does not matter.

       ffmpeg must be compiled with the --enable-libzmq option to support this protocol.

       Options can be set on the ffmpeg/ffplay command line. The following options are supported:

       pkt_size
           Forces the maximum packet size for sending/receiving data. The default value is 131,072 bytes. On the
           server side, this sets the maximum size of sent packets via ZeroMQ. On the clients, it sets an
           internal buffer size for receiving packets. Note that pkt_size on the clients should be equal to or
           greater than pkt_size on the server. Otherwise the received message may be truncated causing decoding
           errors.

DEVICE OPTIONS

       The libavdevice library provides the same interface as libavformat. Namely, an input device is considered
       like a demuxer, and an output device like a muxer, and the interface and generic device options are the
       same provided by libavformat (see the ffmpeg-formats manual).

       In addition each input or output device may support so-called private options, which are specific for
       that component.

       Options may be set by specifying -option value in the FFmpeg tools, or by setting the value explicitly in
       the device "AVFormatContext" options or using the libavutil/opt.h API for programmatic use.

INPUT DEVICES

       Input devices are configured elements in FFmpeg which enable accessing the data coming from a multimedia
       device attached to your system.

       When you configure your FFmpeg build, all the supported input devices are enabled by default. You can
       list all available ones using the configure option "--list-indevs".

       You can disable all the input devices using the configure option "--disable-indevs", and selectively
       enable an input device using the option "--enable-indev=INDEV", or you can disable a particular input
       device using the option "--disable-indev=INDEV".

       The option "-devices" of the ff* tools will display the list of supported input devices.

       A description of the currently available input devices follows.

   alsa
       ALSA (Advanced Linux Sound Architecture) input device.

       To enable this input device during configuration you need libasound installed on your system.

       This device allows capturing from an ALSA device. The name of the device to capture has to be an ALSA
       card identifier.

       An ALSA identifier has the syntax:

               hw:<CARD>[,<DEV>[,<SUBDEV>]]

       where the DEV and SUBDEV components are optional.

       The three arguments (in order: CARD,DEV,SUBDEV) specify card number or identifier, device number and
       subdevice number (-1 means any).

       To see the list of cards currently recognized by your system check the files /proc/asound/cards and
       /proc/asound/devices.

       For example to capture with ffmpeg from an ALSA device with card id 0, you may run the command:

               ffmpeg -f alsa -i hw:0 alsaout.wav

       For more information see: <http://www.alsa-project.org/alsa-doc/alsa-lib/pcm.html>

       Options

       sample_rate
           Set the sample rate in Hz. Default is 48000.

       channels
           Set the number of channels. Default is 2.

   android_camera
       Android camera input device.

       This input devices uses the Android Camera2 NDK API which is available on devices with API level 24+. The
       availability of android_camera is autodetected during configuration.

       This device allows capturing from all cameras on an Android device, which are integrated into the Camera2
       NDK API.

       The available cameras are enumerated internally and can be selected with the camera_index parameter. The
       input file string is discarded.

       Generally the back facing camera has index 0 while the front facing camera has index 1.

       Options

       video_size
           Set the video size given as a string such as 640x480 or hd720.  Falls back to the first available
           configuration reported by Android if requested video size is not available or by default.

       framerate
           Set the video framerate.  Falls back to the first available configuration reported by Android if
           requested framerate is not available or by default (-1).

       camera_index
           Set the index of the camera to use. Default is 0.

       input_queue_size
           Set the maximum number of frames to buffer. Default is 5.

   avfoundation
       AVFoundation input device.

       AVFoundation is the currently recommended framework by Apple for streamgrabbing on OSX >= 10.7 as well as
       on iOS.

       The input filename has to be given in the following syntax:

               -i "[[VIDEO]:[AUDIO]]"

       The first entry selects the video input while the latter selects the audio input.  The stream has to be
       specified by the device name or the device index as shown by the device list.  Alternatively, the video
       and/or audio input device can be chosen by index using the

           B<-video_device_index E<lt>INDEXE<gt>>

       and/or

           B<-audio_device_index E<lt>INDEXE<gt>>

       , overriding any device name or index given in the input filename.

       All available devices can be enumerated by using -list_devices true, listing all device names and
       corresponding indices.

       There are two device name aliases:

       "default"
           Select the AVFoundation default device of the corresponding type.

       "none"
           Do not record the corresponding media type.  This is equivalent to specifying an empty device name or
           index.

       Options

       AVFoundation supports the following options:

       -list_devices <TRUE|FALSE>
           If set to true, a list of all available input devices is given showing all device names and indices.

       -video_device_index <INDEX>
           Specify the video device by its index. Overrides anything given in the input filename.

       -audio_device_index <INDEX>
           Specify the audio device by its index. Overrides anything given in the input filename.

       -pixel_format <FORMAT>
           Request the video device to use a specific pixel format.  If the specified format is not supported, a
           list of available formats is given and the first one in this list is used instead. Available pixel
           formats are: "monob, rgb555be, rgb555le, rgb565be, rgb565le, rgb24, bgr24, 0rgb, bgr0, 0bgr, rgb0,
            bgr48be, uyvy422, yuva444p, yuva444p16le, yuv444p, yuv422p16, yuv422p10, yuv444p10,
            yuv420p, nv12, yuyv422, gray"

       -framerate
           Set the grabbing frame rate. Default is "ntsc", corresponding to a frame rate of "30000/1001".

       -video_size
           Set the video frame size.

       -capture_cursor
           Capture the mouse pointer. Default is 0.

       -capture_mouse_clicks
           Capture the screen mouse clicks. Default is 0.

       -capture_raw_data
           Capture the raw device data. Default is 0.  Using this option may result in receiving the underlying
           data delivered to the AVFoundation framework. E.g. for muxed devices that sends raw DV data to the
           framework (like tape-based camcorders), setting this option to false results in extracted video
           frames captured in the designated pixel format only. Setting this option to true results in receiving
           the raw DV stream untouched.

       Examples

       •   Print the list of AVFoundation supported devices and exit:

                   $ ffmpeg -f avfoundation -list_devices true -i ""

       •   Record video from video device 0 and audio from audio device 0 into out.avi:

                   $ ffmpeg -f avfoundation -i "0:0" out.avi

       •   Record video from video device 2 and audio from audio device 1 into out.avi:

                   $ ffmpeg -f avfoundation -video_device_index 2 -i ":1" out.avi

       •   Record video from the system default video device using the pixel format bgr0 and do not record any
           audio into out.avi:

                   $ ffmpeg -f avfoundation -pixel_format bgr0 -i "default:none" out.avi

       •   Record raw DV data from a suitable input device and write the output into out.dv:

                   $ ffmpeg -f avfoundation -capture_raw_data true -i "zr100:none" out.dv

   bktr
       BSD video input device. Deprecated and will be removed - please contact the developers if you are
       interested in maintaining it.

       Options

       framerate
           Set the frame rate.

       video_size
           Set the video frame size. Default is "vga".

       standard
           Available values are:

           pal
           ntsc
           secam
           paln
           palm
           ntscj

   decklink
       The decklink input device provides capture capabilities for Blackmagic DeckLink devices.

       To enable this input device, you need the Blackmagic DeckLink SDK and you need to configure with the
       appropriate "--extra-cflags" and "--extra-ldflags".  On Windows, you need to run the IDL files through
       widl.

       DeckLink is very picky about the formats it supports. Pixel format of the input can be set with
       raw_format.  Framerate and video size must be determined for your device with -list_formats 1. Audio
       sample rate is always 48 kHz and the number of channels can be 2, 8 or 16. Note that all audio channels
       are bundled in one single audio track.

       Options

       list_devices
           If set to true, print a list of devices and exit.  Defaults to false. This option is deprecated,
           please use the "-sources" option of ffmpeg to list the available input devices.

       list_formats
           If set to true, print a list of supported formats and exit.  Defaults to false.

       format_code <FourCC>
           This sets the input video format to the format given by the FourCC. To see the supported values of
           your device(s) use list_formats.  Note that there is a FourCC 'pal ' that can also be used as pal (3
           letters).  Default behavior is autodetection of the input video format, if the hardware supports it.

       raw_format
           Set the pixel format of the captured video.  Available values are:

           auto
               This is the default which means 8-bit YUV 422 or 8-bit ARGB if format autodetection is used,
               8-bit YUV 422 otherwise.

           uyvy422
               8-bit YUV 422.

           yuv422p10
               10-bit YUV 422.

           argb
               8-bit RGB.

           bgra
               8-bit RGB.

           rgb10
               10-bit RGB.

       teletext_lines
           If set to nonzero, an additional teletext stream will be captured from the vertical ancillary data.
           Both SD PAL (576i) and HD (1080i or 1080p) sources are supported. In case of HD sources, OP47 packets
           are decoded.

           This option is a bitmask of the SD PAL VBI lines captured, specifically lines 6 to 22, and lines 318
           to 335. Line 6 is the LSB in the mask. Selected lines which do not contain teletext information will
           be ignored. You can use the special all constant to select all possible lines, or standard to skip
           lines 6, 318 and 319, which are not compatible with all receivers.

           For SD sources, ffmpeg needs to be compiled with "--enable-libzvbi". For HD sources, on older
           (pre-4K) DeckLink card models you have to capture in 10 bit mode.

       channels
           Defines number of audio channels to capture. Must be 2, 8 or 16.  Defaults to 2.

       duplex_mode
           Sets the decklink device duplex/profile mode. Must be unset, half, full, one_sub_device_full,
           one_sub_device_half, two_sub_device_full, four_sub_device_half Defaults to unset.

           Note: DeckLink SDK 11.0 have replaced the duplex property by a profile property.  For the DeckLink
           Duo 2 and DeckLink Quad 2, a profile is shared between any 2 sub-devices that utilize the same
           connectors. For the DeckLink 8K Pro, a profile is shared between all 4 sub-devices. So DeckLink 8K
           Pro support four profiles.

           Valid profile modes for DeckLink 8K Pro(with DeckLink SDK >= 11.0): one_sub_device_full,
           one_sub_device_half, two_sub_device_full, four_sub_device_half

           Valid profile modes for DeckLink Quad 2 and DeckLink Duo 2: half, full

       timecode_format
           Timecode type to include in the frame and video stream metadata. Must be none, rp188vitc, rp188vitc2,
           rp188ltc, rp188hfr, rp188any, vitc, vitc2, or serial.  Defaults to none (not included).

           In order to properly support 50/60 fps timecodes, the ordering of the queried timecode types for
           rp188any is HFR, VITC1, VITC2 and LTC for >30 fps content. Note that this is slightly different to
           the ordering used by the DeckLink API, which is HFR, VITC1, LTC, VITC2.

       video_input
           Sets the video input source. Must be unset, sdi, hdmi, optical_sdi, component, composite or s_video.
           Defaults to unset.

       audio_input
           Sets the audio input source. Must be unset, embedded, aes_ebu, analog, analog_xlr, analog_rca or
           microphone. Defaults to unset.

       video_pts
           Sets the video packet timestamp source. Must be video, audio, reference, wallclock or abs_wallclock.
           Defaults to video.

       audio_pts
           Sets the audio packet timestamp source. Must be video, audio, reference, wallclock or abs_wallclock.
           Defaults to audio.

       draw_bars
           If set to true, color bars are drawn in the event of a signal loss.  Defaults to true.

       queue_size
           Sets maximum input buffer size in bytes. If the buffering reaches this value, incoming frames will be
           dropped.  Defaults to 1073741824.

       audio_depth
           Sets the audio sample bit depth. Must be 16 or 32.  Defaults to 16.

       decklink_copyts
           If set to true, timestamps are forwarded as they are without removing the initial offset.  Defaults
           to false.

       timestamp_align
           Capture start time alignment in seconds. If set to nonzero, input frames are dropped till the system
           timestamp aligns with configured value.  Alignment difference of up to one frame duration is
           tolerated.  This is useful for maintaining input synchronization across N different hardware devices
           deployed for 'N-way' redundancy. The system time of different hardware devices should be synchronized
           with protocols such as NTP or PTP, before using this option.  Note that this method is not foolproof.
           In some border cases input synchronization may not happen due to thread scheduling jitters in the OS.
           Either sync could go wrong by 1 frame or in a rarer case timestamp_align seconds.  Defaults to 0.

       wait_for_tc (bool)
           Drop frames till a frame with timecode is received. Sometimes serial timecode isn't received with the
           first input frame. If that happens, the stored stream timecode will be inaccurate. If this option is
           set to true, input frames are dropped till a frame with timecode is received.  Option timecode_format
           must be specified.  Defaults to false.

       enable_klv(bool)
           If set to true, extracts KLV data from VANC and outputs KLV packets.  KLV VANC packets are joined
           based on MID and PSC fields and aggregated into one KLV packet.  Defaults to false.

       Examples

       •   List input devices:

                   ffmpeg -sources decklink

       •   List supported formats:

                   ffmpeg -f decklink -list_formats 1 -i 'Intensity Pro'

       •   Capture video clip at 1080i50:

                   ffmpeg -format_code Hi50 -f decklink -i 'Intensity Pro' -c:a copy -c:v copy output.avi

       •   Capture video clip at 1080i50 10 bit:

                   ffmpeg -raw_format yuv422p10 -format_code Hi50 -f decklink -i 'UltraStudio Mini Recorder' -c:a copy -c:v copy output.avi

       •   Capture video clip at 1080i50 with 16 audio channels:

                   ffmpeg -channels 16 -format_code Hi50 -f decklink -i 'UltraStudio Mini Recorder' -c:a copy -c:v copy output.avi

   dshow
       Windows DirectShow input device.

       DirectShow support is enabled when FFmpeg is built with the mingw-w64 project.  Currently only audio and
       video devices are supported.

       Multiple devices may be opened as separate inputs, but they may also be opened on the same input, which
       should improve synchronism between them.

       The input name should be in the format:

               <TYPE>=<NAME>[:<TYPE>=<NAME>]

       where TYPE can be either audio or video, and NAME is the device's name or alternative name..

       Options

       If no options are specified, the device's defaults are used.  If the device does not support the
       requested options, it will fail to open.

       video_size
           Set the video size in the captured video.

       framerate
           Set the frame rate in the captured video.

       sample_rate
           Set the sample rate (in Hz) of the captured audio.

       sample_size
           Set the sample size (in bits) of the captured audio.

       channels
           Set the number of channels in the captured audio.

       list_devices
           If set to true, print a list of devices and exit.

       list_options
           If set to true, print a list of selected device's options and exit.

       video_device_number
           Set video device number for devices with the same name (starts at 0, defaults to 0).

       audio_device_number
           Set audio device number for devices with the same name (starts at 0, defaults to 0).

       pixel_format
           Select pixel format to be used by DirectShow. This may only be set when the video codec is not set or
           set to rawvideo.

       audio_buffer_size
           Set audio device buffer size in milliseconds (which can directly impact latency, depending on the
           device).  Defaults to using the audio device's default buffer size (typically some multiple of
           500ms).  Setting this value too low can degrade performance.  See also
           <http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/windows/desktop/dd377582(v=vs.85).aspx>

       video_pin_name
           Select video capture pin to use by name or alternative name.

       audio_pin_name
           Select audio capture pin to use by name or alternative name.

       crossbar_video_input_pin_number
           Select video input pin number for crossbar device. This will be routed to the crossbar device's Video
           Decoder output pin.  Note that changing this value can affect future invocations (sets a new default)
           until system reboot occurs.

       crossbar_audio_input_pin_number
           Select audio input pin number for crossbar device. This will be routed to the crossbar device's Audio
           Decoder output pin.  Note that changing this value can affect future invocations (sets a new default)
           until system reboot occurs.

       show_video_device_dialog
           If set to true, before capture starts, popup a display dialog to the end user, allowing them to
           change video filter properties and configurations manually.  Note that for crossbar devices,
           adjusting values in this dialog may be needed at times to toggle between PAL (25 fps) and NTSC
           (29.97) input frame rates, sizes, interlacing, etc.  Changing these values can enable different scan
           rates/frame rates and avoiding green bars at the bottom, flickering scan lines, etc.  Note that with
           some devices, changing these properties can also affect future invocations (sets new defaults) until
           system reboot occurs.

       show_audio_device_dialog
           If set to true, before capture starts, popup a display dialog to the end user, allowing them to
           change audio filter properties and configurations manually.

       show_video_crossbar_connection_dialog
           If set to true, before capture starts, popup a display dialog to the end user, allowing them to
           manually modify crossbar pin routings, when it opens a video device.

       show_audio_crossbar_connection_dialog
           If set to true, before capture starts, popup a display dialog to the end user, allowing them to
           manually modify crossbar pin routings, when it opens an audio device.

       show_analog_tv_tuner_dialog
           If set to true, before capture starts, popup a display dialog to the end user, allowing them to
           manually modify TV channels and frequencies.

       show_analog_tv_tuner_audio_dialog
           If set to true, before capture starts, popup a display dialog to the end user, allowing them to
           manually modify TV audio (like mono vs. stereo, Language A,B or C).

       audio_device_load
           Load an audio capture filter device from file instead of searching it by name. It may load additional
           parameters too, if the filter supports the serialization of its properties to.  To use this an audio
           capture source has to be specified, but it can be anything even fake one.

       audio_device_save
           Save the currently used audio capture filter device and its parameters (if the filter supports it) to
           a file.  If a file with the same name exists it will be overwritten.

       video_device_load
           Load a video capture filter device from file instead of searching it by name. It may load additional
           parameters too, if the filter supports the serialization of its properties to.  To use this a video
           capture source has to be specified, but it can be anything even fake one.

       video_device_save
           Save the currently used video capture filter device and its parameters (if the filter supports it) to
           a file.  If a file with the same name exists it will be overwritten.

       use_video_device_timestamps
           If set to false, the timestamp for video frames will be derived from the wallclock instead of the
           timestamp provided by the capture device. This allows working around devices that provide unreliable
           timestamps.

       Examples

       •   Print the list of DirectShow supported devices and exit:

                   $ ffmpeg -list_devices true -f dshow -i dummy

       •   Open video device Camera:

                   $ ffmpeg -f dshow -i video="Camera"

       •   Open second video device with name Camera:

                   $ ffmpeg -f dshow -video_device_number 1 -i video="Camera"

       •   Open video device Camera and audio device Microphone:

                   $ ffmpeg -f dshow -i video="Camera":audio="Microphone"

       •   Print the list of supported options in selected device and exit:

                   $ ffmpeg -list_options true -f dshow -i video="Camera"

       •   Specify pin names to capture by name or alternative name, specify alternative device name:

                   $ ffmpeg -f dshow -audio_pin_name "Audio Out" -video_pin_name 2 -i video=video="@device_pnp_\\?\pci#ven_1a0a&dev_6200&subsys_62021461&rev_01#4&e2c7dd6&0&00e1#{65e8773d-8f56-11d0-a3b9-00a0c9223196}\{ca465100-deb0-4d59-818f-8c477184adf6}":audio="Microphone"

       •   Configure a crossbar device, specifying crossbar pins, allow user to adjust video capture properties
           at startup:

                   $ ffmpeg -f dshow -show_video_device_dialog true -crossbar_video_input_pin_number 0
                        -crossbar_audio_input_pin_number 3 -i video="AVerMedia BDA Analog Capture":audio="AVerMedia BDA Analog Capture"

   fbdev
       Linux framebuffer input device.

       The Linux framebuffer is a graphic hardware-independent abstraction layer to show graphics on a computer
       monitor, typically on the console. It is accessed through a file device node, usually /dev/fb0.

       For more detailed information read the file Documentation/fb/framebuffer.txt included in the Linux source
       tree.

       See also <http://linux-fbdev.sourceforge.net/>, and fbset(1).

       To record from the framebuffer device /dev/fb0 with ffmpeg:

               ffmpeg -f fbdev -framerate 10 -i /dev/fb0 out.avi

       You can take a single screenshot image with the command:

               ffmpeg -f fbdev -framerate 1 -i /dev/fb0 -frames:v 1 screenshot.jpeg

       Options

       framerate
           Set the frame rate. Default is 25.

   gdigrab
       Win32 GDI-based screen capture device.

       This device allows you to capture a region of the display on Windows.

       Amongst options for the imput filenames are such elements as:

               desktop

       or

               title=<window_title>

       or

               hwnd=<window_hwnd>

       The first option will capture the entire desktop, or a fixed region of the desktop. The second and third
       options will instead capture the contents of a single window, regardless of its position on the screen.

       For example, to grab the entire desktop using ffmpeg:

               ffmpeg -f gdigrab -framerate 6 -i desktop out.mpg

       Grab a 640x480 region at position "10,20":

               ffmpeg -f gdigrab -framerate 6 -offset_x 10 -offset_y 20 -video_size vga -i desktop out.mpg

       Grab the contents of the window named "Calculator"

               ffmpeg -f gdigrab -framerate 6 -i title=Calculator out.mpg

       Options

       draw_mouse
           Specify whether to draw the mouse pointer. Use the value 0 to not draw the pointer. Default value is
           1.

       framerate
           Set the grabbing frame rate. Default value is "ntsc", corresponding to a frame rate of "30000/1001".

       show_region
           Show grabbed region on screen.

           If show_region is specified with 1, then the grabbing region will be indicated on screen. With this
           option, it is easy to know what is being grabbed if only a portion of the screen is grabbed.

           Note that show_region is incompatible with grabbing the contents of a single window.

           For example:

                   ffmpeg -f gdigrab -show_region 1 -framerate 6 -video_size cif -offset_x 10 -offset_y 20 -i desktop out.mpg

       video_size
           Set the video frame size. The default is to capture the full screen if desktop is selected, or the
           full window size if title=window_title is selected.

       offset_x
           When capturing a region with video_size, set the distance from the left edge of the screen or
           desktop.

           Note that the offset calculation is from the top left corner of the primary monitor on Windows. If
           you have a monitor positioned to the left of your primary monitor, you will need to use a negative
           offset_x value to move the region to that monitor.

       offset_y
           When capturing a region with video_size, set the distance from the top edge of the screen or desktop.

           Note that the offset calculation is from the top left corner of the primary monitor on Windows. If
           you have a monitor positioned above your primary monitor, you will need to use a negative offset_y
           value to move the region to that monitor.

   iec61883
       FireWire DV/HDV input device using libiec61883.

       To enable this input device, you need libiec61883, libraw1394 and libavc1394 installed on your system.
       Use the configure option "--enable-libiec61883" to compile with the device enabled.

       The iec61883 capture device supports capturing from a video device connected via IEEE1394 (FireWire),
       using libiec61883 and the new Linux FireWire stack (juju). This is the default DV/HDV input method in
       Linux Kernel 2.6.37 and later, since the old FireWire stack was removed.

       Specify the FireWire port to be used as input file, or "auto" to choose the first port connected.

       Options

       dvtype
           Override autodetection of DV/HDV. This should only be used if auto detection does not work, or if
           usage of a different device type should be prohibited. Treating a DV device as HDV (or vice versa)
           will not work and result in undefined behavior.  The values auto, dv and hdv are supported.

       dvbuffer
           Set maximum size of buffer for incoming data, in frames. For DV, this is an exact value. For HDV, it
           is not frame exact, since HDV does not have a fixed frame size.

       dvguid
           Select the capture device by specifying its GUID. Capturing will only be performed from the specified
           device and fails if no device with the given GUID is found. This is useful to select the input if
           multiple devices are connected at the same time.  Look at /sys/bus/firewire/devices to find out the
           GUIDs.

       Examples

       •   Grab and show the input of a FireWire DV/HDV device.

                   ffplay -f iec61883 -i auto

       •   Grab and record the input of a FireWire DV/HDV device, using a packet buffer of 100000 packets if the
           source is HDV.

                   ffmpeg -f iec61883 -i auto -dvbuffer 100000 out.mpg

   jack
       JACK input device.

       To enable this input device during configuration you need libjack installed on your system.

       A JACK input device creates one or more JACK writable clients, one for each audio channel, with name
       client_name:input_N, where client_name is the name provided by the application, and N is a number which
       identifies the channel.  Each writable client will send the acquired data to the FFmpeg input device.

       Once you have created one or more JACK readable clients, you need to connect them to one or more JACK
       writable clients.

       To connect or disconnect JACK clients you can use the jack_connect and jack_disconnect programs, or do it
       through a graphical interface, for example with qjackctl.

       To list the JACK clients and their properties you can invoke the command jack_lsp.

       Follows an example which shows how to capture a JACK readable client with ffmpeg.

               # Create a JACK writable client with name "ffmpeg".
               $ ffmpeg -f jack -i ffmpeg -y out.wav

               # Start the sample jack_metro readable client.
               $ jack_metro -b 120 -d 0.2 -f 4000

               # List the current JACK clients.
               $ jack_lsp -c
               system:capture_1
               system:capture_2
               system:playback_1
               system:playback_2
               ffmpeg:input_1
               metro:120_bpm

               # Connect metro to the ffmpeg writable client.
               $ jack_connect metro:120_bpm ffmpeg:input_1

       For more information read: <http://jackaudio.org/>

       Options

       channels
           Set the number of channels. Default is 2.

   kmsgrab
       KMS video input device.

       Captures the KMS scanout framebuffer associated with a specified CRTC or plane as a DRM object that can
       be passed to other hardware functions.

       Requires either DRM master or CAP_SYS_ADMIN to run.

       If you don't understand what all of that means, you probably don't want this.  Look at x11grab instead.

       Options

       device
           DRM device to capture on.  Defaults to /dev/dri/card0.

       format
           Pixel format of the framebuffer.  This can be autodetected if you are running Linux 5.7 or later, but
           needs to be provided for earlier versions.  Defaults to bgr0, which is the most common format used by
           the Linux console and Xorg X server.

       format_modifier
           Format modifier to signal on output frames.  This is necessary to import correctly into some APIs.
           It can be autodetected if you are running Linux 5.7 or later, but will need to be provided explicitly
           when needed in earlier versions.  See the libdrm documentation for possible values.

       crtc_id
           KMS CRTC ID to define the capture source.  The first active plane on the given CRTC will be used.

       plane_id
           KMS plane ID to define the capture source.  Defaults to the first active plane found if neither
           crtc_id nor plane_id are specified.

       framerate
           Framerate to capture at.  This is not synchronised to any page flipping or framebuffer changes - it
           just defines the interval at which the framebuffer is sampled.  Sampling faster than the framebuffer
           update rate will generate independent frames with the same content.  Defaults to 30.

       Examples

       •   Capture from the first active plane, download the result to normal frames and encode.  This will only
           work if the framebuffer is both linear and mappable - if not, the result may be scrambled or fail to
           download.

                   ffmpeg -f kmsgrab -i - -vf 'hwdownload,format=bgr0' output.mp4

       •   Capture from CRTC ID 42 at 60fps, map the result to VAAPI, convert to NV12 and encode as H.264.

                   ffmpeg -crtc_id 42 -framerate 60 -f kmsgrab -i - -vf 'hwmap=derive_device=vaapi,scale_vaapi=w=1920:h=1080:format=nv12' -c:v h264_vaapi output.mp4

       •   To capture only part of a plane the output can be cropped - this can be used to capture a single
           window, as long as it has a known absolute position and size.  For example, to capture and encode the
           middle quarter of a 1920x1080 plane:

                   ffmpeg -f kmsgrab -i - -vf 'hwmap=derive_device=vaapi,crop=960:540:480:270,scale_vaapi=960:540:nv12' -c:v h264_vaapi output.mp4

   lavfi
       Libavfilter input virtual device.

       This input device reads data from the open output pads of a libavfilter filtergraph.

       For each filtergraph open output, the input device will create a corresponding stream which is mapped to
       the generated output.  The filtergraph is specified through the option graph.

       Options

       graph
           Specify the filtergraph to use as input. Each video open output must be labelled by a unique string
           of the form "outN", where N is a number starting from 0 corresponding to the mapped input stream
           generated by the device.  The first unlabelled output is automatically assigned to the "out0" label,
           but all the others need to be specified explicitly.

           The suffix "+subcc" can be appended to the output label to create an extra stream with the closed
           captions packets attached to that output (experimental; only for EIA-608 / CEA-708 for now).  The
           subcc streams are created after all the normal streams, in the order of the corresponding stream.
           For example, if there is "out19+subcc", "out7+subcc" and up to "out42", the stream #43 is subcc for
           stream #7 and stream #44 is subcc for stream #19.

           If not specified defaults to the filename specified for the input device.

       graph_file
           Set the filename of the filtergraph to be read and sent to the other filters. Syntax of the
           filtergraph is the same as the one specified by the option graph.

       dumpgraph
           Dump graph to stderr.

       Examples

       •   Create a color video stream and play it back with ffplay:

                   ffplay -f lavfi -graph "color=c=pink [out0]" dummy

       •   As the previous example, but use filename for specifying the graph description, and omit the "out0"
           label:

                   ffplay -f lavfi color=c=pink

       •   Create three different video test filtered sources and play them:

                   ffplay -f lavfi -graph "testsrc [out0]; testsrc,hflip [out1]; testsrc,negate [out2]" test3

       •   Read an audio stream from a file using the amovie source and play it back with ffplay:

                   ffplay -f lavfi "amovie=test.wav"

       •   Read an audio stream and a video stream and play it back with ffplay:

                   ffplay -f lavfi "movie=test.avi[out0];amovie=test.wav[out1]"

       •   Dump decoded frames to images and closed captions to a file (experimental):

                   ffmpeg -f lavfi -i "movie=test.ts[out0+subcc]" -map v frame%08d.png -map s -c copy -f rawvideo subcc.bin

   libcdio
       Audio-CD input device based on libcdio.

       To enable this input device during configuration you need libcdio installed on your system. It requires
       the configure option "--enable-libcdio".

       This device allows playing and grabbing from an Audio-CD.

       For example to copy with ffmpeg the entire Audio-CD in /dev/sr0, you may run the command:

               ffmpeg -f libcdio -i /dev/sr0 cd.wav

       Options

       speed
           Set drive reading speed. Default value is 0.

           The speed is specified CD-ROM speed units. The speed is set through the libcdio
           "cdio_cddap_speed_set" function. On many CD-ROM drives, specifying a value too large will result in
           using the fastest speed.

       paranoia_mode
           Set paranoia recovery mode flags. It accepts one of the following values:

           disable
           verify
           overlap
           neverskip
           full

           Default value is disable.

           For more information about the available recovery modes, consult the paranoia project documentation.

   libdc1394
       IIDC1394 input device, based on libdc1394 and libraw1394.

       Requires the configure option "--enable-libdc1394".

       Options

       framerate
           Set the frame rate. Default is "ntsc", corresponding to a frame rate of "30000/1001".

       pixel_format
           Select the pixel format. Default is "uyvy422".

       video_size
           Set the video size given as a string such as "640x480" or "hd720".  Default is "qvga".

   openal
       The OpenAL input device provides audio capture on all systems with a working OpenAL 1.1 implementation.

       To enable this input device during configuration, you need OpenAL headers and libraries installed on your
       system, and need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-openal".

       OpenAL headers and libraries should be provided as part of your OpenAL implementation, or as an
       additional download (an SDK). Depending on your installation you may need to specify additional flags via
       the "--extra-cflags" and "--extra-ldflags" for allowing the build system to locate the OpenAL headers and
       libraries.

       An incomplete list of OpenAL implementations follows:

       Creative
           The official Windows implementation, providing hardware acceleration with supported devices and
           software fallback.  See <http://openal.org/>.

       OpenAL Soft
           Portable, open source (LGPL) software implementation. Includes backends for the most common sound
           APIs on the Windows, Linux, Solaris, and BSD operating systems.  See
           <http://kcat.strangesoft.net/openal.html>.

       Apple
           OpenAL is part of Core Audio, the official Mac OS X Audio interface.  See
           <http://developer.apple.com/technologies/mac/audio-and-video.html>

       This device allows one to capture from an audio input device handled through OpenAL.

       You need to specify the name of the device to capture in the provided filename. If the empty string is
       provided, the device will automatically select the default device. You can get the list of the supported
       devices by using the option list_devices.

       Options

       channels
           Set the number of channels in the captured audio. Only the values 1 (monaural) and 2 (stereo) are
           currently supported.  Defaults to 2.

       sample_size
           Set the sample size (in bits) of the captured audio. Only the values 8 and 16 are currently
           supported. Defaults to 16.

       sample_rate
           Set the sample rate (in Hz) of the captured audio.  Defaults to 44.1k.

       list_devices
           If set to true, print a list of devices and exit.  Defaults to false.

       Examples

       Print the list of OpenAL supported devices and exit:

               $ ffmpeg -list_devices true -f openal -i dummy out.ogg

       Capture from the OpenAL device DR-BT101 via PulseAudio:

               $ ffmpeg -f openal -i 'DR-BT101 via PulseAudio' out.ogg

       Capture from the default device (note the empty string '' as filename):

               $ ffmpeg -f openal -i '' out.ogg

       Capture from two devices simultaneously, writing to two different files, within the same ffmpeg command:

               $ ffmpeg -f openal -i 'DR-BT101 via PulseAudio' out1.ogg -f openal -i 'ALSA Default' out2.ogg

       Note: not all OpenAL implementations support multiple simultaneous capture - try the latest OpenAL Soft
       if the above does not work.

   oss
       Open Sound System input device.

       The filename to provide to the input device is the device node representing the OSS input device, and is
       usually set to /dev/dsp.

       For example to grab from /dev/dsp using ffmpeg use the command:

               ffmpeg -f oss -i /dev/dsp /tmp/oss.wav

       For more information about OSS see: <http://manuals.opensound.com/usersguide/dsp.html>

       Options

       sample_rate
           Set the sample rate in Hz. Default is 48000.

       channels
           Set the number of channels. Default is 2.

   pulse
       PulseAudio input device.

       To enable this output device you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libpulse".

       The filename to provide to the input device is a source device or the string "default"

       To list the PulseAudio source devices and their properties you can invoke the command pactl list sources.

       More information about PulseAudio can be found on <http://www.pulseaudio.org>.

       Options

       server
           Connect to a specific PulseAudio server, specified by an IP address.  Default server is used when not
           provided.

       name
           Specify the application name PulseAudio will use when showing active clients, by default it is the
           "LIBAVFORMAT_IDENT" string.

       stream_name
           Specify the stream name PulseAudio will use when showing active streams, by default it is "record".

       sample_rate
           Specify the samplerate in Hz, by default 48kHz is used.

       channels
           Specify the channels in use, by default 2 (stereo) is set.

       frame_size
           This option does nothing and is deprecated.

       fragment_size
           Specify the size in bytes of the minimal buffering fragment in PulseAudio, it will affect the audio
           latency. By default it is set to 50 ms amount of data.

       wallclock
           Set the initial PTS using the current time. Default is 1.

       Examples

       Record a stream from default device:

               ffmpeg -f pulse -i default /tmp/pulse.wav

   sndio
       sndio input device.

       To enable this input device during configuration you need libsndio installed on your system.

       The filename to provide to the input device is the device node representing the sndio input device, and
       is usually set to /dev/audio0.

       For example to grab from /dev/audio0 using ffmpeg use the command:

               ffmpeg -f sndio -i /dev/audio0 /tmp/oss.wav

       Options

       sample_rate
           Set the sample rate in Hz. Default is 48000.

       channels
           Set the number of channels. Default is 2.

   video4linux2, v4l2
       Video4Linux2 input video device.

       "v4l2" can be used as alias for "video4linux2".

       If FFmpeg is built with v4l-utils support (by using the "--enable-libv4l2" configure option), it is
       possible to use it with the "-use_libv4l2" input device option.

       The name of the device to grab is a file device node, usually Linux systems tend to automatically create
       such nodes when the device (e.g. an USB webcam) is plugged into the system, and has a name of the kind
       /dev/videoN, where N is a number associated to the device.

       Video4Linux2 devices usually support a limited set of widthxheight sizes and frame rates. You can check
       which are supported using -list_formats all for Video4Linux2 devices.  Some devices, like TV cards,
       support one or more standards. It is possible to list all the supported standards using -list_standards
       all.

       The time base for the timestamps is 1 microsecond. Depending on the kernel version and configuration, the
       timestamps may be derived from the real time clock (origin at the Unix Epoch) or the monotonic clock
       (origin usually at boot time, unaffected by NTP or manual changes to the clock). The -timestamps abs or
       -ts abs option can be used to force conversion into the real time clock.

       Some usage examples of the video4linux2 device with ffmpeg and ffplay:

       •   List supported formats for a video4linux2 device:

                   ffplay -f video4linux2 -list_formats all /dev/video0

       •   Grab and show the input of a video4linux2 device:

                   ffplay -f video4linux2 -framerate 30 -video_size hd720 /dev/video0

       •   Grab and record the input of a video4linux2 device, leave the frame rate and size as previously set:

                   ffmpeg -f video4linux2 -input_format mjpeg -i /dev/video0 out.mpeg

       For more information about Video4Linux, check <http://linuxtv.org/>.

       Options

       standard
           Set the standard. Must be the name of a supported standard. To get a list of the supported standards,
           use the list_standards option.

       channel
           Set the input channel number. Default to -1, which means using the previously selected channel.

       video_size
           Set the video frame size. The argument must be a string in the form WIDTHxHEIGHT or a valid size
           abbreviation.

       pixel_format
           Select the pixel format (only valid for raw video input).

       input_format
           Set the preferred pixel format (for raw video) or a codec name.  This option allows one to select the
           input format, when several are available.

       framerate
           Set the preferred video frame rate.

       list_formats
           List available formats (supported pixel formats, codecs, and frame sizes) and exit.

           Available values are:

           all Show all available (compressed and non-compressed) formats.

           raw Show only raw video (non-compressed) formats.

           compressed
               Show only compressed formats.

       list_standards
           List supported standards and exit.

           Available values are:

           all Show all supported standards.

       timestamps, ts
           Set type of timestamps for grabbed frames.

           Available values are:

           default
               Use timestamps from the kernel.

           abs Use absolute timestamps (wall clock).

           mono2abs
               Force conversion from monotonic to absolute timestamps.

           Default value is "default".

       use_libv4l2
           Use libv4l2 (v4l-utils) conversion functions. Default is 0.

   vfwcap
       VfW (Video for Windows) capture input device.

       The filename passed as input is the capture driver number, ranging from 0 to 9. You may use "list" as
       filename to print a list of drivers. Any other filename will be interpreted as device number 0.

       Options

       video_size
           Set the video frame size.

       framerate
           Set the grabbing frame rate. Default value is "ntsc", corresponding to a frame rate of "30000/1001".

   x11grab
       X11 video input device.

       To enable this input device during configuration you need libxcb installed on your system. It will be
       automatically detected during configuration.

       This device allows one to capture a region of an X11 display.

       The filename passed as input has the syntax:

               [<hostname>]:<display_number>.<screen_number>[+<x_offset>,<y_offset>]

       hostname:display_number.screen_number specifies the X11 display name of the screen to grab from. hostname
       can be omitted, and defaults to "localhost". The environment variable DISPLAY contains the default
       display name.

       x_offset and y_offset specify the offsets of the grabbed area with respect to the top-left border of the
       X11 screen. They default to 0.

       Check the X11 documentation (e.g. man X) for more detailed information.

       Use the xdpyinfo program for getting basic information about the properties of your X11 display (e.g.
       grep for "name" or "dimensions").

       For example to grab from :0.0 using ffmpeg:

               ffmpeg -f x11grab -framerate 25 -video_size cif -i :0.0 out.mpg

       Grab at position "10,20":

               ffmpeg -f x11grab -framerate 25 -video_size cif -i :0.0+10,20 out.mpg

       Options

       select_region
           Specify whether to select the grabbing area graphically using the pointer.  A value of 1 prompts the
           user to select the grabbing area graphically by clicking and dragging. A single click with no
           dragging will select the whole screen. A region with zero width or height will also select the whole
           screen. This option overwrites the video_size, grab_x, and grab_y options. Default value is 0.

       draw_mouse
           Specify whether to draw the mouse pointer. A value of 0 specifies not to draw the pointer. Default
           value is 1.

       follow_mouse
           Make the grabbed area follow the mouse. The argument can be "centered" or a number of pixels PIXELS.

           When it is specified with "centered", the grabbing region follows the mouse pointer and keeps the
           pointer at the center of region; otherwise, the region follows only when the mouse pointer reaches
           within PIXELS (greater than zero) to the edge of region.

           For example:

                   ffmpeg -f x11grab -follow_mouse centered -framerate 25 -video_size cif -i :0.0 out.mpg

           To follow only when the mouse pointer reaches within 100 pixels to edge:

                   ffmpeg -f x11grab -follow_mouse 100 -framerate 25 -video_size cif -i :0.0 out.mpg

       framerate
           Set the grabbing frame rate. Default value is "ntsc", corresponding to a frame rate of "30000/1001".

       show_region
           Show grabbed region on screen.

           If show_region is specified with 1, then the grabbing region will be indicated on screen. With this
           option, it is easy to know what is being grabbed if only a portion of the screen is grabbed.

       region_border
           Set the region border thickness if -show_region 1 is used.  Range is 1 to 128 and default is 3 (XCB-
           based x11grab only).

           For example:

                   ffmpeg -f x11grab -show_region 1 -framerate 25 -video_size cif -i :0.0+10,20 out.mpg

           With follow_mouse:

                   ffmpeg -f x11grab -follow_mouse centered -show_region 1 -framerate 25 -video_size cif -i :0.0 out.mpg

       window_id
           Grab this window, instead of the whole screen. Default value is 0, which maps to the whole screen
           (root window).

           The id of a window can be found using the xwininfo program, possibly with options -tree and -root.

           If the window is later enlarged, the new area is not recorded. Video ends when the window is closed,
           unmapped (i.e., iconified) or shrunk beyond the video size (which defaults to the initial window
           size).

           This option disables options follow_mouse and select_region.

       video_size
           Set the video frame size. Default is the full desktop or window.

       grab_x
       grab_y
           Set the grabbing region coordinates. They are expressed as offset from the top left corner of the X11
           window and correspond to the x_offset and y_offset parameters in the device name. The default value
           for both options is 0.

OUTPUT DEVICES

       Output devices are configured elements in FFmpeg that can write multimedia data to an output device
       attached to your system.

       When you configure your FFmpeg build, all the supported output devices are enabled by default. You can
       list all available ones using the configure option "--list-outdevs".

       You can disable all the output devices using the configure option "--disable-outdevs", and selectively
       enable an output device using the option "--enable-outdev=OUTDEV", or you can disable a particular input
       device using the option "--disable-outdev=OUTDEV".

       The option "-devices" of the ff* tools will display the list of enabled output devices.

       A description of the currently available output devices follows.

   alsa
       ALSA (Advanced Linux Sound Architecture) output device.

       Examples

       •   Play a file on default ALSA device:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -f alsa default

       •   Play a file on soundcard 1, audio device 7:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -f alsa hw:1,7

   AudioToolbox
       AudioToolbox output device.

       Allows native output to CoreAudio devices on OSX.

       The output filename can be empty (or "-") to refer to the default system output device or a number that
       refers to the device index as shown using: "-list_devices true".

       Alternatively, the audio input device can be chosen by index using the

           B<-audio_device_index E<lt>INDEXE<gt>>

       , overriding any device name or index given in the input filename.

       All available devices can be enumerated by using -list_devices true, listing all device names, UIDs and
       corresponding indices.

       Options

       AudioToolbox supports the following options:

       -audio_device_index <INDEX>
           Specify the audio device by its index. Overrides anything given in the output filename.

       Examples

       •   Print the list of supported devices and output a sine wave to the default device:

                   $ ffmpeg -f lavfi -i sine=r=44100 -f audiotoolbox -list_devices true -

       •   Output a sine wave to the device with the index 2, overriding any output filename:

                   $ ffmpeg -f lavfi -i sine=r=44100 -f audiotoolbox -audio_device_index 2 -

   caca
       CACA output device.

       This output device allows one to show a video stream in CACA window.  Only one CACA window is allowed per
       application, so you can have only one instance of this output device in an application.

       To enable this output device you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libcaca".  libcaca is a graphics
       library that outputs text instead of pixels.

       For more information about libcaca, check: <http://caca.zoy.org/wiki/libcaca>

       Options

       window_title
           Set the CACA window title, if not specified default to the filename specified for the output device.

       window_size
           Set the CACA window size, can be a string of the form widthxheight or a video size abbreviation.  If
           not specified it defaults to the size of the input video.

       driver
           Set display driver.

       algorithm
           Set dithering algorithm. Dithering is necessary because the picture being rendered has usually far
           more colours than the available palette.  The accepted values are listed with "-list_dither
           algorithms".

       antialias
           Set antialias method. Antialiasing smoothens the rendered image and avoids the commonly seen
           staircase effect.  The accepted values are listed with "-list_dither antialiases".

       charset
           Set which characters are going to be used when rendering text.  The accepted values are listed with
           "-list_dither charsets".

       color
           Set color to be used when rendering text.  The accepted values are listed with "-list_dither colors".

       list_drivers
           If set to true, print a list of available drivers and exit.

       list_dither
           List available dither options related to the argument.  The argument must be one of "algorithms",
           "antialiases", "charsets", "colors".

       Examples

       •   The following command shows the ffmpeg output is an CACA window, forcing its size to 80x25:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:v rawvideo -pix_fmt rgb24 -window_size 80x25 -f caca -

       •   Show the list of available drivers and exit:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -pix_fmt rgb24 -f caca -list_drivers true -

       •   Show the list of available dither colors and exit:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -pix_fmt rgb24 -f caca -list_dither colors -

   decklink
       The decklink output device provides playback capabilities for Blackmagic DeckLink devices.

       To enable this output device, you need the Blackmagic DeckLink SDK and you need to configure with the
       appropriate "--extra-cflags" and "--extra-ldflags".  On Windows, you need to run the IDL files through
       widl.

       DeckLink is very picky about the formats it supports. Pixel format is always uyvy422, framerate, field
       order and video size must be determined for your device with -list_formats 1. Audio sample rate is always
       48 kHz.

       Options

       list_devices
           If set to true, print a list of devices and exit.  Defaults to false. This option is deprecated,
           please use the "-sinks" option of ffmpeg to list the available output devices.

       list_formats
           If set to true, print a list of supported formats and exit.  Defaults to false.

       preroll
           Amount of time to preroll video in seconds.  Defaults to 0.5.

       duplex_mode
           Sets the decklink device duplex/profile mode. Must be unset, half, full, one_sub_device_full,
           one_sub_device_half, two_sub_device_full, four_sub_device_half Defaults to unset.

           Note: DeckLink SDK 11.0 have replaced the duplex property by a profile property.  For the DeckLink
           Duo 2 and DeckLink Quad 2, a profile is shared between any 2 sub-devices that utilize the same
           connectors. For the DeckLink 8K Pro, a profile is shared between all 4 sub-devices. So DeckLink 8K
           Pro support four profiles.

           Valid profile modes for DeckLink 8K Pro(with DeckLink SDK >= 11.0): one_sub_device_full,
           one_sub_device_half, two_sub_device_full, four_sub_device_half

           Valid profile modes for DeckLink Quad 2 and DeckLink Duo 2: half, full

       timing_offset
           Sets the genlock timing pixel offset on the used output.  Defaults to unset.

       link
           Sets the SDI video link configuration on the used output. Must be unset, single link SDI, dual link
           SDI or quad link SDI.  Defaults to unset.

       sqd Enable Square Division Quad Split mode for Quad-link SDI output.  Must be unset, true or false.
           Defaults to unset.

       level_a
           Enable SMPTE Level A mode on the used output.  Must be unset, true or false.  Defaults to unset.

       vanc_queue_size
           Sets maximum output buffer size in bytes for VANC data. If the buffering reaches this value, outgoing
           VANC data will be dropped.  Defaults to 1048576.

       Examples

       •   List output devices:

                   ffmpeg -sinks decklink

       •   List supported formats:

                   ffmpeg -i test.avi -f decklink -list_formats 1 'DeckLink Mini Monitor'

       •   Play video clip:

                   ffmpeg -i test.avi -f decklink -pix_fmt uyvy422 'DeckLink Mini Monitor'

       •   Play video clip with non-standard framerate or video size:

                   ffmpeg -i test.avi -f decklink -pix_fmt uyvy422 -s 720x486 -r 24000/1001 'DeckLink Mini Monitor'

   fbdev
       Linux framebuffer output device.

       The Linux framebuffer is a graphic hardware-independent abstraction layer to show graphics on a computer
       monitor, typically on the console. It is accessed through a file device node, usually /dev/fb0.

       For more detailed information read the file Documentation/fb/framebuffer.txt included in the Linux source
       tree.

       Options

       xoffset
       yoffset
           Set x/y coordinate of top left corner. Default is 0.

       Examples

       Play a file on framebuffer device /dev/fb0.  Required pixel format depends on current framebuffer
       settings.

               ffmpeg -re -i INPUT -c:v rawvideo -pix_fmt bgra -f fbdev /dev/fb0

       See also <http://linux-fbdev.sourceforge.net/>, and fbset(1).

   opengl
       OpenGL output device. Deprecated and will be removed.

       To enable this output device you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-opengl".

       This output device allows one to render to OpenGL context.  Context may be provided by application or
       default SDL window is created.

       When device renders to external context, application must implement handlers for following messages:
       "AV_DEV_TO_APP_CREATE_WINDOW_BUFFER" - create OpenGL context on current thread.
       "AV_DEV_TO_APP_PREPARE_WINDOW_BUFFER" - make OpenGL context current.
       "AV_DEV_TO_APP_DISPLAY_WINDOW_BUFFER" - swap buffers.  "AV_DEV_TO_APP_DESTROY_WINDOW_BUFFER" - destroy
       OpenGL context.  Application is also required to inform a device about current resolution by sending
       "AV_APP_TO_DEV_WINDOW_SIZE" message.

       Options

       background
           Set background color. Black is a default.

       no_window
           Disables default SDL window when set to non-zero value.  Application must provide OpenGL context and
           both "window_size_cb" and "window_swap_buffers_cb" callbacks when set.

       window_title
           Set the SDL window title, if not specified default to the filename specified for the output device.
           Ignored when no_window is set.

       window_size
           Set preferred window size, can be a string of the form widthxheight or a video size abbreviation.  If
           not specified it defaults to the size of the input video, downscaled according to the aspect ratio.
           Mostly usable when no_window is not set.

       Examples

       Play a file on SDL window using OpenGL rendering:

               ffmpeg  -i INPUT -f opengl "window title"

   oss
       OSS (Open Sound System) output device.

   pulse
       PulseAudio output device.

       To enable this output device you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libpulse".

       More information about PulseAudio can be found on <http://www.pulseaudio.org>

       Options

       server
           Connect to a specific PulseAudio server, specified by an IP address.  Default server is used when not
           provided.

       name
           Specify the application name PulseAudio will use when showing active clients, by default it is the
           "LIBAVFORMAT_IDENT" string.

       stream_name
           Specify the stream name PulseAudio will use when showing active streams, by default it is set to the
           specified output name.

       device
           Specify the device to use. Default device is used when not provided.  List of output devices can be
           obtained with command pactl list sinks.

       buffer_size
       buffer_duration
           Control the size and duration of the PulseAudio buffer. A small buffer gives more control, but
           requires more frequent updates.

           buffer_size specifies size in bytes while buffer_duration specifies duration in milliseconds.

           When both options are provided then the highest value is used (duration is recalculated to bytes
           using stream parameters). If they are set to 0 (which is default), the device will use the default
           PulseAudio duration value. By default PulseAudio set buffer duration to around 2 seconds.

       prebuf
           Specify pre-buffering size in bytes. The server does not start with playback before at least prebuf
           bytes are available in the buffer. By default this option is initialized to the same value as
           buffer_size or buffer_duration (whichever is bigger).

       minreq
           Specify minimum request size in bytes. The server does not request less than minreq bytes from the
           client, instead waits until the buffer is free enough to request more bytes at once. It is
           recommended to not set this option, which will initialize this to a value that is deemed sensible by
           the server.

       Examples

       Play a file on default device on default server:

               ffmpeg  -i INPUT -f pulse "stream name"

   sdl
       SDL (Simple DirectMedia Layer) output device. Deprecated and will be removed.

       For monitoring purposes in FFmpeg, pipes and a video player such as ffplay can be used:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -f nut -c:v rawvideo - | ffplay -

       "sdl2" can be used as alias for "sdl".

       This output device allows one to show a video stream in an SDL window. Only one SDL window is allowed per
       application, so you can have only one instance of this output device in an application.

       To enable this output device you need libsdl installed on your system when configuring your build.

       For more information about SDL, check: <http://www.libsdl.org/>

       Options

       window_borderless
           Set SDL window border off.  Default value is 0 (enable window border).

       window_enable_quit
           Enable quit action (using window button or keyboard key) when non-zero value is provided.  Default
           value is 1 (enable quit action).

       window_fullscreen
           Set fullscreen mode when non-zero value is provided.  Default value is zero.

       window_size
           Set the SDL window size, can be a string of the form widthxheight or a video size abbreviation.  If
           not specified it defaults to the size of the input video, downscaled according to the aspect ratio.

       window_title
           Set the SDL window title, if not specified default to the filename specified for the output device.

       window_x
       window_y
           Set the position of the window on the screen.

       Interactive commands

       The window created by the device can be controlled through the following interactive commands.

       q, ESC
           Quit the device immediately.

       Examples

       The following command shows the ffmpeg output is an SDL window, forcing its size to the qcif format:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -c:v rawvideo -pix_fmt yuv420p -window_size qcif -f sdl "SDL output"

   sndio
       sndio audio output device.

   v4l2
       Video4Linux2 output device.

   xv
       XV (XVideo) output device.

       This output device allows one to show a video stream in a X Window System window.

       Options

       display_name
           Specify the hardware display name, which determines the display and communications domain to be used.

           The display name or DISPLAY environment variable can be a string in the format
           hostname[:number[.screen_number]].

           hostname specifies the name of the host machine on which the display is physically attached. number
           specifies the number of the display server on that host machine. screen_number specifies the screen
           to be used on that server.

           If unspecified, it defaults to the value of the DISPLAY environment variable.

           For example, "dual-headed:0.1" would specify screen 1 of display 0 on the machine named
           ``dual-headed''.

           Check the X11 specification for more detailed information about the display name format.

       window_id
           When set to non-zero value then device doesn't create new window, but uses existing one with provided
           window_id. By default this options is set to zero and device creates its own window.

       window_size
           Set the created window size, can be a string of the form widthxheight or a video size abbreviation.
           If not specified it defaults to the size of the input video.  Ignored when window_id is set.

       window_x
       window_y
           Set the X and Y window offsets for the created window. They are both set to 0 by default. The values
           may be ignored by the window manager.  Ignored when window_id is set.

       window_title
           Set the window title, if not specified default to the filename specified for the output device.
           Ignored when window_id is set.

       For more information about XVideo see <http://www.x.org/>.

       Examples

       •   Decode, display and encode video input with ffmpeg at the same time:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT OUTPUT -f xv display

       •   Decode and display the input video to multiple X11 windows:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -f xv normal -vf negate -f xv negated

RESAMPLER OPTIONS

       The audio resampler supports the following named options.

       Options may be set by specifying -option value in the FFmpeg tools, option=value for the aresample
       filter, by setting the value explicitly in the "SwrContext" options or using the libavutil/opt.h API for
       programmatic use.

       uchl, used_chlayout
           Set used input channel layout. Default is unset. This option is only used for special remapping.

       isr, in_sample_rate
           Set the input sample rate. Default value is 0.

       osr, out_sample_rate
           Set the output sample rate. Default value is 0.

       isf, in_sample_fmt
           Specify the input sample format. It is set by default to "none".

       osf, out_sample_fmt
           Specify the output sample format. It is set by default to "none".

       tsf, internal_sample_fmt
           Set the internal sample format. Default value is "none".  This will automatically be chosen when it
           is not explicitly set.

       ichl, in_chlayout
       ochl, out_chlayout
           Set the input/output channel layout.

           See the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for the required syntax.

       clev, center_mix_level
           Set the center mix level. It is a value expressed in deciBel, and must be in the interval [-32,32].

       slev, surround_mix_level
           Set the surround mix level. It is a value expressed in deciBel, and must be in the interval [-32,32].

       lfe_mix_level
           Set LFE mix into non LFE level. It is used when there is a LFE input but no LFE output. It is a value
           expressed in deciBel, and must be in the interval [-32,32].

       rmvol, rematrix_volume
           Set rematrix volume. Default value is 1.0.

       rematrix_maxval
           Set maximum output value for rematrixing.  This can be used to prevent clipping vs. preventing volume
           reduction.  A value of 1.0 prevents clipping.

       flags, swr_flags
           Set flags used by the converter. Default value is 0.

           It supports the following individual flags:

           res force resampling, this flag forces resampling to be used even when the input and output sample
               rates match.

       dither_scale
           Set the dither scale. Default value is 1.

       dither_method
           Set dither method. Default value is 0.

           Supported values:

           rectangular
               select rectangular dither

           triangular
               select triangular dither

           triangular_hp
               select triangular dither with high pass

           lipshitz
               select Lipshitz noise shaping dither.

           shibata
               select Shibata noise shaping dither.

           low_shibata
               select low Shibata noise shaping dither.

           high_shibata
               select high Shibata noise shaping dither.

           f_weighted
               select f-weighted noise shaping dither

           modified_e_weighted
               select modified-e-weighted noise shaping dither

           improved_e_weighted
               select improved-e-weighted noise shaping dither

       resampler
           Set resampling engine. Default value is swr.

           Supported values:

           swr select the native SW Resampler; filter options precision and cheby are not applicable in this
               case.

           soxr
               select the SoX Resampler (where available); compensation, and filter options filter_size,
               phase_shift, exact_rational, filter_type & kaiser_beta, are not applicable in this case.

       filter_size
           For swr only, set resampling filter size, default value is 32.

       phase_shift
           For swr only, set resampling phase shift, default value is 10, and must be in the interval [0,30].

       linear_interp
           Use linear interpolation when enabled (the default). Disable it if you want to preserve speed instead
           of quality when exact_rational fails.

       exact_rational
           For swr only, when enabled, try to use exact phase_count based on input and output sample rate.
           However, if it is larger than "1 << phase_shift", the phase_count will be "1 << phase_shift" as
           fallback. Default is enabled.

       cutoff
           Set cutoff frequency (swr: 6dB point; soxr: 0dB point) ratio; must be a float value between 0 and 1.
           Default value is 0.97 with swr, and 0.91 with soxr (which, with a sample-rate of 44100, preserves the
           entire audio band to 20kHz).

       precision
           For soxr only, the precision in bits to which the resampled signal will be calculated.  The default
           value of 20 (which, with suitable dithering, is appropriate for a destination bit-depth of 16) gives
           SoX's 'High Quality'; a value of 28 gives SoX's 'Very High Quality'.

       cheby
           For soxr only, selects passband rolloff none (Chebyshev) & higher-precision approximation for
           'irrational' ratios. Default value is 0.

       async
           For swr only, simple 1 parameter audio sync to timestamps using stretching, squeezing, filling and
           trimming. Setting this to 1 will enable filling and trimming, larger values represent the maximum
           amount in samples that the data may be stretched or squeezed for each second.  Default value is 0,
           thus no compensation is applied to make the samples match the audio timestamps.

       first_pts
           For swr only, assume the first pts should be this value. The time unit is 1 / sample rate.  This
           allows for padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made about the first
           frame's expected pts, so no padding or trimming is done. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad
           the beginning with silence if an audio stream starts after the video stream or to trim any samples
           with a negative pts due to encoder delay.

       min_comp
           For swr only, set the minimum difference between timestamps and audio data (in seconds) to trigger
           stretching/squeezing/filling or trimming of the data to make it match the timestamps. The default is
           that stretching/squeezing/filling and trimming is disabled (min_comp = "FLT_MAX").

       min_hard_comp
           For swr only, set the minimum difference between timestamps and audio data (in seconds) to trigger
           adding/dropping samples to make it match the timestamps.  This option effectively is a threshold to
           select between hard (trim/fill) and soft (squeeze/stretch) compensation. Note that all compensation
           is by default disabled through min_comp.  The default is 0.1.

       comp_duration
           For swr only, set duration (in seconds) over which data is stretched/squeezed to make it match the
           timestamps. Must be a non-negative double float value, default value is 1.0.

       max_soft_comp
           For swr only, set maximum factor by which data is stretched/squeezed to make it match the timestamps.
           Must be a non-negative double float value, default value is 0.

       matrix_encoding
           Select matrixed stereo encoding.

           It accepts the following values:

           none
               select none

           dolby
               select Dolby

           dplii
               select Dolby Pro Logic II

           Default value is "none".

       filter_type
           For swr only, select resampling filter type. This only affects resampling operations.

           It accepts the following values:

           cubic
               select cubic

           blackman_nuttall
               select Blackman Nuttall windowed sinc

           kaiser
               select Kaiser windowed sinc

       kaiser_beta
           For swr only, set Kaiser window beta value. Must be a double float value in the interval [2,16],
           default value is 9.

       output_sample_bits
           For swr only, set number of used output sample bits for dithering. Must be an integer in the interval
           [0,64], default value is 0, which means it's not used.

SCALER OPTIONS

       The video scaler supports the following named options.

       Options may be set by specifying -option value in the FFmpeg tools, with a few API-only exceptions noted
       below.  For programmatic use, they can be set explicitly in the "SwsContext" options or through the
       libavutil/opt.h API.

       sws_flags
           Set the scaler flags. This is also used to set the scaling algorithm. Only a single algorithm should
           be selected. Default value is bicubic.

           It accepts the following values:

           fast_bilinear
               Select fast bilinear scaling algorithm.

           bilinear
               Select bilinear scaling algorithm.

           bicubic
               Select bicubic scaling algorithm.

           experimental
               Select experimental scaling algorithm.

           neighbor
               Select nearest neighbor rescaling algorithm.

           area
               Select averaging area rescaling algorithm.

           bicublin
               Select bicubic scaling algorithm for the luma component, bilinear for chroma components.

           gauss
               Select Gaussian rescaling algorithm.

           sinc
               Select sinc rescaling algorithm.

           lanczos
               Select Lanczos rescaling algorithm. The default width (alpha) is 3 and can be changed by setting
               "param0".

           spline
               Select natural bicubic spline rescaling algorithm.

           print_info
               Enable printing/debug logging.

           accurate_rnd
               Enable accurate rounding.

           full_chroma_int
               Enable full chroma interpolation.

           full_chroma_inp
               Select full chroma input.

           bitexact
               Enable bitexact output.

       srcw (API only)
           Set source width.

       srch (API only)
           Set source height.

       dstw (API only)
           Set destination width.

       dsth (API only)
           Set destination height.

       src_format (API only)
           Set source pixel format (must be expressed as an integer).

       dst_format (API only)
           Set destination pixel format (must be expressed as an integer).

       src_range (boolean)
           If value is set to 1, indicates source is full range. Default value is 0, which indicates source is
           limited range.

       dst_range (boolean)
           If value is set to 1, enable full range for destination. Default value is 0, which enables limited
           range.

       param0, param1
           Set scaling algorithm parameters. The specified values are specific of some scaling algorithms and
           ignored by others. The specified values are floating point number values.

       sws_dither
           Set the dithering algorithm. Accepts one of the following values. Default value is auto.

           auto
               automatic choice

           none
               no dithering

           bayer
               bayer dither

           ed  error diffusion dither

           a_dither
               arithmetic dither, based using addition

           x_dither
               arithmetic dither, based using xor (more random/less apparent patterning that a_dither).

       alphablend
           Set the alpha blending to use when the input has alpha but the output does not.  Default value is
           none.

           uniform_color
               Blend onto a uniform background color

           checkerboard
               Blend onto a checkerboard

           none
               No blending

FILTERING INTRODUCTION

       Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.

       In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple outputs.  To illustrate the sorts of
       things that are possible, we consider the following filtergraph.

                               [main]
               input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
                           |                             ^
                           |[tmp]                  [flip]|
                           +-----> crop --> vflip -------+

       This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one stream through the crop filter
       and the vflip filter, before merging it back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use
       the following command to achieve this:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT

       The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored onto the bottom half of the output video.

       Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct linear chains of filters are
       separated by semicolons. In our example, crop,vflip are in one linear chain, split and overlay are
       separately in another. The points where the linear chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square
       brackets. In the example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to the labels [main]
       and [tmp].

       The stream sent to the second output of split, labelled as [tmp], is processed through the crop filter,
       which crops away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The overlay filter takes
       in input the first unchanged output of the split filter (which was labelled as [main]), and overlay on
       its lower half the output generated by the crop,vflip filterchain.

       Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified after the filter name and an equal
       sign, and are separated from each other by a colon.

       There exist so-called source filters that do not have an audio/video input, and sink filters that will
       not have audio/video output.

GRAPH

       The graph2dot program included in the FFmpeg tools directory can be used to parse a filtergraph
       description and issue a corresponding textual representation in the dot language.

       Invoke the command:

               graph2dot -h

       to see how to use graph2dot.

       You can then pass the dot description to the dot program (from the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain
       a graphical representation of the filtergraph.

       For example the sequence of commands:

               echo <GRAPH_DESCRIPTION> | \
               tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
               dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
               display graph.png

       can be used to create and display an image representing the graph described by the GRAPH_DESCRIPTION
       string. Note that this string must be a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs
       explicitly defined.  For example if your command line is of the form:

               ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile

       your GRAPH_DESCRIPTION string will need to be of the form:

               nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink

       you may also need to set the nullsrc parameters and add a format filter in order to simulate a specific
       input file.

FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION

       A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain cycles, and there can be multiple
       links between a pair of filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one filter from
       which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other side connecting it to one filter accepting its
       output.

       Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class registered in the application, which
       defines the features and the number of input and output pads of the filter.

       A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no output pads is called a "sink".

   Filtergraph syntax
       A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the -filter/-vf/-af and
       -filter_complex options in ffmpeg and -vf/-af in ffplay, and by the avfilter_graph_parse_ptr() function
       defined in libavfilter/avfilter.h.

       A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one connected to the previous one in the
       sequence. A filterchain is represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.

       A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of filterchains is represented by a list
       of ";"-separated filterchain descriptions.

       A filter is represented by a string of the form:
       [in_link_1]...[in_link_N]filter_name@id=arguments[out_link_1]...[out_link_M]

       filter_name is the name of the filter class of which the described filter is an instance of, and has to
       be the name of one of the filter classes registered in the program optionally followed by "@id".  The
       name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string "=arguments".

       arguments is a string which contains the parameters used to initialize the filter instance. It may have
       one of two forms:

       •   A ':'-separated list of key=value pairs.

       •   A ':'-separated list of value. In this case, the keys are assumed to be the option names in the order
           they are declared. E.g. the "fade" filter declares three options in this order -- type, start_frame
           and nb_frames. Then the parameter list in:0:30 means that the value in is assigned to the option
           type, 0 to start_frame and 30 to nb_frames.

       •   A ':'-separated list of mixed direct value and long key=value pairs. The direct value must precede
           the key=value pairs, and follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
           key=value pairs can be set in any preferred order.

       If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the "format" filter takes a list of pixel formats),
       the items in the list are usually separated by |.

       The list of arguments can be quoted using the character ' as initial and ending mark, and the character \
       for escaping the characters within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
       terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set []=;,) is encountered.

       A special syntax implemented in the ffmpeg CLI tool allows loading option values from files. This is done
       be prepending a slash '/' to the option name, then the supplied value is interpreted as a path from which
       the actual value is loaded. E.g.

               ffmpeg -i <INPUT> -vf drawtext=/text=/tmp/some_text <OUTPUT>

       will load the text to be drawn from /tmp/some_text. API users wishing to implement a similar feature
       should use the "avfilter_graph_segment_*()" functions together with custom IO code.

       The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and followed by a list of link labels.  A
       link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output or input pad. The preceding
       labels in_link_1 ... in_link_N, are associated to the filter input pads, the following labels out_link_1
       ... out_link_M, are associated to the output pads.

       When two link labels with the same name are found in the filtergraph, a link between the corresponding
       input and output pad is created.

       If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first unlabelled input pad of the next
       filter in the filterchain.  For example in the filterchain

               nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink

       the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter instance two input pads. The first
       output pad of split is labelled "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
       output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay, which are both unlabelled.

       In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not specified, "in" is assumed; if the
       output label of the last filter is not specified, "out" is assumed.

       In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output pads must be connected. A
       filtergraph is considered valid if all the filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are
       connected.

       Leading and trailing whitespaces (space, tabs, or line feeds) separating tokens in the filtergraph
       specification are ignored. This means that the filtergraph can be expressed using empty lines and spaces
       to improve redability.

       For example, the filtergraph:

               testsrc,split[L1],hflip[L2];[L1][L2] hstack

       can be represented as:

               testsrc,
               split [L1], hflip [L2];

               [L1][L2] hstack

       Libavfilter will automatically insert scale filters where format conversion is required. It is possible
       to specify swscale flags for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending "sws_flags=flags;" to the
       filtergraph description.

       Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:

               <NAME>             ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
               <FILTER_NAME>      ::= <NAME>["@"<NAME>]
               <LINKLABEL>        ::= "[" <NAME> "]"
               <LINKLABELS>       ::= <LINKLABEL> [<LINKLABELS>]
               <FILTER_ARGUMENTS> ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
               <FILTER>           ::= [<LINKLABELS>] <FILTER_NAME> ["=" <FILTER_ARGUMENTS>] [<LINKLABELS>]
               <FILTERCHAIN>      ::= <FILTER> [,<FILTERCHAIN>]
               <FILTERGRAPH>      ::= [sws_flags=<flags>;] <FILTERCHAIN> [;<FILTERGRAPH>]

   Notes on filtergraph escaping
       Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of escaping. See the "Quoting and escaping"
       section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for more information about the employed escaping procedure.

       A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option value, which may contain the special
       character ":" used to separate values, or one of the escaping characters "\'".

       A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which may contain the escaping characters
       "\'" or the special characters "[],;" used by the filtergraph description.

       Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you need to perform a third level
       escaping for the shell special characters contained within it.

       For example, consider the following string to be embedded in the drawtext filter description text value:

               this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters

       This string contains the "'" special escaping character, and the ":" special character, so it needs to be
       escaped in this way:

               text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters

       A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter description in a filtergraph
       description, in order to escape all the filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:

               drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters

       (note that in addition to the "\'" escaping special characters, also "," needs to be escaped).

       Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the filtergraph description in a shell
       command, which depends on the escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that "\" is
       special and needs to be escaped with another "\", the previous string will finally result in:

               -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"

       In order to avoid cumbersome escaping when using a commandline tool accepting a filter specification as
       input, it is advisable to avoid direct inclusion of the filter or options specification in the shell.

       For example, in case of the drawtext filter, you might prefer to use the textfile option in place of text
       to specify the text to render.

TIMELINE EDITING

       Some filters support a generic enable option. For the filters supporting timeline editing, this option
       can be set to an expression which is evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is
       non-zero, the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the next filter in
       the filtergraph.

       The expression accepts the following values:

       t   timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown

       n   sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0

       pos the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown; deprecated, do not use

       w
       h   width and height of the input frame if video

       Additionally, these filters support an enable command that can be used to re-define the expression.

       Like any other filtering option, the enable option follows the same rules.

       For example, to enable a blur filter (smartblur) from 10 seconds to 3 minutes, and a curves filter
       starting at 3 seconds:

               smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
               curves    = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process

       See "ffmpeg -filters" to view which filters have timeline support.

CHANGING OPTIONS AT RUNTIME WITH A COMMAND

       Some options can be changed during the operation of the filter using a command. These options are marked
       'T' on the output of ffmpeg -h filter=<name of filter>.  The name of the command is the name of the
       option and the argument is the new value.

OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS

       Some filters with several inputs support a common set of options.  These options can only be set by name,
       not with the short notation.

       eof_action
           The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts one of the following
           values:

           repeat
               Repeat the last frame (the default).

           endall
               End both streams.

           pass
               Pass the main input through.

       shortest
           If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input terminates. Default value is 0.

       repeatlast
           If set to 1, force the filter to extend the last frame of secondary streams until the end of the
           primary stream. A value of 0 disables this behavior.  Default value is 1.

       ts_sync_mode
           How strictly to sync streams based on secondary input timestamps; it accepts one of the following
           values:

           default
               Frame from secondary input with the nearest lower or equal timestamp to the primary input frame.

           nearest
               Frame from secondary input with the absolute nearest timestamp to the primary input frame.

AUDIO FILTERS

       When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the existing filters using
       "--disable-filters".  The configure output will show the audio filters included in your build.

       Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.

   aap
       Apply Affine Projection algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.

       This adaptive filter is used to estimate unknown audio based on multiple input audio samples.  Affine
       projection algorithm can make trade-offs between computation complexity with convergence speed.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       order
           Set the filter order.

       projection
           Set the projection order.

       mu  Set the filter mu.

       delta
           Set the coefficient to initialize internal covariance matrix.

       out_mode
           Set the filter output samples. It accepts the following values:

           i   Pass the 1st input.

           d   Pass the 2nd input.

           o   Pass difference between desired, 2nd input and error signal estimate.

           n   Pass difference between input, 1st input and error signal estimate.

           e   Pass error signal estimated samples.

               Default value is o.

       precision
           Set which precision to use when processing samples.

           auto
               Auto pick internal sample format depending on other filters.

           float
               Always use single-floating point precision sample format.

           double
               Always use double-floating point precision sample format.

   acompressor
       A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.  Especially modern music is mostly
       compressed at a high ratio to improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention of a
       listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.  If a signal is compressed too much it
       may sound dull or "dead" afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect but can
       also destroy a track completely).  The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
       the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings it may take a long time to get the
       right feeling for this kind of effect.

       Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level "threshold" and dividing it by the
       factor set with "ratio".  So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio of
       2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of the signal would cause distortion
       of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and
       "Release".  "attack" determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold before any reduction
       will occur and "release" sets the time the signal has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction
       again. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.  The overall reduction of the
       signal can be made up afterwards with the "makeup" setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about
       6dB and raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the source. To gain a
       softer entry in the compression the "knee" flattens the hard edge at the threshold in the range of the
       chosen decibels.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.

       mode
           Set mode of compressor operation. Can be "upward" or "downward".  Default is "downward".

       threshold
           If a signal of stream rises above this level it will affect the gain reduction.  By default it is
           0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.

       ratio
           Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level rose 4dB above the threshold,
           it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.  Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.

       attack
           Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain reduction starts.
           Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.

       release
           Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before reduction is decreased
           again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.

       makeup
           Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.  Default is 1. Range is from 1
           to 64.

       knee
           Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.  Default is 2.82843.
           Range is between 1 and 8.

       link
           Choose if the "average" level between all channels of input stream or the louder("maximum") channel
           of input stream affects the reduction. Default is "average".

       detection
           Should the exact signal be taken in case of "peak" or an RMS one in case of "rms". Default is "rms"
           which is mostly smoother.

       mix How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   acontrast
       Simple audio dynamic range compression/expansion filter.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       contrast
           Set contrast. Default is 33. Allowed range is between 0 and 100.

   acopy
       Copy the input audio source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for testing purposes.

   acrossfade
       Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.  The cross fade is applied
       for specified duration near the end of first stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       nb_samples, ns
           Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.  At the end of the cross
           fade effect the first input audio will be completely silent. Default is 44100.

       duration, d
           Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual for the accepted syntax.  By default the duration is determined by nb_samples.  If set this
           option is used instead of nb_samples.

       overlap, o
           Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.

       curve1
           Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.

       curve2
           Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.

           For description of available curve types see afade filter description.

       Examples

       •   Cross fade from one input to another:

                   ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac

       •   Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:

                   ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac

   acrossover
       Split audio stream into several bands.

       This filter splits audio stream into two or more frequency ranges.  Summing all streams back will give
       flat output.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       split
           Set split frequencies. Those must be positive and increasing.

       order
           Set filter order for each band split. This controls filter roll-off or steepness of filter transfer
           function.  Available values are:

           2nd 12 dB per octave.

           4th 24 dB per octave.

           6th 36 dB per octave.

           8th 48 dB per octave.

           10th
               60 dB per octave.

           12th
               72 dB per octave.

           14th
               84 dB per octave.

           16th
               96 dB per octave.

           18th
               108 dB per octave.

           20th
               120 dB per octave.

           Default is 4th.

       level
           Set input gain level. Allowed range is from 0 to 1. Default value is 1.

       gains
           Set output gain for each band. Default value is 1 for all bands.

       precision
           Set which precision to use when processing samples.

           auto
               Auto pick internal sample format depending on other filters.

           float
               Always use single-floating point precision sample format.

           double
               Always use double-floating point precision sample format.

           Default value is "auto".

       Examples

       •   Split input audio stream into two bands (low and high) with split frequency of 1500 Hz, each band
           will be in separate stream:

                   ffmpeg -i in.flac -filter_complex 'acrossover=split=1500[LOW][HIGH]' -map '[LOW]' low.wav -map '[HIGH]' high.wav

       •   Same as above, but with higher filter order:

                   ffmpeg -i in.flac -filter_complex 'acrossover=split=1500:order=8th[LOW][HIGH]' -map '[LOW]' low.wav -map '[HIGH]' high.wav

       •   Same as above, but also with additional middle band (frequencies between 1500 and 8000):

                   ffmpeg -i in.flac -filter_complex 'acrossover=split=1500 8000:order=8th[LOW][MID][HIGH]' -map '[LOW]' low.wav -map '[MID]' mid.wav -map '[HIGH]' high.wav

   acrusher
       Reduce audio bit resolution.

       This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher is used to audibly reduce number of
       bits an audio signal is sampled with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
       effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".  This filter is able to even round
       to continuous values instead of discrete bit depths.  Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in
       different crushing of the lower and the upper half of the signal.  An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to
       produce "softer" crushing sounds.

       Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.  This setting switches from linear distances
       between bits to logarithmic ones.  The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't
       gate low signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception, so this kind of crushing is
       much more pleasant.  Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set level in.

       level_out
           Set level out.

       bits
           Set bit reduction.

       mix Set mixing amount.

       mode
           Can be linear: "lin" or logarithmic: "log".

       dc  Set DC.

       aa  Set anti-aliasing.

       samples
           Set sample reduction.

       lfo Enable LFO. By default disabled.

       lforange
           Set LFO range.

       lforate
           Set LFO rate.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   acue
       Delay audio filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. See the cue filter.

   adeclick
       Remove impulsive noise from input audio.

       Samples detected as impulsive noise are replaced by interpolated samples using autoregressive modelling.

       window, w
           Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from 10 to 100. Default value is 55 milliseconds.
           This sets size of window which will be processed at once.

       overlap, o
           Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from 50 to 95. Default value is 75
           percent.  Setting this to a very high value increases impulsive noise removal but makes whole process
           much slower.

       arorder, a
           Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from 0 to 25. Default value
           is 2 percent. This option also controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.

       threshold, t
           Set threshold value. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.  Default value is 2.  This controls the strength
           of impulsive noise which is going to be removed.  The lower value, the more samples will be detected
           as impulsive noise.

       burst, b
           Set burst fusion, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is 0 to 10. Default value is 2.  If any
           two samples detected as noise are spaced less than this value then any sample between those two
           samples will be also detected as noise.

       method, m
           Set overlap method.

           It accepts the following values:

           add, a
               Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed with this method.

           save, s
               Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.

           Default value is "a".

   adeclip
       Remove clipped samples from input audio.

       Samples detected as clipped are replaced by interpolated samples using autoregressive modelling.

       window, w
           Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from 10 to 100.  Default value is 55 milliseconds.
           This sets size of window which will be processed at once.

       overlap, o
           Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from 50 to 95. Default value is 75
           percent.

       arorder, a
           Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from 0 to 25. Default value
           is 8 percent. This option also controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.

       threshold, t
           Set threshold value. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.  Default value is 10. Higher values make clip
           detection less aggressive.

       hsize, n
           Set size of histogram used to detect clips. Allowed range is from 100 to 9999.  Default value is
           1000. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.

       method, m
           Set overlap method.

           It accepts the following values:

           add, a
               Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed with this method.

           save, s
               Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.

           Default value is "a".

   adecorrelate
       Apply decorrelation to input audio stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       stages
           Set decorrelation stages of filtering. Allowed range is from 1 to 16. Default value is 6.

       seed
           Set random seed used for setting delay in samples across channels.

   adelay
       Delay one or more audio channels.

       Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       delays
           Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.  Unused delays will be silently
           ignored. If number of given delays is smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not
           be delayed.  If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.  If you want instead
           to delay in seconds, append 's' to number.

       all Use last set delay for all remaining channels. By default is disabled.  This option if enabled
           changes how option "delays" is interpreted.

       Examples

       •   Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave the second channel
           (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.

                   adelay=1500|0|500

       •   Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave the first channel
           (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.

                   adelay=0|500S|700S

       •   Delay all channels by same number of samples:

                   adelay=delays=64S:all=1

   adenorm
       Remedy denormals in audio by adding extremely low-level noise.

       This filter shall be placed before any filter that can produce denormals.

       A description of the accepted parameters follows.

       level
           Set level of added noise in dB. Default is -351.  Allowed range is from -451 to -90.

       type
           Set type of added noise.

           dc  Add DC signal.

           ac  Add AC signal.

           square
               Add square signal.

           pulse
               Add pulse signal.

           Default is "dc".

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   aderivative, aintegral
       Compute derivative/integral of audio stream.

       Applying both filters one after another produces original audio.

   adrc
       Apply spectral dynamic range controller filter to input audio stream.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       transfer
           Set the transfer expression.

           The expression can contain the following constants:

           ch  current channel number

           sn  current sample number

           nb_channels
               number of channels

           t   timestamp expressed in seconds

           sr  sample rate

           p   current frequency power value, in dB

           f   current frequency in Hz

           Default value is "p".

       attack
           Set the attack in milliseconds. Default is 50 milliseconds.  Allowed range is from 1 to 1000
           milliseconds.

       release
           Set the release in milliseconds. Default is 100 milliseconds.  Allowed range is from 5 to 2000
           milliseconds.

       channels
           Set which channels to filter, by default "all" channels in audio stream are filtered.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Apply spectral compression to all frequencies with threshold of -50 dB and 1:6 ratio:

                   adrc=transfer='if(gt(p,-50),-50+(p-(-50))/6,p)':attack=50:release=100

       •   Similar to above but with 1:2 ratio and filtering only front center channel:

                   adrc=transfer='if(gt(p,-50),-50+(p-(-50))/2,p)':attack=50:release=100:channels=FC

       •   Apply spectral noise gate to all frequencies with threshold of -85 dB and with short attack time and
           short release time:

                   adrc=transfer='if(lte(p,-85),p-800,p)':attack=1:release=5

       •   Apply spectral expansion to all frequencies with threshold of -10 dB and 1:2 ratio:

                   adrc=transfer='if(lt(p,-10),-10+(p-(-10))*2,p)':attack=50:release=100

       •   Apply limiter to max -60 dB to all frequencies, with attack of 2 ms and release of 10 ms:

                   adrc=transfer='min(p,-60)':attack=2:release=10

   adynamicequalizer
       Apply dynamic equalization to input audio stream.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       threshold
           Set the detection threshold used to trigger equalization.  Threshold detection is using detection
           filter.  Default value is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.

       dfrequency
           Set the detection frequency in Hz used for detection filter used to trigger equalization.  Default
           value is 1000 Hz. Allowed range is between 2 and 1000000 Hz.

       dqfactor
           Set the detection resonance factor for detection filter used to trigger equalization.  Default value
           is 1. Allowed range is from 0.001 to 1000.

       tfrequency
           Set the target frequency of equalization filter.  Default value is 1000 Hz. Allowed range is between
           2 and 1000000 Hz.

       tqfactor
           Set the target resonance factor for target equalization filter.  Default value is 1. Allowed range is
           from 0.001 to 1000.

       attack
           Set the amount of milliseconds the signal from detection has to rise above the detection threshold
           before equalization starts.  Default is 20. Allowed range is between 1 and 2000.

       release
           Set the amount of milliseconds the signal from detection has to fall below the detection threshold
           before equalization ends.  Default is 200. Allowed range is between 1 and 2000.

       ratio
           Set the ratio by which the equalization gain is raised.  Default is 1. Allowed range is between 0 and
           30.

       makeup
           Set the makeup offset by which the equalization gain is raised.  Default is 0. Allowed range is
           between 0 and 100.

       range
           Set the max allowed cut/boost amount. Default is 50.  Allowed range is from 1 to 200.

       mode
           Set the mode of filter operation, can be one of the following:

           listen
               Output only isolated detection signal.

           cutbelow
               Cut frequencies below detection threshold.

           cutabove
               Cut frequencies above detection threshold.

           boostbelow
               Boost frequencies below detection threshold.

           boostabove
               Boost frequencies above detection threshold.

           Default mode is cutbelow.

       dftype
           Set the type of detection filter, can be one of the following:

           bandpass
           lowpass
           highpass
           peak

           Default type is bandpass.

       tftype
           Set the type of target filter, can be one of the following:

           bell
           lowshelf
           highshelf

           Default type is bell.

       auto
           Automatically gather threshold from detection filter. By default is disabled.  This option is useful
           to detect threshold in certain time frame of input audio stream, in such case option value is changed
           at runtime.

           Available values are:

           disabled
               Disable using automatically gathered threshold value.

           off Stop picking threshold value.

           on  Start picking threshold value.

           adaptive
               Adaptively pick threshold value, by calculating sliding window entropy.

       precision
           Set which precision to use when processing samples.

           auto
               Auto pick internal sample format depending on other filters.

           float
               Always use single-floating point precision sample format.

           double
               Always use double-floating point precision sample format.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   adynamicsmooth
       Apply dynamic smoothing to input audio stream.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       sensitivity
           Set an amount of sensitivity to frequency fluctations. Default is 2.  Allowed range is from 0 to
           1e+06.

       basefreq
           Set a base frequency for smoothing. Default value is 22050.  Allowed range is from 2 to 1e+06.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   aecho
       Apply echoing to the input audio.

       Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains (and sometimes large buildings) when
       talking or shouting; digital echo effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
       sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the original signal and the reflection
       is the "delay", and the loudness of the reflected signal is the "decay".  Multiple echoes can have
       different delays and decays.

       A description of the accepted parameters follows.

       in_gain
           Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is 0.6.

       out_gain
           Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is 0.3.

       delays
           Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections separated by '|'.
           Allowed range for each "delay" is "(0 - 90000.0]".  Default is 1000.

       decays
           Set list of loudness of reflected signals separated by '|'.  Allowed range for each "decay" is "(0 -
           1.0]".  Default is 0.5.

       Examples

       •   Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:

                   aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4

       •   If delay is very short, then it sounds like a (metallic) robot playing music:

                   aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4

       •   A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:

                   aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3

       •   Same as above but with one more mountain:

                   aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25

   aemphasis
       Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or emphased CDs with different
       filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out
       the disadvantages of this recording medium.  Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to
       be applied to restore the distortion of the frequency response.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set input gain.

       level_out
           Set output gain.

       mode
           Set filter mode. For restoring material use "reproduction" mode, otherwise use "production" mode.
           Default is "reproduction" mode.

       type
           Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:

           col select Columbia.

           emi select EMI.

           bsi select BSI (78RPM).

           riaa
               select RIAA.

           cd  select Compact Disc (CD).

           50fm
               select 50µs (FM).

           75fm
               select 75µs (FM).

           50kf
               select 50µs (FM-KF).

           75kf
               select 75µs (FM-KF).

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   aeval
       Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.

       This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel), which are evaluated and used to
       modify a corresponding audio signal.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       exprs
           Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If the number of input channels is
           greater than the number of expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
           output channels.

       channel_layout, c
           Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is specified by the number of
           expressions. If set to same, it will use by default the same input channel layout.

       Each expression in exprs can contain the following constants and functions:

       ch  channel number of the current expression

       n   number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0

       s   sample rate

       t   time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds

       nb_in_channels
       nb_out_channels
           input and output number of channels

       val(CH)
           the value of input channel with number CH

       Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a dedicated filter.

       Examples

       •   Half volume:

                   aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same

       •   Invert phase of the second channel:

                   aeval=val(0)|-val(1)

   aexciter
       An exciter is used to produce high sound that is not present in the original signal. This is done by
       creating harmonic distortions of the signal which are restricted in range and added to the original
       signal.  An Exciter raises the upper end of an audio signal without simply raising the higher frequencies
       like an equalizer would do to create a more "crisp" or "brilliant" sound.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set input level prior processing of signal.  Allowed range is from 0 to 64.  Default value is 1.

       level_out
           Set output level after processing of signal.  Allowed range is from 0 to 64.  Default value is 1.

       amount
           Set the amount of harmonics added to original signal.  Allowed range is from 0 to 64.  Default value
           is 1.

       drive
           Set the amount of newly created harmonics.  Allowed range is from 0.1 to 10.  Default value is 8.5.

       blend
           Set the octave of newly created harmonics.  Allowed range is from -10 to 10.  Default value is 0.

       freq
           Set the lower frequency limit of producing harmonics in Hz.  Allowed range is from 2000 to 12000 Hz.
           Default is 7500 Hz.

       ceil
           Set the upper frequency limit of producing harmonics.  Allowed range is from 9999 to 20000 Hz.  If
           value is lower than 10000 Hz no limit is applied.

       listen
           Mute the original signal and output only added harmonics.  By default is disabled.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   afade
       Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.

       A description of the accepted parameters follows.

       type, t
           Specify the effect type, can be either "in" for fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out effect. Default is
           "in".

       start_sample, ss
           Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade effect. Default is 0.

       nb_samples, ns
           Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the fade-in effect
           the output audio will have the same volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
           the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.

       start_time, st
           Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.  The value must be specified as a time
           duration; see the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for the accepted syntax.  If
           set this option is used instead of start_sample.

       duration, d
           Specify the duration of the fade effect. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual
           for the accepted syntax.  At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same volume
           as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition the output audio will be silence.  By
           default the duration is determined by nb_samples.  If set this option is used instead of nb_samples.

       curve
           Set curve for fade transition.

           It accepts the following values:

           tri select triangular, linear slope (default)

           qsin
               select quarter of sine wave

           hsin
               select half of sine wave

           esin
               select exponential sine wave

           log select logarithmic

           ipar
               select inverted parabola

           qua select quadratic

           cub select cubic

           squ select square root

           cbr select cubic root

           par select parabola

           exp select exponential

           iqsin
               select inverted quarter of sine wave

           ihsin
               select inverted half of sine wave

           dese
               select double-exponential seat

           desi
               select double-exponential sigmoid

           losi
               select logistic sigmoid

           sinc
               select sine cardinal function

           isinc
               select inverted sine cardinal function

           quat
               select quartic

           quatr
               select quartic root

           qsin2
               select squared quarter of sine wave

           hsin2
               select squared half of sine wave

           nofade
               no fade applied

       silence
           Set the initial gain for fade-in or final gain for fade-out.  Default value is 0.0.

       unity
           Set the initial gain for fade-out or final gain for fade-in.  Default value is 1.0.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:

                   afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15

       •   Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:

                   afade=t=out:st=875:d=25

   afftdn
       Denoise audio samples with FFT.

       A description of the accepted parameters follows.

       noise_reduction, nr
           Set the noise reduction in dB, allowed range is 0.01 to 97.  Default value is 12 dB.

       noise_floor, nf
           Set the noise floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.  Default value is -50 dB.

       noise_type, nt
           Set the noise type.

           It accepts the following values:

           white, w
               Select white noise.

           vinyl, v
               Select vinyl noise.

           shellac, s
               Select shellac noise.

           custom, c
               Select custom noise, defined in "bn" option.

               Default value is white noise.

       band_noise, bn
           Set custom band noise profile for every one of 15 bands.  Bands are separated by ' ' or '|'.

       residual_floor, rf
           Set the residual floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.  Default value is -38 dB.

       track_noise, tn
           Enable noise floor tracking. By default is disabled.  With this enabled, noise floor is automatically
           adjusted.

       track_residual, tr
           Enable residual tracking. By default is disabled.

       output_mode, om
           Set the output mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           input, i
               Pass input unchanged.

           output, o
               Pass noise filtered out.

           noise, n
               Pass only noise.

               Default value is output.

       adaptivity, ad
           Set the adaptivity factor, used how fast to adapt gains adjustments per each frequency bin. Value 0
           enables instant adaptation, while higher values react much slower.  Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
           Default value is 0.5.

       floor_offset, fo
           Set the noise floor offset factor. This option is used to adjust offset applied to measured noise
           floor. It is only effective when noise floor tracking is enabled.  Allowed range is from -2.0 to 2.0.
           Default value is 1.0.

       noise_link, nl
           Set the noise link used for multichannel audio.

           It accepts the following values:

           none
               Use unchanged channel's noise floor.

           min Use measured min noise floor of all channels.

           max Use measured max noise floor of all channels.

           average
               Use measured average noise floor of all channels.

               Default value is min.

       band_multiplier, bm
           Set the band multiplier factor, used how much to spread bands across frequency bins.  Allowed range
           is from 0.2 to 5. Default value is 1.25.

       sample_noise, sn
           Toggle capturing and measurement of noise profile from input audio.

           It accepts the following values:

           start, begin
               Start sample noise capture.

           stop, end
               Stop sample noise capture and measure new noise band profile.

               Default value is "none".

       gain_smooth, gs
           Set gain smooth spatial radius, used to smooth gains applied to each frequency bin.  Useful to reduce
           random music noise artefacts.  Higher values increases smoothing of gains.  Allowed range is from 0
           to 50.  Default value is 0.

       Commands

       This filter supports the some above mentioned options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Reduce white noise by 10dB, and use previously measured noise floor of -40dB:

                   afftdn=nr=10:nf=-40

       •   Reduce white noise by 10dB, also set initial noise floor to -80dB and enable automatic tracking of
           noise floor so noise floor will gradually change during processing:

                   afftdn=nr=10:nf=-80:tn=1

       •   Reduce noise by 20dB, using noise floor of -40dB and using commands to take noise profile of first
           0.4 seconds of input audio:

                   asendcmd=0.0 afftdn sn start,asendcmd=0.4 afftdn sn stop,afftdn=nr=20:nf=-40

   afftfilt
       Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.

       real
           Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated by '|'. Default is "re".  If
           the number of input channels is greater than the number of expressions, the last specified expression
           is used for the remaining output channels.

       imag
           Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel separated by '|'. Default is
           "im".

           Each expression in real and imag can contain the following constants and functions:

           sr  sample rate

           b   current frequency bin number

           nb  number of available bins

           ch  channel number of the current expression

           chs number of channels

           pts current frame pts

           re  current real part of frequency bin of current channel

           im  current imaginary part of frequency bin of current channel

           real(b, ch)
               Return the value of real part of frequency bin at location (bin,channel)

           imag(b, ch)
               Return the value of imaginary part of frequency bin at location (bin,channel)

       win_size
           Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 131072.  Default is 4096

       win_func
           Set window function.

           It accepts the following values:

           rect
           bartlett
           hann, hanning
           hamming
           blackman
           welch
           flattop
           bharris
           bnuttall
           bhann
           sine
           nuttall
           lanczos
           gauss
           tukey
           dolph
           cauchy
           parzen
           poisson
           bohman
           kaiser

           Default is "hann".

       overlap
           Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected window function will be picked.
           Default is 0.75.

       Examples

       •   Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:

                   afftfilt="'real=re * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))':imag='im * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))'"

       •   Apply robotize effect:

                   afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*sin(0)':imag='hypot(re,im)*cos(0)':win_size=512:overlap=0.75"

       •   Apply whisper effect:

                   afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*cos((random(0)*2-1)*2*3.14)':imag='hypot(re,im)*sin((random(1)*2-1)*2*3.14)':win_size=128:overlap=0.8"

       •   Apply phase shift:

                   afftfilt="real=re*cos(1)-im*sin(1):imag=re*sin(1)+im*cos(1)"

   afir
       Apply an arbitrary Finite Impulse Response filter.

       This filter is designed for applying long FIR filters, up to 60 seconds long.

       It can be used as component for digital crossover filters, room equalization, cross talk cancellation,
       wavefield synthesis, auralization, ambiophonics, ambisonics and spatialization.

       This filter uses the streams higher than first one as FIR coefficients.  If the non-first stream holds a
       single channel, it will be used for all input channels in the first stream, otherwise the number of
       channels in the non-first stream must be same as the number of channels in the first stream.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       dry Set dry gain. This sets input gain.

       wet Set wet gain. This sets final output gain.

       length
           Set Impulse Response filter length. Default is 1, which means whole IR is processed.

       gtype
           This option is deprecated, and does nothing.

       irnorm
           Set norm to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.  Allowed range is from -1 to 2.  IR
           coefficients are normalized with calculated vector norm set by this option.  For negative values, no
           norm is calculated, and IR coefficients are not modified at all.  Default is 1.

       irlink
           For multichannel IR if this option is set to true, all IR channels will be normalized with maximal
           measured gain of all IR channels coefficients as set by "irnorm" option.  When disabled, all IR
           coefficients in each IR channel will be normalized independently.  Default is true.

       irgain
           Set gain to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.  Allowed range is 0 to 1. This gain is
           applied after any gain applied with irnorm option.

       irfmt
           Set format of IR stream. Can be "mono" or "input".  Default is "input".

       maxir
           Set max allowed Impulse Response filter duration in seconds. Default is 30 seconds.  Allowed range is
           0.1 to 60 seconds.

       response
           This option is deprecated, and does nothing.

       channel
           This option is deprecated, and does nothing.

       size
           This option is deprecated, and does nothing.

       rate
           This option is deprecated, and does nothing.

       minp
           Set minimal partition size used for convolution. Default is 8192.  Allowed range is from 1 to 65536.
           Lower values decreases latency at cost of higher CPU usage.

       maxp
           Set maximal partition size used for convolution. Default is 8192.  Allowed range is from 8 to 65536.
           Lower values may increase CPU usage.

       nbirs
           Set number of input impulse responses streams which will be switchable at runtime.  Allowed range is
           from 1 to 32. Default is 1.

       ir  Set IR stream which will be used for convolution, starting from 0, should always be lower than
           supplied value by "nbirs" option. Default is 0.  This option can be changed at runtime via commands.

       precision
           Set which precision to use when processing samples.

           auto
               Auto pick internal sample format depending on other filters.

           float
               Always use single-floating point precision sample format.

           double
               Always use double-floating point precision sample format.

           Default value is auto.

       irload
           Set when to load IR stream. Can be "init" or "access".  First one load and prepares all IRs on
           initialization, second one once on first access of specific IR.  Default is "init".

       Examples

       •   Apply reverb to stream using mono IR file as second input, complete command using ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i input.wav -i middle_tunnel_1way_mono.wav -lavfi afir output.wav

       •   Apply true stereo processing given input stereo stream, and two stereo impulse responses for left and
           right channel, the impulse response files are files with names l_ir.wav and r_ir.wav, and setting
           irnorm option value:

                   "pan=4C|c0=FL|c1=FL|c2=FR|c3=FR[a];amovie=l_ir.wav[LIR];amovie=r_ir.wav[RIR];[LIR][RIR]amerge[ir];[a][ir]afir=irfmt=input:irnorm=1.2,pan=stereo|FL<c0+c2|FR<c1+c3"

       •   Similar to above example, but with "irgain" explicitly set to estimated value and with "irnorm"
           disabled:

                   "pan=4C|c0=FL|c1=FL|c2=FR|c3=FR[a];amovie=l_ir.wav[LIR];amovie=r_ir.wav[RIR];[LIR][RIR]amerge[ir];[a][ir]afir=irfmt=input:irgain=-5dB:irnom=-1,pan=stereo|FL<c0+c2|FR<c1+c3"

   aformat
       Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will negotiate the most appropriate
       format to minimize conversions.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       sample_fmts, f
           A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.

       sample_rates, r
           A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.

       channel_layouts, cl
           A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.

           See the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for the required syntax.

       If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.

       Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo

               aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo

   afreqshift
       Apply frequency shift to input audio samples.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       shift
           Specify frequency shift. Allowed range is -INT_MAX to INT_MAX.  Default value is 0.0.

       level
           Set output gain applied to final output. Allowed range is from 0.0 to 1.0.  Default value is 1.0.

       order
           Set filter order used for filtering. Allowed range is from 1 to 16.  Default value is 8.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   afwtdn
       Reduce broadband noise from input samples using Wavelets.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       sigma
           Set the noise sigma, allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is 0.  This option controls
           strength of denoising applied to input samples.  Most useful way to set this option is via decibels,
           eg. -45dB.

       levels
           Set the number of wavelet levels of decomposition.  Allowed range is from 1 to 12.  Default value is
           10.  Setting this too low make denoising performance very poor.

       wavet
           Set wavelet type for decomposition of input frame.  They are sorted by number of coefficients, from
           lowest to highest.  More coefficients means worse filtering speed, but overall better quality.
           Available wavelets are:

           sym2
           sym4
           rbior68
           deb10
           sym10
           coif5
           bl3
       percent
           Set percent of full denoising. Allowed range is from 0 to 100 percent.  Default value is 85 percent
           or partial denoising.

       profile
           If enabled, first input frame will be used as noise profile.  If first frame samples contain non-
           noise performance will be very poor.

       adaptive
           If enabled, input frames are analyzed for presence of noise.  If noise is detected with high
           possibility then input frame profile will be used for processing following frames, until new noise
           frame is detected.

       samples
           Set size of single frame in number of samples. Allowed range is from 512 to 65536. Default frame size
           is 8192 samples.

       softness
           Set softness applied inside thresholding function. Allowed range is from 0 to 10. Default softness is
           1.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   agate
       A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal processing reduces
       disturbing noise between useful signals.

       Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level threshold and dividing it by the factor set
       with ratio. The bottom of the noise floor is set via range. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
       would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over time. This is done by setting
       attack and release.

       attack determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold before any reduction will occur and
       release sets the time the signal has to rise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.  Shorter
       signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.

       level_in
           Set input level before filtering.  Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.

       mode
           Set the mode of operation. Can be "upward" or "downward".  Default is "downward". If set to "upward"
           mode, higher parts of signal will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
           Otherwise, in case of "downward" lower parts of signal will be reduced.

       range
           Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.  Default is 0.06125. Allowed
           range is from 0 to 1.  Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.

       threshold
           If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.  Default is 0.125. Allowed range
           is from 0 to 1.

       ratio
           Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced.  Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.

       attack
           Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain reduction stops.
           Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.

       release
           Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the reduction is increased
           again. Default is 250 milliseconds.  Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.

       makeup
           Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.  Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.

       knee
           Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.  Default is
           2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.

       detection
           Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.  Default is "rms". Can be
           "peak" or "rms".

       link
           Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects the reduction.
           Default is "average". Can be "average" or "maximum".

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   aiir
       Apply an arbitrary Infinite Impulse Response filter.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       zeros, z
           Set B/numerator/zeros/reflection coefficients.

       poles, p
           Set A/denominator/poles/ladder coefficients.

       gains, k
           Set channels gains.

       dry_gain
           Set input gain.

       wet_gain
           Set output gain.

       format, f
           Set coefficients format.

           ll  lattice-ladder function

           sf  analog transfer function

           tf  digital transfer function

           zp  Z-plane zeros/poles, cartesian (default)

           pr  Z-plane zeros/poles, polar radians

           pd  Z-plane zeros/poles, polar degrees

           sp  S-plane zeros/poles

       process, r
           Set type of processing.

           d   direct processing

           s   serial processing

           p   parallel processing

       precision, e
           Set filtering precision.

           dbl double-precision floating-point (default)

           flt single-precision floating-point

           i32 32-bit integers

           i16 16-bit integers

       normalize, n
           Normalize filter coefficients, by default is enabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       mix How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       response
           Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional
           video stream.  By default it is disabled.

       channel
           Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel displayed. This
           option is used only when response is enabled.

       size
           Set video stream size. This option is used only when response is enabled.

       Coefficients in "tf" and "sf" format are separated by spaces and are in ascending order.

       Coefficients in "zp" format are separated by spaces and order of coefficients doesn't matter.
       Coefficients in "zp" format are complex numbers with i imaginary unit.

       Different coefficients and gains can be provided for every channel, in such case use '|' to separate
       coefficients or gains. Last provided coefficients will be used for all remaining channels.

       Examples

       •   Apply 2 pole elliptic notch at around 5000Hz for 48000 Hz sample rate:

                   aiir=k=1:z=7.957584807809675810E-1 -2.575128568908332300 3.674839853930788710 -2.57512875289799137 7.957586296317130880E-1:p=1 -2.86950072432325953 3.63022088054647218 -2.28075678147272232 6.361362326477423500E-1:f=tf:r=d

       •   Same as above but in "zp" format:

                   aiir=k=0.79575848078096756:z=0.80918701+0.58773007i 0.80918701-0.58773007i 0.80884700+0.58784055i 0.80884700-0.58784055i:p=0.63892345+0.59951235i 0.63892345-0.59951235i 0.79582691+0.44198673i 0.79582691-0.44198673i:f=zp:r=s

       •   Apply 3-rd order analog normalized Butterworth low-pass filter, using analog transfer function
           format:

                   aiir=z=1.3057 0 0 0:p=1.3057 2.3892 2.1860 1:f=sf:r=d

   alimiter
       The limiter prevents an input signal from rising over a desired threshold.  This limiter uses lookahead
       technology to prevent your signal from distorting.  It means that there is a small delay after the signal
       is processed. Keep in mind that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set input gain. Default is 1.

       level_out
           Set output gain. Default is 1.

       limit
           Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.

       attack
           The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in milliseconds. Default is 5
           milliseconds.

       release
           Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.  Default is 50
           milliseconds.

       asc When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an average reduction level rather
           than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release time.

       asc_level
           Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes in release time while
           1 produces higher release times.

       level
           Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.  This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.

       latency
           Compensate the delay introduced by using the lookahead buffer set with attack parameter. Also flush
           the valid audio data in the lookahead buffer when the stream hits EOF.

       Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times with aresample before
       applying this filter.

   allpass
       Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz) frequency, and filter-width width.  An
       all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship without changing its frequency to
       amplitude relationship.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       frequency, f
           Set frequency in Hz.

       width_type, t
           Set method to specify band-width of filter.

           h   Hz

           q   Q-Factor

           o   octave

           s   slope

           k   kHz

       width, w
           Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.

       mix, m
           How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       channels, c
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.

       normalize, n
           Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       order, o
           Set the filter order, can be 1 or 2. Default is 2.

       transform, a
           Set transform type of IIR filter.

           di
           dii
           tdi
           tdii
           latt
           svf
           zdf
       precision, r
           Set precision of filtering.

           auto
               Pick automatic sample format depending on surround filters.

           s16 Always use signed 16-bit.

           s32 Always use signed 32-bit.

           f32 Always use float 32-bit.

           f64 Always use float 64-bit.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       frequency, f
           Change allpass frequency.  Syntax for the command is : "frequency"

       width_type, t
           Change allpass width_type.  Syntax for the command is : "width_type"

       width, w
           Change allpass width.  Syntax for the command is : "width"

       mix, m
           Change allpass mix.  Syntax for the command is : "mix"

   aloop
       Loop audio samples.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       loop
           Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.  Default is 0.

       size
           Set maximal number of samples. Default is 0.

       start
           Set first sample of loop. Default is 0.

       time
           Set the time of loop start in seconds.  Only used if option named start is set to -1.

   amerge
       Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       inputs
           Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.

       If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible, the channel layout of the
       output will be set accordingly and the channels will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of
       the inputs are not disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all the
       channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of the output will be the default
       value corresponding to the total number of channels.

       For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input is FC+BL+BR, then the output
       will be in 5.1, with the channels in the following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel
       of the first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).

       On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be in the default order: a1, a2,
       b1, b2, and the channel layout will be arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected
       value.

       All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.

       If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the shortest.

       Examples

       •   Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:

                   amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge

       •   Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in input.mkv:

                   ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv

   amix
       Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.

       Note that this filter only supports float samples (the amerge and pan audio filters support many
       formats). If the amix input has integer samples then aresample will be automatically inserted to perform
       the conversion to float samples.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       inputs
           The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.

       duration
           How to determine the end-of-stream.

           longest
               The duration of the longest input. (default)

           shortest
               The duration of the shortest input.

           first
               The duration of the first input.

       dropout_transition
           The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input stream ends. The default
           value is 2 seconds.

       weights
           Specify weight of each input audio stream as a sequence of numbers separated by a space. If fewer
           weights are specified compared to number of inputs, the last weight is assigned to the remaining
           inputs.  Default weight for each input is 1.

       normalize
           Always scale inputs instead of only doing summation of samples.  Beware of heavy clipping if inputs
           are not normalized prior or after filtering by this filter if this option is disabled. By default is
           enabled.

       Examples

       •   This will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the first input and
           a dropout transition time of 3 seconds:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT

       •   This will mix one vocal and one music input audio stream to a single output with the same duration as
           the longest input. The music will have quarter the weight as the vocals, and the inputs are not
           normalized:

                   ffmpeg -i VOCALS -i MUSIC -filter_complex amix=inputs=2:duration=longest:dropout_transition=0:weights="1 0.25":normalize=0 OUTPUT

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       weights
       normalize
           Syntax is same as option with same name.

   amultiply
       Multiply first audio stream with second audio stream and store result in output audio stream.
       Multiplication is done by multiplying each sample from first stream with sample at same position from
       second stream.

       With this element-wise multiplication one can create amplitude fades and amplitude modulations.

   anequalizer
       High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       params
           This option string is in format: "cchn f=cf w=w g=g t=f | ..."  Each equalizer band is separated by
           '|'.

           chn Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.  If input doesn't have that channel the
               entry is ignored.

           f   Set central frequency for band.  If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.

           w   Set band width in Hertz.

           g   Set band gain in dB.

           t   Set filter type for band, optional, can be:

               0   Butterworth, this is default.

               1   Chebyshev type 1.

               2   Chebyshev type 2.

       curves
           With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed in video stream.

       size
           Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.

       mgain
           Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.  Setting this to a
           reasonable value makes it possible to display gain which is derived from neighbour bands which are
           too close to each other and thus produce higher gain when both are activated.

       fscale
           Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.  Can be linear or logarithmic.
           Default is logarithmic.

       colors
           Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.  This is list of
           color names separated by space or by '|'.  Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white
           color.

       Examples

       •   Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz for first 2 channels using Chebyshev
           type 1 filter:

                   anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       change
           Alter existing filter parameters.  Syntax for the commands is : "fN|f=freq|w=width|g=gain"

           fN is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available error is returned.
           freq set new frequency parameter.  width set new width parameter in Hertz.  gain set new gain
           parameter in dB.

           Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this: asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change
           0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...

   anlmdn
       Reduce broadband noise in audio samples using Non-Local Means algorithm.

       Each sample is adjusted by looking for other samples with similar contexts. This context similarity is
       defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size p. Patches are searched in an area of r around the
       sample.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       strength, s
           Set denoising strength. Allowed range is from 0.00001 to 10000. Default value is 0.00001.

       patch, p
           Set patch radius duration. Allowed range is from 1 to 100 milliseconds.  Default value is 2
           milliseconds.

       research, r
           Set research radius duration. Allowed range is from 2 to 300 milliseconds.  Default value is 6
           milliseconds.

       output, o
           Set the output mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           i   Pass input unchanged.

           o   Pass noise filtered out.

           n   Pass only noise.

               Default value is o.

       smooth, m
           Set smooth factor. Default value is 11. Allowed range is from 1 to 1000.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   anlmf, anlms
       Apply Normalized Least-Mean-(Squares|Fourth) algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio
       stream.

       This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by finding the filter coefficients that relate to
       producing the least mean square of the error signal (difference between the desired, 2nd input audio
       stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio stream).

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       order
           Set filter order.

       mu  Set filter mu.

       eps Set the filter eps.

       leakage
           Set the filter leakage.

       out_mode
           It accepts the following values:

           i   Pass the 1st input.

           d   Pass the 2nd input.

           o   Pass difference between desired, 2nd input and error signal estimate.

           n   Pass difference between input, 1st input and error signal estimate.

           e   Pass error signal estimated samples.

               Default value is o.

       precision
           Set which precision to use when processing samples.

           auto
               Auto pick internal sample format depending on other filters.

           float
               Always use single-floating point precision sample format.

           double
               Always use double-floating point precision sample format.

       Examples

       •   One of many usages of this filter is noise reduction, input audio is filtered with same samples that
           are delayed by fixed amount, one such example for stereo audio is:

                   asplit[a][b],[a]adelay=32S|32S[a],[b][a]anlms=order=128:leakage=0.0005:mu=.5:out_mode=o

       Commands

       This filter supports the same commands as options, excluding option "order".

   anull
       Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.

   apad
       Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.

       This can be used together with ffmpeg -shortest to extend audio streams to the same length as the video
       stream.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       packet_size
           Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.

       pad_len
           Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the value is reached, the stream is
           terminated. This option is mutually exclusive with whole_len.

       whole_len
           Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If the value is longer than the
           input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually
           exclusive with pad_len.

       pad_dur
           Specify the duration of samples of silence to add. See the Time duration section in the
           ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-negative value.

       whole_dur
           Specify the minimum total duration in the output audio stream. See the Time duration section in the
           ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-negative value. If the value
           is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached.  This
           option is mutually exclusive with pad_dur

       If neither the pad_len nor the whole_len nor pad_dur nor whole_dur option is set, the filter will add
       silence to the end of the input stream indefinitely.

       Note that for ffmpeg 4.4 and earlier a zero pad_dur or whole_dur also caused the filter to add silence
       indefinitely.

       Examples

       •   Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:

                   apad=pad_len=1024

       •   Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad the input with silence if
           required:

                   apad=whole_len=10000

       •   Use ffmpeg to pad the audio input with silence, so that the video stream will always result the
           shortest and will be converted until the end in the output file when using the shortest option:

                   ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT

   aphaser
       Add a phasing effect to the input audio.

       A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.  The position of the peaks
       and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.

       A description of the accepted parameters follows.

       in_gain
           Set input gain. Default is 0.4.

       out_gain
           Set output gain. Default is 0.74

       delay
           Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.

       decay
           Set decay. Default is 0.4.

       speed
           Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.

       type
           Set modulation type. Default is triangular.

           It accepts the following values:

           triangular, t
           sinusoidal, s

   aphaseshift
       Apply phase shift to input audio samples.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       shift
           Specify phase shift. Allowed range is from -1.0 to 1.0.  Default value is 0.0.

       level
           Set output gain applied to final output. Allowed range is from 0.0 to 1.0.  Default value is 1.0.

       order
           Set filter order used for filtering. Allowed range is from 1 to 16.  Default value is 8.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   apsnr
       Measure Audio Peak Signal-to-Noise Ratio.

       This filter takes two audio streams for input, and outputs first audio stream.  Results are in dB per
       channel at end of either input.

   apsyclip
       Apply Psychoacoustic clipper to input audio stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].

       level_out
           Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].

       clip
           Set the clipping start value. Default value is 0dBFS or 1.

       diff
           Output only difference samples, useful to hear introduced distortions.  By default is disabled.

       adaptive
           Set strength of adaptive distortion applied. Default value is 0.5.  Allowed range is from 0 to 1.

       iterations
           Set number of iterations of psychoacoustic clipper.  Allowed range is from 1 to 20. Default value is
           10.

       level
           Auto level output signal. Default is disabled.  This normalizes audio back to 0dBFS if enabled.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   apulsator
       Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.  But it can produce funny stereo effects
       as well. Pulsator changes the volume of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency
       oscillator) with different waveforms and shifted phases.  This filter have the ability to define an
       offset between left and right channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.  The
       left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.  An offset of 50% means that the
       shape of the right channel is exactly shifted in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) -
       pulsator acts as an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the phase
       shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with sine and triangle waveforms.
       The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to
       the right speaker.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].

       level_out
           Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].

       mode
           Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square, sawup or sawdown. Default
           is sine.

       amount
           Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.

       offset_l
           Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].

       offset_r
           Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].

       width
           Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].

       timing
           Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.

       bpm Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing is set to bpm.

       ms  Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing is set to ms.

       hz  Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used if timing is set to hz.

   aresample
       Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the libswresample library. If none are
       specified then the filter will automatically convert between its input and output.

       This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match the timestamps or to inject
       silence / cut out audio to make it match the timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.

       The filter accepts the syntax [sample_rate:]resampler_options, where sample_rate expresses a sample rate
       and resampler_options is a list of key=value pairs, separated by ":". See the "Resampler Options" section
       in the ffmpeg-resampler(1) manual for the complete list of supported options.

       Examples

       •   Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:

                   aresample=44100

       •   Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000 samples per second
           compensation:

                   aresample=async=1000

   areverse
       Reverse an audio clip.

       Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming is suggested.

       Examples

       •   Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.

                   atrim=end=5,areverse

   arls
       Apply Recursive Least Squares algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.

       This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by recursively finding the filter coefficients
       that relate to producing the minimal weighted linear least squares cost function of the error signal
       (difference between the desired, 2nd input audio stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio
       stream).

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       order
           Set the filter order.

       lambda
           Set the forgetting factor.

       delta
           Set the coefficient to initialize internal covariance matrix.

       out_mode
           Set the filter output samples. It accepts the following values:

           i   Pass the 1st input.

           d   Pass the 2nd input.

           o   Pass difference between desired, 2nd input and error signal estimate.

           n   Pass difference between input, 1st input and error signal estimate.

           e   Pass error signal estimated samples.

               Default value is o.

       precision
           Set which precision to use when processing samples.

           auto
               Auto pick internal sample format depending on other filters.

           float
               Always use single-floating point precision sample format.

           double
               Always use double-floating point precision sample format.

   arnndn
       Reduce noise from speech using Recurrent Neural Networks.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       model, m
           Set train model file to load. This option is always required.

       mix Set how much to mix filtered samples into final output.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1. Default value
           is 1.  Negative values are special, they set how much to keep filtered noise in the final filter
           output. Set this option to -1 to hear actual noise removed from input signal.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   asdr
       Measure Audio Signal-to-Distortion Ratio.

       This filter takes two audio streams for input, and outputs first audio stream.  Results are in dB per
       channel at end of either input.

   asetnsamples
       Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.

       The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as the filter will flush all the
       remaining samples when the input audio signals its end.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       nb_out_samples, n
           Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is intended as the number of samples
           per each channel.  Default value is 1024.

       pad, p
           If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so that the last frame will
           contain the same number of samples as the previous ones. Default value is 1.

       For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and disable padding for the last frame, use:

               asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0

   asetrate
       Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.  This will result in a change of speed and pitch.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sample_rate, r
           Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.

   ashowinfo
       Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.  The input audio is not modified.

       The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form key:value.

       The following values are shown in the output:

       n   The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.

       pts The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base depends on the
           filter input pad, and is usually 1/sample_rate.

       pts_time
           The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.

       fmt The sample format.

       chlayout
           The channel layout.

       rate
           The sample rate for the audio frame.

       nb_samples
           The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.

       checksum
           The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar audio, the data is
           treated as if all the planes were concatenated.

       plane_checksums
           A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.

   asisdr
       Measure Audio Scaled-Invariant Signal-to-Distortion Ratio.

       This filter takes two audio streams for input, and outputs first audio stream.  Results are in dB per
       channel at end of either input.

   asoftclip
       Apply audio soft clipping.

       Soft clipping is a type of distortion effect where the amplitude of a signal is saturated along a smooth
       curve, rather than the abrupt shape of hard-clipping.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       type
           Set type of soft-clipping.

           It accepts the following values:

           hard
           tanh
           atan
           cubic
           exp
           alg
           quintic
           sin
           erf
       threshold
           Set threshold from where to start clipping. Default value is 0dB or 1.

       output
           Set gain applied to output. Default value is 0dB or 1.

       param
           Set additional parameter which controls sigmoid function.

       oversample
           Set oversampling factor.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   aspectralstats
       Display frequency domain statistical information about the audio channels.  Statistics are calculated and
       stored as metadata for each audio channel and for each audio frame.

       It accepts the following option:

       win_size
           Set the window length in samples. Default value is 2048.  Allowed range is from 32 to 65536.

       win_func
           Set window function.

           It accepts the following values:

           rect
           bartlett
           hann, hanning
           hamming
           blackman
           welch
           flattop
           bharris
           bnuttall
           bhann
           sine
           nuttall
           lanczos
           gauss
           tukey
           dolph
           cauchy
           parzen
           poisson
           bohman
           kaiser

           Default is "hann".

       overlap
           Set window overlap. Allowed range is from 0 to 1. Default value is 0.5.

       measure
           Select the parameters which are measured. The metadata keys can be used as flags, default is all
           which measures everything.  none disables all measurement.

       A list of each metadata key follows:

       mean
       variance
       centroid
       spread
       skewness
       kurtosis
       entropy
       flatness
       crest
       flux
       slope
       decrease
       rolloff

   asr
       Automatic Speech Recognition

       This filter uses PocketSphinx for speech recognition. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to
       configure FFmpeg with "--enable-pocketsphinx".

       It accepts the following options:

       rate
           Set sampling rate of input audio. Defaults is 16000.  This need to match speech models, otherwise one
           will get poor results.

       hmm Set dictionary containing acoustic model files.

       dict
           Set pronunciation dictionary.

       lm  Set language model file.

       lmctl
           Set language model set.

       lmname
           Set which language model to use.

       logfn
           Set output for log messages.

       The filter exports recognized speech as the frame metadata "lavfi.asr.text".

   astats
       Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.  Statistics are calculated and
       displayed for each audio channel and, where applicable, an overall figure is also given.

       It accepts the following option:

       length
           Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.  Default is 0.05 (50
           milliseconds). Allowed range is "[0 - 10]".

       metadata
           Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with "lavfi.astats.X", where "X" is
           channel number starting from 1 or string "Overall". Default is disabled.

           Available keys for each channel are: Bit_depth Crest_factor DC_offset Dynamic_range Entropy
           Flat_factor Max_difference Max_level Mean_difference Min_difference Min_level Noise_floor
           Noise_floor_count Number_of_Infs Number_of_NaNs Number_of_denormals Peak_count Abs_Peak_count
           Peak_level RMS_difference RMS_peak RMS_trough Zero_crossings Zero_crossings_rate

           and for "Overall": Bit_depth DC_offset Entropy Flat_factor Max_difference Max_level Mean_difference
           Min_difference Min_level Noise_floor Noise_floor_count Number_of_Infs Number_of_NaNs
           Number_of_denormals Number_of_samples Peak_count Abs_Peak_count Peak_level RMS_difference RMS_level
           RMS_peak RMS_trough

           For example, a full key looks like "lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset" or "lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count".

           Read below for the description of the keys.

       reset
           Set the number of frames over which cumulative stats are calculated before being reset. Default is
           disabled.

       measure_perchannel
           Select the parameters which are measured per channel. The metadata keys can be used as flags, default
           is all which measures everything.  none disables all per channel measurement.

       measure_overall
           Select the parameters which are measured overall. The metadata keys can be used as flags, default is
           all which measures everything.  none disables all overall measurement.

       A description of the measure keys follow:

       none
           no measures

       all all measures

       Bit_depth
           overall bit depth of audio, i.e. number of bits used for each sample

       Crest_factor
           standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB)

       DC_offset
           mean amplitude displacement from zero

       Dynamic_range
           measured dynamic range of audio in dB

       Entropy
           entropy measured across whole audio, entropy of value near 1.0 is typically measured for white noise

       Flat_factor
           flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels (i.e. either
           Min_level or Max_level)

       Max_difference
           maximal difference between two consecutive samples

       Max_level
           maximal sample level

       Mean_difference
           mean difference between two consecutive samples, i.e. the average of each difference between two
           consecutive samples

       Min_difference
           minimal difference between two consecutive samples

       Min_level
           minimal sample level

       Noise_floor
           minimum local peak measured in dBFS over a short window

       Noise_floor_count
           number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained Noise floor

       Number_of_Infs
           number of samples with an infinite value

       Number_of_NaNs
           number of samples with a NaN (not a number) value

       Number_of_denormals
           number of samples with a subnormal value

       Number_of_samples
           number of samples

       Peak_count
           number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either Min_level or
           Max_level

       Abs_Peak_count
           number of occasions that the absolute samples taken from the signal attained max absolute value of
           Min_level and Max_level

       Peak_level
           standard peak level measured in dBFS

       RMS_difference
           Root Mean Square difference between two consecutive samples

       RMS_level
           standard RMS level measured in dBFS

       RMS_peak
       RMS_trough
           peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window, measured in dBFS.

       Zero crossings
           number of points where the waveform crosses the zero level axis

       Zero crossings rate
           rate of Zero crossings and number of audio samples

   asubboost
       Boost subwoofer frequencies.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       dry Set dry gain, how much of original signal is kept. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is
           1.0.

       wet Set wet gain, how much of filtered signal is kept. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is
           1.0.

       boost
           Set max boost factor. Allowed range is from 1 to 12. Default value is 2.

       decay
           Set delay line decay gain value. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is 0.0.

       feedback
           Set delay line feedback gain value. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is 0.9.

       cutoff
           Set cutoff frequency in Hertz. Allowed range is 50 to 900.  Default value is 100.

       slope
           Set slope amount for cutoff frequency. Allowed range is 0.0001 to 1.  Default value is 0.5.

       delay
           Set delay. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.  Default value is 20.

       channels
           Set the channels to process. Default value is all available.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   asubcut
       Cut subwoofer frequencies.

       This filter allows to set custom, steeper roll off than highpass filter, and thus is able to more
       attenuate frequency content in stop-band.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       cutoff
           Set cutoff frequency in Hertz. Allowed range is 2 to 200.  Default value is 20.

       order
           Set filter order. Available values are from 3 to 20.  Default value is 10.

       level
           Set input gain level. Allowed range is from 0 to 1. Default value is 1.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   asupercut
       Cut super frequencies.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       cutoff
           Set cutoff frequency in Hertz. Allowed range is 20000 to 192000.  Default value is 20000.

       order
           Set filter order. Available values are from 3 to 20.  Default value is 10.

       level
           Set input gain level. Allowed range is from 0 to 1. Default value is 1.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   asuperpass
       Apply high order Butterworth band-pass filter.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       centerf
           Set center frequency in Hertz. Allowed range is 2 to 999999.  Default value is 1000.

       order
           Set filter order. Available values are from 4 to 20.  Default value is 4.

       qfactor
           Set Q-factor. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 100. Default value is 1.

       level
           Set input gain level. Allowed range is from 0 to 2. Default value is 1.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   asuperstop
       Apply high order Butterworth band-stop filter.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       centerf
           Set center frequency in Hertz. Allowed range is 2 to 999999.  Default value is 1000.

       order
           Set filter order. Available values are from 4 to 20.  Default value is 4.

       qfactor
           Set Q-factor. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 100. Default value is 1.

       level
           Set input gain level. Allowed range is from 0 to 2. Default value is 1.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   atempo
       Adjust audio tempo.

       The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not specified then the filter will assume
       nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must be in the [0.5, 100.0] range.

       Note that tempo greater than 2 will skip some samples rather than blend them in.  If for any reason this
       is a concern it is always possible to daisy-chain several instances of atempo to achieve the desired
       product tempo.

       Examples

       •   Slow down audio to 80% tempo:

                   atempo=0.8

       •   To speed up audio to 300% tempo:

                   atempo=3

       •   To speed up audio to 300% tempo by daisy-chaining two atempo instances:

                   atempo=sqrt(3),atempo=sqrt(3)

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       tempo
           Change filter tempo scale factor.  Syntax for the command is : "tempo"

   atilt
       Apply spectral tilt filter to audio stream.

       This filter apply any spectral roll-off slope over any specified frequency band.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       freq
           Set central frequency of tilt in Hz. Default is 10000 Hz.

       slope
           Set slope direction of tilt. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.

       width
           Set width of tilt. Default is 1000. Allowed range is from 100 to 10000.

       order
           Set order of tilt filter.

       level
           Set input volume level. Allowed range is from 0 to 4.  Default is 1.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   atrim
       Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       start
           Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio sample with the timestamp
           start will be the first sample in the output.

       end Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the audio sample immediately
           preceding the one with the timestamp end will be the last sample in the output.

       start_pts
           Same as start, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples instead of seconds.

       end_pts
           Same as end, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead of seconds.

       duration
           The maximum duration of the output in seconds.

       start_sample
           The number of the first sample that should be output.

       end_sample
           The number of the first sample that should be dropped.

       start, end, and duration are expressed as time duration specifications; see the Time duration section in
       the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual.

       Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the duration option look at the frame
       timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the samples that pass through the filter. So
       start/end_pts and start/end_sample will give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or
       do not start at zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish to have the
       output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the atrim filter.

       If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and keep all samples that match
       at least one of the specified constraints. To keep only the part that matches all the constraints at
       once, chain multiple atrim filters.

       The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.  just the end values to
       keep everything before the specified time.

       Examples:

       •   Drop everything except the second minute of input:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120

       •   Keep only the first 1000 samples:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000

   axcorrelate
       Calculate normalized windowed cross-correlation between two input audio streams.

       Resulted samples are always between -1 and 1 inclusive.  If result is 1 it means two input samples are
       highly correlated in that selected segment.  Result 0 means they are not correlated at all.  If result is
       -1 it means two input samples are out of phase, which means they cancel each other.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size
           Set size of segment over which cross-correlation is calculated.  Default is 256. Allowed range is
           from 2 to 131072.

       algo
           Set algorithm for cross-correlation. Can be "slow" or "fast" or "best".  Default is "best". Fast
           algorithm assumes mean values over any given segment are always zero and thus need much less
           calculations to make.  This is generally not true, but is valid for typical audio streams.

       Examples

       •   Calculate correlation between channels in stereo audio stream:

                   ffmpeg -i stereo.wav -af channelsplit,axcorrelate=size=1024:algo=fast correlation.wav

   bandpass
       Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central frequency frequency, and (3dB-point) band-
       width width.  The csg option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q) instead of the default:
       constant 0dB peak gain.  The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).

       The filter accepts the following options:

       frequency, f
           Set the filter's central frequency. Default is 3000.

       csg Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.

       width_type, t
           Set method to specify band-width of filter.

           h   Hz

           q   Q-Factor

           o   octave

           s   slope

           k   kHz

       width, w
           Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.

       mix, m
           How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       channels, c
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.

       normalize, n
           Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       transform, a
           Set transform type of IIR filter.

           di
           dii
           tdi
           tdii
           latt
           svf
           zdf
       precision, r
           Set precision of filtering.

           auto
               Pick automatic sample format depending on surround filters.

           s16 Always use signed 16-bit.

           s32 Always use signed 32-bit.

           f32 Always use float 32-bit.

           f64 Always use float 64-bit.

       block_size, b
           Set block size used for reverse IIR processing. If this value is set to high enough value (higher
           than impulse response length truncated when reaches near zero values) filtering will become linear
           phase otherwise if not big enough it will just produce nasty artifacts.

           Note that filter delay will be exactly this many samples when set to non-zero value.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       frequency, f
           Change bandpass frequency.  Syntax for the command is : "frequency"

       width_type, t
           Change bandpass width_type.  Syntax for the command is : "width_type"

       width, w
           Change bandpass width.  Syntax for the command is : "width"

       mix, m
           Change bandpass mix.  Syntax for the command is : "mix"

   bandreject
       Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central frequency frequency, and (3dB-point) band-
       width width.  The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).

       The filter accepts the following options:

       frequency, f
           Set the filter's central frequency. Default is 3000.

       width_type, t
           Set method to specify band-width of filter.

           h   Hz

           q   Q-Factor

           o   octave

           s   slope

           k   kHz

       width, w
           Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.

       mix, m
           How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       channels, c
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.

       normalize, n
           Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       transform, a
           Set transform type of IIR filter.

           di
           dii
           tdi
           tdii
           latt
           svf
           zdf
       precision, r
           Set precision of filtering.

           auto
               Pick automatic sample format depending on surround filters.

           s16 Always use signed 16-bit.

           s32 Always use signed 32-bit.

           f32 Always use float 32-bit.

           f64 Always use float 64-bit.

       block_size, b
           Set block size used for reverse IIR processing. If this value is set to high enough value (higher
           than impulse response length truncated when reaches near zero values) filtering will become linear
           phase otherwise if not big enough it will just produce nasty artifacts.

           Note that filter delay will be exactly this many samples when set to non-zero value.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       frequency, f
           Change bandreject frequency.  Syntax for the command is : "frequency"

       width_type, t
           Change bandreject width_type.  Syntax for the command is : "width_type"

       width, w
           Change bandreject width.  Syntax for the command is : "width"

       mix, m
           Change bandreject mix.  Syntax for the command is : "mix"

   bass, lowshelf
       Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole shelving filter with a response
       similar to that of a standard hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).

       The filter accepts the following options:

       gain, g
           Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
           Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.

       frequency, f
           Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used to extend or reduce the frequency range to be
           boosted or cut.  The default value is 100 Hz.

       width_type, t
           Set method to specify band-width of filter.

           h   Hz

           q   Q-Factor

           o   octave

           s   slope

           k   kHz

       width, w
           Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.

       poles, p
           Set number of poles. Default is 2.

       mix, m
           How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       channels, c
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.

       normalize, n
           Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       transform, a
           Set transform type of IIR filter.

           di
           dii
           tdi
           tdii
           latt
           svf
           zdf
       precision, r
           Set precision of filtering.

           auto
               Pick automatic sample format depending on surround filters.

           s16 Always use signed 16-bit.

           s32 Always use signed 32-bit.

           f32 Always use float 32-bit.

           f64 Always use float 64-bit.

       block_size, b
           Set block size used for reverse IIR processing. If this value is set to high enough value (higher
           than impulse response length truncated when reaches near zero values) filtering will become linear
           phase otherwise if not big enough it will just produce nasty artifacts.

           Note that filter delay will be exactly this many samples when set to non-zero value.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       frequency, f
           Change bass frequency.  Syntax for the command is : "frequency"

       width_type, t
           Change bass width_type.  Syntax for the command is : "width_type"

       width, w
           Change bass width.  Syntax for the command is : "width"

       gain, g
           Change bass gain.  Syntax for the command is : "gain"

       mix, m
           Change bass mix.  Syntax for the command is : "mix"

   biquad
       Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.  Where b0, b1, b2 and a0, a1, a2 are the numerator
       and denominator coefficients respectively.  and channels, c specify which channels to filter, by default
       all available are filtered.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       a0
       a1
       a2
       b0
       b1
       b2  Change biquad parameter.  Syntax for the command is : "value"

       mix, m
           How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       channels, c
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.

       normalize, n
           Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       transform, a
           Set transform type of IIR filter.

           di
           dii
           tdi
           tdii
           latt
           svf
           zdf
       precision, r
           Set precision of filtering.

           auto
               Pick automatic sample format depending on surround filters.

           s16 Always use signed 16-bit.

           s32 Always use signed 32-bit.

           f32 Always use float 32-bit.

           f64 Always use float 64-bit.

       block_size, b
           Set block size used for reverse IIR processing. If this value is set to high enough value (higher
           than impulse response length truncated when reaches near zero values) filtering will become linear
           phase otherwise if not big enough it will just produce nasty artifacts.

           Note that filter delay will be exactly this many samples when set to non-zero value.

   bs2b
       Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of stereo audio records.

       To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libbs2b".

       It accepts the following parameters:

       profile
           Pre-defined crossfeed level.

           default
               Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).

           cmoy
               Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).

           jmeier
               Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).

       fcut
           Cut frequency (in Hz).

       feed
           Feed level (in Hz).

   channelmap
       Remap input channels to new locations.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       map Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of mappings, each in the
           "in_channel-out_channel" or "in_channel" form. in_channel can be either the name of the input channel
           (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout. out_channel is the name of the
           output channel or its index in the output channel layout. If out_channel is not given then it is
           implicitly an index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping. Mixing different
           types of mappings is not allowed and will result in a parse error.

       channel_layout
           The channel layout of the output stream. If not specified, then filter will guess it based on the
           out_channel names or the number of mappings.  Guessed layouts will not necessarily contain channels
           in the order of the mappings.

       If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to output channels, preserving
       indices.

       Examples

       •   For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,

                   ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav

           will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of the input.

       •   To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order

                   ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav

   channelsplit
       Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       channel_layout
           The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".

       channels
           A channel layout describing the channels to be extracted as separate output streams or "all" to
           extract each input channel as a separate stream. The default is "all".

           Choosing channels not present in channel layout in the input will result in an error.

       Examples

       •   For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,

                   ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv

           will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only the left channel and
           the other the right channel.

       •   Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:

                   ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
                   'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
                   -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
                   front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
                   side_right.wav

       •   Extract only LFE from a 5.1 WAV file:

                   ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1:channels=LFE[LFE]'
                   -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav

   chorus
       Add a chorus effect to the audio.

       Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.

       Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is constant, with
       chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.  The modulation depth defines the
       range the modulated delay is played before or after the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower
       or faster, that is the delayed sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals
       are slightly off key.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       in_gain
           Set input gain. Default is 0.4.

       out_gain
           Set output gain. Default is 0.4.

       delays
           Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.

       decays
           Set decays.

       speeds
           Set speeds.

       depths
           Set depths.

       Examples

       •   A single delay:

                   chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2

       •   Two delays:

                   chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3

       •   Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:

                   chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3

   compand
       Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       attacks
       decays
           A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level of the input signal is
           averaged to determine its volume. attacks refers to increase of volume and decays refers to decrease
           of volume. For most situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
           shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden loud audio than sudden
           soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
           If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last set attack/decay
           will be used for all remaining channels.

       points
           A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the maximum possible signal
           amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using the following syntax: "x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|...."
           or "x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...."

           The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function does not have to be
           monotonically rising. The point "0/0" is assumed but may be overridden (by "0/out-dBn"). Typical
           values for the transfer function are "-70/-70|-60/-20|1/0".

       soft-knee
           Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.

       gain
           Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer function. This allows for
           easy adjustment of the overall gain.  It defaults to 0.

       volume
           Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering starts. This permits the
           user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for example, a very large gain is not applied to
           initial signal levels before the companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is
           initially quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.

       delay
           Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is delayed before being
           fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows
           the filter to effectively operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.

       Examples

       •   Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a noisy environment:

                   compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2

           Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:

                   compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0

       •   A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:

                   compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1

       •   Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level than the signal (making
           it, in some ways, similar to squelch):

                   compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1

       •   2:1 compression starting at -6dB:

                   compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5

       •   2:1 compression starting at -9dB:

                   compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9

       •   2:1 compression starting at -12dB:

                   compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9

       •   2:1 compression starting at -18dB:

                   compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7

       •   3:1 compression starting at -15dB:

                   compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2

       •   Compressor/Gate:

                   compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6

       •   Expander:

                   compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3

       •   Hard limiter at -6dB:

                   compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6

       •   Hard limiter at -12dB:

                   compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12

       •   Hard noise gate at -35 dB:

                   compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20

       •   Soft limiter:

                   compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8

   compensationdelay
       Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing positions of microphones or
       speakers.

       For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in different locations. Because the
       front of sound wave has fixed speed in normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends
       on their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when these microphones are in
       phase (synchronized). Note that a distance of ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone capture the
       signal in antiphase to the other microphone. That makes the final mix sound moody.  This filter helps to
       solve phasing problems by adding different delays to each microphone track and make them synchronized.

       The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and synchronize other tracks one by one
       with it.  Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.  Higher sample rates
       will give more tolerance.

       The filter accepts the following parameters:

       mm  Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.  Default is 0.

       cm  Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.  Default is 0.

       m   Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.  Default is 0.

       dry Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.  Default is 0.

       wet Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.  Default is 1.

       temp
           Set temperature in degrees Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.  Default is 20.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   crossfeed
       Apply headphone crossfeed filter.

       Crossfeed is the process of blending the left and right channels of stereo audio recording.  It is mainly
       used to reduce extreme stereo separation of low frequencies.

       The intent is to produce more speaker like sound to the listener.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       strength
           Set strength of crossfeed. Default is 0.2. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  This sets gain of low shelf
           filter for side part of stereo image.  Default is -6dB. Max allowed is -30db when strength is set to
           1.

       range
           Set soundstage wideness. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  This sets cut off frequency
           of low shelf filter. Default is cut off near 1550 Hz. With range set to 1 cut off frequency is set to
           2100 Hz.

       slope
           Set curve slope of low shelf filter. Default is 0.5.  Allowed range is from 0.01 to 1.

       level_in
           Set input gain. Default is 0.9.

       level_out
           Set output gain. Default is 1.

       block_size
           Set block size used for reverse IIR processing. If this value is set to high enough value (higher
           than impulse response length truncated when reaches near zero values) filtering will become linear
           phase otherwise if not big enough it will just produce nasty artifacts.

           Note that filter delay will be exactly this many samples when set to non-zero value.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   crystalizer
       Simple algorithm for audio noise sharpening.

       This filter linearly increases differences between each audio sample.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       i   Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between -10.0 to 0 (unchanged sound) to
           10.0 (maximum effect).  To inverse filtering use negative value.

       c   Enable clipping. By default is enabled.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   dcshift
       Apply a DC shift to the audio.

       This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem in the recording chain)
       from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced headroom and hence volume. The astats filter can be
       used to determine if a signal has a DC offset.

       shift
           Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift the audio.

       limitergain
           Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is used to prevent
           clipping.

   deesser
       Apply de-essing to the audio samples.

       i   Set intensity for triggering de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default is 0.

       m   Set amount of ducking on treble part of sound. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default is 0.5.

       f   How much of original frequency content to keep when de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default
           is 0.5.

       s   Set the output mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           i   Pass input unchanged.

           o   Pass ess filtered out.

           e   Pass only ess.

               Default value is o.

   dialoguenhance
       Enhance dialogue in stereo audio.

       This filter accepts stereo input and produce surround (3.0) channels output.  The newly produced front
       center channel have enhanced speech dialogue originally available in both stereo channels.  This filter
       outputs front left and front right channels same as available in stereo input.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       original
           Set the original center factor to keep in front center channel output.  Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
           Default value is 1.

       enhance
           Set the dialogue enhance factor to put in front center channel output.  Allowed range is from 0 to 3.
           Default value is 1.

       voice
           Set the voice detection factor.  Allowed range is from 2 to 32. Default value is 2.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   drmeter
       Measure audio dynamic range.

       DR values of 14 and higher is found in very dynamic material. DR of 8 to 13 is found in transition
       material. And anything less that 8 have very poor dynamics and is very compressed.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       length
           Set window length in seconds used to split audio into segments of equal length.  Default is 3
           seconds.

   dynaudnorm
       Dynamic Audio Normalizer.

       This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order to bring its peak magnitude to a
       target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic
       Audio Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.  This allows for applying
       extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud"
       sections. In other words: The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
       sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the same target level. Note,
       however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves this goal *without* applying "dynamic range
       compressing". It will retain 100% of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.

       framelen, f
           Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.  Default is 500
           milliseconds.  The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks, referred to as
           frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no meaning for just a single sample value.
           Instead, we need to determine the peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a
           "standard" normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the Dynamic Audio
           Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each frame. The length of a frame is
           specified in milliseconds. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500
           milliseconds, which has been found to give good results with most files.  Note that the exact frame
           length, in number of samples, will be determined automatically, based on the sampling rate of the
           individual input audio file.

       gausssize, g
           Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd number. Default is 31.
           Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the "window size" of the
           Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size is specified in frames, centered around the
           current frame. For the sake of simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default
           value of 31 takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and the 15
           subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger smoothing effect and thus in less gain
           variation, i.e. slower gain adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker
           smoothing effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.  In other words, the
           more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will behave like a "traditional"
           normalization filter. On the contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
           Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.

       peak, p
           Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude level for the normalized
           audio input. This filter will try to approach the target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but
           at the same time it also makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
           A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak magnitude. The default
           value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.  It is not recommended to go above this value.

       maxgain, m
           Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.  The Dynamic Audio
           Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum
           gain factor that does not result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
           the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer additionally bounds the
           frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to
           avoid excessive gain factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain factor
           is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and it usually is not recommended to
           increase this value. Though, for input with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be
           necessary to allow even higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
           not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).  Instead, a "sigmoid"
           threshold function will be applied. This way, the gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold
           value, but never exceed that value.

       targetrms, r
           Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.  By default, the Dynamic
           Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.  This means that the maximum local gain factor for
           each frame is defined (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can be
           amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal level, i.e. without clipping.
           Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean
           square, abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to determine the power
           of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered that the RMS is a better approximation of the
           "perceived loudness" than just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
           frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be established. If a target RMS
           value has been specified, a frame's local gain factor is defined as the factor that would result in
           exactly that RMS value.  Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
           frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.

       coupling, n
           Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.  By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will
           amplify all channels by the same amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all
           channels, i.e.  the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.  However, in
           some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different channels is uneven, e.g. one channel
           may be "quieter" than the other one(s).  In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel
           coupling. This way, the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending only
           on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for harmonizing the volume of the
           different channels.

       correctdc, c
           Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.  An audio signal (in the time domain) is a
           sequence of sample values.  In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in
           the -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the audio signal, or
           "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.  That means if we calculate the mean value of
           all samples in a file, or in a single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to
           that value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from 0.0, in either
           positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is
           clearly undesirable, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.  With DC bias
           correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine the mean value, or "DC correction"
           offset, of each input frame and subtract that value from all of the frame's sample values which
           ensures those samples are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
           boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly between neighbouring
           frames.

       altboundary, b
           Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.  The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into
           account a certain neighbourhood around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
           subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very beginning and at the very
           end of the audio file, not all neighbouring frames are available. In particular, for the first few
           frames in the audio file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few frames
           in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the question arises which gain factors
           should be assumed for the missing frames in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer
           implements two modes to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor of
           exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and "fade out" at the beginning
           and at the end of the input, respectively.

       compress, s
           Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.  By default, the Dynamic Audio
           Normalizer does not apply "traditional" compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned
           and thus the full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However, in some
           cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's normalization algorithm with a
           more "traditional" compression.  For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional
           compression (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled, all input
           frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior to the actual normalization
           process. Put simply, the thresholding function is going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds
           a certain threshold value.  However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed
           threshold value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual frame.  In
           general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.  Values below 3.0 are not
           recommended, because audible distortion may appear.

       threshold, t
           Set the target threshold value. This specifies the lowest permissible magnitude level for the audio
           input which will be normalized.  If input frame volume is above this value frame will be normalized.
           Otherwise frame may not be normalized at all. The default value is set to 0, which means all input
           frames will be normalized.  This option is mostly useful if digital noise is not wanted to be
           amplified.

       channels, h
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available channels are filtered.

       overlap, o
           Specify overlap for frames. If set to 0 (default) no frame overlapping is done.  Using >0 and <1
           values will make less conservative gain adjustments, like when framelen option is set to smaller
           value, if framelen option value is compensated for non-zero overlap then gain adjustments will be
           smoother across time compared to zero overlap case.

       curve, v
           Specify the peak mapping curve expression which is going to be used when calculating gain applied to
           frames. The max output frame gain will still be limited by other options mentioned previously for
           this filter.

           The expression can contain the following constants:

           ch  current channel number

           sn  current sample number

           nb_channels
               number of channels

           t   timestamp expressed in seconds

           sr  sample rate

           p   current frame peak value

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   earwax
       Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.

       This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio so that when listened to on
       headphones the stereo image is moved from inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in
       front of the listener (standard for speakers).

       Ported from SoX.

   equalizer
       Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this filter, the signal-level at and around a
       selected frequency can be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject filters) that at
       all other frequencies is unchanged.

       In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can be given several times, each with a
       different central frequency.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       frequency, f
           Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.

       width_type, t
           Set method to specify band-width of filter.

           h   Hz

           q   Q-Factor

           o   octave

           s   slope

           k   kHz

       width, w
           Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.

       gain, g
           Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.  Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.

       mix, m
           How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       channels, c
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.

       normalize, n
           Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       transform, a
           Set transform type of IIR filter.

           di
           dii
           tdi
           tdii
           latt
           svf
           zdf
       precision, r
           Set precision of filtering.

           auto
               Pick automatic sample format depending on surround filters.

           s16 Always use signed 16-bit.

           s32 Always use signed 32-bit.

           f32 Always use float 32-bit.

           f64 Always use float 64-bit.

       block_size, b
           Set block size used for reverse IIR processing. If this value is set to high enough value (higher
           than impulse response length truncated when reaches near zero values) filtering will become linear
           phase otherwise if not big enough it will just produce nasty artifacts.

           Note that filter delay will be exactly this many samples when set to non-zero value.

       Examples

       •   Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:

                   equalizer=f=1000:t=h:width=200:g=-10

       •   Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:

                   equalizer=f=1000:t=q:w=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:t=q:w=2:g=-5

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       frequency, f
           Change equalizer frequency.  Syntax for the command is : "frequency"

       width_type, t
           Change equalizer width_type.  Syntax for the command is : "width_type"

       width, w
           Change equalizer width.  Syntax for the command is : "width"

       gain, g
           Change equalizer gain.  Syntax for the command is : "gain"

       mix, m
           Change equalizer mix.  Syntax for the command is : "mix"

   extrastereo
       Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which adds some sort of "live" effect
       to playback.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       m   Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound (average of both channels), with
           1.0 sound will be unchanged, with -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.

       c   Enable clipping. By default is enabled.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   firequalizer
       Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       gain
           Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:

           f   the evaluated frequency

           sr  sample rate

           ch  channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled

           chid
               channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when multichannels
               evaluation is disabled

           chs number of channels

           chlayout
               channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h

           and functions:

           gain_interpolate(f)
               interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry

           cubic_interpolate(f)
               same as gain_interpolate, but smoother

           This option is also available as command. Default is gain_interpolate(f).

       gain_entry
           Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can contain functions:

           entry(f, g)
               store gain entry at frequency f with value g

           This option is also available as command.

       delay
           Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.  Default is 0.01.

       accuracy
           Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.  Default is 5.

       wfunc
           Set window function. Acceptable values are:

           rectangular
               rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth

           hann
               hann window (default)

           hamming
               hamming window

           blackman
               blackman window

           nuttall3
               3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window

           mnuttall3
               minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window

           nuttall
               4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window

           bnuttall
               minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window

           bharris
               blackman-harris window

           tukey
               tukey window

       fixed
           If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when filtering with large delay.
           Default is disabled.

       multi
           Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.

       zero_phase
           Enable zero phase mode by subtracting timestamp to compensate delay.  Default is disabled.

       scale
           Set scale used by gain. Acceptable values are:

           linlin
               linear frequency, linear gain

           linlog
               linear frequency, logarithmic (in dB) gain (default)

           loglin
               logarithmic (in octave scale where 20 Hz is 0) frequency, linear gain

           loglog
               logarithmic frequency, logarithmic gain

       dumpfile
           Set file for dumping, suitable for gnuplot.

       dumpscale
           Set scale for dumpfile. Acceptable values are same with scale option.  Default is linlog.

       fft2
           Enable 2-channel convolution using complex FFT. This improves speed significantly.  Default is
           disabled.

       min_phase
           Enable minimum phase impulse response. Default is disabled.

       Examples

       •   lowpass at 1000 Hz:

                   firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'

       •   lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:

                   firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'

       •   custom equalization:

                   firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'

       •   higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:

                   firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on

       •   lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:

                   firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
                   :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on

   flanger
       Apply a flanging effect to the audio.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       delay
           Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.

       depth
           Set added sweep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.

       regen
           Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.  Default value is 0.

       width
           Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.  Default value is 71.

       speed
           Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.

       shape
           Set swept wave shape, can be triangular or sinusoidal.  Default value is sinusoidal.

       phase
           Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.  Default value is 25.

       interp
           Set delay-line interpolation, linear or quadratic.  Default is linear.

   haas
       Apply Haas effect to audio.

       Note that this makes most sense to apply on mono signals.  With this filter applied to mono signals it
       give some directionality and stretches its stereo image.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set input level. By default is 1, or 0dB

       level_out
           Set output level. By default is 1, or 0dB.

       side_gain
           Set gain applied to side part of signal. By default is 1.

       middle_source
           Set kind of middle source. Can be one of the following:

           left
               Pick left channel.

           right
               Pick right channel.

           mid Pick middle part signal of stereo image.

           side
               Pick side part signal of stereo image.

       middle_phase
           Change middle phase. By default is disabled.

       left_delay
           Set left channel delay. By default is 2.05 milliseconds.

       left_balance
           Set left channel balance. By default is -1.

       left_gain
           Set left channel gain. By default is 1.

       left_phase
           Change left phase. By default is disabled.

       right_delay
           Set right channel delay. By defaults is 2.12 milliseconds.

       right_balance
           Set right channel balance. By default is 1.

       right_gain
           Set right channel gain. By default is 1.

       right_phase
           Change right phase. By default is enabled.

   hdcd
       Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with embedded HDCD codes is
       expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.

       The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features of HDCD, and detects the
       Transient Filter flag.

               ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac

       When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit, so the resulting 20-bit
       stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something like -acodec pcm_s24le after the filter to get
       24-bit PCM output.

               ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
               ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -c:a pcm_s24le OUT24.wav

       The filter accepts the following options:

       disable_autoconvert
           Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.

       process_stereo
           Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between channels, consider it
           invalid and use the last valid target_gain.

       cdt_ms
           Set the code detect timer period in ms.

       force_pe
           Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.

       analyze_mode
           Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some specific aspect of the
           decoding process. The output file can be loaded in an audio editor alongside the original to aid
           analysis.

           "analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true" can be used to see all samples above the PE level.

           Modes are:

           0, off
               Disabled

           1, lle
               Gain adjustment level at each sample

           2, pe
               Samples where peak extend occurs

           3, cdt
               Samples where the code detect timer is active

           4, tgm
               Samples where the target gain does not match between channels

   headphone
       Apply head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual loudspeakers around the user for binaural
       listening via headphones.  The HRIRs are provided via additional streams, for each channel one stereo
       input stream is needed.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       map Set mapping of input streams for convolution.  The argument is a '|'-separated list of channel names
           in order as they are given as additional stream inputs for filter.  This also specify number of input
           streams. Number of input streams must be not less than number of channels in first stream plus one.

       gain
           Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.

       type
           Set processing type. Can be time or freq. time is processing audio in time domain which is slow.
           freq is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.  Default is freq.

       lfe Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.

       size
           Set size of frame in number of samples which will be processed at once.  Default value is 1024.
           Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.

       hrir
           Set format of hrir stream.  Default value is stereo. Alternative value is multich.  If value is set
           to stereo, number of additional streams should be greater or equal to number of input channels in
           first input stream.  Also each additional stream should have stereo number of channels.  If value is
           set to multich, number of additional streams should be exactly one. Also number of input channels of
           additional stream should be equal or greater than twice number of channels of first input stream.

       Examples

       •   Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix, each amovie filter
           use stereo file with IR coefficients as input.  The files give coefficients for each position of
           virtual loudspeaker:

                   ffmpeg -i input.wav
                   -filter_complex "amovie=azi_270_ele_0_DFC.wav[sr];amovie=azi_90_ele_0_DFC.wav[sl];amovie=azi_225_ele_0_DFC.wav[br];amovie=azi_135_ele_0_DFC.wav[bl];amovie=azi_0_ele_0_DFC.wav,asplit[fc][lfe];amovie=azi_35_ele_0_DFC.wav[fl];amovie=azi_325_ele_0_DFC.wav[fr];[0:a][fl][fr][fc][lfe][bl][br][sl][sr]headphone=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR"
                   output.wav

       •   Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix, but now in multich
           hrir format.

                   ffmpeg -i input.wav -filter_complex "amovie=minp.wav[hrirs];[0:a][hrirs]headphone=map=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR:hrir=multich"
                   output.wav

   highpass
       Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.  The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole
       (the default).  The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).

       The filter accepts the following options:

       frequency, f
           Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.

       poles, p
           Set number of poles. Default is 2.

       width_type, t
           Set method to specify band-width of filter.

           h   Hz

           q   Q-Factor

           o   octave

           s   slope

           k   kHz

       width, w
           Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.  Applies only to double-pole filter.  The
           default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.

       mix, m
           How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       channels, c
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.

       normalize, n
           Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       transform, a
           Set transform type of IIR filter.

           di
           dii
           tdi
           tdii
           latt
           svf
           zdf
       precision, r
           Set precision of filtering.

           auto
               Pick automatic sample format depending on surround filters.

           s16 Always use signed 16-bit.

           s32 Always use signed 32-bit.

           f32 Always use float 32-bit.

           f64 Always use float 64-bit.

       block_size, b
           Set block size used for reverse IIR processing. If this value is set to high enough value (higher
           than impulse response length truncated when reaches near zero values) filtering will become linear
           phase otherwise if not big enough it will just produce nasty artifacts.

           Note that filter delay will be exactly this many samples when set to non-zero value.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       frequency, f
           Change highpass frequency.  Syntax for the command is : "frequency"

       width_type, t
           Change highpass width_type.  Syntax for the command is : "width_type"

       width, w
           Change highpass width.  Syntax for the command is : "width"

       mix, m
           Change highpass mix.  Syntax for the command is : "mix"

   join
       Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       inputs
           The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.

       channel_layout
           The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.

       map Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of mappings, each in the
           "input_idx.in_channel-out_channel" form. input_idx is the 0-based index of the input stream.
           in_channel can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the
           specified input stream. out_channel is the name of the output channel.

       The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified explicitly. It does so by first
       trying to find an unused matching input channel and if that fails it picks the first unused input
       channel.

       Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):

               ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT

       Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:

               ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
               'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
               out

   ladspa
       Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.

       To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-ladspa".

       file, f
           Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment variable LADSPA_PATH is
           defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in each one of the directories specified by the colon
           separated list in LADSPA_PATH, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in this order:
           HOME/.ladspa/lib/, /usr/local/lib/ladspa/, /usr/lib/ladspa/.

       plugin, p
           Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only one plugin, but others contain
           many of them. If this is not set filter will list all available plugins within the specified library.

       controls, c
           Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point values that determine
           the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay, threshold or gain).  Controls need to be
           defined using the following syntax: c0=value0|c1=value1|c2=value2|..., where valuei is the value set
           on the i-th control.  Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
           value0|value1|value2|..., where valuei is the value set on the i-th control.  If controls is set to
           "help", all available controls and their valid ranges are printed.

       sample_rate, s
           Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.

       nb_samples, n
           Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default is 1024. Only used if plugin
           have zero inputs.

       duration, d
           Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual for the accepted syntax.  Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
           duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.  If not specified, or
           the expressed duration is negative, the audio is supposed to be generated forever.  Only used if
           plugin have zero inputs.

       latency, l
           Enable latency compensation, by default is disabled.  Only used if plugin have inputs.

       Examples

       •   List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:

                   ladspa=file=amp

       •   List all available controls and their valid ranges for "vcf_notch" plugin from "VCF" library:

                   ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help

       •   Simulate low quality audio equipment using "Computer Music Toolkit" (CMT) plugin library:

                   ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12

       •   Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):

                   ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb

       •   Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:

                   ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2

       •   Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin "C* Click - Metronome" from the "C* Audio Plugin Suite" (CAPS)
           library:

                   ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'

       •   Apply "C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser" effect:

                   ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2

       •   Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris "SWH Plugins" collection:

                   ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2

       •   Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris "SWH Plugins" collection:

                   ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0

       •   Reduce stereo image using "Narrower" from the "C* Audio Plugin Suite" (CAPS) library:

                   ladspa=caps:Narrower

       •   Another white noise, now using "C* Audio Plugin Suite" (CAPS) library:

                   ladspa=caps:White:.2

       •   Some fractal noise, using "C* Audio Plugin Suite" (CAPS) library:

                   ladspa=caps:Fractal:c=c1=1

       •   Dynamic volume normalization using "VLevel" plugin:

                   ladspa=vlevel-ladspa:vlevel_mono

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       cN  Modify the N-th control value.

           If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.

   loudnorm
       EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.  Support for both
       single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.  This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and
       maximum true peak. In dynamic mode, to accurately detect true peaks, the audio stream will be upsampled
       to 192 kHz.  Use the "-ar" option or "aresample" filter to explicitly set an output sample rate.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       I, i
           Set integrated loudness target.  Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.

       LRA, lra
           Set loudness range target.  Range is 1.0 - 50.0. Default value is 7.0.

       TP, tp
           Set maximum true peak.  Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.

       measured_I, measured_i
           Measured IL of input file.  Range is -99.0 - +0.0.

       measured_LRA, measured_lra
           Measured LRA of input file.  Range is  0.0 - 99.0.

       measured_TP, measured_tp
           Measured true peak of input file.  Range is  -99.0 - +99.0.

       measured_thresh
           Measured threshold of input file.  Range is -99.0 - +0.0.

       offset
           Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.  Range is  -99.0 - +99.0. Default is
           +0.0.

       linear
           Normalize by linearly scaling the source audio.  "measured_I", "measured_LRA", "measured_TP", and
           "measured_thresh" must all be specified. Target LRA shouldn't be lower than source LRA and the change
           in integrated loudness shouldn't result in a true peak which exceeds the target TP. If any of these
           conditions aren't met, normalization mode will revert to dynamic.  Options are "true" or "false".
           Default is "true".

       dual_mono
           Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback on a stereo system,
           its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.  If set to "true", this option will
           compensate for this effect.  Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.  Options are
           true or false. Default is false.

       print_format
           Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.  Default value is none.

   lowpass
       Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.  The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole
       (the default).  The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).

       The filter accepts the following options:

       frequency, f
           Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.

       poles, p
           Set number of poles. Default is 2.

       width_type, t
           Set method to specify band-width of filter.

           h   Hz

           q   Q-Factor

           o   octave

           s   slope

           k   kHz

       width, w
           Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.  Applies only to double-pole filter.  The
           default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.

       mix, m
           How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       channels, c
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.

       normalize, n
           Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       transform, a
           Set transform type of IIR filter.

           di
           dii
           tdi
           tdii
           latt
           svf
           zdf
       precision, r
           Set precision of filtering.

           auto
               Pick automatic sample format depending on surround filters.

           s16 Always use signed 16-bit.

           s32 Always use signed 32-bit.

           f32 Always use float 32-bit.

           f64 Always use float 64-bit.

       block_size, b
           Set block size used for reverse IIR processing. If this value is set to high enough value (higher
           than impulse response length truncated when reaches near zero values) filtering will become linear
           phase otherwise if not big enough it will just produce nasty artifacts.

           Note that filter delay will be exactly this many samples when set to non-zero value.

       Examples

       •   Lowpass only LFE channel, it LFE is not present it does nothing:

                   lowpass=c=LFE

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       frequency, f
           Change lowpass frequency.  Syntax for the command is : "frequency"

       width_type, t
           Change lowpass width_type.  Syntax for the command is : "width_type"

       width, w
           Change lowpass width.  Syntax for the command is : "width"

       mix, m
           Change lowpass mix.  Syntax for the command is : "mix"

   lv2
       Load a LV2 (LADSPA Version 2) plugin.

       To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-lv2".

       plugin, p
           Specifies the plugin URI. You may need to escape ':'.

       controls, c
           Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point values that determine
           the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay, threshold or gain).  If controls is set to
           "help", all available controls and their valid ranges are printed.

       sample_rate, s
           Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.

       nb_samples, n
           Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default is 1024. Only used if plugin
           have zero inputs.

       duration, d
           Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual for the accepted syntax.  Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
           duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.  If not specified, or
           the expressed duration is negative, the audio is supposed to be generated forever.  Only used if
           plugin have zero inputs.

       Examples

       •   Apply bass enhancer plugin from Calf:

                   lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/BassEnhancer:c=amount=2

       •   Apply vinyl plugin from Calf:

                   lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/Vinyl:c=drone=0.2|aging=0.5

       •   Apply bit crusher plugin from ArtyFX:

                   lv2=p=http\\\\://www.openavproductions.com/artyfx#bitta:c=crush=0.3

       Commands

       This filter supports all options that are exported by plugin as commands.

   mcompand
       Multiband Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.

       The input audio is divided into bands using 4th order Linkwitz-Riley IIRs.  This is akin to the crossover
       of a loudspeaker, and results in flat frequency response when absent compander action.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       args
           This option syntax is: attack,decay,[attack,decay..] soft-knee points crossover_frequency [delay
           [initial_volume [gain]]] | attack,decay ...  For explanation of each item refer to compand filter
           documentation.

   pan
       Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output channel layout followed by a set of
       channels definitions.

       This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio stream.

       The filter accepts parameters of the form: "l|outdef|outdef|..."

       l   output channel layout or number of channels

       outdef
           output channel specification, of the form: "out_name=[gain*]in_name[(+-)[gain*]in_name...]"

       out_name
           output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel number (c0, c1, etc.)

       gain
           multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged

       in_name
           input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix named and numbered input
           channels

       If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for that specification will be
       renormalized so that the total is 1, thus avoiding clipping noise.

       Mixing examples

       For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger factor for the left channel:

               pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1

       A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and 7-channels surround:

               pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR

       Note that ffmpeg integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system that should be preferred (see "-ac"
       option) unless you have very specific needs.

       Remapping examples

       The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:

       *<gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,>
       *<only one input per channel output,>

       If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure channel mapping detected"),
       and use an optimized and lossless method to do the remapping.

       For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by dropping the extra channels:

               pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"

       Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels and keep the input channel
       layout:

               pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"

       If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and still keep the stereo
       channel layout) with:

               pan="stereo|c1=c1"

       Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both front left and right:

               pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"

   replaygain
       ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and outputs it unchanged.  At
       end of filtering it displays "track_gain" and "track_peak".

       The filter accepts the following exported read-only options:

       track_gain
           Exported track gain in dB at end of stream.

       track_peak
           Exported track peak at end of stream.

   resample
       Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is not meant to be used directly.

   rubberband
       Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.

       To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-librubberband".

       The filter accepts the following options:

       tempo
           Set tempo scale factor.

       pitch
           Set pitch scale factor.

       transients
           Set transients detector.  Possible values are:

           crisp
           mixed
           smooth
       detector
           Set detector.  Possible values are:

           compound
           percussive
           soft
       phase
           Set phase.  Possible values are:

           laminar
           independent
       window
           Set processing window size.  Possible values are:

           standard
           short
           long
       smoothing
           Set smoothing.  Possible values are:

           off
           on
       formant
           Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.  Possible values are:

           shifted
           preserved
       pitchq
           Set pitch quality.  Possible values are:

           quality
           speed
           consistency
       channels
           Set channels.  Possible values are:

           apart
           together

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       tempo
           Change filter tempo scale factor.  Syntax for the command is : "tempo"

       pitch
           Change filter pitch scale factor.  Syntax for the command is : "pitch"

   sidechaincompress
       This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress detected signal using second
       input signal.  It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.  First input stream will be
       processed depending on second stream signal.  The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters
       in later stages of processing. See pan and amerge filter.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.

       mode
           Set mode of compressor operation. Can be "upward" or "downward".  Default is "downward".

       threshold
           If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain reduction of first
           stream.  By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.

       ratio
           Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level raised 4dB above the
           threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.  Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.

       attack
           Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain reduction starts.
           Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.

       release
           Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before reduction is decreased
           again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.

       makeup
           Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.  Default is 1. Range is from 1
           to 64.

       knee
           Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.  Default is 2.82843.
           Range is between 1 and 8.

       link
           Choose if the "average" level between all channels of side-chain stream or the louder("maximum")
           channel of side-chain stream affects the reduction. Default is "average".

       detection
           Should the exact signal be taken in case of "peak" or an RMS one in case of "rms". Default is "rms"
           which is mainly smoother.

       level_sc
           Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.

       mix How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed depending on the signal of 2nd
           input and later compressed signal to be merged with 2nd input:

                   ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"

   sidechaingate
       A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to filter the detected signal
       before sending it to the gain reduction stage.  Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a
       level above the threshold.  For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal the
       gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs appear. With this technique you are
       able to reduce the resonation of a natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily
       distorted guitar.  It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.  First input stream will be
       processed depending on second stream signal.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set input level before filtering.  Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.

       mode
           Set the mode of operation. Can be "upward" or "downward".  Default is "downward". If set to "upward"
           mode, higher parts of signal will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
           Otherwise, in case of "downward" lower parts of signal will be reduced.

       range
           Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.  Default is 0.06125. Allowed
           range is from 0 to 1.  Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.

       threshold
           If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.  Default is 0.125. Allowed range
           is from 0 to 1.

       ratio
           Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.  Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.

       attack
           Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain reduction stops.
           Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.

       release
           Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the reduction is increased
           again. Default is 250 milliseconds.  Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.

       makeup
           Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.  Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.

       knee
           Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.  Default is
           2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.

       detection
           Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.  Default is rms. Can be peak
           or rms.

       link
           Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects the reduction.
           Default is average. Can be average or maximum.

       level_sc
           Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   silencedetect
       Detect silence in an audio stream.

       This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less or equal to a noise
       tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the minimum detected noise duration.

       The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The "lavfi.silence_start" or
       "lavfi.silence_start.X" metadata key is set on the first frame whose timestamp equals or exceeds the
       detection duration and it contains the timestamp of the first frame of the silence.

       The "lavfi.silence_duration" or "lavfi.silence_duration.X" and "lavfi.silence_end" or
       "lavfi.silence_end.X" metadata keys are set on the first frame after the silence. If mono is enabled, and
       each channel is evaluated separately, the ".X" suffixed keys are used, and "X" corresponds to the channel
       number.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       noise, n
           Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value) or
           amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.

       duration, d
           Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds). See the Time duration section in the
           ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for the accepted syntax.

       mono, m
           Process each channel separately, instead of combined. By default is disabled.

       Examples

       •   Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:

                   silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5

       •   Complete example with ffmpeg to detect silence with 0.0001 noise tolerance in silence.mp3:

                   ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -

   silenceremove
       Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       start_periods
           This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of the audio. A value of zero
           indicates no silence should be trimmed from the beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims
           audio up until it finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio the
           start_periods will be 1 but it can be increased to higher values to trim all audio up to specific
           count of non-silence periods.  Default value is 0.

       start_duration
           Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops trimming audio. By
           increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated as silence and trimmed off. Default value is
           0.

       start_threshold
           This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital audio, a value of 0 may be
           fine but for audio recorded from analog, you may wish to increase the value to account for background
           noise.  Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value) or amplitude ratio.
           Default value is 0.

       start_silence
           Specify max duration of silence at beginning that will be kept after trimming. Default is 0, which is
           equal to trimming all samples detected as silence.

       start_mode
           Specify mode of detection of silence end at start of multi-channel audio.  Can be any or all. Default
           is any.  With any, any sample from any channel that is detected as non-silence will trigger end of
           silence trimming at start of audio stream.  With all, only if every sample from every channel is
           detected as non-silence will trigger end of silence trimming at start of audio stream, limited usage.

       stop_periods
           Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio. When specifying a positive value, it trims
           audio after it finds specified silence period.  To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify
           a stop_periods that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is used to
           indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by stop_periods, making it suitable for
           removing periods of silence in the middle of the audio.  Default value is 0.

       stop_duration
           Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any more. By specifying a
           higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in the audio.  Default value is 0.

       stop_threshold
           This is the same as start_threshold but for trimming silence from the end of audio.  Can be specified
           in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default value is 0.

       stop_silence
           Specify max duration of silence at end that will be kept after trimming. Default is 0, which is equal
           to trimming all samples detected as silence.

       stop_mode
           Specify mode of detection of silence start after start of multi-channel audio.  Can be any or all.
           Default is all.  With any, any sample from any channel that is detected as silence will trigger start
           of silence trimming after start of audio stream, limited usage.  With all, only if every sample from
           every channel is detected as silence will trigger start of silence trimming after start of audio
           stream.

       detection
           Set how is silence detected.

           avg Mean of absolute values of samples in moving window.

           rms Root squared mean of absolute values of samples in moving window.

           peak
               Maximum of absolute values of samples in moving window.

           median
               Median of absolute values of samples in moving window.

           ptp Absolute of max peak to min peak difference of samples in moving window.

           dev Standard deviation of values of samples in moving window.

           Default value is "rms".

       window
           Set duration in number of seconds used to calculate size of window in number of samples for detecting
           silence. Using 0 will effectively disable any windowing and use only single sample per channel for
           silence detection.  In that case it may be needed to also set start_silence and/or stop_silence to
           nonzero values with also start_duration and/or stop_duration to nonzero values.  Default value is
           0.02. Allowed range is from 0 to 10.

       timestamp
           Set processing mode of every audio frame output timestamp.

           write
               Full timestamps rewrite, keep only the start time for the first output frame.

           copy
               Non-dropped frames are left with same timestamp as input audio frame.

           Defaults value is "write".

       Examples

       •   The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording that does not contain
           the delay at the start which usually occurs between pressing the record button and the start of the
           performance:

                   silenceremove=start_periods=1:start_duration=5:start_threshold=0.02

       •   Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1 second of silence in
           audio:

                   silenceremove=stop_periods=-1:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB

       •   Trim all digital silence samples, using peak detection, from beginning to end where there is more
           than 0 samples of digital silence in audio and digital silence is detected in all channels at same
           positions in stream:

                   silenceremove=window=0:detection=peak:stop_mode=all:start_mode=all:stop_periods=-1:stop_threshold=0

       •   Trim every 2nd encountered silence period from beginning to end where there is more than 1 second of
           silence per silence period in audio:

                   silenceremove=stop_periods=-2:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB

       •   Similar as above, but keep maximum of 0.5 seconds of silence from each trimmed period:

                   silenceremove=stop_periods=-2:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB:stop_silence=0.5

       •   Similar as above, but keep maximum of 1.5 seconds of silence from start of audio:

                   silenceremove=stop_periods=-2:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB:stop_silence=0.5:start_periods=1:start_duration=1:start_silence=1.5:stop_threshold=-90dB

       Commands

       This filter supports some above options as commands.

   sofalizer
       SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual loudspeakers around the user for
       binaural listening via headphones (audio formats up to 9 channels supported).  The HRTFs are stored in
       SOFA files (see <http://www.sofacoustics.org/> for a database).  SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics
       Research Institute (ARI) of the Austrian Academy of Sciences.

       To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libmysofa".

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sofa
           Set the SOFA file used for rendering.

       gain
           Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.

       rotation
           Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.

       elevation
           Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.

       radius
           Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field HRTFs. Default is 1.

       type
           Set processing type. Can be time or freq. time is processing audio in time domain which is slow.
           freq is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.  Default is freq.

       speakers
           Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is: <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH>
           <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].  Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
           azimuth and elevation in degrees.  Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.  For
           example to override front left and front right channel positions use: 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
           Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.

       lfegain
           Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.

       framesize
           Set custom frame size in number of samples. Default is 1024.  Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.
           Only used if option type is set to freq.

       normalize
           Should all IRs be normalized upon importing SOFA file.  By default is enabled.

       interpolate
           Should nearest IRs be interpolated with neighbor IRs if exact position does not match. By default is
           disabled.

       minphase
           Minphase all IRs upon loading of SOFA file. By default is disabled.

       anglestep
           Set neighbor search angle step. Only used if option interpolate is enabled.

       radstep
           Set neighbor search radius step. Only used if option interpolate is enabled.

       Examples

       •   Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:

                   sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1

       •   Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:

                   sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5

       •   Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, back left and back
           right and also with custom gain:

                   "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|BL 135|BR 225:gain=28"

   speechnorm
       Speech Normalizer.

       This filter expands or compresses each half-cycle of audio samples (local set of samples all above or all
       below zero and between two nearest zero crossings) depending on threshold value, so audio reaches target
       peak value under conditions controlled by below options.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       peak, p
           Set the expansion target peak value. This specifies the highest allowed absolute amplitude level for
           the normalized audio input. Default value is 0.95. Allowed range is from 0.0 to 1.0.

       expansion, e
           Set the maximum expansion factor. Allowed range is from 1.0 to 50.0. Default value is 2.0.  This
           option controls maximum local half-cycle of samples expansion. The maximum expansion would be such
           that local peak value reaches target peak value but never to surpass it and that ratio between new
           and previous peak value does not surpass this option value.

       compression, c
           Set the maximum compression factor. Allowed range is from 1.0 to 50.0. Default value is 2.0.  This
           option controls maximum local half-cycle of samples compression. This option is used only if
           threshold option is set to value greater than 0.0, then in such cases when local peak is lower or
           same as value set by threshold all samples belonging to that peak's half-cycle will be compressed by
           current compression factor.

       threshold, t
           Set the threshold value. Default value is 0.0. Allowed range is from 0.0 to 1.0.  This option
           specifies which half-cycles of samples will be compressed and which will be expanded.  Any half-cycle
           samples with their local peak value below or same as this option value will be compressed by current
           compression factor, otherwise, if greater than threshold value they will be expanded with expansion
           factor so that it could reach peak target value but never surpass it.

       raise, r
           Set the expansion raising amount per each half-cycle of samples. Default value is 0.001.  Allowed
           range is from 0.0 to 1.0. This controls how fast expansion factor is raised per each new half-cycle
           until it reaches expansion value.  Setting this options too high may lead to distortions.

       fall, f
           Set the compression raising amount per each half-cycle of samples. Default value is 0.001.  Allowed
           range is from 0.0 to 1.0. This controls how fast compression factor is raised per each new half-cycle
           until it reaches compression value.

       channels, h
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available channels are filtered.

       invert, i
           Enable inverted filtering, by default is disabled. This inverts interpretation of threshold option.
           When enabled any half-cycle of samples with their local peak value below or same as threshold option
           will be expanded otherwise it will be compressed.

       link, l
           Link channels when calculating gain applied to each filtered channel sample, by default is disabled.
           When disabled each filtered channel gain calculation is independent, otherwise when this option is
           enabled the minimum of all possible gains for each filtered channel is used.

       rms, m
           Set the expansion target RMS value. This specifies the highest allowed RMS level for the normalized
           audio input. Default value is 0.0, thus disabled. Allowed range is from 0.0 to 1.0.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Weak and slow amplification:

                   speechnorm=e=3:r=0.00001:l=1

       •   Moderate and slow amplification:

                   speechnorm=e=6.25:r=0.00001:l=1

       •   Strong and fast amplification:

                   speechnorm=e=12.5:r=0.0001:l=1

       •   Very strong and fast amplification:

                   speechnorm=e=25:r=0.0001:l=1

       •   Extreme and fast amplification:

                   speechnorm=e=50:r=0.0001:l=1

   stereotools
       This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting M/S stereo recordings to
       L/R signal while having control over the parameters or spreading the stereo image of master track.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_in
           Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.  Allowed range is from 0.015625 to
           64.

       level_out
           Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.  Allowed range is from 0.015625 to
           64.

       balance_in
           Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1.

       balance_out
           Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1.

       softclip
           Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB clipping. Disabled by
           default.

       mutel
           Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.

       muter
           Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.

       phasel
           Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.

       phaser
           Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.

       mode
           Set stereo mode. Available values are:

           lr>lr
               Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.

           lr>ms
               Left/Right to Mid/Side.

           ms>lr
               Mid/Side to Left/Right.

           lr>ll
               Left/Right to Left/Left.

           lr>rr
               Left/Right to Right/Right.

           lr>l+r
               Left/Right to Left + Right.

           lr>rl
               Left/Right to Right/Left.

           ms>ll
               Mid/Side to Left/Left.

           ms>rr
               Mid/Side to Right/Right.

           ms>rl
               Mid/Side to Right/Left.

           lr>l-r
               Left/Right to Left - Right.

       slev
           Set level of side signal. Default is 1.  Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.

       sbal
           Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1.

       mlev
           Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.  Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.

       mpan
           Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.

       base
           Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1.

       delay
           Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and vice versa. Default is 0.
           Allowed range is from -20 to 20.

       sclevel
           Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.

       phase
           Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.

       bmode_in, bmode_out
           Set balance mode for balance_in/balance_out option.

           Can be one of the following:

           balance
               Classic balance mode. Attenuate one channel at time.  Gain is raised up to 1.

           amplitude
               Similar as classic mode above but gain is raised up to 2.

           power
               Equal power distribution, from -6dB to +6dB range.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Apply karaoke like effect:

                   stereotools=mlev=0.015625

       •   Convert M/S signal to L/R:

                   "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"

   stereowiden
       This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both channels and by delaying the
       signal of left into right and vice versa, thereby widening the stereo effect.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       delay
           Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.  Default is 20
           milliseconds.

       feedback
           Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay effect of left signal in
           right output and vice versa which gives widening effect. Default is 0.3.

       crossfeed
           Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing the mono. If the value
           is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both channels. Default is 0.3.

       drymix
           Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options except "delay" as commands.

   superequalizer
       Apply 18 band equalizer.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       1b  Set 65Hz band gain.

       2b  Set 92Hz band gain.

       3b  Set 131Hz band gain.

       4b  Set 185Hz band gain.

       5b  Set 262Hz band gain.

       6b  Set 370Hz band gain.

       7b  Set 523Hz band gain.

       8b  Set 740Hz band gain.

       9b  Set 1047Hz band gain.

       10b Set 1480Hz band gain.

       11b Set 2093Hz band gain.

       12b Set 2960Hz band gain.

       13b Set 4186Hz band gain.

       14b Set 5920Hz band gain.

       15b Set 8372Hz band gain.

       16b Set 11840Hz band gain.

       17b Set 16744Hz band gain.

       18b Set 20000Hz band gain.

   surround
       Apply audio surround upmix filter.

       This filter allows to produce multichannel output from audio stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       chl_out
           Set output channel layout. By default, this is 5.1.

           See the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for the required syntax.

       chl_in
           Set input channel layout. By default, this is stereo.

           See the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for the required syntax.

       level_in
           Set input volume level. By default, this is 1.

       level_out
           Set output volume level. By default, this is 1.

       lfe Enable LFE channel output if output channel layout has it. By default, this is enabled.

       lfe_low
           Set LFE low cut off frequency. By default, this is 128 Hz.

       lfe_high
           Set LFE high cut off frequency. By default, this is 256 Hz.

       lfe_mode
           Set LFE mode, can be add or sub. Default is add.  In add mode, LFE channel is created from input
           audio and added to output.  In sub mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output
           but also all non-LFE output channels are subtracted with output LFE channel.

       smooth
           Set temporal smoothness strength, used to gradually change factors when transforming stereo sound in
           time. Allowed range is from 0.0 to 1.0.  Useful to improve output quality with focus option values
           greater than 0.0.  Default is 0.0. Only values inside this range and without edges are effective.

       angle
           Set angle of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from 0 to 360.  Default is 90.

       focus
           Set focus of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from -1 to 1.  Default is 0.

       fc_in
           Set front center input volume. By default, this is 1.

       fc_out
           Set front center output volume. By default, this is 1.

       fl_in
           Set front left input volume. By default, this is 1.

       fl_out
           Set front left output volume. By default, this is 1.

       fr_in
           Set front right input volume. By default, this is 1.

       fr_out
           Set front right output volume. By default, this is 1.

       sl_in
           Set side left input volume. By default, this is 1.

       sl_out
           Set side left output volume. By default, this is 1.

       sr_in
           Set side right input volume. By default, this is 1.

       sr_out
           Set side right output volume. By default, this is 1.

       bl_in
           Set back left input volume. By default, this is 1.

       bl_out
           Set back left output volume. By default, this is 1.

       br_in
           Set back right input volume. By default, this is 1.

       br_out
           Set back right output volume. By default, this is 1.

       bc_in
           Set back center input volume. By default, this is 1.

       bc_out
           Set back center output volume. By default, this is 1.

       lfe_in
           Set LFE input volume. By default, this is 1.

       lfe_out
           Set LFE output volume. By default, this is 1.

       allx
           Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for all channels.  Allowed range is from -1 to 15.  By
           default this value is negative -1, and thus unused.

       ally
           Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for all channels.  Allowed range is from -1 to 15.  By
           default this value is negative -1, and thus unused.

       fcx, flx, frx, blx, brx, slx, srx, bcx
           Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for each channel.  Allowed range is from 0.06 to 15.
           By default this value is 0.5.

       fcy, fly, fry, bly, bry, sly, sry, bcy
           Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for each channel.  Allowed range is from 0.06 to 15.
           By default this value is 0.5.

       win_size
           Set window size. Allowed range is from 1024 to 65536. Default size is 4096.

       win_func
           Set window function.

           It accepts the following values:

           rect
           bartlett
           hann, hanning
           hamming
           blackman
           welch
           flattop
           bharris
           bnuttall
           bhann
           sine
           nuttall
           lanczos
           gauss
           tukey
           dolph
           cauchy
           parzen
           poisson
           bohman
           kaiser

           Default is "hann".

       overlap
           Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected window function will be picked.
           Default is 0.5.

   tiltshelf
       Boost or cut the lower frequencies and cut or boost higher frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
       shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard hi-fi's tone-controls.  This is also known
       as shelving equalisation (EQ).

       The filter accepts the following options:

       gain, g
           Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
           Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.

       frequency, f
           Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used to extend or reduce the frequency range to be
           boosted or cut.  The default value is 3000 Hz.

       width_type, t
           Set method to specify band-width of filter.

           h   Hz

           q   Q-Factor

           o   octave

           s   slope

           k   kHz

       width, w
           Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.

       poles, p
           Set number of poles. Default is 2.

       mix, m
           How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       channels, c
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.

       normalize, n
           Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       transform, a
           Set transform type of IIR filter.

           di
           dii
           tdi
           tdii
           latt
           svf
           zdf
       precision, r
           Set precision of filtering.

           auto
               Pick automatic sample format depending on surround filters.

           s16 Always use signed 16-bit.

           s32 Always use signed 32-bit.

           f32 Always use float 32-bit.

           f64 Always use float 64-bit.

       block_size, b
           Set block size used for reverse IIR processing. If this value is set to high enough value (higher
           than impulse response length truncated when reaches near zero values) filtering will become linear
           phase otherwise if not big enough it will just produce nasty artifacts.

           Note that filter delay will be exactly this many samples when set to non-zero value.

       Commands

       This filter supports some options as commands.

   treble, highshelf
       Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole shelving filter with a response
       similar to that of a standard hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).

       The filter accepts the following options:

       gain, g
           Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is
           about -20 (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive
           gain.

       frequency, f
           Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used to extend or reduce the frequency range to be
           boosted or cut.  The default value is 3000 Hz.

       width_type, t
           Set method to specify band-width of filter.

           h   Hz

           q   Q-Factor

           o   octave

           s   slope

           k   kHz

       width, w
           Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.

       poles, p
           Set number of poles. Default is 2.

       mix, m
           How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.  Range is between 0 and 1.

       channels, c
           Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.

       normalize, n
           Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.  Enabling it will normalize magnitude response
           at DC to 0dB.

       transform, a
           Set transform type of IIR filter.

           di
           dii
           tdi
           tdii
           latt
           svf
           zdf
       precision, r
           Set precision of filtering.

           auto
               Pick automatic sample format depending on surround filters.

           s16 Always use signed 16-bit.

           s32 Always use signed 32-bit.

           f32 Always use float 32-bit.

           f64 Always use float 64-bit.

       block_size, b
           Set block size used for reverse IIR processing. If this value is set to high enough value (higher
           than impulse response length truncated when reaches near zero values) filtering will become linear
           phase otherwise if not big enough it will just produce nasty artifacts.

           Note that filter delay will be exactly this many samples when set to non-zero value.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       frequency, f
           Change treble frequency.  Syntax for the command is : "frequency"

       width_type, t
           Change treble width_type.  Syntax for the command is : "width_type"

       width, w
           Change treble width.  Syntax for the command is : "width"

       gain, g
           Change treble gain.  Syntax for the command is : "gain"

       mix, m
           Change treble mix.  Syntax for the command is : "mix"

   tremolo
       Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       f   Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range (20 Hz or lower) will
           result in a tremolo effect.  This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying a
           modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.  Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.

       d   Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.  Default value is 0.5.

   vibrato
       Sinusoidal phase modulation.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       f   Modulation frequency in Hertz.  Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.

       d   Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.  Default value is 0.5.

   virtualbass
       Apply audio Virtual Bass filter.

       This filter accepts stereo input and produce stereo with LFE (2.1) channels output.  The newly produced
       LFE channel have enhanced virtual bass originally obtained from both stereo channels.  This filter
       outputs front left and front right channels unchanged as available in stereo input.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       cutoff
           Set the virtual bass cutoff frequency. Default value is 250 Hz.  Allowed range is from 100 to 500 Hz.

       strength
           Set the virtual bass strength. Allowed range is from 0.5 to 3.  Default value is 3.

   volume
       Adjust the input audio volume.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       volume
           Set audio volume expression.

           Output values are clipped to the maximum value.

           The output audio volume is given by the relation:

                   <output_volume> = <volume> * <input_volume>

           The default value for volume is "1.0".

       precision
           This parameter represents the mathematical precision.

           It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the precision of the volume
           scaling.

           fixed
               8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.

           float
               32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)

           double
               64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.

       replaygain
           Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.

           drop
               Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).

           ignore
               Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.

           track
               Prefer the track gain, if present.

           album
               Prefer the album gain, if present.

       replaygain_preamp
           Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.

           Default value for replaygain_preamp is 0.0.

       replaygain_noclip
           Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.

           Default value for replaygain_noclip is 1.

       eval
           Set when the volume expression is evaluated.

           It accepts the following values:

           once
               only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or when the volume command is
               sent

           frame
               evaluate expression for each incoming frame

           Default value is once.

       The volume expression can contain the following parameters.

       n   frame number (starting at zero)

       nb_channels
           number of channels

       nb_consumed_samples
           number of samples consumed by the filter

       nb_samples
           number of samples in the current frame

       pos original frame position in the file; deprecated, do not use

       pts frame PTS

       sample_rate
           sample rate

       startpts
           PTS at start of stream

       startt
           time at start of stream

       t   frame time

       tb  timestamp timebase

       volume
           last set volume value

       Note that when eval is set to once only the sample_rate and tb variables are available, all other
       variables will evaluate to NAN.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       volume
           Modify the volume expression.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.

           If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

       Examples

       •   Halve the input audio volume:

                   volume=volume=0.5
                   volume=volume=1/2
                   volume=volume=-6.0206dB

           In all the above example the named key for volume can be omitted, for example like in:

                   volume=0.5

       •   Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:

                   volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed

       •   Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:

                   volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame

   volumedetect
       Detect the volume of the input video.

       The filter has no parameters. It supports only 16-bit signed integer samples, so the input will be
       converted when needed. Statistics about the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end
       is reached.

       In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum volume (on a per-sample basis),
       and the beginning of a histogram of the registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated
       1/1000 of the samples).

       All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.

       Examples

       Here is an excerpt of the output:

               [Parsed_volumedetect_0  0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
               [Parsed_volumedetect_0  0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
               [Parsed_volumedetect_0  0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
               [Parsed_volumedetect_0  0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
               [Parsed_volumedetect_0  0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
               [Parsed_volumedetect_0  0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
               [Parsed_volumedetect_0  0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
               [Parsed_volumedetect_0  0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
               [Parsed_volumedetect_0  0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409

       It means that:

       •   The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.

       •   The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.

       •   There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.

       In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping, raising it by +5 dB causes
       clipping for 6 samples, etc.

AUDIO SOURCES

       Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.

   abuffer
       Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.

       This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular through the interface defined in
       libavfilter/buffersrc.h.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       time_base
           The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be either a floating-
           point number or in numerator/denominator form.

       sample_rate
           The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.

       sample_fmt
           The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.  Either a sample format name or its corresponding
           integer representation from the enum AVSampleFormat in libavutil/samplefmt.h

       channel_layout
           The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.  Either a channel layout name from
           channel_layout_map in libavutil/channel_layout.c or its corresponding integer representation from the
           AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in libavutil/channel_layout.h

       channels
           The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.  If both channels and channel_layout are
           specified, then they must be consistent.

       Examples

               abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo

       will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.  Since the sample format with
       name "s16p" corresponds to the number 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3,
       this is equivalent to:

               abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3

   aevalsrc
       Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.

       This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each channel), which are evaluated and used
       to generate a corresponding audio signal.

       This source accepts the following options:

       exprs
           Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the channel_layout option
           is not specified, the selected channel layout depends on the number of provided expressions.
           Otherwise the last specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.

       channel_layout, c
           Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout must be equal to the number of
           specified expressions.

       duration, d
           Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual for the accepted syntax.  Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
           duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.

           If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is supposed to be generated
           forever.

       nb_samples, n
           Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default to 1024.

       sample_rate, s
           Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.

       Each expression in exprs can contain the following constants:

       n   number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0

       t   time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0

       s   sample rate

       Examples

       •   Generate silence:

                   aevalsrc=0

       •   Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to 8000 Hz:

                   aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"

       •   Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front Center + Back Center) explicitly:

                   aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"

       •   Generate white noise:

                   aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"

       •   Generate an amplitude modulated signal:

                   aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"

       •   Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:

                   aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"

   afdelaysrc
       Generate a fractional delay FIR coefficients.

       The resulting stream can be used with afir filter for filtering the audio signal.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       delay, d
           Set the fractional delay. Default is 0.

       sample_rate, r
           Set the sample rate, default is 44100.

       nb_samples, n
           Set the number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.

       taps, t
           Set the number of filter coefficients in output audio stream.  Default value is 0.

       channel_layout, c
           Specifies the channel layout, and can be a string representing a channel layout.  The default value
           of channel_layout is "stereo".

   afireqsrc
       Generate a FIR equalizer coefficients.

       The resulting stream can be used with afir filter for filtering the audio signal.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       preset, p
           Set equalizer preset.  Default preset is "flat".

           Available presets are:

           custom
           flat
           acoustic
           bass
           beats
           classic
           clear
           deep bass
           dubstep
           electronic
           hard-style
           hip-hop
           jazz
           metal
           movie
           pop
           r&b
           rock
           vocal booster
       gains, g
           Set custom gains for each band. Only used if the preset option is set to "custom".  Gains are
           separated by white spaces and each gain is set in dBFS.  Default is "0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
           0".

       bands, b
           Set the custom bands from where custon equalizer gains are set.  This must be in strictly increasing
           order. Only used if the preset option is set to "custom".  Bands are separated by white spaces and
           each band represent frequency in Hz.  Default is "25 40 63 100 160 250 400 630 1000 1600 2500 4000
           6300 10000 16000 24000".

       taps, t
           Set number of filter coefficients in output audio stream.  Default value is 4096.

       sample_rate, r
           Set sample rate of output audio stream, default is 44100.

       nb_samples, n
           Set number of samples per each frame in output audio stream. Default is 1024.

       interp, i
           Set interpolation method for FIR equalizer coefficients. Can be "linear" or "cubic".

       phase, h
           Set phase type of FIR filter. Can be "linear" or "min": minimum-phase.  Default is minimum-phase
           filter.

   afirsrc
       Generate a FIR coefficients using frequency sampling method.

       The resulting stream can be used with afir filter for filtering the audio signal.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       taps, t
           Set number of filter coefficients in output audio stream.  Default value is 1025.

       frequency, f
           Set frequency points from where magnitude and phase are set.  This must be in non decreasing order,
           and first element must be 0, while last element must be 1. Elements are separated by white spaces.

       magnitude, m
           Set magnitude value for every frequency point set by frequency.  Number of values must be same as
           number of frequency points.  Values are separated by white spaces.

       phase, p
           Set phase value for every frequency point set by frequency.  Number of values must be same as number
           of frequency points.  Values are separated by white spaces.

       sample_rate, r
           Set sample rate, default is 44100.

       nb_samples, n
           Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.

       win_func, w
           Set window function. Default is blackman.

   anullsrc
       The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful as a template and to be
       employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the source for filters which ignore the input data (for
       example the sox synth filter).

       This source accepts the following options:

       channel_layout, cl
           Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string representing a channel layout.
           The default value of channel_layout is "stereo".

           Check the channel_layout_map definition in libavutil/channel_layout.c for the mapping between strings
           and channel layout values.

       sample_rate, r
           Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.

       nb_samples, n
           Set the number of samples per requested frames.

       duration, d
           Set the duration of the sourced audio. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual
           for the accepted syntax.

           If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is supposed to be generated
           forever.

       Examples

       •   Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.

                   anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4

       •   Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:

                   anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono

       All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.

   flite
       Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.

       To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libflite".

       Note that versions of the flite library prior to 2.0 are not thread-safe.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       list_voices
           If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit immediately. Default value is 0.

       nb_samples, n
           Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.

       textfile
           Set the filename containing the text to speak.

       text
           Set the text to speak.

       voice, v
           Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is "kal". See also the list_voices
           option.

       Examples

       •   Read from file speech.txt, and synthesize the text using the standard flite voice:

                   flite=textfile=speech.txt

       •   Read the specified text selecting the "slt" voice:

                   flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt

       •   Input text to ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt

       •   Make ffplay speak the specified text, using "flite" and the "lavfi" device:

                   ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'

       For more information about libflite, check: <http://www.festvox.org/flite/>

   anoisesrc
       Generate a noise audio signal.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sample_rate, r
           Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.

       amplitude, a
           Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value is 1.0.

       duration, d
           Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option results in noise with
           an infinite length.

       color, colour, c
           Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, brown, blue, violet and velvet.
           Default color is white.

       seed, s
           Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.

       nb_samples, n
           Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.

       density
           Set the density (0.0 - 1.0) for the velvet noise generator, default is 0.05.

       Examples

       •   Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:

                   anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5

   hilbert
       Generate odd-tap Hilbert transform FIR coefficients.

       The resulting stream can be used with afir filter for phase-shifting the signal by 90 degrees.

       This is used in many matrix coding schemes and for analytic signal generation.  The process is often
       written as a multiplication by i (or j), the imaginary unit.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sample_rate, s
           Set sample rate, default is 44100.

       taps, t
           Set length of FIR filter, default is 22051.

       nb_samples, n
           Set number of samples per each frame.

       win_func, w
           Set window function to be used when generating FIR coefficients.

   sinc
       Generate a sinc kaiser-windowed low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, or band-reject FIR coefficients.

       The resulting stream can be used with afir filter for filtering the audio signal.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sample_rate, r
           Set sample rate, default is 44100.

       nb_samples, n
           Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.

       hp  Set high-pass frequency. Default is 0.

       lp  Set low-pass frequency. Default is 0.  If high-pass frequency is lower than low-pass frequency and
           low-pass frequency is higher than 0 then filter will create band-pass filter coefficients, otherwise
           band-reject filter coefficients.

       phase
           Set filter phase response. Default is 50. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.

       beta
           Set Kaiser window beta.

       att Set stop-band attenuation. Default is 120dB, allowed range is from 40 to 180 dB.

       round
           Enable rounding, by default is disabled.

       hptaps
           Set number of taps for high-pass filter.

       lptaps
           Set number of taps for low-pass filter.

   sine
       Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.

       The audio signal is bit-exact.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       frequency, f
           Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.

       beep_factor, b
           Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency beep_factor times the carrier frequency. Default
           is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.

       sample_rate, r
           Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.

       duration, d
           Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.

       samples_per_frame
           Set the number of samples per output frame.

           The expression can contain the following constants:

           n   The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.

           pts The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame, expressed in TB units.

           t   The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.

           TB  The timebase of the output audio frames.

           Default is 1024.

       Examples

       •   Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:

                   sine

       •   Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:

                   sine=220:4:d=5
                   sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
                   sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5

       •   Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following "1602,1601,1602,1601,1602" NTSC pattern:

                   sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'

AUDIO SINKS

       Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.

   abuffersink
       Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.

       This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular through the interface defined in
       libavfilter/buffersink.h or the options system.

       It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which defines the incoming buffers' formats,
       to be passed as the opaque parameter to "avfilter_init_filter" for initialization.

   anullsink
       Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is mainly useful as a template and for
       use in analysis / debugging tools.

VIDEO FILTERS

       When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the existing filters using
       "--disable-filters".  The configure output will show the video filters included in your build.

       Below is a description of the currently available video filters.

   addroi
       Mark a region of interest in a video frame.

       The frame data is passed through unchanged, but metadata is attached to the frame indicating regions of
       interest which can affect the behaviour of later encoding.  Multiple regions can be marked by applying
       the filter multiple times.

       x   Region distance in pixels from the left edge of the frame.

       y   Region distance in pixels from the top edge of the frame.

       w   Region width in pixels.

       h   Region height in pixels.

           The parameters x, y, w and h are expressions, and may contain the following variables:

           iw  Width of the input frame.

           ih  Height of the input frame.

       qoffset
           Quantisation offset to apply within the region.

           This must be a real value in the range -1 to +1.  A value of zero indicates no quality change.  A
           negative value asks for better quality (less quantisation), while a positive value asks for worse
           quality (greater quantisation).

           The range is calibrated so that the extreme values indicate the largest possible offset - if the rest
           of the frame is encoded with the worst possible quality, an offset of -1 indicates that this region
           should be encoded with the best possible quality anyway.  Intermediate values are then interpolated
           in some codec-dependent way.

           For example, in 10-bit H.264 the quantisation parameter varies between -12 and 51.  A typical qoffset
           value of -1/10 therefore indicates that this region should be encoded with a QP around one-tenth of
           the full range better than the rest of the frame.  So, if most of the frame were to be encoded with a
           QP of around 30, this region would get a QP of around 24 (an offset of approximately -1/10 * (51 -
           -12) = -6.3).  An extreme value of -1 would indicate that this region should be encoded with the best
           possible quality regardless of the treatment of the rest of the frame - that is, should be encoded at
           a QP of -12.

       clear
           If set to true, remove any existing regions of interest marked on the frame before adding the new
           one.

       Examples

       •   Mark the centre quarter of the frame as interesting.

                   addroi=iw/4:ih/4:iw/2:ih/2:-1/10

       •   Mark the 100-pixel-wide region on the left edge of the frame as very uninteresting (to be encoded at
           much lower quality than the rest of the frame).

                   addroi=0:0:100:ih:+1/5

   alphaextract
       Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This is especially useful with the
       alphamerge filter.

   alphamerge
       Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the grayscale value of a second input. This
       is intended for use with alphaextract to allow the transmission or storage of frame sequences that have
       alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha channel.

       For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video and a separate video created with
       alphaextract, you might use:

               movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]

   amplify
       Amplify differences between current pixel and pixels of adjacent frames in same pixel location.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       radius
           Set frame radius. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 63.  For example radius of 3 will instruct
           filter to calculate average of 7 frames.

       factor
           Set factor to amplify difference. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.

       threshold
           Set threshold for difference amplification. Any difference greater or equal to this value will not
           alter source pixel. Default is 10.  Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.

       tolerance
           Set tolerance for difference amplification. Any difference lower to this value will not alter source
           pixel. Default is 0.  Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.

       low Set lower limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.  This
           option controls maximum possible value that will decrease source pixel value.

       high
           Set high limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.  This
           option controls maximum possible value that will increase source pixel value.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands that corresponds to option of same name:

       factor
       threshold
       tolerance
       low
       high
       planes

   ass
       Same as the subtitles filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec and libavformat to work. On the
       other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced Substation Alpha) subtitles files.

       This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from the subtitles filter:

       shaping
           Set the shaping engine

           Available values are:

           auto
               The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.

           simple
               Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions

           complex
               Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning

           The default is "auto".

   atadenoise
       Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       0a  Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.  Valid range is 0 to 0.3.

       0b  Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.  Valid range is 0 to 5.

       1a  Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.  Valid range is 0 to 0.3.

       1b  Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.  Valid range is 0 to 5.

       2a  Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.  Valid range is 0 to 0.3.

       2b  Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.  Valid range is 0 to 5.

           Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and threshold B is designed to
           react on continuous changes in the input signal.

       s   Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 9. Must be odd number in range [5,
           129].

       p   Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.

       a   Set what variant of algorithm filter will use for averaging. Default is "p" parallel.  Alternatively
           can be set to "s" serial.

           Parallel can be faster then serial, while other way around is never true.  Parallel will abort early
           on first change being greater then thresholds, while serial will continue processing other side of
           frames if they are equal or below thresholds.

       0s
       1s
       2s  Set sigma for 1st plane, 2nd plane or 3rd plane. Default is 32767.  Valid range is from 0 to 32767.
           This options controls weight for each pixel in radius defined by size.  Default value means every
           pixel have same weight.  Setting this option to 0 effectively disables filtering.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options except option "s".  The command accepts the same syntax of
       the corresponding option.

   avgblur
       Apply average blur filter.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sizeX
           Set horizontal radius size.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.

       sizeY
           Set vertical radius size, if zero it will be same as "sizeX".  Default is 0.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   backgroundkey
       Turns a static background into transparency.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       threshold
           Threshold for scene change detection.

       similarity
           Similarity percentage with the background.

       blend
           Set the blend amount for pixels that are not similar.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   bbox
       Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame luma plane.

       This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a luma value greater than the
       minimum allowed value.  The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter log.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       min_val
           Set the minimal luma value. Default is 16.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   bilateral
       Apply bilateral filter, spatial smoothing while preserving edges.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sigmaS
           Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate spatial weight.  Allowed range is 0 to 512. Default is
           0.1.

       sigmaR
           Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate range weight.  Allowed range is 0 to 1. Default is 0.1.

       planes
           Set planes to filter. Default is first only.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   bilateral_cuda
       CUDA accelerated bilateral filter, an edge preserving filter.  This filter is mathematically accurate
       thanks to the use of GPU acceleration.  For best output quality, use one to one chroma subsampling, i.e.
       yuv444p format.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sigmaS
           Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate spatial weight, also called sigma space.  Allowed range
           is 0.1 to 512. Default is 0.1.

       sigmaR
           Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate color range weight, also called sigma color.  Allowed
           range is 0.1 to 512. Default is 0.1.

       window_size
           Set window size of the bilateral function to determine the number of neighbours to loop on.  If the
           number entered is even, one will be added automatically.  Allowed range is 1 to 255. Default is 1.

       Examples

       •   Apply the bilateral filter on a video.

                   ./ffmpeg -v verbose \
                   -hwaccel cuda -hwaccel_output_format cuda -i input.mp4  \
                   -init_hw_device cuda \
                   -filter_complex \
                   " \
                   [0:v]scale_cuda=format=yuv444p[scaled_video];
                   [scaled_video]bilateral_cuda=window_size=9:sigmaS=3.0:sigmaR=50.0" \
                   -an -sn -c:v h264_nvenc -cq 20 out.mp4

   bitplanenoise
       Show and measure bit plane noise.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       bitplane
           Set which plane to analyze. Default is 1.

       filter
           Filter out noisy pixels from "bitplane" set above.  Default is disabled.

   blackdetect
       Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to detect chapter transitions,
       commercials, or invalid recordings.

       The filter outputs its detection analysis to both the log as well as frame metadata. If a black segment
       of at least the specified minimum duration is found, a line with the start and end timestamps as well as
       duration is printed to the log with level "info". In addition, a log line with level "debug" is printed
       per frame showing the black amount detected for that frame.

       The filter also attaches metadata to the first frame of a black segment with key "lavfi.black_start" and
       to the first frame after the black segment ends with key "lavfi.black_end". The value is the frame's
       timestamp. This metadata is added regardless of the minimum duration specified.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       black_min_duration, d
           Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must be a non-negative floating
           point number.

           Default value is 2.0.

       picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
           Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".  Express the minimum value for the ratio:

                   <nb_black_pixels> / <nb_pixels>

           for which a picture is considered black.  Default value is 0.98.

       pixel_black_th, pix_th
           Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".

           The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luma value for which a pixel is considered "black". The
           provided value is scaled according to the following equation:

                   <absolute_threshold> = <luma_minimum_value> + <pixel_black_th> * <luma_range_size>

           luma_range_size and luma_minimum_value depend on the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV
           full-range formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.

           Default value is 0.10.

       The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum value, and detects only black
       intervals of 2 or more seconds:

               blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00

   blackframe
       Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to detect chapter transitions or
       commercials. Output lines consist of the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
       the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.

       In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.

       This filter exports frame metadata "lavfi.blackframe.pblack".  The value represents the percentage of
       pixels in the picture that are below the threshold value.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       amount
           The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to 98.

       threshold, thresh
           The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to 32.

   blend
       Blend two video frames into each other.

       The "blend" filter takes two input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the "top" layer and
       second input is "bottom" layer.  By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.

       The "tblend" (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames from one single stream, and outputs the
       result obtained by blending the new frame on top of the old frame.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       c0_mode
       c1_mode
       c2_mode
       c3_mode
       all_mode
           Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case of all_mode. Default
           value is "normal".

           Available values for component modes are:

           addition
           and
           average
           bleach
           burn
           darken
           difference
           divide
           dodge
           exclusion
           extremity
           freeze
           geometric
           glow
           grainextract
           grainmerge
           hardlight
           hardmix
           hardoverlay
           harmonic
           heat
           interpolate
           lighten
           linearlight
           multiply
           multiply128
           negation
           normal
           or
           overlay
           phoenix
           pinlight
           reflect
           screen
           softdifference
           softlight
           stain
           subtract
           vividlight
           xor
       c0_opacity
       c1_opacity
       c2_opacity
       c3_opacity
       all_opacity
           Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case of all_opacity. Only
           used in combination with pixel component blend modes.

       c0_expr
       c1_expr
       c2_expr
       c3_expr
       all_expr
           Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case of all_expr. Note
           that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.

           The expressions can use the following variables:

           N   The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.

           X
           Y   the coordinates of the current sample

           W
           H   the width and height of currently filtered plane

           SW
           SH  Width and height scale for the plane being filtered. It is the ratio between the dimensions of
               the current plane to the luma plane, e.g. for a "yuv420p" frame, the values are "1,1" for the
               luma plane and "0.5,0.5" for the chroma planes.

           T   Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.

           TOP, A
               Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).

           BOTTOM, B
               Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).

       The "blend" filter also supports the framesync options.

       Examples

       •   Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:

                   blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'

       •   Apply linear horizontal transition from top layer to bottom layer:

                   blend=all_expr='A*(X/W)+B*(1-X/W)'

       •   Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:

                   blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'

       •   Apply uncover left effect:

                   blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'

       •   Apply uncover down effect:

                   blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'

       •   Apply uncover up-left effect:

                   blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'

       •   Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:

                   blend=all_expr='if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)'

       •   Display differences between the current and the previous frame:

                   tblend=all_mode=grainextract

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   blockdetect
       Determines blockiness of frames without altering the input frames.

       Based on Remco Muijs and Ihor Kirenko: "A no-reference blocking artifact measure for adaptive video
       processing." 2005 13th European signal processing conference.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       period_min
       period_max
           Set minimum and maximum values for determining pixel grids (periods).  Default values are [3,24].

       planes
           Set planes to filter. Default is first only.

       Examples

       •   Determine blockiness for the first plane and search for periods within [8,32]:

                   blockdetect=period_min=8:period_max=32:planes=1

   blurdetect
       Determines blurriness of frames without altering the input frames.

       Based on Marziliano, Pina, et al. "A no-reference perceptual blur metric."  Allows for a block-based
       abbreviation.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       low
       high
           Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding algorithm.

           The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then connected through 8-connectivity
           with the "weak" edge pixels selected by the low threshold.

           low and high threshold values must be chosen in the range [0,1], and low should be lesser or equal to
           high.

           Default value for low is "20/255", and default value for high is "50/255".

       radius
           Define the radius to search around an edge pixel for local maxima.

       block_pct
           Determine blurriness only for the most significant blocks, given in percentage.

       block_width
           Determine blurriness for blocks of width block_width. If set to any value smaller 1, no blocks are
           used and the whole image is processed as one no matter of block_height.

       block_height
           Determine blurriness for blocks of height block_height. If set to any value smaller 1, no blocks are
           used and the whole image is processed as one no matter of block_width.

       planes
           Set planes to filter. Default is first only.

       Examples

       •   Determine blur for 80% of most significant 32x32 blocks:

                   blurdetect=block_width=32:block_height=32:block_pct=80

   bm3d
       Denoise frames using Block-Matching 3D algorithm.

       The filter accepts the following options.

       sigma
           Set denoising strength. Default value is 1.  Allowed range is from 0 to 999.9.  The denoising
           algorithm is very sensitive to sigma, so adjust it according to the source.

       block
           Set local patch size. This sets dimensions in 2D.

       bstep
           Set sliding step for processing blocks. Default value is 4.  Allowed range is from 1 to 64.  Smaller
           values allows processing more reference blocks and is slower.

       group
           Set maximal number of similar blocks for 3rd dimension. Default value is 1.  When set to 1, no block
           matching is done. Larger values allows more blocks in single group.  Allowed range is from 1 to 256.

       range
           Set radius for search block matching. Default is 9.  Allowed range is from 1 to INT32_MAX.

       mstep
           Set step between two search locations for block matching. Default is 1.  Allowed range is from 1 to
           64. Smaller is slower.

       thmse
           Set threshold of mean square error for block matching. Valid range is 0 to INT32_MAX.

       hdthr
           Set thresholding parameter for hard thresholding in 3D transformed domain.  Larger values results in
           stronger hard-thresholding filtering in frequency domain.

       estim
           Set filtering estimation mode. Can be "basic" or "final".  Default is "basic".

       ref If enabled, filter will use 2nd stream for block matching.  Default is disabled for "basic" value of
           estim option, and always enabled if value of estim is "final".

       planes
           Set planes to filter. Default is all available except alpha.

       Examples

       •   Basic filtering with bm3d:

                   bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic

       •   Same as above, but filtering only luma:

                   bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic:planes=1

       •   Same as above, but with both estimation modes:

                   split[a][b],[a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1

       •   Same as above, but prefilter with nlmeans filter instead:

                   split[a][b],[a]nlmeans=s=3:r=7:p=3[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1

   boxblur
       Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       luma_radius, lr
       luma_power, lp
       chroma_radius, cr
       chroma_power, cp
       alpha_radius, ar
       alpha_power, ap

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       luma_radius, lr
       chroma_radius, cr
       alpha_radius, ar
           Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the corresponding input plane.

           The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be greater than the value of the
           expression "min(w,h)/2" for the luma and alpha planes, and of "min(cw,ch)/2" for the chroma planes.

           Default value for luma_radius is "2". If not specified, chroma_radius and alpha_radius default to the
           corresponding value set for luma_radius.

           The expressions can contain the following constants:

           w
           h   The input width and height in pixels.

           cw
           ch  The input chroma image width and height in pixels.

           hsub
           vsub
               The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the pixel format "yuv422p",
               hsub is 2 and vsub is 1.

       luma_power, lp
       chroma_power, cp
       alpha_power, ap
           Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the corresponding plane.

           Default value for luma_power is 2. If not specified, chroma_power and alpha_power default to the
           corresponding value set for luma_power.

           A value of 0 will disable the effect.

       Examples

       •   Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii set to 2:

                   boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
                   boxblur=2:1

       •   Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:

                   boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0

       •   Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:

                   boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1

   bwdif
       Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver Deinterlacing Filter").

       Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic interpolation algorithms.
       It accepts the following parameters:

       mode
           The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:

           0, send_frame
               Output one frame for each frame.

           1, send_field
               Output one frame for each field.

           The default value is "send_field".

       parity
           The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one of the following
           values:

           0, tff
               Assume the top field is first.

           1, bff
               Assume the bottom field is first.

           -1, auto
               Enable automatic detection of field parity.

           The default value is "auto".  If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this
           information, top field first will be assumed.

       deint
           Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:

           0, all
               Deinterlace all frames.

           1, interlaced
               Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.

           The default value is "all".

   bwdif_cuda
       Deinterlace the input video using the bwdif algorithm, but implemented in CUDA so that it can work as
       part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec and/or nvenc.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       mode
           The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:

           0, send_frame
               Output one frame for each frame.

           1, send_field
               Output one frame for each field.

           The default value is "send_field".

       parity
           The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one of the following
           values:

           0, tff
               Assume the top field is first.

           1, bff
               Assume the bottom field is first.

           -1, auto
               Enable automatic detection of field parity.

           The default value is "auto".  If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this
           information, top field first will be assumed.

       deint
           Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:

           0, all
               Deinterlace all frames.

           1, interlaced
               Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.

           The default value is "all".

   ccrepack
       Repack CEA-708 closed captioning side data

       This filter fixes various issues seen with commerical encoders related to upstream malformed CEA-708
       payloads, specifically incorrect number of tuples (wrong cc_count for the target FPS), and incorrect
       ordering of tuples (i.e. the CEA-608 tuples are not at the first entries in the payload).

   cas
       Apply Contrast Adaptive Sharpen filter to video stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       strength
           Set the sharpening strength. Default value is 0.

       planes
           Set planes to filter. Default value is to filter all planes except alpha plane.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   chromahold
       Remove all color information for all colors except for certain one.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       color
           The color which will not be replaced with neutral chroma.

       similarity
           Similarity percentage with the above color.  0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches
           everything.

       blend
           Blend percentage.  0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.  Higher values result in
           more preserved color.

       yuv Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.

           Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.  This can be used to
           pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   chromakey
       YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       color
           The color which will be replaced with transparency.

       similarity
           Similarity percentage with the key color.

           0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.

       blend
           Blend percentage.

           0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.

           Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency the more similar the
           pixels color is to the key color.

       yuv Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.

           Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.  This can be used to
           pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

       Examples

       •   Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:

                   ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png

       •   Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.

                   ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv

   chromakey_cuda
       CUDA accelerated YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.

       This filter works like normal chromakey filter but operates on CUDA frames.  for more details and
       parameters see chromakey.

       Examples

       •   Make all the green pixels in the input video transparent and use it as an overlay for another video:

                   ./ffmpeg \
                       -hwaccel cuda -hwaccel_output_format cuda -i input_green.mp4  \
                       -hwaccel cuda -hwaccel_output_format cuda -i base_video.mp4 \
                       -init_hw_device cuda \
                       -filter_complex \
                       " \
                           [0:v]chromakey_cuda=0x25302D:0.1:0.12:1[overlay_video]; \
                           [1:v]scale_cuda=format=yuv420p[base]; \
                           [base][overlay_video]overlay_cuda" \
                       -an -sn -c:v h264_nvenc -cq 20 output.mp4

       •   Process two software sources, explicitly uploading the frames:

                   ./ffmpeg -init_hw_device cuda=cuda -filter_hw_device cuda \
                       -f lavfi -i color=size=800x600:color=white,format=yuv420p \
                       -f lavfi -i yuvtestsrc=size=200x200,format=yuv420p \
                       -filter_complex \
                       " \
                           [0]hwupload[under]; \
                           [1]hwupload,chromakey_cuda=green:0.1:0.12[over]; \
                           [under][over]overlay_cuda" \
                       -c:v hevc_nvenc -cq 18 -preset slow output.mp4

   chromanr
       Reduce chrominance noise.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       thres
           Set threshold for averaging chrominance values.  Sum of absolute difference of Y, U and V pixel
           components of current pixel and neighbour pixels lower than this threshold will be used in averaging.
           Luma component is left unchanged and is copied to output.  Default value is 30. Allowed range is from
           1 to 200.

       sizew
           Set horizontal radius of rectangle used for averaging.  Allowed range is from 1 to 100. Default value
           is 5.

       sizeh
           Set vertical radius of rectangle used for averaging.  Allowed range is from 1 to 100. Default value
           is 5.

       stepw
           Set horizontal step when averaging. Default value is 1.  Allowed range is from 1 to 50.  Mostly
           useful to speed-up filtering.

       steph
           Set vertical step when averaging. Default value is 1.  Allowed range is from 1 to 50.  Mostly useful
           to speed-up filtering.

       threy
           Set Y threshold for averaging chrominance values.  Set finer control for max allowed difference
           between Y components of current pixel and neigbour pixels.  Default value is 200. Allowed range is
           from 1 to 200.

       threu
           Set U threshold for averaging chrominance values.  Set finer control for max allowed difference
           between U components of current pixel and neigbour pixels.  Default value is 200. Allowed range is
           from 1 to 200.

       threv
           Set V threshold for averaging chrominance values.  Set finer control for max allowed difference
           between V components of current pixel and neigbour pixels.  Default value is 200. Allowed range is
           from 1 to 200.

       distance
           Set distance type used in calculations.

           manhattan
               Absolute difference.

           euclidean
               Difference squared.

           Default distance type is manhattan.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

   chromashift
       Shift chroma pixels horizontally and/or vertically.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       cbh Set amount to shift chroma-blue horizontally.

       cbv Set amount to shift chroma-blue vertically.

       crh Set amount to shift chroma-red horizontally.

       crv Set amount to shift chroma-red vertically.

       edge
           Set edge mode, can be smear, default, or warp.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   ciescope
       Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       system
           Set color system.

           ntsc, 470m
           ebu, 470bg
           smpte
           240m
           apple
           widergb
           cie1931
           rec709, hdtv
           uhdtv, rec2020
           dcip3
       cie Set CIE system.

           xyy
           ucs
           luv
       gamuts
           Set what gamuts to draw.

           See "system" option for available values.

       size, s
           Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.

       intensity, i
           Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.

       contrast
           Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.

       corrgamma
           Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.

       showwhite
           Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.

       gamma
           Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.

       fill
           Fill with CIE colors. By default is enabled.

   codecview
       Visualize information exported by some codecs.

       Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other means. For example, some MPEG
       based codecs export motion vectors through the export_mvs flag in the codec flags2 option.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       block
           Display block partition structure using the luma plane.

       mv  Set motion vectors to visualize.

           Available flags for mv are:

           pf  forward predicted MVs of P-frames

           bf  forward predicted MVs of B-frames

           bb  backward predicted MVs of B-frames

       qp  Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.

       mv_type, mvt
           Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by frame_type
           option.

           Available flags for mv_type are:

           fp  forward predicted MVs

           bp  backward predicted MVs

       frame_type, ft
           Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.

           Available flags for frame_type are:

           if  intra-coded frames (I-frames)

           pf  predicted frames (P-frames)

           bf  bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)

       Examples

       •   Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using ffplay:

                   ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp

       •   Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using ffplay:

                   ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb

   colorbalance
       Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.

       The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights regions for the
       red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.

       A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative value towards the
       complementary color.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       rs
       gs
       bs  Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).

       rm
       gm
       bm  Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).

       rh
       gh
       bh  Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).

           Allowed ranges for options are "[-1.0, 1.0]". Defaults are 0.

       pl  Preserve lightness when changing color balance. Default is disabled.

       Examples

       •   Add red color cast to shadows:

                   colorbalance=rs=.3

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   colorcontrast
       Adjust color contrast between RGB components.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       rc  Set the red-cyan contrast. Defaults is 0.0. Allowed range is from -1.0 to 1.0.

       gm  Set the green-magenta contrast. Defaults is 0.0. Allowed range is from -1.0 to 1.0.

       by  Set the blue-yellow contrast. Defaults is 0.0. Allowed range is from -1.0 to 1.0.

       rcw
       gmw
       byw Set the weight of each "rc", "gm", "by" option value. Default value is 0.0.  Allowed range is from
           0.0 to 1.0. If all weights are 0.0 filtering is disabled.

       pl  Set the amount of preserving lightness. Default value is 0.0. Allowed range is from 0.0 to 1.0.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   colorcorrect
       Adjust color white balance selectively for blacks and whites.  This filter operates in YUV colorspace.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       rl  Set the red shadow spot. Allowed range is from -1.0 to 1.0.  Default value is 0.

       bl  Set the blue shadow spot. Allowed range is from -1.0 to 1.0.  Default value is 0.

       rh  Set the red highlight spot. Allowed range is from -1.0 to 1.0.  Default value is 0.

       bh  Set the blue highlight spot. Allowed range is from -1.0 to 1.0.  Default value is 0.

       saturation
           Set the amount of saturation. Allowed range is from -3.0 to 3.0.  Default value is 1.

       analyze
           If set to anything other than "manual" it will analyze every frame and use derived parameters for
           filtering output frame.

           Possible values are:

           manual
           average
           minmax
           median

           Default value is "manual".

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   colorchannelmixer
       Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.

       This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to the other channels of the same
       pixels. For example if the value to modify is red, the output value will be:

               <red>=<red>*<rr> + <blue>*<rb> + <green>*<rg> + <alpha>*<ra>

       The filter accepts the following options:

       rr
       rg
       rb
       ra  Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.  Default is
           1 for rr, and 0 for rg, rb and ra.

       gr
       gg
       gb
       ga  Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.  Default
           is 1 for gg, and 0 for gr, gb and ga.

       br
       bg
       bb
       ba  Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.  Default is
           1 for bb, and 0 for br, bg and ba.

       ar
       ag
       ab
       aa  Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.  Default
           is 1 for aa, and 0 for ar, ag and ab.

           Allowed ranges for options are "[-2.0, 2.0]".

       pc  Set preserve color mode. The accepted values are:

           none
               Disable color preserving, this is default.

           lum Preserve luminance.

           max Preserve max value of RGB triplet.

           avg Preserve average value of RGB triplet.

           sum Preserve sum value of RGB triplet.

           nrm Preserve normalized value of RGB triplet.

           pwr Preserve power value of RGB triplet.

       pa  Set the preserve color amount when changing colors. Allowed range is from "[0.0, 1.0]".  Default is
           0.0, thus disabled.

       Examples

       •   Convert source to grayscale:

                   colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3

       •   Simulate sepia tones:

                   colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   colorize
       Overlay a solid color on the video stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       hue Set the color hue. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.  Default value is 0.

       saturation
           Set the color saturation. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is 0.5.

       lightness
           Set the color lightness. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is 0.5.

       mix Set the mix of source lightness. By default is set to 1.0.  Allowed range is from 0.0 to 1.0.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   colorkey
       RGB colorspace color keying.  This filter operates on 8-bit RGB format frames by setting the alpha
       component of each pixel which falls within the similarity radius of the key color to 0. The alpha value
       for pixels outside the similarity radius depends on the value of the blend option.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       color
           Set the color for which alpha will be set to 0 (full transparency).  See "Color" section in the
           ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default is "black".

       similarity
           Set the radius from the key color within which other colors also have full transparency.  The
           computed distance is related to the unit fractional distance in 3D space between the RGB values of
           the key color and the pixel's color. Range is 0.01 to 1.0. 0.01 matches within a very small radius
           around the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.  Default is 0.01.

       blend
           Set how the alpha value for pixels that fall outside the similarity radius is computed.  0.0 makes
           pixels either fully transparent or fully opaque.  Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels,
           with greater transparency the more similar the pixel color is to the key color.  Range is 0.0 to 1.0.
           Default is 0.0.

       Examples

       •   Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:

                   ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png

       •   Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.

                   ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   colorhold
       Remove all color information for all RGB colors except for certain one.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       color
           The color which will not be replaced with neutral gray.

       similarity
           Similarity percentage with the above color.  0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches
           everything.

       blend
           Blend percentage. 0.0 makes pixels fully gray.  Higher values result in more preserved color.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   colorlevels
       Adjust video input frames using levels.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       rimin
       gimin
       bimin
       aimin
           Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.  Allowed ranges for options are "[-1.0, 1.0]".
           Defaults are 0.

       rimax
       gimax
       bimax
       aimax
           Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.  Allowed ranges for options are "[-1.0, 1.0]".
           Defaults are 1.

           Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows (dark tones), change the
           balance of bright and dark tones.

       romin
       gomin
       bomin
       aomin
           Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.  Allowed ranges for options are "[0, 1.0]".
           Defaults are 0.

       romax
       gomax
       bomax
       aomax
           Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.  Allowed ranges for options are "[0, 1.0]".
           Defaults are 1.

           Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.

       preserve
           Set preserve color mode. The accepted values are:

           none
               Disable color preserving, this is default.

           lum Preserve luminance.

           max Preserve max value of RGB triplet.

           avg Preserve average value of RGB triplet.

           sum Preserve sum value of RGB triplet.

           nrm Preserve normalized value of RGB triplet.

           pwr Preserve power value of RGB triplet.

       Examples

       •   Make video output darker:

                   colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058

       •   Increase contrast:

                   colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96

       •   Make video output lighter:

                   colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902

       •   Increase brightness:

                   colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   colormap
       Apply custom color maps to video stream.

       This filter needs three input video streams.  First stream is video stream that is going to be filtered
       out.  Second and third video stream specify color patches for source color to target color mapping.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       patch_size
           Set the source and target video stream patch size in pixels.

       nb_patches
           Set the max number of used patches from source and target video stream.  Default value is number of
           patches available in additional video streams.  Max allowed number of patches is 64.

       type
           Set the adjustments used for target colors. Can be "relative" or "absolute".  Defaults is "absolute".

       kernel
           Set the kernel used to measure color differences between mapped colors.

           The accepted values are:

           euclidean
           weuclidean

           Default is "euclidean".

   colormatrix
       Convert color matrix.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       src
       dst Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be specified.

           The accepted values are:

           bt709
               BT.709

           fcc FCC

           bt601
               BT.601

           bt470
               BT.470

           bt470bg
               BT.470BG

           smpte170m
               SMPTE-170M

           smpte240m
               SMPTE-240M

           bt2020
               BT.2020

       For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:

               colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m

   colorspace
       Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.  Input video needs to have an even size.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       all Specify all color properties at once.

           The accepted values are:

           bt470m
               BT.470M

           bt470bg
               BT.470BG

           bt601-6-525
               BT.601-6 525

           bt601-6-625
               BT.601-6 625

           bt709
               BT.709

           smpte170m
               SMPTE-170M

           smpte240m
               SMPTE-240M

           bt2020
               BT.2020

       space
           Specify output colorspace.

           The accepted values are:

           bt709
               BT.709

           fcc FCC

           bt470bg
               BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625

           smpte170m
               SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525

           smpte240m
               SMPTE-240M

           ycgco
               YCgCo

           bt2020ncl
               BT.2020 with non-constant luminance

       trc Specify output transfer characteristics.

           The accepted values are:

           bt709
               BT.709

           bt470m
               BT.470M

           bt470bg
               BT.470BG

           gamma22
               Constant gamma of 2.2

           gamma28
               Constant gamma of 2.8

           smpte170m
               SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525

           smpte240m
               SMPTE-240M

           srgb
               SRGB

           iec61966-2-1
               iec61966-2-1

           iec61966-2-4
               iec61966-2-4

           xvycc
               xvycc

           bt2020-10
               BT.2020 for 10-bits content

           bt2020-12
               BT.2020 for 12-bits content

       primaries
           Specify output color primaries.

           The accepted values are:

           bt709
               BT.709

           bt470m
               BT.470M

           bt470bg
               BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625

           smpte170m
               SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525

           smpte240m
               SMPTE-240M

           film
               film

           smpte431
               SMPTE-431

           smpte432
               SMPTE-432

           bt2020
               BT.2020

           jedec-p22
               JEDEC P22 phosphors

       range
           Specify output color range.

           The accepted values are:

           tv  TV (restricted) range

           mpeg
               MPEG (restricted) range

           pc  PC (full) range

           jpeg
               JPEG (full) range

       format
           Specify output color format.

           The accepted values are:

           yuv420p
               YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits

           yuv420p10
               YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits

           yuv420p12
               YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits

           yuv422p
               YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits

           yuv422p10
               YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits

           yuv422p12
               YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits

           yuv444p
               YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits

           yuv444p10
               YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits

           yuv444p12
               YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits

       fast
           Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take significantly less CPU,
           but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output compatible with that produced by the colormatrix
           filter, use fast=1.

       dither
           Specify dithering mode.

           The accepted values are:

           none
               No dithering

           fsb Floyd-Steinberg dithering

       wpadapt
           Whitepoint adaptation mode.

           The accepted values are:

           bradford
               Bradford whitepoint adaptation

           vonkries
               von Kries whitepoint adaptation

           identity
               identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)

       iall
           Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as all.

       ispace
           Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as space.

       iprimaries
           Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as primaries.

       itrc
           Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as trc.

       irange
           Override input color range. Same accepted values as range.

       The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color primaries to the specified user
       values. The output value, if not specified, is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If
       that property is also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and format
       default to the same value as the input color range and format. The input transfer characteristics, color
       space, color primaries and color range should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the
       filter will log an error and no conversion will take place.

       For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:

               colorspace=smpte240m

   colorspace_cuda
       CUDA accelerated implementation of the colorspace filter.

       It is by no means feature complete compared to the software colorspace filter, and at the current time
       only supports color range conversion between jpeg/full and mpeg/limited range.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       range
           Specify output color range.

           The accepted values are:

           tv  TV (restricted) range

           mpeg
               MPEG (restricted) range

           pc  PC (full) range

           jpeg
               JPEG (full) range

   colortemperature
       Adjust color temperature in video to simulate variations in ambient color temperature.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       temperature
           Set the temperature in Kelvin. Allowed range is from 1000 to 40000.  Default value is 6500 K.

       mix Set mixing with filtered output. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is 1.

       pl  Set the amount of preserving lightness. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is 0.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   convolution
       Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 or horizontal/vertical up to 49 elements.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       0m
       1m
       2m
       3m  Set matrix for each plane.  Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed integers in square mode, and
           from 1 to 49 odd number of signed integers in row mode.

       0rdiv
       1rdiv
       2rdiv
       3rdiv
           Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.  If unset or 0, it will be 1/sum of all matrix
           elements.

       0bias
       1bias
       2bias
       3bias
           Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.  Useful for making
           the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.

       0mode
       1mode
       2mode
       3mode
           Set matrix mode for each plane. Can be square, row or column.  Default is square.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Apply sharpen:

                   convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"

       •   Apply blur:

                   convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"

       •   Apply edge enhance:

                   convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"

       •   Apply edge detect:

                   convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"

       •   Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:

                   convolution="1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0"

       •   Apply emboss:

                   convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"

   convolve
       Apply 2D convolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream as impulse.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       planes
           Set which planes to process.

       impulse
           Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be first or all. Default is all.

       The "convolve" filter also supports the framesync options.

   copy
       Copy the input video source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for testing purposes.

   coreimage
       Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.

       Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is processed by video
       hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations exist which means there is no guarantee for
       hardware processing. It depends on the respective OSX.

       There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a large variety of options.
       The filter has to be referenced by its name along with its options.

       The coreimage filter accepts the following options:

       list_filters
           List all available filters and generators along with all their respective options as well as possible
           minimum and maximum values along with the default values.

                   list_filters=true

       filter
           Specify all filters by their respective name and options.  Use list_filters to determine all valid
           filter names and options.  Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically
           clamped to their respective value range.  Vector and color options have to be specified by a list of
           space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.  A special option name "default" is
           available to use default options for a filter.

           It is required to specify either "default" or at least one of the filter options.  All omitted
           options are used with their default values.  The syntax of the filter string is as follows:

                   filter=<NAME>@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@...][#<NAME>@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@...]][#...]

       output_rect
           Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the input image. It is given
           by a list of space separated float values:

                   output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height

           If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.  The output rectangle is
           automatically cropped at the borders of the input image. Negative values are valid for each
           component.

                   output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100

       Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST transfers allowing for fast
       processing of complex filter chains.  Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one
       (filters) input image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet usable as
       intended.

       Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the respective filter kernel.
       The padding is automatically removed to ensure the filter output has the same size as the input image.

       For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the previous output image of the
       filter chain or the input image of the whole filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the
       pixel information of this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is blended onto
       this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the output image.

       The coreimagesrc video source can be used for generating input images which are directly fed into the
       filter chain. By using it, providing input images by another video source or an input video is not
       required.

       Examples

       •   List all filters available:

                   coreimage=list_filters=true

       •   Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:

                   coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@default

       •   Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with its center at 100x100
           and a radius of 50 pixels:

                   coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@default#CIVignetteEffect@inputCenter=100\ 100@inputRadius=50

       •   Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage, given as complete and
           escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:

                   ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png

   corr
       Obtain the correlation between two input videos.

       This filter takes two input videos.

       Both input videos must have the same resolution and pixel format for this filter to work correctly. Also
       it assumes that both inputs have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.

       The obtained per component, average, min and max correlation is printed through the logging system.

       The filter stores the calculated correlation of each frame in frame metadata.

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

       In the below example the input file main.mpg being processed is compared with the reference file ref.mpg.

               ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi corr -f null -

   cover_rect
       Cover a rectangular object

       It accepts the following options:

       cover
           Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.

       mode
           Set covering mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           cover
               cover it by the supplied image

           blur
               cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels

           Default value is blur.

       Examples

       •   Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv

   crop
       Crop the input video to given dimensions.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       w, out_w
           The width of the output video. It defaults to "iw".  This expression is evaluated only once during
           the filter configuration, or when the w or out_w command is sent.

       h, out_h
           The height of the output video. It defaults to "ih".  This expression is evaluated only once during
           the filter configuration, or when the h or out_h command is sent.

       x   The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output video. It defaults to
           "(in_w-out_w)/2".  This expression is evaluated per-frame.

       y   The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.  It defaults to
           "(in_h-out_h)/2".  This expression is evaluated per-frame.

       keep_aspect
           If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio to be the same of the input, by changing the
           output sample aspect ratio. It defaults to 0.

       exact
           Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact width/height/x/y as
           specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.  It defaults to 0.

       The out_w, out_h, x, y parameters are expressions containing the following constants:

       x
       y   The computed values for x and y. They are evaluated for each new frame.

       in_w
       in_h
           The input width and height.

       iw
       ih  These are the same as in_w and in_h.

       out_w
       out_h
           The output (cropped) width and height.

       ow
       oh  These are the same as out_w and out_h.

       a   same as iw / ih

       sar input sample aspect ratio

       dar input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (iw / ih) * sar

       hsub
       vsub
           horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" hsub is 2
           and vsub is 1.

       n   The number of the input frame, starting from 0.

       pos the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown; deprecated, do not use

       t   The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.

       The expression for out_w may depend on the value of out_h, and the expression for out_h may depend on
       out_w, but they cannot depend on x and y, as x and y are evaluated after out_w and out_h.

       The x and y parameters specify the expressions for the position of the top-left corner of the output
       (non-cropped) area. They are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it is
       approximated to the nearest valid value.

       The expression for x may depend on y, and the expression for y may depend on x.

       Examples

       •   Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).

                   crop=100:100:12:34

           Using named options, the example above becomes:

                   crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34

       •   Crop the central input area with size 100x100:

                   crop=100:100

       •   Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:

                   crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h

       •   Crop the input video central square:

                   crop=out_w=in_h
                   crop=in_h

       •   Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position 100:100 and the right-bottom corner
           corresponding to the right-bottom corner of the input image.

                   crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100

       •   Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from the top and bottom borders

                   crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20

       •   Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:

                   crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2

       •   Crop height for getting Greek harmony:

                   crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w

       •   Apply trembling effect:

                   crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)

       •   Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:

                   crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)

       •   Set x depending on the value of y:

                   crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       w, out_w
       h, out_h
       x
       y   Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position in the input video.  The
           command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.

           If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   cropdetect
       Auto-detect the crop size.

       It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the recommended parameters via the logging
       system. The detected dimensions correspond to the non-black or video area of the input video according to
       mode.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       mode
           Depending on mode crop detection is based on either the mere black value of surrounding pixels or a
           combination of motion vectors and edge pixels.

           black
               Detect black pixels surrounding the playing video. For fine control use option limit.

           mvedges
               Detect the playing video by the motion vectors inside the video and scanning for edge pixels
               typically forming the border of a playing video.

       limit
           Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified from nothing (0) to everything
           (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity value greater to the set value is considered non-black.
           It defaults to 24.  You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
           on the bitdepth of the pixel format.

       round
           The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to 16. The offset is
           automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2
           video). 16 is best when encoding to most video codecs.

       skip
           Set the number of initial frames for which evaluation is skipped.  Default is 2. Range is 0 to
           INT_MAX.

       reset_count, reset
           Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will reset the previously detected
           largest video area and start over to detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.

           This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0 indicates 'never reset', and returns
           the largest area encountered during playback.

       mv_threshold
           Set motion in pixel units as threshold for motion detection. It defaults to 8.

       low
       high
           Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding algorithm.

           The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then connected through 8-connectivity
           with the "weak" edge pixels selected by the low threshold.

           low and high threshold values must be chosen in the range [0,1], and low should be lesser or equal to
           high.

           Default value for low is "5/255", and default value for high is "15/255".

       Examples

       •   Find video area surrounded by black borders:

                   ffmpeg -i file.mp4 -vf cropdetect,metadata=mode=print -f null -

       •   Find an embedded video area, generate motion vectors beforehand:

                   ffmpeg -i file.mp4 -vf mestimate,cropdetect=mode=mvedges,metadata=mode=print -f null -

       •   Find an embedded video area, use motion vectors from decoder:

                   ffmpeg -flags2 +export_mvs -i file.mp4 -vf cropdetect=mode=mvedges,metadata=mode=print -f null -

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       limit
           The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.  If the specified expression is not
           valid, it is kept at its current value.

   cue
       Delay video filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. The filter first passes on preroll amount of
       frames, then it buffers at most buffer amount of frames and waits for the cue. After reaching the cue it
       forwards the buffered frames and also any subsequent frames coming in its input.

       The filter can be used synchronize the output of multiple ffmpeg processes for realtime output devices
       like decklink. By putting the delay in the filtering chain and pre-buffering frames the process can pass
       on data to output almost immediately after the target wallclock timestamp is reached.

       Perfect frame accuracy cannot be guaranteed, but the result is good enough for some use cases.

       cue The cue timestamp expressed in a UNIX timestamp in microseconds. Default is 0.

       preroll
           The duration of content to pass on as preroll expressed in seconds. Default is 0.

       buffer
           The maximum duration of content to buffer before waiting for the cue expressed in seconds. Default is
           0.

   curves
       Apply color adjustments using curves.

       This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each component (red, green and blue)
       has its values defined by N key points tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents
       the pixel values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for the output
       frame.

       By default, a component curve is defined by the two points (0;0) and (1;1). This creates a straight line
       where each original pixel value is "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.

       The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new curve will be define to pass
       smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be strictly increasing over
       the x-axis, and their x and y values must be in the [0;1] interval. The curve is formed by using a
       natural or monotonic cubic spline interpolation, depending on the interp option (default: "natural"). The
       "natural" spline produces a smoother curve in general while the monotonic ("pchip") spline guarantees the
       transitions between the specified points to be monotonic. If the computed curves happened to go outside
       the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       preset
           Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition to the r, g, b
           parameters; in this case, the later options takes priority on the preset values.  Available presets
           are:

           none
           color_negative
           cross_process
           darker
           increase_contrast
           lighter
           linear_contrast
           medium_contrast
           negative
           strong_contrast
           vintage

           Default is "none".

       master, m
           Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It is sometimes called a
           "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with r, g, b or all since it acts like a post-
           processing LUT.

       red, r
           Set the key points for the red component.

       green, g
           Set the key points for the green component.

       blue, b
           Set the key points for the blue component.

       all Set the key points for all components (not including master).  Can be used in addition to the other
           key points component options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this all setting.

       psfile
           Specify a Photoshop curves file (".acv") to import the settings from.

       plot
           Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.

       interp
           Specify the kind of interpolation. Available algorithms are:

           natural
               Natural cubic spline using a piece-wise cubic polynomial that is twice continuously
               differentiable.

           pchip
               Monotonic cubic spline using a piecewise cubic Hermite interpolating polynomial (PCHIP).

       To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be defined using the following
       syntax: "x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...".

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

       Examples

       •   Increase slightly the middle level of blue:

                   curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'

       •   Vintage effect:

                   curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'

           Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:

           red "(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)"

           green
               "(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)"

           blue
               "(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)"

       •   The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:

                   curves=preset=vintage

       •   Or simply:

                   curves=vintage

       •   Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:

                   curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'

       •   Check out the curves of the "cross_process" profile using ffmpeg and gnuplot:

                   ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
                   gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt

   datascope
       Video data analysis filter.

       This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Set output video size.

       x   Set x offset from where to pick pixels.

       y   Set y offset from where to pick pixels.

       mode
           Set scope mode, can be one of the following:

           mono
               Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.

           color
               Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black background.

           color2
               Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video, the text color is
               picked in such way so its always visible.

       axis
           Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.

       opacity
           Set background opacity.

       format
           Set display number format. Can be "hex", or "dec". Default is "hex".

       components
           Set pixel components to display. By default all pixel components are displayed.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options excluding "size" option.

   dblur
       Apply Directional blur filter.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       angle
           Set angle of directional blur. Default is 45.

       radius
           Set radius of directional blur. Default is 5.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   dctdnoiz
       Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).

       This filter is not designed for real time.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sigma, s
           Set the noise sigma constant.

           This sigma defines a hard threshold of "3 * sigma"; every DCT coefficient (absolute value) below this
           threshold with be dropped.

           If you need a more advanced filtering, see expr.

           Default is 0.

       overlap
           Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you may want to reduce
           this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the risk of various artefacts.

           If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or height, a warning will be
           displayed and according borders won't be denoised.

           Default value is blocksize-1, which is the best possible setting.

       expr, e
           Set the coefficient factor expression.

           For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a multiplier value for the
           coefficient.

           If this is option is set, the sigma option will be ignored.

           The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the c variable.

       n   Set the blocksize using the number of bits. "1<<n" defines the blocksize, which is the width and
           height of the processed blocks.

           The default value is 3 (8x8) and can be raised to 4 for a blocksize of 16x16. Note that changing this
           setting has huge consequences on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily
           means a better de-noising.

       Examples

       Apply a denoise with a sigma of 4.5:

               dctdnoiz=4.5

       The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:

               dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'

       Violent denoise using a block size of "16x16":

               dctdnoiz=15:n=4

   deband
       Remove banding artifacts from input video.  It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of
       referenced pixels.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       1thr
       2thr
       3thr
       4thr
           Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.  Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.  If
           difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold, it will be considered as
           banded.

       range, r
           Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number in range 0 to set value
           will be used. If negative, exact absolute value will be used.  The range defines square of four
           pixels around current pixel.

       direction, d
           Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive, random direction from 0
           to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of absolute value will be picked. For example
           direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels
           on same column.

       blur, b
           If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four surrounding pixels. The default
           is enabled. If disabled current pixel is compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is
           considered banded if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.

       coupling, c
           If enabled, current pixel is changed if and only if all pixel components are banded, e.g. banding
           detection threshold is triggered for all color components.  The default is disabled.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   deblock
       Remove blocking artifacts from input video.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       filter
           Set filter type, can be weak or strong. Default is strong.  This controls what kind of deblocking is
           applied.

       block
           Set size of block, allowed range is from 4 to 512. Default is 8.

       alpha
       beta
       gamma
       delta
           Set blocking detection thresholds. Allowed range is 0 to 1.  Defaults are: 0.098 for alpha and 0.05
           for the rest.  Using higher threshold gives more deblocking strength.  Setting alpha controls
           threshold detection at exact edge of block.  Remaining options controls threshold detection near the
           edge. Each one for below/above or left/right. Setting any of those to 0 disables deblocking.

       planes
           Set planes to filter. Default is to filter all available planes.

       Examples

       •   Deblock using weak filter and block size of 4 pixels.

                   deblock=filter=weak:block=4

       •   Deblock using strong filter, block size of 4 pixels and custom thresholds for deblocking more edges.

                   deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05

       •   Similar as above, but filter only first plane.

                   deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=1

       •   Similar as above, but filter only second and third plane.

                   deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=6

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   decimate
       Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       cycle
           Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to N means one frame in every
           batch of N frames will be dropped.  Default is 5.

       dupthresh
           Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame is less than or equal
           to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default is 1.1

       scthresh
           Set scene change threshold. Default is 15.

       blockx
       blocky
           Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.  Larger blocks give better
           noise suppression, but also give worse detection of small movements. Must be a power of two. Default
           is 32.

       ppsrc
           Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input stream. This allows the
           input to be pre-processed with various filters to help the metrics calculation while keeping the
           frame selection lossless. When set to 1, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the
           second stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is 0.

       chroma
           Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is 1.

       mixed
           Set whether or not the input only partially contains content to be decimated.  Default is "false".
           If enabled video output stream will be in variable frame rate.

   deconvolve
       Apply 2D deconvolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream as impulse.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       planes
           Set which planes to process.

       impulse
           Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be first or all. Default is all.

       noise
           Set noise when doing divisions. Default is 0.0000001. Useful when width and height are not same and
           not power of 2 or if stream prior to convolving had noise.

       The "deconvolve" filter also supports the framesync options.

   dedot
       Reduce cross-luminance (dot-crawl) and cross-color (rainbows) from video.

       It accepts the following options:

       m   Set mode of operation. Can be combination of dotcrawl for cross-luminance reduction and/or rainbows
           for cross-color reduction.

       lt  Set spatial luma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-luminance.

       tl  Set tolerance for temporal luma. Higher values increases reduction of cross-luminance.

       tc  Set tolerance for chroma temporal variation. Higher values increases reduction of cross-color.

       ct  Set temporal chroma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-color.

   deflate
       Apply deflate effect to the video.

       This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account only values lower than
       the pixel.

       It accepts the following options:

       threshold0
       threshold1
       threshold2
       threshold3
           Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.  If 0, plane will remain unchanged.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   deflicker
       Remove temporal frame luminance variations.

       It accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Set moving-average filter size in frames. Default is 5. Allowed range is 2 - 129.

       mode, m
           Set averaging mode to smooth temporal luminance variations.

           Available values are:

           am  Arithmetic mean

           gm  Geometric mean

           hm  Harmonic mean

           qm  Quadratic mean

           cm  Cubic mean

           pm  Power mean

           median
               Median

       bypass
           Do not actually modify frame. Useful when one only wants metadata.

   dejudder
       Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.

       Judder can be introduced, for instance, by pullup filter. If the original source was partially telecined
       content then the output of "pullup,dejudder" will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded
       frame rate of the container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame rate
       video.

       The option available in this filter is:

       cycle
           Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.

           Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:

           4   If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).

           5   If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).

           20  If a mixture of the two.

           The default is 4.

   delogo
       Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding pixels. Just set a rectangle
       covering the logo and watch it disappear (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may
       vary).

       It accepts the following parameters:

       x
       y   Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be specified.

       w
       h   Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be specified.

       show
           When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify finding the right x, y, w, and h
           parameters.  The default value is 0.

           The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly) replaced with interpolated
           values. The values of the next pixels immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be
           used to compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.

       Examples

       •   Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0 and size 100x77:

                   delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77

   derain
       Remove the rain in the input image/video by applying the derain methods based on convolutional neural
       networks. Supported models:

       •   Recurrent Squeeze-and-Excitation Context Aggregation Net (RESCAN).  See
           <http://openaccess.thecvf.com/content_ECCV_2018/papers/Xia_Li_Recurrent_Squeeze-and-Excitation_Context_ECCV_2018_paper.pdf>.

       Training as well as model generation scripts are provided in the repository at
       <https://github.com/XueweiMeng/derain_filter.git>.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       filter_type
           Specify which filter to use. This option accepts the following values:

           derain
               Derain filter. To conduct derain filter, you need to use a derain model.

           dehaze
               Dehaze filter. To conduct dehaze filter, you need to use a dehaze model.

           Default value is derain.

       dnn_backend
           Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts the following
           values:

           tensorflow
               TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
               <https://www.tensorflow.org/install/lang_c>) and configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libtensorflow"

       model
           Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.  Note that different
           backends use different file formats. TensorFlow can load files for only its format.

       To get full functionality (such as async execution), please use the dnn_processing filter.

   deshake
       Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This filter helps remove camera shake
       from hand-holding a camera, bumping a tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       x
       y
       w
       h   Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion vectors.  If desired the search for
           motion vectors can be limited to a rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner,
           width and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox filter which can be used to
           visualise the position of the bounding box.

           This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame might be confused for camera
           motion by the motion vector search.

           If any or all of x, y, w and h are set to -1 then the full frame is used. This allows later options
           to be set without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.

           Default - search the whole frame.

       rx
       ry  Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.

       edge
           Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the frame. Available values are:

           blank, 0
               Fill zeroes at blank locations

           original, 1
               Original image at blank locations

           clamp, 2
               Extruded edge value at blank locations

           mirror, 3
               Mirrored edge at blank locations

           Default value is mirror.

       blocksize
           Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels, default 8.

       contrast
           Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than the specified contrast
           (difference between darkest and lightest pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.

       search
           Specify the search strategy. Available values are:

           exhaustive, 0
               Set exhaustive search

           less, 1
               Set less exhaustive search.

           Default value is exhaustive.

       filename
           If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the specified file.

   despill
       Remove unwanted contamination of foreground colors, caused by reflected color of greenscreen or
       bluescreen.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       type
           Set what type of despill to use.

       mix Set how spillmap will be generated.

       expand
           Set how much to get rid of still remaining spill.

       red Controls amount of red in spill area.

       green
           Controls amount of green in spill area.  Should be -1 for greenscreen.

       blue
           Controls amount of blue in spill area.  Should be -1 for bluescreen.

       brightness
           Controls brightness of spill area, preserving colors.

       alpha
           Modify alpha from generated spillmap.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   detelecine
       Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined pattern specified using the
       pattern option which must be the same as that passed to the telecine filter.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       first_field
           top, t
               top field first

           bottom, b
               bottom field first The default value is "top".

       pattern
           A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.  The default value is 23.

       start_frame
           A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine pattern. This is to be
           used if the stream is cut. The default value is 0.

   dilation
       Apply dilation effect to the video.

       This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.

       It accepts the following options:

       threshold0
       threshold1
       threshold2
       threshold3
           Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.  If 0, plane will remain unchanged.

       coordinates
           Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight pixels are used.

           Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:

               1 2 3
               4   5
               6 7 8

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   displace
       Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.

       It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the source, and second and third
       input are displacement maps.

       The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the x-axis, while the third input specifies
       how much to displace pixels along the y-axis.  If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame
       from that displacement map will be used.

       Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       edge
           Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.

           Available values are:

           blank
               Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.

           smear
               Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.

           wrap
               Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.

           mirror
               Out of range pixels will be replaced with mirrored pixels.

           Default is smear.

       Examples

       •   Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT

       •   Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT

   dnn_classify
       Do classification with deep neural networks based on bounding boxes.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       dnn_backend
           Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts only openvino
           now, tensorflow backends will be added.

       model
           Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.  Note that different
           backends use different file formats.

       input
           Set the input name of the dnn network.

       output
           Set the output name of the dnn network.

       confidence
           Set the confidence threshold (default: 0.5).

       labels
           Set path to label file specifying the mapping between label id and name.  Each label name is written
           in one line, tailing spaces and empty lines are skipped.  The first line is the name of label id 0,
           and the second line is the name of label id 1, etc.  The label id is considered as name if the label
           file is not provided.

       backend_configs
           Set the configs to be passed into backend

           For tensorflow backend, you can set its configs with sess_config options, please use
           tools/python/tf_sess_config.py to get the configs for your system.

   dnn_detect
       Do object detection with deep neural networks.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       dnn_backend
           Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts only openvino
           now, tensorflow backends will be added.

       model
           Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.  Note that different
           backends use different file formats.

       input
           Set the input name of the dnn network.

       output
           Set the output name of the dnn network.

       confidence
           Set the confidence threshold (default: 0.5).

       labels
           Set path to label file specifying the mapping between label id and name.  Each label name is written
           in one line, tailing spaces and empty lines are skipped.  The first line is the name of label id 0
           (usually it is 'background'), and the second line is the name of label id 1, etc.  The label id is
           considered as name if the label file is not provided.

       backend_configs
           Set the configs to be passed into backend. To use async execution, set async (default: set).  Roll
           back to sync execution if the backend does not support async.

   dnn_processing
       Do image processing with deep neural networks. It works together with another filter which converts the
       pixel format of the Frame to what the dnn network requires.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       dnn_backend
           Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts the following
           values:

           tensorflow
               TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
               <https://www.tensorflow.org/install/lang_c>) and configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libtensorflow"

           openvino
               OpenVINO backend. To enable this backend you need to build and install the OpenVINO for C library
               (see <https://github.com/openvinotoolkit/openvino/blob/master/build-instruction.md>) and
               configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libopenvino" (--extra-cflags=-I... --extra-ldflags=-L... might be
               needed if the header files and libraries are not installed into system path)

           torch
               Libtorch backend. To enable this backend you need to build and install Libtroch for C++ library.
               Please download cxx11 ABI version (see <https://pytorch.org/get-started/locally>) and configure
               FFmpeg with "--enable-libtorch --extra-cflags=-I/libtorch_root/libtorch/include
               --extra-cflags=-I/libtorch_root/libtorch/include/torch/csrc/api/include
               --extra-ldflags=-L/libtorch_root/libtorch/lib/"

       model
           Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.  Note that different
           backends use different file formats. TensorFlow, OpenVINO and Libtorch backend can load files for
           only its format.

       input
           Set the input name of the dnn network.

       output
           Set the output name of the dnn network.

       backend_configs
           Set the configs to be passed into backend. To use async execution, set async (default: set).  Roll
           back to sync execution if the backend does not support async.

           For tensorflow backend, you can set its configs with sess_config options, please use
           tools/python/tf_sess_config.py to get the configs of TensorFlow backend for your system.

       Examples

       •   Remove rain in rgb24 frame with can.pb (see derain filter):

                   ./ffmpeg -i rain.jpg -vf format=rgb24,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=can.pb:input=x:output=y derain.jpg

       •   Handle the Y channel with srcnn.pb (see sr filter) for frame with yuv420p (planar YUV formats
           supported):

                   ./ffmpeg -i 480p.jpg -vf format=yuv420p,scale=w=iw*2:h=ih*2,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=srcnn.pb:input=x:output=y -y srcnn.jpg

       •   Handle the Y channel with espcn.pb (see sr filter), which changes frame size, for format yuv420p
           (planar YUV formats supported), please use tools/python/tf_sess_config.py to get the configs of
           TensorFlow backend for your system.

                   ./ffmpeg -i 480p.jpg -vf format=yuv420p,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=espcn.pb:input=x:output=y:backend_configs=sess_config=0x10022805320e09cdccccccccccec3f20012a01303801 -y tmp.espcn.jpg

   drawbox
       Draw a colored box on the input image.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       x
       y   The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.

       width, w
       height, h
           The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as the input
           width and height. It defaults to 0.

       color, c
           Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option, check the "Color"
           section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special value "invert" is used, the box edge color is the
           same as the video with inverted luma.

       thickness, t
           The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge.  A value of "fill" will create a filled box.
           Default value is 3.

           See below for the list of accepted constants.

       replace
           Applicable if the input has alpha. With value 1, the pixels of the painted box will overwrite the
           video's color and alpha pixels.  Default is 0, which composites the box onto the input, leaving the
           video's alpha intact.

       The parameters for x, y, w and h and t are expressions containing the following constants:

       dar The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (w / h) * sar.

       hsub
       vsub
           horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" hsub is 2
           and vsub is 1.

       in_h, ih
       in_w, iw
           The input width and height.

       sar The input sample aspect ratio.

       x
       y   The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.

       w
       h   The width and height of the drawn box.

       box_source
           Box source can be set as side_data_detection_bboxes if you want to use box data in detection bboxes
           of side data.

           If box_source is set, the x, y, width and height will be ignored and still use box data in detection
           bboxes of side data. So please do not use this parameter if you were not sure about the box source.

       t   The thickness of the drawn box.

           These constants allow the x, y, w, h and t expressions to refer to each other, so you may for example
           specify "y=x/dar" or "h=w/dar".

       Examples

       •   Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:

                   drawbox

       •   Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:

                   drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@0.5

           The previous example can be specified as:

                   drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@0.5

       •   Fill the box with pink color:

                   drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@0.5:t=fill

       •   Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:

                   drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   drawgraph
       Draw a graph using input video metadata.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       m1  Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.

       fg1 Set 1st foreground color expression.

       m2  Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.

       fg2 Set 2nd foreground color expression.

       m3  Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.

       fg3 Set 3rd foreground color expression.

       m4  Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.

       fg4 Set 4th foreground color expression.

       min Set minimal value of metadata value.

       max Set maximal value of metadata value.

       bg  Set graph background color. Default is white.

       mode
           Set graph mode.

           Available values for mode is:

           bar
           dot
           line

           Default is "line".

       slide
           Set slide mode.

           Available values for slide is:

           frame
               Draw new frame when right border is reached.

           replace
               Replace old columns with new ones.

           scroll
               Scroll from right to left.

           rscroll
               Scroll from left to right.

           picture
               Draw single picture.

           Default is "frame".

       size
           Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-
           utils manual.  The default value is "900x256".

       rate, r
           Set the output frame rate. Default value is 25.

           The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:

           MIN Minimal value of metadata value.

           MAX Maximal value of metadata value.

           VAL Current metadata key value.

           The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.

       Example using metadata from signalstats filter:

               signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255

       Example using metadata from ebur128 filter:

               ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5

   drawgrid
       Draw a grid on the input image.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       x
       y   The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure
           offset). Both default to 0.

       width, w
       height, h
           The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
           input width and height, respectively, minus "thickness", so image gets framed. Default to 0.

       color, c
           Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in
           the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special value "invert" is used, the grid color is the same as the
           video with inverted luma.

       thickness, t
           The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is 1.

           See below for the list of accepted constants.

       replace
           Applicable if the input has alpha. With 1 the pixels of the painted grid will overwrite the video's
           color and alpha pixels.  Default is 0, which composites the grid onto the input, leaving the video's
           alpha intact.

       The parameters for x, y, w and h and t are expressions containing the following constants:

       dar The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (w / h) * sar.

       hsub
       vsub
           horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" hsub is 2
           and vsub is 1.

       in_h, ih
       in_w, iw
           The input grid cell width and height.

       sar The input sample aspect ratio.

       x
       y   The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).

       w
       h   The width and height of the drawn cell.

       t   The thickness of the drawn cell.

           These constants allow the x, y, w, h and t expressions to refer to each other, so you may for example
           specify "y=x/dar" or "h=w/dar".

       Examples

       •   Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:

                   drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@0.5

       •   Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:

                   drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@0.5

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   drawtext
       Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the libfreetype library.

       To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libfreetype" and
       "--enable-libharfbuzz".  To enable default font fallback and the font option you need to configure FFmpeg
       with "--enable-libfontconfig".  To enable the text_shaping option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
       "--enable-libfribidi".

       Syntax

       It accepts the following parameters:

       box Used to draw a box around text using the background color.  The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0
           (disable).  The default value of box is 0.

       boxborderw
           Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using boxcolor.  The value must be specified
           using one of the following formats:

           *<"boxborderw=10" set the width of all the borders to 10>
           *<"boxborderw=10|20" set the width of the top and bottom borders to 10>
                   and the width of the left and right borders to 20

           *<"boxborderw=10|20|30" set the width of the top border to 10, the width>
                   of the bottom border to 30 and the width of the left and right borders to 20

           *<"boxborderw=10|20|30|40" set the borders width to 10 (top), 20 (right),>
                   30 (bottom), 40 (left)

           The default value of boxborderw is "0".

       boxcolor
           The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color"
           section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

           The default value of boxcolor is "white".

       line_spacing
           Set the line spacing in pixels. The default value of line_spacing is 0.

       text_align
           Set the vertical and horizontal alignment of the text with respect to the box boundaries.  The value
           is combination of flags, one for the vertical alignment (T=top, M=middle, B=bottom) and one for the
           horizontal alignment (L=left, C=center, R=right).  Please note that tab characters are only supported
           with the left horizontal alignment.

       y_align
           Specify what the y value is referred to. Possible values are:

           *<"text" the top of the highest glyph of the first text line is placed at y>
           *<"baseline" the baseline of the first text line is placed at y>
           *<"font" the baseline of the first text line is placed at y plus the>
                   ascent (in pixels) defined in the font metrics

           The default value of y_align is "text" for backward compatibility.

       borderw
           Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using bordercolor.  The default value of
           borderw is 0.

       bordercolor
           Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this option, check the
           "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

           The default value of bordercolor is "black".

       expansion
           Select how the text is expanded. Can be either "none", "strftime" (deprecated) or "normal" (default).
           See the drawtext_expansion, Text expansion section below for details.

       basetime
           Set a start time for the count. Value is in microseconds. Only applied in the deprecated "strftime"
           expansion mode. To emulate in normal expansion mode use the "pts" function, supplying the start time
           (in seconds) as the second argument.

       fix_bounds
           If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.

       fontcolor
           The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in
           the ffmpeg-utils manual.

           The default value of fontcolor is "black".

       fontcolor_expr
           String which is expanded the same way as text to obtain dynamic fontcolor value. By default this
           option has empty value and is not processed. When this option is set, it overrides fontcolor option.

       font
           The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.

       fontfile
           The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.  This parameter is mandatory if
           the fontconfig support is disabled.

       alpha
           Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can be a number between 0.0 and 1.0.  The expression
           accepts the same variables x, y as well.  The default value is 1.  Please see fontcolor_expr.

       fontsize
           The font size to be used for drawing text.  The default value of fontsize is 16.

       text_shaping
           If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of right-to-left text and join
           Arabic characters) before drawing it.  Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.  By default 1
           (if supported).

       ft_load_flags
           The flags to be used for loading the fonts.

           The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are a combination of the
           following values:

           default
           no_scale
           no_hinting
           render
           no_bitmap
           vertical_layout
           force_autohint
           crop_bitmap
           pedantic
           ignore_global_advance_width
           no_recurse
           ignore_transform
           monochrome
           linear_design
           no_autohint

           Default value is "default".

           For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_* libfreetype flags.

       shadowcolor
           The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the syntax of this option, check
           the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

           The default value of shadowcolor is "black".

       boxw
           Set the width of the box to be drawn around text.  The default value of boxw is computed
           automatically to match the text width

       boxh
           Set the height of the box to be drawn around text.  The default value of boxh is computed
           automatically to match the text height

       shadowx
       shadowy
           The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the position of the text. They can
           be either positive or negative values. The default value for both is "0".

       start_number
           The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value is "0".

       tabsize
           The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.  Default value is 4.

       timecode
           Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff" format. It can be used with or without
           text parameter. timecode_rate option must be specified.

       timecode_rate, rate, r
           Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only). Value will be rounded to nearest integer. Minimum value
           is "1".  Drop-frame timecode is supported for frame rates 30 & 60.

       tc24hmax
           If set to 1, the output of the timecode option will wrap around at 24 hours.  Default is 0
           (disabled).

       text
           The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8 encoded characters.  This parameter
           is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter textfile.

       textfile
           A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8 encoded characters.

           This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the parameter text.

           If both text and textfile are specified, an error is thrown.

       text_source
           Text source should be set as side_data_detection_bboxes if you want to use text data in detection
           bboxes of side data.

           If text source is set, text and textfile will be ignored and still use text data in detection bboxes
           of side data. So please do not use this parameter if you are not sure about the text source.

       reload
           The textfile will be reloaded at specified frame interval.  Be sure to update textfile atomically, or
           it may be read partially, or even fail.  Range is 0 to INT_MAX. Default is 0.

       x
       y   The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn within the video frame. They are
           relative to the top/left border of the output image.

           The default value of x and y is "0".

           See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.

       The parameters for x and y are expressions containing the following constants and functions:

       dar input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (w / h) * sar

       hsub
       vsub
           horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" hsub is 2
           and vsub is 1.

       line_h, lh
           the height of each text line

       main_h, h, H
           the input height

       main_w, w, W
           the input width

       max_glyph_a, ascent
           the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid coordinate used to place a glyph
           outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.  It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation
           with the Y axis upwards.

       max_glyph_d, descent
           the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate used to place a glyph outline
           point, for all the rendered glyphs.  This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with
           the Y axis upwards.

       max_glyph_h
           maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs contained in the rendered text,
           it is equivalent to ascent - descent.

       max_glyph_w
           maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs contained in the rendered text

       font_a
           the ascent size defined in the font metrics

       font_d
           the descent size defined in the font metrics

       top_a
           the maximum ascender of the glyphs of the first text line

       bottom_d
           the maximum descender of the glyphs of the last text line

       n   the number of input frame, starting from 0

       rand(min, max)
           return a random number included between min and max

       sar The input sample aspect ratio.

       t   timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown

       text_h, th
           the height of the rendered text

       text_w, tw
           the width of the rendered text

       x
       y   the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.

           These parameters allow the x and y expressions to refer to each other, so you can for example specify
           "y=x/dar".

       pict_type
           A one character description of the current frame's picture type.

       pkt_pos
           The current packet's position in the input file or stream (in bytes, from the start of the input). A
           value of -1 indicates this info is not available.

       duration
           The current packet's duration, in seconds.

       pkt_size
           The current packet's size (in bytes).

       Text expansion

       If expansion is set to "strftime", the filter recognizes sequences accepted by the "strftime" C function
       in the provided text and expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of "strftime". This feature is
       deprecated in favor of "normal" expansion with the "gmtime" or "localtime" expansion functions.

       If expansion is set to "none", the text is printed verbatim.

       If expansion is set to "normal" (which is the default), the following expansion mechanism is used.

       The backslash character \, followed by any character, always expands to the second character.

       Sequences of the form "%{...}" are expanded. The text between the braces is a function name, possibly
       followed by arguments separated by ':'.  If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':'
       or '}'), they should be escaped.

       Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the text option in the filter argument
       string and as the filter argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell, that
       makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file with the textfile option avoids these problems.

       The following functions are available:

       expr, e
           The expression evaluation result.

           It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated, which accepts the same constants
           and functions as the x and y values. Note that not all constants should be used, for example the text
           size is not known when evaluating the expression, so the constants text_w and text_h will have an
           undefined value.

       expr_int_format, eif
           Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.

           The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the expr function.  The second
           argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are x, X, d and u. They are treated exactly as
           in the "printf" function.  The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by
           the output.  It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.

       gmtime
           The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.  It can accept an argument: a "strftime" C
           function format string.  The format string is extended to support the variable %[1-6]N which prints
           fractions of the second with optionally specified number of digits.

       localtime
           The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.  It can accept an
           argument: a "strftime" C function format string.  The format string is extended to support the
           variable %[1-6]N which prints fractions of the second with optionally specified number of digits.

       metadata
           Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.

           The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.

           The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the metadata key is not
           found or empty.

           Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries starting with TAG included within each
           frame section printed by running "ffprobe -show_frames".

           String metadata generated in filters leading to the drawtext filter are also available.

       n, frame_num
           The frame number, starting from 0.

       pict_type
           A one character description of the current picture type.

       pts The timestamp of the current frame.  It can take up to three arguments.

           The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to "flt" for seconds as a decimal
           number with microsecond accuracy; "hms" stands for a formatted [-]HH:MM:SS.mmm timestamp with
           millisecond accuracy.  "gmtime" stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
           "localtime" stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as local time zone time.

           The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.

           If the format is set to "hms", a third argument "24HH" may be supplied to present the hour part of
           the formatted timestamp in 24h format (00-23).

           If the format is set to "localtime" or "gmtime", a third argument may be supplied: a "strftime" C
           function format string.  By default, YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS format will be used.

       Commands

       This filter supports altering parameters via commands:

       reinit
           Alter existing filter parameters.

           Syntax for the argument is the same as for filter invocation, e.g.

                   fontsize=56:fontcolor=green:text='Hello World'

           Full filter invocation with sendcmd would look like this:

                   sendcmd=c='56.0 drawtext reinit fontsize=56\:fontcolor=green\:text=Hello\\ World'

           If the entire argument can't be parsed or applied as valid values then the filter will continue with
           its existing parameters.

       The following options are also supported as commands:

       *<x>
       *<y>
       *<alpha>
       *<fontsize>
       *<fontcolor>
       *<boxcolor>
       *<bordercolor>
       *<shadowcolor>
       *<box>
       *<boxw>
       *<boxh>
       *<boxborderw>
       *<line_spacing>
       *<text_align>
       *<shadowx>
       *<shadowy>
       *<borderw>

       Examples

       •   Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the optional parameters.

                   drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"

       •   Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100 and y=50 (counting from the top-
           left corner of the screen), text is yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have
           an opacity of 20%.

                   drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
                             x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@0.2"

           Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used within the parameter list.

       •   Show the text at the center of the video frame:

                   drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"

       •   Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:

                   drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"

       •   Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video frame. The file LONG_LINE is
           assumed to contain a single line with no newlines.

                   drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"

       •   Show the content of file CREDITS off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.

                   drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"

       •   Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.  The glyph baseline is placed at
           half screen height.

                   drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"

       •   Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:

                   drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"

       •   Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.

                   drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'

       •   Draw "Test Text" with font size dependent on height of the video.

                   drawtext="text='Test Text': fontsize=h/30: x=(w-text_w)/2: y=(h-text_h*2)"

       •   Print the date of a real-time encoding (see documentation for the "strftime" C function):

                   drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y}'

       •   Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):

                   #!/bin/sh
                   DS=1.0 # display start
                   DE=10.0 # display end
                   FID=1.5 # fade in duration
                   FOD=5 # fade out duration
                   ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 }"

       •   Horizontally align multiple separate texts. Note that max_glyph_a and the fontsize value are included
           in the y offset.

                   drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=DOG:fontsize=24:x=10:y=20+24-max_glyph_a,
                   drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=cow:fontsize=24:x=80:y=20+24-max_glyph_a

       •   Plot special lavf.image2dec.source_basename metadata onto each frame if such metadata exists.
           Otherwise, plot the string "NA". Note that image2 demuxer must have option -export_path_metadata 1
           for the special metadata fields to be available for filters.

                   drawtext="fontsize=20:fontcolor=white:fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text='%{metadata\:lavf.image2dec.source_basename\:NA}':x=10:y=10"

       For more information about libfreetype, check: <http://www.freetype.org/>.

       For more information about fontconfig, check:
       <http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html>.

       For more information about libfribidi, check: <http://fribidi.org/>.

       For more information about libharfbuzz, check: <https://github.com/harfbuzz/harfbuzz>.

   edgedetect
       Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       low
       high
           Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding algorithm.

           The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then connected through 8-connectivity
           with the "weak" edge pixels selected by the low threshold.

           low and high threshold values must be chosen in the range [0,1], and low should be lesser or equal to
           high.

           Default value for low is "20/255", and default value for high is "50/255".

       mode
           Define the drawing mode.

           wires
               Draw white/gray wires on black background.

           colormix
               Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.

           canny
               Apply Canny edge detector on all selected planes.

           Default value is wires.

       planes
           Select planes for filtering. By default all available planes are filtered.

       Examples

       •   Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:

                   edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4

       •   Painting effect without thresholding:

                   edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0

   elbg
       Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.

       For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from the input to the output given the
       codebook length, that is the number of distinct output colors.

       This filter accepts the following options.

       codebook_length, l
           Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and represents the number of distinct
           output colors. Default value is 256.

       nb_steps, n
           Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal mapping. The higher the value
           the better the result and the higher the computation time. Default value is 1.

       seed, s
           Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if
           explicitly set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.

       pal8
           Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook length greater than 256.
           Default is disabled.

       use_alpha
           Include alpha values in the quantization calculation. Allows creating palettized output images (e.g.
           PNG8) with multiple alpha smooth blending.

   entropy
       Measure graylevel entropy in histogram of color channels of video frames.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       mode
           Can be either normal or diff. Default is normal.

           diff mode measures entropy of histogram delta values, absolute differences between neighbour
           histogram values.

   epx
       Apply the EPX magnification filter which is designed for pixel art.

       It accepts the following option:

       n   Set the scaling dimension: 2 for "2xEPX", 3 for "3xEPX".  Default is 3.

   eq
       Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       contrast
           Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range -1000.0 to 1000.0. The default
           value is "1".

       brightness
           Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in range -1.0 to 1.0. The default
           value is "0".

       saturation
           Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in range 0.0 to 3.0. The default value is
           "1".

       gamma
           Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range 0.1 to 10.0.  The default value is "1".

       gamma_r
           Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in range 0.1 to 10.0. The default value
           is "1".

       gamma_g
           Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range 0.1 to 10.0. The default value
           is "1".

       gamma_b
           Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range 0.1 to 10.0. The default value
           is "1".

       gamma_weight
           Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect of a high gamma value on bright
           image areas, e.g. keep them from getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a
           float in range 0.0 to 1.0. A value of 0.0 turns the gamma correction all the way down while 1.0
           leaves it at its full strength. Default is "1".

       eval
           Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and gamma expressions are evaluated.

           It accepts the following values:

           init
               only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed

           frame
               evaluate expressions for each incoming frame

           Default value is init.

       The expressions accept the following parameters:

       n   frame count of the input frame starting from 0

       pos byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if unspecified; deprecated, do not
           use

       r   frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown

       t   timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown

       Commands

       The filter supports the following commands:

       contrast
           Set the contrast expression.

       brightness
           Set the brightness expression.

       saturation
           Set the saturation expression.

       gamma
           Set the gamma expression.

       gamma_r
           Set the gamma_r expression.

       gamma_g
           Set gamma_g expression.

       gamma_b
           Set gamma_b expression.

       gamma_weight
           Set gamma_weight expression.

           The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.

           If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   erosion
       Apply erosion effect to the video.

       This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.

       It accepts the following options:

       threshold0
       threshold1
       threshold2
       threshold3
           Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.  If 0, plane will remain unchanged.

       coordinates
           Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight pixels are used.

           Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:

               1 2 3
               4   5
               6 7 8

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   estdif
       Deinterlace the input video ("estdif" stands for "Edge Slope Tracing Deinterlacing Filter").

       Spatial only filter that uses edge slope tracing algorithm to interpolate missing lines.  It accepts the
       following parameters:

       mode
           The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:

           frame
               Output one frame for each frame.

           field
               Output one frame for each field.

           The default value is "field".

       parity
           The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one of the following
           values:

           tff Assume the top field is first.

           bff Assume the bottom field is first.

           auto
               Enable automatic detection of field parity.

           The default value is "auto".  If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this
           information, top field first will be assumed.

       deint
           Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:

           all Deinterlace all frames.

           interlaced
               Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.

           The default value is "all".

       rslope
           Specify the search radius for edge slope tracing. Default value is 1.  Allowed range is from 1 to 15.

       redge
           Specify the search radius for best edge matching. Default value is 2.  Allowed range is from 0 to 15.

       ecost
           Specify the edge cost for edge matching. Default value is 2.  Allowed range is from 0 to 50.

       mcost
           Specify the middle cost for edge matching. Default value is 1.  Allowed range is from 0 to 50.

       dcost
           Specify the distance cost for edge matching. Default value is 1.  Allowed range is from 0 to 50.

       interp
           Specify the interpolation used. Default is 4-point interpolation. It accepts one of the following
           values:

           2p  Two-point interpolation.

           4p  Four-point interpolation.

           6p  Six-point interpolation.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   exposure
       Adjust exposure of the video stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       exposure
           Set the exposure correction in EV. Allowed range is from -3.0 to 3.0 EV Default value is 0 EV.

       black
           Set the black level correction. Allowed range is from -1.0 to 1.0.  Default value is 0.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   extractplanes
       Extract color channel components from input video stream into separate grayscale video streams.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set plane(s) to extract.

           Available values for planes are:

           y
           u
           v
           a
           r
           g
           b

           Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.  That means you cannot select
           "r", "g", "b" planes with "y", "u", "v" planes at same time.

       Examples

       •   Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame into 3 grayscale outputs:

                   ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi

   fade
       Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       type, t
           The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out effect.  Default is "in".

       start_frame, s
           Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade effect at. Default is 0.

       nb_frames, n
           The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the fade-in effect, the output video
           will have the same intensity as the input video.  At the end of the fade-out transition, the output
           video will be filled with the selected color.  Default is 25.

       alpha
           If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.  Default value is 0.

       start_time, st
           Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade effect. If both
           start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at whichever comes last.  Default is 0.

       duration, d
           The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the fade-in effect the
           output video will have the same intensity as the input video, at the end of the fade-out transition
           the output video will be filled with the selected color.  If both duration and nb_frames are
           specified, duration is used. Default is 0 (nb_frames is used by default).

       color, c
           Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".

       Examples

       •   Fade in the first 30 frames of video:

                   fade=in:0:30

           The command above is equivalent to:

                   fade=t=in:s=0:n=30

       •   Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:

                   fade=out:155:45
                   fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45

       •   Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:

                   fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25

       •   Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:

                   fade=in:5:20:color=yellow

       •   Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:

                   fade=in:0:25:alpha=1

       •   Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:

                   fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5

   feedback
       Apply feedback video filter.

       This filter pass cropped input frames to 2nd output.  From there it can be filtered with other video
       filters.  After filter receives frame from 2nd input, that frame is combined on top of original frame
       from 1st input and passed to 1st output.

       The typical usage is filter only part of frame.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       x
       y   Set the top left crop position.

       w
       h   Set the crop size.

       Examples

       •   Blur only top left rectangular part of video frame size 100x100 with gblur filter.

                   [in][blurin]feedback=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=100[out][blurout];[blurout]gblur=8[blurin]

       •   Draw black box on top left part of video frame of size 100x100 with drawbox filter.

                   [in][blurin]feedback=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=100[out][blurout];[blurout]drawbox=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=100:t=100[blurin]

       •   Pixelize rectangular part of video frame of size 100x100 with pixelize filter.

                   [in][blurin]feedback=x=320:y=240:w=100:h=100[out][blurout];[blurout]pixelize[blurin]

   fftdnoiz
       Denoise frames using 3D FFT (frequency domain filtering).

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sigma
           Set the noise sigma constant. This sets denoising strength.  Default value is 1. Allowed range is
           from 0 to 30.  Using very high sigma with low overlap may give blocking artifacts.

       amount
           Set amount of denoising. By default all detected noise is reduced.  Default value is 1. Allowed range
           is from 0 to 1.

       block
           Set size of block in pixels, Default is 32, can be 8 to 256.

       overlap
           Set block overlap. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0.2 to 0.8.

       method
           Set denoising method. Default is "wiener", can also be "hard".

       prev
           Set number of previous frames to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.

       next
           Set number of next frames to to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.

       planes
           Set planes which will be filtered, by default are all available filtered except alpha.

   fftfilt
       Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain

       dc_Y
           Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter accepts an integer value in
           range 0 to 1000. The default value is set to 0.

       dc_U
           Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The filter accepts an integer value
           in range 0 to 1000. The default value is set to 0.

       dc_V
           Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The filter accepts an integer value
           in range 0 to 1000. The default value is set to 0.

       weight_Y
           Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.

       weight_U
           Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.

       weight_V
           Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.

       eval
           Set when the expressions are evaluated.

           It accepts the following values:

           init
               Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization.

           frame
               Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.

           Default value is init.

           The filter accepts the following variables:

       X
       Y   The coordinates of the current sample.

       W
       H   The width and height of the image.

       N   The number of input frame, starting from 0.

       WS
       HS  The size of FFT array for horizontal and vertical processing.

       Examples

       •   High-pass:

                   fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'

       •   Low-pass:

                   fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'

       •   Sharpen:

                   fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'

       •   Blur:

                   fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'

   field
       Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The
       output frames are marked as non-interlaced.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       type
           Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is 0 or "top") or the bottom field (if the value is
           1 or "bottom").

   fieldhint
       Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames supplied as numbers by the
       hint file.

       hint
           Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.

           There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two numbers separated by the
           comma, optionally followed by "-" or "+".  Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of
           [N-1,N+1] where N is current frame number for "absolute" mode or out of [-1, 1] range for "relative"
           mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top field and second number tells from which
           frame to pick up bottom field.

           If optionally followed by "+" output frame will be marked as interlaced, else if followed by "-"
           output frame will be marked as progressive, else it will be marked same as input frame.  If
           optionally followed by "t" output frame will use only top field, or in case of "b" it will use only
           bottom field.  If line starts with "#" or ";" that line is skipped.

       mode
           Can be item "absolute" or "relative" or "pattern". Default is "absolute".  The "pattern" mode is same
           as "relative" mode, except at last entry of file if there are more frames to process than "hint" file
           is seek back to start.

       Example of first several lines of "hint" file for "relative" mode:

               0,0 - # first frame
               1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
               1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
               1,0 -
               0,0 -
               0,0 -
               1,0 -
               1,0 -
               1,0 -
               0,0 -
               0,0 -
               1,0 -
               1,0 -
               1,0 -
               0,0 -

   fieldmatch
       Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the progressive frames from a
       telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine
       "fieldmatch" needs to be followed by a decimation filter such as decimate in the filtergraph.

       The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by the possibility of
       inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.  If the source has mixed telecined and real
       interlaced content, "fieldmatch" will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.  But these
       remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be de-interlaced by a later filter
       such as yadif before decimation.

       In addition to the various configuration options, "fieldmatch" can take an optional second stream,
       activated through the ppsrc option. If enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and
       frames from this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to help the
       various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless (assuming the fields are matched
       properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser, or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.

       Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project) and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth
       project). The later is a light clone of TFM from which "fieldmatch" is based on. While the semantic and
       usage are very close, some behaviour and options names can differ.

       The decimate filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.  If your input has mixed
       telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain
       to produce the necessary cfr stream: "dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate".

       The filter accepts the following options:

       order
           Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:

           auto
               Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).

           bff Assume bottom field first.

           tff Assume top field first.

           Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the stream.

           Default value is auto.

       mode
           Set the matching mode or strategy to use. pc mode is the safest in the sense that it won't risk
           creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when possible, but if there are bad edits or blended
           fields it will end up outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
           hand, pcn_ub mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness, but will almost always find a
           good frame if there is one. The other values are all somewhere in between pc and pcn_ub in terms of
           risking jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections with bad
           edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.

           More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in p/c/n/u/b meaning section.

           Available values are:

           pc  2-way matching (p/c)

           pc_n
               2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)

           pc_u
               2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)

           pc_n_ub
               2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if still combed (p/c
               + n + u/b)

           pcn 3-way matching (p/c/n)

           pcn_ub
               3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are detected as
               combed (p/c/n + u/b)

           The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that mode assuming order=tff
           (and field on auto or top).

           In terms of speed pc mode is by far the fastest and pcn_ub is the slowest.

           Default value is pc_n.

       ppsrc
           Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary input stream as the
           clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter introduction for more details. It is similar to
           the clip2 feature from VFM/TFM.

           Default value is 0 (disabled).

       field
           Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as order unless you
           experience matching failures with that setting. In certain circumstances changing the field that is
           used to match from can have a large impact on matching performance. Available values are:

           auto
               Automatic (same value as order).

           bottom
               Match from the bottom field.

           top Match from the top field.

           Default value is auto.

       mchroma
           Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most cases it is recommended
           to leave this enabled. You should set this to 0 only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as
           heavy rainbowing or other artifacts. Setting this to 0 could also be used to speed things up at the
           cost of some accuracy.

           Default value is 1.

       y0
       y1  These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between y0 and y1 from being included in the
           field matching decision. An exclusion band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things
           that may interfere with the matching. y0 sets the starting scan line and y1 sets the ending line; all
           lines in between y0 and y1 (including y0 and y1) will be ignored. Setting y0 and y1 to the same value
           will disable the feature.  y0 and y1 defaults to 0.

       scthresh
           Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on the luma plane. Good
           values are in the "[8.0, 14.0]" range. Scene change detection is only relevant in case combmatch=sc.
           The range for scthresh is "[0.0, 100.0]".

           Default value is 12.0.

       combmatch
           When combatch is not none, "fieldmatch" will take into account the combed scores of matches when
           deciding what match to use as the final match. Available values are:

           none
               No final matching based on combed scores.

           sc  Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.

           full
               Use combed scores all the time.

           Default is sc.

       combdbg
           Force "fieldmatch" to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and print them. This setting
           is known as micout in TFM/VFM vocabulary.  Available values are:

           none
               No forced calculation.

           pcn Force p/c/n calculations.

           pcnub
               Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.

           Default value is none.

       cthresh
           This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This essentially controls how
           "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.  Larger values mean combing must be more
           visible and smaller values mean combing can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid
           settings are from -1 (every pixel will be detected as combed) to 255 (no pixel will be detected as
           combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good range is "[8, 12]".

           Default value is 9.

       chroma
           Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision.  Only disable this if your
           source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are causing problems for the combed frame
           detection with chroma enabled. Actually, using chroma=0 is usually more reliable, except for the case
           where there is chroma only combing in the source.

           Default value is 0.

       blockx
       blocky
           Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed frame detection. This
           has to do with the size of the area in which combpel pixels are required to be detected as combed for
           a frame to be declared combed. See the combpel parameter description for more info.  Possible values
           are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up to 512.

           Default value is 16.

       combpel
           The number of combed pixels inside any of the blocky by blockx size blocks on the frame for the frame
           to be detected as combed. While cthresh controls how "visible" the combing must be, this setting
           controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a window defined by the blockx and
           blocky settings) on the frame. Minimum value is 0 and maximum is "blocky x blockx" (at which point no
           frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known as MI in TFM/VFM vocabulary.

           Default value is 80.

       p/c/n/u/b meaning

       p/c/n

       We assume the following telecined stream:

               Top fields:     1 2 2 3 4
               Bottom fields:  1 2 3 4 4

       The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the first two frames are
       progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.

       When "fieldmatch" is configured to run a matching from bottom (field=bottom) this is how this input
       stream get transformed:

               Input stream:
                               T     1 2 2 3 4
                               B     1 2 3 4 4   <-- matching reference

               Matches:              c c n n c

               Output stream:
                               T     1 2 3 4 4
                               B     1 2 3 4 4

       As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.  To perform a complete
       inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter after this operation. See for instance the
       decimate filter.

       The same operation now matching from top fields (field=top) looks like this:

               Input stream:
                               T     1 2 2 3 4   <-- matching reference
                               B     1 2 3 4 4

               Matches:              c c p p c

               Output stream:
                               T     1 2 2 3 4
                               B     1 2 2 3 4

       In these examples, we can see what p, c and n mean; basically, they refer to the frame and field of the
       opposite parity:

       *<p matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame>
       *<c matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame>
       *<n matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame>

       u/b

       The u and b matching are a bit special in the sense that they match from the opposite parity flag. In the
       following examples, we assume that we are currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According
       to the match, a 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.

       With bottom matching (field=bottom):

               Match:           c         p           n          b          u

                                x       x               x        x          x
                 Top          1 2 2     1 2 2       1 2 2      1 2 2      1 2 2
                 Bottom       1 2 3     1 2 3       1 2 3      1 2 3      1 2 3
                                x         x           x        x              x

               Output frames:
                                2          1          2          2          2
                                2          2          2          1          3

       With top matching (field=top):

               Match:           c         p           n          b          u

                                x         x           x        x              x
                 Top          1 2 2     1 2 2       1 2 2      1 2 2      1 2 2
                 Bottom       1 2 3     1 2 3       1 2 3      1 2 3      1 2 3
                                x       x               x        x          x

               Output frames:
                                2          2          2          1          2
                                2          1          3          2          2

       Examples

       Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:

               fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate

       Advanced IVTC, with fallback on yadif for still combed frames:

               fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate

   fieldorder
       Transform the field order of the input video.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       order
           The output field order. Valid values are tff for top field first or bff for bottom field first.

       The default value is tff.

       The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down by one line, and filling the
       remaining line with appropriate picture content.  This method is consistent with most broadcast field
       order converters.

       If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already flagged as being of the required
       output field order, then this filter does not alter the incoming video.

       It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material, which is bottom field first.

       For example:

               ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv

   fillborders
       Fill borders of the input video, without changing video stream dimensions.  Sometimes video can have
       garbage at the four edges and you may not want to crop video input to keep size multiple of some number.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       left
           Number of pixels to fill from left border.

       right
           Number of pixels to fill from right border.

       top Number of pixels to fill from top border.

       bottom
           Number of pixels to fill from bottom border.

       mode
           Set fill mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           smear
               fill pixels using outermost pixels

           mirror
               fill pixels using mirroring (half sample symmetric)

           fixed
               fill pixels with constant value

           reflect
               fill pixels using reflecting (whole sample symmetric)

           wrap
               fill pixels using wrapping

           fade
               fade pixels to constant value

           margins
               fill pixels at top and bottom with weighted averages pixels near borders

           Default is smear.

       color
           Set color for pixels in fixed or fade mode. Default is black.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   find_rect
       Find a rectangular object in the input video.

       The object to search for must be specified as a gray8 image specified with the object option.

       For each possible match, a score is computed. If the score reaches the specified threshold, the object is
       considered found.

       If the input video contains multiple instances of the object, the filter will find only one of them.

       When an object is found, the following metadata entries are set in the matching frame:

       lavfi.rect.w
           width of object

       lavfi.rect.h
           height of object

       lavfi.rect.x
           x position of object

       lavfi.rect.y
           y position of object

       lavfi.rect.score
           match score of the found object

       It accepts the following options:

       object
           Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.

       threshold
           Detection threshold, expressed as a decimal number in the range 0-1.

           A threshold value of 0.01 means only exact matches, a threshold of 0.99 means almost everything
           matches.

           Default value is 0.5.

       mipmaps
           Number of mipmaps, default is 3.

       xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
           Specifies the rectangle in which to search.

       discard
           Discard frames where object is not detected. Default is disabled.

       Examples

       •   Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv

       •   Find the position of an object in each frame using ffprobe and write it to a log file:

                   ffprobe -f lavfi movie=test.mp4,find_rect=object=object.pgm:threshold=0.3 \
                     -show_entries frame=pkt_pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.rect.x,lavfi.rect.y \
                     -of csv -o find_rect.csv

   floodfill
       Flood area with values of same pixel components with another values.

       It accepts the following options:

       x   Set pixel x coordinate.

       y   Set pixel y coordinate.

       s0  Set source #0 component value.

       s1  Set source #1 component value.

       s2  Set source #2 component value.

       s3  Set source #3 component value.

       d0  Set destination #0 component value.

       d1  Set destination #1 component value.

       d2  Set destination #2 component value.

       d3  Set destination #3 component value.

   format
       Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.  Libavfilter will try to pick one that is
       suitable as input to the next filter.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       pix_fmts
           A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".

       color_spaces
           A '|'-separated list of color space names, such as "color_spaces=bt709|bt470bg|bt2020nc".

       color_ranges
           A '|'-separated list of color range names, such as "color_spaces=tv|pc".

       Examples

       •   Convert the input video to the yuv420p format

                   format=pix_fmts=yuv420p

           Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list

                   format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p

   fps
       Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping frames as necessary.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       fps The desired output frame rate. It accepts expressions containing the following constants:

           source_fps
               The input's frame rate

           ntsc
               NTSC frame rate of "30000/1001"

           pal PAL frame rate of 25.0

           film
               Film frame rate of 24.0

           ntsc_film
               NTSC-film frame rate of "24000/1001"

           The default is 25.

       start_time
           Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for padding/trimming at the
           start of stream. By default, no assumption is made about the first frame's expected PTS, so no
           padding or trimming is done.  For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with
           duplicates of the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any frames
           with a negative PTS.

       round
           Timestamp (PTS) rounding method.

           Possible values are:

           zero
               round towards 0

           inf round away from 0

           down
               round towards -infinity

           up  round towards +infinity

           near
               round to nearest

           The default is "near".

       eof_action
           Action performed when reading the last frame.

           Possible values are:

           round
               Use same timestamp rounding method as used for other frames.

           pass
               Pass through last frame if input duration has not been reached yet.

           The default is "round".

       Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string: fps[:start_time[:round]].

       See also the setpts filter.

       Examples

       •   A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:

                   fps=fps=25

       •   Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:

                   fps=fps=film:round=near

   framepack
       Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper metadata on supported codecs.
       The two views should have the same size and framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video
       ends. Please note that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the scale and fps filters.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       format
           The desired packing format. Supported values are:

           sbs The views are next to each other (default).

           tab The views are on top of each other.

           lines
               The views are packed by line.

           columns
               The views are packed by column.

           frameseq
               The views are temporally interleaved.

       Some examples:

               # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
               ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT

               # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
               ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT

   framerate
       Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source frames.

       This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If you wish to change the frame
       rate of interlaced media then you are required to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after
       this filter.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       fps Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified as a value alone. The default
           is 50.

       interp_start
           Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a linear interpolation of two
           frames. The range is [0-255], the default is 15.

       interp_end
           Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a linear interpolation of two
           frames. The range is [0-255], the default is 240.

       scene
           Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between 0 and 100 to indicate a new
           scene; a low value reflects a low probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a
           higher value means the current frame is more likely to be one.  The default is 8.2.

       flags
           Specify flags influencing the filter process.

           Available value for flags is:

           scene_change_detect, scd
               Enable scene change detection using the value of the option scene.  This flag is enabled by
               default.

   framestep
       Select one frame every N-th frame.

       This filter accepts the following option:

       step
           Select frame after every "step" frames.  Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default
           value is 1.

   freezedetect
       Detect frozen video.

       This filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects that the input video has no
       significant change in content during a specified duration.  Video freeze detection calculates the mean
       average absolute difference of all the components of video frames and compares it to a noise floor.

       The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The "lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_start" metadata
       key is set on the first frame whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection duration and it contains
       the timestamp of the first frame of the freeze. The "lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_duration" and
       "lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_end" metadata keys are set on the first frame after the freeze.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       noise, n
           Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value) or as a
           difference ratio between 0 and 1. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.

       duration, d
           Set freeze duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).

   freezeframes
       Freeze video frames.

       This filter freezes video frames using frame from 2nd input.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       first
           Set number of first frame from which to start freeze.

       last
           Set number of last frame from which to end freeze.

       replace
           Set number of frame from 2nd input which will be used instead of replaced frames.

   frei0r
       Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.

       To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r header and configure FFmpeg with
       "--enable-frei0r".

       It accepts the following parameters:

       filter_name
           The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable FREI0R_PATH is defined, the frei0r
           effect is searched for in each of the directories specified by the colon-separated list in
           FREI0R_PATH.  Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order: HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/,
           /usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/, /usr/lib/frei0r-1/.

       filter_params
           A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.

       A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified
       as R/G/B, where R, G, and B are floating point numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or a color
       description as specified in the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual, a position (specified as X/Y,
       where X and Y are floating point numbers) and/or a string.

       The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an effect parameter is not specified,
       the default value is set.

       Examples

       •   Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:

                   frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01

       •   Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:

                   frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
                   frei0r=colordistance:violet
                   frei0r=colordistance:0x112233

       •   Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image positions:

                   frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2

       For more information, see <http://frei0r.dyne.org>

       Commands

       This filter supports the filter_params option as commands.

   fspp
       Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of spp.

       It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post- processing filter, one of them
       is performed once per block, not per pixel.  This allows for much higher speed.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       quality
           Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts an integer in the
           range 4-5. Default value is 4.

       qp  Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.  If not set, the filter
           will use the QP from the video stream (if available).

       strength
           Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean more details but
           also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother but also blurrier. Default value is
           0 − PSNR optimal.

       use_bframe_qp
           Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to 1. Using this option may cause flicker since the
           B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is 0 (not enabled).

   fsync
       Synchronize video frames with an external mapping from a file.

       For each input PTS given in the map file it either drops or creates as many frames as necessary to
       recreate the sequence of output frames given in the map file.

       This filter is useful to recreate the output frames of a framerate conversion by the fps filter, recorded
       into a map file using the ffmpeg option "-stats_mux_pre", and do further processing to the corresponding
       frames e.g. quality comparison.

       Each line of the map file must contain three items per input frame, the input PTS (decimal), the output
       PTS (decimal) and the output TIMEBASE (decimal/decimal), seperated by a space.  This file format
       corresponds to the output of "-stats_mux_pre_fmt="{ptsi} {pts} {tb}"".

       The filter assumes the map file is sorted by increasing input PTS.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       file, f
           The filename of the map file to be used.

       Example:

               # Convert a video to 25 fps and record a MAP_FILE file with the default format of this filter
               ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf fps=fps=25 -stats_mux_pre MAP_FILE -stats_mux_pre_fmt "{ptsi} {pts} {tb}" OUTPUT

               # Sort MAP_FILE by increasing input PTS
               sort -n MAP_FILE

               # Use INPUT, OUTPUT and the MAP_FILE from above to compare the corresponding frames in INPUT and OUTPUT via SSIM
               ffmpeg -i INPUT -i OUTPUT -filter_complex '[0:v]fsync=file=MAP_FILE[ref];[1:v][ref]ssim' -f null -

   gblur
       Apply Gaussian blur filter.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sigma
           Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is 0.5.

       steps
           Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Default is 1.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.

       sigmaV
           Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as "sigma".  Default is -1.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   geq
       Apply generic equation to each pixel.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       lum_expr, lum
           Set the luma expression.

       cb_expr, cb
           Set the chrominance blue expression.

       cr_expr, cr
           Set the chrominance red expression.

       alpha_expr, a
           Set the alpha expression.

       red_expr, r
           Set the red expression.

       green_expr, g
           Set the green expression.

       blue_expr, b
           Set the blue expression.

       The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one of the lum_expr, cb_expr, or
       cr_expr options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr colorspace. If one of the
       red_expr, green_expr, or blue_expr options is specified, it will select an RGB colorspace.

       If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other one. If no alpha
       expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.  If none of chrominance expressions are
       specified, they will evaluate to the luma expression.

       The expressions can use the following variables and functions:

       N   The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.

       X
       Y   The coordinates of the current sample.

       W
       H   The width and height of the image.

       SW
       SH  Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the ratio between the
           corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values
           are "1,1" for the luma plane, and "0.5,0.5" for chroma planes.

       T   Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.

       p(x, y)
           Return the value of the pixel at location (x,y) of the current plane.

       lum(x, y)
           Return the value of the pixel at location (x,y) of the luma plane.

       cb(x, y)
           Return the value of the pixel at location (x,y) of the blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if
           there is no such plane.

       cr(x, y)
           Return the value of the pixel at location (x,y) of the red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there
           is no such plane.

       r(x, y)
       g(x, y)
       b(x, y)
           Return the value of the pixel at location (x,y) of the red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is
           no such component.

       alpha(x, y)
           Return the value of the pixel at location (x,y) of the alpha plane. Return 0 if there is no such
           plane.

       psum(x,y), lumsum(x, y), cbsum(x,y), crsum(x,y), rsum(x,y), gsum(x,y), bsum(x,y), alphasum(x,y)
           Sum of sample values in the rectangle from (0,0) to (x,y), this allows obtaining sums of samples
           within a rectangle. See the functions without the sum postfix.

       interpolation
           Set one of interpolation methods:

           nearest, n
           bilinear, b

           Default is bilinear.

       For functions, if x and y are outside the area, the value will be automatically clipped to the closer
       edge.

       Please note that this filter can use multiple threads in which case each slice will have its own
       expression state. If you want to use only a single expression state because your expressions depend on
       previous state then you should limit the number of filter threads to 1.

       Examples

       •   Flip the image horizontally:

                   geq=p(W-X\,Y)

       •   Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle "PI/3" and a wavelength of 100 pixels:

                   geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128

       •   Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:

                   nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128

       •   Generate a quick emboss effect:

                   format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'

       •   Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:

                   geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'

       •   Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see the vignette filter):

                   geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray

   gradfun
       Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat regions by truncation to 8-bit
       color depth.  Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and dither them.

       It is designed for playback only.  Do not use it prior to lossy compression, because compression tends to
       lose the dither and bring back the bands.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       strength
           The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also the threshold for
           detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-
           of-range values will be clipped to the valid range.

       radius
           The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother gradients, but also
           prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the
           default value is 16. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the valid range.

       Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string: strength[:radius]

       Examples

       •   Apply the filter with a 3.5 strength and radius of 8:

                   gradfun=3.5:8

       •   Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default value):

                   gradfun=radius=8

   graphmonitor
       Show various filtergraph stats.

       With this filter one can debug complete filtergraph.  Especially issues with links filling with queued
       frames.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Set video output size. Default is hd720.

       opacity, o
           Set video opacity. Default is 0.9. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.

       mode, m
           Set output mode flags.

           Available values for flags are:

           full
               No any filtering. Default.

           compact
               Show only filters with queued frames.

           nozero
               Show only filters with non-zero stats.

           noeof
               Show only filters with non-eof stat.

           nodisabled
               Show only filters that are enabled in timeline.

       flags, f
           Set flags which enable which stats are shown in video.

           Available values for flags are:

           none
               All flags turned off.

           all All flags turned on.

           queue
               Display number of queued frames in each link.

           frame_count_in
               Display number of frames taken from filter.

           frame_count_out
               Display number of frames given out from filter.

           frame_count_delta
               Display delta number of frames between above two values.

           pts Display current filtered frame pts.

           pts_delta
               Display pts delta between current and previous frame.

           time
               Display current filtered frame time.

           time_delta
               Display time delta between current and previous frame.

           timebase
               Display time base for filter link.

           format
               Display used format for filter link.

           size
               Display video size or number of audio channels in case of audio used by filter link.

           rate
               Display video frame rate or sample rate in case of audio used by filter link.

           eof Display link output status.

           sample_count_in
               Display number of samples taken from filter.

           sample_count_out
               Display number of samples given out from filter.

           sample_count_delta
               Display delta number of samples between above two values.

           disabled
               Show the timeline filter status.

       rate, r
           Set upper limit for video rate of output stream, Default value is 25.  This guarantee that output
           video frame rate will not be higher than this value.

   grayworld
       A color constancy filter that applies color correction based on the grayworld assumption

       See:
       <https://www.researchgate.net/publication/275213614_A_New_Color_Correction_Method_for_Underwater_Imaging>

       The algorithm  uses linear light, so input data should be linearized beforehand (and possibly correctly
       tagged).

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,grayworld,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT

   greyedge
       A color constancy variation filter which estimates scene illumination via grey edge algorithm and
       corrects the scene colors accordingly.

       See: <https://staff.science.uva.nl/th.gevers/pub/GeversTIP07.pdf>

       The filter accepts the following options:

       difford
           The order of differentiation to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range [0,2] and
           default value is 1.

       minknorm
           The Minkowski parameter to be used for calculating the Minkowski distance. Must be chosen in the
           range [0,20] and default value is 1. Set to 0 for getting max value instead of calculating Minkowski
           distance.

       sigma
           The standard deviation of Gaussian blur to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range
           [0,1024.0] and default value = 1. floor( sigma * break_off_sigma(3) ) can't be equal to 0 if difford
           is greater than 0.

       Examples

       •   Grey Edge:

                   greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=5:sigma=2

       •   Max Edge:

                   greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=0:sigma=2

   guided
       Apply guided filter for edge-preserving smoothing, dehazing and so on.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       radius
           Set the box radius in pixels.  Allowed range is 1 to 20. Default is 3.

       eps Set regularization parameter (with square).  Allowed range is 0 to 1. Default is 0.01.

       mode
           Set filter mode. Can be "basic" or "fast".  Default is "basic".

       sub Set subsampling ratio for "fast" mode.  Range is 2 to 64. Default is 4.  No subsampling occurs in
           "basic" mode.

       guidance
           Set guidance mode. Can be "off" or "on". Default is "off".  If "off", single input is required.  If
           "on", two inputs of the same resolution and pixel format are required.  The second input serves as
           the guidance.

       planes
           Set planes to filter. Default is first only.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Edge-preserving smoothing with guided filter:

                   ffmpeg -i in.png -vf guided out.png

       •   Dehazing, structure-transferring filtering, detail enhancement with guided filter.  For the
           generation of guidance image, refer to paper "Guided Image Filtering".  See:
           <http://kaiminghe.com/publications/pami12guidedfilter.pdf>.

                   ffmpeg -i in.png -i guidance.png -filter_complex guided=guidance=on out.png

   haldclut
       Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.

       First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.  The Hald CLUT input can be
       a simple picture or a complete video stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       clut
           Set which CLUT video frames will be processed from second input stream, can be first or all. Default
           is all.

       shortest
           Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is 0.

       repeatlast
           Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of 0 disable the filter after
           the last frame of the CLUT is reached.  Default is 1.

       "haldclut" also has the same interpolation options as lut3d (both filters share the same internals).

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

       More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website (Hald CLUT author) at
       <http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html>.

       Commands

       This filter supports the "interp" option as commands.

       Workflow examples

       Hald CLUT video stream

       Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:

               ffmpeg -f lavfi -i B<haldclutsrc>=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut

       Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.

       Then use it with "haldclut" to apply it on some random stream:

               ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv

       The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of clut.nut), then the latest picture of
       that CLUT stream will be applied to the remaining frames of the "mandelbrot" stream.

       Hald CLUT with preview

       A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of "Level*Level*Level" by "Level*Level*Level" pixels. For a
       given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture.
       The remaining padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add a preview of
       the Hald CLUT.

       Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the "haldclut" filter:

               ffmpeg -f lavfi -i B<haldclutsrc>=8 -vf "
                  pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
                  smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
                  [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
                  [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png

       It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color bars are displayed on the
       right-top, and below the same color bars processed by the color changes.

       Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:

               ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"

   hflip
       Flip the input video horizontally.

       For example, to horizontally flip the input video with ffmpeg:

               ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi

   histeq
       This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a per-frame basis.

       It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel intensities.  The filter
       redistributes the pixel intensities to equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
       viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is useful only for correcting
       degraded or poorly captured source video.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       strength
           Determine the amount of equalization to be applied.  As the strength is reduced, the distribution of
           pixel intensities more-and-more approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
           in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.

       intensity
           Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output values appropriately.  The strength
           should be set as desired and then the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The
           value must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.

       antibanding
           Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary the luminance of output pixels by
           a small amount to avoid banding of the histogram. Possible values are "none", "weak" or "strong". It
           defaults to "none".

   histogram
       Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.

       The computed histogram is a representation of the color component distribution in an image.

       Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.  Displays color graph for each
       color component. Shows distribution of the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format,
       in the current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       level_height
           Set height of level. Default value is 200.  Allowed range is [50, 2048].

       scale_height
           Set height of color scale. Default value is 12.  Allowed range is [0, 40].

       display_mode
           Set display mode.  It accepts the following values:

           stack
               Per color component graphs are placed below each other.

           parade
               Per color component graphs are placed side by side.

           overlay
               Presents information identical to that in the "parade", except that the graphs representing color
               components are superimposed directly over one another.

           Default is "stack".

       levels_mode
           Set mode. Can be either "linear", or "logarithmic".  Default is "linear".

       components
           Set what color components to display.  Default is 7.

       fgopacity
           Set foreground opacity. Default is 0.7.

       bgopacity
           Set background opacity. Default is 0.5.

       colors_mode
           Set colors mode.  It accepts the following values:

           whiteonblack
           blackonwhite
           whiteongray
           blackongray
           coloronblack
           coloronwhite
           colorongray
           blackoncolor
           whiteoncolor
           grayoncolor

           Default is "whiteonblack".

       Examples

       •   Calculate and draw histogram:

                   ffplay -i input -vf histogram

   hqdn3d
       This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce image noise, producing smooth
       images and making still images really still. It should enhance compressibility.

       It accepts the following optional parameters:

       luma_spatial
           A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.  It defaults to 4.0.

       chroma_spatial
           A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.  It defaults to
           3.0*luma_spatial/4.0.

       luma_tmp
           A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to 6.0*luma_spatial/4.0.

       chroma_tmp
           A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
           luma_tmp*chroma_spatial/luma_spatial.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   hwdownload
       Download hardware frames to system memory.

       The input must be in hardware frames, and the output a non-hardware format.  Not all formats will be
       supported on the output - it may be necessary to insert an additional format filter immediately following
       in the graph to get the output in a supported format.

   hwmap
       Map hardware frames to system memory or to another device.

       This filter has several different modes of operation; which one is used depends on the input and output
       formats:

       •   Hardware frame input, normal frame output

           Map the input frames to system memory and pass them to the output.  If the original hardware frame is
           later required (for example, after overlaying something else on part of it), the hwmap filter can be
           used again in the next mode to retrieve it.

       •   Normal frame input, hardware frame output

           If the input is actually a software-mapped hardware frame, then unmap it - that is, return the
           original hardware frame.

           Otherwise, a device must be provided.  Create new hardware surfaces on that device for the output,
           then map them back to the software format at the input and give those frames to the preceding filter.
           This will then act like the hwupload filter, but may be able to avoid an additional copy when the
           input is already in a compatible format.

       •   Hardware frame input and output

           A device must be supplied for the output, either directly or with the derive_device option.  The
           input and output devices must be of different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
           system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same underlying hardware context
           (for example, refer to the same graphics card).

           If the input frames were originally created on the output device, then unmap to retrieve the original
           frames.

           Otherwise, map the frames to the output device - create new hardware frames on the output
           corresponding to the frames on the input.

       The following additional parameters are accepted:

       mode
           Set the frame mapping mode.  Some combination of:

           read
               The mapped frame should be readable.

           write
               The mapped frame should be writeable.

           overwrite
               The mapping will always overwrite the entire frame.

               This may improve performance in some cases, as the original contents of the frame need not be
               loaded.

           direct
               The mapping must not involve any copying.

               Indirect mappings to copies of frames are created in some cases where either direct mapping is
               not possible or it would have unexpected properties.  Setting this flag ensures that the mapping
               is direct and will fail if that is not possible.

           Defaults to read+write if not specified.

       derive_device type
           Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new device of type type
           from the device the input frames exist on.

       reverse
           In a hardware to hardware mapping, map in reverse - create frames in the sink and map them back to
           the source.  This may be necessary in some cases where a mapping in one direction is required but
           only the opposite direction is supported by the devices being used.

           This option is dangerous - it may break the preceding filter in undefined ways if there are any
           additional constraints on that filter's output.  Do not use it without fully understanding the
           implications of its use.

   hwupload
       Upload system memory frames to hardware surfaces.

       The device to upload to must be supplied when the filter is initialised.  If using ffmpeg, select the
       appropriate device with the -filter_hw_device option or with the derive_device option.  The input and
       output devices must be of different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is system-dependent,
       but typically it means that they must refer to the same underlying hardware context (for example, refer
       to the same graphics card).

       The following additional parameters are accepted:

       derive_device type
           Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new device of type type
           from the device the input frames exist on.

   hwupload_cuda
       Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.

       It accepts the following optional parameters:

       device
           The number of the CUDA device to use

   hqx
       Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter was originally created by
       Maxim Stepin.

       It accepts the following option:

       n   Set the scaling dimension: 2 for "hq2x", 3 for "hq3x" and 4 for "hq4x".  Default is 3.

   hstack
       Stack input videos horizontally.

       All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.

       Note that this filter is faster than using overlay and pad filter to create same output.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       inputs
           Set number of input streams. Default is 2.

       shortest
           If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input terminates. Default value is 0.

   hsvhold
       Turns a certain HSV range into gray values.

       This filter measures color difference between set HSV color in options and ones measured in video stream.
       Depending on options, output colors can be changed to be gray or not.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       hue Set the hue value which will be used in color difference calculation.  Allowed range is from -360 to
           360. Default value is 0.

       sat Set the saturation value which will be used in color difference calculation.  Allowed range is from
           -1 to 1. Default value is 0.

       val Set the value which will be used in color difference calculation.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
           Default value is 0.

       similarity
           Set similarity percentage with the key color.  Allowed range is from 0 to 1. Default value is 0.01.

           0.00001 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.

       blend
           Blend percentage.  Allowed range is from 0 to 1. Default value is 0.

           0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.

           Higher values result in more gray pixels, with a higher gray pixel the more similar the pixels color
           is to the key color.

   hsvkey
       Turns a certain HSV range into transparency.

       This filter measures color difference between set HSV color in options and ones measured in video stream.
       Depending on options, output colors can be changed to transparent by adding alpha channel.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       hue Set the hue value which will be used in color difference calculation.  Allowed range is from -360 to
           360. Default value is 0.

       sat Set the saturation value which will be used in color difference calculation.  Allowed range is from
           -1 to 1. Default value is 0.

       val Set the value which will be used in color difference calculation.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
           Default value is 0.

       similarity
           Set similarity percentage with the key color.  Allowed range is from 0 to 1. Default value is 0.01.

           0.00001 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.

       blend
           Blend percentage.  Allowed range is from 0 to 1. Default value is 0.

           0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.

           Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency the more similar the
           pixels color is to the key color.

   hue
       Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       h   Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression, and defaults to "0".

       s   Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and defaults to "1".

       H   Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an expression, and defaults to "0".

       b   Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and defaults to "0".

       h and H are mutually exclusive, and can't be specified at the same time.

       The b, h, H and s option values are expressions containing the following constants:

       n   frame count of the input frame starting from 0

       pts presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units

       r   frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown

       t   timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown

       tb  time base of the input video

       Examples

       •   Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:

                   hue=h=90:s=1

       •   Same command but expressing the hue in radians:

                   hue=H=PI/2:s=1

       •   Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0 and 2 over a period of 1 second:

                   hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"

       •   Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:

                   hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"

           The general fade-in expression can be written as:

                   hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"

       •   Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:

                   hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"

           The general fade-out expression can be written as:

                   hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       b
       s
       h
       H   Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.  The command accepts the
           same syntax of the corresponding option.

           If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   huesaturation
       Apply hue-saturation-intensity adjustments to input video stream.

       This filter operates in RGB colorspace.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       hue Set the hue shift in degrees to apply. Default is 0.  Allowed range is from -180 to 180.

       saturation
           Set the saturation shift. Default is 0.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1.

       intensity
           Set the intensity shift. Default is 0.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1.

       colors
           Set which primary and complementary colors are going to be adjusted.  This options is set by
           providing one or multiple values.  This can select multiple colors at once. By default all colors are
           selected.

           r   Adjust reds.

           y   Adjust yellows.

           g   Adjust greens.

           c   Adjust cyans.

           b   Adjust blues.

           m   Adjust magentas.

           a   Adjust all colors.

       strength
           Set strength of filtering. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.  Default value is 1.

       rw, gw, bw
           Set weight for each RGB component. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  By default is set to 0.333, 0.334,
           0.333.  Those options are used in saturation and lightess processing.

       lightness
           Set preserving lightness, by default is disabled.  Adjusting hues can change lightness from original
           RGB triplet, with this option enabled lightness is kept at same value.

   hysteresis
       Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.  This makes it possible to build more
       robust edge masks.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be copied from first stream.
           By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.

       threshold
           Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than this value filter
           algorithm for connecting components is activated.  By default value is 0.

       The "hysteresis" filter also supports the framesync options.

   iccdetect
       Detect the colorspace  from an embedded ICC profile (if present), and update the frame's tags
       accordingly.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       force
           If true, the frame's existing colorspace tags will always be overridden by values detected from an
           ICC profile. Otherwise, they will only be assigned if they contain "unknown". Enabled by default.

   iccgen
       Generate ICC profiles and attach them to frames.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       color_primaries
       color_trc
           Configure the colorspace that the ICC profile will be generated for. The default value of "auto"
           infers the value from the input frame's metadata, defaulting to BT.709/sRGB as appropriate.

           See the setparams filter for a list of possible values, but note that "unknown" are not valid values
           for this filter.

       force
           If true, an ICC profile will be generated even if it would overwrite an already existing ICC profile.
           Disabled by default.

   identity
       Obtain the identity score between two input videos.

       This filter takes two input videos.

       Both input videos must have the same resolution and pixel format for this filter to work correctly. Also
       it assumes that both inputs have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.

       The obtained per component, average, min and max identity score is printed through the logging system.

       The filter stores the calculated identity scores of each frame in frame metadata.

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

       In the below example the input file main.mpg being processed is compared with the reference file ref.mpg.

               ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi identity -f null -

   idet
       Detect video interlacing type.

       This filter tries to detect if the input frames are interlaced, progressive, top or bottom field first.
       It will also try to detect fields that are repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).

       Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.  Multiple
       frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.

       The filter will log these metadata values:

       single.current_frame
           Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of: ``tff'' (top field first),
           ``bff'' (bottom field first), ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''

       single.tff
           Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.

       multiple.tff
           Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.

       single.bff
           Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.

       multiple.current_frame
           Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of: ``tff'' (top field first),
           ``bff'' (bottom field first), ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''

       multiple.bff
           Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.

       single.progressive
           Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.

       multiple.progressive
           Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.

       single.undetermined
           Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.

       multiple.undetermined
           Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.

       repeated.current_frame
           Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or
           ``bottom''.

       repeated.neither
           Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.

       repeated.top
           Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.

       repeated.bottom
           Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       intl_thres
           Set interlacing threshold.

       prog_thres
           Set progressive threshold.

       rep_thres
           Threshold for repeated field detection.

       half_life
           Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the statistics is halved (i.e., it
           contributes only 0.5 to its classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
           full weight of 1.0 forever.

       analyze_interlaced_flag
           When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine if the interlaced
           flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.  If the flag is found to be accurate it will
           be used without any further computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without
           any further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational method to
           clean up the interlaced flag

       Examples

       Inspect the field order of the first 360 frames in a video, in verbose detail:

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter:v idet,metadata=mode=print -frames:v 360 -an -f null -

       The idet filter will add analysis metadata to each frame, which will then be discarded. At the end, the
       filter will also print a final report with statistics.

   il
       Deinterleave or interleave fields.

       This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving
       splits the input frame into 2 fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top half of
       the output image, even lines to the bottom half.  You can process (filter) them independently and then
       re-interleave them.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       luma_mode, l
       chroma_mode, c
       alpha_mode, a
           Available values for luma_mode, chroma_mode and alpha_mode are:

           none
               Do nothing.

           deinterleave, d
               Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.

           interleave, i
               Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.

           Default value is "none".

       luma_swap, ls
       chroma_swap, cs
       alpha_swap, as
           Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is 0.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   inflate
       Apply inflate effect to the video.

       This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account only values higher than
       the pixel.

       It accepts the following options:

       threshold0
       threshold1
       threshold2
       threshold3
           Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.  If 0, plane will remain unchanged.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   interlace
       Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or lower) lines from odd
       frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames, halving the frame rate and preserving image height.

                  Original        Original             New Frame
                  Frame 'j'      Frame 'j+1'             (tff)
                 ==========      ===========       ==================
                   Line 0  -------------------->    Frame 'j' Line 0
                   Line 1          Line 1  ---->   Frame 'j+1' Line 1
                   Line 2 --------------------->    Frame 'j' Line 2
                   Line 3          Line 3  ---->   Frame 'j+1' Line 3
                    ...             ...                   ...
               New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on

       It accepts the following optional parameters:

       scan
           This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even (tff - default) or odd (bff)
           lines of the progressive frame.

       lowpass
           Vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter interlacing and reduce moire patterns.

           0, off
               Disable vertical lowpass filter

           1, linear
               Enable linear filter (default)

           2, complex
               Enable complex filter. This will slightly less reduce twitter and moire but better retain detail
               and subjective sharpness impression.

   kerndeint
       Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel deinterling. Work on interlaced parts
       of a video to produce progressive frames.

       The description of the accepted parameters follows.

       thresh
           Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when determining if a pixel line must be
           processed. It must be an integer in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
           applying the process on every pixels.

       map Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.  Default is 0.

       order
           Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if 0. Default is 0.

       sharp
           Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.

       twoway
           Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.

       Examples

       •   Apply default values:

                   kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0

       •   Enable additional sharpening:

                   kerndeint=sharp=1

       •   Paint processed pixels in white:

                   kerndeint=map=1

   kirsch
       Apply kirsch operator to input video stream.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.  By default value 0xf, all
           planes will be processed.

       scale
           Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.

       delta
           Set value which will be added to filtered result.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   lagfun
       Slowly update darker pixels.

       This filter makes short flashes of light appear longer.  This filter accepts the following options:

       decay
           Set factor for decaying. Default is .95. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   lenscorrection
       Correct radial lens distortion

       This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use of wide angle lenses,
       and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters one can use tools available for example as
       part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.  To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp)
       from the opencv sources and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.

       Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and Digikam from the
       KDE project.

       In contrast to the vignette filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors, this filter
       corrects the distortion of the image, whereas vignette corrects the brightness distribution, so you may
       want to use both filters together in certain cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e.
       whether vignetting should be applied before or after lens correction.

       Options

       The filter accepts the following options:

       cx  Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the distortion. This
           value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image width. Default is 0.5.

       cy  Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the distortion. This
           value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image height. Default is 0.5.

       k1  Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1]. 0 means no correction.
           Default is 0.

       k2  Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1].  0 means no
           correction. Default is 0.

       i   Set interpolation type. Can be "nearest" or "bilinear".  Default is "nearest".

       fc  Specify the color of the unmapped pixels. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in
           the ffmpeg-utils manual. Default color is "black@0".

       The formula that generates the correction is:

       r_src = r_tgt * (1 + k1 * (r_tgt / r_0)^2 + k2 * (r_tgt / r_0)^4)

       where r_0 is halve of the image diagonal and r_src and r_tgt are the distances from the focal point in
       the source and target images, respectively.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   lensfun
       Apply lens correction via the lensfun library (<http://lensfun.sourceforge.net/>).

       The "lensfun" filter requires the camera make, camera model, and lens model to apply the lens correction.
       The filter will load the lensfun database and query it to find the corresponding camera and lens entries
       in the database. As long as these entries can be found with the given options, the filter can perform
       corrections on frames. Note that incomplete strings will result in the filter choosing the best match
       with the given options, and the filter will output the chosen camera and lens models (logged with level
       "info"). You must provide the make, camera model, and lens model as they are required.

       To obtain a list of available makes and models, leave out one or both of "make" and "model" options. The
       filter will send the full list to the log with level "INFO".  The first column is the make and the second
       column is the model.  To obtain a list of available lenses, set any values for make and model and leave
       out the "lens_model" option. The filter will send the full list of lenses in the log with level "INFO".
       The ffmpeg tool will exit after the list is printed.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       make
           The make of the camera (for example, "Canon"). This option is required.

       model
           The model of the camera (for example, "Canon EOS 100D"). This option is required.

       lens_model
           The model of the lens (for example, "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM"). This option is required.

       db_path
           The full path to the lens database folder. If not set, the filter will attempt to load the database
           from the install path when the library was built. Default is unset.

       mode
           The type of correction to apply. The following values are valid options:

           vignetting
               Enables fixing lens vignetting.

           geometry
               Enables fixing lens geometry. This is the default.

           subpixel
               Enables fixing chromatic aberrations.

           vig_geo
               Enables fixing lens vignetting and lens geometry.

           vig_subpixel
               Enables fixing lens vignetting and chromatic aberrations.

           distortion
               Enables fixing both lens geometry and chromatic aberrations.

           all Enables all possible corrections.

       focal_length
           The focal length of the image/video (zoom; expected constant for video). For example, a 18--55mm lens
           has focal length range of [18--55], so a value in that range should be chosen when using that lens.
           Default 18.

       aperture
           The aperture of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that aperture is only used for
           vignetting correction. Default 3.5.

       focus_distance
           The focus distance of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that focus distance is only
           used for vignetting and only slightly affects the vignetting correction process. If unknown, leave it
           at the default value (which is 1000).

       scale
           The scale factor which is applied after transformation. After correction the video is no longer
           necessarily rectangular. This parameter controls how much of the resulting image is visible. The
           value 0 means that a value will be chosen automatically such that there is little or no unmapped area
           in the output image. 1.0 means that no additional scaling is done. Lower values may result in more of
           the corrected image being visible, while higher values may avoid unmapped areas in the output.

       target_geometry
           The target geometry of the output image/video. The following values are valid options:

           rectilinear (default)
           fisheye
           panoramic
           equirectangular
           fisheye_orthographic
           fisheye_stereographic
           fisheye_equisolid
           fisheye_thoby
       reverse
           Apply the reverse of image correction (instead of correcting distortion, apply it).

       interpolation
           The type of interpolation used when correcting distortion. The following values are valid options:

           nearest
           linear (default)
           lanczos

       Examples

       •   Apply lens correction with make "Canon", camera model "Canon EOS 100D", and lens model "Canon EF-S
           18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM" with focal length of "18" and aperture of "8.0".

                   ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8 -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov

       •   Apply the same as before, but only for the first 5 seconds of video.

                   ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8:enable='lte(t\,5)' -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov

   libplacebo
       Flexible GPU-accelerated processing filter based on libplacebo
       (<https://code.videolan.org/videolan/libplacebo>).

       Options

       The options for this filter are divided into the following sections:

       Output mode

       These options control the overall output mode. By default, libplacebo will try to preserve the source
       colorimetry and size as best as it can, but it will apply any embedded film grain, dolby vision metadata
       or anamorphic SAR present in source frames.

       inputs
           Set the number of inputs. This can be used, alongside the "idx" variable, to allow placing/blending
           multiple inputs inside the output frame. This effectively enables functionality similar to hstack,
           overlay, etc.

       w
       h   Set the output video dimension expression. Default values are "iw" and "ih".

           Allows for the same expressions as the scale filter.

       crop_x
       crop_y
           Set the input crop x/y expressions, default values are "(iw-cw)/2" and "(ih-ch)/2".

       crop_w
       crop_h
           Set the input crop width/height expressions, default values are "iw" and "ih".

       pos_x
       pos_y
           Set the output placement x/y expressions, default values are "(ow-pw)/2" and "(oh-ph)/2".

       pos_w
       pos_h
           Set the output placement width/height expressions, default values are "ow" and "oh".

       fps Set the output frame rate. This can be rational, e.g. "60000/1001". If set to the special string
           "none" (the default), input timestamps will instead be passed through to the output unmodified.
           Otherwise, the input video frames will be interpolated as necessary to rescale the video to the
           specified target framerate, in a manner as determined by the frame_mixer option.

       format
           Set the output format override. If unset (the default), frames will be output in the same format as
           the respective input frames. Otherwise, format conversion will be performed.

       force_original_aspect_ratio
       force_divisible_by
           Work the same as the identical scale filter options.

       normalize_sar
           If enabled, output frames will always have a pixel aspect ratio of 1:1. This will introduce
           additional padding/cropping as necessary. If disabled (the default), any aspect ratio mismatches,
           including those from e.g. anamorphic video sources, are forwarded to the output pixel aspect ratio.

       pad_crop_ratio
           Specifies a ratio (between 0.0 and 1.0) between padding and cropping when the input aspect ratio does
           not match the output aspect ratio and normalize_sar is in effect. The default of 0.0 always pads the
           content with black borders, while a value of 1.0 always crops off parts of the content. Intermediate
           values are possible, leading to a mix of the two approaches.

       fillcolor
           Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the output image, for example as a result
           of normalize_sar. For the general syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-
           utils manual. Defaults to "black".

       corner_rounding
           Render frames with rounded corners. The value, given as a float ranging from 0.0 to 1.0, indicates
           the relative degree of rounding, from fully square to fully circular. In other words, it gives the
           radius divided by half the smaller side length. Defaults to 0.0.

       extra_opts
           Pass extra libplacebo internal configuration options. These can be specified as a list of key=value
           pairs separated by ':'. The following example shows how to configure a custom filter kernel ("EWA
           LanczosSharp") and use it to double the input image resolution:

                   -vf "libplacebo=w=iw*2:h=ih*2:extra_opts='upscaler=custom\:upscaler_preset=ewa_lanczos\:upscaler_blur=0.9812505644269356'"

       colorspace
       color_primaries
       color_trc
       range
           Configure the colorspace that output frames will be delivered in. The default value of "auto" outputs
           frames in the same format as the input frames, leading to no change. For any other value, conversion
           will be performed.

           See the setparams filter for a list of possible values.

       apply_filmgrain
           Apply film grain (e.g. AV1 or H.274) if present in source frames, and strip it from the output.
           Enabled by default.

       apply_dolbyvision
           Apply Dolby Vision RPU metadata if present in source frames, and strip it from the output. Enabled by
           default. Note that Dolby Vision will always output BT.2020+PQ, overriding the usual input frame
           metadata. These will also be picked as the values of "auto" for the respective frame output options.

       In addition to the expression constants documented for the scale filter, the crop_w, crop_h, crop_x,
       crop_y, pos_w, pos_h, pos_x and pos_y options can also contain the following constants:

       in_idx, idx
           The (0-based) numeric index of the currently active input stream.

       crop_w, cw
       crop_h, ch
           The computed values of crop_w and crop_h.

       pos_w, pw
       pos_h, ph
           The computed values of pos_w and pos_h.

       in_t, t
           The input frame timestamp, in seconds. NAN if input timestamp is unknown.

       out_t, ot
           The input frame timestamp, in seconds. NAN if input timestamp is unknown.

       n   The input frame number, starting with 0.

       Scaling

       The options in this section control how libplacebo performs upscaling and (if necessary) downscaling.
       Note that libplacebo will always internally operate on 4:4:4 content, so any sub-sampled chroma formats
       such as "yuv420p" will necessarily be upsampled and downsampled as part of the rendering process. That
       means scaling might be in effect even if the source and destination resolution are the same.

       upscaler
       downscaler
           Configure the filter kernel used for upscaling and downscaling. The respective defaults are
           "spline36" and "mitchell". For a full list of possible values, pass "help" to these options. The most
           important values are:

           none
               Forces the use of built-in GPU texture sampling (typically bilinear). Extremely fast but poor
               quality, especially when downscaling.

           bilinear
               Bilinear interpolation. Can generally be done for free on GPUs, except when doing so would lead
               to aliasing. Fast and low quality.

           nearest
               Nearest-neighbour interpolation. Sharp but highly aliasing.

           oversample
               Algorithm that looks visually similar to nearest-neighbour interpolation but tries to preserve
               pixel aspect ratio. Good for pixel art, since it results in minimal distortion of the artistic
               appearance.

           lanczos
               Standard sinc-sinc interpolation kernel.

           spline36
               Cubic spline approximation of lanczos. No difference in performance, but has very slightly less
               ringing.

           ewa_lanczos
               Elliptically weighted average version of lanczos, based on a jinc-sinc kernel.  This is also
               popularly referred to as just "Jinc scaling". Slow but very high quality.

           gaussian
               Gaussian kernel. Has certain ideal mathematical properties, but subjectively very blurry.

           mitchell
               Cubic BC spline with parameters recommended by Mitchell and Netravali. Very little ringing.

       frame_mixer
           Controls the kernel used for mixing frames temporally. The default value is "none", which disables
           frame mixing. For a full list of possible values, pass "help" to this option. The most important
           values are:

           none
               Disables frame mixing, giving a result equivalent to "nearest neighbour" semantics.

           oversample
               Oversamples the input video to create a "Smooth Motion"-type effect: if an output frame would
               exactly fall on the transition between two video frames, it is blended according to the relative
               overlap. This is the recommended option whenever preserving the original subjective appearance is
               desired.

           mitchell_clamp
               Larger filter kernel that smoothly interpolates multiple frames in a manner designed to eliminate
               ringing and other artefacts as much as possible. This is the recommended option wherever maximum
               visual smoothness is desired.

           linear
               Linear blend/fade between frames. Especially useful for constructing e.g.  slideshows.

       lut_entries
           Configures the size of scaler LUTs, ranging from 1 to 256. The default of 0 will pick libplacebo's
           internal default, typically 64.

       antiringing
           Enables anti-ringing (for non-EWA filters). The value (between 0.0 and 1.0) configures the strength
           of the anti-ringing algorithm. May increase aliasing if set too high. Disabled by default.

       sigmoid
           Enable sigmoidal compression during upscaling. Reduces ringing slightly.  Enabled by default.

       Debanding

       Libplacebo comes with a built-in debanding filter that is good at counteracting many common sources of
       banding and blocking. Turning this on is highly recommended whenever quality is desired.

       deband
           Enable (fast) debanding algorithm. Disabled by default.

       deband_iterations
           Number of deband iterations of the debanding algorithm. Each iteration is performed with
           progressively increased radius (and diminished threshold).  Recommended values are in the range 1 to
           4. Defaults to 1.

       deband_threshold
           Debanding filter strength. Higher numbers lead to more aggressive debanding.  Defaults to 4.0.

       deband_radius
           Debanding filter radius. A higher radius is better for slow gradients, while a lower radius is better
           for steep gradients. Defaults to 16.0.

       deband_grain
           Amount of extra output grain to add. Helps hide imperfections. Defaults to 6.0.

       Color adjustment

       A collection of subjective color controls. Not very rigorous, so the exact effect will vary somewhat
       depending on the input primaries and colorspace.

       brightness
           Brightness boost, between -1.0 and 1.0. Defaults to 0.0.

       contrast
           Contrast gain, between 0.0 and 16.0. Defaults to 1.0.

       saturation
           Saturation gain, between 0.0 and 16.0. Defaults to 1.0.

       hue Hue shift in radians, between -3.14 and 3.14. Defaults to 0.0. This will rotate the UV subvector,
           defaulting to BT.709 coefficients for RGB inputs.

       gamma
           Gamma adjustment, between 0.0 and 16.0. Defaults to 1.0.

       cones
           Cone model to use for color blindness simulation. Accepts any combination of "l", "m" and "s". Here
           are some examples:

           m   Deuteranomaly / deuteranopia (affecting 3%-4% of the population)

           l   Protanomaly / protanopia (affecting 1%-2% of the population)

           l+m Monochromacy (very rare)

           l+m+s
               Achromatopsy (complete loss of daytime vision, extremely rare)

       cone-strength
           Gain factor for the cones specified by "cones", between 0.0 and 10.0. A value of 1.0 results in no
           change to color vision. A value of 0.0 (the default) simulates complete loss of those cones. Values
           above 1.0 result in exaggerating the differences between cones, which may help compensate for reduced
           color vision.

       Peak detection

       To help deal with sources that only have static HDR10 metadata (or no tagging whatsoever), libplacebo
       uses its own internal frame analysis compute shader to analyze source frames and adapt the tone mapping
       function in realtime. If this is too slow, or if exactly reproducible frame-perfect results are needed,
       it's recommended to turn this feature off.

       peak_detect
           Enable HDR peak detection. Ignores static MaxCLL/MaxFALL values in favor of dynamic detection from
           the input. Note that the detected values do not get written back to the output frames, they merely
           guide the internal tone mapping process. Enabled by default.

       smoothing_period
           Peak detection smoothing period, between 0.0 and 1000.0. Higher values result in peak detection
           becoming less responsive to changes in the input. Defaults to 100.0.

       minimum_peak
           Lower bound on the detected peak (relative to SDR white), between 0.0 and 100.0. Defaults to 1.0.

       scene_threshold_low
       scene_threshold_high
           Lower and upper thresholds for scene change detection. Expressed in a logarithmic scale between 0.0
           and 100.0. Default to 5.5 and 10.0, respectively. Setting either to a negative value disables this
           functionality.

       percentile
           Which percentile of the frame brightness histogram to use as the source peak for tone-mapping.
           Defaults to 99.995, a fairly conservative value.  Setting this to 100.0 disables frame histogram
           measurement and instead uses the true peak brightness for tone-mapping.

       Tone mapping

       The options in this section control how libplacebo performs tone-mapping and gamut-mapping when dealing
       with mismatches between wide-gamut or HDR content.  In general, libplacebo relies on accurate source
       tagging and mastering display gamut information to produce the best results.

       gamut_mode
           How to handle out-of-gamut colors that can occur as a result of colorimetric gamut mapping.

           clip
               Do nothing, simply clip out-of-range colors to the RGB volume. Low quality but extremely fast.

           perceptual
               Perceptually soft-clip colors to the gamut volume. This is the default.

           relative
               Relative colorimetric hard-clip. Similar to "perceptual" but without the soft knee.

           saturation
               Saturation mapping, maps primaries directly to primaries in RGB space.  Not recommended except
               for artificial computer graphics for which a bright, saturated display is desired.

           absolute
               Absolute colorimetric hard-clip. Performs no adjustment of the white point.

           desaturate
               Hard-desaturates out-of-gamut colors towards white, while preserving the luminance. Has a
               tendency to distort the visual appearance of bright objects.

           darken
               Linearly reduces content brightness to preserves saturated details, followed by clipping the
               remaining out-of-gamut colors.

           warn
               Highlight out-of-gamut pixels (by inverting/marking them).

           linear
               Linearly reduces chromaticity of the entire image to make it fit within the target color volume.
               Be careful when using this on BT.2020 sources without proper mastering metadata, as doing so will
               lead to excessive desaturation.

       tonemapping
           Tone-mapping algorithm to use. Available values are:

           auto
               Automatic selection based on internal heuristics. This is the default.

           clip
               Performs no tone-mapping, just clips out-of-range colors. Retains perfect color accuracy for in-
               range colors but completely destroys out-of-range information.  Does not perform any black point
               adaptation. Not configurable.

           st2094-40
               EETF from SMPTE ST 2094-40 Annex B, which applies the Bezier curves from HDR10+ dynamic metadata
               based on Bezier curves to perform tone-mapping. The OOTF used is adjusted based on the ratio
               between the targeted and actual display peak luminances.

           st2094-10
               EETF from SMPTE ST 2094-10 Annex B.2, which takes into account the input signal average luminance
               in addition to the maximum/minimum. The configurable contrast parameter influences the slope of
               the linear output segment, defaulting to 1.0 for no increase/decrease in contrast. Note that this
               does not currently include the subjective gain/offset/gamma controls defined in Annex B.3.

           bt.2390
               EETF from the ITU-R Report BT.2390, a hermite spline roll-off with linear segment. The knee point
               offset is configurable. Note that this parameter defaults to 1.0, rather than the value of 0.5
               from the ITU-R spec.

           bt.2446a
               EETF from ITU-R Report BT.2446, method A. Designed for well-mastered HDR sources. Can be used for
               both forward and inverse tone mapping. Not configurable.

           spline
               Simple spline consisting of two polynomials, joined by a single pivot point.  The parameter gives
               the pivot point (in PQ space), defaulting to 0.30.  Can be used for both forward and inverse tone
               mapping.

           reinhard
               Simple non-linear, global tone mapping algorithm. The parameter specifies the local contrast
               coefficient at the display peak. Essentially, a parameter of 0.5 implies that the reference white
               will be about half as bright as when clipping. Defaults to 0.5, which results in the simplest
               formulation of this function.

           mobius
               Generalization of the reinhard tone mapping algorithm to support an additional linear slope near
               black. The tone mapping parameter indicates the trade-off between the linear section and the non-
               linear section. Essentially, for a given parameter x, every color value below x will be mapped
               linearly, while higher values get non-linearly tone-mapped. Values near 1.0 make this curve
               behave like "clip", while values near 0.0 make this curve behave like "reinhard". The default
               value is 0.3, which provides a good balance between colorimetric accuracy and preserving out-of-
               gamut details.

           hable
               Piece-wise, filmic tone-mapping algorithm developed by John Hable for use in Uncharted 2,
               inspired by a similar tone-mapping algorithm used by Kodak.  Popularized by its use in video
               games with HDR rendering. Preserves both dark and bright details very well, but comes with the
               drawback of changing the average brightness quite significantly. This is sort of similar to
               "reinhard" with parameter 0.24.

           gamma
               Fits a gamma (power) function to transfer between the source and target color spaces, effectively
               resulting in a perceptual hard-knee joining two roughly linear sections. This preserves details
               at all scales fairly accurately, but can result in an image with a muted or dull appearance. The
               parameter is used as the cutoff point, defaulting to 0.5.

           linear
               Linearly stretches the input range to the output range, in PQ space. This will preserve all
               details accurately, but results in a significantly different average brightness. Can be used for
               inverse tone-mapping in addition to regular tone-mapping. The parameter can be used as an
               additional linear gain coefficient (defaulting to 1.0).

       tonemapping_param
           For tunable tone mapping functions, this parameter can be used to fine-tune the curve behavior. Refer
           to the documentation of "tonemapping". The default value of 0.0 is replaced by the curve's preferred
           default setting.

       inverse_tonemapping
           If enabled, this filter will also attempt stretching SDR signals to fill HDR output color volumes.
           Disabled by default.

       tonemapping_lut_size
           Size of the tone-mapping LUT, between 2 and 1024. Defaults to 256. Note that this figure is squared
           when combined with "peak_detect".

       contrast_recovery
           Contrast recovery strength. If set to a value above 0.0, the source image will be divided into high-
           frequency and low-frequency components, and a portion of the high-frequency image is added back onto
           the tone-mapped output.  May cause excessive ringing artifacts for some HDR sources, but can improve
           the subjective sharpness and detail left over in the image after tone-mapping.  Defaults to 0.30.

       contrast_smoothness
           Contrast recovery lowpass kernel size. Defaults to 3.5. Increasing or decreasing this will affect the
           visual appearance substantially. Has no effect when "contrast_recovery" is disabled.

       Dithering

       By default, libplacebo will dither whenever necessary, which includes rendering to any integer format
       below 16-bit precision. It's recommended to always leave this on, since not doing so may result in
       visible banding in the output, even if the "debanding" filter is enabled. If maximum performance is
       needed, use "ordered_fixed" instead of disabling dithering.

       dithering
           Dithering method to use. Accepts the following values:

           none
               Disables dithering completely. May result in visible banding.

           blue
               Dither with pseudo-blue noise. This is the default.

           ordered
               Tunable ordered dither pattern.

           ordered_fixed
               Faster ordered dither with a fixed size of 6. Texture-less.

           white
               Dither with white noise. Texture-less.

       dither_lut_size
           Dither LUT size, as log base2 between 1 and 8. Defaults to 6, corresponding to a LUT size of "64x64".

       dither_temporal
           Enables temporal dithering. Disabled by default.

       Custom shaders

       libplacebo supports a number of custom shaders based on the mpv .hook GLSL syntax. A collection of such
       shaders can be found here: <https://github.com/mpv-player/mpv/wiki/User-Scripts#user-shaders>

       A full description of the mpv shader format is beyond the scope of this section, but a summary can be
       found here: <https://mpv.io/manual/master/#options-glsl-shader>

       custom_shader_path
           Specifies a path to a custom shader file to load at runtime.

       custom_shader_bin
           Specifies a complete custom shader as a raw string.

       Debugging / performance

       All of the options in this section default off. They may be of assistance when attempting to squeeze the
       maximum performance at the cost of quality.

       skip_aa
           Disable anti-aliasing when downscaling.

       polar_cutoff
           Truncate polar (EWA) scaler kernels below this absolute magnitude, between 0.0 and 1.0.

       disable_linear
           Disable linear light scaling.

       disable_builtin
           Disable built-in GPU sampling (forces LUT).

       disable_fbos
           Forcibly disable FBOs, resulting in loss of almost all functionality, but offering the maximum
           possible speed.

       Commands

       This filter supports almost all of the above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Tone-map input to standard gamut BT.709 output:

                   libplacebo=colorspace=bt709:color_primaries=bt709:color_trc=bt709:range=tv

       •   Rescale input to fit into standard 1080p, with high quality scaling:

                   libplacebo=w=1920:h=1080:force_original_aspect_ratio=decrease:normalize_sar=true:upscaler=ewa_lanczos:downscaler=ewa_lanczos

       •   Interpolate low FPS / VFR input to smoothed constant 60 fps output:

                   libplacebo=fps=60:frame_mixer=mitchell_clamp

       •   Convert input to standard sRGB JPEG:

                   libplacebo=format=yuv420p:colorspace=bt470bg:color_primaries=bt709:color_trc=iec61966-2-1:range=pc

       •   Use higher quality debanding settings:

                   libplacebo=deband=true:deband_iterations=3:deband_radius=8:deband_threshold=6

       •   Run this filter on the CPU, on systems with Mesa installed (and with the most expensive options
           disabled):

                   ffmpeg ... -init_hw_device vulkan:llvmpipe ... -vf libplacebo=upscaler=none:downscaler=none:peak_detect=false

       •   Suppress CPU-based AV1/H.274 film grain application in the decoder, in favor of doing it with this
           filter. Note that this is only a gain if the frames are either already on the GPU, or if you're using
           libplacebo for other purposes, since otherwise the VRAM roundtrip will more than offset any expected
           speedup.

                   ffmpeg -export_side_data +film_grain ... -vf libplacebo=apply_filmgrain=true

       •   Interop with VAAPI hwdec to avoid round-tripping through RAM:

                   ffmpeg -init_hw_device vulkan -hwaccel vaapi -hwaccel_output_format vaapi ... -vf libplacebo

   libvmaf
       Calculate the VMAF (Video Multi-Method Assessment Fusion) score for a reference/distorted pair of input
       videos.

       The first input is the distorted video, and the second input is the reference video.

       The obtained VMAF score is printed through the logging system.

       It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.  After installing the library it can be
       enabled using: "./configure --enable-libvmaf".

       The filter has following options:

       model
           A `|` delimited list of vmaf models. Each model can be configured with a number of parameters.
           Default value: "version=vmaf_v0.6.1"

       feature
           A `|` delimited list of features. Each feature can be configured with a number of parameters.

       log_path
           Set the file path to be used to store log files.

       log_fmt
           Set the format of the log file (xml, json, csv, or sub).

       pool
           Set the pool method to be used for computing vmaf.  Options are "min", "harmonic_mean" or "mean"
           (default).

       n_threads
           Set number of threads to be used when initializing libvmaf.  Default value: 0, no threads.

       n_subsample
           Set frame subsampling interval to be used.

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

       Examples

       •   In the examples below, a distorted video distorted.mpg is compared with a reference file
           reference.mpg.

       •   Basic usage:

                   ffmpeg -i distorted.mpg -i reference.mpg -lavfi libvmaf=log_path=output.xml -f null -

       •   Example with multiple models:

                   ffmpeg -i distorted.mpg -i reference.mpg -lavfi libvmaf='model=version=vmaf_v0.6.1\\:name=vmaf|version=vmaf_v0.6.1neg\\:name=vmaf_neg' -f null -

       •   Example with multiple additional features:

                   ffmpeg -i distorted.mpg -i reference.mpg -lavfi libvmaf='feature=name=psnr|name=ciede' -f null -

       •   Example with options and different containers:

                   ffmpeg -i distorted.mpg -i reference.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]libvmaf=log_fmt=json:log_path=output.json" -f null -

   libvmaf_cuda
       This is the CUDA variant of the libvmaf filter. It only accepts CUDA frames.

       It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.  After installing the library it can be
       enabled using: "./configure --enable-nonfree --enable-ffnvcodec --enable-libvmaf".

       Examples

       •   Basic usage showing CUVID hardware decoding and CUDA scaling with scale_cuda:

                   ffmpeg \
                       -hwaccel cuda -hwaccel_output_format cuda -codec:v av1_cuvid -i dis.obu \
                       -hwaccel cuda -hwaccel_output_format cuda -codec:v av1_cuvid -i ref.obu \
                       -filter_complex "
                           [0:v]scale_cuda=format=yuv420p[ref]; \
                           [1:v]scale_cuda=format=yuv420p[dis]; \
                           [dis][ref]libvmaf_cuda=log_fmt=json:log_path=output.json
                       " \
                       -f null -

   limitdiff
       Apply limited difference filter using second and optionally third video stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       threshold
           Set the threshold to use when allowing certain differences between video streams.  Any absolute
           difference value lower or exact than this threshold will pick pixel components from first video
           stream.

       elasticity
           Set the elasticity of soft thresholding when processing video streams.  This value multiplied with
           first one sets second threshold.  Any absolute difference value greater or exact than second
           threshold will pick pixel components from second video stream. For values between those two threshold
           linear interpolation between first and second video stream will be used.

       reference
           Enable the reference (third) video stream processing. By default is disabled.  If set, this video
           stream will be used for calculating absolute difference with first video stream.

       planes
           Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands except option reference.

   limiter
       Limits the pixel components values to the specified range [min, max].

       The filter accepts the following options:

       min Lower bound. Defaults to the lowest allowed value for the input.

       max Upper bound. Defaults to the highest allowed value for the input.

       planes
           Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   loop
       Loop video frames.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       loop
           Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.  Default is 0.

       size
           Set maximal size in number of frames. Default is 0.

       start
           Set first frame of loop. Default is 0.

       time
           Set the time of loop start in seconds.  Only used if option named start is set to -1.

       Examples

       •   Loop single first frame infinitely:

                   loop=loop=-1:size=1:start=0

       •   Loop single first frame 10 times:

                   loop=loop=10:size=1:start=0

       •   Loop 10 first frames 5 times:

                   loop=loop=5:size=10:start=0

   lut1d
       Apply a 1D LUT to an input video.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       file
           Set the 1D LUT file name.

           Currently supported formats:

           cube
               Iridas

           csp cineSpace

       interp
           Select interpolation mode.

           Available values are:

           nearest
               Use values from the nearest defined point.

           linear
               Interpolate values using the linear interpolation.

           cosine
               Interpolate values using the cosine interpolation.

           cubic
               Interpolate values using the cubic interpolation.

           spline
               Interpolate values using the spline interpolation.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   lut3d
       Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       file
           Set the 3D LUT file name.

           Currently supported formats:

           3dl AfterEffects

           cube
               Iridas

           dat DaVinci

           m3d Pandora

           csp cineSpace

       interp
           Select interpolation mode.

           Available values are:

           nearest
               Use values from the nearest defined point.

           trilinear
               Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.

           tetrahedral
               Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.

           pyramid
               Interpolate values using a pyramid.

           prism
               Interpolate values using a prism.

       Commands

       This filter supports the "interp" option as commands.

   lumakey
       Turn certain luma values into transparency.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       threshold
           Set the luma which will be used as base for transparency.  Default value is 0.

       tolerance
           Set the range of luma values to be keyed out.  Default value is 0.01.

       softness
           Set the range of softness. Default value is 0.  Use this to control gradual transition from zero to
           full transparency.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
       Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value to an output value, and apply it to
       the input video.

       lutyuv applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, lutrgb to an RGB input video.

       These filters accept the following parameters:

       c0  set first pixel component expression

       c1  set second pixel component expression

       c2  set third pixel component expression

       c3  set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component

       r   set red component expression

       g   set green component expression

       b   set blue component expression

       a   alpha component expression

       y   set Y/luma component expression

       u   set U/Cb component expression

       v   set V/Cr component expression

       Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for the corresponding pixel
       component values.

       The exact component associated to each of the c* options depends on the format in input.

       The lut filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input, lutrgb requires RGB pixel formats in
       input, and lutyuv requires YUV.

       The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:

       w
       h   The input width and height.

       val The input value for the pixel component.

       clipval
           The input value, clipped to the minval-maxval range.

       maxval
           The maximum value for the pixel component.

       minval
           The minimum value for the pixel component.

       negval
           The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the minval-maxval range; it corresponds
           to the expression "maxval-clipval+minval".

       clip(val)
           The computed value in val, clipped to the minval-maxval range.

       gammaval(gamma)
           The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value, clipped to the minval-maxval range.
           It corresponds to the expression
           "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,gamma)*(maxval-minval)+minval"

       All expressions default to "clipval".

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

       Examples

       •   Negate input video:

                   lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
                   lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"

           The above is the same as:

                   lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
                   lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"

       •   Negate luma:

                   lutyuv=y=negval

       •   Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:

                   lutyuv="u=128:v=128"

       •   Apply a luma burning effect:

                   lutyuv="y=2*val"

       •   Remove green and blue components:

                   lutrgb="g=0:b=0"

       •   Set a constant alpha channel value on input:

                   format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"

       •   Correct luma gamma by a factor of 0.5:

                   lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)

       •   Discard least significant bits of luma:

                   lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'

       •   Technicolor like effect:

                   lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'

   lut2, tlut2
       The "lut2" filter takes two input streams and outputs one stream.

       The "tlut2" (time lut2) filter takes two consecutive frames from one single stream.

       This filter accepts the following parameters:

       c0  set first pixel component expression

       c1  set second pixel component expression

       c2  set third pixel component expression

       c3  set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component

       d   set output bit depth, only available for "lut2" filter. By default is 0, which means bit depth is
           automatically picked from first input format.

       The "lut2" filter also supports the framesync options.

       Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for the corresponding pixel
       component values.

       The exact component associated to each of the c* options depends on the format in inputs.

       The expressions can contain the following constants:

       w
       h   The input width and height.

       x   The first input value for the pixel component.

       y   The second input value for the pixel component.

       bdx The first input video bit depth.

       bdy The second input video bit depth.

       All expressions default to "x".

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands except option "d".

       Examples

       •   Highlight differences between two RGB video streams:

                   lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1)'

       •   Highlight differences between two YUV video streams:

                   lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1)'

       •   Show max difference between two video streams:

                   lut2='if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1)))'

   maskedclamp
       Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.

       Returns the value of first stream to be between second input stream - "undershoot" and third input stream
       + "overshoot".

       This filter accepts the following options:

       undershoot
           Default value is 0.

       overshoot
           Default value is 0.

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be copied from first stream.
           By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   maskedmax
       Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences between second
       input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between third input stream and first input
       stream. The picked value will be from second input stream if second absolute difference is greater than
       first one or from third input stream otherwise.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be copied from first stream.
           By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   maskedmerge
       Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel weights in the third input
       stream.

       A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component from first stream is returned
       unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream
       is returned unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both input stream's pixel
       components.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be copied from first stream.
           By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   maskedmin
       Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences between second
       input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between third input stream and first input
       stream. The picked value will be from second input stream if second absolute difference is less than
       first one or from third input stream otherwise.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be copied from first stream.
           By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   maskedthreshold
       Pick pixels comparing absolute difference of two video streams with fixed threshold.

       If absolute difference between pixel component of first and second video stream is equal or lower than
       user supplied threshold than pixel component from first video stream is picked, otherwise pixel component
       from second video stream is picked.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       threshold
           Set threshold used when picking pixels from absolute difference from two input video streams.

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be copied from second stream.
           By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.

       mode
           Set mode of filter operation. Can be "abs" or "diff".  Default is "abs".

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   maskfun
       Create mask from input video.

       For example it is useful to create motion masks after "tblend" filter.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       low Set low threshold. Any pixel component lower or exact than this value will be set to 0.

       high
           Set high threshold. Any pixel component higher than this value will be set to max value allowed for
           current pixel format.

       planes
           Set planes to filter, by default all available planes are filtered.

       fill
           Fill all frame pixels with this value.

       sum Set max average pixel value for frame. If sum of all pixel components is higher that this average,
           output frame will be completely filled with value set by fill option.  Typically useful for scene
           changes when used in combination with "tblend" filter.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   mcdeint
       Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.

       It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       mode
           Set the deinterlacing mode.

           It accepts one of the following values:

           fast
           medium
           slow
               use iterative motion estimation

           extra_slow
               like slow, but use multiple reference frames.

           Default value is fast.

       parity
           Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be one of the following values:

           0, tff
               assume top field first

           1, bff
               assume bottom field first

           Default value is bff.

       qp  Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal encoder.

           Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less optimal individual vectors.
           Default value is 1.

   median
       Pick median pixel from certain rectangle defined by radius.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       radius
           Set horizontal radius size. Default value is 1.  Allowed range is integer from 1 to 127.

       planes
           Set which planes to process. Default is 15, which is all available planes.

       radiusV
           Set vertical radius size. Default value is 0.  Allowed range is integer from 0 to 127.  If it is 0,
           value will be picked from horizontal "radius" option.

       percentile
           Set median percentile. Default value is 0.5.  Default value of 0.5 will pick always median values,
           while 0 will pick minimum values, and 1 maximum values.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   mergeplanes
       Merge color channel components from several video streams.

       The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input planes to the output video.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       mapping
           Set input to output plane mapping. Default is 0.

           The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a hexadecimal number in the form
           0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the
           number of the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the corresponding input
           to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output
           stream second plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and 'Dd' describes
           the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.

       format
           Set output pixel format. Default is "yuva444p".

       map0s
       map1s
       map2s
       map3s
           Set input to output stream mapping for output Nth plane. Default is 0.

       map0p
       map1p
       map2p
       map3p
           Set input to output plane mapping for output Nth plane. Default is 0.

       Examples

       •   Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:

                   [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p

       •   Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:

                   [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p

       •   Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:

                   format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p

       •   Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:

                   format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p

       •   Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:

                   format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p

   mestimate
       Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.  Motion vectors are stored in frame
       side data to be used by other filters.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       method
           Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:

           esa Exhaustive search algorithm.

           tss Three step search algorithm.

           tdls
               Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.

           ntss
               New three step search algorithm.

           fss Four step search algorithm.

           ds  Diamond search algorithm.

           hexbs
               Hexagon-based search algorithm.

           epzs
               Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.

           umh Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.

           Default value is esa.

       mb_size
           Macroblock size. Default 16.

       search_param
           Search parameter. Default 7.

   midequalizer
       Apply Midway Image Equalization effect using two video streams.

       Midway Image Equalization adjusts a pair of images to have the same histogram, while maintaining their
       dynamics as much as possible. It's useful for e.g. matching exposures from a pair of stereo cameras.

       This filter has two inputs and one output, which must be of same pixel format, but may be of different
       sizes. The output of filter is first input adjusted with midway histogram of both inputs.

       This filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes to process. Default is 15, which is all available planes.

   minterpolate
       Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       fps Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. "60000/1001". Frames are dropped if fps is
           lower than source fps. Default 60.

       mi_mode
           Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:

           dup Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.

           blend
               Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.

           mci Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:

               mc_mode
                   Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:

                   obmc
                       Overlapped block motion compensation.

                   aobmc
                       Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are
                       controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to
                       reduce oversmoothing.

                   Default mode is obmc.

               me_mode
                   Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:

                   bidir
                       Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in
                       both forward and backward directions.

                   bilat
                       Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated
                       frame.

                   Default mode is bilat.

               me  The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:

                   esa Exhaustive search algorithm.

                   tss Three step search algorithm.

                   tdls
                       Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.

                   ntss
                       New three step search algorithm.

                   fss Four step search algorithm.

                   ds  Diamond search algorithm.

                   hexbs
                       Hexagon-based search algorithm.

                   epzs
                       Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.

                   umh Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.

                   Default algorithm is epzs.

               mb_size
                   Macroblock size. Default 16.

               search_param
                   Motion estimation search parameter. Default 32.

               vsbmc
                   Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller
                   block sizes at object boundaries in order to make them less blurry. Default is 0 (disabled).

       scd Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene
           change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes.
           Following values are accepted:

           none
               Disable scene change detection.

           fdiff
               Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it satisfies scd_threshold scene
               change is detected.

           Default method is fdiff.

       scd_threshold
           Scene change detection threshold. Default is 10..

   mix
       Mix several video input streams into one video stream.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       inputs
           The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.

       weights
           Specify weight of each input video stream as sequence.  Each weight is separated by space. If number
           of weights is smaller than number of frames last specified weight will be used for all remaining
           unset weights.

       scale
           Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum of each weight multiplied with pixel
           values to give final destination pixel value. By default scale is auto scaled to sum of weights.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.

       duration
           Specify how end of stream is determined.

           longest
               The duration of the longest input. (default)

           shortest
               The duration of the shortest input.

           first
               The duration of the first input.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       weights
       scale
       planes
           Syntax is same as option with same name.

   monochrome
       Convert video to gray using custom color filter.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       cb  Set the chroma blue spot. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.  Default value is 0.

       cr  Set the chroma red spot. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.  Default value is 0.

       size
           Set the color filter size. Allowed range is from .1 to 10.  Default value is 1.

       high
           Set the highlights strength. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is 0.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   morpho
       This filter allows to apply main morphological grayscale transforms, erode and dilate with arbitrary
       structures set in second input stream.

       Unlike naive implementation and much slower performance in erosion and dilation filters, when speed is
       critical "morpho" filter should be used instead.

       A description of accepted options follows,

       mode
           Set morphological transform to apply, can be:

           erode
           dilate
           open
           close
           gradient
           tophat
           blackhat

           Default is "erode".

       planes
           Set planes to filter, by default all planes except alpha are filtered.

       structure
           Set which structure video frames will be processed from second input stream, can be first or all.
           Default is all.

       The "morpho" filter also supports the framesync options.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   mpdecimate
       Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in order to reduce frame rate.

       The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it
       could in theory be used for fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       max Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if positive), or the minimum
           interval between dropped frames (if negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding
           the number of previous sequentially dropped frames.

           Default value is 0.

       keep
           Set the maximum number of consecutive similar frames to ignore before to start dropping them.  If the
           value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding the number of previous sequentially similar frames.

           Default value is 0.

       hi
       lo
       frac
           Set the dropping threshold values.

           Values for hi and lo are for 8x8 pixel blocks and represent actual pixel value differences, so a
           threshold of 64 corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread out
           differently over the block.

           A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more than a threshold of hi, and if no
           more than frac blocks (1 meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of lo.

           Default value for hi is 64*12, default value for lo is 64*5, and default value for frac is 0.33.

   msad
       Obtain the MSAD (Mean Sum of Absolute Differences) between two input videos.

       This filter takes two input videos.

       Both input videos must have the same resolution and pixel format for this filter to work correctly. Also
       it assumes that both inputs have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.

       The obtained per component, average, min and max MSAD is printed through the logging system.

       The filter stores the calculated MSAD of each frame in frame metadata.

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

       In the below example the input file main.mpg being processed is compared with the reference file ref.mpg.

               ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi msad -f null -

   multiply
       Multiply first video stream pixels values with second video stream pixels values.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       scale
           Set the scale applied to second video stream. By default is 1.  Allowed range is from 0 to 9.

       offset
           Set the offset applied to second video stream. By default is 0.5.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1.

       planes
           Specify planes from input video stream that will be processed.  By default all planes are processed.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   negate
       Negate (invert) the input video.

       It accepts the following option:

       components
           Set components to negate.

           Available values for components are:

           y
           u
           v
           a
           r
           g
           b
       negate_alpha
           With value 1, it negates the alpha component, if present. Default value is 0.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   nlmeans
       Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm.

       Each pixel is adjusted by looking for other pixels with similar contexts. This context similarity is
       defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size pxp. Patches are searched in an area of rxr around
       the pixel.

       Note that the research area defines centers for patches, which means some patches will be made of pixels
       outside that research area.

       The filter accepts the following options.

       s   Set denoising strength. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 30.0].

       p   Set patch size. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].

       pc  Same as p but for chroma planes.

           The default value is 0 and means automatic.

       r   Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].

       rc  Same as r but for chroma planes.

           The default value is 0 and means automatic.

   nnedi
       Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       weights
           Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.  Currently file can be found here:
           https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin

       deint
           Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is "all".  Can be "all" or "interlaced".

       field
           Set mode of operation.

           Can be one of the following:

           af  Use frame flags, both fields.

           a   Use frame flags, single field.

           t   Use top field only.

           b   Use bottom field only.

           tf  Use both fields, top first.

           bf  Use both fields, bottom first.

       planes
           Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.

       nsize
           Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural network.

           Can be one of the following:

           s8x6
           s16x6
           s32x6
           s48x6
           s8x4
           s16x4
           s32x4
       nns Set the number of neurons in predictor neural network.  Can be one of the following:

           n16
           n32
           n64
           n128
           n256
       qual
           Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended together to compute the
           final output value. Can be "fast", default or "slow".

       etype
           Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.  Can be one of the following:

           a, abs
               weights trained to minimize absolute error

           s, mse
               weights trained to minimize squared error

       pscrn
           Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide which pixels should be
           processed by the predictor neural network and which can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
           The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be sufficient for a pixel or
           whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.  The computational complexity of the prescreener
           nn is much less than that of the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic
           interpolation, using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.  The prescreener is
           pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not using it is almost always unnoticeable.

           Can be one of the following:

           none
           original
           new
           new2
           new3

           Default is "new".

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options, excluding weights option.

   noformat
       Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the input to the next filter.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       pix_fmts
           A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".

       Examples

       •   Force libavfilter to use a format different from yuv420p for the input to the vflip filter:

                   noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip

       •   Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:

                   noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p

   noise
       Add noise on video input frame.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       all_seed
       c0_seed
       c1_seed
       c2_seed
       c3_seed
           Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case of all_seed. Default
           value is 123457.

       all_strength, alls
       c0_strength, c0s
       c1_strength, c1s
       c2_strength, c2s
       c3_strength, c3s
           Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case all_strength. Default
           value is 0. Allowed range is [0, 100].

       all_flags, allf
       c0_flags, c0f
       c1_flags, c1f
       c2_flags, c2f
       c3_flags, c3f
           Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if all_flags.  Available values for
           component flags are:

           a   averaged temporal noise (smoother)

           p   mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern

           t   temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)

           u   uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)

       Examples

       Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:

               noise=alls=20:allf=t+u

   normalize
       Normalize RGB video (aka histogram stretching, contrast stretching).  See:
       https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normalization_(image_processing)

       For each channel of each frame, the filter computes the input range and maps it linearly to the user-
       specified output range. The output range defaults to the full dynamic range from pure black to pure
       white.

       Temporal smoothing can be used on the input range to reduce flickering (rapid changes in brightness)
       caused when small dark or bright objects enter or leave the scene. This is similar to the auto-exposure
       (automatic gain control) on a video camera, and, like a video camera, it may cause a period of over- or
       under-exposure of the video.

       The R,G,B channels can be normalized independently, which may cause some color shifting, or linked
       together as a single channel, which prevents color shifting. Linked normalization preserves hue.
       Independent normalization does not, so it can be used to remove some color casts. Independent and linked
       normalization can be combined in any ratio.

       The normalize filter accepts the following options:

       blackpt
       whitept
           Colors which define the output range. The minimum input value is mapped to the blackpt. The maximum
           input value is mapped to the whitept.  The defaults are black and white respectively. Specifying
           white for blackpt and black for whitept will give color-inverted, normalized video. Shades of grey
           can be used to reduce the dynamic range (contrast). Specifying saturated colors here can create some
           interesting effects.

       smoothing
           The number of previous frames to use for temporal smoothing. The input range of each channel is
           smoothed using a rolling average over the current frame and the smoothing previous frames. The
           default is 0 (no temporal smoothing).

       independence
           Controls the ratio of independent (color shifting) channel normalization to linked (color preserving)
           normalization. 0.0 is fully linked, 1.0 is fully independent. Defaults to 1.0 (fully independent).

       strength
           Overall strength of the filter. 1.0 is full strength. 0.0 is a rather expensive no-op. Defaults to
           1.0 (full strength).

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options, excluding smoothing option.  The command accepts the same
       syntax of the corresponding option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

       Examples

       Stretch video contrast to use the full dynamic range, with no temporal smoothing; may flicker depending
       on the source content:

               normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=0

       As above, but with 50 frames of temporal smoothing; flicker should be reduced, depending on the source
       content:

               normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50

       As above, but with hue-preserving linked channel normalization:

               normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0

       As above, but with half strength:

               normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0:strength=0.5

       Map the darkest input color to red, the brightest input color to cyan:

               normalize=blackpt=red:whitept=cyan

   null
       Pass the video source unchanged to the output.

   ocr
       Optical Character Recognition

       This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition. To enable compilation of this filter, you
       need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libtesseract".

       It accepts the following options:

       datapath
           Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was set at installation.

       language
           Set language, default is "eng".

       whitelist
           Set character whitelist.

       blacklist
           Set character blacklist.

       The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata "lavfi.ocr.text".  The filter exports confidence
       of recognized words as the frame metadata "lavfi.ocr.confidence".

   ocv
       Apply a video transform using libopencv.

       To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and configure FFmpeg with
       "--enable-libopencv".

       It accepts the following parameters:

       filter_name
           The name of the libopencv filter to apply.

       filter_params
           The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default values are assumed.

       Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise information:
       <http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html>

       Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.

       dilate

       Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.  It corresponds to the libopencv function
       "cvDilate".

       It accepts the parameters: struct_el|nb_iterations.

       struct_el represents a structuring element, and has the syntax: colsxrows+anchor_xxanchor_y/shape

       cols and rows represent the number of columns and rows of the structuring element, anchor_x and anchor_y
       the anchor point, and shape the shape for the structuring element. shape must be "rect", "cross",
       "ellipse", or "custom".

       If the value for shape is "custom", it must be followed by a string of the form "=filename". The file
       with name filename is assumed to represent a binary image, with each printable character corresponding to
       a bright pixel. When a custom shape is used, cols and rows are ignored, the number or columns and rows of
       the read file are assumed instead.

       The default value for struct_el is "3x3+0x0/rect".

       nb_iterations specifies the number of times the transform is applied to the image, and defaults to 1.

       Some examples:

               # Use the default values
               ocv=dilate

               # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
               ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2

               # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
               # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
               #   *
               #  ***
               # *****
               #  ***
               #   *
               # The specified columns and rows are ignored
               # but the anchor point coordinates are not
               ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2

       erode

       Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.  It corresponds to the libopencv function
       "cvErode".

       It accepts the parameters: struct_el:nb_iterations, with the same syntax and semantics as the dilate
       filter.

       smooth

       Smooth the input video.

       The filter takes the following parameters: type|param1|param2|param3|param4.

       type is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of the following values: "blur",
       "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian", or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".

       The meaning of param1, param2, param3, and param4 depends on the smooth type. param1 and param2 accept
       integer positive values or 0. param3 and param4 accept floating point values.

       The default value for param1 is 3. The default value for the other parameters is 0.

       These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the libopencv function "cvSmooth".

   oscilloscope
       2D Video Oscilloscope.

       Useful to measure spatial impulse, step responses, chroma delays, etc.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       x   Set scope center x position.

       y   Set scope center y position.

       s   Set scope size, relative to frame diagonal.

       t   Set scope tilt/rotation.

       o   Set trace opacity.

       tx  Set trace center x position.

       ty  Set trace center y position.

       tw  Set trace width, relative to width of frame.

       th  Set trace height, relative to height of frame.

       c   Set which components to trace. By default it traces first three components.

       g   Draw trace grid. By default is enabled.

       st  Draw some statistics. By default is enabled.

       sc  Draw scope. By default is enabled.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
       option.

       If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

       Examples

       •   Inspect full first row of video frame.

                   oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=0:s=1

       •   Inspect full last row of video frame.

                   oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=1:s=1

       •   Inspect full 5th line of video frame of height 1080.

                   oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=5/1080:s=1

       •   Inspect full last column of video frame.

                   oscilloscope=x=1:y=0.5:s=1:t=1

   overlay
       Overlay one video on top of another.

       It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is
       overlaid.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       x
       y   Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video on the main video. Default value
           is "0" for both expressions. In case the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning
           that the overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).

       eof_action
           See framesync.

       eval
           Set when the expressions for x, and y are evaluated.

           It accepts the following values:

           init
               only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed

           frame
               evaluate expressions for each incoming frame

           Default value is frame.

       shortest
           See framesync.

       format
           Set the format for the output video.

           It accepts the following values:

           yuv420
               force YUV 4:2:0 8-bit planar output

           yuv420p10
               force YUV 4:2:0 10-bit planar output

           yuv422
               force YUV 4:2:2 8-bit planar output

           yuv422p10
               force YUV 4:2:2 10-bit planar output

           yuv444
               force YUV 4:4:4 8-bit planar output

           yuv444p10
               force YUV 4:4:4 10-bit planar output

           rgb force RGB 8-bit packed output

           gbrp
               force RGB 8-bit planar output

           auto
               automatically pick format

           Default value is yuv420.

       repeatlast
           See framesync.

       alpha
           Set format of alpha of the overlaid video, it can be straight or premultiplied. Default is straight.

       The x, and y expressions can contain the following parameters.

       main_w, W
       main_h, H
           The main input width and height.

       overlay_w, w
       overlay_h, h
           The overlay input width and height.

       x
       y   The computed values for x and y. They are evaluated for each new frame.

       hsub
       vsub
           horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output format. For example for the pixel
           format "yuv422p" hsub is 2 and vsub is 1.

       n   the number of input frame, starting from 0

       pos the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown; deprecated, do not use

       t   The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

       Note that the n, t variables are available only when evaluation is done per frame, and will evaluate to
       NAN when eval is set to init.

       Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp order, hence, if their initial
       timestamps differ, it is a good idea to pass the two inputs through a setpts=PTS-STARTPTS filter to have
       them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for the movie filter does.

       You can chain together more overlays but you should test the efficiency of such approach.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       x
       y   Modify the x and y of the overlay input.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
           option.

           If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

       Examples

       •   Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main video:

                   overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10

           Using named options the example above becomes:

                   overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10

       •   Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input, using the ffmpeg tool with the
           "-filter_complex" option:

                   ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output

       •   Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom right corner) using the ffmpeg tool:

                   ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output

       •   Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; "WxH" must specify the size of the main input
           to the overlay filter:

                   color=color=red@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]

       •   Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake filter) side by side using the
           ffplay tool:

                   ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'

           The above command is the same as:

                   ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'

       •   Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the screen starting since
           time 2:

                   overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0

       •   Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:

                   ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
                   nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
                   [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
                   [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
                   [background][left]       overlay=shortest=1       [background+left];
                   [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
                   "

       •   Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section

                   ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
                   -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
                   masked.avi

       •   Chain several overlays in cascade:

                   nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
                   testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
                   [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg]   overlay=0:0     [mid0];
                   [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0   [mid1];
                   [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100   [mid2];
                   [in3] null,       [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]

   overlay_cuda
       Overlay one video on top of another.

       This is the CUDA variant of the overlay filter.  It only accepts CUDA frames. The underlying input pixel
       formats have to match.

       It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is
       overlaid.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       x
       y   Set expressions for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video on the main video.

           They can contain the following parameters:

           main_w, W
           main_h, H
               The main input width and height.

           overlay_w, w
           overlay_h, h
               The overlay input width and height.

           x
           y   The computed values for x and y. They are evaluated for each new frame.

           n   The ordinal index of the main input frame, starting from 0.

           pos The byte offset position in the file of the main input frame, NAN if unknown.  Deprecated, do not
               use.

           t   The timestamp of the main input frame, expressed in seconds, NAN if unknown.

           Default value is "0" for both expressions.

       eval
           Set when the expressions for x and y are evaluated.

           It accepts the following values:

           init
               Evaluate expressions once during filter initialization or when a command is processed.

           frame
               Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame

           Default value is frame.

       eof_action
           See framesync.

       shortest
           See framesync.

       repeatlast
           See framesync.

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

   owdenoise
       Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       depth
           Set depth.

           Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but slow down filtering.

           Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is 8.

       luma_strength, ls
           Set luma strength.

           Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is 1.0.

       chroma_strength, cs
           Set chroma strength.

           Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is 1.0.

   pad
       Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the provided x, y coordinates.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       width, w
       height, h
           Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the paddings added. If the value for
           width or height is 0, the corresponding input size is used for the output.

           The width expression can reference the value set by the height expression, and vice versa.

           The default value of width and height is 0.

       x
       y   Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area, with respect to the top/left
           border of the output image.

           The x expression can reference the value set by the y expression, and vice versa.

           The default value of x and y is 0.

           If x or y evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed so the input image is centered on the
           padded area.

       color
           Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
           ffmpeg-utils manual.

           The default value of color is "black".

       eval
           Specify when to evaluate  width, height, x and y expression.

           It accepts the following values:

           init
               Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.

           frame
               Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.

           Default value is init.

       aspect
           Pad to aspect instead to a resolution.

       The value for the width, height, x, and y options are expressions containing the following constants:

       in_w
       in_h
           The input video width and height.

       iw
       ih  These are the same as in_w and in_h.

       out_w
       out_h
           The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as specified by the width and height
           expressions.

       ow
       oh  These are the same as out_w and out_h.

       x
       y   The x and y offsets as specified by the x and y expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.

       a   same as iw / ih

       sar input sample aspect ratio

       dar input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (iw / ih) * sar

       hsub
       vsub
           The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" hsub
           is 2 and vsub is 1.

       Examples

       •   Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video size is 640x480, and the
           top-left corner of the input video is placed at column 0, row 40

                   pad=640:480:0:40:violet

           The example above is equivalent to the following command:

                   pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet

       •   Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2, and put the input video at the
           center of the padded area:

                   pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"

       •   Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum value between the input width
           and height, and put the input video at the center of the padded area:

                   pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"

       •   Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:

                   pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"

       •   In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect correctly, it is necessary to
           use sar in the expression, according to the relation:

                   (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
                   X = output_dar / sar

           Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:

                   pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"

       •   Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right corner of the output padded area:

                   pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"

   palettegen
       Generate one palette for a whole video stream.

       It accepts the following options:

       max_colors
           Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.  Note: the palette will still contain
           256 colors; the unused palette entries will be black.

       reserve_transparent
           Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for transparency. Reserving the
           transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.  If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette
           will be 256. You probably want to disable this option for a standalone image.  Set by default.

       transparency_color
           Set the color that will be used as background for transparency.

       stats_mode
           Set statistics mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           full
               Compute full frame histograms.

           diff
               Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This might be relevant to
               give more importance to the moving part of your input if the background is static.

           single
               Compute new histogram for each frame.

           Default value is full.

       The filter also exports the frame metadata "lavfi.color_quant_ratio" ("nb_color_in / nb_color_out") which
       you can use to evaluate the degree of color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible
       at info logging level.

       Examples

       •   Generate a representative palette of a given video using ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png

   paletteuse
       Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.

       The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must be a 256 pixels image.

       It accepts the following options:

       dither
           Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:

           bayer
               Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)

           heckbert
               Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).  Note: this dithering is
               sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a reference.

           floyd_steinberg
               Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)

           sierra2
               Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)

           sierra2_4a
               Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)

           sierra3
               Frankie Sierra dithering v3 (error diffusion)

           burkes
               Burkes dithering (error diffusion)

           atkinson
               Atkinson dithering by Bill Atkinson at Apple Computer (error diffusion)

           none
               Disable dithering.

           Default is sierra2_4a.

       bayer_scale
           When bayer dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the pattern (how much the
           crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more visible pattern for less banding, and higher
           value means less visible pattern at the cost of more banding.

           The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is 2.

       diff_mode
           If set, define the zone to process

           rectangle
               Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF cropping/offsetting
               compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed if only a part of the image is
               changing, and has use cases such as limiting the scope of the error diffusal dither to the
               rectangle that bounds the moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene
               doesn't change much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).

           Default is none.

       new Take new palette for each output frame.

       alpha_threshold
           Sets the alpha threshold for transparency. Alpha values above this threshold will be treated as
           completely opaque, and values below this threshold will be treated as completely transparent.

           The option must be an integer value in the range [0,255]. Default is 128.

       Examples

       •   Use a palette (generated for example with palettegen) to encode a GIF using ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif

   perspective
       Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.

       A description of the accepted parameters follows.

       x0
       y0
       x1
       y1
       x2
       y2
       x3
       y3  Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.  Default
           values are "0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H" with which perspective will remain unchanged.  If the "sense" option is
           set to "source", then the specified points will be sent to the corners of the destination. If the
           "sense" option is set to "destination", then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified
           coordinates.

           The expressions can use the following variables:

           W
           H   the width and height of video frame.

           in  Input frame count.

           on  Output frame count.

       interpolation
           Set interpolation for perspective correction.

           It accepts the following values:

           linear
           cubic

           Default value is linear.

       sense
           Set interpretation of coordinate options.

           It accepts the following values:

           0, source
               Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to the corners of the destination.

           1, destination
               Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified by the given
               coordinates.

               Default value is source.

       eval
           Set when the expressions for coordinates x0,y0,...x3,y3 are evaluated.

           It accepts the following values:

           init
               only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed

           frame
               evaluate expressions for each incoming frame

           Default value is init.

   phase
       Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.

       The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the opposite field order to the film-
       to-video transfer.

       A description of the accepted parameters follows.

       mode
           Set phase mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           t   Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.  Filter will delay the bottom field.

           b   Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.  Filter will delay the top field.

           p   Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists for the documentation of
               the other options to refer to, but if you actually select it, the filter will faithfully do
               nothing.

           a   Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer opposite.  Filter selects
               among t and b modes on a frame by frame basis using field flags. If no field information is
               available, then this works just like u.

           u   Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.  Filter selects among t and b on a frame by frame
               basis by analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best match between the
               fields.

           T   Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.  Filter selects among t and p using image
               analysis.

           B   Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.  Filter selects among b and p using image
               analysis.

           A   Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.  Filter selects among t, b and p
               using field flags and image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
               like U. This is the default mode.

           U   Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.  Filter selects among t, b and p using image
               analysis only.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   photosensitivity
       Reduce various flashes in video, so to help users with epilepsy.

       It accepts the following options:

       frames, f
           Set how many frames to use when filtering. Default is 30.

       threshold, t
           Set detection threshold factor. Default is 1.  Lower is stricter.

       skip
           Set how many pixels to skip when sampling frames. Default is 1.  Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.

       bypass
           Leave frames unchanged. Default is disabled.

   pixdesctest
       Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal testing. The output video should be equal
       to the input video.

       For example:

               format=monow, pixdesctest

       can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.

   pixelize
       Apply pixelization to video stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       width, w
       height, h
           Set block dimensions that will be used for pixelization.  Default value is 16.

       mode, m
           Set the mode of pixelization used.

           Possible values are:

           avg
           min
           max

           Default value is "avg".

       planes, p
           Set what planes to filter. Default is to filter all planes.

       Commands

       This filter supports all options as commands.

   pixscope
       Display sample values of color channels. Mainly useful for checking color and levels. Minimum supported
       resolution is 640x480.

       The filters accept the following options:

       x   Set scope X position, relative offset on X axis.

       y   Set scope Y position, relative offset on Y axis.

       w   Set scope width.

       h   Set scope height.

       o   Set window opacity. This window also holds statistics about pixel area.

       wx  Set window X position, relative offset on X axis.

       wy  Set window Y position, relative offset on Y axis.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   pp
       Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This library should be
       automatically selected with a GPL build ("--enable-gpl").  Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be
       disabled by prepending a '-'.  Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be
       used interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.

       The filters accept the following options:

       subfilters
           Set postprocessing subfilters string.

       All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:

       a/autoq
           Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.

       c/chrom
           Do chrominance filtering, too (default).

       y/nochrom
           Do luma filtering only (no chrominance).

       n/noluma
           Do chrominance filtering only (no luma).

       These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.

       Available subfilters are:

       hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
           Horizontal deblocking filter

           difference
               Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: 32).

           flatness
               Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: 39).

       vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
           Vertical deblocking filter

           difference
               Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: 32).

           flatness
               Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: 39).

       ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
           Accurate horizontal deblocking filter

           difference
               Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: 32).

           flatness
               Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: 39).

       va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
           Accurate vertical deblocking filter

           difference
               Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: 32).

           flatness
               Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: 39).

       The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and flatness values so you cannot set
       different horizontal and vertical thresholds.

       h1/x1hdeblock
           Experimental horizontal deblocking filter

       v1/x1vdeblock
           Experimental vertical deblocking filter

       dr/dering
           Deringing filter

       tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
           threshold1
               larger -> stronger filtering

           threshold2
               larger -> stronger filtering

           threshold3
               larger -> stronger filtering

       al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
           f/fullyrange
               Stretch luma to "0-255".

       lb/linblenddeint
           Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering all lines with a "(1
           2 1)" filter.

       li/linipoldeint
           Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by linearly interpolating
           every second line.

       ci/cubicipoldeint
           Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by cubically interpolating
           every second line.

       md/mediandeint
           Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a median filter to every
           second line.

       fd/ffmpegdeint
           FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every second line with a
           "(-1 4 2 4 -1)" filter.

       l5/lowpass5
           Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering
           all lines with a "(-1 2 6 2 -1)" filter.

       fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
           Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you specify.

           quantizer
               Quantizer to use

       de/default
           Default pp filter combination ("hb|a,vb|a,dr|a")

       fa/fast
           Fast pp filter combination ("h1|a,v1|a,dr|a")

       ac  High quality pp filter combination ("ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a")

       Examples

       •   Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic brightness/contrast:

                   pp=hb/vb/dr/al

       •   Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:

                   pp=de/-al

       •   Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:

                   pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3

       •   Apply deblocking on luma only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off automatically depending on
           available CPU time:

                   pp=hb|y/vb|a

   pp7
       Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the spp filter, similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT,
       where only the center sample is used after IDCT.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       qp  Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0 to 63. If not set, the
           filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).

       mode
           Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:

           hard
               Set hard thresholding.

           soft
               Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).

           medium
               Set medium thresholding (good results, default).

   premultiply
       Apply alpha premultiply effect to input video stream using first plane of second stream as alpha.

       Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.  By default value 0xf, all
           planes will be processed.

       inplace
           Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.

   prewitt
       Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.  By default value 0xf, all
           planes will be processed.

       scale
           Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.

       delta
           Set value which will be added to filtered result.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   pseudocolor
       Alter frame colors in video with pseudocolors.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       c0  set pixel first component expression

       c1  set pixel second component expression

       c2  set pixel third component expression

       c3  set pixel fourth component expression, corresponds to the alpha component

       index, i
           set component to use as base for altering colors

       preset, p
           Pick one of built-in LUTs. By default is set to none.

           Available LUTs:

           magma
           inferno
           plasma
           viridis
           turbo
           cividis
           range1
           range2
           shadows
           highlights
           solar
           nominal
           preferred
           total
           spectral
           cool
           heat
           fiery
           blues
           green
           helix
       opacity
           Set opacity of output colors. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is set to 1.

       Each of the expression options specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for the
       corresponding pixel component values.

       The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:

       w
       h   The input width and height.

       val The input value for the pixel component.

       ymin, umin, vmin, amin
           The minimum allowed component value.

       ymax, umax, vmax, amax
           The maximum allowed component value.

       All expressions default to "val".

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Change too high luma values to gradient:

                   pseudocolor="'if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(ymin,ymax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(umax,umin,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(vmin,vmax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):-1'"

   psnr
       Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise Ratio) between two input videos.

       This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is considered the "main" source and is
       passed unchanged to the output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing the PSNR.

       Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for this filter to work correctly. Also
       it assumes that both inputs have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.

       The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.

       The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each frame, and at the end of the
       processing it is averaged across all frames equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the
       PSNR:

               PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)

       Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the image.

       The description of the accepted parameters follows.

       stats_file, f
           If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of each individual frame. When
           filename equals "-" the data is sent to standard output.

       stats_version
           Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of each format are written below.
           Default value is 1.

       stats_add_max
           Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.  Default value is 0.  Requires
           stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2, the filter will return an error.

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

       The file printed if stats_file is selected, contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form key:value
       for each compared couple of frames.

       If a stats_version greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes the list of per-frame-pair stats,
       with key value pairs following the frame format with the following parameters:

       psnr_log_version
           The version of the log file format. Will match stats_version.

       fields
           A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in the log.

       A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:

       n   sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1

       mse_avg
           Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared frames, averaged over all the
           image components.

       mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_b, mse_a
           Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared frames for the component
           specified by the suffix.

       psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
           Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.

       max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
           Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all channels.

       Examples

       •   For example:

                   movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
                   [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]

           On this example the input file being processed is compared with the reference file ref_movie.mpg. The
           PSNR of each individual frame is stored in stats.log.

       •   Another example with different containers:

                   ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi  "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]psnr" -f null -

   pullup
       Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps
       progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive content.

       The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making its decisions. This filter is
       stateless in the sense that it does not lock onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to
       the following fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.

       To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after pullup, use "fps=24000/1001" if
       the input frame rate is 29.97fps, "fps=24" for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       jl
       jr
       jt
       jb  These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and bottom of the image,
           respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels, while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
           The default is 8 pixels on each side.

       sb  Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of filter generating an
           occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an excessive number of frames to be dropped during
           high motion sequences.  Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.  This
           may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between the fields, but may also cause
           there to be interlaced frames in the output.  Default value is 0.

       mp  Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:

           l   Use luma plane.

           u   Use chroma blue plane.

           v   Use chroma red plane.

           This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane for doing filter's
           computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean source material, but more likely will decrease
           accuracy, especially if there is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.  The main
           purpose of setting mp to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU load and make pullup usable in realtime on
           slow machines.

       For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is necessary to change the output
       frame rate. For example, to inverse telecine NTSC input:

               ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...

   qp
       Change video quantization parameters (QP).

       The filter accepts the following option:

       qp  Set expression for quantization parameter.

       The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others, the following constants:

       known
           1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.

       qp  Sequential index starting from -129 to 128.

       Examples

       •   Some equation like:

                   qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)

   qrencode
       Generate a QR code using the libqrencode library (see <https://fukuchi.org/works/qrencode/>), and overlay
       it on top of the current frame.

       To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libqrencode".

       The QR code is generated from the provided text or text pattern. The corresponding QR code is scaled and
       overlayed into the video output according to the specified options.

       In case no text is specified, no QR code is overlaied.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       qrcode_width, q
       padded_qrcode_width, Q
           Specify an expression for the width of the rendered QR code, with and without padding. The
           qrcode_width expression can reference the value set by the padded_qrcode_width expression, and vice
           versa.  By default padded_qrcode_width is set to qrcode_width, meaning that there is no padding.

           These expressions are evaluated for each new frame.

           See the qrencode Expressions section for details.

       x
       y   Specify an expression for positioning the padded QR code top-left corner.  The x expression can
           reference the value set by the y expression, and vice.

           By default x and y are set set to 0, meaning that the QR code is placed in the top left corner of the
           input.

           These expressions are evaluated for each new frame.

           See the qrencode Expressions section for details.

       case_sensitive, cs
           Instruct libqrencode to use case sensitive encoding. This is enabled by default. This can be disabled
           to reduce the QR encoding size.

       level, l
           Specify the QR encoding error correction level. With an higher correction level, the encoding size
           will increase but the code will be more robust to corruption.  Lower level is L.

           It accepts the following values:

           L
           M
           Q
           H
       expansion
           Select how the input text is expanded. Can be either "none", or "normal" (default). See the qrencode
           Text expansion section below for details.

       text
       textfile
           Define the text to be rendered. In case neither is specified, no QR is encoded (just an empty colored
           frame).

           In case expansion is enabled, the text is treated as a text template, using the qrencode expansion
           mechanism. See the qrencode Text expansion section below for details.

       background_color, bc
       foreground_color, fc
           Set the QR code and background color. The default value of foreground_color is "black", the default
           value of background_color is "white".

           For the syntax of the color options, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

       qrencode Expressions

       The expressions set by the options contain the following constants and functions.

       dar input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (w / h) * sar

       duration
           the current frame's duration, in seconds

       hsub
       vsub
           horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" hsub is 2
           and vsub is 1.

       main_h, H
           the input height

       main_w, W
           the input width

       n   the number of input frame, starting from 0

       pict_type
           a number representing the picture type

       qr_w, w
           the width of the encoded QR code

       rendered_qr_w, q
       rendered_padded_qr_w, Q
           the width of the rendered QR code, without and without padding.

           These parameters allow the q and Q expressions to refer to each other, so you can for example specify
           "q=3/4*Q".

       rand(min, max)
           return a random number included between min and max

       sar the input sample aspect ratio

       t   timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown

       x
       y   the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.

           These parameters allow the x and y expressions to refer to each other, so you can for example specify
           "y=x/dar".

       qrencode Text expansion

       If expansion is set to "none", the text is printed verbatim.

       If expansion is set to "normal" (which is the default), the following expansion mechanism is used.

       The backslash character \, followed by any character, always expands to the second character.

       Sequences of the form "%{...}" are expanded. The text between the braces is a function name, possibly
       followed by arguments separated by ':'.  If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':'
       or '}'), they should be escaped.

       Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the text option in the filter argument
       string and as the filter argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell, that
       makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file with the textfile option avoids these problems.

       The following functions are available:

       n, frame_num
           return the frame number

       pts Return the presentation timestamp of the current frame.

           It can take up to two arguments.

           The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to "flt" for seconds as a decimal
           number with microsecond accuracy; "hms" stands for a formatted [-]HH:MM:SS.mmm timestamp with
           millisecond accuracy.  "gmtime" stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
           "localtime" stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as local time zone time. If the format is
           set to "hms24hh", the time is formatted in 24h format (00-23).

           The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.

           If the format is set to "localtime" or "gmtime", a third argument may be supplied: a "strftime" C
           function format string. By default, YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS format will be used.

       expr, e
           Evaluate the expression's value and output as a double.

           It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated, accepting the constants and
           functions defined in qrencode_expressions.

       expr_formatted, ef
           Evaluate the expression's value and output as a formatted string.

           The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the expr function.  The second
           argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are x, X, d and u. They are treated exactly as
           in the "printf" function.  The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by
           the output.  It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.

       gmtime
           The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.  It can accept an argument: a "strftime" C
           function format string.  The format string is extended to support the variable %[1-6]N which prints
           fractions of the second with optionally specified number of digits.

       localtime
           The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.  It can accept an
           argument: a "strftime" C function format string.  The format string is extended to support the
           variable %[1-6]N which prints fractions of the second with optionally specified number of digits.

       metadata
           Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.

           The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.

           The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the metadata key is not
           found or empty.

           Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries starting with TAG included within each
           frame section printed by running "ffprobe -show_frames".

           String metadata generated in filters leading to the qrencode filter are also available.

       rand(min, max)
           return a random number included between min and max

       Examples

       •   Generate a QR code encoding the specified text with the default size, overalaid in the top left
           corner of the input video, with the default size:

                   qrencode=text=www.ffmpeg.org

       •   Same as below, but select blue on pink colors:

                   qrencode=text=www.ffmpeg.org:bc=pink@0.5:fc=blue

       •   Place the QR code in the bottom right corner of the input video:

                   qrencode=text=www.ffmpeg.org:x=W-Q:y=H-Q

       •   Generate a QR code with width of 200 pixels and padding, making the padded width 4/3 of the QR code
           width:

                   qrencode=text=www.ffmpeg.org:q=200:Q=4/3*q

       •   Generate a QR code with padded width of 200 pixels and padding, making the QR code width 3/4 of the
           padded width:

                   qrencode=text=www.ffmpeg.org:Q=200:q=3/4*Q

       •   Make the QR code a fraction of the input video width:

                   qrencode=text=www.ffmpeg.org:q=W/5

       •   Generate a QR code encoding the frame number:

                   qrencode=text=%{n}

       •   Generate a QR code encoding the GMT timestamp:

                   qrencode=text=%{gmtime}

       •   Generate a QR code encoding the timestamp expressed as a float:

                   qrencode=text=%{pts}

   quirc
       Identify and decode a QR code using the libquirc library (see <https://github.com/dlbeer/quirc/>), and
       print the identified QR codes positions and payload as metadata.

       To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libquirc".

       For each found QR code in the input video, some metadata entries are added with the prefix lavfi.quirc.N,
       where N is the index, starting from 0, associated to the QR code.

       A description of each metadata value follows:

       lavfi.quirc.count
           the number of found QR codes, it is not set in case none was found

       lavfi.quirc.N.corner.M.x
       lavfi.quirc.N.coreer.M.y
           the x/y positions of the four corners of the square containing the QR code, where M is the index of
           the corner starting from 0

       lavfi.quirc.N.payload
           the payload of the QR code

   random
       Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.  No frame is discarded.  Inspired
       by frei0r nervous filter.

       frames
           Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from 2 to 512. Default is 30.

       seed
           Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between 0 and "UINT32_MAX". If not
           specified, or if explicitly set to less than 0, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
           best effort basis.

   readeia608
       Read closed captioning (EIA-608) information from the top lines of a video frame.

       This filter adds frame metadata for "lavfi.readeia608.X.cc" and "lavfi.readeia608.X.line", where "X" is
       the number of the identified line with EIA-608 data (starting from 0). A description of each metadata
       value follows:

       lavfi.readeia608.X.cc
           The two bytes stored as EIA-608 data (printed in hexadecimal).

       lavfi.readeia608.X.line
           The number of the line on which the EIA-608 data was identified and read.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       scan_min
           Set the line to start scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is 0.

       scan_max
           Set the line to end scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is 29.

       spw Set the ratio of width reserved for sync code detection.  Default is 0.27. Allowed range is "[0.1 -
           0.7]".

       chp Enable checking the parity bit. In the event of a parity error, the filter will output 0x00 for that
           character. Default is false.

       lp  Lowpass lines prior to further processing. Default is enabled.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Output a csv with presentation time and the first two lines of identified EIA-608 captioning data.

                   ffprobe -f lavfi -i movie=captioned_video.mov,readeia608 -show_entries frame=pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.readeia608.0.cc,lavfi.readeia608.1.cc -of csv

   readvitc
       Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a video frame.

       The filter adds frame metadata key "lavfi.readvitc.tc_str" with the timecode value, if a valid timecode
       has been detected. Further metadata key "lavfi.readvitc.found" is set to 0/1 depending on whether
       timecode data has been found or not.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       scan_max
           Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to -1 the full video frame
           is scanned. Default is 45.

       thr_b
           Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0], default value is 0.2.
           The value must be equal or less than "thr_w".

       thr_w
           Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0], default value is 0.6.
           The value must be equal or greater than "thr_b".

       Examples

       •   Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected, draw "--:--:--:--" as a
           placeholder:

                   ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'

   remap
       Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.

       Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position where x = Xmap(X, Y) and
       y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero value for pixel will be used for destination
       pixel.

       Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream will have Xmap/Ymap
       video stream dimensions.  Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.

       format
           Specify pixel format of output from this filter. Can be "color" or "gray".  Default is "color".

       fill
           Specify the color of the unmapped pixels. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in
           the ffmpeg-utils manual. Default color is "black".

   removegrain
       The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.

       m0  Set mode for the first plane.

       m1  Set mode for the second plane.

       m2  Set mode for the third plane.

       m3  Set mode for the fourth plane.

       Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:

       0   Leave input plane unchanged. Default.

       1   Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.

       2   Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.

       3   Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.

       4   Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.  This is equivalent to
           a median filter.

       5   Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.

       6   Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.

       7   Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.

       8   Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.

       9   Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.

       10  Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.

       11  [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.

       12  Same as mode 11.

       13  Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.

       14  Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.

       15  Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated interpolation formula.

       16  Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated interpolation formula.

       17  Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and minimum of each pair of
           opposite neighbour pixels.

       18  Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from the current pixel is
           minimal.

       19  Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.

       20  Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).

       21  Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.

       22  Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.

       23  Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.

       24  Similar as 23.

   removelogo
       Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which pixels comprise the logo. It works by
       filling in the pixels that comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       filename, f
           Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by libavformat. The width and
           height of the image file must match those of the video stream being processed.

       Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not considered part of the logo, non-zero
       pixels are considered part of the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the rest,
       you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is recommended to take a screen capture of a black
       frame with the logo visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode filter once or
       twice.

       If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if logo pixels are not covered, the
       filter quality will be much reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as much,
       but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over the image and will destroy more
       information than necessary, and extra pixels will slow things down on a large logo.

   repeatfields
       This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats fields based on its
       value.

   reverse
       Reverse a video clip.

       Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming is suggested.

       Examples

       •   Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.

                   trim=end=5,reverse

   rgbashift
       Shift R/G/B/A pixels horizontally and/or vertically.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       rh  Set amount to shift red horizontally.

       rv  Set amount to shift red vertically.

       gh  Set amount to shift green horizontally.

       gv  Set amount to shift green vertically.

       bh  Set amount to shift blue horizontally.

       bv  Set amount to shift blue vertically.

       ah  Set amount to shift alpha horizontally.

       av  Set amount to shift alpha vertically.

       edge
           Set edge mode, can be smear, default, or warp.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   roberts
       Apply roberts cross operator to input video stream.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.  By default value 0xf, all
           planes will be processed.

       scale
           Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.

       delta
           Set value which will be added to filtered result.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   rotate
       Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       A description of the optional parameters follows.

       angle, a
           Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video clockwise, expressed as a number
           of radians. A negative value will result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to
           "0".

           This expression is evaluated for each frame.

       out_w, ow
           Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".  This expression is evaluated just once
           during configuration.

       out_h, oh
           Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".  This expression is evaluated just once
           during configuration.

       bilinear
           Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables it. Default value is 1.

       fillcolor, c
           Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated image. For the general syntax
           of this option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  If the special value "none" is
           selected then no background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).

           Default value is "black".

       The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the following constants and functions:

       n   sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN before the first frame is
           filtered.

       t   time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is configured. It is always NAN
           before the first frame is filtered.

       hsub
       vsub
           horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" hsub is 2
           and vsub is 1.

       in_w, iw
       in_h, ih
           the input video width and height

       out_w, ow
       out_h, oh
           the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as specified by the width and height
           expressions

       rotw(a)
       roth(a)
           the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input video rotated by a radians.

           These are only available when computing the out_w and out_h expressions.

       Examples

       •   Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:

                   rotate=PI/6

       •   Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:

                   rotate=-PI/6

       •   Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:

                   rotate=45*PI/180

       •   Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:

                   rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T

       •   Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T seconds and an amplitude of A radians:

                   rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)

       •   Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating input video is always completely
           contained in the output:

                   rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'

       •   Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever shown:

                   rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none

       Commands

       The filter supports the following commands:

       a, angle
           Set the angle expression.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.

           If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   sab
       Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       luma_radius, lr
           Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default value is 1.0. A greater
           value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower processing.

       luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
           Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default value is 1.0.

       luma_strength, ls
           Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must be a value in the 0.1-100.0
           range, default value is 1.0.

       chroma_radius, cr
           Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A greater value will result in a
           more blurred image, and in slower processing.

       chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
           Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.

       chroma_strength, cs
           Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must be a value in the
           -0.9-100.0 range.

       Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the corresponding luma option value.

   scale
       Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.

       The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same of the input, by changing the
       output sample aspect ratio.

       If the input image format is different from the format requested by the next filter, the scale filter
       will convert the input to the requested format.

       Options

       The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options supported by the libswscale scaler.

       See the ffmpeg-scaler manual for the complete list of scaler options.

       width, w
       height, h
           Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input dimension.

           If the width or w value is 0, the input width is used for the output. If the height or h value is 0,
           the input height is used for the output.

           If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the scale filter will use a value that maintains
           the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it
           will, however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if
           necessary.

           If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to both values being set to 0 as
           previously detailed.

           See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension expression.

       eval
           Specify when to evaluate width and height expression. It accepts the following values:

           init
               Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.

           frame
               Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.

           Default value is init.

       interl
           Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:

           1   Force interlaced aware scaling.

           0   Do not apply interlaced scaling.

           -1  Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames are flagged as interlaced
               or not.

           Default value is 0.

       flags
           Set libswscale scaling flags. See the ffmpeg-scaler manual for the complete list of values. If not
           explicitly specified the filter applies the default flags.

       param0, param1
           Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See the ffmpeg-scaler manual
           for the complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies empty parameters.

       size, s
           Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils
           manual.

       in_color_matrix
       out_color_matrix
           Set in/output YCbCr color space type.

           This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing a specific value used
           for the output and encoder.

           If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.

           Possible values:

           auto
               Choose automatically.

           bt709
               Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU) Recommendation BT.709.

           fcc Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Code of
               Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).

           bt601
           bt470
           smpte170m
               Set color space conforming to:

               •   ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601

               •   ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G

               •   Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004

           smpte240m
               Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.

           bt2020
               Set color space conforming to ITU-R BT.2020 non-constant luminance system.

       in_range
       out_range
           Set in/output YCbCr sample range.

           This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing a specific value used
           for the output and encoder. If not specified, the range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:

           auto/unknown
               Choose automatically.

           jpeg/full/pc
               Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).

           mpeg/limited/tv
               Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).

       force_original_aspect_ratio
           Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to keep the original aspect
           ratio. Possible values:

           disable
               Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.

           decrease
               The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.

           increase
               The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.

           One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's maximum allowed
           resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For
           example, device A allows 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
           decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output 1280x533.

           Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for w or h, you still need to specify
           the output resolution for this option to work.

       force_divisible_by
           Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the given integer when
           used together with force_original_aspect_ratio. This works similar to using "-n" in the w and h
           options.

           This option respects the value set for force_original_aspect_ratio, increasing or decreasing the
           resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio may be slightly modified.

           This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed a defined resolution using
           force_original_aspect_ratio but also have encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.

       The values of the w and h options are expressions containing the following constants:

       in_w
       in_h
           The input width and height

       iw
       ih  These are the same as in_w and in_h.

       out_w
       out_h
           The output (scaled) width and height

       ow
       oh  These are the same as out_w and out_h

       a   The same as iw / ih

       sar input sample aspect ratio

       dar The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from "(iw / ih) * sar".

       hsub
       vsub
           horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p"
           hsub is 2 and vsub is 1.

       ohsub
       ovsub
           horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p"
           hsub is 2 and vsub is 1.

       n   The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.  Only available with "eval=frame".

       t   The presentation timestamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of seconds. Only available with
           "eval=frame".

       pos The position (byte offset) of the frame in the input stream, or NaN if this information is
           unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).  Only available with
           "eval=frame".  Deprecated, do not use.

       Examples

       •   Scale the input video to a size of 200x100

                   scale=w=200:h=100

           This is equivalent to:

                   scale=200:100

           or:

                   scale=200x100

       •   Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:

                   scale=qcif

           which can also be written as:

                   scale=size=qcif

       •   Scale the input to 2x:

                   scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih

       •   The above is the same as:

                   scale=2*in_w:2*in_h

       •   Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:

                   scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1

       •   Scale the input to half size:

                   scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2

       •   Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:

                   scale=3/2*iw:ow

       •   Seek Greek harmony:

                   scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
                   scale=ih*PHI:ih

       •   Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:

                   scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih

       •   Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma subsample values:

                   scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"

       •   Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels, keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:

                   scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'

       •   Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar:

                   scale='trunc(ih*dar):ih',setsar=1/1

       •   Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar, making sure the resulting resolution is even
           (required by some codecs):

                   scale='trunc(ih*dar/2)*2:trunc(ih/2)*2',setsar=1/1

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       width, w
       height, h
           Set the output video dimension expression.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
           option.

           If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   scale_cuda
       Scale (resize) and convert (pixel format) the input video, using accelerated CUDA kernels.  Setting the
       output width and height works in the same way as for the scale filter.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       w
       h   Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input dimension.

           Allows for the same expressions as the scale filter.

       interp_algo
           Sets the algorithm used for scaling:

           nearest
               Nearest neighbour

               Used by default if input parameters match the desired output.

           bilinear
               Bilinear

           bicubic
               Bicubic

               This is the default.

           lanczos
               Lanczos

       format
           Controls the output pixel format. By default, or if none is specified, the input pixel format is
           used.

           The filter does not support converting between YUV and RGB pixel formats.

       passthrough
           If set to 0, every frame is processed, even if no conversion is necessary.  This mode can be useful
           to use the filter as a buffer for a downstream frame-consumer that exhausts the limited decoder frame
           pool.

           If set to 1, frames are passed through as-is if they match the desired output parameters. This is the
           default behaviour.

       param
           Algorithm-Specific parameter.

           Affects the curves of the bicubic algorithm.

       force_original_aspect_ratio
       force_divisible_by
           Work the same as the identical scale filter options.

       Examples

       •   Scale input to 720p, keeping aspect ratio and ensuring the output is yuv420p.

                   scale_cuda=-2:720:format=yuv420p

       •   Upscale to 4K using nearest neighbour algorithm.

                   scale_cuda=4096:2160:interp_algo=nearest

       •   Don't do any conversion or scaling, but copy all input frames into newly allocated ones.  This can be
           useful to deal with a filter and encode chain that otherwise exhausts the decoders frame pool.

                   scale_cuda=passthrough=0

   scale_npp
       Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel format conversion on CUDA
       video frames. Setting the output width and height works in the same way as for the scale filter.

       The following additional options are accepted:

       format
           The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the default), the input
           format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation and conversion is not yet supported for
           hardware frames

       interp_algo
           The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:

           nn  Nearest neighbour.

           linear
           cubic
           cubic2p_bspline
               2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)

           cubic2p_catmullrom
               2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)

           cubic2p_b05c03
               2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)

           super
               Supersampling

           lanczos
       force_original_aspect_ratio
           Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to keep the original aspect
           ratio. Possible values:

           disable
               Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.

           decrease
               The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.

           increase
               The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.

           One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's maximum allowed
           resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For
           example, device A allows 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
           decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output 1280x533.

           Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for w or h, you still need to specify
           the output resolution for this option to work.

       force_divisible_by
           Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the given integer when
           used together with force_original_aspect_ratio. This works similar to using "-n" in the w and h
           options.

           This option respects the value set for force_original_aspect_ratio, increasing or decreasing the
           resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio may be slightly modified.

           This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed a defined resolution using
           force_original_aspect_ratio but also have encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.

       eval
           Specify when to evaluate width and height expression. It accepts the following values:

           init
               Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.

           frame
               Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.

       The values of the w and h options are expressions containing the following constants:

       in_w
       in_h
           The input width and height

       iw
       ih  These are the same as in_w and in_h.

       out_w
       out_h
           The output (scaled) width and height

       ow
       oh  These are the same as out_w and out_h

       a   The same as iw / ih

       sar input sample aspect ratio

       dar The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from "(iw / ih) * sar".

       n   The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.  Only available with "eval=frame".

       t   The presentation timestamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of seconds. Only available with
           "eval=frame".

       pos The position (byte offset) of the frame in the input stream, or NaN if this information is
           unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).  Only available with
           "eval=frame".  Deprecated, do not use.

   scale2ref
       Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.

       See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but uses the reference video
       instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref also supports the following additional constants for the w
       and h options:

       main_w
       main_h
           The main input video's width and height

       main_a
           The same as main_w / main_h

       main_sar
           The main input video's sample aspect ratio

       main_dar, mdar
           The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from "(main_w / main_h) * main_sar".

       main_hsub
       main_vsub
           The main input video's horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values.  For example for the pixel
           format "yuv422p" hsub is 2 and vsub is 1.

       main_n
           The (sequential) number of the main input frame, starting from 0.  Only available with "eval=frame".

       main_t
           The presentation timestamp of the main input frame, expressed as a number of seconds. Only available
           with "eval=frame".

       main_pos
           The position (byte offset) of the frame in the main input stream, or NaN if this information is
           unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).  Only available with
           "eval=frame".

       Examples

       •   Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying

                   'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'

       •   Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.

                   [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       width, w
       height, h
           Set the output video dimension expression.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
           option.

           If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

   scale2ref_npp
       Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference
       video.

       See the scale_npp filter for available options, scale2ref_npp supports the same but uses the reference
       video instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref_npp also supports the following additional constants
       for the w and h options:

       main_w
       main_h
           The main input video's width and height

       main_a
           The same as main_w / main_h

       main_sar
           The main input video's sample aspect ratio

       main_dar, mdar
           The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from "(main_w / main_h) * main_sar".

       main_n
           The (sequential) number of the main input frame, starting from 0.  Only available with "eval=frame".

       main_t
           The presentation timestamp of the main input frame, expressed as a number of seconds. Only available
           with "eval=frame".

       main_pos
           The position (byte offset) of the frame in the main input stream, or NaN if this information is
           unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).  Only available with
           "eval=frame".

       Examples

       •   Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying

                   'scale2ref_npp[b][a];[a][b]overlay_cuda'

       •   Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.

                   [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref_npp=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]

   scale_vt
       Scale and convert the color parameters using VTPixelTransferSession.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       w
       h   Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input dimension.

       color_matrix
           Set the output colorspace matrix.

       color_primaries
           Set the output color primaries.

       color_transfer
           Set the output transfer characteristics.

   scharr
       Apply scharr operator to input video stream.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.  By default value 0xf, all
           planes will be processed.

       scale
           Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.

       delta
           Set value which will be added to filtered result.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   scroll
       Scroll input video horizontally and/or vertically by constant speed.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       horizontal, h
           Set the horizontal scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.  Negative values
           changes scrolling direction.

       vertical, v
           Set the vertical scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.  Negative values
           changes scrolling direction.

       hpos
           Set the initial horizontal scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.

       vpos
           Set the initial vertical scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       horizontal, h
           Set the horizontal scrolling speed.

       vertical, v
           Set the vertical scrolling speed.

   scdet
       Detect video scene change.

       This filter sets frame metadata with mafd between frame, the scene score, and forward the frame to the
       next filter, so they can use these metadata to detect scene change or others.

       In addition, this filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects a scene change by
       threshold.

       "lavfi.scd.mafd" metadata keys are set with mafd for every frame.

       "lavfi.scd.score" metadata keys are set with scene change score for every frame to detect scene change.

       "lavfi.scd.time" metadata keys are set with current filtered frame time which detect scene change with
       threshold.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       threshold, t
           Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change. Good values are in the
           "[8.0, 14.0]" range. The range for threshold is "[0., 100.]".

           Default value is 10..

       sc_pass, s
           Set the flag to pass scene change frames to the next filter. Default value is 0 You can enable it if
           you want to get snapshot of scene change frames only.

   selectivecolor
       Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such as "reds", "yellows",
       "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined by the "purity" of the color (that is, how
       saturated it already is).

       This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       correction_method
           Select color correction method.

           Available values are:

           absolute
               Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel component value).

           relative
               Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.

           Default is "absolute".

       reds
           Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)

       yellows
           Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)

       greens
           Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)

       cyans
           Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)

       blues
           Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)

       magentas
           Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)

       whites
           Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)

       neutrals
           Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white

       blacks
           Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)

       psfile
           Specify a Photoshop selective color file (".asv") to import the settings from.

       All the adjustment settings (reds, yellows, ...) accept up to 4 space separated floating point adjustment
       values in the [-1,1] range, respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
       pixels of its range.

       Examples

       •   Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and increase magenta by 27% in
           blue areas:

                   selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27

       •   Use a Photoshop selective color preset:

                   selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv

   separatefields
       The "separatefields" takes a frame-based video input and splits each frame into its components fields,
       producing a new half height clip with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.

       This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which of each pair of fields to place
       first in the output.  If it gets it wrong use setfield filter before "separatefields" filter.

   setdar, setsar
       The "setdar" filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter output video.

       This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio, according to the following
       equation:

               <DAR> = <HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION> / <VERTICAL_RESOLUTION> * <SAR>

       Keep in mind that the "setdar" filter does not modify the pixel dimensions of the video frame. Also, the
       display aspect ratio set by this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. in case
       of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is applied.

       The "setsar" filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for the filter output video.

       Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the output display aspect ratio will change
       according to the equation above.

       Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the "setsar" filter may be changed by later filters in
       the filterchain, e.g. if another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       r, ratio, dar ("setdar" only), sar ("setsar" only)
           Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.

           The parameter can be a floating point number string, or an expression. If the parameter is not
           specified, the value "0" is assumed, meaning that the same input value is used.

       max Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and denominator when reducing the
           expressed aspect ratio to a rational.  Default value is 100.

       The parameter sar is an expression containing the following constants:

       w, h
           The input width and height.

       a   Same as w / h.

       sar The input sample aspect ratio.

       dar The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as (w / h) * sar.

       hsub, vsub
           Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the pixel format "yuv422p" hsub is
           2 and vsub is 1.

       Examples

       •   To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:

                   setdar=dar=1.77777
                   setdar=dar=16/9

       •   To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:

                   setsar=sar=10/11

       •   To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of 1000 in the aspect
           ratio reduction, use the command:

                   setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000

   setfield
       Force field for the output video frame.

       The "setfield" filter marks the interlace type field for the output frames. It does not change the input
       frame, but only sets the corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by following
       filters (e.g. "fieldorder" or "yadif").

       The filter accepts the following options:

       mode
           Available values are:

           auto
               Keep the same field property.

           bff Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.

           tff Mark the frame as top-field-first.

           prog
               Mark the frame as progressive.

   setparams
       Force frame parameter for the output video frame.

       The "setparams" filter marks interlace and color range for the output frames. It does not change the
       input frame, but only sets the corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
       filters/encoders.

       field_mode
           Available values are:

           auto
               Keep the same field property (default).

           bff Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.

           tff Mark the frame as top-field-first.

           prog
               Mark the frame as progressive.

       range
           Available values are:

           auto
               Keep the same color range property (default).

           unspecified, unknown
               Mark the frame as unspecified color range.

           limited, tv, mpeg
               Mark the frame as limited range.

           full, pc, jpeg
               Mark the frame as full range.

       color_primaries
           Set the color primaries.  Available values are:

           auto
               Keep the same color primaries property (default).

           bt709
           unknown
           bt470m
           bt470bg
           smpte170m
           smpte240m
           film
           bt2020
           smpte428
           smpte431
           smpte432
           jedec-p22
       color_trc
           Set the color transfer.  Available values are:

           auto
               Keep the same color trc property (default).

           bt709
           unknown
           bt470m
           bt470bg
           smpte170m
           smpte240m
           linear
           log100
           log316
           iec61966-2-4
           bt1361e
           iec61966-2-1
           bt2020-10
           bt2020-12
           smpte2084
           smpte428
           arib-std-b67
       colorspace
           Set the colorspace.  Available values are:

           auto
               Keep the same colorspace property (default).

           gbr
           bt709
           unknown
           fcc
           bt470bg
           smpte170m
           smpte240m
           ycgco
           bt2020nc
           bt2020c
           smpte2085
           chroma-derived-nc
           chroma-derived-c
           ictcp

   sharpen_npp
       Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform image sharpening with border control.

       The following additional options are accepted:

       border_type
           Type of sampling to be used ad frame borders. One of the following:

           replicate
               Replicate pixel values.

   shear
       Apply shear transform to input video.

       This filter supports the following options:

       shx Shear factor in X-direction. Default value is 0.  Allowed range is from -2 to 2.

       shy Shear factor in Y-direction. Default value is 0.  Allowed range is from -2 to 2.

       fillcolor, c
           Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the transformed video. For the general
           syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  If the special value
           "none" is selected then no background is printed (useful for example if the background is never
           shown).

           Default value is "black".

       interp
           Set interpolation type. Can be "bilinear" or "nearest". Default is "bilinear".

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   showinfo
       Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.  The input video is not modified.

       This filter supports the following options:

       checksum
           Calculate checksums of each plane. By default enabled.

       udu_sei_as_ascii
           Try to print user data unregistered SEI as ascii character when possible, in hex format otherwise.

       The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form key:value.

       The following values are shown in the output:

       n   The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.

       pts The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of time base units. The time
           base unit depends on the filter input pad.

       pts_time
           The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of seconds.

       fmt The pixel format name.

       sar The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form num/den.

       s   The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in the
           ffmpeg-utils manual.

       i   The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B" for bottom field
           first).

       iskey
           This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.

       type
           The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?"
           for an unknown type).  Also refer to the documentation of the "AVPictureType" enum and of the
           "av_get_picture_type_char" function defined in libavutil/avutil.h.

       checksum
           The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.

       plane_checksum
           The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame, expressed in the
           form "[c0 c1 c2 c3]".

       mean
           The mean value of pixels in each plane of the input frame, expressed in the form "[mean0 mean1 mean2
           mean3]".

       stdev
           The standard deviation of pixel values in each plane of the input frame, expressed in the form
           "[stdev0 stdev1 stdev2 stdev3]".

   showpalette
       Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for pal8 pixel format frames.

       It accepts the following option:

       s   Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is 30 (for a "30x30" pixel
           box).

   shuffleframes
       Reorder and/or duplicate and/or drop video frames.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       mapping
           Set the destination indexes of input frames.  This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that
           maps input frames to output frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may
           have.  '-1' index have special meaning and that is to drop frame.

       The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.

       Examples

       •   Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT

       •   Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT

   shufflepixels
       Reorder pixels in video frames.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       direction, d
           Set shuffle direction. Can be forward or inverse direction.  Default direction is forward.

       mode, m
           Set shuffle mode. Can be horizontal, vertical or block mode.

       width, w
       height, h
           Set shuffle block_size. In case of horizontal shuffle mode only width part of size is used, and in
           case of vertical shuffle mode only height part of size is used.

       seed, s
           Set random seed used with shuffling pixels. Mainly useful to set to be able to reverse filtering
           process to get original input.  For example, to reverse forward shuffle you need to use same
           parameters and exact same seed and to set direction to inverse.

   shuffleplanes
       Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       map0
           The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.

       map1
           The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.

       map2
           The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.

       map3
           The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.

       The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.

       Examples

       •   Swap the second and third planes of the input:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT

   signalstats
       Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated with the digitization of
       analog video media.

       By default the filter will log these metadata values:

       YMIN
           Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       YLOW
           Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       YAVG
           Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       YHIGH
           Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       YMAX
           Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       UMIN
           Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       ULOW
           Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       UAVG
           Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       UHIGH
           Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       UMAX
           Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       VMIN
           Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       VLOW
           Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       VAVG
           Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       VHIGH
           Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       VMAX
           Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-255].

       SATMIN
           Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.  Expressed in range of
           [0-~181.02].

       SATLOW
           Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.  Expressed in range of
           [0-~181.02].

       SATAVG
           Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].

       SATHIGH
           Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.  Expressed in range of
           [0-~181.02].

       SATMAX
           Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.  Expressed in range of
           [0-~181.02].

       HUEMED
           Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-360].

       HUEAVG
           Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of [0-360].

       YDIF
           Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y plane in the current frame
           and corresponding values of the previous input frame.  Expressed in range of [0-255].

       UDIF
           Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U plane in the current frame
           and corresponding values of the previous input frame.  Expressed in range of [0-255].

       VDIF
           Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V plane in the current frame
           and corresponding values of the previous input frame.  Expressed in range of [0-255].

       YBITDEPTH
           Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.  Expressed in range of [0-16].

       UBITDEPTH
           Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.  Expressed in range of [0-16].

       VBITDEPTH
           Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.  Expressed in range of [0-16].

       The filter accepts the following options:

       stat
       out stat specify an additional form of image analysis.  out output video with the specified type of pixel
           highlighted.

           Both options accept the following values:

           tout
               Identify temporal outliers pixels. A temporal outlier is a pixel unlike the neighboring pixels of
               the same field. Examples of temporal outliers include the results of video dropouts, head clogs,
               or tape tracking issues.

           vrep
               Identify vertical line repetition. Vertical line repetition includes similar rows of pixels
               within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line repetition is common, but this pattern is
               uncommon in video digitized from an analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the
               digitization of an analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.

           brng
               Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.

       color, c
           Set the highlight color for the out option. The default color is yellow.

       Examples

       •   Output data of various video metrics:

                   ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames

       •   Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:

                   ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN

       •   Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.

                   ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"

       •   Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.

                   ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt

           The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:

                   time %{pts:hms}
                   Y (%{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN}-%{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX})
                   U (%{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN}-%{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX})
                   V (%{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN}-%{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX})
                   saturation maximum: %{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX}

   signature
       Calculates the MPEG-7 Video Signature. The filter can handle more than one input. In this case the
       matching between the inputs can be calculated additionally.  The filter always passes through the first
       input. The signature of each stream can be written into a file.

       It accepts the following options:

       detectmode
           Enable or disable the matching process.

           Available values are:

           off Disable the calculation of a matching (default).

           full
               Calculate the matching for the whole video and output whether the whole video matches or only
               parts.

           fast
               Calculate only until a matching is found or the video ends. Should be faster in some cases.

       nb_inputs
           Set the number of inputs. The option value must be a non negative integer.  Default value is 1.

       filename
           Set the path to which the output is written. If there is more than one input, the path must be a
           prototype, i.e. must contain %d or %0nd (where n is a positive integer), that will be replaced with
           the input number. If no filename is specified, no output will be written. This is the default.

       format
           Choose the output format.

           Available values are:

           binary
               Use the specified binary representation (default).

           xml Use the specified xml representation.

       th_d
           Set threshold to detect one word as similar. The option value must be an integer greater than zero.
           The default value is 9000.

       th_dc
           Set threshold to detect all words as similar. The option value must be an integer greater than zero.
           The default value is 60000.

       th_xh
           Set threshold to detect frames as similar. The option value must be an integer greater than zero. The
           default value is 116.

       th_di
           Set the minimum length of a sequence in frames to recognize it as matching sequence. The option value
           must be a non negative integer value.  The default value is 0.

       th_it
           Set the minimum relation, that matching frames to all frames must have.  The option value must be a
           double value between 0 and 1. The default value is 0.5.

       Examples

       •   To calculate the signature of an input video and store it in signature.bin:

                   ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf signature=filename=signature.bin -map 0:v -f null -

       •   To detect whether two videos match and store the signatures in XML format in signature0.xml and
           signature1.xml:

                   ffmpeg -i input1.mkv -i input2.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] signature=nb_inputs=2:detectmode=full:format=xml:filename=signature%d.xml" -map :v -f null -

   siti
       Calculate Spatial Information (SI) and Temporal Information (TI) scores for a video, as defined in ITU-T
       Rec. P.910 (11/21): Subjective video quality assessment methods for multimedia applications. Available
       PDF at <https://www.itu.int/rec/T-REC-P.910-202111-S/en>.  Note that this is a legacy implementation that
       corresponds to a superseded recommendation.  Refer to ITU-T Rec. P.910 (07/22) for the latest version:
       <https://www.itu.int/rec/T-REC-P.910-202207-I/en>

       It accepts the following option:

       print_summary
           If set to 1, Summary statistics will be printed to the console. Default 0.

       Examples

       •   To calculate SI/TI metrics and print summary:

                   ffmpeg -i input.mp4 -vf siti=print_summary=1 -f null -

   smartblur
       Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.

       It accepts the following options:

       luma_radius, lr
           Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies
           the variance of the gaussian filter used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.

       luma_strength, ls
           Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number in the range [-1.0,1.0] that
           configures the blurring. A value included in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included
           in [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.

       luma_threshold, lt
           Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine whether a pixel should be blurred or not.
           The option value must be an integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image, a
           value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included in [-30,0] will filter edges.
           Default value is 0.

       chroma_radius, cr
           Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies
           the variance of the gaussian filter used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is
           luma_radius.

       chroma_strength, cs
           Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number in the range [-1.0,1.0] that
           configures the blurring. A value included in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included
           in [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is luma_strength.

       chroma_threshold, ct
           Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine whether a pixel should be blurred or not.
           The option value must be an integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image, a
           value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included in [-30,0] will filter edges.
           Default value is luma_threshold.

       If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value is set.

   sobel
       Apply sobel operator to input video stream.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.  By default value 0xf, all
           planes will be processed.

       scale
           Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.

       delta
           Set value which will be added to filtered result.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   spp
       Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image at several (or - in the
       case of quality level 6 - all) shifts and average the results.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       quality
           Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts an integer in the
           range 0-6. If set to 0, the filter will have no effect. A value of 6 means the higher quality. For
           each increment of that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2.  Default value is 3.

       qp  Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
           (if available).

       mode
           Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:

           hard
               Set hard thresholding (default).

           soft
               Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).

       use_bframe_qp
           Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to 1. Using this option may cause flicker since the
           B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is 0 (not enabled).

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       quality, level
           Set quality level. The value "max" can be used to set the maximum level, currently 6.

   sr
       Scale the input by applying one of the super-resolution methods based on convolutional neural networks.
       Supported models:

       •   Super-Resolution Convolutional Neural Network model (SRCNN).  See <https://arxiv.org/abs/1501.00092>.

       •   Efficient Sub-Pixel Convolutional Neural Network model (ESPCN).  See
           <https://arxiv.org/abs/1609.05158>.

       Training scripts as well as scripts for model file (.pb) saving can be found at
       <https://github.com/XueweiMeng/sr/tree/sr_dnn_native>. Original repository is at
       <https://github.com/HighVoltageRocknRoll/sr.git>.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       dnn_backend
           Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts the following
           values:

           tensorflow
               TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
               <https://www.tensorflow.org/install/lang_c>) and configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libtensorflow"

       model
           Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.  Note that different
           backends use different file formats. TensorFlow, OpenVINO backend can load files for only its format.

       scale_factor
           Set scale factor for SRCNN model. Allowed values are 2, 3 and 4.  Default value is 2. Scale factor is
           necessary for SRCNN model, because it accepts input upscaled using bicubic upscaling with proper
           scale factor.

       To get full functionality (such as async execution), please use the dnn_processing filter.

   ssim
       Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.

       This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is considered the "main" source and is
       passed unchanged to the output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing the SSIM.

       Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for this filter to work correctly. Also
       it assumes that both inputs have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.

       The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.

       The description of the accepted parameters follows.

       stats_file, f
           If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of each individual frame. When
           filename equals "-" the data is sent to standard output.

       The file printed if stats_file is selected, contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form key:value
       for each compared couple of frames.

       A description of each shown parameter follows:

       n   sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1

       Y, U, V, R, G, B
           SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.

       All SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.

       dB  Same as above but in dB representation.

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

       Examples

       •   For example:

                   movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
                   [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]

           On this example the input file being processed is compared with the reference file ref_movie.mpg. The
           SSIM of each individual frame is stored in stats.log.

       •   Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:

                   ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi  "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -

       •   Another example with different containers:

                   ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi  "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]ssim" -f null -

   stereo3d
       Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.

       The filters accept the following options:

       in  Set stereoscopic image format of input.

           Available values for input image formats are:

           sbsl
               side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)

           sbsr
               side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)

           sbs2l
               side by side parallel with half width resolution (left eye left, right eye right)

           sbs2r
               side by side crosseye with half width resolution (right eye left, left eye right)

           abl
           tbl above-below (left eye above, right eye below)

           abr
           tbr above-below (right eye above, left eye below)

           ab2l
           tb2l
               above-below with half height resolution (left eye above, right eye below)

           ab2r
           tb2r
               above-below with half height resolution (right eye above, left eye below)

           al  alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)

           ar  alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)

           irl interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)

           irr interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)

           icl interleaved columns, left eye first

           icr interleaved columns, right eye first

               Default value is sbsl.

       out Set stereoscopic image format of output.

           sbsl
               side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)

           sbsr
               side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)

           sbs2l
               side by side parallel with half width resolution (left eye left, right eye right)

           sbs2r
               side by side crosseye with half width resolution (right eye left, left eye right)

           abl
           tbl above-below (left eye above, right eye below)

           abr
           tbr above-below (right eye above, left eye below)

           ab2l
           tb2l
               above-below with half height resolution (left eye above, right eye below)

           ab2r
           tb2r
               above-below with half height resolution (right eye above, left eye below)

           al  alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)

           ar  alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)

           irl interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)

           irr interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)

           arbg
               anaglyph red/blue gray (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)

           argg
               anaglyph red/green gray (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)

           arcg
               anaglyph red/cyan gray (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)

           arch
               anaglyph red/cyan half colored (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)

           arcc
               anaglyph red/cyan color (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)

           arcd
               anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois (red filter on left
               eye, cyan filter on right eye)

           agmg
               anaglyph green/magenta gray (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)

           agmh
               anaglyph green/magenta half colored (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)

           agmc
               anaglyph green/magenta colored (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)

           agmd
               anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois (green filter
               on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)

           aybg
               anaglyph yellow/blue gray (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)

           aybh
               anaglyph yellow/blue half colored (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)

           aybc
               anaglyph yellow/blue colored (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)

           aybd
               anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois (yellow filter
               on left eye, blue filter on right eye)

           ml  mono output (left eye only)

           mr  mono output (right eye only)

           chl checkerboard, left eye first

           chr checkerboard, right eye first

           icl interleaved columns, left eye first

           icr interleaved columns, right eye first

           hdmi
               HDMI frame pack

           Default value is arcd.

       Examples

       •   Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:

                   stereo3d=sbsl:aybd

       •   Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.

                   stereo3d=abl:sbsr

   streamselect, astreamselect
       Select video or audio streams.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       inputs
           Set number of inputs. Default is 2.

       map Set input indexes to remap to outputs.

       Commands

       The "streamselect" and "astreamselect" filter supports the following commands:

       map Set input indexes to remap to outputs.

       Examples

       •   Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:

                   sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0

       •   Same as above, but for audio:

                   asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0

   subtitles
       Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.

       To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libass". This filter
       also requires a build with libavcodec and libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS
       (Advanced Substation Alpha) subtitles format.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       filename, f
           Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.

       original_size
           Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file was composed. For the syntax
           of this option, check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Due to a misdesign in ASS
           aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been
           changed.

       fontsdir
           Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.  These fonts will be used in
           addition to whatever the font provider uses.

       alpha
           Process alpha channel, by default alpha channel is untouched.

       charenc
           Set subtitles input character encoding. "subtitles" filter only. Only useful if not UTF-8.

       stream_index, si
           Set subtitles stream index. "subtitles" filter only.

       force_style
           Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a string containing ASS
           style format "KEY=VALUE" couples separated by ",".

       wrap_unicode
           Break lines according to the Unicode Line Breaking Algorithm. Availability requires at least libass
           release 0.17.0 (or LIBASS_VERSION 0x01600010), and libass must have been built with libunibreak.

           The option is enabled by default except for native ASS.

       If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value specifies the filename.

       For example, to render the file sub.srt on top of the input video, use the command:

               subtitles=sub.srt

       which is equivalent to:

               subtitles=filename=sub.srt

       To render the default subtitles stream from file video.mkv, use:

               subtitles=video.mkv

       To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:

               subtitles=video.mkv:si=1

       To make the subtitles stream from sub.srt appear in 80% transparent blue "DejaVu Serif", use:

               subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='Fontname=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HCCFF0000'

   super2xsai
       Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and Interpolate) pixel art scaling
       algorithm.

       Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.

   swaprect
       Swap two rectangular objects in video.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       w   Set object width.

       h   Set object height.

       x1  Set 1st rect x coordinate.

       y1  Set 1st rect y coordinate.

       x2  Set 2nd rect x coordinate.

       y2  Set 2nd rect y coordinate.

           All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.

       The all options are expressions containing the following constants:

       w
       h   The input width and height.

       a   same as w / h

       sar input sample aspect ratio

       dar input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (w / h) * sar

       n   The number of the input frame, starting from 0.

       t   The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.

       pos the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown; deprecated, do not use

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   swapuv
       Swap U & V plane.

   tblend
       Blend successive video frames.

       See blend

   telecine
       Apply telecine process to the video.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       first_field
           top, t
               top field first

           bottom, b
               bottom field first The default value is "top".

       pattern
           A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.  The default value is 23.

               Some typical patterns:

               NTSC output (30i):
               27.5p: 32222
               24p: 23 (classic)
               24p: 2332 (preferred)
               20p: 33
               18p: 334
               16p: 3444

               PAL output (25i):
               27.5p: 12222
               24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
               16.67p: 33
               16p: 33333334

   thistogram
       Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video across time.

       Unlike histogram video filter which only shows histogram of single input frame at certain time, this
       filter shows also past histograms of number of frames defined by "width" option.

       The computed histogram is a representation of the color component distribution in an image.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       width, w
           Set width of single color component output. Default value is 0.  Value of 0 means width will be
           picked from input video.  This also set number of passed histograms to keep.  Allowed range is [0,
           8192].

       display_mode, d
           Set display mode.  It accepts the following values:

           stack
               Per color component graphs are placed below each other.

           parade
               Per color component graphs are placed side by side.

           overlay
               Presents information identical to that in the "parade", except that the graphs representing color
               components are superimposed directly over one another.

           Default is "stack".

       levels_mode, m
           Set mode. Can be either "linear", or "logarithmic".  Default is "linear".

       components, c
           Set what color components to display.  Default is 7.

       bgopacity, b
           Set background opacity. Default is 0.9.

       envelope, e
           Show envelope. Default is disabled.

       ecolor, ec
           Set envelope color. Default is "gold".

       slide
           Set slide mode.

           Available values for slide is:

           frame
               Draw new frame when right border is reached.

           replace
               Replace old columns with new ones.

           scroll
               Scroll from right to left.

           rscroll
               Scroll from left to right.

           picture
               Draw single picture.

           Default is "replace".

   threshold
       Apply threshold effect to video stream.

       This filter needs four video streams to perform thresholding.  First stream is stream we are filtering.
       Second stream is holding threshold values, third stream is holding min values, and last, fourth stream is
       holding max values.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.  By default value 0xf, all
           planes will be processed.

       For example if first stream pixel's component value is less then threshold value of pixel component from
       2nd threshold stream, third stream value will picked, otherwise fourth stream pixel component value will
       be picked.

       Using color source filter one can perform various types of thresholding:

       Commands

       This filter supports the all options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:

                   ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=black -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi

       •   Inverted binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:

                   ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -f lavfi -i color=black -lavfi threshold output.avi

       •   Truncate binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:

                   ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -lavfi threshold output.avi

       •   Threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:

                   ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -i 320x240.avi -lavfi threshold output.avi

       •   Inverted threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:

                   ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi

   thumbnail
       Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       n   Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of n frames, the filter will pick one of them, and
           then handle the next batch of n frames until the end. Default is 100.

       log Set the log level to display picked frame stats.  Default is "info".

       Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger n value will result in a higher
       memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.

       Examples

       •   Extract one picture each 50 frames:

                   thumbnail=50

       •   Complete example of a thumbnail creation with ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png

   tile
       Tile several successive frames together.

       The untile filter can do the reverse.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       layout
           Set the grid size in the form "COLUMNSxROWS". Range is up to UINT_MAX cells.  Default is "6x5".

       nb_frames
           Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less than or equal to wxh.
           The default value is 0, meaning all the area will be used.

       margin
           Set the outer border margin in pixels. Range is 0 to 1024. Default is 0.

       padding
           Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For more advanced padding
           options (such as having different values for the edges), refer to the pad video filter. Range is 0 to
           1024. Default is 0.

       color
           Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
           ffmpeg-utils manual.  The default value of color is "black".

       overlap
           Set the number of frames to overlap when tiling several successive frames together.  The value must
           be between 0 and nb_frames - 1. Default is 0.

       init_padding
           Set the number of frames to initially be empty before displaying first output frame.  This controls
           how soon will one get first output frame.  The value must be between 0 and nb_frames - 1. Default is
           0.

       Examples

       •   Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (-skip_frame nokey) in a movie:

                   ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png

           The -vsync 0 is necessary to prevent ffmpeg from duplicating each output frame to accommodate the
           originally detected frame rate.

       •   Display 5 pictures in an area of "3x2" frames, with 7 pixels between them, and 2 pixels of initial
           margin, using mixed flat and named options:

                   tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2

   tiltandshift
       What happens when you invert time and space?

       Normally a video is composed of several frames that represent a different instant of time and shows a
       scence that evolves in the space captured by the frame. This filter is the antipode of that concept,
       taking inspiration by tilt and shift photography.

       A filtered frame contains the whole timeline of events composing the sequence, and this is obtained by
       placing a slice of pixels from each frame into a single one. However, since there are no infinite-width
       frames, this is done up the width of the input frame, and a video is recomposed by shifting away one
       column for each subsequent frame. In order to map space to time, the filter tilts each input frame as
       well, so that motion is preseved. This is accomplished by progressively selecting a different column from
       each input frame.

       The end result is a sort of inverted parralax, so that far away objects move much faster that the ones in
       the front. The ideal conditions for this video effect are when there is either very little motion and the
       backgroud is static, or when there is a lot of motion and a very wide depth of field (eg. wide panorama,
       while moving on a train).

       The filter accepts the following parameters:

       tilt
           Tilt video while shifting (default). When unset, video will be sliding a static image, composed of
           the first column of each frame.

       start
           What to do at the start of filtering (see below).

       end What to do at the end of filtering (see below).

       hold
           How many columns should pass through before start of filtering.

       pad How many columns should be inserted before end of filtering.

       Normally the filter shifts and tils from the very first frame, and stops when the last one is received.
       However, before filtering starts, normal video may be preseved, so that the effect is slowly shifted in
       its place. Similarly, the last video frame may be reconstructed at the end. Alternatively it is possible
       to just start and end with black.

       none
           Filtering is starts immediately and ends when the last frame is received.

       frame
           The first frames or the very last frame are kept intact during processing.

       black
           Black is padded at the beginning or at the end of filtering.

   tinterlace
       Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.

       Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is considered odd.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       mode
           Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified as a value alone. See below
           for a list of values for this option.

           Available values are:

           merge, 0
               Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field, generating a double height frame
               at half frame rate.

                        ------> time
                       Input:
                       Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4

                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444

                       Output:
                       11111                           33333
                       22222                           44444
                       11111                           33333
                       22222                           44444
                       11111                           33333
                       22222                           44444
                       11111                           33333
                       22222                           44444

           drop_even, 1
               Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with unchanged height at half
               frame rate.

                        ------> time
                       Input:
                       Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4

                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444

                       Output:
                       11111                           33333
                       11111                           33333
                       11111                           33333
                       11111                           33333

           drop_odd, 2
               Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with unchanged height at half
               frame rate.

                        ------> time
                       Input:
                       Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4

                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444

                       Output:
                                       22222                           44444
                                       22222                           44444
                                       22222                           44444
                                       22222                           44444

           pad, 3
               Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black, generating a frame with
               double height at the same input frame rate.

                        ------> time
                       Input:
                       Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4

                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444

                       Output:
                       11111           .....           33333           .....
                       .....           22222           .....           44444
                       11111           .....           33333           .....
                       .....           22222           .....           44444
                       11111           .....           33333           .....
                       .....           22222           .....           44444
                       11111           .....           33333           .....
                       .....           22222           .....           44444

           interleave_top, 4
               Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from even frames, generating a
               frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.

                        ------> time
                       Input:
                       Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4

                       11111<-         22222           33333<-         44444
                       11111           22222<-         33333           44444<-
                       11111<-         22222           33333<-         44444
                       11111           22222<-         33333           44444<-

                       Output:
                       11111                           33333
                       22222                           44444
                       11111                           33333
                       22222                           44444

           interleave_bottom, 5
               Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from even frames, generating a
               frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.

                        ------> time
                       Input:
                       Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4

                       11111           22222<-         33333           44444<-
                       11111<-         22222           33333<-         44444
                       11111           22222<-         33333           44444<-
                       11111<-         22222           33333<-         44444

                       Output:
                       22222                           44444
                       11111                           33333
                       22222                           44444
                       11111                           33333

           interlacex2, 6
               Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each containing the second temporal
               field from the previous input frame and the first temporal field from the next input frame. This
               mode relies on the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no field
               synchronisation.

                        ------> time
                       Input:
                       Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4

                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                        11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                        11111           22222           33333           44444

                       Output:
                       11111   22222   22222   33333   33333   44444   44444
                        11111   11111   22222   22222   33333   33333   44444
                       11111   22222   22222   33333   33333   44444   44444
                        11111   11111   22222   22222   33333   33333   44444

           mergex2, 7
               Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field, generating a double height frame
               at same frame rate.

                        ------> time
                       Input:
                       Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4

                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444
                       11111           22222           33333           44444

                       Output:
                       11111           33333           33333           55555
                       22222           22222           44444           44444
                       11111           33333           33333           55555
                       22222           22222           44444           44444
                       11111           33333           33333           55555
                       22222           22222           44444           44444
                       11111           33333           33333           55555
                       22222           22222           44444           44444

           Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward compatibility reasons.

           Default mode is "merge".

       flags
           Specify flags influencing the filter process.

           Available value for flags is:

           low_pass_filter, vlpf
               Enable linear vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.  Vertical low-pass filtering is required
               when creating an interlaced destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
               vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire patterning.

           complex_filter, cvlpf
               Enable complex vertical low-pass filtering.  This will slightly less reduce interlace 'twitter'
               and Moire patterning but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.

           bypass_il
               Bypass already interlaced frames, only adjust the frame rate.

           Vertical low-pass filtering and bypassing already interlaced frames can only be enabled for mode
           interleave_top and interleave_bottom.

   tmedian
       Pick median pixels from several successive input video frames.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       radius
           Set radius of median filter.  Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 127.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default value is 15, by which all planes are processed.

       percentile
           Set median percentile. Default value is 0.5.  Default value of 0.5 will pick always median values,
           while 0 will pick minimum values, and 1 maximum values.

       Commands

       This filter supports all above options as commands, excluding option "radius".

   tmidequalizer
       Apply Temporal Midway Video Equalization effect.

       Midway Video Equalization adjusts a sequence of video frames to have the same histograms, while
       maintaining their dynamics as much as possible. It's useful for e.g. matching exposures from a video
       frames sequence.

       This filter accepts the following option:

       radius
           Set filtering radius. Default is 5. Allowed range is from 1 to 127.

       sigma
           Set filtering sigma. Default is 0.5. This controls strength of filtering.  Setting this option to 0
           effectively does nothing.

       planes
           Set which planes to process. Default is 15, which is all available planes.

   tmix
       Mix successive video frames.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       frames
           The number of successive frames to mix. If unspecified, it defaults to 3.

       weights
           Specify weight of each input video frame.  Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights is
           smaller than number of frames last specified weight will be used for all remaining unset weights.

       scale
           Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum of each weight multiplied with pixel
           values to give final destination pixel value. By default scale is auto scaled to sum of weights.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.

       Examples

       •   Average 7 successive frames:

                   tmix=frames=7:weights="1 1 1 1 1 1 1"

       •   Apply simple temporal convolution:

                   tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 3 -1"

       •   Similar as above but only showing temporal differences:

                   tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 2 -1":scale=1

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       weights
       scale
       planes
           Syntax is same as option with same name.

   tonemap
       Tone map colors from different dynamic ranges.

       This filter expects data in single precision floating point, as it needs to operate on (and can output)
       out-of-range values. Another filter, such as zscale, is needed to convert the resulting frame to a usable
       format.

       The tonemapping algorithms implemented only work on linear light, so input data should be linearized
       beforehand (and possibly correctly tagged).

               ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,tonemap=clip,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT

       Options

       The filter accepts the following options.

       tonemap
           Set the tone map algorithm to use.

           Possible values are:

           none
               Do not apply any tone map, only desaturate overbright pixels.

           clip
               Hard-clip any out-of-range values. Use it for perfect color accuracy for in-range values, while
               distorting out-of-range values.

           linear
               Stretch the entire reference gamut to a linear multiple of the display.

           gamma
               Fit a logarithmic transfer between the tone curves.

           reinhard
               Preserve overall image brightness with a simple curve, using nonlinear contrast, which results in
               flattening details and degrading color accuracy.

           hable
               Preserve both dark and bright details better than reinhard, at the cost of slightly darkening
               everything. Use it when detail preservation is more important than color and brightness accuracy.

           mobius
               Smoothly map out-of-range values, while retaining contrast and colors for in-range material as
               much as possible. Use it when color accuracy is more important than detail preservation.

           Default is none.

       param
           Tune the tone mapping algorithm.

           This affects the following algorithms:

           none
               Ignored.

           linear
               Specifies the scale factor to use while stretching.  Default to 1.0.

           gamma
               Specifies the exponent of the function.  Default to 1.8.

           clip
               Specify an extra linear coefficient to multiply into the signal before clipping.  Default to 1.0.

           reinhard
               Specify the local contrast coefficient at the display peak.  Default to 0.5, which means that in-
               gamut values will be about half as bright as when clipping.

           hable
               Ignored.

           mobius
               Specify the transition point from linear to mobius transform. Every value below this point is
               guaranteed to be mapped 1:1. The higher the value, the more accurate the result will be, at the
               cost of losing bright details.  Default to 0.3, which due to the steep initial slope still
               preserves in-range colors fairly accurately.

       desat
           Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The higher the parameter, the
           more color information will be preserved. This setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for
           super-highlights, by (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural, at
           the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.

           The default of 2.0 is somewhat conservative and will mostly just apply to skies or directly sunlit
           surfaces. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.

           This option works only if the input frame has a supported color tag.

       peak
           Override signal/nominal/reference peak with this value. Useful when the embedded peak information in
           display metadata is not reliable or when tone mapping from a lower range to a higher range.

   tpad
       Temporarily pad video frames.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       start
           Specify number of delay frames before input video stream. Default is 0.

       stop
           Specify number of padding frames after input video stream.  Set to -1 to pad indefinitely. Default is
           0.

       start_mode
           Set kind of frames added to beginning of stream.  Can be either add or clone.  With add frames of
           solid-color are added.  With clone frames are clones of first frame.  Default is add.

       stop_mode
           Set kind of frames added to end of stream.  Can be either add or clone.  With add frames of solid-
           color are added.  With clone frames are clones of last frame.  Default is add.

       start_duration, stop_duration
           Specify the duration of the start/stop delay. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1)
           manual for the accepted syntax.  These options override start and stop. Default is 0.

       color
           Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
           ffmpeg-utils manual.

           The default value of color is "black".

   transpose
       Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       dir Specify the transposition direction.

           Can assume the following values:

           0, 4, cclock_flip
               Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:

                       L.R     L.l
                       . . ->  . .
                       l.r     R.r

           1, 5, clock
               Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:

                       L.R     l.L
                       . . ->  . .
                       l.r     r.R

           2, 6, cclock
               Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:

                       L.R     R.r
                       . . ->  . .
                       l.r     L.l

           3, 7, clock_flip
               Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:

                       L.R     r.R
                       . . ->  . .
                       l.r     l.L

           For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input video geometry is portrait and
           not landscape. These values are deprecated, the "passthrough" option should be used instead.

           Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of symbolic constants.

       passthrough
           Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one specified by the specified
           value. It accepts the following values:

           none
               Always apply transposition.

           portrait
               Preserve portrait geometry (when height >= width).

           landscape
               Preserve landscape geometry (when width >= height).

           Default value is "none".

       For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait layout:

               transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait

       The command above can also be specified as:

               transpose=1:portrait

   transpose_npp
       Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.  For more in depth examples see
       the transpose video filter, which shares mostly the same options.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       dir Specify the transposition direction.

           Can assume the following values:

           cclock_flip
               Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)

           clock
               Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.

           cclock
               Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.

           clock_flip
               Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.

       passthrough
           Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one specified by the specified
           value. It accepts the following values:

           none
               Always apply transposition. (default)

           portrait
               Preserve portrait geometry (when height >= width).

           landscape
               Preserve landscape geometry (when width >= height).

   trim
       Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       start
           Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the timestamp start will be
           the first frame in the output.

       end Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame immediately preceding the
           one with the timestamp end will be the last frame in the output.

       start_pts
           This is the same as start, except this option sets the start timestamp in timebase units instead of
           seconds.

       end_pts
           This is the same as end, except this option sets the end timestamp in timebase units instead of
           seconds.

       duration
           The maximum duration of the output in seconds.

       start_frame
           The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.

       end_frame
           The number of the first frame that should be dropped.

       start, end, and duration are expressed as time duration specifications; see the Time duration section in
       the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual for the accepted syntax.

       Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the duration option look at the frame
       timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the frames that pass through the filter. Also note that
       this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero,
       insert a setpts filter after the trim filter.

       If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and keep all the frames that
       match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep only the part that matches all the constraints
       at once, chain multiple trim filters.

       The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.  just the end values to
       keep everything before the specified time.

       Examples:

       •   Drop everything except the second minute of input:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120

       •   Keep only the first second:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1

   unpremultiply
       Apply alpha unpremultiply effect to input video stream using first plane of second stream as alpha.

       Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.  By default value 0xf, all
           planes will be processed.

           If the format has 1 or 2 components, then luma is bit 0.  If the format has 3 or 4 components: for
           RGB formats bit 0 is green, bit 1 is blue and bit 2 is red; for YUV formats bit 0 is luma, bit 1 is
           chroma-U and bit 2 is chroma-V.  If present, the alpha channel is always the last bit.

       inplace
           Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.

   unsharp
       Sharpen or blur the input video.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       luma_msize_x, lx
           Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between 3 and 23. The default value is
           5.

       luma_msize_y, ly
           Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3 and 23. The default value is
           5.

       luma_amount, la
           Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable values lay between -1.5
           and 1.5.

           Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will sharpen it, a value of zero
           will disable the effect.

           Default value is 1.0.

       chroma_msize_x, cx
           Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between 3 and 23. The default value
           is 5.

       chroma_msize_y, cy
           Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3 and 23. The default value is
           5.

       chroma_amount, ca
           Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable values lay between
           -1.5 and 1.5.

           Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will sharpen it, a value of zero
           will disable the effect.

           Default value is 0.0.

       alpha_msize_x, ax
           Set the alpha matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between 3 and 23. The default value
           is 5.

       alpha_msize_y, ay
           Set the alpha matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3 and 23. The default value is
           5.

       alpha_amount, aa
           Set the alpha effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable values lay between -1.5
           and 1.5.

           Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will sharpen it, a value of zero
           will disable the effect.

           Default value is 0.0.

       All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.

       Examples

       •   Apply strong luma sharpen effect:

                   unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5

       •   Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:

                   unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2

   untile
       Decompose a video made of tiled images into the individual images.

       The frame rate of the output video is the frame rate of the input video multiplied by the number of
       tiles.

       This filter does the reverse of tile.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       layout
           Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of this option, check the
           "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

       Examples

       •   Produce a 1-second video from a still image file made of 25 frames stacked vertically, like an
           analogic film reel:

                   ffmpeg -r 1 -i image.jpg -vf untile=1x25 movie.mkv

   uspp
       Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image at several (or -
       in the case of quality level 8 - all) shifts and average the results.

       The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes & decodes each case with
       libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8 DCT similar to MJPEG.

       This filter is only available in ffmpeg version 4.4 or earlier.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       quality
           Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts an integer in the
           range 0-8. If set to 0, the filter will have no effect. A value of 8 means the higher quality. For
           each increment of that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2.  Default value is 3.

       qp  Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
           (if available).

       codec
           Use specified codec instead of snow.

   v360
       Convert 360 videos between various formats.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       input
       output
           Set format of the input/output video.

           Available formats:

           e
           equirect
               Equirectangular projection.

           c3x2
           c6x1
           c1x6
               Cubemap with 3x2/6x1/1x6 layout.

               Format specific options:

               in_pad
               out_pad
                   Set padding proportion for the input/output cubemap. Values in decimals.

                   Example values:

                   0   No padding.

                   0.01
                       1% of face is padding. For example, with 1920x1280 resolution face size would be 640x640
                       and padding would be 3 pixels from each side. (640 * 0.01 = 6 pixels)

                   Default value is @samp{0}.  Maximum value is @samp{0.1}.

               fin_pad
               fout_pad
                   Set fixed padding for the input/output cubemap. Values in pixels.

                   Default value is @samp{0}. If greater than zero it overrides other padding options.

               in_forder
               out_forder
                   Set order of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one direction for each position.

                   Designation of directions:

                   r   right

                   l   left

                   u   up

                   d   down

                   f   forward

                   b   back

                   Default value is @samp{rludfb}.

               in_frot
               out_frot
                   Set rotation of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one angle for each position.

                   Designation of angles:

                   0   0 degrees clockwise

                   1   90 degrees clockwise

                   2   180 degrees clockwise

                   3   270 degrees clockwise

                   Default value is @samp{000000}.

           eac Equi-Angular Cubemap.

           flat
           gnomonic
           rectilinear
               Regular video.

               Format specific options:

               h_fov
               v_fov
               d_fov
                   Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

               ih_fov
               iv_fov
               id_fov
                   Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

           dfisheye
               Dual fisheye.

               Format specific options:

               h_fov
               v_fov
               d_fov
                   Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

               ih_fov
               iv_fov
               id_fov
                   Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

           barrel
           fb
           barrelsplit
               Facebook's 360 formats.

           sg  Stereographic format.

               Format specific options:

               h_fov
               v_fov
               d_fov
                   Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

               ih_fov
               iv_fov
               id_fov
                   Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

           mercator
               Mercator format.

           ball
               Ball format, gives significant distortion toward the back.

           hammer
               Hammer-Aitoff map projection format.

           sinusoidal
               Sinusoidal map projection format.

           fisheye
               Fisheye projection.

               Format specific options:

               h_fov
               v_fov
               d_fov
                   Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

               ih_fov
               iv_fov
               id_fov
                   Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

           pannini
               Pannini projection.

               Format specific options:

               h_fov
                   Set output pannini parameter.

               ih_fov
                   Set input pannini parameter.

           cylindrical
               Cylindrical projection.

               Format specific options:

               h_fov
               v_fov
               d_fov
                   Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

               ih_fov
               iv_fov
               id_fov
                   Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

           perspective
               Perspective projection. (output only)

               Format specific options:

               v_fov
                   Set perspective parameter.

           tetrahedron
               Tetrahedron projection.

           tsp Truncated square pyramid projection.

           he
           hequirect
               Half equirectangular projection.

           equisolid
               Equisolid format.

               Format specific options:

               h_fov
               v_fov
               d_fov
                   Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

               ih_fov
               iv_fov
               id_fov
                   Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

           og  Orthographic format.

               Format specific options:

               h_fov
               v_fov
               d_fov
                   Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

               ih_fov
               iv_fov
               id_fov
                   Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.

                   If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.

           octahedron
               Octahedron projection.

           cylindricalea
               Cylindrical Equal Area projection.

       interp
           Set interpolation method.Note: more complex interpolation methods require much more memory to run.

           Available methods:

           near
           nearest
               Nearest neighbour.

           line
           linear
               Bilinear interpolation.

           lagrange9
               Lagrange9 interpolation.

           cube
           cubic
               Bicubic interpolation.

           lanc
           lanczos
               Lanczos interpolation.

           sp16
           spline16
               Spline16 interpolation.

           gauss
           gaussian
               Gaussian interpolation.

           mitchell
               Mitchell interpolation.

           Default value is @samp{line}.

       w
       h   Set the output video resolution.

           Default resolution depends on formats.

       in_stereo
       out_stereo
           Set the input/output stereo format.

           2d  2D mono

           sbs Side by side

           tb  Top bottom

           Default value is @samp{2d} for input and output format.

       yaw
       pitch
       roll
           Set rotation for the output video. Values in degrees.

       rorder
           Set rotation order for the output video. Choose one item for each position.

           y, Y
               yaw

           p, P
               pitch

           r, R
               roll

           Default value is @samp{ypr}.

       h_flip
       v_flip
       d_flip
           Flip the output video horizontally(swaps left-right)/vertically(swaps up-down)/in-depth(swaps back-
           forward). Boolean values.

       ih_flip
       iv_flip
           Set if input video is flipped horizontally/vertically. Boolean values.

       in_trans
           Set if input video is transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.

       out_trans
           Set if output video needs to be transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.

       h_offset
       v_offset
           Set output horizontal/vertical off-axis offset. Default is set to 0.  Allowed range is from -1 to 1.

       alpha_mask
           Build mask in alpha plane for all unmapped pixels by marking them fully transparent. Boolean value,
           by default disabled.

       reset_rot
           Reset rotation of output video. Boolean value, by default disabled.

       Examples

       •   Convert equirectangular video to cubemap with 3x2 layout and 1% padding using bicubic interpolation:

                   ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=e:c3x2:cubic:out_pad=0.01 output.mkv

       •   Extract back view of Equi-Angular Cubemap:

                   ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=eac:flat:yaw=180 output.mkv

       •   Convert transposed and horizontally flipped Equi-Angular Cubemap in side-by-side stereo format to
           equirectangular top-bottom stereo format:

                   v360=eac:equirect:in_stereo=sbs:in_trans=1:ih_flip=1:out_stereo=tb

       Commands

       This filter supports subset of above options as commands.

   vaguedenoiser
       Apply a wavelet based denoiser.

       It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain, using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau
       9/7. Then it applies some filtering to the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform
       after.  Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and reduced noise, without
       blurring picture features.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       threshold
           The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.  Hard thresholding can use a
           higher threshold than soft thresholding before the video looks overfiltered. Default value is 2.

       method
           The filtering method the filter will use.

           It accepts the following values:

           hard
               All values under the threshold will be zeroed.

           soft
               All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be reduced by the threshold.

           garrote
               Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and (less) hard thresholding.

           Default is garrote.

       nsteps
           Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't be decomposed beyond a
           particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480 frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480). Valid values are integers
           between 1 and 32. Default value is 6.

       percent
           Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100. Default value is 85.

       planes
           A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.

       type
           The threshold type the filter will use.

           It accepts the following values:

           universal
               Threshold used is same for all decompositions.

           bayes
               Threshold used depends also on each decomposition coefficients.

           Default is universal.

   varblur
       Apply variable blur filter by using 2nd video stream to set blur radius.  The 2nd stream must have the
       same dimensions.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       min_r
           Set min allowed radius. Allowed range is from 0 to 254. Default is 0.

       max_r
           Set max allowed radius. Allowed range is from 1 to 255. Default is 8.

       planes
           Set which planes to process. By default, all are used.

       The "varblur" filter also supports the framesync options.

       Commands

       This filter supports all the above options as commands.

   vectorscope
       Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called a vectorscope).

       This filter accepts the following options:

       mode, m
           Set vectorscope mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           gray
           tint
               Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have same component color
               value on location in graph. This is the default mode.

           color
               Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not present in video
               frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are set by option "x" and "y". The 3rd
               color component is static.

           color2
               Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.

           color3
               Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values "x" and "y" on graph increases value of
               another color component, which is luminance by default values of "x" and "y".

           color4
               Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different colors map to same
               position on graph then color with higher value of component not present in graph is picked.

           color5
               Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to "color" but with 3rd color component picked from
               radial gradient.

       x   Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is 1.

       y   Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is 2.

       intensity, i
           Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness of color
           component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.

       envelope, e
           none
               No envelope, this is default.

           instant
               Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.

           peak
               Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you can still spot out of
               range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.

           peak+instant
               Peak and instant envelope combined together.

       graticule, g
           Set what kind of graticule to draw.

           none
           green
           color
           invert
       opacity, o
           Set graticule opacity.

       flags, f
           Set graticule flags.

           white
               Draw graticule for white point.

           black
               Draw graticule for black point.

           name
               Draw color points short names.

       bgopacity, b
           Set background opacity.

       lthreshold, l
           Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.  Values lower than this value
           will be ignored. Default is 0.  Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one
           pixel component can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold is 0.1 *
           255 = 25.

       hthreshold, h
           Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.  Values higher than this value
           will be ignored. Default is 1.  Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one
           pixel component can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold is 0.9
           * 255 = 230.

       colorspace, c
           Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.

           auto
           601
           709

           Default is auto.

       tint0, t0
       tint1, t1
           Set color tint for gray/tint vectorscope mode. By default both options are zero.  This means no tint,
           and output will remain gray.

   vidstabdetect
       Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see vidstabtransform for pass 2.

       This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation transform information about
       subsequent frames, which is then used by the vidstabtransform filter.

       To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libvidstab".

       This filter accepts the following options:

       result
           Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.  Default value is transforms.trf.

       shakiness
           Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an integer in the range 1-10, a
           value of 1 means little shakiness, a value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.

       accuracy
           Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the range 1-15. A value of 1 means
           low accuracy, a value of 15 means high accuracy. Default value is 15.

       stepsize
           Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is scanned with 1 pixel resolution.
           Default value is 6.

       mincontrast
           Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is discarded. Must be a floating
           point value in the range 0-1. Default value is 0.3.

       tripod
           Set reference frame number for tripod mode.

           If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame in the filtered stream,
           identified by the specified number. The idea is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static
           scene and keep the camera view absolutely still.

           If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.

       show
           Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an integer in the range 0-2. Default
           value is 0, which disables any visualization.

       fileformat
           Format for the transforms data file to be written.  Acceptable values are

           ascii
               Human-readable plain text

           binary
               Binary format, roughly 40% smaller than "ascii". (default)

       Examples

       •   Use default values:

                   vidstabdetect

       •   Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file mytransforms.trf:

                   vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"

       •   Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting video:

                   vidstabdetect=show=1

       •   Analyze a video with medium shakiness using ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi

   vidstabtransform
       Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2, see vidstabdetect for pass 1.

       Read a file with transform information for each frame and apply/compensate them. Together with the
       vidstabdetect filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also <http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab>.
       It is important to also use the unsharp filter, see below.

       To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libvidstab".

       Options

       input
           Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is transforms.trf.

       smoothing
           Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the camera movements. Default value
           is 10.

           For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the past and 10 in the future) to
           smoothen the motion in the video. A larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the
           acceleration of the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static camera is
           simulated.

       optalgo
           Set the camera path optimization algorithm.

           Accepted values are:

           gauss
               gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)

           avg averaging on transformations

       maxshift
           Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1, meaning no limit.

       maxangle
           Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default value is -1, meaning no limit.

       crop
           Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement compensation.

           Available values are:

           keep
               keep image information from previous frame (default)

           black
               fill the border black

       invert
           Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.

       relative
           Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1, absolute if set to 0. Default value is
           0.

       zoom
           Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in effect, a negative value in a zoom-
           out effect. Default value is 0 (no zoom).

       optzoom
           Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.

           Accepted values are:

           0   disabled

           1   optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements will lead to visible borders)
               (default)

           2   optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be visible), see zoomspeed

           Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.

       zoomspeed
           Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when optzoom is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5,
           default value is 0.25.

       interpol
           Specify type of interpolation.

           Available values are:

           no  no interpolation

           linear
               linear only horizontal

           bilinear
               linear in both directions (default)

           bicubic
               cubic in both directions (slow)

       tripod
           Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to "relative=0:smoothing=0". Default
           value is 0.

           Use also "tripod" option of vidstabdetect.

       debug
           Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions are written to the temporary
           file global_motions.trf. Default value is 0.

       Examples

       •   Use ffmpeg for a typical stabilization with default values:

                   ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg

           Note the use of the unsharp filter which is always recommended.

       •   Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:

                   vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"

       •   Smoothen the video even more:

                   vidstabtransform=smoothing=30

   vflip
       Flip the input video vertically.

       For example, to vertically flip a video with ffmpeg:

               ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi

   vfrdet
       Detect variable frame rate video.

       This filter tries to detect if the input is variable or constant frame rate.

       At end it will output number of frames detected as having variable delta pts, and ones with constant
       delta pts.  If there was frames with variable delta, than it will also show min, max and average delta
       encountered.

   vibrance
       Boost or alter saturation.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       intensity
           Set strength of boost if positive value or strength of alter if negative value.  Default is 0.
           Allowed range is from -2 to 2.

       rbal
           Set the red balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.

       gbal
           Set the green balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.

       bbal
           Set the blue balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.

       rlum
           Set the red luma coefficient.

       glum
           Set the green luma coefficient.

       blum
           Set the blue luma coefficient.

       alternate
           If "intensity" is negative and this is set to 1, colors will change, otherwise colors will be less
           saturated, more towards gray.

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands.

   vif
       Obtain the average VIF (Visual Information Fidelity) between two input videos.

       This filter takes two input videos.

       Both input videos must have the same resolution and pixel format for this filter to work correctly. Also
       it assumes that both inputs have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.

       The obtained average VIF score is printed through the logging system.

       The filter stores the calculated VIF score of each frame.

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

       In the below example the input file main.mpg being processed is compared with the reference file ref.mpg.

               ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi vif -f null -

   vignette
       Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       angle, a
           Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.

           The value is clipped in the "[0,PI/2]" range.

           Default value: "PI/5"

       x0
       y0  Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively "w/2" and "h/2" by default.

       mode
           Set forward/backward mode.

           Available modes are:

           forward
               The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.

           backward
               The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.  This can be used
               to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic detection to extract the lens angle
               and other settings (yet). It can also be used to create a burning effect.

           Default value is forward.

       eval
           Set evaluation mode for the expressions (angle, x0, y0).

           It accepts the following values:

           init
               Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.

           frame
               Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the init mode since it
               requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it allows advanced dynamic expressions.

           Default value is init.

       dither
           Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is 1 (enabled).

       aspect
           Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.  Setting this value
           to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting following the dimensions of the video.

           Default is "1/1".

       Expressions

       The alpha, x0 and y0 expressions can contain the following parameters.

       w
       h   input width and height

       n   the number of input frame, starting from 0

       pts the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in TB units, NAN if
           undefined

       r   frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown

       t   the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame, expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined

       tb  time base of the input video

       Examples

       •   Apply simple strong vignetting effect:

                   vignette=PI/4

       •   Make a flickering vignetting:

                   vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame

   vmafmotion
       Obtain the average VMAF motion score of a video.  It is one of the component metrics of VMAF.

       The obtained average motion score is printed through the logging system.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       stats_file
           If specified, the filter will use the named file to save the motion score of each frame with respect
           to the previous frame.  When filename equals "-" the data is sent to standard output.

       Example:

               ffmpeg -i ref.mpg -vf vmafmotion -f null -

   vstack
       Stack input videos vertically.

       All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.

       Note that this filter is faster than using overlay and pad filter to create same output.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       inputs
           Set number of input streams. Default is 2.

       shortest
           If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input terminates. Default value is 0.

   w3fdif
       Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field Deinterlacing Filter").

       Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and implemented based on the de-interlace
       algorithm written by Jim Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter uses filter
       coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.

       This filter uses field-dominance information in frame to decide which of each pair of fields to place
       first in the output.  If it gets it wrong use setfield filter before "w3fdif" filter.

       There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple" and "complex". Which set of filter
       coefficients is used can be set by passing an optional parameter:

       filter
           Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:

           simple
               Simple filter coefficient set.

           complex
               More-complex filter coefficient set.

           Default value is complex.

       mode
           The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:

           frame
               Output one frame for each frame.

           field
               Output one frame for each field.

           The default value is "field".

       parity
           The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one of the following
           values:

           tff Assume the top field is first.

           bff Assume the bottom field is first.

           auto
               Enable automatic detection of field parity.

           The default value is "auto".  If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this
           information, top field first will be assumed.

       deint
           Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:

           all Deinterlace all frames,

           interlaced
               Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.

           Default value is all.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   waveform
       Video waveform monitor.

       The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luma only. Each column of the waveform
       corresponds to a column of pixels in the source video.

       It accepts the following options:

       mode, m
           Can be either "row", or "column". Default is "column".  In row mode, the graph on the left side
           represents color component value 0 and the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top
           side represents color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.

       intensity, i
           Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same luminance are
           distributed across input rows/columns.  Default value is 0.04. Allowed range is [0, 1].

       mirror, r
           Set mirroring mode. 0 means unmirrored, 1 means mirrored.  In mirrored mode, higher values will be
           represented on the left side for "row" mode and at the top for "column" mode. Default is 1
           (mirrored).

       display, d
           Set display mode.  It accepts the following values:

           overlay
               Presents information identical to that in the "parade", except that the graphs representing color
               components are superimposed directly over one another.

               This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities in overlapping
               areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical, such as neutral whites, grays,
               or blacks.

           stack
               Display separate graph for the color components side by side in "row" mode or one below the other
               in "column" mode.

           parade
               Display separate graph for the color components side by side in "column" mode or one below the
               other in "row" mode.

               Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights and shadows of an
               image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom graphs of each waveform. Since whites,
               grays, and blacks are characterized by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral
               areas of the picture should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
               correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.

           Default is "stack".

       components, c
           Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luma or red color component if
           input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color
           components.

       envelope, e
           none
               No envelope, this is default.

           instant
               Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily visible even with
               small "step" value.

           peak
               Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you can still spot out
               of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.

           peak+instant
               Peak and instant envelope combined together.

       filter, f
           lowpass
               No filtering, this is default.

           flat
               Luma and chroma combined together.

           aflat
               Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.

           xflat
               Similar as above, but use different colors.

           yflat
               Similar as above, but again with different colors.

           chroma
               Displays only chroma.

           color
               Displays actual color value on waveform.

           acolor
               Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.

       graticule, g
           Set which graticule to display.

           none
               Do not display graticule.

           green
               Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.

           orange
               Display orange graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.

           invert
               Display invert graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.

       opacity, o
           Set graticule opacity.

       flags, fl
           Set graticule flags.

           numbers
               Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.

           dots
               Draw dots instead of lines.

       scale, s
           Set scale used for displaying graticule.

           digital
           millivolts
           ire

           Default is digital.

       bgopacity, b
           Set background opacity.

       tint0, t0
       tint1, t1
           Set tint for output.  Only used with lowpass filter and when display is not overlay and input pixel
           formats are not RGB.

       fitmode, fm
           Set sample aspect ratio of video output frames.  Can be used to configure waveform so it is not
           streched too much in one of directions.

           none
               Set sample aspect ration to 1/1.

           size
               Set sample aspect ratio to match input size of video

           Default is none.

       input
           Set input formats for filter to pick from.  Can be all, for selecting from all available formats, or
           first, for selecting first available format.  Default is first.

   weave, doubleweave
       The "weave" takes a field-based video input and join each two sequential fields into single frame,
       producing a new double height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.

       The "doubleweave" works same as "weave" but without halving frame rate and frame count.

       It accepts the following option:

       first_field
           Set first field. Available values are:

           top, t
               Set the frame as top-field-first.

           bottom, b
               Set the frame as bottom-field-first.

       Examples

       •   Interlace video using select and separatefields filter:

                   separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave

   xbr
       Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel art. It follows a set of
       edge-detection rules, see <https://forums.libretro.com/t/xbr-algorithm-tutorial/123>.

       It accepts the following option:

       n   Set the scaling dimension: 2 for "2xBR", 3 for "3xBR" and 4 for "4xBR".  Default is 3.

   xcorrelate
       Apply normalized cross-correlation between first and second input video stream.

       Second input video stream dimensions must be lower than first input video stream.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       planes
           Set which planes to process.

       secondary
           Set which secondary video frames will be processed from second input video stream, can be first or
           all. Default is all.

       The "xcorrelate" filter also supports the framesync options.

   xfade
       Apply cross fade from one input video stream to another input video stream.  The cross fade is applied
       for specified duration.

       Both inputs must be constant frame-rate and have the same resolution, pixel format, frame rate and
       timebase.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       transition
           Set one of available transition effects:

           custom
           fade
           wipeleft
           wiperight
           wipeup
           wipedown
           slideleft
           slideright
           slideup
           slidedown
           circlecrop
           rectcrop
           distance
           fadeblack
           fadewhite
           radial
           smoothleft
           smoothright
           smoothup
           smoothdown
           circleopen
           circleclose
           vertopen
           vertclose
           horzopen
           horzclose
           dissolve
           pixelize
           diagtl
           diagtr
           diagbl
           diagbr
           hlslice
           hrslice
           vuslice
           vdslice
           hblur
           fadegrays
           wipetl
           wipetr
           wipebl
           wipebr
           squeezeh
           squeezev
           zoomin
           fadefast
           fadeslow
           hlwind
           hrwind
           vuwind
           vdwind
           coverleft
           coverright
           coverup
           coverdown
           revealleft
           revealright
           revealup
           revealdown

           Default transition effect is fade.

       duration
           Set cross fade duration in seconds.  Range is 0 to 60 seconds.  Default duration is 1 second.

       offset
           Set cross fade start relative to first input stream in seconds.  Default offset is 0.

       expr
           Set expression for custom transition effect.

           The expressions can use the following variables and functions:

           X
           Y   The coordinates of the current sample.

           W
           H   The width and height of the image.

           P   Progress of transition effect.

           PLANE
               Currently processed plane.

           A   Return value of first input at current location and plane.

           B   Return value of second input at current location and plane.

           a0(x, y)
           a1(x, y)
           a2(x, y)
           a3(x, y)
               Return the value of the pixel at location (x,y) of the first/second/third/fourth component of
               first input.

           b0(x, y)
           b1(x, y)
           b2(x, y)
           b3(x, y)
               Return the value of the pixel at location (x,y) of the first/second/third/fourth component of
               second input.

       Examples

       •   Cross fade from one input video to another input video, with fade transition and duration of
           transition of 2 seconds starting at offset of 5 seconds:

                   ffmpeg -i first.mp4 -i second.mp4 -filter_complex xfade=transition=fade:duration=2:offset=5 output.mp4

   xmedian
       Pick median pixels from several input videos.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       inputs
           Set number of inputs.  Default is 3. Allowed range is from 3 to 255.  If number of inputs is even
           number, than result will be mean value between two median values.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default value is 15, by which all planes are processed.

       percentile
           Set median percentile. Default value is 0.5.  Default value of 0.5 will pick always median values,
           while 0 will pick minimum values, and 1 maximum values.

       Commands

       This filter supports all above options as commands, excluding option "inputs".

   xstack
       Stack video inputs into custom layout.

       All streams must be of same pixel format.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       inputs
           Set number of input streams. Default is 2.

       layout
           Specify layout of inputs.  This option requires the desired layout configuration to be explicitly set
           by the user.  This sets position of each video input in output. Each input is separated by '|'.  The
           first number represents the column, and the second number represents the row.  Numbers start at 0 and
           are separated by '_'. Optionally one can use wX and hX, where X is video input from which to take
           width or height.  Multiple values can be used when separated by '+'. In such case values are summed
           together.

           Note that if inputs are of different sizes gaps may appear, as not all of the output video frame will
           be filled. Similarly, videos can overlap each other if their position doesn't leave enough space for
           the full frame of adjoining videos.

           For 2 inputs, a default layout of "0_0|w0_0" (equivalent to "grid=2x1") is set. In all other cases, a
           layout or a grid must be set by the user. Either "grid" or "layout" can be specified at a time.
           Specifying both will result in an error.

       grid
           Specify a fixed size grid of inputs.  This option is used to create a fixed size grid of the input
           streams. Set the grid size in the form "COLUMNSxROWS". There must be "ROWS * COLUMNS" input streams
           and they will be arranged as a grid with "ROWS" rows and "COLUMNS" columns. When using this option,
           each input stream within a row must have the same height and all the rows must have the same width.

           If "grid" is set, then "inputs" option is ignored and is implicitly set to "ROWS * COLUMNS".

           For 2 inputs, a default grid of "2x1" (equivalent to "layout=0_0|w0_0") is set. In all other cases, a
           layout or a grid must be set by the user. Either "grid" or "layout" can be specified at a time.
           Specifying both will result in an error.

       shortest
           If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input terminates. Default value is 0.

       fill
           If set to valid color, all unused pixels will be filled with that color.  By default fill is set to
           none, so it is disabled.

       Examples

       •   Display 4 inputs into 2x2 grid.

           Layout:

                   input1(0, 0)  | input3(w0, 0)
                   input2(0, h0) | input4(w0, h0)

                   xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|w0_0|w0_h0

           Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.

       •   Display 4 inputs into 1x4 grid.

           Layout:

                   input1(0, 0)
                   input2(0, h0)
                   input3(0, h0+h1)
                   input4(0, h0+h1+h2)

                   xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2

           Note that if inputs are of different widths, unused space will appear.

       •   Display 9 inputs into 3x3 grid.

           Layout:

                   input1(0, 0)       | input4(w0, 0)      | input7(w0+w3, 0)
                   input2(0, h0)      | input5(w0, h0)     | input8(w0+w3, h0)
                   input3(0, h0+h1)   | input6(w0, h0+h1)  | input9(w0+w3, h0+h1)

                   xstack=inputs=9:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0+w3_0|w0+w3_h0|w0+w3_h0+h1

           Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.

       •   Display 16 inputs into 4x4 grid.

           Layout:

                   input1(0, 0)       | input5(w0, 0)       | input9 (w0+w4, 0)       | input13(w0+w4+w8, 0)
                   input2(0, h0)      | input6(w0, h0)      | input10(w0+w4, h0)      | input14(w0+w4+w8, h0)
                   input3(0, h0+h1)   | input7(w0, h0+h1)   | input11(w0+w4, h0+h1)   | input15(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1)
                   input4(0, h0+h1+h2)| input8(w0, h0+h1+h2)| input12(w0+w4, h0+h1+h2)| input16(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1+h2)

                   xstack=inputs=16:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4_0|
                   w0+w4_h0|w0+w4_h0+h1|w0+w4_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4+w8_0|w0+w4+w8_h0|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1+h2

           Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.

   yadif
       Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing filter").

       It accepts the following parameters:

       mode
           The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:

           0, send_frame
               Output one frame for each frame.

           1, send_field
               Output one frame for each field.

           2, send_frame_nospatial
               Like "send_frame", but it skips the spatial interlacing check.

           3, send_field_nospatial
               Like "send_field", but it skips the spatial interlacing check.

           The default value is "send_frame".

       parity
           The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one of the following
           values:

           0, tff
               Assume the top field is first.

           1, bff
               Assume the bottom field is first.

           -1, auto
               Enable automatic detection of field parity.

           The default value is "auto".  If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this
           information, top field first will be assumed.

       deint
           Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:

           0, all
               Deinterlace all frames.

           1, interlaced
               Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.

           The default value is "all".

   yadif_cuda
       Deinterlace the input video using the yadif algorithm, but implemented in CUDA so that it can work as
       part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec and/or nvenc.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       mode
           The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:

           0, send_frame
               Output one frame for each frame.

           1, send_field
               Output one frame for each field.

           2, send_frame_nospatial
               Like "send_frame", but it skips the spatial interlacing check.

           3, send_field_nospatial
               Like "send_field", but it skips the spatial interlacing check.

           The default value is "send_frame".

       parity
           The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one of the following
           values:

           0, tff
               Assume the top field is first.

           1, bff
               Assume the bottom field is first.

           -1, auto
               Enable automatic detection of field parity.

           The default value is "auto".  If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this
           information, top field first will be assumed.

       deint
           Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:

           0, all
               Deinterlace all frames.

           1, interlaced
               Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.

           The default value is "all".

   yaepblur
       Apply blur filter while preserving edges ("yaepblur" means "yet another edge preserving blur filter").
       The algorithm is described in "J. S. Lee, Digital image enhancement and noise filtering by use of local
       statistics, IEEE Trans. Pattern Anal. Mach. Intell. PAMI-2, 1980."

       It accepts the following parameters:

       radius, r
           Set the window radius. Default value is 3.

       planes, p
           Set which planes to filter. Default is only the first plane.

       sigma, s
           Set blur strength. Default value is 128.

       Commands

       This filter supports same commands as options.

   zoompan
       Apply Zoom & Pan effect.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       zoom, z
           Set the zoom expression. Range is 1-10. Default is 1.

       x
       y   Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.

       d   Set the duration expression in number of frames.  This sets for how many number of frames effect will
           last for single input image. Default is 90.

       s   Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.

       fps Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.

       Each expression can contain the following constants:

       in_w, iw
           Input width.

       in_h, ih
           Input height.

       out_w, ow
           Output width.

       out_h, oh
           Output height.

       in  Input frame count.

       on  Output frame count.

       in_time, it
           The input timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.

       out_time, time, ot
           The output timestamp expressed in seconds.

       x
       y   Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression for current input frame.

       px
       py  'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was not yet such frame
           (first input frame).

       zoom
           Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.

       pzoom
           Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.

       duration
           Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression for each input frame.

       pduration
           number of output frames created for previous input frame

       a   Rational number: input width / input height

       sar sample aspect ratio

       dar display aspect ratio

       Examples

       •   Zoom in up to 1.5x and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:

                   zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360

       •   Zoom in up to 1.5x and pan always at center of picture:

                   zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'

       •   Same as above but without pausing:

                   zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'

       •   Zoom in 2x into center of picture only for the first second of the input video:

                   zoompan=z='if(between(in_time,0,1),2,1)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'

   zscale
       Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library: <https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg>. To enable
       compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libzimg".

       The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same as the input, by changing the
       output sample aspect ratio.

       If the input image format is different from the format requested by the next filter, the zscale filter
       will convert the input to the requested format.

       Options

       The filter accepts the following options.

       width, w
       height, h
           Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input dimension.

           If the width or w value is 0, the input width is used for the output. If the height or h value is 0,
           the input height is used for the output.

           If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the zscale filter will use a value that
           maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other specified dimension. After
           that it will, however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value
           if necessary.

           If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to both values being set to 0 as
           previously detailed.

           See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension expression.

       size, s
           Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils
           manual.

       dither, d
           Set the dither type.

           Possible values are:

           none
           ordered
           random
           error_diffusion

           Default is none.

       filter, f
           Set the resize filter type.

           Possible values are:

           point
           bilinear
           bicubic
           spline16
           spline36
           lanczos

           Default is bilinear.

       range, r
           Set the color range.

           Possible values are:

           input
           limited
           full

           Default is same as input.

       primaries, p
           Set the color primaries.

           Possible values are:

           input
           709
           unspecified
           170m
           240m
           2020

           Default is same as input.

       transfer, t
           Set the transfer characteristics.

           Possible values are:

           input
           709
           unspecified
           601
           linear
           2020_10
           2020_12
           smpte2084
           iec61966-2-1
           arib-std-b67

           Default is same as input.

       matrix, m
           Set the colorspace matrix.

           Possible value are:

           input
           709
           unspecified
           470bg
           170m
           2020_ncl
           2020_cl

           Default is same as input.

       rangein, rin
           Set the input color range.

           Possible values are:

           input
           limited
           full

           Default is same as input.

       primariesin, pin
           Set the input color primaries.

           Possible values are:

           input
           709
           unspecified
           170m
           240m
           2020

           Default is same as input.

       transferin, tin
           Set the input transfer characteristics.

           Possible values are:

           input
           709
           unspecified
           601
           linear
           2020_10
           2020_12

           Default is same as input.

       matrixin, min
           Set the input colorspace matrix.

           Possible value are:

           input
           709
           unspecified
           470bg
           170m
           2020_ncl
           2020_cl
       chromal, c
           Set the output chroma location.

           Possible values are:

           input
           left
           center
           topleft
           top
           bottomleft
           bottom
       chromalin, cin
           Set the input chroma location.

           Possible values are:

           input
           left
           center
           topleft
           top
           bottomleft
           bottom
       npl Set the nominal peak luminance.

       param_a
           Parameter A for scaling filters. Parameter "b" for bicubic, and the number of filter taps for
           lanczos.

       param_b
           Parameter B for scaling filters. Parameter "c" for bicubic.

       The values of the w and h options are expressions containing the following constants:

       in_w
       in_h
           The input width and height

       iw
       ih  These are the same as in_w and in_h.

       out_w
       out_h
           The output (scaled) width and height

       ow
       oh  These are the same as out_w and out_h

       a   The same as iw / ih

       sar input sample aspect ratio

       dar The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from "(iw / ih) * sar".

       hsub
       vsub
           horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p"
           hsub is 2 and vsub is 1.

       ohsub
       ovsub
           horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p"
           hsub is 2 and vsub is 1.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       width, w
       height, h
           Set the output video dimension expression.  The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding
           option.

           If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current value.

OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS

       Below is a description of the currently available OpenCL video filters.

       To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-opencl".

       Running OpenCL filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all
       filters in any filter graph.

       -init_hw_device opencl[=name][:device[,key=value...]]
           Initialise a new hardware device of type opencl called name, using the given device parameters.

       -filter_hw_device name
           Pass the hardware device called name to all filters in any filter graph.

       For more detailed information see <https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options>

       •   Example of choosing the first device on the second platform and running avgblur_opencl filter with
           default parameters on it.

                   -init_hw_device opencl=gpu:1.0 -filter_hw_device gpu -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT

       Since OpenCL filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be
       uploaded(hwupload) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then
       downloaded(hwdownload) back to normal memory. Note that hwupload will upload to a surface with the same
       layout as the software frame, so it may be necessary to add a format filter immediately before to get the
       input into the right format and hwdownload does not support all formats on the output - it may be
       necessary to insert an additional format filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a
       supported format.

   avgblur_opencl
       Apply average blur filter.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sizeX
           Set horizontal radius size.  Range is "[1, 1024]" and default value is 1.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default value is 0xf, by which all planes are processed.

       sizeY
           Set vertical radius size. Range is "[1, 1024]" and default value is 0. If zero, "sizeX" value will be
           used.

       Example

       •   Apply average blur filter with horizontal and vertical size of 3, setting each pixel of the output to
           the average value of the 7x7 region centered on it in the input. For pixels on the edges of the
           image, the region does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are
           not used in the calculations.

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   boxblur_opencl
       Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       luma_radius, lr
       luma_power, lp
       chroma_radius, cr
       chroma_power, cp
       alpha_radius, ar
       alpha_power, ap

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       luma_radius, lr
       chroma_radius, cr
       alpha_radius, ar
           Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the corresponding input plane.

           The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be greater than the value of the
           expression "min(w,h)/2" for the luma and alpha planes, and of "min(cw,ch)/2" for the chroma planes.

           Default value for luma_radius is "2". If not specified, chroma_radius and alpha_radius default to the
           corresponding value set for luma_radius.

           The expressions can contain the following constants:

           w
           h   The input width and height in pixels.

           cw
           ch  The input chroma image width and height in pixels.

           hsub
           vsub
               The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the pixel format "yuv422p",
               hsub is 2 and vsub is 1.

       luma_power, lp
       chroma_power, cp
       alpha_power, ap
           Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the corresponding plane.

           Default value for luma_power is 2. If not specified, chroma_power and alpha_power default to the
           corresponding value set for luma_power.

           A value of 0 will disable the effect.

       Examples

       Apply boxblur filter, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of box-radiuses luma_radius,
       chroma_radius, alpha_radius for each plane respectively. The filter will apply luma_power, chroma_power,
       alpha_power times onto the corresponding plane. For pixels on the edges of the image, the radius does not
       extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.

       •   Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radius set to 2 and luma, chroma, and alpha
           power set to 3. The filter will run 3 times with box-radius set to 2 for every plane of the image.

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=luma_radius=2:luma_power=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:3, hwdownload" OUTPUT

       •   Apply a boxblur filter with luma radius set to 2, luma_power to 1, chroma_radius to 4, chroma_power
           to 5, alpha_radius to 3 and alpha_power to 7.

           For the luma plane, a 2x2 box radius will be run once.

           For the chroma plane, a 4x4 box radius will be run 5 times.

           For the alpha plane, a 3x3 box radius will be run 7 times.

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:1:4:5:3:7, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   colorkey_opencl
       RGB colorspace color keying.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       color
           The color which will be replaced with transparency.

       similarity
           Similarity percentage with the key color.

           0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.

       blend
           Blend percentage.

           0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.

           Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency the more similar the
           pixels color is to the key color.

       Examples

       •   Make every semi-green pixel in the input transparent with some slight blending:

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, colorkey_opencl=green:0.3:0.1, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   convolution_opencl
       Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 matrix.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       0m
       1m
       2m
       3m  Set matrix for each plane.  Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed numbers.  Default value for each
           plane is "0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0".

       0rdiv
       1rdiv
       2rdiv
       3rdiv
           Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.  If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix
           elements.  The option value must be a float number greater or equal to 0.0. Default value is 1.0.

       0bias
       1bias
       2bias
       3bias
           Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.  Useful for making
           the overall image brighter or darker.  The option value must be a float number greater or equal to
           0.0. Default value is 0.0.

       Examples

       •   Apply sharpen:

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0, hwdownload" OUTPUT

       •   Apply blur:

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9, hwdownload" OUTPUT

       •   Apply edge enhance:

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT

       •   Apply edge detect:

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT

       •   Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0, hwdownload" OUTPUT

       •   Apply emboss:

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   erosion_opencl
       Apply erosion effect to the video.

       This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.

       It accepts the following options:

       threshold0
       threshold1
       threshold2
       threshold3
           Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is "[0, 65535]" and default value is 65535.  If 0,
           plane will remain unchanged.

       coordinates
           Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.  Range is "[0, 255]" and default value is 255, i.e. all
           eight pixels are used.

           Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on "x":

               1 2 3

               4 x 5

               6 7 8

       Example

       •   Apply erosion filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and
           coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local minimum between pixels: 1, 2,
           3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and
           local minimum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input
           pixel - threshold of corresponding plane.

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, erosion_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   deshake_opencl
       Feature-point based video stabilization filter.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       tripod
           Simulates a tripod by preventing any camera movement whatsoever from the original frame. Defaults to
           0.

       debug
           Whether or not additional debug info should be displayed, both in the processed output and in the
           console.

           Note that in order to see console debug output you will also need to pass "-v verbose" to ffmpeg.

           Viewing point matches in the output video is only supported for RGB input.

           Defaults to 0.

       adaptive_crop
           Whether or not to do a tiny bit of cropping at the borders to cut down on the amount of mirrored
           pixels.

           Defaults to 1.

       refine_features
           Whether or not feature points should be refined at a sub-pixel level.

           This can be turned off for a slight performance gain at the cost of precision.

           Defaults to 1.

       smooth_strength
           The strength of the smoothing applied to the camera path from 0.0 to 1.0.

           1.0 is the maximum smoothing strength while values less than that result in less smoothing.

           0.0 causes the filter to adaptively choose a smoothing strength on a per-frame basis.

           Defaults to 0.0.

       smooth_window_multiplier
           Controls the size of the smoothing window (the number of frames buffered to determine motion
           information from).

           The size of the smoothing window is determined by multiplying the framerate of the video by this
           number.

           Acceptable values range from 0.1 to 10.0.

           Larger values increase the amount of motion data available for determining how to smooth the camera
           path, potentially improving smoothness, but also increase latency and memory usage.

           Defaults to 2.0.

       Examples

       •   Stabilize a video with a fixed, medium smoothing strength:

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, deshake_opencl=smooth_strength=0.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT

       •   Stabilize a video with debugging (both in console and in rendered video):

                   -i INPUT -filter_complex "[0:v]format=rgba, hwupload, deshake_opencl=debug=1, hwdownload, format=rgba, format=yuv420p" -v verbose OUTPUT

   dilation_opencl
       Apply dilation effect to the video.

       This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.

       It accepts the following options:

       threshold0
       threshold1
       threshold2
       threshold3
           Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is "[0, 65535]" and default value is 65535.  If 0,
           plane will remain unchanged.

       coordinates
           Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.  Range is "[0, 255]" and default value is 255, i.e. all
           eight pixels are used.

           Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on "x":

               1 2 3

               4 x 5

               6 7 8

       Example

       •   Apply dilation filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and
           coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local maximum between pixels: 1, 2,
           3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and
           local maximum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input
           pixel + threshold of corresponding plane.

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, dilation_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   nlmeans_opencl
       Non-local Means denoise filter through OpenCL, this filter accepts same options as nlmeans.

   overlay_opencl
       Overlay one video on top of another.

       It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is
       overlaid.  This filter requires same memory layout for all the inputs. So, format conversion may be
       needed.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       x   Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.  Default value is 0.

       y   Set the y coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.  Default value is 0.

       Examples

       •   Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs are yuv420p format.

                   -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT

       •   The inputs have same memory layout for color channels , the overlay has additional alpha plane, like
           INPUT is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.

                   -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   pad_opencl
       Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the provided x, y coordinates.

       It accepts the following options:

       width, w
       height, h
           Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the paddings added. If the value for
           width or height is 0, the corresponding input size is used for the output.

           The width expression can reference the value set by the height expression, and vice versa.

           The default value of width and height is 0.

       x
       y   Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area, with respect to the top/left
           border of the output image.

           The x expression can reference the value set by the y expression, and vice versa.

           The default value of x and y is 0.

           If x or y evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed so the input image is centered on the
           padded area.

       color
           Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
           ffmpeg-utils manual.

       aspect
           Pad to an aspect instead to a resolution.

       The value for the width, height, x, and y options are expressions containing the following constants:

       in_w
       in_h
           The input video width and height.

       iw
       ih  These are the same as in_w and in_h.

       out_w
       out_h
           The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as specified by the width and height
           expressions.

       ow
       oh  These are the same as out_w and out_h.

       x
       y   The x and y offsets as specified by the x and y expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.

       a   same as iw / ih

       sar input sample aspect ratio

       dar input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (iw / ih) * sar

   prewitt_opencl
       Apply the Prewitt operator (<https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Prewitt_operator>) to input video stream.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default value is 0xf, by which all planes are processed.

       scale
           Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.  Range is "[0.0, 65535]" and default value
           is 1.0.

       delta
           Set value which will be added to filtered result.  Range is "[-65535, 65535]" and default value is
           0.0.

       Example

       •   Apply the Prewitt operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10.

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, prewitt_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   program_opencl
       Filter video using an OpenCL program.

       source
           OpenCL program source file.

       kernel
           Kernel name in program.

       inputs
           Number of inputs to the filter.  Defaults to 1.

       size, s
           Size of output frames.  Defaults to the same as the first input.

       The "program_opencl" filter also supports the framesync options.

       The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name, which will be run once for
       each plane of the output.  Each run on a plane gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one
       work-item for each pixel to be generated.  The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore the
       coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.

       The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:

       •   Destination image, __write_only image2d_t.

           This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.

       •   Frame index, unsigned int.

           This is a counter starting from zero and increasing by one for each frame.

       •   Source images, __read_only image2d_t.

           These are the most recent images on each input.  The kernel may read from them to generate the
           output, but they can't be written to.

       Example programs:

       •   Copy the input to the output (output must be the same size as the input).

                   __kernel void copy(__write_only image2d_t destination,
                                      unsigned int index,
                                      __read_only  image2d_t source)
                   {
                       const sampler_t sampler = CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE;

                       int2 location = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));

                       float4 value = read_imagef(source, sampler, location);

                       write_imagef(destination, location, value);
                   }

       •   Apply a simple transformation, rotating the input by an amount increasing with the index counter.
           Pixel values are linearly interpolated by the sampler, and the output need not have the same
           dimensions as the input.

                   __kernel void rotate_image(__write_only image2d_t dst,
                                              unsigned int index,
                                              __read_only  image2d_t src)
                   {
                       const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
                                                  CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);

                       float angle = (float)index / 100.0f;

                       float2 dst_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
                       float2 src_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(src));

                       float2 dst_cen = dst_dim / 2.0f;
                       float2 src_cen = src_dim / 2.0f;

                       int2   dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));

                       float2 dst_pos = convert_float2(dst_loc) - dst_cen;
                       float2 src_pos = {
                           cos(angle) * dst_pos.x - sin(angle) * dst_pos.y,
                           sin(angle) * dst_pos.x + cos(angle) * dst_pos.y
                       };
                       src_pos = src_pos * src_dim / dst_dim;

                       float2 src_loc = src_pos + src_cen;

                       if (src_loc.x < 0.0f      || src_loc.y < 0.0f ||
                           src_loc.x > src_dim.x || src_loc.y > src_dim.y)
                           write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, 0.5f);
                       else
                           write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, read_imagef(src, sampler, src_loc));
                   }

       •   Blend two inputs together, with the amount of each input used varying with the index counter.

                   __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
                                              unsigned int index,
                                              __read_only  image2d_t src1,
                                              __read_only  image2d_t src2)
                   {
                       const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
                                                  CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);

                       float blend = (cos((float)index / 50.0f) + 1.0f) / 2.0f;

                       int2  dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
                       int2 src1_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src1) / get_image_dim(dst);
                       int2 src2_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src2) / get_image_dim(dst);

                       float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, src1_loc);
                       float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, src2_loc);

                       write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, val1 * blend + val2 * (1.0f - blend));
                   }

   remap_opencl
       Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.

       Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position where x = Xmap(X, Y) and
       y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero value for pixel will be used for destination
       pixel.

       Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream will have Xmap/Ymap
       video stream dimensions.  Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 32bit float pixel format, single channel.

       interp
           Specify interpolation used for remapping of pixels.  Allowed values are "near" and "linear".  Default
           value is "linear".

       fill
           Specify the color of the unmapped pixels. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in
           the ffmpeg-utils manual. Default color is "black".

   roberts_opencl
       Apply the Roberts cross operator (<https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Roberts_cross>) to input video stream.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default value is 0xf, by which all planes are processed.

       scale
           Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.  Range is "[0.0, 65535]" and default value
           is 1.0.

       delta
           Set value which will be added to filtered result.  Range is "[-65535, 65535]" and default value is
           0.0.

       Example

       •   Apply the Roberts cross operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, roberts_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   sobel_opencl
       Apply the Sobel operator (<https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sobel_operator>) to input video stream.

       The filter accepts the following option:

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default value is 0xf, by which all planes are processed.

       scale
           Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.  Range is "[0.0, 65535]" and default value
           is 1.0.

       delta
           Set value which will be added to filtered result.  Range is "[-65535, 65535]" and default value is
           0.0.

       Example

       •   Apply sobel operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, sobel_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   tonemap_opencl
       Perform HDR(PQ/HLG) to SDR conversion with tone-mapping.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       tonemap
           Specify the tone-mapping operator to be used. Same as tonemap option in tonemap.

       param
           Tune the tone mapping algorithm. same as param option in tonemap.

       desat
           Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The higher the parameter, the
           more color information will be preserved. This setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for
           super-highlights, by (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural, at
           the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.

           The default value is 0.5, and the algorithm here is a little different from the cpu version tonemap
           currently. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.

       threshold
           The tonemapping algorithm parameters is fine-tuned per each scene. And a threshold is used to detect
           whether the scene has changed or not. If the distance between the current frame average brightness
           and the current running average exceeds a threshold value, we would re-calculate scene average and
           peak brightness.  The default value is 0.2.

       format
           Specify the output pixel format.

           Currently supported formats are:

           p010
           nv12
       range, r
           Set the output color range.

           Possible values are:

           tv/mpeg
           pc/jpeg

           Default is same as input.

       primaries, p
           Set the output color primaries.

           Possible values are:

           bt709
           bt2020

           Default is same as input.

       transfer, t
           Set the output transfer characteristics.

           Possible values are:

           bt709
           bt2020

           Default is bt709.

       matrix, m
           Set the output colorspace matrix.

           Possible value are:

           bt709
           bt2020

           Default is same as input.

       Example

       •   Convert HDR(PQ/HLG) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format using linear operator.

                   -i INPUT -vf "format=p010,hwupload,tonemap_opencl=t=bt2020:tonemap=linear:format=p010,hwdownload,format=p010" OUTPUT

   unsharp_opencl
       Sharpen or blur the input video.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       luma_msize_x, lx
           Set the luma matrix horizontal size.  Range is "[1, 23]" and default value is 5.

       luma_msize_y, ly
           Set the luma matrix vertical size.  Range is "[1, 23]" and default value is 5.

       luma_amount, la
           Set the luma effect strength.  Range is "[-10, 10]" and default value is 1.0.

           Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will sharpen it, a value of zero
           will disable the effect.

       chroma_msize_x, cx
           Set the chroma matrix horizontal size.  Range is "[1, 23]" and default value is 5.

       chroma_msize_y, cy
           Set the chroma matrix vertical size.  Range is "[1, 23]" and default value is 5.

       chroma_amount, ca
           Set the chroma effect strength.  Range is "[-10, 10]" and default value is 0.0.

           Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will sharpen it, a value of zero
           will disable the effect.

       All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.

       Examples

       •   Apply strong luma sharpen effect:

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT

       •   Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:

                   -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=7:7:-2:7:7:-2, hwdownload" OUTPUT

   xfade_opencl
       Cross fade two videos with custom transition effect by using OpenCL.

       It accepts the following options:

       transition
           Set one of possible transition effects.

           custom
               Select custom transition effect, the actual transition description will be picked from source and
               kernel options.

           fade
           wipeleft
           wiperight
           wipeup
           wipedown
           slideleft
           slideright
           slideup
           slidedown
               Default transition is fade.

       source
           OpenCL program source file for custom transition.

       kernel
           Set name of kernel to use for custom transition from program source file.

       duration
           Set duration of video transition.

       offset
           Set time of start of transition relative to first video.

       The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name, which will be run once for
       each plane of the output.  Each run on a plane gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one
       work-item for each pixel to be generated.  The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore the
       coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.

       The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:

       •   Destination image, __write_only image2d_t.

           This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.

       •   First Source image, __read_only image2d_t.  Second Source image, __read_only image2d_t.

           These are the most recent images on each input.  The kernel may read from them to generate the
           output, but they can't be written to.

       •   Transition progress, float. This value is always between 0 and 1 inclusive.

       Example programs:

       •   Apply dots curtain transition effect:

                   __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
                                              __read_only  image2d_t src1,
                                              __read_only  image2d_t src2,
                                              float progress)
                   {
                       const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
                                                  CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
                       int2  p = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
                       float2 rp = (float2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
                       float2 dim = (float2)(get_image_dim(src1).x, get_image_dim(src1).y);
                       rp = rp / dim;

                       float2 dots = (float2)(20.0, 20.0);
                       float2 center = (float2)(0,0);
                       float2 unused;

                       float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, p);
                       float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, p);
                       bool next = distance(fract(rp * dots, &unused), (float2)(0.5, 0.5)) < (progress / distance(rp, center));

                       write_imagef(dst, p, next ? val1 : val2);
                   }

VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS

       VAAPI Video filters are usually used with VAAPI decoder and VAAPI encoder. Below is a description of
       VAAPI video filters.

       To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-vaapi".

       To use vaapi filters, you need to setup the vaapi device correctly. For more information, please read
       <https://trac.ffmpeg.org/wiki/Hardware/VAAPI>

   overlay_vaapi
       Overlay one video on the top of another.

       It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is
       overlaid.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       x
       y   Set expressions for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video on the main video.

           Default value is "0" for both expressions.

       w
       h   Set expressions for the width and height the overlaid video on the main video.

           Default values are 'overlay_iw' for 'w' and 'overlay_ih*w/overlay_iw' for 'h'.

           The expressions can contain the following parameters:

           main_w, W
           main_h, H
               The main input width and height.

           overlay_iw
           overlay_ih
               The overlay input width and height.

           overlay_w, w
           overlay_h, h
               The overlay output width and height.

           overlay_x, x
           overlay_y, y
               Position of the overlay layer inside of main

       alpha
           Set transparency of overlaid video. Allowed range is 0.0 to 1.0.  Higher value means lower
           transparency.  Default value is 1.0.

       eof_action
           See framesync.

       shortest
           See framesync.

       repeatlast
           See framesync.

       This filter also supports the framesync options.

       Examples

       •   Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs for this filter are
           yuv420p format.

                   -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_vaapi" OUTPUT

       •   Overlay an image LOGO at the offset (200, 100) from the top-left corner of the INPUT video.  The
           inputs have same memory layout for color channels, the overlay has additional alpha plane, like INPUT
           is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.

                   -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_vaapi=x=200:y=100:w=400:h=300:alpha=1.0, hwdownload, format=nv12" OUTPUT

   tonemap_vaapi
       Perform HDR(High Dynamic Range) to SDR(Standard Dynamic Range) conversion with tone-mapping.  It maps the
       dynamic range of HDR10 content to the SDR content.  It currently only accepts HDR10 as input.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       format
           Specify the output pixel format.

           Currently supported formats are:

           p010
           nv12

           Default is nv12.

       primaries, p
           Set the output color primaries.

           Default is same as input.

       transfer, t
           Set the output transfer characteristics.

           Default is bt709.

       matrix, m
           Set the output colorspace matrix.

           Default is same as input.

       Example

       •   Convert HDR(HDR10) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format

                   tonemap_vaapi=format=p010:t=bt2020-10

   hstack_vaapi
       Stack input videos horizontally.

       This is the VA-API variant of the hstack filter, each input stream may have different height, this filter
       will scale down/up each input stream while keeping the original aspect.

       It accepts the following options:

       inputs
           See hstack.

       shortest
           See hstack.

       height
           Set height of output. If set to 0, this filter will set height of output to height of the first input
           stream. Default value is 0.

   vstack_vaapi
       Stack input videos vertically.

       This is the VA-API variant of the vstack filter, each input stream may have different width, this filter
       will scale down/up each input stream while keeping the original aspect.

       It accepts the following options:

       inputs
           See vstack.

       shortest
           See vstack.

       width
           Set width of output. If set to 0, this filter will set width of output to width of the first input
           stream. Default value is 0.

   xstack_vaapi
       Stack video inputs into custom layout.

       This is the VA-API variant of the xstack filter,  each input stream may have different size, this filter
       will scale down/up each input stream to the given output size, or the size of the first input stream.

       It accepts the following options:

       inputs
           See xstack.

       shortest
           See xstack.

       layout
           See xstack.  Moreover, this permits the user to supply output size for each input stream.

                   xstack_vaapi=inputs=4:layout=0_0_1920x1080|0_h0_1920x1080|w0_0_1920x1080|w0_h0_1920x1080

       grid
           See xstack.

       grid_tile_size
           Set output size for each input stream when grid is set. If this option is not set, this filter will
           set output size by default to the size of the first input stream. For the syntax of this option,
           check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

       fill
           See xstack.

VULKAN VIDEO FILTERS

       Below is a description of the currently available Vulkan video filters.

       To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-vulkan" and either
       "--enable-libglslang" or "--enable-libshaderc".

       Running Vulkan filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all
       filters in any filter graph.

       -init_hw_device vulkan[=name][:device[,key=value...]]
           Initialise a new hardware device of type vulkan called name, using the given device parameters and
           options in key=value. The following options are supported:

           debug
               Switches validation layers on if set to 1.

           linear_images
               Allocates linear images. Does not apply to decoding.

           disable_multiplane
               Disables multiplane images. Does not apply to decoding.

       -filter_hw_device name
           Pass the hardware device called name to all filters in any filter graph.

       For more detailed information see <https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options>

       •   Example of choosing the first device and running nlmeans_vulkan filter with default parameters on it.

                   -init_hw_device vulkan=vk:0 -filter_hw_device vk -i INPUT -vf "hwupload,nlmeans_vulkan,hwdownload" OUTPUT

       As Vulkan filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be uploaded
       (hwupload) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then downloaded
       (hwdownload) back to normal memory. Note that hwupload will upload to a frame with the same layout as the
       software frame, so it may be necessary to add a format filter immediately before to get the input into
       the right format and hwdownload does not support all formats on the output - it is usually necessary to
       insert an additional format filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a supported
       format.

   avgblur_vulkan
       Apply an average blur filter, implemented on the GPU using Vulkan.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sizeX
           Set horizontal radius size.  Range is "[1, 32]" and default value is 3.

       sizeY
           Set vertical radius size. Range is "[1, 32]" and default value is 3.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. Default value is 0xf, by which all planes are processed.

   blend_vulkan
       Blend two Vulkan frames into each other.

       The "blend" filter takes two input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the "top" layer and
       second input is "bottom" layer.  By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.

       A description of the accepted options follows.

       c0_mode
       c1_mode
       c2_mode
       c3_mode
       all_mode
           Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case of all_mode. Default
           value is "normal".

           Available values for component modes are:

           normal
           multiply

   bwdif_vulkan
       Deinterlacer using bwdif, the "Bob Weaver Deinterlacing Filter" algorithm, implemented on the GPU using
       Vulkan.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       mode
           The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:

           0, send_frame
               Output one frame for each frame.

           1, send_field
               Output one frame for each field.

           The default value is "send_field".

       parity
           The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one of the following
           values:

           0, tff
               Assume the top field is first.

           1, bff
               Assume the bottom field is first.

           -1, auto
               Enable automatic detection of field parity.

           The default value is "auto".  If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this
           information, top field first will be assumed.

       deint
           Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:

           0, all
               Deinterlace all frames.

           1, interlaced
               Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.

           The default value is "all".

   chromaber_vulkan
       Apply an effect that emulates chromatic aberration. Works best with RGB inputs, but provides a similar
       effect with YCbCr inputs too.

       dist_x
           Horizontal displacement multiplier. Each chroma pixel's position will be multiplied by this amount,
           starting from the center of the image. Default is 0.

       dist_y
           Similarly, this sets the vertical displacement multiplier. Default is 0.

   color_vulkan
       Video source that creates a Vulkan frame of a solid color.  Useful for benchmarking, or overlaying.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       color
           The color to use. Either a name, or a hexadecimal value.  The default value is "black".

       size
           The size of the output frame. Default value is "1920x1080".

       rate
           The framerate to output at. Default value is 60 frames per second.

       duration
           The video duration. Default value is -0.000001.

       sar The video signal aspect ratio. Default value is "1/1".

       format
           The pixel format of the output Vulkan frames. Default value is "yuv444p".

       out_range
           Set the output YCbCr sample range.

           This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing a specific value used
           for the output and encoder. If not specified, the range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:

           auto/unknown
               Choose automatically.

           jpeg/full/pc
               Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).

           mpeg/limited/tv
               Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).

   vflip_vulkan
       Flips an image vertically.

   hflip_vulkan
       Flips an image horizontally.

   flip_vulkan
       Flips an image along both the vertical and horizontal axis.

   gblur_vulkan
       Apply Gaussian blur filter on Vulkan frames.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sigma
           Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is 0.5.

       sigmaV
           Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as "sigma".  Default is -1.

       planes
           Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.

       size
           Set the kernel size along the horizontal axis. Default is 19.

       sizeV
           Set the kernel size along the vertical axis. Default is 0, which sets to use the same value as size.

   nlmeans_vulkan
       Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm, implemented on the GPU using Vulkan.  Supports more pixel
       formats than nlmeans or nlmeans_opencl, including alpha channel support.

       The filter accepts the following options.

       s   Set denoising strength for all components. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 100.0].

       p   Set patch size for all planes. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].

       r   Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].

       t   Set parallelism. Default is 36. Must be a number in the range [1, 168].  Larger values may speed up
           processing, at the cost of more VRAM.  Lower values will slow it down, reducing VRAM usage.  Only
           supported on GPUs with atomic float operations (RDNA3+, Ampere+).

       s0
       s1
       s2
       s3  Set denoising strength for a specific component. Default is 1, equal to s.  Must be odd number in
           range [1, 100].

       p0
       p1
       p2
       p3  Set patch size for a specific component. Default is 7, equal to p.  Must be odd number in range [0,
           99].

   overlay_vulkan
       Overlay one video on top of another.

       It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is
       overlaid.  This filter requires all inputs to use the same pixel format. So, format conversion may be
       needed.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       x   Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.  Default value is 0.

       y   Set the y coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.  Default value is 0.

   transpose_vt
       Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.  For more in depth examples see
       the transpose video filter, which shares mostly the same options.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       dir Specify the transposition direction.

           Can assume the following values:

           cclock_flip
               Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)

           clock
               Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.

           cclock
               Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.

           clock_flip
               Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.

           hflip
               Flip the input video horizontally.

           vflip
               Flip the input video vertically.

       passthrough
           Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one specified by the specified
           value. It accepts the following values:

           none
               Always apply transposition. (default)

           portrait
               Preserve portrait geometry (when height >= width).

           landscape
               Preserve landscape geometry (when width >= height).

   transpose_vulkan
       Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.  For more in depth examples see
       the transpose video filter, which shares mostly the same options.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       dir Specify the transposition direction.

           Can assume the following values:

           cclock_flip
               Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)

           clock
               Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.

           cclock
               Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.

           clock_flip
               Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.

       passthrough
           Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one specified by the specified
           value. It accepts the following values:

           none
               Always apply transposition. (default)

           portrait
               Preserve portrait geometry (when height >= width).

           landscape
               Preserve landscape geometry (when width >= height).

QSV VIDEO FILTERS

       Below is a description of the currently available QSV video filters.

       To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libmfx" or
       "--enable-libvpl".

       To use QSV filters, you need to setup the QSV device correctly. For more information, please read
       <https://trac.ffmpeg.org/wiki/Hardware/QuickSync>

   hstack_qsv
       Stack input videos horizontally.

       This is the QSV variant of the hstack filter, each input stream may have different height, this filter
       will scale down/up each input stream while keeping the original aspect.

       It accepts the following options:

       inputs
           See hstack.

       shortest
           See hstack.

       height
           Set height of output. If set to 0, this filter will set height of output to height of the first input
           stream. Default value is 0.

   vstack_qsv
       Stack input videos vertically.

       This is the QSV variant of the vstack filter, each input stream may have different width, this filter
       will scale down/up each input stream while keeping the original aspect.

       It accepts the following options:

       inputs
           See vstack.

       shortest
           See vstack.

       width
           Set width of output. If set to 0, this filter will set width of output to width of the first input
           stream. Default value is 0.

   xstack_qsv
       Stack video inputs into custom layout.

       This is the QSV variant of the xstack filter.

       It accepts the following options:

       inputs
           See xstack.

       shortest
           See xstack.

       layout
           See xstack.  Moreover, this permits the user to supply output size for each input stream.

                   xstack_qsv=inputs=4:layout=0_0_1920x1080|0_h0_1920x1080|w0_0_1920x1080|w0_h0_1920x1080

       grid
           See xstack.

       grid_tile_size
           Set output size for each input stream when grid is set. If this option is not set, this filter will
           set output size by default to the size of the first input stream. For the syntax of this option,
           check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

       fill
           See xstack.

VIDEO SOURCES

       Below is a description of the currently available video sources.

   buffer
       Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.

       This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular through the interface defined in
       libavfilter/buffersrc.h.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       video_size
           Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the syntax of this option,
           check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

       width
           The input video width.

       height
           The input video height.

       pix_fmt
           A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.  It may be a number
           corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format name.

       time_base
           Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.

       frame_rate
           Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.

       colorspace
           A string representing the color space of the buffered video frames.  It may be a number corresponding
           to a color space, or a color space name.

       range
           A string representing the color range of the buffered video frames.  It may be a number corresponding
           to a color range, or a color range name.

       pixel_aspect, sar
           The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.

       hw_frames_ctx
           When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an AVHWFramesContext describing
           input frames.

       For example:

               buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1

       will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and with format "yuv410p", assuming
       1/24 as the timestamps timebase and square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).  Since the pixel format with
       name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6 (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in
       libavutil/pixfmt.h), this example corresponds to:

               buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1

       Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this syntax is deprecated:

       width:height:pix_fmt:time_base.num:time_base.den:pixel_aspect.num:pixel_aspect.den

   cellauto
       Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.

       The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the filename and pattern options. If
       such options are not specified an initial state is created randomly.

       At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of the cellular automaton next
       generation. The behavior when the whole frame is filled is defined by the scroll option.

       This source accepts the following options:

       filename, f
           Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from the specified file.  In the
           file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, a newline will terminate the row,
           and further characters in the file will be ignored.

       pattern, p
           Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from the specified string.

           Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive cell, a newline will terminate the
           row, and further characters in the string will be ignored.

       rate, r
           Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.  Default is 25.

       random_fill_ratio, ratio
           Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It is a floating point number value
           ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.

           This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.

       random_seed, seed
           Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer included between 0 and
           UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random
           seed on a best effort basis.

       rule
           Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.  Default value is 110.

       size, s
           Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in
           the ffmpeg-utils manual.

           If filename or pattern is specified, the size is set by default to the width of the specified initial
           state row, and the height is set to width * PHI.

           If size is set, it must contain the width of the specified pattern string, and the specified pattern
           will be centered in the larger row.

           If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x518" (used for a
           randomly generated initial state).

       scroll
           If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output have been already filled. If
           set to 0, the new generated row will be written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
           Defaults to 1.

       start_full, full
           If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before outputting the first frame.  This
           is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.

       stitch
           If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.  This is the default behavior, for
           disabling set the value to 0.

       Examples

       •   Read the initial state from pattern, and specify an output of size 200x400.

                   cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400

       •   Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill ratio of 2/3:

                   cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200

       •   Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell centered on an initial row with
           width 100:

                   cellauto=p=@s=100x400:full=0:rule=18

       •   Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:

                   cellauto=p='@@ @ @@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18

   coreimagesrc
       Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.

       This video source is a specialized version of the coreimage video filter.  Use a core image generator at
       the beginning of the applied filterchain to generate the content.

       The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:

       list_generators
           List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as possible minimum and
           maximum values along with the default values.

                   list_generators=true

       size, s
           Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  The default value is "320x240".

       rate, r
           Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames generated per second. It has to
           be a string in the format frame_rate_num/frame_rate_den, an integer number, a floating point number
           or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is "25".

       sar Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.

       duration, d
           Set the duration of the sourced video. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual
           for the accepted syntax.

           If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is supposed to be generated
           forever.

       Additionally, all options of the coreimage video filter are accepted.  A complete filterchain can be used
       for further processing of the generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See coreimage documentation and
       examples for details.

       Examples

       •   Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage, given as complete and escaped
           command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:

                   ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png

           This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of coreimage without the need for a nullsrc video
           source.

   ddagrab
       Captures the Windows Desktop via Desktop Duplication API.

       The filter exclusively returns D3D11 Hardware Frames, for on-gpu encoding or processing. So an explicit
       hwdownload is needed for any kind of software processing.

       It accepts the following options:

       output_idx
           DXGI Output Index to capture.

           Usually corresponds to the index Windows has given the screen minus one, so it's starting at 0.

           Defaults to output 0.

       draw_mouse
           Whether to draw the mouse cursor.

           Defaults to true.

           Only affects hardware cursors. If a game or application renders its own cursor, it'll always be
           captured.

       framerate
           Maximum framerate at which the desktop will be captured - the interval between successive frames will
           not be smaller than the inverse of the framerate. When dup_frames is true (the default) and the
           desktop is not being updated often enough, the filter will duplicate a previous frame. Note that
           there is no background buffering going on, so when the filter is not polled often enough then the
           actual inter-frame interval may be significantly larger.

           Defaults to 30 FPS.

       video_size
           Specify the size of the captured video.

           Defaults to the full size of the screen.

           Cropped from the bottom/right if smaller than screen size.

       offset_x
           Horizontal offset of the captured video.

       offset_y
           Vertical offset of the captured video.

       output_fmt
           Desired filter output format.  Defaults to 8 Bit BGRA.

           It accepts the following values:

           auto
               Passes all supported output formats to DDA and returns what DDA decides to use.

           8bit
           bgra
               8 Bit formats always work, and DDA will convert to them if necessary.

           10bit
           x2bgr10
               Filter initialization will fail if 10 bit format is requested but unavailable.

       dup_frames
           When this option is set to true (the default), the filter will duplicate frames when the desktop has
           not been updated in order to maintain approximately constant target framerate. When this option is
           set to false, the filter will wait for the desktop to be updated (inter-frame intervals may vary
           significantly in this case).

       Examples

       Capture primary screen and encode using nvenc:

               ffmpeg -f lavfi -i ddagrab -c:v h264_nvenc -cq 18 output.mp4

       You can also skip the lavfi device and directly use the filter.  Also demonstrates downloading the frame
       and encoding with libx264.  Explicit output format specification is required in this case:

               ffmpeg -filter_complex ddagrab=output_idx=1:framerate=60,hwdownload,format=bgra -c:v libx264 -crf 18 output.mp4

       If you want to capture only a subsection of the desktop, this can be achieved by specifying a smaller
       size and its offsets into the screen:

               ddagrab=video_size=800x600:offset_x=100:offset_y=100

   gradients
       Generate several gradients.

       size, s
           Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils
           manual. Default value is "640x480".

       rate, r
           Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default value is "25".

       c0, c1, c2, c3, c4, c5, c6, c7
           Set 8 colors. Default values for colors is to pick random one.

       x0, y0, y0, y1
           Set gradient line source and destination points. If negative or out of range, random ones are picked.

       nb_colors, n
           Set number of colors to use at once. Allowed range is from 2 to 8. Default value is 2.

       seed
           Set seed for picking gradient line points.

       duration, d
           Set the duration of the sourced video. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual
           for the accepted syntax.

           If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is supposed to be generated
           forever.

       speed
           Set speed of gradients rotation.

       type, t
           Set type of gradients.  Available values are:

           linear
           radial
           circular
           spiral
           square

           Default type is linear.

       Commands

       This source supports the some above options as commands.

   mandelbrot
       Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the point specified with start_x and
       start_y.

       This source accepts the following options:

       end_pts
           Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.

       end_scale
           Set the terminal scale value.  Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.

       inner
           Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the Mandelbrot fractal internal
           region.

           It shall assume one of the following values:

           black
               Set black mode.

           convergence
               Show time until convergence.

           mincol
               Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.

           period
               Set period mode.

           Default value is mincol.

       bailout
           Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.

       maxiter
           Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering algorithm. Default value is 7189.

       outer
           Set outer coloring mode.  It shall assume one of following values:

           iteration_count
               Set iteration count mode.

           normalized_iteration_count
               set normalized iteration count mode.

           Default value is normalized_iteration_count.

       rate, r
           Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default value is "25".

       size, s
           Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils
           manual. Default value is "640x480".

       start_scale
           Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.

       start_x
           Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between -100 and 100. Default value is
           -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.

       start_y
           Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between -100 and 100. Default value is
           -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.

   mptestsrc
       Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.

       The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.  This source is useful in particular for
       testing encoding features.

       This source accepts the following options:

       rate, r
           Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames generated per second. It has to
           be a string in the format frame_rate_num/frame_rate_den, an integer number, a floating point number
           or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is "25".

       duration, d
           Set the duration of the sourced video. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual
           for the accepted syntax.

           If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is supposed to be generated
           forever.

       test, t
           Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:

           dc_luma
           dc_chroma
           freq_luma
           freq_chroma
           amp_luma
           amp_chroma
           cbp
           mv
           ring1
           ring2
           all
           max_frames, m
               Set the maximum number of frames generated for each test, default value is 30.

           Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.

       Some examples:

               mptestsrc=t=dc_luma

       will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.

   frei0r_src
       Provide a frei0r source.

       To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r header and configure FFmpeg with
       "--enable-frei0r".

       This source accepts the following parameters:

       size
           The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in
           the ffmpeg-utils manual.

       framerate
           The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form num/den or a frame rate
           abbreviation.

       filter_name
           The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and how to set the
           parameters, read the frei0r section in the video filters documentation.

       filter_params
           A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.

       For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200 and frame rate 10 which is overlaid
       on the overlay filter main input:

               frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay

   life
       Generate a life pattern.

       This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.

       The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell which can be in one of two
       possible states, alive or dead. Every cell interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that
       are horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.

       At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule, which specifies the number of
       neighbor alive cells which will make a cell stay alive or born. The rule option allows one to specify the
       rule to adopt.

       This source accepts the following options:

       filename, f
           Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file, each non-whitespace character is
           considered an alive cell, and newline is used to delimit the end of each row.

           If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated randomly.

       rate, r
           Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.  Default is 25.

       random_fill_ratio, ratio
           Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a floating point number value ranging
           from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.  It is ignored when a file is specified.

       random_seed, seed
           Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer included between 0 and
           UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random
           seed on a best effort basis.

       rule
           Set the life rule.

           A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "SNS/BNB", where NS and NB are sequences of numbers
           in the range 0-8, NS specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a live cell stay alive,
           and NB the number of alive neighbor cells which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
           "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.

           Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9 high order bits are used to encode
           the next cell state if it is alive for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits
           specify the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an higher number of neighbor
           cells.  For example the number 6153 = "(12<<9)+9" specifies a stay alive rule of 12 and a born rule
           of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".

           Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life rule, and will keep a cell
           alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells
           around a dead cell.

       size, s
           Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in
           the ffmpeg-utils manual.

           If filename is specified, the size is set by default to the same size of the input file. If size is
           set, it must contain the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in that file
           is centered in the larger resulting area.

           If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240" (used for a randomly generated
           initial grid).

       stitch
           If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the top and bottom edges also.
           Defaults to 1.

       mold
           Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from death_color to mold_color with a step of mold.
           mold can have a value from 0 to 255.

       life_color
           Set the color of living (or new born) cells.

       death_color
           Set the color of dead cells. If mold is set, this is the first color used to represent a dead cell.

       mold_color
           Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.

           For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

       Examples

       •   Read a grid from pattern, and center it on a grid of size 300x300 pixels:

                   life=f=pattern:s=300x300

       •   Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:

                   life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200

       •   Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:

                   life=rule=S14/B34

       •   Full example with slow death effect (mold) using ffplay:

                   ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16

   qrencodesrc
       Generate a QR code using the libqrencode library (see <https://fukuchi.org/works/qrencode/>).

       To enable the compilation of this source, you need to configure FFmpeg with "--enable-libqrencode".

       The QR code is generated from the provided text or text pattern. The corresponding QR code is scaled and
       put in the video output according to the specified output size options.

       In case no text is specified, the QR code is not generated, but an empty colored output is returned
       instead.

       This source accepts the following options:

       qrcode_width, q
       padded_qrcode_width, Q
           Specify an expression for the width of the rendered QR code, with and without padding. The
           qrcode_width expression can reference the value set by the padded_qrcode_width expression, and vice
           versa.  By default padded_qrcode_width is set to qrcode_width, meaning that there is no padding.

           These expressions are evaluated only once, when initializing the source.  See the qrencode
           Expressions section for details.

           Note that some of the constants are missing for the source (for example the x or t or ¸n), since they
           only makes sense when evaluating the expression for each frame rather than at initialization time.

       rate, r
           Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames generated per second. It has to
           be a string in the format frame_rate_num/frame_rate_den, an integer number, a floating point number
           or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is "25".

       case_sensitive, cs
           Instruct libqrencode to use case sensitive encoding. This is enabled by default. This can be disabled
           to reduce the QR encoding size.

       level, l
           Specify the QR encoding error correction level. With an higher correction level, the encoding size
           will increase but the code will be more robust to corruption.  Lower level is L.

           It accepts the following values:

           L
           M
           Q
           H
       expansion
           Select how the input text is expanded. Can be either "none", or "normal" (default). See the qrencode
           Text expansion section for details.

       text
       textfile
           Define the text to be rendered. In case neither is specified, no QR is encoded (just an empty colored
           frame).

           In case expansion is enabled, the text is treated as a text template, using the qrencode expansion
           mechanism. See the qrencode Text expansion section for details.

       background_color, bc
       foreground_color, fc
           Set the QR code and background color. The default value of foreground_color is "black", the default
           value of background_color is "white".

           For the syntax of the color options, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

       Examples

       •   Generate a QR code encoding the specified text with the default size:

                   qrencodesrc=text=www.ffmpeg.org

       •   Same as below, but select blue on pink colors:

                   qrencodesrc=text=www.ffmpeg.org:bc=pink:fc=blue

       •   Generate a QR code with width of 200 pixels and padding, making the padded width 4/3 of the QR code
           width:

                   qrencodesrc=text=www.ffmpeg.org:q=200:Q=4/3*q

       •   Generate a QR code with padded width of 200 pixels and padding, making the QR code width 3/4 of the
           padded width:

                   qrencodesrc=text=www.ffmpeg.org:Q=200:q=3/4*Q

       •   Generate a QR code encoding the frame number:

                   qrencodesrc=text=%{n}

       •   Generate a QR code encoding the GMT timestamp:

                   qrencodesrc=text=%{gmtime}

       •   Generate a QR code encoding the timestamp expressed as a float:

                   qrencodesrc=text=%{pts}

   allrgb, allyuv, color, colorchart, colorspectrum, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, pal75bars, pal100bars, rgbtestsrc,
       smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
       The "allrgb" source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.

       The "allyuv" source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.

       The "color" source provides an uniformly colored input.

       The "colorchart" source provides a colors checker chart.

       The "colorspectrum" source provides a color spectrum input.

       The "haldclutsrc" source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also haldclut filter.

       The "nullsrc" source returns unprocessed video frames. It is mainly useful to be employed in analysis /
       debugging tools, or as the source for filters which ignore the input data.

       The "pal75bars" source generates a color bars pattern, based on EBU PAL recommendations with 75% color
       levels.

       The "pal100bars" source generates a color bars pattern, based on EBU PAL recommendations with 100% color
       levels.

       The "rgbtestsrc" source generates an RGB test pattern useful for detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should
       see a red, green and blue stripe from top to bottom.

       The "smptebars" source generates a color bars pattern, based on the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG
       1-1990.

       The "smptehdbars" source generates a color bars pattern, based on the SMPTE RP 219-2002.

       The "testsrc" source generates a test video pattern, showing a color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a
       timestamp. This is mainly intended for testing purposes.

       The "testsrc2" source is similar to testsrc, but supports more pixel formats instead of just "rgb24".
       This allows using it as an input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.

       The "yuvtestsrc" source generates an YUV test pattern. You should see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to
       bottom.

       The sources accept the following parameters:

       level
           Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the "haldclutsrc" source. A level of "N"
           generates a picture of "N*N*N" by "N*N*N" pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables.
           Each component is coded on a "1/(N*N)" scale.

       color, c
           Specify the color of the source, only available in the "color" source. For the syntax of this option,
           check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.

       size, s
           Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  The default value is "320x240".

           This option is not available with the "allrgb", "allyuv", and "haldclutsrc" filters.

       rate, r
           Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames generated per second. It has to
           be a string in the format frame_rate_num/frame_rate_den, an integer number, a floating point number
           or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is "25".

       duration, d
           Set the duration of the sourced video. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual
           for the accepted syntax.

           If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is supposed to be generated
           forever.

           Since the frame rate is used as time base, all frames including the last one will have their full
           duration. If the specified duration is not a multiple of the frame duration, it will be rounded up.

       sar Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.

       alpha
           Specify the alpha (opacity) of the background, only available in the "testsrc2" source. The value
           must be between 0 (fully transparent) and 255 (fully opaque, the default).

       decimals, n
           Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the "testsrc" source.

           The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original timestamp value multiplied by the power
           of 10 of the specified value. Default value is 0.

       type
           Set the type of the color spectrum, only available in the "colorspectrum" source. Can be one of the
           following:

           black
           white
           all
       patch_size
           Set patch size of single color patch, only available in the "colorchart" source. Default is "64x64".

       preset
           Set colorchecker colors preset, only available in the "colorchart" source.

           Available values are:

           reference
           skintones

           Default value is "reference".

       Examples

       •   Generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per
           second:

                   testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10

       •   The following graph description will generate a red source with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif"
           and a frame rate of 10 frames per second:

                   color=c=red@0.2:s=qcif:r=10

       •   If the input content is to be ignored, "nullsrc" can be used. The following command generates noise
           in the luma plane by employing the "geq" filter:

                   nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128

       Commands

       The "color" source supports the following commands:

       c, color
           Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the corresponding color option.

   openclsrc
       Generate video using an OpenCL program.

       source
           OpenCL program source file.

       kernel
           Kernel name in program.

       size, s
           Size of frames to generate.  This must be set.

       format
           Pixel format to use for the generated frames.  This must be set.

       rate, r
           Number of frames generated every second.  Default value is '25'.

       For details of how the program loading works, see the program_opencl filter.

       Example programs:

       •   Generate a colour ramp by setting pixel values from the position of the pixel in the output image.
           (Note that this will work with all pixel formats, but the generated output will not be the same.)

                   __kernel void ramp(__write_only image2d_t dst,
                                      unsigned int index)
                   {
                       int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));

                       float4 val;
                       val.xy = val.zw = convert_float2(loc) / convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));

                       write_imagef(dst, loc, val);
                   }

       •   Generate a Sierpinski carpet pattern, panning by a single pixel each frame.

                   __kernel void sierpinski_carpet(__write_only image2d_t dst,
                                                   unsigned int index)
                   {
                       int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));

                       float4 value = 0.0f;
                       int x = loc.x + index;
                       int y = loc.y + index;
                       while (x > 0 || y > 0) {
                           if (x % 3 == 1 && y % 3 == 1) {
                               value = 1.0f;
                               break;
                           }
                           x /= 3;
                           y /= 3;
                       }

                       write_imagef(dst, loc, value);
                   }

   sierpinski
       Generate a Sierpinski carpet/triangle fractal, and randomly pan around.

       This source accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils
           manual. Default value is "640x480".

       rate, r
           Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default value is "25".

       seed
           Set seed which is used for random panning.

       jump
           Set max jump for single pan destination. Allowed range is from 1 to 10000.

       type
           Set fractal type, can be default "carpet" or "triangle".

   zoneplate
       Generate a zoneplate test video pattern.

       This source accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils
           manual. Default value is "320x240".

       rate, r
           Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default value is "25".

       duration, d
           Set the duration of the sourced video. See the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual
           for the accepted syntax.

           If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is supposed to be generated
           forever.

       sar Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.

       precision
           Set precision in bits for look-up table for sine calculations. Default value is 10.  Allowed range is
           from 4 to 16.

       xo  Set horizontal axis offset for output signal. Default value is 0.

       yo  Set vertical axis offset for output signal. Default value is 0.

       to  Set time axis offset for output signal. Default value is 0.

       k0  Set 0-order, constant added to signal phase. Default value is 0.

       kx  Set 1-order, phase factor multiplier for horizontal axis. Default value is 0.

       ky  Set 1-order, phase factor multiplier for vertical axis. Default value is 0.

       kt  Set 1-order, phase factor multiplier for time axis. Default value is 0.

       kxt, kyt, kxy
           Set phase factor multipliers for combination of spatial and temporal axis.  Default value is 0.

       kx2 Set 2-order, phase factor multiplier for horizontal axis. Default value is 0.

       ky2 Set 2-order, phase factor multiplier for vertical axis. Default value is 0.

       kt2 Set 2-order, phase factor multiplier for time axis. Default value is 0.

       ku  Set the constant added to final phase to produce chroma-blue component of signal.  Default value is
           0.

       kv  Set the constant added to final phase to produce chroma-red component of signal.  Default value is 0.

       Commands

       This source supports the some above options as commands.

       Examples

       •   Generate horizontal color sine sweep:

                   zoneplate=ku=512:kv=0:kt2=0:kx2=256:s=wvga:xo=-426:kt=11

       •   Generate vertical color sine sweep:

                   zoneplate=ku=512:kv=0:kt2=0:ky2=156:s=wvga:yo=-240:kt=11

       •   Generate circular zone-plate:

                   zoneplate=ku=512:kv=100:kt2=0:ky2=256:kx2=556:s=wvga:yo=0:kt=11

VIDEO SINKS

       Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.

   buffersink
       Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter graph.

       This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular through the interface defined in
       libavfilter/buffersink.h or the options system.

       It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which defines the incoming buffers' formats, to
       be passed as the opaque parameter to "avfilter_init_filter" for initialization.

   nullsink
       Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is mainly useful as a template and for
       use in analysis / debugging tools.

MULTIMEDIA FILTERS

       Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.

   a3dscope
       Convert input audio to 3d scope video output.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       rate, r
           Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default value is "25".

       size, s
           Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "hd720".

       fov Set the camera field of view. Default is 90 degrees.  Allowed range is from 40 to 150.

       roll
           Set the camera roll.

       pitch
           Set the camera pitch.

       yaw Set the camera yaw.

       xzoom
           Set the camera zoom on X-axis.

       yzoom
           Set the camera zoom on Y-axis.

       zzoom
           Set the camera zoom on Z-axis.

       xpos
           Set the camera position on X-axis.

       ypos
           Set the camera position on Y-axis.

       zpos
           Set the camera position on Z-axis.

       length
           Set the length of displayed audio waves in number of frames.

       Commands

       Filter supports the some above options as commands.

   abitscope
       Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio bit scope.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       rate, r
           Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default value is "25".

       size, s
           Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "1024x256".

       colors
           Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to draw channels. Unrecognized
           or missing colors will be replaced by white color.

       mode, m
           Set output mode. Can be "bars" or "trace". Default is "bars".

   adrawgraph
       Draw a graph using input audio metadata.

       See drawgraph

   agraphmonitor
       See graphmonitor.

   ahistogram
       Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       dmode
           Specify how histogram is calculated.

           It accepts the following values:

           single
               Use single histogram for all channels.

           separate
               Use separate histogram for each channel.

           Default is "single".

       rate, r
           Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default value is "25".

       size, s
           Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "hd720".

       scale
           Set display scale.

           It accepts the following values:

           log logarithmic

           sqrt
               square root

           cbrt
               cubic root

           lin linear

           rlog
               reverse logarithmic

           Default is "log".

       ascale
           Set amplitude scale.

           It accepts the following values:

           log logarithmic

           lin linear

           Default is "log".

       acount
           Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.  Default is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all
           frames.

       rheight
           Set histogram ratio of window height.

       slide
           Set sonogram sliding.

           It accepts the following values:

           replace
               replace old rows with new ones.

           scroll
               scroll from top to bottom.

           Default is "replace".

       hmode
           Set histogram mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           abs Use absolute values of samples.

           sign
               Use untouched values of samples.

           Default is "abs".

   aphasemeter
       Measures phase of input audio, which is exported as metadata "lavfi.aphasemeter.phase", representing mean
       phase of current audio frame. A video output can also be produced and is enabled by default. The audio is
       passed through as first output.

       Audio will be rematrixed to stereo if it has a different channel layout. Phase value is in range "[-1,
       1]" where -1 means left and right channels are completely out of phase and 1 means channels are in phase.

       The filter accepts the following options, all related to its video output:

       rate, r
           Set the output frame rate. Default value is 25.

       size, s
           Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in
           the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "800x400".

       rc
       gc
       bc  Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are 2, 7 and 1.  Allowed range is "[0, 255]".

       mpc Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is "none" which is default, no median
           phase value will be drawn.

       video
           Enable video output. Default is enabled.

       phasing detection

       The filter also detects out of phase and mono sequences in stereo streams.  It logs the sequence start,
       end and duration when it lasts longer or as long as the minimum set.

       The filter accepts the following options for this detection:

       phasing
           Enable mono and out of phase detection. Default is disabled.

       tolerance, t
           Set phase tolerance for mono detection, in amplitude ratio. Default is 0.  Allowed range is "[0, 1]".

       angle, a
           Set angle threshold for out of phase detection, in degree. Default is 170.  Allowed range is "[90,
           180]".

       duration, d
           Set mono or out of phase duration until notification, expressed in seconds. Default is 2.

       Examples

       •   Complete example with ffmpeg to detect 1 second of mono with 0.001 phase tolerance:

                   ffmpeg -i stereo.wav -af aphasemeter=video=0:phasing=1:duration=1:tolerance=0.001 -f null -

   avectorscope
       Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector scope.

       The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo audio stream. A monaural signal,
       consisting of identical left and right signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation
       is visible as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.  If the straight (or deviation
       from it) but horizontal line appears this indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       mode, m
           Set the vectorscope mode.

           Available values are:

           lissajous
               Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.

           lissajous_xy
               Same as above but not rotated.

           polar
               Shape resembling half of circle.

           Default value is lissajous.

       size, s
           Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in
           the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "400x400".

       rate, r
           Set the output frame rate. Default value is 25.

       rc
       gc
       bc
       ac  Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are 40, 160, 80 and 255.  Allowed
           range is "[0, 255]".

       rf
       gf
       bf
       af  Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are 15, 10, 5 and 5.  Allowed range is
           "[0, 255]".

       zoom
           Set the zoom factor. Default value is 1. Allowed range is "[0, 10]".  Values lower than 1 will auto
           adjust zoom factor to maximal possible value.

       draw
           Set the vectorscope drawing mode.

           Available values are:

           dot Draw dot for each sample.

           line
               Draw line between previous and current sample.

           aaline
               Draw anti-aliased line between previous and current sample.

           Default value is dot.

       scale
           Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.

           Available values are:

           lin Linear.

           sqrt
               Square root.

           cbrt
               Cubic root.

           log Logarithmic.

       swap
           Swap left channel axis with right channel axis.

       mirror
           Mirror axis.

           none
               No mirror.

           x   Mirror only x axis.

           y   Mirror only y axis.

           xy  Mirror both axis.

       Examples

       •   Complete example using ffplay:

                   ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
                                [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'

       Commands

       This filter supports the all above options as commands except options "size" and "rate".

   bench, abench
       Benchmark part of a filtergraph.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       action
           Start or stop a timer.

           Available values are:

           start
               Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key "lavfi.bench.start_time"), and
               forward the frame to the next filter.

           stop
               Get the current time and fetch the "lavfi.bench.start_time" metadata from the input frame
               metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average, maximum and minimum time
               (respectively "t", "avg", "max" and "min") are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in
               seconds.

       Examples

       •   Benchmark selectivecolor filter:

                   bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop

   concat
       Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the other.

       The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All segments must have the same
       number of streams of each type, and that will also be the number of streams at output.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       n   Set the number of segments. Default is 2.

       v   Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video streams in each segment.
           Default is 1.

       a   Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio streams in each segment.
           Default is 0.

       unsafe
           Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.

       The filter has v+a outputs: first v video outputs, then a audio outputs.

       There are nx(v+a) inputs: first the inputs for the first segment, in the same order as the outputs, then
       the inputs for the second segment, etc.

       Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various reasons including codec frame
       size or sloppy authoring. For that reason, related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio
       track) should be concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest stream in
       each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter audio streams with silence.

       For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.

       All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the filtering system will
       automatically select a common pixel format for video streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and
       channel layout for audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted explicitly by
       the user.

       Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate at output; be sure to
       configure the output file to handle it.

       Examples

       •   Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version (video in stream 0, audio
           in streams 1 and 2):

                   ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
                     '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
                      concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
                     -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv

       •   Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the (a)movie sources, and adjusting
           the resolution:

                   movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
                   movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
                   [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]

           Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams do not have exactly the
           same duration in the first file.

       Commands

       This filter supports the following commands:

       next
           Close the current segment and step to the next one

   ebur128
       EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream and analyzes its loudness level. By default,
       it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the Momentary loudness (identified by "M"), Short-term
       loudness ("S"), Integrated loudness ("I") and Loudness Range ("LRA").

       The filter can only analyze streams which have sample format is double-precision floating point. The
       input stream will be converted to this specification, if needed. Users may need to insert aformat and/or
       aresample filters after this filter to obtain the original parameters.

       The filter also has a video output (see the video option) with a real time graph to observe the loudness
       evolution. The graphic contains the logged message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when
       this option is set, unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the short-term
       loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for the momentary loudness (400
       milliseconds), but can optionally be configured to instead display short-term loudness (see gauge).

       The green area marks a  +/- 1LU target range around the target loudness (-23LUFS by default, unless
       modified through target).

       More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on <http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness>.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       video
           Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this option is set or no. The
           video stream will be the first output stream if activated. Default is 0.

       size
           Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video
           size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default and minimum resolution is "640x480".

       meter
           Set the EBU scale meter. Default is 9. Common values are 9 and 18, respectively for EBU scale meter
           +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any other integer value between this range is allowed.

       metadata
           Set metadata injection. If set to 1, the audio input will be segmented into 100ms output frames, each
           of them containing various loudness information in metadata.  All the metadata keys are prefixed with
           "lavfi.r128.".

           Default is 0.

       framelog
           Force the frame logging level.

           Available values are:

           quiet
               logging disabled

           info
               information logging level

           verbose
               verbose logging level

           By default, the logging level is set to info. If the video or the metadata options are set, it
           switches to verbose.

       peak
           Set peak mode(s).

           Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a "flag" type). Possible values are:

           none
               Disable any peak mode (default).

           sample
               Enable sample-peak mode.

               Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message for sample-peak
               (identified by "SPK").

           true
               Enable true-peak mode.

               If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input stream for better
               peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.  (identified by "TPK") and true-peak per frame
               (identified by "FTPK").  This mode requires a build with "libswresample".

       dualmono
           Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback on a stereo system,
           its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.  If set to "true", this option will
           compensate for this effect.  Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.

       panlaw
           Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.  This parameter is
           optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.

       target
           Set a specific target level (in LUFS) used as relative zero in the visualization.  This parameter is
           optional and has a default value of -23LUFS as specified by EBU R128. However, material published
           online may prefer a level of -16LUFS (e.g. for use with podcasts or video platforms).

       gauge
           Set the value displayed by the gauge. Valid values are "momentary" and s "shortterm". By default the
           momentary value will be used, but in certain scenarios it may be more useful to observe the short
           term value instead (e.g.  live mixing).

       scale
           Sets the display scale for the loudness. Valid parameters are "absolute" (in LUFS) or "relative" (LU)
           relative to the target. This only affects the video output, not the summary or continuous log output.

       integrated
           Read-only exported value for measured integrated loudness, in LUFS.

       range
           Read-only exported value for measured loudness range, in LU.

       lra_low
           Read-only exported value for measured LRA low, in LUFS.

       lra_high
           Read-only exported value for measured LRA high, in LUFS.

       sample_peak
           Read-only exported value for measured sample peak, in dBFS.

       true_peak
           Read-only exported value for measured true peak, in dBFS.

       Examples

       •   Real-time graph using ffplay, with a EBU scale meter +18:

                   ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"

       •   Run an analysis with ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -

   interleave, ainterleave
       Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.

       "interleave" works with video inputs, "ainterleave" with audio.

       These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest queued frame to the output.

       Input streams must have well defined, monotonically increasing frame timestamp values.

       In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue at least one frame for each input,
       so they cannot work in case one input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.

       For example consider the case when one input is a "select" filter which always drops input frames. The
       "interleave" filter will keep reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames to
       output until the input sends an end-of-stream signal.

       Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop frames in case one input receives more
       frames than the other ones, and the queue is already filled.

       These filters accept the following options:

       nb_inputs, n
           Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.

       duration
           How to determine the end-of-stream.

           longest
               The duration of the longest input. (default)

           shortest
               The duration of the shortest input.

           first
               The duration of the first input.

       Examples

       •   Interleave frames belonging to different streams using ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi

       •   Add flickering blur effect:

                   select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave

   latency, alatency
       Measure filtering latency.

       Report previous filter filtering latency, delay in number of audio samples for audio filters or number of
       video frames for video filters.

       On end of input stream, filter will report min and max measured latency for previous running filter in
       filtergraph.

   metadata, ametadata
       Manipulate frame metadata.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       mode
           Set mode of operation of the filter.

           Can be one of the following:

           select
               If both "value" and "key" is set, select frames which have such metadata. If only "key" is set,
               select every frame that has such key in metadata.

           add Add new metadata "key" and "value". If key is already available do nothing.

           modify
               Modify value of already present key.

           delete
               If "value" is set, delete only keys that have such value.  Otherwise, delete key. If "key" is not
               set, delete all metadata values in the frame.

           print
               Print key and its value if metadata was found. If "key" is not set print all metadata values
               available in frame.

       key Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except "print" and "delete".

       value
           Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for "modify" and "add" mode.

       function
           Which function to use when comparing metadata value and "value".

           Can be one of following:

           same_str
               Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as "value".

           starts_with
               Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with the "value" option
               string.

           less
               Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than "value".

           equal
               Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if "value" is equal with metadata value.

           greater
               Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than "value".

           expr
               Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option "expr" evaluates to
               true.

           ends_with
               Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value ends with the "value" option
               string.

       expr
           Set expression which is used when "function" is set to "expr".  The expression is evaluated through
           the eval API and can contain the following constants:

           VALUE1, FRAMEVAL
               Float representation of "value" from metadata key.

           VALUE2, USERVAL
               Float representation of "value" as supplied by user in "value" option.

       file
           If specified in "print" mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of plain filename any
           writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand for standard output. If "file" option is
           not set, output is written to the log with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.

       direct
           Reduces buffering in print mode when output is written to a URL set using file.

       Examples

       •   Print all metadata values for frames with key "lavfi.signalstats.YDIF" with values between 0 and 1.

                   signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'

       •   Print silencedetect output to file metadata.txt.

                   silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt

       •   Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.

                   metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'

   perms, aperms
       Set read/write permissions for the output frames.

       These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the following filter in the
       filtergraph.

       The filters accept the following options:

       mode
           Select the permissions mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           none
               Do nothing. This is the default.

           ro  Set all the output frames read-only.

           rw  Set all the output frames directly writable.

           toggle
               Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.

           random
               Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.

       seed
           Set the seed for the random mode, must be an integer included between 0 and "UINT32_MAX". If not
           specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
           basis.

       Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the following one, the permission
       might not be received as expected in that following filter. Inserting a format or aformat filter before
       the perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.

   realtime, arealtime
       Slow down filtering to match real time approximately.

       These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to match the output rate with the
       input timestamps.  They are similar to the re option to "ffmpeg".

       They accept the following options:

       limit
           Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered a timestamp discontinuity
           and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.

       speed
           Speed factor for processing. The value must be a float larger than zero.  Values larger than 1.0 will
           result in faster than realtime processing, smaller will slow processing down. The limit is
           automatically adapted accordingly. Default is 1.0.

           A processing speed faster than what is possible without these filters cannot be achieved.

       Commands

       Both filters supports the all above options as commands.

   segment, asegment
       Split single input stream into multiple streams.

       This filter does opposite of concat filters.

       "segment" works on video frames, "asegment" on audio samples.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       timestamps
           Timestamps of output segments separated by '|'. The first segment will run from the beginning of the
           input stream. The last segment will run until the end of the input stream

       frames, samples
           Exact frame/sample count to split the segments.

       In all cases, prefixing an each segment with '+' will make it relative to the previous segment.

       Examples

       •   Split input audio stream into three output audio streams, starting at start of input audio stream and
           storing that in 1st output audio stream, then following at 60th second and storing than in 2nd output
           audio stream, and last after 150th second of input audio stream store in 3rd output audio stream:

                   asegment=timestamps="60|150"

   select, aselect
       Select frames to pass in output.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       expr, e
           Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.

           If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.

           If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the first output; otherwise it is
           sent to the output with index "ceil(val)-1", assuming that the input index starts from 0.

           For example a value of 1.2 corresponds to the output with index "ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1", that is the
           second output.

       outputs, n
           Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected frame is based on the result of
           the evaluation. Default value is 1.

       The expression can contain the following constants:

       n   The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.

       selected_n
           The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.

       prev_selected_n
           The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.

       TB  The timebase of the input timestamps.

       pts The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered frame, expressed in TB units. It's NAN if undefined.

       t   The PTS of the filtered frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.

       prev_pts
           The PTS of the previously filtered frame. It's NAN if undefined.

       prev_selected_pts
           The PTS of the last previously filtered frame. It's NAN if undefined.

       prev_selected_t
           The PTS of the last previously selected frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.

       start_pts
           The first PTS in the stream which is not NAN. It remains NAN if not found.

       start_t
           The first PTS, in seconds, in the stream which is not NAN. It remains NAN if not found.

       pict_type (video only)
           The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following values:

           I
           P
           B
           S
           SI
           SP
           BI
       interlace_type (video only)
           The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:

           PROGRESSIVE
               The frame is progressive (not interlaced).

           TOPFIRST
               The frame is top-field-first.

           BOTTOMFIRST
               The frame is bottom-field-first.

       consumed_sample_n (audio only)
           the number of selected samples before the current frame

       samples_n (audio only)
           the number of samples in the current frame

       sample_rate (audio only)
           the input sample rate

       key This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.

       pos the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information is not available (e.g. for
           synthetic video); deprecated, do not use

       scene (video only)
           value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low probability for the current
           frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher value means the current frame is more likely to be one
           (see the example below)

       concatdec_select
           The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an inpoint and an outpoint,
           but the output packets may not be entirely contained in the selected interval. By using this
           variable, it is possible to skip frames generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly
           contained in the selected interval.

           This works by comparing the frame pts against the lavf.concat.start_time and the lavf.concat.duration
           packet metadata values which are also present in the decoded frames.

           The concatdec_select variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least start_time and either the duration
           metadata is missing or the frame pts is less than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the
           start_time metadata is missing.

           That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the interval set by the
           concat demuxer.

       The default value of the select expression is "1".

       Examples

       •   Select all frames in input:

                   select

           The example above is the same as:

                   select=1

       •   Skip all frames:

                   select=0

       •   Select only I-frames:

                   select='eq(pict_type\,I)'

       •   Select one frame every 100:

                   select='not(mod(n\,100))'

       •   Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:

                   select=between(t\,10\,20)

       •   Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:

                   select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)

       •   Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:

                   select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'

       •   Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:

                   aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'

       •   Create a mosaic of the first scenes:

                   ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png

           Comparing scene against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane choice.

       •   Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:

                   select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h

       •   Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and outpoints but where the source
           files are not intra frame only.

                   ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi

   sendcmd, asendcmd
       Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.

       These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the filtergraph.

       "sendcmd" must be inserted between two video filters, "asendcmd" must be inserted between two audio
       filters, but apart from that they act the same way.

       The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments with the commands option, or in a
       file specified by the filename option.

       These filters accept the following options:

       commands, c
           Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.

       filename, f
           Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.

       Commands syntax

       A commands description consists of a sequence of interval specifications, comprising a list of commands
       to be executed when a particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event is typically
       the current frame time entering or leaving a given time interval.

       An interval is specified by the following syntax:

               <START>[-<END>] <COMMANDS>;

       The time interval is specified by the START and END times.  END is optional and defaults to the maximum
       time.

       The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if it is included in the interval
       [START, END), that is when the time is greater or equal to START and is lesser than END.

       COMMANDS consists of a sequence of one or more command specifications, separated by ",", relating to that
       interval.  The syntax of a command specification is given by:

               [<FLAGS>] <TARGET> <COMMAND> <ARG>

       FLAGS is optional and specifies the type of events relating to the time interval which enable sending the
       specified command, and must be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
       enclosed between "[" and "]".

       The following flags are recognized:

       enter
           The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the specified interval. In other words,
           the command is sent when the previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the current
           is.

       leave
           The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the specified interval. In other words,
           the command is sent when the previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the current is
           not.

       expr
           The command ARG is interpreted as expression and result of expression is passed as ARG.

           The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following constants:

           POS Original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined for the current frame.
               Deprecated, do not use.

           PTS The presentation timestamp in input.

           N   The count of the input frame for video or audio, starting from 0.

           T   The time in seconds of the current frame.

           TS  The start time in seconds of the current command interval.

           TE  The end time in seconds of the current command interval.

           TI  The interpolated time of the current command interval, TI = (T - TS) / (TE - TS).

           W   The video frame width.

           H   The video frame height.

       If FLAGS is not specified, a default value of "[enter]" is assumed.

       TARGET specifies the target of the command, usually the name of the filter class or a specific filter
       instance name.

       COMMAND specifies the name of the command for the target filter.

       ARG is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for the given COMMAND.

       Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or sequences of characters starting with "#"
       until the end of line, are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.

       A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax follows:

               <COMMAND_FLAG>  ::= "enter" | "leave"
               <COMMAND_FLAGS> ::= <COMMAND_FLAG> [(+|"|")<COMMAND_FLAG>]
               <COMMAND>       ::= ["[" <COMMAND_FLAGS> "]"] <TARGET> <COMMAND> [<ARG>]
               <COMMANDS>      ::= <COMMAND> [,<COMMANDS>]
               <INTERVAL>      ::= <START>[-<END>] <COMMANDS>
               <INTERVALS>     ::= <INTERVAL>[;<INTERVALS>]

       Examples

       •   Specify audio tempo change at second 4:

                   asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo

       •   Target a specific filter instance:

                   asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo@my tempo 1.5',atempo@my

       •   Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.

                   # show text in the interval 5-10
                   5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
                            [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';

                   # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
                   15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
                             [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
                             [leave] hue s 1,
                             [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';

                   # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
                   25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)

           A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list stored in a file test.cmd, can be
           specified with:

                   sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue

   setpts, asetpts
       Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.

       "setpts" works on video frames, "asetpts" on audio frames.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       expr
           The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.

       The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following constants:

       FRAME_RATE, FR
           frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video

       PTS The presentation timestamp in input

       N   The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples, not including the current
           frame for audio, starting from 0.

       NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
           The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only audio)

       NB_SAMPLES, S
           The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)

       SAMPLE_RATE, SR
           The audio sample rate.

       STARTPTS
           The PTS of the first frame.

       STARTT
           the time in seconds of the first frame

       INTERLACED
           State whether the current frame is interlaced.

       T   the time in seconds of the current frame

       POS original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined for the current frame;
           deprecated, do not use

       PREV_INPTS
           The previous input PTS.

       PREV_INT
           previous input time in seconds

       PREV_OUTPTS
           The previous output PTS.

       PREV_OUTT
           previous output time in seconds

       RTCTIME
           The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0) instead.

       RTCSTART
           The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.

       TB  The timebase of the input timestamps.

       T_CHANGE
           Time of the first frame after command was applied or time of the first frame if no commands.

       Examples

       •   Start counting PTS from zero

                   setpts=PTS-STARTPTS

       •   Apply fast motion effect:

                   setpts=0.5*PTS

       •   Apply slow motion effect:

                   setpts=2.0*PTS

       •   Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:

                   setpts=N/(25*TB)

       •   Apply a random jitter effect of +/-100 TB units:

                   setpts=PTS+randomi(0, -100\,100)

       •   Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:

                   setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'

       •   Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:

                   setpts=PTS+10/TB

       •   Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:

                   setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'

       •   Generate timestamps by counting samples:

                   asetpts=N/SR/TB

       Commands

       Both filters support all above options as commands.

   setrange
       Force color range for the output video frame.

       The "setrange" filter marks the color range property for the output frames. It does not change the input
       frame, but only sets the corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by following
       filters.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       range
           Available values are:

           auto
               Keep the same color range property.

           unspecified, unknown
               Set the color range as unspecified.

           limited, tv, mpeg
               Set the color range as limited.

           full, pc, jpeg
               Set the color range as full.

   settb, asettb
       Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.  It is mainly useful for testing timebase
       configuration.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       expr, tb
           The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.

       The value for tb is an arithmetic expression representing a rational. The expression can contain the
       constants "AVTB" (the default timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate, audio
       only). Default value is "intb".

       Examples

       •   Set the timebase to 1/25:

                   settb=expr=1/25

       •   Set the timebase to 1/10:

                   settb=expr=0.1

       •   Set the timebase to 1001/1000:

                   settb=1+0.001

       •   Set the timebase to 2*intb:

                   settb=2*intb

       •   Set the default timebase value:

                   settb=AVTB

   showcqt
       Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum logarithmically using Brown-
       Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the
       transform itself is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped), with
       musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option, check the
           "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "1920x1080".

       fps, rate, r
           Set the output frame rate. Default value is 25.

       bar_h
           Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is -1 which computes the bargraph height
           automatically.

       axis_h
           Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is -1 which computes the axis height
           automatically.

       sono_h
           Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is -1 which computes the sonogram height
           automatically.

       fullhd
           Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use size, s instead. Default value is 1.

       sono_v, volume
           Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:

           bar_v
               the bar_v evaluated expression

           frequency, freq, f
               the frequency where it is evaluated

           timeclamp, tc
               the value of timeclamp option

           and functions:

           a_weighting(f)
               A-weighting of equal loudness

           b_weighting(f)
               B-weighting of equal loudness

           c_weighting(f)
               C-weighting of equal loudness.

           Default value is 16.

       bar_v, volume2
           Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:

           sono_v
               the sono_v evaluated expression

           frequency, freq, f
               the frequency where it is evaluated

           timeclamp, tc
               the value of timeclamp option

           and functions:

           a_weighting(f)
               A-weighting of equal loudness

           b_weighting(f)
               B-weighting of equal loudness

           c_weighting(f)
               C-weighting of equal loudness.

           Default value is "sono_v".

       sono_g, gamma
           Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast, higher gamma makes the
           spectrum having more range. Default value is 3.  Acceptable range is "[1, 7]".

       bar_g, gamma2
           Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is 1. Acceptable range is "[1, 7]".

       bar_t
           Specify the bargraph transparency level. Lower value makes the bargraph sharper.  Default value is 1.
           Acceptable range is "[0, 1]".

       timeclamp, tc
           Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between accuracy in time domain
           and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower, event in time domain is represented more accurately
           (such as fast bass drum), otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately (such as
           bass guitar). Acceptable range is "[0.002, 1]". Default value is 0.17.

       attack
           Set attack time in seconds. The default is 0 (disabled). Otherwise, it limits future samples by
           applying asymmetric windowing in time domain, useful when low latency is required. Accepted range is
           "[0, 1]".

       basefreq
           Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is 20.01523126408007475, which is frequency 50
           cents below E0. Acceptable range is "[10, 100000]".

       endfreq
           Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is 20495.59681441799654, which is frequency 50
           cents above D#10. Acceptable range is "[10, 100000]".

       coeffclamp
           This option is deprecated and ignored.

       tlength
           Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy trade-off between
           time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.  It can contain variables:

           frequency, freq, f
               the frequency where it is evaluated

           timeclamp, tc
               the value of timeclamp option.

           Default value is "384*tc/(384+tc*f)".

       count
           Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is 6.  Acceptable range is "[1,
           30]".

       fcount
           Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is 0, which makes it computed
           automatically. Acceptable range is "[0, 10]".

       fontfile
           Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified, use embedded font. Note
           that drawing with font file or embedded font is not implemented with custom basefreq and endfreq, use
           axisfile option instead.

       font
           Specify fontconfig pattern. This has lower priority than fontfile. The ":" in the pattern may be
           replaced by "|" to avoid unnecessary escaping.

       fontcolor
           Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return integer value
           0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:

           frequency, freq, f
               the frequency where it is evaluated

           timeclamp, tc
               the value of timeclamp option

           and functions:

           midi(f)
               midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)

           r(x), g(x), b(x)
               red, green, and blue value of intensity x.

           Default value is "st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12); st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)),
           0)); r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))".

       axisfile
           Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override fontfile and fontcolor option.

       axis, text
           Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to 0, drawing to the axis is disabled, ignoring
           fontfile and axisfile option.  Default value is 1.

       csp Set colorspace. The accepted values are:

           unspecified
               Unspecified (default)

           bt709
               BT.709

           fcc FCC

           bt470bg
               BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625

           smpte170m
               SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525

           smpte240m
               SMPTE-240M

           bt2020ncl
               BT.2020 with non-constant luminance

       cscheme
           Set spectrogram color scheme. This is list of floating point values with format
           "left_r|left_g|left_b|right_r|right_g|right_b".  The default is "1|0.5|0|0|0.5|1".

       Examples

       •   Playing audio while showing the spectrum:

                   ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'

       •   Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:

                   ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'

       •   Playing at 1280x720:

                   ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'

       •   Disable sonogram display:

                   sono_h=0

       •   A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:

                   ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
                                    asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'

       •   Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:

                   ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
                                    asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'

       •   Custom volume:

                   bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)

       •   Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.

                   bar_g=2:sono_g=2

       •   Custom tlength equation:

                   tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'

       •   Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:

                   fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf

       •   Custom font using fontconfig:

                   font='Courier New,Monospace,mono|bold'

       •   Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:

                   axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000

   showcwt
       Convert input audio to video output representing frequency spectrum using Continuous Wavelet Transform
       and Morlet wavelet.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "640x512".

       rate, r
           Set the output frame rate. Default value is 25.

       scale
           Set the frequency scale used. Allowed values are:

           linear
           log
           bark
           mel
           erbs
           sqrt
           cbrt
           qdrt
           fm

           Default value is "linear".

       iscale
           Set the intensity scale used. Allowed values are:

           linear
           log
           sqrt
           cbrt
           qdrt

           Default value is "log".

       min Set the minimum frequency that will be used in output.  Default is 20 Hz.

       max Set the maximum frequency that will be used in output.  Default is 20000 Hz. The real frequency upper
           limit depends on input audio's sample rate and such will be enforced on this value when it is set to
           value greater than Nyquist frequency.

       imin
           Set the minimum intensity that will be used in output.

       imax
           Set the maximum intensity that will be used in output.

       logb
           Set the logarithmic basis for brightness strength when mapping calculated magnitude values to pixel
           values.  Allowed range is from 0 to 1.  Default value is 0.0001.

       deviation
           Set the frequency deviation.  Lower values than 1 are more frequency oriented, while higher values
           than 1 are more time oriented.  Allowed range is from 0 to 10.  Default value is 1.

       pps Set the number of pixel output per each second in one row.  Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.  Default
           value is 64.

       mode
           Set the output visual mode. Allowed values are:

           magnitude
               Show magnitude.

           phase
               Show only phase.

           magphase
               Show combination of magnitude and phase.  Magnitude is mapped to brightness and phase to color.

           channel
               Show unique color per channel magnitude.

           stereo
               Show unique color per stereo difference.

           Default value is "magnitude".

       slide
           Set the output slide method. Allowed values are:

           replace
           scroll
           frame
       direction
           Set the direction method for output slide method. Allowed values are:

           lr  Direction from left to right.

           rl  Direction from right to left.

           ud  Direction from up to down.

           du  Direction from down to up.

       bar Set the ratio of bargraph display to display size. Default is 0.

       rotation
           Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.  Default value is 0.

   showfreqs
       Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.  Audio amplitude is on Y-axis
       while frequency is on X-axis.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section in the ffmpeg-
           utils manual.  Default is "1024x512".

       rate, r
           Set video rate. Default is 25.

       mode
           Set display mode.  This set how each frequency bin will be represented.

           It accepts the following values:

           line
           bar
           dot

           Default is "bar".

       ascale
           Set amplitude scale.

           It accepts the following values:

           lin Linear scale.

           sqrt
               Square root scale.

           cbrt
               Cubic root scale.

           log Logarithmic scale.

           Default is "log".

       fscale
           Set frequency scale.

           It accepts the following values:

           lin Linear scale.

           log Logarithmic scale.

           rlog
               Reverse logarithmic scale.

           Default is "lin".

       win_size
           Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 65536.

           Default is 2048

       win_func
           Set windowing function.

           It accepts the following values:

           rect
           bartlett
           hanning
           hamming
           blackman
           welch
           flattop
           bharris
           bnuttall
           bhann
           sine
           nuttall
           lanczos
           gauss
           tukey
           dolph
           cauchy
           parzen
           poisson
           bohman
           kaiser

           Default is "hanning".

       overlap
           Set window overlap. In range "[0, 1]". Default is 1, which means optimal overlap for selected window
           function will be picked.

       averaging
           Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.  Default is 1, which means
           time averaging is disabled.

       colors
           Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to draw channel frequencies.
           Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced by white color.

       cmode
           Set channel display mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           combined
           separate

           Default is "combined".

       minamp
           Set minimum amplitude used in "log" amplitude scaler.

       data
           Set data display mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           magnitude
           phase
           delay

           Default is "magnitude".

       channels
           Set channels to use when processing audio. By default all are processed.

   showspatial
       Convert stereo input audio to a video output, representing the spatial relationship between two channels.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "512x512".

       win_size
           Set window size. Allowed range is from 1024 to 65536. Default size is 4096.

       win_func
           Set window function.

           It accepts the following values:

           rect
           bartlett
           hann
           hanning
           hamming
           blackman
           welch
           flattop
           bharris
           bnuttall
           bhann
           sine
           nuttall
           lanczos
           gauss
           tukey
           dolph
           cauchy
           parzen
           poisson
           bohman
           kaiser

           Default value is "hann".

       rate, r
           Set output framerate.

   showspectrum
       Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency spectrum.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "640x512".

       slide
           Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.

           It accepts the following values:

           replace
               the samples start again on the left when they reach the right

           scroll
               the samples scroll from right to left

           fullframe
               frames are only produced when the samples reach the right

           rscroll
               the samples scroll from left to right

           lreplace
               the samples start again on the right when they reach the left

           Default value is "replace".

       mode
           Specify display mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           combined
               all channels are displayed in the same row

           separate
               all channels are displayed in separate rows

           Default value is combined.

       color
           Specify display color mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           channel
               each channel is displayed in a separate color

           intensity
               each channel is displayed using the same color scheme

           rainbow
               each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme

           moreland
               each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme

           nebulae
               each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme

           fire
               each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme

           fiery
               each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme

           fruit
               each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme

           cool
               each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme

           magma
               each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme

           green
               each channel is displayed using the green color scheme

           viridis
               each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme

           plasma
               each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme

           cividis
               each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme

           terrain
               each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme

           Default value is channel.

       scale
           Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.

           It accepts the following values:

           lin linear

           sqrt
               square root, default

           cbrt
               cubic root

           log logarithmic

           4thrt
               4th root

           5thrt
               5th root

           Default value is sqrt.

       fscale
           Specify frequency scale.

           It accepts the following values:

           lin linear

           log logarithmic

           Default value is lin.

       saturation
           Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide alternative color scheme. 0 is
           no saturation at all.  Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.  Default value is 1.

       win_func
           Set window function.

           It accepts the following values:

           rect
           bartlett
           hann
           hanning
           hamming
           blackman
           welch
           flattop
           bharris
           bnuttall
           bhann
           sine
           nuttall
           lanczos
           gauss
           tukey
           dolph
           cauchy
           parzen
           poisson
           bohman
           kaiser

           Default value is "hann".

       orientation
           Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be "vertical" or "horizontal". Default is "vertical".

       overlap
           Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is 0.  When value is 1 overlap is set to recommended size
           for specific window function currently used.

       gain
           Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.  Default value is 1.

       data
           Set which data to display. Can be "magnitude", default or "phase", or unwrapped phase: "uphase".

       rotation
           Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.  Default value is 0.

       start
           Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is 0.

       stop
           Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is 0.

       fps Set upper frame rate limit. Default is "auto", unlimited.

       legend
           Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is disabled.

       drange
           Set dynamic range used to calculate intensity color values. Default is 120 dBFS.  Allowed range is
           from 10 to 200.

       limit
           Set upper limit of input audio samples volume in dBFS. Default is 0 dBFS.  Allowed range is from -100
           to 100.

       opacity
           Set opacity strength when using pixel format output with alpha component.

       The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that section.

       Examples

       •   Large window with logarithmic color scaling:

                   showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log

       •   Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using ffplay:

                   ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
                                [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'

   showspectrumpic
       Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency spectrum.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "4096x2048".

       mode
           Specify display mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           combined
               all channels are displayed in the same row

           separate
               all channels are displayed in separate rows

           Default value is combined.

       color
           Specify display color mode.

           It accepts the following values:

           channel
               each channel is displayed in a separate color

           intensity
               each channel is displayed using the same color scheme

           rainbow
               each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme

           moreland
               each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme

           nebulae
               each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme

           fire
               each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme

           fiery
               each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme

           fruit
               each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme

           cool
               each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme

           magma
               each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme

           green
               each channel is displayed using the green color scheme

           viridis
               each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme

           plasma
               each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme

           cividis
               each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme

           terrain
               each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme

           Default value is intensity.

       scale
           Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.

           It accepts the following values:

           lin linear

           sqrt
               square root, default

           cbrt
               cubic root

           log logarithmic

           4thrt
               4th root

           5thrt
               5th root

           Default value is log.

       fscale
           Specify frequency scale.

           It accepts the following values:

           lin linear

           log logarithmic

           Default value is lin.

       saturation
           Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide alternative color scheme. 0 is
           no saturation at all.  Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.  Default value is 1.

       win_func
           Set window function.

           It accepts the following values:

           rect
           bartlett
           hann
           hanning
           hamming
           blackman
           welch
           flattop
           bharris
           bnuttall
           bhann
           sine
           nuttall
           lanczos
           gauss
           tukey
           dolph
           cauchy
           parzen
           poisson
           bohman
           kaiser

           Default value is "hann".

       orientation
           Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be "vertical" or "horizontal". Default is "vertical".

       gain
           Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.  Default value is 1.

       legend
           Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.

       rotation
           Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.  Default value is 0.

       start
           Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is 0.

       stop
           Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is 0.

       drange
           Set dynamic range used to calculate intensity color values. Default is 120 dBFS.  Allowed range is
           from 10 to 200.

       limit
           Set upper limit of input audio samples volume in dBFS. Default is 0 dBFS.  Allowed range is from -100
           to 100.

       opacity
           Set opacity strength when using pixel format output with alpha component.

       Examples

       •   Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track in a 1024x1024 picture using ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png

   showvolume
       Convert input audio volume to a video output.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       rate, r
           Set video rate.

       b   Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.

       w   Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.

       h   Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.

       f   Set fade, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.95.

       c   Set volume color expression.

           The expression can use the following variables:

           VOLUME
               Current max volume of channel in dB.

           PEAK
               Current peak.

           CHANNEL
               Current channel number, starting from 0.

       t   If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.

       v   If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.

       o   Set orientation, can be horizontal: "h" or vertical: "v", default is "h".

       s   Set step size, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means step is disabled.

       p   Set background opacity, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.

       m   Set metering mode, can be peak: "p" or rms: "r", default is "p".

       ds  Set display scale, can be linear: "lin" or log: "log", default is "lin".

       dm  In second.  If set to > 0., display a line for the max level in the previous seconds.  default is
           disabled: 0.

       dmc The color of the max line. Use when "dm" option is set to > 0.  default is: "orange"

   showwaves
       Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "600x240".

       mode
           Set display mode.

           Available values are:

           point
               Draw a point for each sample.

           line
               Draw a vertical line for each sample.

           p2p Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.

           cline
               Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.

           Default value is "point".

       n   Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A larger value will decrease the
           frame rate. Must be a positive integer. This option can be set only if the value for rate is not
           explicitly specified.

       rate, r
           Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the option n. Default value is "25".

       split_channels
           Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.

       colors
           Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.

       scale
           Set amplitude scale.

           Available values are:

           lin Linear.

           log Logarithmic.

           sqrt
               Square root.

           cbrt
               Cubic root.

           Default is linear.

       draw
           Set the draw mode. This is mostly useful to set for high n.

           Available values are:

           scale
               Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.

           full
               Draw every sample directly.

           Default value is "scale".

       Examples

       •   Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation at the same time:

                   amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]

       •   Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a frame rate of 30 frames per second:

                   aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]

   showwavespic
       Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video size" section
           in the ffmpeg-utils manual.  Default value is "600x240".

       split_channels
           Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.

       colors
           Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.

       scale
           Set amplitude scale.

           Available values are:

           lin Linear.

           log Logarithmic.

           sqrt
               Square root.

           cbrt
               Cubic root.

           Default is linear.

       draw
           Set the draw mode.

           Available values are:

           scale
               Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.

           full
               Draw every sample directly.

           Default value is "scale".

       filter
           Set the filter mode.

           Available values are:

           average
               Use average samples values for each drawn sample.

           peak
               Use peak samples values for each drawn sample.

           Default value is "average".

       Examples

       •   Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track in a 1024x800 picture
           using ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png

   sidedata, asidedata
       Delete frame side data, or select frames based on it.

       This filter accepts the following options:

       mode
           Set mode of operation of the filter.

           Can be one of the following:

           select
               Select every frame with side data of "type".

           delete
               Delete side data of "type". If "type" is not set, delete all side data in the frame.

       type
           Set side data type used with all modes. Must be set for "select" mode. For the list of frame side
           data types, refer to the "AVFrameSideDataType" enum in libavutil/frame.h. For example, to choose
           "AV_FRAME_DATA_PANSCAN" side data, you must specify "PANSCAN".

   spectrumsynth
       Synthesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents magnitude across time and
       second represents phase across time.  The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in
       videos back to time domain as presented in audio output.

       This filter is primarily created for reversing processed showspectrum filter outputs, but can synthesize
       sound from other spectrograms too.  But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is
       not available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually it's just recreated from
       random noise.  For best results use gray only output ("channel" color mode in showspectrum filter) and
       "log" scale for magnitude video and "lin" scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
       "data" option. Inputs videos should generally use "fullframe" slide mode as that saves resources needed
       for decoding video.

       The filter accepts the following options:

       sample_rate
           Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which spectrum was generated may
           differ.

       channels
           Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.

       scale
           Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.  Can be "lin" or "log". Default is
           "log".

       slide
           Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.  Can be "replace", "scroll", "fullframe"
           or "rscroll".  Default is "fullframe".

       win_func
           Set window function used for resynthesis.

       overlap
           Set window overlap. In range "[0, 1]". Default is 1, which means optimal overlap for selected window
           function will be picked.

       orientation
           Set orientation of input videos. Can be "vertical" or "horizontal".  Default is "vertical".

       Examples

       •   First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
           then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:

                   ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
                   ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
                   ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac

   split, asplit
       Split input into several identical outputs.

       "asplit" works with audio input, "split" with video.

       The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If unspecified, it defaults
       to 2.

       Examples

       •   Create two separate outputs from the same input:

                   [in] split [out0][out1]

       •   To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of outputs, like in:

                   [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]

       •   Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and one padded:

                   [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
                   [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0    [cropout];
                   [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];

       •   Create 5 copies of the input audio with ffmpeg:

                   ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT

   zmq, azmq
       Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to filters in the filtergraph.

       "zmq" and "azmq" work as a pass-through filters. "zmq" must be inserted between two video filters, "azmq"
       between two audio filters. Both are capable to send messages to any filter type.

       To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and headers and configure FFmpeg with
       "--enable-libzmq".

       For more information about libzmq see: <http://www.zeromq.org/>

       The "zmq" and "azmq" filters work as a libzmq server, which receives messages sent through a network
       interface defined by the bind_address (or the abbreviation "b") option.  Default value of this option is
       tcp://localhost:5555. You may want to alter this value to your needs, but do not forget to escape any ':'
       signs (see filtergraph escaping).

       The received message must be in the form:

               <TARGET> <COMMAND> [<ARG>]

       TARGET specifies the target of the command, usually the name of the filter class or a specific filter
       instance name. The default filter instance name uses the pattern Parsed_<filter_name>_<index>, but you
       can override this by using the filter_name@id syntax (see Filtergraph syntax).

       COMMAND specifies the name of the command for the target filter.

       ARG is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the given COMMAND.

       Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command is injected into the filtergraph.
       Depending on the result, the filter will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:

               <ERROR_CODE> <ERROR_REASON>
               <MESSAGE>

       MESSAGE is optional.

       Examples

       Look at tools/zmqsend for an example of a zmq client which can be used to send commands processed by
       these filters.

       Consider the following filtergraph generated by ffplay.  In this example the last overlay filter has an
       instance name. All other filters will have default instance names.

               ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
               color=s=100x100:c=red  [l];
               color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
               nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
               [bg][l]   overlay     [bg+l];
               [bg+l][r] overlay@my=x=100 "

       To change the color of the left side of the video, the following command can be used:

               echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend

       To change the right side:

               echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend

       To change the position of the right side:

               echo overlay@my x 150 | tools/zmqsend

MULTIMEDIA SOURCES

       Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.

   amovie
       This is the same as movie source, except it selects an audio stream by default.

   avsynctest
       Generate an Audio/Video Sync Test.

       Generated stream periodically shows flash video frame and emits beep in audio.  Useful to inspect A/V
       sync issues.

       It accepts the following options:

       size, s
           Set output video size. Default value is "hd720".

       framerate, fr
           Set output video frame rate. Default value is 30.

       samplerate, sr
           Set output audio sample rate. Default value is 44100.

       amplitude, a
           Set output audio beep amplitude. Default value is 0.7.

       period, p
           Set output audio beep period in seconds. Default value is 3.

       delay, dl
           Set output video flash delay in number of frames. Default value is 0.

       cycle, c
           Enable cycling of video delays, by default is disabled.

       duration, d
           Set stream output duration. By default duration is unlimited.

       fg, bg, ag
           Set foreground/background/additional color.

       Commands

       This source supports the some above options as commands.

   movie
       Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.

       It accepts the following parameters:

       filename
           The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a device or a stream
           accessed through some protocol).

       format_name, f
           Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either the name of a container or an
           input device. If not specified, the format is guessed from movie_name or by probing.

       seek_point, sp
           Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output starting from this seek point. The
           parameter is evaluated with "av_strtod", so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS postfix. The
           default value is "0".

       streams, s
           Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified, separated by "+". The source will
           then have as many outputs, in the same order. The syntax is explained in the "Stream specifiers"
           section in the ffmpeg manual. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify respectively the default (best
           suited) video and audio stream. Default is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".

       stream_index, si
           Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1, the most suitable video stream
           will be automatically selected. The default value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called
           "amovie", it will select audio instead of video.

       loop
           Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.  If the value is 0, the stream will be
           looped infinitely.  Default value is "1".

           Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not changed, so it will generate non
           monotonically increasing timestamps.

       discontinuity
           Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is considered a timestamp
           discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later timestamps.

       dec_threads
           Specifies the number of threads for decoding

       format_opts
           Specify format options for the opened file. Format options can be specified as a list of key=value
           pairs separated by ':'. The following example shows how to add protocol_whitelist and
           protocol_blacklist options:

                   ffplay -f lavfi
                   "movie=filename='1.sdp':format_opts='protocol_whitelist=file,rtp,udp\:protocol_blacklist=http'"

       It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:

               input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
                                                   ^
                                                   |
               movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+

       Examples

       •   Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it on top of the input labelled
           "in":

                   movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
                   [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
                   [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]

       •   Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input labelled "in":

                   movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
                   [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
                   [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]

       •   Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from dvd.vob; the video is connected to
           the pad named "video" and the audio is connected to the pad named "audio":

                   movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]

       Commands

       Both movie and amovie support the following commands:

       seek
           Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".  The syntax is: seek stream_index|timestamp|flagsstream_index: If stream_index is -1, a default stream is selected, and timestamp is automatically
               converted from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.

           •   timestamp: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE
               units.

           •   flags: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.

       get_duration
           Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.

EXTERNAL LIBRARIES

       FFmpeg can be hooked up with a number of external libraries to add support for more formats. None of them
       are used by default, their use has to be explicitly requested by passing the appropriate flags to
       ./configure.

   Alliance for Open Media (AOM)
       FFmpeg can make use of the AOM library for AV1 decoding and encoding.

       Go to <http://aomedia.org/> and follow the instructions for installing the library. Then pass
       "--enable-libaom" to configure to enable it.

   AMD AMF/VCE
       FFmpeg can use the AMD Advanced Media Framework library for accelerated H.264 and HEVC(only windows)
       encoding on hardware with Video Coding Engine (VCE).

       To enable support you must obtain the AMF framework header files(version 1.4.9+) from
       <https://github.com/GPUOpen-LibrariesAndSDKs/AMF.git>.

       Create an "AMF/" directory in the system include path.  Copy the contents of "AMF/amf/public/include/"
       into that directory.  Then configure FFmpeg with "--enable-amf".

       Initialization of amf encoder occurs in this order: 1) trying to initialize through dx11(only windows) 2)
       trying to initialize through dx9(only windows) 3) trying to initialize through vulkan

       To use h.264(AMD VCE) encoder on linux amdgru-pro version 19.20+ and amf-amdgpu-pro package(amdgru-pro
       contains, but does not install automatically) are required.

       This driver can be installed using amdgpu-pro-install script in official amd driver archive.

   AviSynth
       FFmpeg can read AviSynth scripts as input. To enable support, pass "--enable-avisynth" to configure after
       installing the headers provided by <https://github.com/AviSynth/AviSynthPlus>.  AviSynth+ can be
       configured to install only the headers by either passing "-DHEADERS_ONLY:bool=on" to the normal CMake-
       based build system, or by using the supplied "GNUmakefile".

       For Windows, supported AviSynth variants are <http://avisynth.nl> for 32-bit builds and
       <http://avisynth.nl/index.php/AviSynth+> for 32-bit and 64-bit builds.

       For Linux, macOS, and BSD, the only supported AviSynth variant is
       <https://github.com/AviSynth/AviSynthPlus>, starting with version 3.5.

           In 2016, AviSynth+ added support for building with GCC. However, due to the eccentricities of
           Windows' calling conventions, 32-bit GCC builds of AviSynth+ are not compatible with typical 32-bit
           builds of FFmpeg.

           By default, FFmpeg assumes compatibility with 32-bit MSVC builds of AviSynth+ since that is the most
           widely-used and entrenched build configuration.  Users can override this and enable support for
           32-bit GCC builds of AviSynth+ by passing "-DAVSC_WIN32_GCC32" to "--extra-cflags" when configuring
           FFmpeg.

           64-bit builds of FFmpeg are not affected, and can use either MSVC or GCC builds of AviSynth+ without
           any special flags.

           AviSynth(+) is loaded dynamically.  Distributors can build FFmpeg with "--enable-avisynth", and the
           binaries will work regardless of the end user having AviSynth installed.  If/when an end user would
           like to use AviSynth scripts, then they can install AviSynth(+) and FFmpeg will be able to find and
           use it to open scripts.

   Chromaprint
       FFmpeg can make use of the Chromaprint library for generating audio fingerprints.  Pass
       "--enable-chromaprint" to configure to enable it. See <https://acoustid.org/chromaprint>.

   codec2
       FFmpeg can make use of the codec2 library for codec2 decoding and encoding.  There is currently no native
       decoder, so libcodec2 must be used for decoding.

       Go to <http://freedv.org/>, download "Codec 2 source archive".  Build and install using CMake. Debian
       users can install the libcodec2-dev package instead.  Once libcodec2 is installed you can pass
       "--enable-libcodec2" to configure to enable it.

       The easiest way to use codec2 is with .c2 files, since they contain the mode information required for
       decoding.  To encode such a file, use a .c2 file extension and give the libcodec2 encoder the -mode
       option: "ffmpeg -i input.wav -mode 700C output.c2".  Playback is as simple as "ffplay output.c2".  For a
       list of supported modes, run "ffmpeg -h encoder=libcodec2".  Raw codec2 files are also supported.  To
       make sense of them the mode in use needs to be specified as a format option: "ffmpeg -f codec2raw -mode
       1300 -i input.raw output.wav".

   dav1d
       FFmpeg can make use of the dav1d library for AV1 video decoding.

       Go to <https://code.videolan.org/videolan/dav1d> and follow the instructions for installing the library.
       Then pass "--enable-libdav1d" to configure to enable it.

   davs2
       FFmpeg can make use of the davs2 library for AVS2-P2/IEEE1857.4 video decoding.

       Go to <https://github.com/pkuvcl/davs2> and follow the instructions for installing the library. Then pass
       "--enable-libdavs2" to configure to enable it.

           libdavs2 is under the GNU Public License Version 2 or later (see
           <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-licenses/gpl-2.0.html> for details), you must upgrade FFmpeg's
           license to GPL in order to use it.

   uavs3d
       FFmpeg can make use of the uavs3d library for AVS3-P2/IEEE1857.10 video decoding.

       Go to <https://github.com/uavs3/uavs3d> and follow the instructions for installing the library. Then pass
       "--enable-libuavs3d" to configure to enable it.

   Game Music Emu
       FFmpeg can make use of the Game Music Emu library to read audio from supported video game music file
       formats. Pass "--enable-libgme" to configure to enable it. See
       <https://bitbucket.org/mpyne/game-music-emu/overview>.

   Intel QuickSync Video
       FFmpeg can use Intel QuickSync Video (QSV) for accelerated decoding and encoding of multiple codecs. To
       use QSV, FFmpeg must be linked against the "libmfx" dispatcher, which loads the actual decoding
       libraries.

       The dispatcher is open source and can be downloaded from <https://github.com/lu-zero/mfx_dispatch.git>.
       FFmpeg needs to be configured with the "--enable-libmfx" option and "pkg-config" needs to be able to
       locate the dispatcher's ".pc" files.

   Kvazaar
       FFmpeg can make use of the Kvazaar library for HEVC encoding.

       Go to <https://github.com/ultravideo/kvazaar> and follow the instructions for installing the library.
       Then pass "--enable-libkvazaar" to configure to enable it.

   LAME
       FFmpeg can make use of the LAME library for MP3 encoding.

       Go to <http://lame.sourceforge.net/> and follow the instructions for installing the library.  Then pass
       "--enable-libmp3lame" to configure to enable it.

   libilbc
       iLBC is a narrowband speech codec that has been made freely available by Google as part of the WebRTC
       project. libilbc is a packaging friendly copy of the iLBC codec. FFmpeg can make use of the libilbc
       library for iLBC decoding and encoding.

       Go to <https://github.com/TimothyGu/libilbc> and follow the instructions for installing the library. Then
       pass "--enable-libilbc" to configure to enable it.

   libjxl
       JPEG XL is an image format intended to fully replace legacy JPEG for an extended period of life. See
       <https://jpegxl.info/> for more information, and see <https://github.com/libjxl/libjxl> for the library
       source. You can pass "--enable-libjxl" to configure in order enable the libjxl wrapper.

   libvpx
       FFmpeg can make use of the libvpx library for VP8/VP9 decoding and encoding.

       Go to <http://www.webmproject.org/> and follow the instructions for installing the library. Then pass
       "--enable-libvpx" to configure to enable it.

   ModPlug
       FFmpeg can make use of this library, originating in Modplug-XMMS, to read from MOD-like music files.  See
       <https://github.com/Konstanty/libmodplug>. Pass "--enable-libmodplug" to configure to enable it.

   OpenCORE, VisualOn, and Fraunhofer libraries
       Spun off Google Android sources, OpenCore, VisualOn and Fraunhofer libraries provide encoders for a
       number of audio codecs.

           OpenCORE and VisualOn libraries are under the Apache License 2.0 (see
           <http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0> for details), which is incompatible to the LGPL version
           2.1 and GPL version 2. You have to upgrade FFmpeg's license to LGPL version 3 (or if you have enabled
           GPL components, GPL version 3) by passing "--enable-version3" to configure in order to use it.

           The license of the Fraunhofer AAC library is incompatible with the GPL.  Therefore, for GPL builds,
           you have to pass "--enable-nonfree" to configure in order to use it. To the best of our knowledge, it
           is compatible with the LGPL.

       OpenCORE AMR

       FFmpeg can make use of the OpenCORE libraries for AMR-NB decoding/encoding and AMR-WB decoding.

       Go to <http://sourceforge.net/projects/opencore-amr/> and follow the instructions for installing the
       libraries.  Then pass "--enable-libopencore-amrnb" and/or "--enable-libopencore-amrwb" to configure to
       enable them.

       VisualOn AMR-WB encoder library

       FFmpeg can make use of the VisualOn AMR-WBenc library for AMR-WB encoding.

       Go to <http://sourceforge.net/projects/opencore-amr/> and follow the instructions for installing the
       library.  Then pass "--enable-libvo-amrwbenc" to configure to enable it.

       Fraunhofer AAC library

       FFmpeg can make use of the Fraunhofer AAC library for AAC decoding & encoding.

       Go to <http://sourceforge.net/projects/opencore-amr/> and follow the instructions for installing the
       library.  Then pass "--enable-libfdk-aac" to configure to enable it.

   OpenH264
       FFmpeg can make use of the OpenH264 library for H.264 decoding and encoding.

       Go to <http://www.openh264.org/> and follow the instructions for installing the library. Then pass
       "--enable-libopenh264" to configure to enable it.

       For decoding, this library is much more limited than the built-in decoder in libavcodec; currently, this
       library lacks support for decoding B-frames and some other main/high profile features. (It currently only
       supports constrained baseline profile and CABAC.) Using it is mostly useful for testing and for taking
       advantage of Cisco's patent portfolio license (<http://www.openh264.org/BINARY_LICENSE.txt>).

   OpenJPEG
       FFmpeg can use the OpenJPEG libraries for decoding/encoding J2K videos.  Go to <http://www.openjpeg.org/>
       to get the libraries and follow the installation instructions.  To enable using OpenJPEG in FFmpeg, pass
       "--enable-libopenjpeg" to ./configure.

   rav1e
       FFmpeg can make use of rav1e (Rust AV1 Encoder) via its C bindings to encode videos.  Go to
       <https://github.com/xiph/rav1e/> and follow the instructions to build the C library. To enable using
       rav1e in FFmpeg, pass "--enable-librav1e" to ./configure.

   SVT-AV1
       FFmpeg can make use of the Scalable Video Technology for AV1 library for AV1 encoding.

       Go to <https://gitlab.com/AOMediaCodec/SVT-AV1/> and follow the instructions for installing the library.
       Then pass "--enable-libsvtav1" to configure to enable it.

   TwoLAME
       FFmpeg can make use of the TwoLAME library for MP2 encoding.

       Go to <http://www.twolame.org/> and follow the instructions for installing the library.  Then pass
       "--enable-libtwolame" to configure to enable it.

   VapourSynth
       FFmpeg can read VapourSynth scripts as input. To enable support, pass "--enable-vapoursynth" to
       configure. Vapoursynth is detected via "pkg-config". Versions 42 or greater supported.  See
       <http://www.vapoursynth.com/>.

       Due to security concerns, Vapoursynth scripts will not be autodetected so the input format has to be
       forced. For ff* CLI tools, add "-f vapoursynth" before the input "-i yourscript.vpy".

   x264
       FFmpeg can make use of the x264 library for H.264 encoding.

       Go to <http://www.videolan.org/developers/x264.html> and follow the instructions for installing the
       library. Then pass "--enable-libx264" to configure to enable it.

           x264 is under the GNU Public License Version 2 or later (see
           <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-licenses/gpl-2.0.html> for details), you must upgrade FFmpeg's
           license to GPL in order to use it.

   x265
       FFmpeg can make use of the x265 library for HEVC encoding.

       Go to <http://x265.org/developers.html> and follow the instructions for installing the library. Then pass
       "--enable-libx265" to configure to enable it.

           x265 is under the GNU Public License Version 2 or later (see
           <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-licenses/gpl-2.0.html> for details), you must upgrade FFmpeg's
           license to GPL in order to use it.

   xavs
       FFmpeg can make use of the xavs library for AVS encoding.

       Go to <http://xavs.sf.net/> and follow the instructions for installing the library. Then pass
       "--enable-libxavs" to configure to enable it.

   xavs2
       FFmpeg can make use of the xavs2 library for AVS2-P2/IEEE1857.4 video encoding.

       Go to <https://github.com/pkuvcl/xavs2> and follow the instructions for installing the library. Then pass
       "--enable-libxavs2" to configure to enable it.

           libxavs2 is under the GNU Public License Version 2 or later (see
           <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-licenses/gpl-2.0.html> for details), you must upgrade FFmpeg's
           license to GPL in order to use it.

   eXtra-fast Essential Video Encoder (XEVE)
       FFmpeg can make use of the XEVE library for EVC video encoding.

       Go to <https://github.com/mpeg5/xeve> and follow the instructions for installing the XEVE library. Then
       pass "--enable-libxeve" to configure to enable it.

   eXtra-fast Essential Video Decoder (XEVD)
       FFmpeg can make use of the XEVD library for EVC video decoding.

       Go to <https://github.com/mpeg5/xevd> and follow the instructions for installing the XEVD library. Then
       pass "--enable-libxevd" to configure to enable it.

   ZVBI
       ZVBI is a VBI decoding library which can be used by FFmpeg to decode DVB teletext pages and DVB teletext
       subtitles.

       Go to <http://sourceforge.net/projects/zapping/> and follow the instructions for installing the library.
       Then pass "--enable-libzvbi" to configure to enable it.

SUPPORTED FILE FORMATS

       You can use the "-formats" and "-codecs" options to have an exhaustive list.

   File Formats
       FFmpeg supports the following file formats through the "libavformat" library:

       Name  :  Encoding @tab Decoding @tab Comments
       3dostr                     :    @tab X
       4xm                        :    @tab X
               @tab 4X Technologies format, used in some games.

       8088flex TMV               :    @tab X
       AAX                        :    @tab X
               @tab Audible Enhanced Audio format, used in audiobooks.

       AA                         :    @tab X
               @tab Audible Format 2, 3, and 4, used in audiobooks.

       ACT Voice                  :    @tab X
               @tab contains G.729 audio

       Adobe Filmstrip            :  X @tab X
       Audio IFF (AIFF)           :  X @tab X
       American Laser Games MM    :    @tab X
               @tab Multimedia format used in games like Mad Dog McCree.

       3GPP AMR                   :  X @tab X
       Amazing Studio Packed Animation File   :    @tab X
               @tab Multimedia format used in game Heart Of Darkness.

       Apple HTTP Live Streaming  :    @tab X
       Artworx Data Format        :    @tab X
       Interplay ACM              :    @tab X
               @tab Audio only format used in some Interplay games.

       ADP                        :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used on the Nintendo Gamecube.

       AFC                        :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used on the Nintendo Gamecube.

       ADS/SS2                    :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used on the PS2.

       APNG                       :  X @tab X
       ASF                        :  X @tab X
               @tab Advanced / Active Streaming Format.

       AST                        :  X @tab X
               @tab Audio format used on the Nintendo Wii.

       AVI                        :  X @tab X
       AviSynth                   :    @tab X
       AVR                        :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used on Mac.

       AVS                        :    @tab X
               @tab Multimedia format used by the Creature Shock game.

       Beam Software SIFF         :    @tab X
               @tab Audio and video format used in some games by Beam Software.

       Bethesda Softworks VID     :    @tab X
               @tab Used in some games from Bethesda Softworks.

       Binary text                :    @tab X
       Bink                       :    @tab X
               @tab Multimedia format used by many games.

       Bink Audio                 :    @tab X
               @tab Audio only multimedia format used by some games.

       Bitmap Brothers JV         :    @tab X
               @tab Used in Z and Z95 games.

       BRP                        :    @tab X
               @tab Argonaut Games format.

       Brute Force & Ignorance    :    @tab X
               @tab Used in the game Flash Traffic: City of Angels.

       BFSTM                      :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used on the Nintendo WiiU (based on BRSTM).

       BRSTM                      :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used on the Nintendo Wii.

       BW64                       :    @tab X
               @tab Broadcast Wave 64bit.

       BWF                        :  X @tab X
       codec2 (raw)               :  X @tab X
               @tab Must be given -mode format option to decode correctly.

       codec2 (.c2 files)         :  X @tab X
               @tab Contains header with version and mode info, simplifying playback.

       CRI ADX                    :  X @tab X
               @tab Audio-only format used in console video games.

       CRI AIX                    :    @tab X
       CRI HCA                    :    @tab X
               @tab Audio-only format used in console video games.

       Discworld II BMV           :    @tab X
       Interplay C93              :    @tab X
               @tab Used in the game Cyberia from Interplay.

       Delphine Software International CIN  :    @tab X
               @tab Multimedia format used by Delphine Software games.

       Digital Speech Standard (DSS)  :    @tab X
       CD+G                       :    @tab X
               @tab Video format used by CD+G karaoke disks

       Phantom Cine               :    @tab X
       Commodore CDXL             :    @tab X
               @tab Amiga CD video format

       Core Audio Format          :  X @tab X
               @tab Apple Core Audio Format

       CRC testing format         :  X @tab
       Creative Voice             :  X @tab X
               @tab Created for the Sound Blaster Pro.

       CRYO APC                   :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used in some games by CRYO Interactive Entertainment.

       D-Cinema audio             :  X @tab X
       Deluxe Paint Animation     :    @tab X
       DCSTR                      :    @tab X
       DFA                        :    @tab X
               @tab This format is used in Chronomaster game

       DirectDraw Surface         :    @tab X
       DSD Stream File (DSF)      :    @tab X
       DV video                   :  X @tab X
       DXA                        :    @tab X
               @tab This format is used in the non-Windows version of the Feeble Files
                    game and different game cutscenes repacked for use with ScummVM.

       Electronic Arts cdata   :     @tab X
       Electronic Arts Multimedia   :     @tab X
               @tab Used in various EA games; files have extensions like WVE and UV2.

       Ensoniq Paris Audio File   :    @tab X
       FFM (FFserver live feed)   :  X @tab X
       Flash (SWF)                :  X @tab X
       Flash 9 (AVM2)             :  X @tab X
               @tab Only embedded audio is decoded.

       FLI/FLC/FLX animation      :    @tab X
               @tab .fli/.flc files

       Flash Video (FLV)          :  X @tab X
               @tab Macromedia Flash video files

       framecrc testing format    :  X @tab
       FunCom ISS                 :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used in various games from FunCom like The Longest Journey.

       G.723.1                    :  X @tab X
       G.726                      :    @tab X @tab Both left- and right-justified.
       G.729 BIT                  :  X @tab X
       G.729 raw                  :    @tab X
       GENH                       :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format for various games.

       GIF Animation              :  X @tab X
       GXF                        :  X @tab X
               @tab General eXchange Format SMPTE 360M, used by Thomson Grass Valley
                    playout servers.

       HNM  :    @tab X
               @tab Only version 4 supported, used in some games from Cryo Interactive

       iCEDraw File               :    @tab X
       ICO                        :  X @tab X
               @tab Microsoft Windows ICO

       id Quake II CIN video      :    @tab X
       id RoQ                     :  X @tab X
               @tab Used in Quake III, Jedi Knight 2 and other computer games.

       IEC61937 encapsulation  :  X @tab X
       IFF                        :    @tab X
               @tab Interchange File Format

       IFV                        :    @tab X
               @tab A format used by some old CCTV DVRs.

       iLBC                       :  X @tab X
       Interplay MVE              :    @tab X
               @tab Format used in various Interplay computer games.

       Iterated Systems ClearVideo  :      @tab  X
               @tab I-frames only

       IV8                        :    @tab X
               @tab A format generated by IndigoVision 8000 video server.

       IVF (On2)                  :  X @tab X
               @tab A format used by libvpx

       Internet Video Recording   :    @tab X
       IRCAM                      :  X @tab X
       LAF                        :    @tab X
               @tab Limitless Audio Format

       LATM                       :  X @tab X
       LMLM4                      :    @tab X
               @tab Used by Linux Media Labs MPEG-4 PCI boards

       LOAS                       :    @tab X
               @tab contains LATM multiplexed AAC audio

       LRC                        :  X @tab X
       LVF                        :    @tab X
       LXF                        :    @tab X
               @tab VR native stream format, used by Leitch/Harris' video servers.

       Magic Lantern Video (MLV)  :    @tab X
       Matroska                   :  X @tab X
       Matroska audio             :  X @tab
       FFmpeg metadata            :  X @tab X
               @tab Metadata in text format.

       MAXIS XA                   :    @tab X
               @tab Used in Sim City 3000; file extension .xa.

       MCA                        :    @tab X
               @tab Used in some games from Capcom; file extension .mca.

       MD Studio                  :    @tab X
       Metal Gear Solid: The Twin Snakes  :  @tab X
       Megalux Frame              :    @tab X
               @tab Used by Megalux Ultimate Paint

       MobiClip MODS              :    @tab X
       MobiClip MOFLEX            :    @tab X
       Mobotix .mxg               :    @tab X
       Monkey's Audio             :    @tab X
       Motion Pixels MVI          :    @tab X
       MOV/QuickTime/MP4          :  X @tab X
               @tab 3GP, 3GP2, PSP, iPod variants supported

       MP2                        :  X @tab X
       MP3                        :  X @tab X
       MPEG-1 System              :  X @tab X
               @tab muxed audio and video, VCD format supported

       MPEG-PS (program stream)   :  X @tab X
               @tab also known as C<VOB> file, SVCD and DVD format supported

       MPEG-TS (transport stream)  :  X @tab X
               @tab also known as DVB Transport Stream

       MPEG-4                     :  X @tab X
               @tab MPEG-4 is a variant of QuickTime.

       MSF                        :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used on the PS3.

       Mirillis FIC video         :    @tab X
               @tab No cursor rendering.

       MIDI Sample Dump Standard  :    @tab X
       MIME multipart JPEG        :  X @tab
       MSN TCP webcam             :    @tab X
               @tab Used by MSN Messenger webcam streams.

       MTV                        :    @tab X
       Musepack                   :    @tab X
       Musepack SV8               :    @tab X
       Material eXchange Format (MXF)  :  X @tab X
               @tab SMPTE 377M, used by D-Cinema, broadcast industry.

       Material eXchange Format (MXF), D-10 Mapping  :  X @tab X
               @tab SMPTE 386M, D-10/IMX Mapping.

       NC camera feed             :    @tab X
               @tab NC (AVIP NC4600) camera streams

       NIST SPeech HEader REsources  :    @tab X
       Computerized Speech Lab NSP  :    @tab X
       NTT TwinVQ (VQF)           :    @tab X
               @tab Nippon Telegraph and Telephone Corporation TwinVQ.

       Nullsoft Streaming Video   :    @tab X
       NuppelVideo                :    @tab X
       NUT                        :  X @tab X
               @tab NUT Open Container Format

       Ogg                        :  X @tab X
       Playstation Portable PMP   :    @tab X
       Portable Voice Format      :    @tab X
       RK Audio (RKA)             :    @tab X
       TechnoTrend PVA            :    @tab X
               @tab Used by TechnoTrend DVB PCI boards.

       QCP                        :    @tab X
       raw ADTS (AAC)             :  X @tab X
       raw AC-3                   :  X @tab X
       raw AMR-NB                 :    @tab X
       raw AMR-WB                 :    @tab X
       raw APAC                   :    @tab X
       raw aptX                   :  X @tab X
       raw aptX HD                :  X @tab X
       raw Bonk                   :    @tab X
       raw Chinese AVS video      :  X @tab X
       raw DFPWM                  :  X @tab X
       raw Dirac                  :  X @tab X
       raw DNxHD                  :  X @tab X
       raw DTS                    :  X @tab X
       raw DTS-HD                 :    @tab X
       raw E-AC-3                 :  X @tab X
       raw EVC                    :  X @tab X
       raw FLAC                   :  X @tab X
       raw GSM                    :    @tab X
       raw H.261                  :  X @tab X
       raw H.263                  :  X @tab X
       raw H.264                  :  X @tab X
       raw HEVC                   :  X @tab X
       raw Ingenient MJPEG        :    @tab X
       raw MJPEG                  :  X @tab X
       raw MLP                    :    @tab X
       raw MPEG                   :    @tab X
       raw MPEG-1                 :    @tab X
       raw MPEG-2                 :    @tab X
       raw MPEG-4                 :  X @tab X
       raw NULL                   :  X @tab
       raw video                  :  X @tab X
       raw id RoQ                 :  X @tab
       raw OBU                    :  X @tab X
       raw OSQ                    :    @tab X
       raw SBC                    :  X @tab X
       raw Shorten                :    @tab X
       raw TAK                    :    @tab X
       raw TrueHD                 :  X @tab X
       raw VC-1                   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM A-law              :  X @tab X
       raw PCM mu-law             :  X @tab X
       raw PCM Archimedes VIDC    :  X @tab X
       raw PCM signed 8 bit       :  X @tab X
       raw PCM signed 16 bit big-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM signed 16 bit little-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM signed 24 bit big-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM signed 24 bit little-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM signed 32 bit big-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM signed 32 bit little-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM signed 64 bit big-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM signed 64 bit little-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM unsigned 8 bit     :  X @tab X
       raw PCM unsigned 16 bit big-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM unsigned 16 bit little-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM unsigned 24 bit big-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM unsigned 24 bit little-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM unsigned 32 bit big-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM unsigned 32 bit little-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM 16.8 floating point little-endian  :    @tab X
       raw PCM 24.0 floating point little-endian  :    @tab X
       raw PCM floating-point 32 bit big-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM floating-point 32 bit little-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM floating-point 64 bit big-endian   :  X @tab X
       raw PCM floating-point 64 bit little-endian   :  X @tab X
       RDT                        :    @tab X
       REDCODE R3D                :    @tab X
               @tab File format used by RED Digital cameras, contains JPEG 2000 frames and PCM audio.

       RealMedia                  :  X @tab X
       Redirector                 :    @tab X
       RedSpark                   :    @tab X
       Renderware TeXture Dictionary  :    @tab X
       Resolume DXV               :  X @tab X
               @tab Encoding is only supported for the DXT1 (Normal Quality, No Alpha) texture format.

       RF64                       :    @tab X
       RL2                        :    @tab X
               @tab Audio and video format used in some games by Entertainment Software Partners.

       RPL/ARMovie                :    @tab X
       Lego Mindstorms RSO        :  X @tab X
       RSD                        :    @tab X
       RTMP                       :  X @tab X
               @tab Output is performed by publishing stream to RTMP server

       RTP                        :  X @tab X
       RTSP                       :  X @tab X
       Sample Dump eXchange       :    @tab X
       SAP                        :  X @tab X
       SBG                        :    @tab X
       SDNS                       :    @tab X
       SDP                        :    @tab X
       SER                        :    @tab X
       Digital Pictures SGA       :    @tab X
       Sega FILM/CPK              :  X @tab X
               @tab Used in many Sega Saturn console games.

       Silicon Graphics Movie     :    @tab X
       Sierra SOL                 :    @tab X
               @tab .sol files used in Sierra Online games.

       Sierra VMD                 :    @tab X
               @tab Used in Sierra CD-ROM games.

       Smacker                    :    @tab X
               @tab Multimedia format used by many games.

       SMJPEG                     :  X @tab X
               @tab Used in certain Loki game ports.

       SMPTE 337M encapsulation   :    @tab X
       Smush                      :    @tab X
               @tab Multimedia format used in some LucasArts games.

       Sony OpenMG (OMA)          :  X @tab X
               @tab Audio format used in Sony Sonic Stage and Sony Vegas.

       Sony PlayStation STR       :    @tab X
       Sony Wave64 (W64)          :  X @tab X
       SoX native format          :  X @tab X
       SUN AU format              :  X @tab X
       SUP raw PGS subtitles      :  X @tab X
       SVAG                       :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used in Konami PS2 games.

       TDSC                       :    @tab X
       Text files                 :    @tab X
       THP                        :    @tab X
               @tab Used on the Nintendo GameCube.

       Tiertex Limited SEQ        :    @tab X
               @tab Tiertex .seq files used in the DOS CD-ROM version of the game Flashback.

       True Audio                 :  X @tab X
       VAG                        :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used in many Sony PS2 games.

       VC-1 test bitstream        :  X @tab X
       Vidvox Hap                 :  X @tab X
       Vivo                       :    @tab X
       VPK                        :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used in Sony PS games.

       Marble WADY                :    @tab X
       WAV                        :  X @tab X
       Waveform Archiver          :    @tab X
       WavPack                    :  X @tab X
       WebM                       :  X @tab X
       Windows Televison (WTV)    :  X @tab X
       Wing Commander III movie   :    @tab X
               @tab Multimedia format used in Origin's Wing Commander III computer game.

       Westwood Studios audio     :  X @tab X
               @tab Multimedia format used in Westwood Studios games.

       Westwood Studios VQA       :    @tab X
               @tab Multimedia format used in Westwood Studios games.

       Wideband Single-bit Data (WSD)  :    @tab X
       WVE                        :    @tab X
       Konami XMD                 :    @tab X
       XMV                        :    @tab X
               @tab Microsoft video container used in Xbox games.

       XVAG                       :    @tab X
               @tab Audio format used on the PS3.

       xWMA                       :    @tab X
               @tab Microsoft audio container used by XAudio 2.

       eXtended BINary text (XBIN)  :  @tab X
       YUV4MPEG pipe              :  X @tab X
       Psygnosis YOP              :    @tab X

       "X" means that the feature in that column (encoding / decoding) is supported.

   Image Formats
       FFmpeg can read and write images for each frame of a video sequence. The following image formats are
       supported:

       Name  :  Encoding @tab Decoding @tab Comments
       .Y.U.V        :  X @tab X
               @tab one raw file per component

       Alias PIX     :  X @tab X
               @tab Alias/Wavefront PIX image format

       animated GIF  :  X @tab X
       APNG          :  X @tab X
               @tab Animated Portable Network Graphics

       BMP           :  X @tab X
               @tab Microsoft BMP image

       BRender PIX   :    @tab X
               @tab Argonaut BRender 3D engine image format.

       CRI           :    @tab X
               @tab Cintel RAW

       DPX           :  X @tab X
               @tab Digital Picture Exchange

       EXR           :    @tab X
               @tab OpenEXR

       FITS          :  X @tab X
               @tab Flexible Image Transport System

       HDR           :  X @tab X
               @tab Radiance HDR RGBE Image format

       IMG           :    @tab X
               @tab GEM Raster image

       JPEG          :  X @tab X
               @tab Progressive JPEG is not supported.

       JPEG 2000     :  X @tab X
       JPEG-LS       :  X @tab X
       LJPEG         :  X @tab
               @tab Lossless JPEG

       Media 100     :    @tab X
       MSP           :    @tab X
               @tab Microsoft Paint image

       PAM           :  X @tab X
               @tab PAM is a PNM extension with alpha support.

       PBM           :  X @tab X
               @tab Portable BitMap image

       PCD           :    @tab X
               @tab PhotoCD

       PCX           :  X @tab X
               @tab PC Paintbrush

       PFM           :  X @tab X
               @tab Portable FloatMap image

       PGM           :  X @tab X
               @tab Portable GrayMap image

       PGMYUV        :  X @tab X
               @tab PGM with U and V components in YUV 4:2:0

       PGX           :    @tab X
               @tab PGX file decoder

       PHM           :  X @tab X
               @tab Portable HalfFloatMap image

       PIC           :  @tab X
               @tab Pictor/PC Paint

       PNG           :  X @tab X
               @tab Portable Network Graphics image

       PPM           :  X @tab X
               @tab Portable PixelMap image

       PSD           :    @tab X
               @tab Photoshop

       PTX           :    @tab X
               @tab V.Flash PTX format

       QOI           :  X @tab X
               @tab Quite OK Image format

       SGI           :  X @tab X
               @tab SGI RGB image format

       Sun Rasterfile   :  X @tab X
               @tab Sun RAS image format

       TIFF          :  X @tab X
               @tab YUV, JPEG and some extension is not supported yet.

       Truevision Targa   :  X @tab X
               @tab Targa (.TGA) image format

       VBN   :  X @tab X
               @tab Vizrt Binary Image format

       WBMP          :  X @tab X
               @tab Wireless Application Protocol Bitmap image format

       WebP          :  E @tab X
               @tab WebP image format, encoding supported through external library libwebp

       XBM   :  X @tab X
               @tab X BitMap image format

       XFace  :  X @tab X
               @tab X-Face image format

       XPM   :    @tab X
               @tab X PixMap image format

       XWD   :  X @tab X
               @tab X Window Dump image format

       "X" means that the feature in that column (encoding / decoding) is supported.

       "E" means that support is provided through an external library.

   Video Codecs
       Name  :  Encoding @tab Decoding @tab Comments
       4X Movie                :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in certain computer games.

       8088flex TMV            :      @tab  X
       A64 multicolor          :   X  @tab
               @tab Creates video suitable to be played on a commodore 64 (multicolor mode).

       Amazing Studio PAF Video  :      @tab  X
       American Laser Games MM   :     @tab X
               @tab Used in games like Mad Dog McCree.

       Amuse Graphics Movie    :      @tab  X
       AMV Video               :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Used in Chinese MP3 players.

       ANSI/ASCII art          :      @tab  X
       Apple Intermediate Codec  :      @tab  X
       Apple MJPEG-B           :      @tab  X
       Apple Pixlet            :      @tab  X
       Apple ProRes            :   X  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: apch,apcn,apcs,apco,ap4h,ap4x

       Apple QuickDraw         :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: qdrw

       Argonaut Video          :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in some Argonaut games.

       Asus v1                 :   X  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: ASV1

       Asus v2                 :   X  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: ASV2

       ATI VCR1                :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: VCR1

       ATI VCR2                :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: VCR2

       Auravision Aura         :      @tab  X
       Auravision Aura 2       :      @tab  X
       Autodesk Animator Flic video   :      @tab  X
       Autodesk RLE            :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: AASC

       AV1                     :   E  @tab  E
               @tab Supported through external libraries libaom, libdav1d, librav1e and libsvtav1

       Avid 1:1 10-bit RGB Packer   :   X  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: AVrp

       AVS (Audio Video Standard) video   :      @tab  X
               @tab Video encoding used by the Creature Shock game.

       AVS2-P2/IEEE1857.4      :   E  @tab  E
               @tab Supported through external libraries libxavs2 and libdavs2

       AVS3-P2/IEEE1857.10     :      @tab  E
               @tab Supported through external library libuavs3d

       AYUV                    :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Microsoft uncompressed packed 4:4:4:4

       Beam Software VB        :      @tab  X
       Bethesda VID video      :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in some games from Bethesda Softworks.

       Bink Video              :      @tab  X
       BitJazz SheerVideo      :      @tab  X
       Bitmap Brothers JV video   :    @tab X
       y41p Brooktree uncompressed 4:1:1 12-bit      :   X  @tab  X
       Brooktree ProSumer Video   :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: BT20

       Brute Force & Ignorance    :    @tab X
               @tab Used in the game Flash Traffic: City of Angels.

       C93 video               :      @tab  X
               @tab Codec used in Cyberia game.

       CamStudio               :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: CSCD

       CD+G                    :      @tab  X
               @tab Video codec for CD+G karaoke disks

       CDXL                    :      @tab  X
               @tab Amiga CD video codec

       Chinese AVS video       :   E  @tab  X
               @tab AVS1-P2, JiZhun profile, encoding through external library libxavs

       Delphine Software International CIN video   :      @tab  X
               @tab Codec used in Delphine Software International games.

       Discworld II BMV Video  :      @tab  X
       CineForm HD             :   X  @tab  X
       Canopus HQ              :      @tab  X
       Canopus HQA             :      @tab  X
       Canopus HQX             :      @tab  X
       Canopus Lossless Codec  :      @tab  X
       CDToons                 :      @tab  X
               @tab Codec used in various Broderbund games.

       Cinepak                 :      @tab  X
       Cirrus Logic AccuPak    :   X  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: CLJR

       CPiA Video Format       :      @tab  X
       Creative YUV (CYUV)     :      @tab  X
       DFA                     :      @tab  X
               @tab Codec used in Chronomaster game.

       Dirac                   :   E  @tab  X
               @tab supported though the native vc2 (Dirac Pro) encoder

       Deluxe Paint Animation  :      @tab  X
       DNxHD                   :    X @tab  X
               @tab aka SMPTE VC3

       Duck TrueMotion 1.0    :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: DUCK

       Duck TrueMotion 2.0     :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: TM20

       Duck TrueMotion 2.0 RT  :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: TR20

       DV (Digital Video)      :   X  @tab  X
       Dxtory capture format   :      @tab  X
       Feeble Files/ScummVM DXA   :      @tab  X
               @tab Codec originally used in Feeble Files game.

       Electronic Arts CMV video   :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in NHL 95 game.

       Electronic Arts Madcow video   :      @tab  X
       Electronic Arts TGV video   :      @tab  X
       Electronic Arts TGQ video   :      @tab  X
       Electronic Arts TQI video   :      @tab  X
       Escape 124              :      @tab  X
       Escape 130              :      @tab  X
       EVC / MPEG-5 Part 1     :   E  @tab  E
               @tab encoding and decoding supported through external libraries libxeve and libxevd

       FFmpeg video codec #1   :   X  @tab  X
               @tab lossless codec (fourcc: FFV1)

       Flash Screen Video v1   :   X  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: FSV1

       Flash Screen Video v2   :   X  @tab  X
       Flash Video (FLV)       :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Sorenson H.263 used in Flash

       FM Screen Capture Codec   :      @tab  X
       Forward Uncompressed    :      @tab  X
       Fraps                   :      @tab  X
       Go2Meeting              :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: G2M2, G2M3

       Go2Webinar              :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: G2M4

       Gremlin Digital Video   :      @tab  X
       H.261                   :   X  @tab  X
       H.263 / H.263-1996      :   X  @tab  X
       H.263+ / H.263-1998 / H.263 version 2   :   X  @tab  X
       H.264 / AVC / MPEG-4 AVC / MPEG-4 part 10   :   E  @tab  X
               @tab encoding supported through external library libx264 and OpenH264

       HEVC                    :   X  @tab  X
               @tab encoding supported through external library libx265 and libkvazaar

       HNM version 4           :      @tab  X
       HuffYUV                 :   X  @tab  X
       HuffYUV FFmpeg variant  :   X  @tab  X
       IBM Ultimotion          :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: ULTI

       id Cinematic video      :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in Quake II.

       id RoQ video            :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Used in Quake III, Jedi Knight 2, other computer games.

       IFF ILBM                :      @tab  X
               @tab IFF interleaved bitmap

       IFF ByteRun1            :      @tab  X
               @tab IFF run length encoded bitmap

       Infinity IMM4           :      @tab  X
       Intel H.263             :      @tab  X
       Intel Indeo 2           :      @tab  X
       Intel Indeo 3           :      @tab  X
       Intel Indeo 4           :      @tab  X
       Intel Indeo 5           :      @tab  X
       Interplay C93           :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in the game Cyberia from Interplay.

       Interplay MVE video     :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in Interplay .MVE files.

       J2K  :   X  @tab  X
       Karl Morton's video codec   :      @tab  X
               @tab Codec used in Worms games.

       Kega Game Video (KGV1)  :       @tab  X
               @tab Kega emulator screen capture codec.

       Lagarith                :      @tab  X
       LCL (LossLess Codec Library) MSZH   :      @tab  X
       LCL (LossLess Codec Library) ZLIB   :   E  @tab  E
       LEAD MCMP               :      @tab  X
       LOCO                    :      @tab  X
       LucasArts SANM/Smush    :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in LucasArts games / SMUSH animations.

       lossless MJPEG          :   X  @tab  X
       MagicYUV Video          :   X  @tab  X
       Mandsoft Screen Capture Codec   :      @tab  X
       Microsoft ATC Screen    :      @tab  X
               @tab Also known as Microsoft Screen 3.

       Microsoft Expression Encoder Screen   :      @tab  X
               @tab Also known as Microsoft Titanium Screen 2.

       Microsoft RLE           :   X  @tab  X
       Microsoft Screen 1      :      @tab  X
               @tab Also known as Windows Media Video V7 Screen.

       Microsoft Screen 2      :      @tab  X
               @tab Also known as Windows Media Video V9 Screen.

       Microsoft Video 1       :      @tab  X
       Mimic                   :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in MSN Messenger Webcam streams.

       Miro VideoXL            :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: VIXL

       MJPEG (Motion JPEG)     :   X  @tab  X
       Mobotix MxPEG video     :      @tab  X
       Motion Pixels video     :      @tab  X
       MPEG-1 video            :   X  @tab  X
       MPEG-2 video            :   X  @tab  X
       MPEG-4 part 2           :   X  @tab  X
               @tab libxvidcore can be used alternatively for encoding.

       MPEG-4 part 2 Microsoft variant version 1   :      @tab  X
       MPEG-4 part 2 Microsoft variant version 2   :   X  @tab  X
       MPEG-4 part 2 Microsoft variant version 3   :   X  @tab  X
       Newtek SpeedHQ                :   X  @tab  X
       Nintendo Gamecube THP video   :      @tab  X
       NotchLC                 :      @tab  X
       NuppelVideo/RTjpeg      :      @tab  X
               @tab Video encoding used in NuppelVideo files.

       On2 VP3                 :      @tab  X
               @tab still experimental

       On2 VP4                 :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: VP40

       On2 VP5                 :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: VP50

       On2 VP6                 :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: VP60,VP61,VP62

       On2 VP7                 :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: VP70,VP71

       VP8                     :   E  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: VP80, encoding supported through external library libvpx

       VP9                     :   E  @tab  X
               @tab encoding supported through external library libvpx

       Pinnacle TARGA CineWave YUV16  :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: Y216

       Q-team QPEG             :      @tab  X
               @tab fourccs: QPEG, Q1.0, Q1.1

       QuickTime 8BPS video    :      @tab  X
       QuickTime Animation (RLE) video   :   X  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: 'rle '

       QuickTime Graphics (SMC)   :   X  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: 'smc '

       QuickTime video (RPZA)  :   X  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: rpza

       R10K AJA Kona 10-bit RGB Codec      :   X  @tab  X
       R210 Quicktime Uncompressed RGB 10-bit      :   X  @tab  X
       Raw Video               :   X  @tab  X
       RealVideo 1.0           :   X  @tab  X
       RealVideo 2.0           :   X  @tab  X
       RealVideo 3.0           :      @tab  X
               @tab still far from ideal

       RealVideo 4.0           :      @tab  X
       Renderware TXD (TeXture Dictionary)   :      @tab  X
               @tab Texture dictionaries used by the Renderware Engine.

       RivaTuner Video         :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: 'RTV1'

       RL2 video               :      @tab  X
               @tab used in some games by Entertainment Software Partners

       ScreenPressor           :      @tab  X
       Screenpresso            :      @tab  X
       Screen Recorder Gold Codec   :      @tab  X
       Sierra VMD video        :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in Sierra VMD files.

       Silicon Graphics Motion Video Compressor 1 (MVC1)   :      @tab  X
       Silicon Graphics Motion Video Compressor 2 (MVC2)   :      @tab  X
       Silicon Graphics RLE 8-bit video   :      @tab  X
       Smacker video           :      @tab  X
               @tab Video encoding used in Smacker.

       SMPTE VC-1              :      @tab  X
       Snow                    :   X  @tab  X
               @tab experimental wavelet codec (fourcc: SNOW)

       Sony PlayStation MDEC (Motion DECoder)   :      @tab  X
       Sorenson Vector Quantizer 1   :   X  @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: SVQ1

       Sorenson Vector Quantizer 3   :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: SVQ3

       Sunplus JPEG (SP5X)     :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: SP5X

       TechSmith Screen Capture Codec   :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: TSCC

       TechSmith Screen Capture Codec 2   :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: TSC2

       Theora                  :   E  @tab  X
               @tab encoding supported through external library libtheora

       Tiertex Limited SEQ video   :      @tab  X
               @tab Codec used in DOS CD-ROM FlashBack game.

       Ut Video                :   X  @tab  X
       v210 QuickTime uncompressed 4:2:2 10-bit      :   X  @tab  X
       v308 QuickTime uncompressed 4:4:4             :   X  @tab  X
       v408 QuickTime uncompressed 4:4:4:4           :   X  @tab  X
       v410 QuickTime uncompressed 4:4:4 10-bit      :   X  @tab  X
       VBLE Lossless Codec     :      @tab  X
       vMix Video              :      @tab  X
               @tab fourcc: 'VMX1'

       VMware Screen Codec / VMware Video   :      @tab  X
               @tab Codec used in videos captured by VMware.

       Westwood Studios VQA (Vector Quantized Animation) video   :      @tab  X
       Windows Media Image     :      @tab  X
       Windows Media Video 7   :   X  @tab  X
       Windows Media Video 8   :   X  @tab  X
       Windows Media Video 9   :      @tab  X
               @tab not completely working

       Wing Commander III / Xan   :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in Wing Commander III .MVE files.

       Wing Commander IV / Xan   :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in Wing Commander IV.

       Winnov WNV1             :      @tab  X
       WMV7                    :   X  @tab  X
       YAMAHA SMAF             :   X  @tab  X
       Psygnosis YOP Video     :      @tab  X
       yuv4                    :   X  @tab  X
               @tab libquicktime uncompressed packed 4:2:0

       ZeroCodec Lossless Video  :      @tab  X
       ZLIB                    :   X  @tab  X
               @tab part of LCL, encoder experimental

       Zip Motion Blocks Video   :    X @tab  X
               @tab Encoder works only in PAL8.

       "X" means that the feature in that column (encoding / decoding) is supported.

       "E" means that support is provided through an external library.

   Audio Codecs
       Name  :  Encoding @tab Decoding @tab Comments
       8SVX exponential        :      @tab  X
       8SVX fibonacci          :      @tab  X
       AAC                     :  EX  @tab  X
               @tab encoding supported through internal encoder and external library libfdk-aac

       AAC+                    :   E  @tab  IX
               @tab encoding supported through external library libfdk-aac

       AC-3                    :  IX  @tab  IX
       ACELP.KELVIN            :      @tab  X
       ADPCM 4X Movie          :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Yamaha AICA       :      @tab  X
       ADPCM AmuseGraphics Movie  :     @tab  X
       ADPCM Argonaut Games    :  X   @tab  X
       ADPCM CDROM XA          :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Creative Technology  :      @tab  X
               @tab 16 -E<gt> 4, 8 -E<gt> 4, 8 -E<gt> 3, 8 -E<gt> 2

       ADPCM Electronic Arts   :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in various EA titles.

       ADPCM Electronic Arts Maxis CDROM XS   :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in Sim City 3000.

       ADPCM Electronic Arts R1   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Electronic Arts R2   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Electronic Arts R3   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Electronic Arts XAS  :      @tab  X
       ADPCM G.722             :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM G.726             :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA Acorn Replay  :      @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA AMV           :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Used in AMV files

       ADPCM IMA Cunning Developments   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA Electronic Arts EACS   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA Electronic Arts SEAD   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA Funcom        :      @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA High Voltage Software ALP       :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA Mobiclip MOFLEX   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA QuickTime     :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA Simon & Schuster Interactive    :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA Ubisoft APM   :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA Loki SDL MJPEG   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA WAV           :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA Westwood      :      @tab  X
       ADPCM ISS IMA           :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in FunCom games.

       ADPCM IMA Dialogic      :      @tab  X
       ADPCM IMA Duck DK3      :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in some Sega Saturn console games.

       ADPCM IMA Duck DK4      :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in some Sega Saturn console games.

       ADPCM IMA Radical       :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Microsoft         :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM MS IMA            :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM Nintendo Gamecube AFC   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Nintendo Gamecube DTK   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Nintendo THP   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Playstation       :      @tab  X
       ADPCM QT IMA            :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM SEGA CRI ADX      :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Used in Sega Dreamcast games.

       ADPCM Shockwave Flash   :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM Sound Blaster Pro 2-bit   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Sound Blaster Pro 2.6-bit   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Sound Blaster Pro 4-bit   :      @tab  X
       ADPCM VIMA              :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in LucasArts SMUSH animations.

       ADPCM Konami XMD        :      @tab  X
       ADPCM Westwood Studios IMA       :   X @tab  X
               @tab Used in Westwood Studios games like Command and Conquer.

       ADPCM Yamaha            :   X  @tab  X
       ADPCM Zork              :      @tab  X
       AMR-NB                  :   E  @tab  X
               @tab encoding supported through external library libopencore-amrnb

       AMR-WB                  :   E  @tab  X
               @tab encoding supported through external library libvo-amrwbenc

       Amazing Studio PAF Audio  :      @tab  X
       Apple lossless audio    :   X  @tab  X
               @tab QuickTime fourcc 'alac'

       aptX                    :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Used in Bluetooth A2DP

       aptX HD                 :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Used in Bluetooth A2DP

       ATRAC1                  :      @tab  X
       ATRAC3                  :      @tab  X
       ATRAC3+                 :      @tab  X
       ATRAC9                  :      @tab  X
       Bink Audio              :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in Bink and Smacker files in many games.

       Bonk audio              :      @tab  X
       CELT                    :      @tab  E
               @tab decoding supported through external library libcelt

       codec2                  :   E  @tab  E
               @tab en/decoding supported through external library libcodec2

       CRI HCA                 :      @tab X
       Delphine Software International CIN audio   :      @tab  X
               @tab Codec used in Delphine Software International games.

       DFPWM                   :   X  @tab  X
       Digital Speech Standard - Standard Play mode (DSS SP)  :      @tab  X
       Discworld II BMV Audio  :      @tab  X
       COOK                    :      @tab  X
               @tab All versions except 5.1 are supported.

       DCA (DTS Coherent Acoustics)   :   X  @tab  X
               @tab supported extensions: XCh, XXCH, X96, XBR, XLL, LBR (partially)

       Dolby E   :      @tab  X
       DPCM Cuberoot-Delta-Exact  :   @tab  X
               @tab Used in few games.

       DPCM Gremlin            :      @tab  X
       DPCM id RoQ             :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Used in Quake III, Jedi Knight 2 and other computer games.

       DPCM Marble WADY        :      @tab  X
       DPCM Interplay          :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in various Interplay computer games.

       DPCM Squareroot-Delta-Exact   :   @tab  X
               @tab Used in various games.

       DPCM Sierra Online      :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in Sierra Online game audio files.

       DPCM Sol                :      @tab  X
       DPCM Xan                :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in Origin's Wing Commander IV AVI files.

       DPCM Xilam DERF         :      @tab  X
       DSD (Direct Stream Digital), least significant bit first   :   @tab  X
       DSD (Direct Stream Digital), most significant bit first    :   @tab  X
       DSD (Direct Stream Digital), least significant bit first, planar   :   @tab  X
       DSD (Direct Stream Digital), most significant bit first, planar    :   @tab  X
       DSP Group TrueSpeech    :      @tab  X
       DST (Direct Stream Transfer)  :   @tab  X
       DV audio                :      @tab  X
       Enhanced AC-3           :   X  @tab  X
       EVRC (Enhanced Variable Rate Codec)  :      @tab  X
       FLAC (Free Lossless Audio Codec)   :   X  @tab  IX
       FTR Voice               :      @tab  X
       G.723.1                 :  X   @tab  X
       G.729                   :      @tab  X
       GSM                     :   E  @tab  X
               @tab encoding supported through external library libgsm

       GSM Microsoft variant   :   E  @tab  X
               @tab encoding supported through external library libgsm

       IAC (Indeo Audio Coder)   :      @tab  X
       iLBC (Internet Low Bitrate Codec)  :   E  @tab  EX
               @tab encoding and decoding supported through external library libilbc

       IMC (Intel Music Coder)   :      @tab  X
       Interplay ACM             :      @tab  X
       MACE (Macintosh Audio Compression/Expansion) 3:1   :      @tab  X
       MACE (Macintosh Audio Compression/Expansion) 6:1   :      @tab  X
       Marian's A-pac audio      :      @tab  X
       MI-SC4 (Micronas SC-4 Audio)   :      @tab  X
       MLP (Meridian Lossless Packing)   :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Used in DVD-Audio discs.

       Monkey's Audio          :      @tab  X
       MP1 (MPEG audio layer 1)   :      @tab IX
       MP2 (MPEG audio layer 2)   :  IX  @tab IX
               @tab encoding supported also through external library TwoLAME

       MP3 (MPEG audio layer 3)   :   E  @tab IX
               @tab encoding supported through external library LAME, ADU MP3 and MP3onMP4 also supported

       MPEG-4 Audio Lossless Coding (ALS)   :      @tab  X
       MobiClip FastAudio      :      @tab  X
       Musepack SV7            :      @tab  X
       Musepack SV8            :      @tab  X
       Nellymoser Asao         :   X  @tab  X
       On2 AVC (Audio for Video Codec)  :      @tab  X
       Opus                    :   E  @tab  X
               @tab encoding supported through external library libopus

       OSQ (Original Sound Quality)   :      @tab  X
       PCM A-law               :   X  @tab  X
       PCM mu-law              :   X  @tab  X
       PCM Archimedes VIDC     :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 8-bit planar   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 16-bit big-endian planar   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 16-bit little-endian planar   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 24-bit little-endian planar   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 32-bit little-endian planar   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM 32-bit floating point big-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM 32-bit floating point little-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM 64-bit floating point big-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM 64-bit floating point little-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM D-Cinema audio signed 24-bit    :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 8-bit        :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 16-bit big-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 16-bit little-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 24-bit big-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 24-bit little-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 32-bit big-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 32-bit little-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM signed 16/20/24-bit big-endian in MPEG-TS   :      @tab  X
       PCM unsigned 8-bit      :   X  @tab  X
       PCM unsigned 16-bit big-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM unsigned 16-bit little-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM unsigned 24-bit big-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM unsigned 24-bit little-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM unsigned 32-bit big-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM unsigned 32-bit little-endian   :   X  @tab  X
       PCM SGA                 :      @tab  X
       QCELP / PureVoice       :      @tab  X
       QDesign Music Codec 1   :      @tab  X
       QDesign Music Codec 2   :      @tab  X
               @tab There are still some distortions.

       RealAudio 1.0 (14.4K)   :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Real 14400 bit/s codec

       RealAudio 2.0 (28.8K)   :      @tab  X
               @tab Real 28800 bit/s codec

       RealAudio 3.0 (dnet)    :  IX  @tab  X
               @tab Real low bitrate AC-3 codec

       RealAudio Lossless      :      @tab  X
       RealAudio SIPR / ACELP.NET  :      @tab  X
       RK Audio (RKA)          :      @tab  X
       SBC (low-complexity subband codec)  :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Used in Bluetooth A2DP

       Shorten                 :      @tab  X
       Sierra VMD audio        :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in Sierra VMD files.

       Smacker audio           :      @tab  X
       SMPTE 302M AES3 audio   :   X  @tab  X
       Sonic                   :   X  @tab  X
               @tab experimental codec

       Sonic lossless          :   X  @tab  X
               @tab experimental codec

       Speex                   :   E  @tab  EX
               @tab supported through external library libspeex

       TAK (Tom's lossless Audio Kompressor)   :      @tab  X
       True Audio (TTA)        :   X  @tab  X
       TrueHD                  :   X  @tab  X
               @tab Used in HD-DVD and Blu-Ray discs.

       TwinVQ (VQF flavor)     :      @tab  X
       VIMA                    :      @tab  X
               @tab Used in LucasArts SMUSH animations.

       ViewQuest VQC           :      @tab  X
       Vorbis                  :   E  @tab  X
               @tab A native but very primitive encoder exists.

       Voxware MetaSound       :      @tab  X
       Waveform Archiver       :      @tab  X
       WavPack                 :   X  @tab  X
       Westwood Audio (SND1)   :      @tab  X
       Windows Media Audio 1   :   X  @tab  X
       Windows Media Audio 2   :   X  @tab  X
       Windows Media Audio Lossless  :   @tab  X
       Windows Media Audio Pro  :     @tab  X
       Windows Media Audio Voice  :   @tab  X
       Xbox Media Audio 1      :      @tab  X
       Xbox Media Audio 2      :      @tab  X

       "X" means that the feature in that column (encoding / decoding) is supported.

       "E" means that support is provided through an external library.

       "I" means that an integer-only version is available, too (ensures high performance on systems without
       hardware floating point support).

   Subtitle Formats
       Name  :  Muxing @tab Demuxing @tab Encoding @tab Decoding
       3GPP Timed Text   :    @tab   @tab X @tab X
       AQTitle           :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       DVB               :  X @tab X @tab X @tab X
       DVB teletext      :    @tab X @tab   @tab E
       DVD               :  X @tab X @tab X @tab X
       JACOsub           :  X @tab X @tab   @tab X
       MicroDVD          :  X @tab X @tab   @tab X
       MPL2              :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       MPsub (MPlayer)   :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       PGS               :    @tab   @tab   @tab X
       PJS (Phoenix)     :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       RealText          :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       SAMI              :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       Spruce format (STL)  :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       SSA/ASS           :  X @tab X @tab X @tab X
       SubRip (SRT)      :  X @tab X @tab X @tab X
       SubViewer v1      :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       SubViewer         :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       TED Talks captions  :  @tab X @tab   @tab X
       TTML              :  X @tab   @tab X @tab
       VobSub (IDX+SUB)  :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       VPlayer           :    @tab X @tab   @tab X
       WebVTT            :  X @tab X @tab X @tab X
       XSUB              :    @tab   @tab X @tab X

       "X" means that the feature is supported.

       "E" means that support is provided through an external library.

   Network Protocols
       Name          :  Support
       AMQP          :  E
       file          :  X
       FTP           :  X
       Gopher        :  X
       Gophers       :  X
       HLS           :  X
       HTTP          :  X
       HTTPS         :  X
       Icecast       :  X
       MMSH          :  X
       MMST          :  X
       pipe          :  X
       Pro-MPEG FEC  :  X
       RTMP          :  X
       RTMPE         :  X
       RTMPS         :  X
       RTMPT         :  X
       RTMPTE        :  X
       RTMPTS        :  X
       RTP           :  X
       SAMBA         :  E
       SCTP          :  X
       SFTP          :  E
       TCP           :  X
       TLS           :  X
       UDP           :  X
       ZMQ           :  E

       "X" means that the protocol is supported.

       "E" means that support is provided through an external library.

   Input/Output Devices
       Name               :  Input  @tab Output
       ALSA               :  X      @tab X
       BKTR               :  X      @tab
       caca               :         @tab X
       DV1394             :  X      @tab
       Lavfi virtual device  :  X   @tab
       Linux framebuffer  :  X      @tab X
       JACK               :  X      @tab
       LIBCDIO            :  X
       LIBDC1394          :  X      @tab
       OpenAL             :  X
       OpenGL             :         @tab X
       OSS                :  X      @tab X
       PulseAudio         :  X      @tab X
       SDL                :         @tab X
       Video4Linux2       :  X      @tab X
       VfW capture        :  X      @tab
       X11 grabbing       :  X      @tab
       Win32 grabbing     :  X      @tab

       "X" means that input/output is supported.

   Timecode
       Codec/format       :  Read   @tab Write
       AVI                :  X      @tab X
       DV                 :  X      @tab X
       GXF                :  X      @tab X
       MOV                :  X      @tab X
       MPEG1/2            :  X      @tab X
       MXF                :  X      @tab X

SEE ALSO

       ffmpeg(1), ffplay(1), ffprobe(1), ffmpeg-utils(1), ffmpeg-scaler(1), ffmpeg-resampler(1),
       ffmpeg-codecs(1), ffmpeg-bitstream-filters(1), ffmpeg-formats(1), ffmpeg-devices(1), ffmpeg-protocols(1),
       ffmpeg-filters(1)

AUTHORS

       The FFmpeg developers.

       For details about the authorship, see the Git history of the project (https://git.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg),
       e.g. by typing the command git log in the FFmpeg source directory, or browsing the online repository at
       <https://git.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg>.

       Maintainers for the specific components are listed in the file MAINTAINERS in the source code tree.

                                                                                                   FFMPEG-ALL(1)